View
218
Download
2
Category
Preview:
Citation preview
1
AFBE 2015 CONFERENCE PAPERS
– Udayana
University
ISSN 1905-8055
2
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PUBLIC SERVICES MODEL IN VOCATIONAL HIGH SCHOOL AT KENDARI, SOUTHEAST SULAWESI, INDONESIA Jamal Bake Rola Pola Anto
6
STUDENTS’ PRIDE IN HIGHER EDUCATION SERVICE CONTEXT: A MARKETING PERSPECTIVE Joseph Robert Daniel
20
ENTREPRENEURSHIP AND ECONOMIC TRANSFORMATION (CASE STUDY: BLIMBINGSARI COMMUNITY) Wayan Ruspendi Junaedi
46
PRACTICE ENTREPRENEURSHIP AMONG STUDENTS AS A FORM OF PREPARATION THE ASEAN ECONOMIC COMMUNITY IN 2015 (CASE STUDY ON THREE STUDENTS DIPLOMA PROGRAM UNIVERSITYOF BUSINESS AND ENTREPRENEURSHIP 2015 JAKARTA GUNADARMA) Dassaad, SE Mulatsih, SE
59
ENTREPRENEUR STUDENT’S CREATED MODEL BASED ON BUSINESS INCUBATOR AT STATE POLYTECHNIC OF SRIWIJAYA Bainil Yulina Pridson Mandiangan Indah Indra Andi
75
THE APPLICATION OF GREEN BEHAVIOR: ‘GO GREEN’ FOR CAMPUS THROUGH PLASTIC WASTE MANAGEMENT FOR UNIVERSITY IN SOUTH KALIMANTAN REGION Hastin Umi Anisah, Wimby Wandary, Tinik Sugiati
98
ETHICS AS THE BASIS FOR INCREASING ROLE OF HUMAN RESOURCE MANAGEMENT STRATEGIES IN THE PUBLIC SERVICE Yulia Hambo Gita Amalia
108
MODERATOR VARIABLE IDENTIFICATION AND ANALYSIS OF RELATIONSHIP SATISFACTION AND LOYALTY (STUDY IN ISLAMIC BANK CUSTOMERS IN CENTRAL JAVA) Mokhamad Arwani Marthin Nanere
114
ANTECEDENTS CUSTOMERS BANKING LOYALTY Dwy Puspitasari Mokhamad Arwani Suprehatin Marthin Nanere
123
3
AN EXPLORATORY STUDY ON CONSUMERS’ BEHAVIOR OF CANANG IN BALI: THE IMPLEMENTATION OF SOCIAL MARKETING CONCEPT TOWARDS ECO-FRIENDLY BEHAVIOR Ni Wayan Sri Suprapti Ni Ketut Purnawati Ni Made Rastini Sudarsana Arka Eka Ardhani Sisdyani
137
STRATEGY FOR WOODEN CRAFT INDUSTRY DEVELOPMENT IN GIANYAR REGENCY Gusti Ayu Ketut Giantari Ni Wayan Ekawati Komang Ardana Made Jatra
150
SOCIAL MEDIA: BRINGING REAL WORLD PRACTICES INTO BUSINESS EDUCATION AND LEARNING Harriet Perryer
163
SPATIAL ANALYSIS TO DETERMINE OPTIMAL LOCATION FOR RETAIL STORE IN SLEMAN DISTRICT, SPECIAL REGION OF YOGYAKARTA PROVINCE Sa’duddin Kuncoro Harto Widodo
168
AN ANALYSIS OF FACTORS INFLUENCING REGIONAL ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT: A CASE STUDY ON THE ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT OF THE SPECIAL REGION OF YOGYAKARTA, INDONESIA Fitra Prasapawidya Purna Didin Wahyudin Imamudin Yuliadi Wahdi Salasi April Yudhi
174
BUSINESS MANAGEMENT AND NATIONAL CULTURE IN MONGOLIA: A LITERATURE REVIEW Bolormaa Boldbaatar
190
EFFECT OF MINUMUM WAGE, GDP AND POPULATION AGAINST OPEN UNEMPLOYMENT RATE IN WEST JAVA IN 2010-2013 Helin Garlinia Y
199
OPTIMIZING DIGITAL MARKETING STRATEGY THROUGH CUSTOMIZATION SYSTEM DEVELOPMENT FOR OUTFIDES R. Dewintha Nur Annisa Intan Rizky Mutiaz
210
4
SMALL MEDIUM ENTERPRISE (SMES) DEVELOPMENT STRATEGY IN ENHANCING THE LOCAL COMPETITIVENESS BY USING CLUSTER MANAGEMENT APPLICATION Mochamad Edris
M. Zainuri
Mamik Indaryani
Marthin Nanere
231
THE INFLUENCE OF SERVICE MARKETING MIX TOWARD STUDENTS DECISIONS TO STUDY AT THE CENTER FOR COMPUTING INFORMATION AND TECHNOLOGY FAKULTAS TEKNIK UNIVERSITAS INDONESIA Siska Purnama Manurung
Ikhlas Nurzaman Tasya Aspiranti
242
EMPOWERMENT MODEL OF BUSINESS OWNED BY WOMEN IN INFORMAL SECTOR: CASE IN YOGYAKARTA PROVINCE, INDONESIA Sauptika Kancana Puji Lestari
253
THE INFLUENCE OF ENTREPRENEUR BEHAVIOR, BUSINESS MOTIVATION AND MANAGERIAL ABILITY TOWARD THE BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND ITS IMPLICATION ON THEIR BUSINESS SUSTAINABILITY (STUDY ON SMALL SCALE BUSINESSES IN KENDARI CITY) Mahmudin AS Muslimin Mansyur Asri Muhidin Sharman
267
THE INFLUENCE OF OPERATIONAL FLEXIBILITY CAPABILITIES TOWARD TRUST (STUDY AT SMALL AND MICRO ENTERPRISE) Wirdah Irawati, SE. Yurnalis
280
THE EFFECT OF ORGANIZATIONAL JUSTICE ON JOB SATISFACTION AND ORGANIZATIONAL COMMITMENT Lino Da Silva Saldanha Wayan Gede Supartha Gede Riana
290
DATA ENVELOPMENT ANALYSIS METHOD TO ESTIMATE STOCK RETURN IN BANKING FIRMS Joni Devitra
301
INTEGRATION OF ASEAN 5 +3 STOCK MARKETS AND RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN STOCK MARKETS WITH EXCHANGE RATE AND CRUDE OIL Umi Mujahadah
318
TESTING PECKING ORDER THEORY AND TRADE OFF THEORY MODELS IN PUBLIC COMPANIES IN INDONESIA Arief Yulianto Notonegoro
339
5
CREATIVITY AND INNOVATION: CONTRIBUTION OF EMPLOYEE EMPOWERMENT AND ASTA BRATA LEADERSHIP Desak Ketut Sintaasih Ayu Desi Indrawati Ni Wayan Mujiati
350
BRIDGING THE GAP BETWEEN PROFESSIONAL ACCOUNTANT AND SMALL MEDIUM ENTERPRISE: INDONESIA CASE Novita Puspasari Agus Faturrokhman Kiky Sri Rejeki Margani Pinasti
378
BUDGETING ADMINISTRATION OF AUTONOMOUS UNIVERSITIES Wasan Kanchanamukda
390
DESIGNING PERFORMANCE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM USING THE BALANCED SCORECARD METHOD IN NON-PROFIT ORGANIZATION (STUDY CASE: NGO X) Dara Maisarah
402
THE EFFECT OF HUMAN RELATION ON EMPLOYEE PERFORMANCE AT FACULTY OF ECONOMICS OF SYIAH KUALA UNIVERSITY Yurnalis Wirdah Irawati
426
THE MEDIATING ROLE OF ORGANIZATIONAL COMMITMENT: RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN JOB SATISFACTION AND INTENTION TO QUIT Gusti Ayu Putu Wita Indrayani Gede Riana
445
MANAGING EXECUTIVE EDUCATION IN VIETNAM – A SWISS PERSPECTIVE Tobias Hüttche Uta Milow
460
6
PUBLICSERVICES MODEL IN VOCATIONAL HIGH SCHOOL
AT KENDARI,SOUTHEAST SULAWESI, INDONESIA
By Jamal Bake
(Halu Oleo University)
Elsikapi2002@yahoo.com
RolaPolaAnto
(Halu Oleo University)
(rola.polaanto70@gmail.com)
ABSTRACT
Division of roles between the government and the community in the
organization within the public service in vocational school is still not clear. This is
not yet have an impact on and the responsibility he explained the each party in this
financing, providing personnel, the curriculum with, legality of the organization
and management in vocational high school.Lack of educational facilities in
Vocational High School (VHS) is still an important issue in improving the quality
of education, especially atKendari.
According to Savas, E.S. (1997), there are several models in public
service settings that government service, governmentvending, intergovernment
agreement, contracting, franchising, grants, vouchers, market, voluntary and
selfservice.
Research aims is to describe public services model in the VHS at Kendari
practice which is managed by the government (state school) as well as by the
foundation (private schools). Data collection will be done through interviews and
focus group discussions with the school management and study documents.
Results, the public services model in state VHS of different with
privateVHS. In the state VHS, a source of financing,most of the 83.50% comes
from the government, and 16.50% comes from public funds school management
and education curriculum set up and carried out by the government, it means is a
government service model. In private VHS, a source of financing most of the
14.79% comes from the government, and 85.21% comes from public/private
funds, that is voluntary and selfservice model in education funding. In VHS, the
manual education services both curriculum and administration standard refers to
standard of vocational education from central government, and its implementation
is controlled by the local government, in terms servicesmodelembraced a
franchising.
Key words: Public ServicesModel and Vocational Education.
A. Background
In this time in Indonesia are trying to improve the quality of human
resources through education in a fair and open to all people of Indonesia. This was
done in order to realize the goal macro-level education in Indonesia, namely
7
develop the intellectual life of the nation. To be able to achieve the aim of
education meant, the one of the principles of national education namely education
was held in a democratic and equitable and non-discriminative with respect
human rights, religious values, cultural values, and the pluralistic nation (Danim,
2010: 175).
Indonesian government's goal to improve the quality of human resources
among others laid out in the Law No. 20 of 2003 on the National Education
System, (Article 11 verse 1 and 2) explained that the government and local
governments are obliged to provide services and relaxation and ensure holding a
quality education for every citizen of without discrimination.
All this time, problems that need to be addressed in the fields of education
is that there are still discrimination, still levy fees that will be charged to the
disciples, and low quality graduates from education in every level education units,
and especially school education. The quality of education is a must. Availability
the budget, facilities and infrastructure, education facilities, the curriculum and
management school management is the important thing to create a graduate school
that has high quality, has the competency and is ready to enter world safety.
In fact, the role of government in shouldered education in vocational high
school is not yet continuously, affecting the low quality graduates. Lack of
government services to facilities and infrastructure that owned Vocational High
School (VHS) up to now, there is an important issue in order to increase the
quality of education atKendari.
In KendariVHScontinues to grow. In 2015 according to data City education
Service 23 school, is composed of 6 state schools of 16 private schools,
everything is responsible for providing services in the fields of vocational
education. The presence community (private) is very important in participate to
organnized a vocational education. But there are still not clear division of roles
between the government and the community (private) in education services
vocational schools. Division of roles In the case that there is a and the
responsibilities between the government and people related to education
vocational training such as financing, providing personnel, the curriculum,
legality and management schools are expected to be able to determine the quality
education in vocational schools in the area. A model public services that are
appropriate related to people's participation (private) in education in vocational
schools can affect quality of its graduates that are produced.
B. The Problems
The Research Problems: 1) How public services model in Vokational High School
(VHS)atKendari?; 2) Are there any differences of the public services model in the
state VHSand privateVHSat Kendari seen to the financingaspect, providing
personnel, the curriculum, and school management?
C. The Purpose Research
1) Describe and analyze public services model in VHSatKendari;
2)Describe and analyze the difference public services model in State VHS and
Private VHSatKendari seen from the aspect financing, providing personnel, the
curriculum, and the school management.
8
D. Theory AndConcept
1. Public Service Model
According to Gronroos (1990: 27) service is a "such or a series activity
that is not all too obvious (can't be touch) that happened as a result of the
interaction between consumers and its employees or in things is provided by the
organization service provider that was meant to solve problems
customer/user".Warella (2004: 18) said that the ministry is as an act, a
performance or a business. However, this emphasis on service as an act,
performance and business each organization. The statement that was relevant by
Ivancevich, et.al (1997: 449) that "service is the products that are not invisible
(can't be touch) involving business people and using the equipment".
Public services related with accomplishing accountability and
responsibility of the government. According to Sinambela. (2005: 5) public
service is every activities of government that will be done to some people to meet
the needs for the benefit activity or a group and offers customer satisfaction even
though the results are not tied to a physical onea product. According to Widodo
(2001: 270-271), public service as a professional service is characterizedby
accountability and responsibility of the service provider that government
apparatus or which was facilitated by the government to provide services to the
community. Government bureaucracies as an organization that function and have
responsibility to providing facilities and providing services to the public.
Salusu. J (1996: 8) said, that public function of the government is set up,
organizing, provide facilities for the creation and guarantees public service (public
service), both by the government as well as non-government institution which was
given a mandate to carry out public services. In order to satisfy needs of society in
an effective and efficient and public services should not only by the government,
but it should be given authority to the private to be involved in public services, the
so-called privatization.
According to Savas (1987) privatization measures is to reduce the role of
government and private role in public services. There are several models public
services is associated with the role government organizations and the private
sector, namely:
(1) Government service, is a public service model, where the government to take
their duties and roles and responsibilities in providing services, ranging from a
number of rules, make and carry out an instrument with a high standard of
services, provide facilities, provide the fund, providing salary to a civil servant,
providing services in accordance with the requirements community and managing
organization that hold public services. In this model, there is no participation of
private sector to third parties (people) in providing services, all things are done by
the government;
(2) Government vending, is one of the service setting where government to
provide funds or the budget for the public service, and aturanyang become
reference while fest being handed over to other parties to produce goods and
services in accordance with the requirements public. As an example the
government has prepared the budget for water, in this case, the government
provides/ produces the service and the people use if the service has an obligation
to pay for services that have been given. A Profitable organization in public
services model is no government intervention, the Manager for the private sector
9
or civil society organizations (foundation) parties that are believed to be the
government has a role in managing organization public services. The government
vending, the government to make the rules and regulations in supervising the
public service was held by private companies or the foundation ditununjuk by the
government. Private companies or foundation organized public service based on
the rule that is, provides or produce goods and services and distribute goods and
services public public according to the standard made by the government will
provide justice in public services.
(3) Intergovermental agreement; is the public services model, that will be done is
based on the agreement between government officials that related to both central
government with one another (national) , between national government and local
government, between local government and local government one another, and
inter executive elements of governance in the region. If the central and regional
governments involved, a profitable service and supervision will be done by the
central government, while the local administration carrying out and to provide a
report; If involving local government interregional government with one another,
the central government mengkordinasikan agreement between local government.
Kewenengan in a profitable service, financing, organising service and personnel
and goods and services supplying public services is made on the agreement with
inter-government blood that are involved in public services.
(4) Contracting, is a model for the public services with contract system. The
government mengontrakan holding public services to the other party (private or
community) who are interested to take over the role service, by taking advantage
for services that given. This was done because of limited government in providing
services. The Government would only make regulations on service
implementation.
(5) Franchising model a profitable services which the organization public services
is controlled by head office. The people who wish to be involved in public service
must receive recognition or legality of head office, with the system fee or a
commitment to the system for the result or compensation. Decentralization public
services through francashing can take all aspects or some aspects of service
management from service system that is controlled head office to ensure quality
of service that same uniform in every line service. In this setting where the
government gave authority to a private company that has a quality standard that is
identical to that required by the government to provide services to the people, and
the people pay for the services provided.
(6) Grants, is a public service model, where the government to help (subsidies)
funding to the private sector or community organizations that have played a role
in providing public services to improve the service quality to the community. In
this model government or consumer given the authority to private companies or
community organizations to the event services suitable needs of society and is still
to ensure that quality of service in accordance with whom he by both the
government and by the community.
(7) Vouchers; service system model by using vouchers is not much different from
a profitable service by using grant, the purpose of which is helping people as
consumers. The government gives subsidy In its organising directly to the
consumer (medical card free of charge) and consumer has the authority to appoint
a company will provide services to work their needs. The Government or the
10
public finance service, which was held, here corporate services according to the
standard that determined by the government.
(8) Market; this model, assumes a principle service where goods and services are
status. The process to get service through market mechanisms, there is a side
goods manufacturers and service needs of the society and consumers who need
work and legal services. Someone who is going to get work needs and services
need to buy according to ability that has been owned. Those who have paid great
can enjoy quality service, while for those who have a limited ability can enjoy
quality of service less in accordance with nominal that has been paid to get goods
and services public that is needed. Financing services is done by the consumer
directly. In relation to this role of the government is to provide regulations that
restrict arbitrariness and monopili by certain parties in the public service.
(9) Voluntary arrangement, a profitable service is done by social organization
community needs in. Social organization who voluntarily to provide service
directly to the community without any intervention of the government and the role
and private sector. Voluntary arrangement there are two models, the first of which
are services that directly conducted by social organizations to the community as a
decomposed above and the second is services done by social organization but not
directly.
(10) Self-Service. Is a model service where most goods and services needs needs
of the society is prepared to be handled by individuals or the community (self-
service), without the role and the government or private sector.
2. Vocational Education Services
In the Law No. 20 of 2003 on the National Education System (article 15),
explained that vocational high school is "secondary education are preparing
students mainly in their respective fields particular". Whereas Article 38 which
states that basic framework and the structure curriculum for elementary and
secondary determined by the government through the National Education
Standards Agency (NESA).
Vocational High School (VHS) is the educational institutions have a goal
to prepare to labor and become self-sufficient to give priority to what was actually
abilities and skills in a particular area they planed to use. Djojonegoro (1999) said,
the benchmark vocational education efficient is (a) prepare students to type of
work that is based on their need for labor and (b) The students get the work in
accordance with skills training. Considerant like that indicates the importance of
secondary education system that was carried out on the principle partnership,
especially how relate to competency with the industry as the target working world.
The aim of vocational school is to prepare students to have competency
teenage vocational training in certain areas so that at once to be able to work in
order to the future and to welfare of the nation. For that, students must supplied
and practical skills scientific theory, also patterns of behavior and attitude social
and political expectation certain, and it was all absolutely necessary for our
provision are precious to be successful in order to enter the world, both as workers
in the company or as entrepreneur who are independent and to become members
of the community who were responsible for (Schiopepers and Patriana,1994).
Vocational Education has different characteristics with public education, in terms
of education, substantial criteria lessons, and the graduates. That Criteria
11
vocational education must be owned by: (1) Orientation in the working world
individual performance; (2) Justification in real in the field; (3) Focus on the
curriculum in these aspects impact, affective, and cognitive; (4) The measure the
success not only limited in the school, and (5) Sensitivity to the development
work world; (6) Requires a sufficient infrastructure facilities, and (7) the support
of the society, Financ & Crunkilton, in Sonhaji (2000).
Sallis (1993:280) refers to human beings that education is the service in
the form cultural process. This sense be implicated in the existence of input
(input) and the exodus (output). The students' feedback can be infrastructure
facilities, damaging learning facilities including other environment, while output
is a graduate or alumni, who later became a quality, considering education
products is services, and quality services education very much depends on what
the attitude service provider in the field and the expectations user education
services. This means services education is not tangible objects (intangible directly,
but a qualitative quality/education services can be seen from soft indicators such
as concern and attention on the desire to /hope and customer satisfaction
education services.
In the context of good education macro-level (country) as well as in micro-
level (a) financing is the key element that must be in place. As an example the
government of the Republic of Indonesia in accordance with the mandate Undang-
Undang each year has launched education budget allocation of minimum 20
percent of the total budget revenues and expenditure of the State Budget, also said
the government areas each year to set a budget for education such as for the salary
of teachers and educators other salary in the region. In the context institution or
organization, the school every year draw up a budget and income school budget
that shows how planning revenue and fees for operational activities using school.
The bill use methods described in the field of education funding. Thus at all levels
of education funding is a very important to guarantee to the
educationimplementation.
Education finance as the cost of education is budgetair namely that is
taken and spent by the school as an institution. This means that, for the education
expenses that are budgetair and non-budgetair costs of education, including in the
sense in general meaning. Education costs while understanding that is
nonbudgetair is for the education expenses that spent by the disciples, or
parents/family expenses and educational opportunities (Fattah, 2006:23).The
budget for education consists of two side of the relation to one another, namely
the acceptance and the budget expenditures to achieve the educational goals. Still
in the same book according to Fattah (2006:23) Budget acceptance is the revenues
every year by the schools from various sources official and bace on a
regularreceived.
E. Research Methods
Research methods use qualitative approach, it was done in schools and
Vocational Education and the Ministry and Cultural Kendari. Informant heads of
organizations an Department of Education and Culture Kendari, and the heads of
vocational school. Data Collection will be done through interviews,
documentsstudy and focused groups discussion (FGD). Data analysis was using a
12
model description prsentase and analysis of information using a model interactive
(Miles and Huberman on, 1992:20; and Silalahi, 2009: 338).
F. Result
1. The Description Vocational High School in Kendari
Vocational High School (VHS) in Kendari can be classified into two
categories namely State VHS and Private VHS. As a whole VHS in the safety of
Educational and Cultural Kendari there are 22 vocational high school, as's was in
Table 1.
Table 1 List of Names, status, the Number of State and private vocational high
school in Kendari, 2015.
Nu. School Name Status
1 VHS I Kendari State School
2 VHS II Kendari State School
3 VHS III Kendari State School
4 VHS IV Kendari State School
5 VHS V Kendari State School
6 VHS VI Kendari State School
7 VHS Husada Kendari Private school
8 VHS Live Skill Kendari Private school
9 VHS Mine Nusantara Kendari Private school
10 VHS Panca Marga Kendari Private school
11 VHS Cruise Ship Samudra Kendari Private school
12 VHS Sailing Kendari Private school
13 VHS Indonesia Kendari Private school
14 VHS Maritime and Fishery Private school
15 VHS Satria Kendari Private school
16 VHS Earth Moral StandardsKendari Private school
17 VHS ForestryKendari Private school
18 VHS Shoot Husada Kendari Private school
19 VHS Eka Bhakti Kendari Private school
20 VHS Health Mandonga Private school
21 VHS SincerityKendari Private school
22 VHS AzadiracthaKendari Private school
23 VHS Telkom Kendari Private school
Source: Department of Education and Culture, Kendari, Mey 2015
(processed)
Table 1 shows amount of VHSat Kendari as many as 23, which serves as a
goverenment as much as 6 schools (26.89 percent) and managed by private or
foundation as many as 17 schools (73.91 percent). Data suggest that interest of
the public through the foundation for the private sector to school education is very
high. It is related to the consciousness, the experiences and the fact that during
this VHS graduate produce human resources who are ready to work in accordance
with the competencies and expertise in each of them. A private VHSat Kendari
describes as the following:
13
.... we are interested in and want to develop vocational school, because the
need the market to ready-to-use labor in the field of technical, us, and opened
Vocational High School, mine is intended to fulfill the market will labor
mining sector .... mining sector such as nickel and other minerals are the
mainstays Southeast Sulawesi region ... (Interview, 2015)
With regard to this, the Department of Education and Culture Kendari pay
attention to VHS which is managed by the public or private schools, the
monitoring and evaluation of school management, especially in relation to the
development curriculum learning. Learning curriculum tailored to provide the
market, in addition to remain consistent in implementing that serves as a guideline
national curriculum in the event Vocational High School. One informant said as
that:
.... there is freedom the management of the school to formulate a curriculum
for expertise as local content of the components bagiaan. But the education is
still monitor so that private vocational high school to be consistent education
vocational training in a professional manner in line with its mission resources
that provides ready-to-use in more sectors, such as mining, fishing, tourism,
health and other (interview, 2015).
The information management insisted that the school will be done by
every VHS but in the execution receive supervision from the Department of
Education and Culture Kendari as coach and manager in organising the local
vocational schools.
.
2. The Students
Data in vocational high school in Kendari period in 2015 as many as 6,094
students who are spread out in state VHS and private VHS. On the data is describe
that the number of students in state VHS far more than the number of students
who attended the education in private VHS. It can be seen in table 2
Table 2 Number of students who attended the State HS and Private VHS
Schools at Kendari, 2015.
VHS Status Amount
(Unit)
Number of students
(person)
Percent
(%)
State 6 4.369 71,69
Private/Foundation 17 1.725 28,31
Total 23 6.094 100.00
Source: Department of Education dan Culture,Kendari, May 2015
(processed)
Table 2 shows that from 6,094 vocational school students in Kendari there
are 4,369 students (71.69 percent) is a student at State Vocational School and as
many as 1,725 students (28.31 percent) students in private vocational high school.
That shows people's progress through education that the interest in vocational
high school in the City is still dominant in schools. The causal factor: 1) facilities
and infrastructure that available more complete and sufficient; 2) teachers and
education workers a reasonable cost of education; 3) cheaper; 4) have trust of the
community because it has been famous and managed by the government.
Interviews with various aspects stakeholders revealed the cause, why number of
private vocational high school students still a little bit, because: 1) have not had a
14
name that state vocational school; 2) Prodi opened limited, average of only 1 to 2
studies program; 3) facilities is still limited; 4) Number of personnel still less; 5)
Quality still doubted by the community; 6) is still a last resort for the community;
7) financing is still minim, depending on the ability foundation which is also
limited. In fact, there is some private vocational high school that was established
in the hope that they will be able to get support funding from the government
(central and regional level). That means that This they can only exist if getting
funding support from the government.
3. Teachers
Amost important elements in education services in Vocational High
School (VHS) is the availability teachers (teacher). Without the teachers either
kuanitas and quality, learning process will not be accomplished. The picture
availability vocational school teachers in Kendari served in table 3.
Table 3 School status, the number of schools, the Number of Teachers and the
Status Teachers In Vocational High School at Kendari, 2015.
VHS
Status
Amount
(unit)
Teachers Status Total
Permanent Non Permnent
Person % Person % Person %
State 6 403 86,48 63 13,52 466 100,00
Private 17 68 42,24 93 57,76 161 100,00
Total 23 471 75,12 156 24,88 627 100,00
Source: Deparment of Education and Culture Kendari, Mey 2015
(processed)
Table 3 shows that from 466 teachers in the State VHSat Kendari there are
403 teachers (86.48 percent ) bersatus teachers are still and as many as 63 people
teachers (13, 52 percent ) bersatus teachers. While the number of teachers in
private vocational high school as many as 161 people, there are 68 teachers (42.24
percent) with the status teachers are still and as many as 93 people (57, 76 percent
) are temporary teachers on. Data was shows that the State Vocational School has
been using teachers with Public Servant status power of the Civil Servant, only a
few using non-permanent teachers. While in private vocational high school is still
largely dependent on teachers on the teachers from State VHS that teaches private
vocational high school or teacher in a year by the foundation.
The process for the redeployment of teachers in the VHS Kendari was the
authority of Department of Education and Culture Kendari. Support personnel
started to their attention by placing civil servant teachers to be teachers is still in
private VHS, although it has not yet fully carried out. There are still private
vocational high school teachers who do not receive civil servant allocation. For
allocating teachers civil servants in private VHS showing a commitment by the
city govermnent in order to support private VHS that is to reduce the burden
foundation in financing teachers' salary, as well as to ensure quality of learning in
private VHS in order to state VHS. This shows that local governments lack of
commitment in developing the quality of vocational education at the local level.
15
4. The Models of Education Services
a. Financing Source
Vocational High School (VHS) at Kendari should be supported by human
resource availability or budget financing to make all the process of learning in
school. Availability the budget schools used to complete all facilities, equipment
and infrastructure in teaching and learning in vocational high school in the City
Kendari. Source of funds and the financing that is allocated to meet the needs
school budgets (budgets) in Kendari can be seen in table 4 as follows:
Table 4 Source of Financing of Vocational High Schoolin, Kendari Vocational,
2015 School Financing Source
State
VHS
Local
Government
Budget
School Operational
Assistance (Central
Government)
Operational
Costs Education
(Central
Governmen)
Social
Assistance
(Government)
People
Through The
School
Commite
Private
VHS
Foundation;
Fund School
Operational
Assistance
School Operational
Cost Assistance;
(Central
Government)
Operational
Costs Education
(Central
Governmen)
Social
Assistance
(Comunnity)
Education
Development
Donations
Source: Deparment of Education and Culture, Kendari City, Mey 2015
(processed)
Table 4 shows that a source of financing the State Vocational High School
at Kendari: (1) funds regularly, (2) School Operational Assistance and (3)
Operational costs for Education. These three kinds of assistance funding is
increased for the service quality education in Vocational High School from the
central government to increase the facilities and schoolinfrastructure. In addition,
State Vocational School as a source of public funds through the school. School
committee Fund, from the students used to improve development of means and
schools facilities in order to realize that are convenient, education services fair and
transparent. In private VHS financing sources from the government to increase the
facilities and infrastructure: (1) School Operational Cost from central government;
2) Operational support education both are called grant. In addition, private VHS
has get routine of the foundation, donations from the students is an artist
Donations Development of Education (self-service), and help from Local Non-
Governmental Organizations that cannot be binding (Voluntary) to support
funding for private VHS.
The difference is prominent in education services in vocational high
school in Kendari was the regular budget from the state budget City to State VHS
that given every month, while private VHS did not get funds from the central
government and routine budget from the City Government Kendari. The event
school education Funding in Kendari is used to meet the facilities and
infrastructure, stationary and other operasional.
Composition source of financing State VHS in Kendari from the government in
the amount of 75.27 percent (through the School Operational Assistent, Social
Assistent, help for the poor students, the Fund EOA, ProvinceBudget, funds from
the regional routine budget city covernmen. The concept is according to Savas
called government service where government to provide all facilities for education
16
service, starting from the building, operational funds, the salary, curriculum and
management of school. Funds from the community or the student fee of 24.73
percent through school committee fund to support the fulfillment needs of the
school called the self-service.
A source of financing Private VHS has three sources from the fund of
63.31 percent, from total needs, from the community (0.09 percent), from the
parents of the students through Education Development Donation (3.96 percent).
Government aid (grant) was 32.63 percent. A source of financing from the
government as the school operational assistent, Social Assistent, help for poor
students, the Fund Education Operational Assistent (Provincial Government). The
pattern financing the government in private VHS at Kendari adheres to grant
model where the government only provides subsidies to school budgets, most
stems from the foundation and donations from the community does not bind
(voluntary) and mandatory fee students (self-service).
b. Assets Source
Overall average total assets owned State Vocational School in Kendari,
83.5 percent rise by APBN, from the government budget, the Asian Development
Bank (ADB Province, BOP, a building (classrooms, laboratories, multi-media
laboratory building, the school principal, teachers and the administrative staff,
multipurpose building, and the OSIS), practices a laboratory as well as a good
field, so-called government vending. While 16.5 percent is derived from the
parents of the students, donation to willingly voluntary. through the school, such
as the mosque, security posts (security guard), the office co-operatives and
electricity post
That was different from private VHS, the average most of the or 85.21
percent of the total assets they came from foundations or public funds (voluntary)
as office building, the classroom, learning facility (chairs, tables, chairs and tables
the school principals working and working room teachers and staff. In addition,
assets private vocational high school, including land for the foundation, is part of
the community in the event vocational education. While that comes from the
government price was only 14.79 percent of the total assets private VHS. A
number of schools among others VHS Fisheries and Marine Kendari Bhineka Eka
Bakti Kendari, to get aid (grant) for the development of building schools, (the
classroom), head room school, a teachers' room and administrative staff,
laboratory room or practice room students are given in the form subdsisi. Based
on composition source assets in State VHS and Private VHS pawned private
sector, obliterated the comparison between the government and the people in the
provision assets education in VHSat Kendari was (49.15:50.85) or 49.14 percent
came from government aid (grant), while 50.86 percent of the people that is a
foundation contribution and voluntary and mandatory fee students (self-service).
c. The Learning Curriculum
Curriculum is strategic for instruments effort to raise the quality of
education vocational training. Competence of the teachers and the provision of the
means and education facilities will only for learners gives the meaning if directed
in order to reach the goal education that was formed in the curriculum as the
content, teaching methods and purpose. In the context National Education System
17
formulation vocational education curriculum formulated the students based on
competency standard.
A curriculum that is used in vocational high school State and private
vocational high school in Kendari referring to Learning Unit Level Curriculum
(KTSP) in 2008, consisting of normative, adaptive and productive. According to
the government provision the curriculum center through policy ministry of
education. The program and expertise has competency test in accordance with the
National Education Standards Agency (BSNP) in 2008. Using this curriculum is
expected to be able to answer the problem that is developing in the event that
oriented education vocational school in the field work. That Model can be called
francashing according to Savas (1987) because the curriculum developed in the
region must get approval from central or refer to national curriculum. It intends to
education curriculum Vocational High School in the region have relevance and
between Vocational High School on a national, in accordance with the business
world and industry in the world today. Thus, the graduate school can be accepted
for work in accordance with the competencies and expertise. In addition, also to
anticipate accelerating the development of technology and changes the global
economy that affect the demands of human resources (SDM) which has a
competency standard that has been required by the world of business and industry
in the world. In addition, vocational high school graduate in Kendari achievement
is expected to be ready to work independently or to meet the need for business
world.
A curriculum that developed in vocational high school in Kendari
essentially emphasized on learning approach, based on competency-based
production and learning to be completed (mastery learning). The Third approach
to learning is focused on efforts to achieve competency standard expertise
students for each program expertise competency standard vocational skills that
developed and used in vocational high school in Kendari expertise in accordance
with the program, and will require increased fulfilling various standard in each
component education and teaching and learning. Involvement industrial world,
professional associations, and the government in the implementation of the
curriculum especially in order evaluation start to be done, but has not yet.
d. Management of VHS
Education in VHS at Kendari can be done with good to the management of
the school that is consistent. School Management in this would include planning
process (the determination target resources needs lessons, personnel, equipment,
materials, organizing, implementing, monitoring and evaluation on the student
field, will be maintained, the curriculum, personnel, good corporate governance
schools, facilities and infrastructure required education implementation so that the
process is good. Management process schools were also payroll system related
personnel (teacher, energy administrative, security, cleaning service) that is set in
the Budget and school budgets showing fund of which came from the fund
government as well as the foundation organizers.
Management practices that will be done in State VHSat Kendari has
implemented the principles of the good management started planning, organizing,
implementing, and controlling and evaluation market coordination. a sustainable
manner. That was different from private VHS that is not optimal in implementing
18
school management. This is related to human resource that still lack available. In
fact, applying management principles in vocational high school to be able to
produce graduates have achievement, are ready to work, according to the needs
business world.
The aspects which have attention in the management in VHSat Kendari
was: (1) Good governance in school organization; (2) curriculum development;
(3) Learning; (4) Management teachers and educators; (5) Student Field; (6)
facilities and infrastructure; (7) Financial and finance: (8) Administration, (9)
Regulations, (10) The behavior and work culture and (k) Cooperation and
partnership. This is in accordance with a view to Joyonegoro (1999) that
management vocational schools that should pay attention curriculum and teaching
and learning, Giving teachers and educators, means and latest learning,
management and financing and resources cooperation and partnership with the
working world.
E. Supervision
Educational implementation in Vocational High School in Kendari was
brought supervision of the Education Office Kendari that have the capacity and
the authority according to the regulations are there. In the framework, school
supervisors to carry out the construction supervision function, namely academic
supervision and managerial skills supervision. Academic supervision in relation to
the education and development professional capacity teachers in improving
quality of teaching and learning and leadership in the school. Target academic
supervision is intended to help teachers in: 1) Planned learning activities; 2) To
learning activities; 3) considered the process and learning outcomes; 4) To be able
to benefit assessment result for the increase service, partici pation; give feedback
5) and in order to the participants and continually students, (6) the students to
serve who would have difficulty learning, (7) to provide counselling the students
learning, (8) create an learning environment, (9) use learning resources, (10)
develop interaction learning (method, the strategy, the technique, the model
approach, etc. that accurate and efficient, (10) or practical to improve teaching;
and (11) to develop innovative teaching learning. The function of academic
supervision VHS at Kendari, a school supervisor played a role as: (1) teachers'
partners to increase the quality process and result in teaching and leadership in the
school; (2) Innovator and a pioneer in developing innovative lessons and
leadership in the school;. (3) a Consultant in the school; (4) a counselor for school
principals, teachers and the entire school staff, and (5) a Motivator to improve
performance all school staff
Objects target of managerial supervision in VHS at Kendari in relation to
the school, to increase efficiency and effectiveness of schoolsmanagement. It
includes aspects: planning,coordination, the implementation, assessment,
developing human resource competence educational and other resources. Target
managerial supervision be done to help the school principal and the staff in
managing administration will be maintained as: administration curriculum,
financial, infrastructure, staffing, student field, relationship between schools and
community, culture and school environment, and aspects of the other
administration in order to improve the quality of education.
19
In carrying out supervision, managerial supervisors play a role as: (1)
Kolaborator and negotiator in the planning, coordination, develop of school
management, (2) become assessor candidates in identifying weaknesses and
analyze the potential schools, (3) information center development quality of
education in schools and (4) a follow-up on the results supervision. Periodically
supervision VHSat Kendari has carried out a routine supervision through weekly,
monthly and supervision every first, to ensure that the process of learning can
reach the target and to be able to apply the curriculum will continuously.
G. Discussion
Model of public service in Vocational High School (VHS) at Kendari, in
practical, terms have differences between vocational school which is managed by
the government or state VHS with the school that was held by the foundation or
private VHS, viewed from a number of aspects such as a source of financing, the
assets, the curriculum, school management and supervision. A source of financing
and assets, state VHS most of them are from the government and only a small
part comes from the students through committee fund. This model is called
government vending according to Savas (1987). The community in financing state
VHS through the school called (self-service) as a contribution to meet the needs
education services in state vocational school. The community is not calculating
the amount of quantity received to contribute to the school, but only on the basis
limit (voluntary) and the ability to inventory the parents of the students to meet
the facilities services at state vocational school.
Different thing happened in private vocational high school, where the
government is likely to grant model that is to provide assistance (subsidies) to
meet some needs of the school in providing services to the people, while most
needs of the school budget, means good, infrastructure and facilities or assets
school comes from the foundation (private or community organization) on the
voluntary basis (voluntary) as the manager private vocational high school and a
mandatory fee charged to students through the donation development of
education, called the self-service).
A curriculum that is used in education committee state and private
vocational high school in derived from the central government. Vocational
curriculum development to local also refers to the head officepolicy, the
department of national education, including local content curriculum
determination must be reported to the local department of education.
Implementation of VHS curriculum is controlled by the government through their
representatives in the area or the district education office. This model according to
Savas (1987) is called francashing in public services, where action that has been
done by representative office in the region must always be controlled and
monitored by head office, and the only can perform creations in the corridor
normative policy of central government. This was done to keep its consistency in
national curriculum vocational education to suit your needs market and maintain
quality education vocational schools in the region.
The event Management education in state vocational school to follow a
profitable or the government's policy of Education and Culture, where
government institutions is state vocational school. Process, organization
perencnanaan, implementation, monitoring and monitoring of public service
20
through state vocational school will be done government officials, termmasuk in
supplying personnel. Because this system management service management in
state vocational school called model government service. Different with private
vocational high school management, where the government does not interfere in
management process, the government is simply to provide assistance funding, aid
personnel and the construction management, so-called model grant according to
the views Savas (1987).
Improvement of public services in the event pendididkan in vocational
high school in Kendari continue to be done through the school management,
curriculum development, pebaikan learning process, carrying out personnel
management, student field, floating facilities and infrastructure, financing and
financial management, improve administration services, the leadership,
environmental management and co-operation with stakeholders. This is relevant
with Joyonegoro (1999), that aspects must receive attention in development of
VHS is its management of schools, the curriculum, study, teachers and education
workers, student field,, facilities and infrastructure, financial, the administration,
and the financing regulations, environmental management and work culture and
partnership cooperation, so that the aims and objectives education resources
vocational training to produce human being who is ready to enter world of work
can be realized.
H. Conclusion
Amodel of public services in the VHSat Kendari was concluded as follows:
1) Model financing, and source assets in providing public services to follow
model grant, voluntary and self service, there is no difference between the state
VHS and private VHS. The state vocational high school to apply a government
vending model but in private VHS, government apply grantmodels, the foundation
and community is voluntary so mandatory students fee determined of nominal,
that is self-service.
2) Education curriculum of VHS uses a francashing model, where the state VHS
and private VHS applyed the curriculum education standards was determine by
the central government, at the supervision of the VHS curriculum competency-
based on accordance with the potential locally but in the policy corridor of central
government, so the curriculum learning is still in the corridor national standards,
and the quality education services of VHS is still guaranteed human resources to
give birth to a child who is ready for competition to the world of work.
3) Management school in the State VHS uses a governmemnt service model,
refers the city government. Planning process, procurement teachers and education
workers, development of facilities and infrastructure, budget management, the
public relations, and supervision school determined by the schools as government
officials. That was different than private vocational high school management,
where the government does not interfere in planning, organizing and
implementation school. The education point out the supervision periodically, to
give aid operations, the aid workers personnel, operational funds called model
grant in public services.
REFERENCES
21
Danim, Sudarwan, 2010, ProfesionalisasidanEtikaProfesi Guru, Alfabeta,
Bandung
Djojonegoro, Wardiman. 1999. PengembanganSumberDayaManusiamelaluiVHS.
Jakarta: PT. BalaiPustaka (Persero).
Fattah, N. 2004.LandasanManajemenPendidikan, Bandung: RemajaRosdaKarya.
Gronroos, C, 1990: Service Management and Marketing: Managing The Moment
of Truth in Service Competition, Massachuetts, Lexington
Ivancevich, et.al, 1997, Management Quality and Competitiveness (second
edition), Mirwin, Chicago.
Roy V. Salomodan Jamal Bake, “AdministrasiPublik,
AransemenKelembagaandan ReformasiPelayananPublik di Tingkat Lokal”,
JurnalPSPK, PusatstudiPengembanganKawasan, Edisi 1, Februari 2002, Jakarta,
hal. 9
Sallis, E., 1993, Total Quality Management In Education. London
Salusu, J., 1996, Pengambilan Keputusan Strategik, Gramedia Widiasarana
Indonesia,Jakarta.
Savas, ES, 1987, Privatization: The Key To Better Government (New Jersey:
Chatham House Publishers.
Savas, E.S. 1997. Privatization and Public Partnerships. LLC, New York –
London: Chatham House Publishers, Seven Bridges Press
Schippers, Uwe &Patriana, DjadjangMadya. 1994. PendidikanKejuruan di
Indonesia. Bandung: PenerbitAngkasa
Silalahi, Ulber, 2009, Metode Penelitian Sosial, Refika Aditama, Bandung
Sonhadji, Ahmad, 2000, AlternatifPenyempurnaan Pembangunan
PenyelenggaraanPendidikan di Sekolah Menengah Kejuruan
Warella, Y, 2004, Administrasi Negara dan Kualitas Pelayanan Publik. MAP
UNDIP, Semarang
Widodo, Joko, 2001, Good Governance, Telaah dari Dimensi Akuntabilitas dan
Kontrol Birokrasi Pada Era Desentralisasi dan Otonomi Daerah, Insan Cendikia,
Surabaya;
Undang-Undang No. 20 Tahun 2003 TentangSistemPendidikan Nasional
IndonesiaSekolah Menengah Kejuruan.html
22
STUDENTS’ PRIDE IN HIGHER EDUCATION SERVICE CONTEXT:
A MARKETING PERSPECTIVE
Joseph Robert Daniel
SoE School of Teacher Training and Education
joedaniel22@gmail.com
ABSTRACT
This study aims to find several things as the causes and effects of organizational
pride of the students in one of the private universities in Central Java, Indonesia.
This study was conducted by using qualitative descriptive method, which was
combined with an approach to build a theory. Data were collected through
interviews, observation and documentation. The results showed that in addition to
student evaluations of the college attributes as the source, the cultural aspect of
the college also engage the growth of organizational pride. As a result, the
students will demonstrate certain behaviors that benefit colleges (e.g. recruiting
new students, Positive WOM, etc). The contribution of this study was a micro-
theory of the antecedents and consequents of customer organizational pride with
a number of new propositions that were ready to be tested in future studies.
Keywords: Organizational Pride, Student-University Relationship, Customer-
Company Relationship.
BACKGROUND OF THE STUDY
This study was motivated by an empirical reality that had been observed in the
Faculty of Economics and Business (FEB), Satya Wacana Christian University,
Salatiga, Indonesia. In some lecture activities there were a number of lecturers and
students who were happy to reveal and express their pride to be a part of, and
could be enrolled in FEB, because a number of achievements of the faculty. One
achievement that referred was the success to open FEB doctoral program in
Management Science - which was recorded the faculty, so far, as the only private
university in Central Java, which established doctoral program in the field of
management science. According to some lecturers, this success was the result of a
long struggle that had been endured by the faculty since the 1980s, through
various human resource (lecturers) development programs. After approximately
30 years, then through the capacity of its human resources, FEB could open the
program. Regarding the success, several unstructured interviews have been
conducted to find out students impressions about the expression of pride in the
success of the FEB. SM, one of postgraduate of management students expressed
this statement:
23
“Beta [I]feel proud as a student of FEB. The achievements that have been
made by the lecturers will impact our future right? After that the results
are proven and the impact can also be felt by us, then beta with the status
as a student of FEB, I feel proud.”
In addition to that achievement, the achievement of the highest accreditation by
management study program of FEB SWCU at all levels ranging from
undergraduate to doctorate and a number of national-level achievements attained
were also be the students pride. In 2011, Master of Management study program,
for example, earned A accreditation by the National Accreditation Board - Higher
Education (BAN - PT) through a Decree of BAN-PT number 007/BAN-PT/Ak-
IX/S2/VII/2011. In 2009, Master of Management study program achieved the
fourth ranks of best Business School in Indonesia by SWA magazine. This
achievement was followed by a Doctorate in Management Science program that
achieved A accreditation in 2013 through Decree of BAN-PT number
094/SK/BAN-PT/Ak-X/D/II/2013. On these achievements, one of the Bachelor
students of management study program named J, recalled:
"The most obvious thing to be proud of is the Accreditation. S1, S2, S3 all
have Accreditation of A for the Management, and it is heartening for us,
especially when sometimes people do not respect, where is Salatiga? Many
people do not know where Salatiga is, but in fact in Salatiga, in such small
town there is a private university that can compete with other universities."
Empirical phenomena related to the pride of these students became very
interesting to be observed under to marketing perspective, especially if the
students were positioned as the customers (customer or client), in this case, the
customers of educational services. Such supposition is relevant for a number of
reasons. First, at present, limited government financial support for higher
education make financing educational operations more difficult (Susanti, 2011).
Universities, especially private ones, now can no longer simply rely on subsidies
and funds from foundations and philanthropies, but they must compete with one
another based on value-added to recruit students as the main funding alternative
(Ihalauw, 1999). This fact, coupled with the flexibility to open colleges in the
present, made parents and prospective students had many choices and increased
their bargaining power in choosing a college. This led to a shift from the classical
standpoint that views education as a social activity towards the view that
education as a service industry in which parents, students, and industry as the
consumers and customers (Suwignyo, 2008). The second reason is that students
are the customers of non-academic facilities that are provided by the college in
addition to the status as lecture material receivers which has been paid (Mark,
2013; Pereira Da Silva, 2003).
When looking at the observed empirical phenomena based on the assumptions
above, the questions that immediately arise are what causes the customers feel
proud of the institution or organization that provides services for them. It is
noticeably different from the general view that the employees are the parties who
have pride of the organization, because normally, organization's performance is
24
the responsibility of the employees and internal stakeholders. The next question
that arises here is if the customers proud of institutions that provide services to
them, what are the impacts of that pride to their behavior?
This study aims to explore the empirical reality of the students pride in FEB
SWCU Salatiga in order to answer the two questions above. This study seeks to
investigate what are the things that cause the students pride towards FEB SWCU,
then what are the pride impacts on their behavior.
LITERATURE REVIEW
In management literatures, it was found that the empirical reality outlined above
reflected what was referred to as organizational pride. The concept of
organizational pride has been received growing attention in psychology,
particularly with regard to the psychology of the group or organization. According
to Haslam (2004: 77), the group-based pride pointed to the positive feelings of the
individual to the group, which was derived from the evaluation of the group’s
relative status. Meanwhile, according to Mischkind (1998), organizational pride
was the pride of individuals as a result of their identification with the reputation of
the institution where the individual was involved. By the early decades of the
2000s, this concept began widely studied also in business and management studies
because it was seen as an important asset for the company (Mischkind, 1998), the
main drivers of the positive behaviors of the employees in the company and
company key differentiator in competition (Katzenbach, 2003), and a factor that
was vital for business success (Appleberg, 2005; Gouthier and Rhein, 2011).
There were also a number of empirical studies that provided evidence that the
organizational pride could increase employee commitment to the company
(Boezeman and Ellemers 2008; Gouthier and Rhein, 2011; Ellemers, Kingma, van
de Burgt, and Barreto, 2011), increasing the creativity of employees (Gouthier and
Rhein, 2011), influence the turnover intention (Gouthier and Rhein, 2011; Helm,
2012), job satisfaction (Ellemers et al, 2011), and the awareness of employees
about their impact on the company's reputation (Helm, 2011).
This literature review also showed two problems. The first issue was the studies
on organizational pride that have been more focused on employees and not on the
customer or customer. This caused the ideas that have been proven right about the
concept was not appropriate to explain the phenomenon on the customer. In the
marketing literatures, the concept of organizational pride was still rarely
discussed. Studies on the concept of pride in the study of consumer behavior, for
example, were more focused on the pride generated by the internal attributes of
the individual, and not external attributes such as status or reputation of the
organization in which an individual was involved. The concept of pride was also
mostly discussed as a peripheral concept, and not as a core concept of research.
Pride might affect positive WOM and intentions of consumers to buy again
(Louro, Pieters and Zeelenberg, 2005; Soscia, 2007), the self-control of the
consumers when faced with the opportunity to perform unplanned buy and
25
consumed products that were unhealthy (Mukhopadhyay and Johar, 2007; Patrick,
Chun, and Machinis, 2009; Wilcox, Kramer and Sen, 2011; Winterich and Haws,
2011), product desirability and consumer evaluation of the top brands and the
under-dog (Griskevicius, Shiota, and Nowlis, 2010; Staton, Paharia and Oveis,
2011). As far as the literatures exploration performed, the only studies that had
high relevance when talking about pride in the organization was the research
conducted by Decrop and Derbaix (2010).
In the period between 2005-2010, Alain Decrop and Christian Derbaix conducted
a research (used a combined strategy of ethnography and grounded theory) to
investigate the phenomenon of increased consumption of paraphernalia (scarves,
shirts, flags, etc.) from the fans of the popular football teams in Europe. From
these study both experts came to the conclusion that the main constructs behind
the high consumption of the fans was pride, as a result of the fans’ self-
identification with the football team that they idolize. Decrop and Derbaix stated
that pride was triggered by the achievement of the club as well as socio-cultural
background similarities between the fans and the club. The pride of the fans for
their football team, rised the commitment and loyalty to the club, increased
consumption and collection of merchandise associated with the club, positive
word of mouth, as well as customization and bricolage. The second problem was
that the idea of this group-based pride was constructed in the context of sports
consumption. There is a doubt about the accuracy of these concepts when it is
used in describing a similar phenomenon in the context of different consumption,
particularly in the context of higher education services consumption. These two
issues later led to the selection of the research methods that will be described
further below.
RESEARCH METHODS
The study began with an initial assumption that the causes and effects of customer
organizational pride were still unknown. Therefore, they were still called
unknown variables. Thus, the study method used here was qualitative research
method, which aimed to explore and let the phenomenon under study "talk" about
itself according to its context. This phenomenon description was later abstracted
into a theoretical construction of customer organizational pride in the context of
higher education services.
This study was basically a descriptive research which was then combined with the
method for building a theory based on empirical data. Empirical data were
collected using three kinds of techniques (triangulation techniques) that were
interview, observation and documentation. The first two techniques were used to
obtain primary data, while the last was used to obtain secondary data. The process
of data collection was performed for 4 months at the Faculty of Economics and
Business SWCU, 29 active students of Management Studies were interviewed, a
number of organizational activities in the campus such as the Economy People
Party (Pesakom) as well as sports activities such as Student Sports Week (POM)
26
had been observed, and also a number of physical evidence (magazine E-Time)
and virtual evidence from social media (Facebook and Twitter) had been
documented.
TABLE 1. LIST OF THE STUDENTS WHO BECAME THE STUDY
INFORMANTS
Informants
Code Name Program Origin Alumnus
M1 Niko Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M2 Herfin Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M3 Indra Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M4 Samuel Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M5 Leo Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M6 Chelly Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M7 Rilie Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M8 Vonny Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M9 Debby Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M10 Yoki Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga
Non-Alumni
FEB
M11 Frans Doctor of
Management Science
Non-
Salatiga
Alumni MM
FEB
M12 Gracia Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga Alumni S1 FEB
M13 Jocelyn Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga Alumni S1 FEB
M14 Santo Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga Alumni S1 FEB
M15 Ida Master of
Management Salatiga Alumni S1 FEB
M16 Melissa Master of
Management Salatiga Alumni S1 FEB
M17 Kiki Master of
Management Salatiga Alumni S1 FEB
M18 Abdi Master of
Management Salatiga
Non Alumni
FEB
M19 Gloria Master of
Management
Non-
Salatiga -
27
M20 Yohana S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M21 Sally S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M22 Anastasia S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M23 Ramos S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M24 Julia S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M25 Ruri S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M26 Yosafat S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M27 Faleria S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M28 Jaya S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
M29 Yuni S1 Management Non-
Salatiga -
The empirical data were then analyzed to follow a number of grounded analysis
stages that were presented by Ihalauw, Gouw, and Trita (2011). The analysis stage
began with direct data transcription following each data collection. The interview
data were directly excerpted in text form, and observation results were recorded in
the form of field records. Once transcribed, the data were then given particular
analytical codes, the analytical codes for the interview data were given per-some
sentences coherently in the transcript, the codes for observation data were given
after analyzing the descriptive and reflective notes of the overall observation
results, while for documentation data, the codes were given based on phenomenon
captured in each document either physical or virtual.
The analytical codes were then registered in the form of a table according to the
research questions and the study informants. After that, a horizontal comparative
analysis was carried per questions to obtain several categories. After categories
per research question were obtained, comparative analysis was performed
vertically to classify the categories in the same phenomenon into a single cluster.
The category clusters were then abstracted into a certain pattern, which later
became the basis for identifying the key variables. After the variables of each
study issue were identified, the variables were then rationalized and given the
opportunity to be linked to one another into propositions. A number of
propositions were then assembled into an integrated structure, as the customer
organizational pride theory. After the theory was constructed, the researcher
carried out comparisons with other theories that had already existed, to find the
new facts from this study.
To test the validity of the data, this study used technical triangulation and sources
triangulation tactics. If there ws consistency in the information according to the
28
three data collection techniques used, or at least three sources of information, then
the data could be said to be valid. To ensure the reliability of the data, the research
also created a study track record (research trails). Inductive analysis process was
recorded and systematized in such a way so that the readers could track the
abstraction results to the most empirical form. The result summary and discussion
of the study results are presented in the following explanation.
RESULTS AND DISCUSSION
In this section we will consecutively discuss two things, the causes the
organizational pride in students and the impacts of organizational pride for the
students as the customers of higher education services. From the study results, it
could be observed some kind of situations that allowed the emergence of a pride
sense in students towards FEB, especially during the time when the students
compared the attributes of FEB organization with other faculties or universities;
when the students performed self-evaluation related to intellectual development in
college; upon academic and non-academic achievements that were considered
valuable to the institution and the students themselves; when they were listening
to the recognition and admiration of others about FEB and when they were
participating in scientific FEB activities that involve qualified speakers.
The Causes of Organizational Pride of the Students towards Higher
Education Institution
Based on the interviews conducted, it could be observed that there were nine
things as the pride of FEB SWCU students. The nine things were alumnus,
learning environment, intimacy between lecturers and students, faculty reputation,
faculty achievements, study program achievements, student achievements,
benefits for personal, and the intimacy between students. Detailed description
about the nine things will be presented as follows:
Alumni
As a faculty that has been aged more than 50 years, FEB SWCU have alumni who
are scattered everywhere, and not a few who have successfully occupy important
positions in the government and companies, both national and abroad. It became
one pride for the students in the SWCU Faculty today. M12, one of the
postgraduate students and alumni of S1 FEB SWCU admitted that many
important people in Indonesia were graduated from SWCU, especially the Faculty
of Economics. There was also M6, also a post graduate student non-alumnus of
FEB SWCU, who said that he was proud to be one of the students in the FEB
program, because of the admission of the quality of the study program alumni in
their hometown. The informant said so: "The thing to be proud of ... the second is
the quality of the alumni. Not so many people in Kupang know about MM SWCU,
but they know certain alumni of MM SWCU who are in average have been
29
lecturers there, and they are recognized to have good quality" (Interview/M6/15-
03-2013)
Although some students were proud of FEB alumni, there were also students who
claimed not satisfied with what had been achieved by FEB alumni along this time.
For example M1 who expressed such sentences,
"I do not close my eyes to the alumni of the university except SWCU, for
example when I look at UGM alumni, who sit in strategic positions in
government, corporations, and so when I see the mass media about the
opinions of those experts etc. Well so far I have not heard the opinion from
SWCU alumni, but from the UI and so on, it makes me not satisfied at all
"(Interview/M1/01-03-2013)
Based on those empirical data, it can be seen that the spreading and success of
FEB SWCU alumni, is one of the pride triggers of the students who are enrolled
in the faculty today.
Learning Environment
The second thing to be proud by the students of FEB SWCU was the learning
environment in the college. There were three aspects concerning the unique
learning environment for FEB SWCU students, namely the diversity of cultural
backgrounds of the students, the campus convenience, and friendliness of the
people in the campus. With regard to the cultural background of the students, it is
not independent of the characteristics of SWCU itself as a mini-Indonesia
university, where there are many people from different cultural backgrounds in
Indonesia who are enrolled there. M17 said so,
"FEB is also mini SWCU, especially that FEB also consists of a lot of
students who don’t only come from one tribe, so we can learn to socialize
not only with origin Salatiga people, we can be study together with people
of Ambon, every people can be friends, not only in the academic activities
but we can also learn socialization anyway ..."
The diversity of cultural backgrounds of the students who enrolled in the SWCU
in general, and the FEB in particular, is an advantage for the students who
enrolled in the faculty. Therefore, the students have the opportunity to have cross-
tribe and cross-ethnic socialization. According to the students, it was very
important for their future because they would be dealing with many people who
came from various backgrounds. This diversity has been conditioned by nature, so
that it becomes a uniqueness of SWCU and FEB. The students feel the difference,
especially when they travel to certain campuses that the students mostly
dominated by certain tribes or ethnic. In addition to the diversity of cultural
background, there were also other things such as campus comfort and friendly
attitude of the people in the campus. Some postgraduate students who were non-
alumni of FEB and did not come from Salatiga, have made some kind of
comparison involves these two things of the FEB SWCU with their previous study
30
places. In this comparison, they recognized that natural condition of Salatiga was
cool and far away from the noise, it had made SWCU and especially FEB a very
comfortable environment for learning. In addition, people in FEB and SWCU
were also generally very friendly, even they were students, lecturers, staffs, even
security guards. According to them, these differences made them feel proud to
study in SWCU, especially FEB.
If we pay attention to what the students said about the success of the alumni and
the learning environment, it can be identified the first concept as the cause or
trigger of the pride growth of a customer towards the organizations that provide
products or services to him or her, that is brand association. Aaker (1991: 109)
defined brand association as everything that was connected with the memory of a
brand. Meanwhile, the customer pride of the organization can be redefined into
the realm of marketing as a positive feeling of the goods or services of an
organization, which is derived from certain customer identification with
reputation, uniqueness, and excellence attributes of such organizations than any
other organization. Gouthier and Rhein (2011) suggested that the pride of an
individual to institutions indicated that the individual had a high preference level
(high degree of favor) against the institution. A high regard for this institution
could arise, if the institution was perceived positively or associated with positive
things. Thus, the first proposition can be formulated as follows:
P1: The more positive the association given by the customers about
the brand of an organization, the more proud of the person to be
the customers of the organization.
Intimacy between Lecturers and Students
The following thing as a proud of FEB SWCU students is intimacy created
between lecturers and students. Nearly all the students that were interviewed
expressed this as a matter to be proud of. One proof of that intimacy was that the
lecturers were called with non-formal name like "mas" "mbak", "koh", or "cik" by
the students. It was recognized to make the warm interaction between lecturers
and students. Another proof was the communication via BlackBerry Messenger
(BBM) between lecturers and students. Students and lecturers could discuss each
other anywhere and anytime. Lecturers also have a high concern for students.
According to M11, the concern was reflected through concrete actions such as
asking students whether he or she experienced difficulties related to the course
material, lending books, open the time to consult when the students had difficulty,
and so on. In fact, according to M14, lecturers sometimes also played a role as a
parent. M14 recalled:
"... When I studied S1, the next day I would have thesis examination and at
evening the lecturer sent me SMS about the preparations that was still
need help, he said I believe you can certainly bla..bla..bla. I feel the
lecturer such as my parent, that's what I think does not exist everywhere
because like I said earlier, my brother who went to Jakarta or my friends
31
who study at other universities, were never told me such a story, and I
never heard it "(Interview/M14/25-03-2013)
According to the students, they have never met or heard it was discussed by their
friends who went to other campuses. They were proud of that intimacy between
lecturers and students that was only happening in FEBSWCU.
Intimacy that was created between the employees and the customers was a trigger
of a sense of pride to the service provider institution. These findings support the
claims of some experts that familiarity with customers played an important role as
'marketing mantra' today (Bhattacharya and Sen, 2003). A qualified service relied
heavily on the willingness of employees to demonstrate their commitment to
customer service (Peccei and Rosenthal, 2007). Intimacy between employee-
customer (employee-customer intimacy) can be defined as a condition in which
there is liquid and harmonious intimacy between employees and customers before,
during, and after the consumption of a good or service. The results showed that in
these circumstances, a sense of pride as a customer of the education service was
emerged. Excerpts of the interview above also supported the argument of Tracy
and Robins (2004) that pride would occur if a person felt they were appreciated by
others. If the customer is well served by the employee during the consumption
process, then of course the customer will feel appreciated. Thus, the following
propositions can be proposed:
P2: The more intimate the relationship between employees and
customers in the process of consumption, the more proud of these
customers to use the products of the organization
Lecturer’s Reputation
The reputation of the lecturers in FEB SWCU was also one aspect that fostered
the pride of the students in the faculty. According to students, lecturers in FEB
had been known by many people because they often led seminar or training in
various areas. In certain events such as a study tour to companies, students were
often asked about the lecturers in the FEB SWCU by certain parties, because the
lecturers had ever give trainings on several occasions in companies. In terms of
competence, lecturers in FEB SWCU were also qualified. According to students,
the quality was reflected through the academic degrees held by the lecturers.
Specifically at the post graduate level, students had pride by being instructed by
the Doctors and Professors who had a lot of experience and high professionalism.
This was disclosed by M18, one of the Master of Management students. He said:
"I am so proud since I am taught by the teachers who are professional,
experienced, not only in education, but experience outside in the business
world, they have experience, it is also a matter of pride, since our lecturers
are not ordinary lecturers but professors with great
achievements".(Interview/M18/07-05-2013)
32
In addition, the totality of the lecturers in providing classroom teaching was also
became a proud expressed by FEB students. Some students revealed that FEB
lecturers were not only teaching but actually distributed their entire science to the
students. This was in contrast with the lecturers at other universities who taught
simply. M12 said:
"So the lesson which the UKSW economic lecturers gave to us was full,
what they have is what they give to us, well in other universities, the
lecturers only give half to the students, from 100% that they can, they give
only 50% or at least 45%, not full. It makes me proud because the
knowledge that I gain is different from the others ... "(Interview/M12/02-
03-2013)
Nonetheless, based on the students’ experience, they recognized that there were
some professors who did not meet their expectations in the college. The lecturers
were sometimes did not present a lecture material as it should, but much discussed
things that had nothing to do with the material. It was then difficult for students to
take the mid test or final test, because they were not ready.
Some previous studies on organizational pride had provided evidence that the
organizational reputation was a strong trigger of organizational pride (Helm, 2011
& 2012). These results indicated that not only the reputation of the organization as
a whole that could lead to organizational pride, but the reputation of the individual
employees in the institution could also generate pride. Reputation of the
employees can be defined as the perception of employees that reflects a complex
combination of standout personal characteristics, achievements, shown behavior,
and the image attached to the employees, whether directly observed or reported by
the other party (adapted from Greenberg, 2003: 205). If it is assumed that the
customer perceives themselves as institution 'insiders', the good reputation of the
employees in these institutions can be a source of positive feelings of the
customer. This supports the argument of some experts that an individual can feel
pride when his closest colleagues showed a good performance (Tracy, Shariff, and
Cheng, 2010). Thus, based on the study results it can be formulated the following
proposition:
P3: The better the reputation of the employees in an organization, the
more proud of customers in using the products of the
organization
Achievement
One aspect that would be the pride of the FEB SWCU students was its
achievement. For some students, when compared with other faculties within
SWCU, FEB had an advantage in terms of organizational development and
capability to realize its vision and mission. Big names from FEB UKSW
especially in Central Java was an honor for the students. The pride was felt when
many universities and other colleges came to FEB UKSW to conduct a
comparative study (benchmarking), in which it indicated that FEB SWCU had a
33
good quality. In addition, students were also proud because in some seminars,
FEB was able to bring prominent speakers at national and international levels.
According to the students, participation in seminars with prominent speakers also
created a sense of pride. In the case of faculty achievement, fact that could carry
the faculty name was not only at institutional level but also at the collegial level
(lecturer/student achievement). One of the achievements that the students proud of
was the achievement in extracurricular activities such as Student Sports Week
(POM) on campus. In the POM in 2012 and 2013, the overall winners were
achieved by FEB, and it became the pride of the students who were participated in
the event or who were just fans.
The achievement in study program level was also accreditation. Besides being one
of the attractions for students to choose a major, FEB UKSW accreditation
(especially management study program) also became the pride of the students,
because in some other prominent universities, accreditation was still lower than
FEB accreditation. For students, though SWCU only a small university in the
small town of Salatiga, it had a good quality that had been recognized in Indonesia
and was able to compete with top universities in big cities. M24, one of the S1
management students said,
"The most important thing to be proud of is obviously Accreditation. S1,
S2, S3 haveA accreditation of the Management, it is heartening for us,
especially when sometimes people do not see us, where is anyway
Salatiga? Many people do not know where Salatiga is, but in fact in
Salatiga, one small town, there is a private university that can compete
with other universities". (Interview/M24/11-04-2013)
Accreditation that was achieved by FEB study program was a source of pride as
well as a comparison factor when the students compared it with other study
programs, both in SWCU environments, as well as outside the institution.
In addition to the faculty and study program achievement, one of the
achievements to be proud of was the achievement of SWCU FEB students
themselves. The achievement might be referred as an individual achievement or
collective achievement, as class achievement, achievement in student
organizations, in the achievement of a group of talent and interest that were
followed by the students and so on. In an observation that the researcher did in
Economy People's Party (PESAKOM) in 2013, the researcher succeed to briefly
interview M, which was one of the PESAKOM participants, and also a chairman
of the 2011class. When the researcher asked whether there was pride to 2011
batch, M replied: "Of course we are proud. Last year we (2011 generation) were
in the 1st place for this event, so we were the first champion. Then there is an
offer in Bethany church to perform, then this year we are in the final of POM, and
in Pancasila we will also perform fill this…"(Observation/PESAKOM/05-04-
2013)
There were achievements of the students in one class, and it became our pride. In
addition to brother M, the researcher also conducted a short interview with P,
34
chairman of 2009 generation. When he was asked about the uniqueness of 2009
generation, P said,
"2009 generation has many things, from the multi-talents which is not only
good in the field of sport that we prove in Kambing Cup, in each year the
Economic Faculty has Kambing Cup, we've got two times in a row, it was
also a history where we as the the first class got the title twice in a row.
And also in the art field wecan see there is OMB, they had wandered up to
a distant island of Bali. It is not earned by all class, only 2009 had. So I
can be proud of the 2009 generation. There is still a lot anyway, one of the
students also got Djarum scholarship".
In addition to the achievements of students in one class, there is also achievement
of the Talent groups in FEB SWCU, which the causes a pride for the students.
One example is the Finger Kine Club achievement, one of the groups for FEB
SWCU students who are interested in the field of cinema in the IT Indie Movie
Competition festival, it was organized by SEMA SWCU FTI in 2010 ago. At the
competition the representative of the SWCU FEB Finger Kine Klub won the
second champion and got a number of other awards. One student then expressed
his pride to such achievement via the Internet (feb-uksw.blogspot.com).
Related to the three kinds of achievements above, a number of studies had
confirmed that the achievements were sources of pride (Decrop and Derbaix 2010;
Gouthier and Rhein, 2010). Tracy and Robins (2007) also argued that a sense of
pride was a feeling that was almost always arises when an individual achieved
certain accomplishments. Based on the consistency between the observed reality
and the results of previous studies of accomplishment and pride, it can be
proposed a proposition as follows:
P4: The more achievements of the organization, the more proud of
the customers in using the product of the organization.
Benefits for Personal
FEB students pride against SWCU, was also triggered by the presence or absence
of the student benefits derived from study process in FEB SWCU. Some students
who were interviewed expressed it. One informant, M23, expressed: "... Actually,
all universities can be proud when people who are enrolled in the place are
developed. So when I feel I'm growing, I grow here, I can take all of the
knowledge, I can learn here, at that time there is pride ". (Interview/M23/11-04-
2013)
Some other students also expressed a similar thing. The pride of the SWCU FEB
students arose due to the benefits gained in FEB SWCU that could be distributed
to others, and therefore the future of the students was built starting at FEB SWCU.
The kind of benefits trigger a sense of pride of the FEB SCWU students.
35
These findings revealed the perceived benefits, which became one of the
triggering factors of organizational pride. Perceived benefits can be defined as the
customer's perception of what is obtained from consuming particular goods or
service (adapted from Mulyanegara, 2011). Gouthier and Rhein (2010) expressed
that pride always comes up when the actual achievement was equal to or more
than the previous expectation. When the customers consume a product of the
institution and receive benefits more than their expectation, positive feelings
towards the institution that provides the product would appear. Thus, the
following proposition that can be proposed is:
P5: The more appropriate the benefits gained by the customers of the
expected benefits in consuming the products of an organization,
the more proud these customers in using the products of the
organization
Relationship Between Students
Relationships between students were this last aspect that could cause a students’
pride to their faculty, in this case FEB institution. Relationship between students
generally occurs in a particular class generation. Familiarity created between
students in a class, and also academic competitions among students are created in
such generation. There are two main factors that can bring a pride of a student.
M2, a Master of Management student said,
"... In MM there is a very strong kinship and friendship can not be denied
even in cross-ethnic relations, it happens so strong. That is something to be
proud of. However, competition is quite strong in views, competition
among students is usual, it occurs in MM institution. I do not know another
generation but for the 23 class generation, each student had his or her own
ideology and it was the real thing that in one side was good to be
maintained in fact, it made all of us proud to be in a community like this
"(Interview/M2/05-03-2013)
Each class has its own unique characteristics. An example was the students of S1
of 2011 generation, who were characterized by its Bollywood dances which were
often performed at various events, both on campus and off campus. The
compactness of a class was often formed because of the uniqueness of each
student in the class. In addition, the non-formal activities such as soccer together,
eat together, or walk together also became close relationship between students.
Compactness and kinship that were created in a generation formed an identity of
the students.
If we pay attention, these findings were talking about organizational culture.
Kondhalkar (2007: 336) argued that one of the factors that gave identity to
individuals in institutions was the organizational culture. Organizational culture
provides identity in individuals within the organization. Identity is one of the
factors that make an individual feel himself or herself as different than other
individuals. Gouthier and Rhein (2010) suggested that organizational pride could
36
be created if people perceived themselves as a different single entity. Thus, the
next proposition that can be formed is,
P6: The more distinctive the organization culture, the more proud
the customers in using the products
Students way in Expressing Pride
Based on the data collected, it was known that FEB SWCU students expressed
their pride against SWCU through five ways, namely oral communication,
showing affiliation, recruitment, self-actualization, and further study.
Verbal Communication
The most obvious form of pride expression of the students against FEB SWCU
was seen through their oral communication with others. Based on data collected,
these oral communications were occurred between FEB students, among students
with non-FEB friends and between students with non-SWCU friends. The verbal
communication can also be classified according to its purpose, which is to inform,
recommend, compare, associate, and promote. Oral communication with the
purpose of informing usually involved an individual with FEB students, talking
about the place of study, tuition, professors, and others. In these talks, FEB
students were simply be a conduit of information about what was to be known by
others regarding FEB SWCU. Such communication was usually occurred with the
limited purpose of sharing. In addition, oral communication with the aim of
recommending was communication in which students FEB openly advised others
to study in FEB. Consider some excerpts of the interview that reflects this type of
communication as follows: "That time I had just finished S1, or some were
temporary studied in S1, so I told that if I or my parents still had money, it was
better to had further study in S2. S2 is better in SWCU, in terms of cost and in
terms of quality, MM can be taken into account. "(Interview/M6/15-03-2013).
This kind of communication showed that the FEB students had particular
intention that was to invite others to study at FEB. The following type of oral
communication is verbal communication that aims to compare. In such
communication, each communicator comparing the attributes possessed by the
faculty or study program with the attributes of FEB and study programs in FEB.
However, in such communication FEB students do not want the others
underestimate the faculty or the study program. Consider an interview with M4,
one of the Master of Management students as follows: "In the way of expressing
personal pride as students in MM, we often discuss or mock or humiliate other S2
study program in everyday life, although in the form of deliberately joke but
indirectly it also our way to defend each study program." (Interview / M4 / 04-03-
2013).
The following verbal communication is verbal communication with the purpose of
associate. This kind of communication happens when students associate
themselves with FEB when the students get something positive.
37
"Suppose we're talking about something, suppose the topic of A, well, if for
example we talk that we are very proud of Economy, it seems that we are
arrogant, but sometimes after finishing the discussion on the topic A, I
respond the conversation by the way what I usually do in Economy, or
what have already taught by the lecturers in the courses, a systematic way
of thinking, way to respond a problem well. I forget when or where, there
was someone who said ‘okay’, well, and then I said oh of course Economy.
"(Interview / M14 / 25-03-2013)
In addition to associate themselves with faculty, students were also often associate
themselves with the lecturers. This was often done in a conversation with another
person, the person who was familiar with the lecturer in FEB SWCU. Some
students told me that they were often chat with their friends from other
universities, and in particular topics they mentioned some professors at FEB
SWCU. When they heard the name of the lecturer, they immediately said that He
or She was their lecturer. The last type of verbal communication is verbal
communication with the purpose of promoting. This kind of communication
occured when a student told only FEB SWCU advantages to others, be it
facilities, lecturers, curriculum, accreditation, competitiveness with other
universities, and so on. This communication was done to highlight the advantages
of FEB SWCU.
This reality was actually in line with the findings of other experts that pride could
cause a positive Word of Mouth (Soscia, 2007; Decrop and Derbaix, 2010). Tracy
and Robins (2007) also suggested that the responsive action which was appeared
first when a person felt proud was communicating with other people. Thus, from
the reasoning it can be formed the next proposition as follows:
P7: The more proud the customers in using the product of an
organization, the more positive word of mouth about the
organization will be communicated to others
Showing Affiliation
The second way of the students to express pride in FEB SWCU was to show
affiliation with FEB SWCU to others. There were two media to indicate the
affiliation, namely the physical media and virtual media. FEB SWCU students
used a variety of physical media or tangible items (t-shirts, stickers, co-cards,
brochures, folders, etc.) to identify themselves as part of the FEB SWCU. One of
the media was T-shirt. Almost every generation (generally at S1 level) the
students always make a shirt or jacket to signify and distinguish them from
another generation or another faculty. This generation T-shirt was often pointed
out to their friends, as an identity that they studied in FEB SWCU. Consider some
of the following interview excerpts: "I have, yesterday we bought the class T-
shirt, and then we bought the class jacket again. The clothes are often used in
college, used at home to show off with my friends, you know I am a FEB student,
38
there are T-shirt, jacket, then also stickers, I paste on my helmet.
"(Interview/M20/05-03 -2013)
"When we had our tour to Bali, there was the T- shirt right, that's all I could be
proud of. So when I went home to my city, I took it and I wore it there, then
everybode said ‘MM SWCU’? Then they saw the tour to Bali writings and asked
me. Then I said yes we were there every year and also tour to other regions and
abroad. "(Interview/M3/04-03-2013)\
"The simple example is that we ever got MM sticker, when I first came in, I was
also happy, I put it on the helmet, my helmet. So wherever I go I wear that helmet,
oh so this kid from MM, so that is my pride too. "(Interview/M18/07-05-2013)
In addition to demonstrating affiliation with FEB SWCU through tangible objects,
the students also showed an affiliation through virtual media such as Facebook,
Twitter, BlackBerry Messenger, etc. Students put their academic identity in social
media accounts belonging to them. When the were asked how to express pride in
FEB SWCU, M23 said "Maybe the first thing is show it on Facebook, show on
Facebook that I study at SatyaWacana Christian University, Faculty of
Economics and Business, Management, right that is my pride."
(Interview/M23/11-04-2013).
Several other students are also performed the same thing. In addition, the
important things to be learned in college was often published as status on social
media, then photographs of activities in FEB SWCU, and photographs along with
professors also frequently uploaded to show the public their affiliation with the
lecturer or FEB SWCU. Affiliation will explain identity, and becomes an
expression of the pride of the students against SWCU FEB.
The variable that could be identified through these results was an affiliate
performance or display of affiliation. According to Bove, Pervan, Beatty, and Shiu
(2009), display of affiliation was the way from which the customers communicate
their relationship with an institution to others through tangible displays. This
definition can be reformulated in accordance with the results of this study that is
symbolic communication to inform the customers affiliated with an institution to
others through tangible objects or virtual media. Other than through the medium
of language and words (word of mouth), intangibles objects such as shirts, jackets,
stickers and media-virtual media such as Facebook, Twitter, BBM and so on, are
also medium for customers to indicate their identity and express his or her pride to
a product or institution.
This finding has implicitly been appointed by Decrop and Derbaix (2010) in their
study, that the fans of the football team who were proud of the club they idolize,
often drew symbols of the club or the colors typical of the club on objects
belonging to them like car, motorcycles, and even their own bodies, when they
gave support to their club in a match. Similarity of two realities in different
contexts is that the individual who is proud of the organization, tend to show their
39
identity or their relationship with the organization through their ownership. Thus,
a proposition that can be proposed is as follows,
P8: The more proud the customers to consume the products of an
organization, the more likely they would show their affiliation
with the organization to the public.
Recruitment
The third way of the FEB SWCU students to express pride was recruitment.
Recruitment means recruiting new students, and to recruit relatives or
acquaintances to engage in a particular activity in FEB SWCU. Pride of FEB
made the students had a will to recruit relatives or friends to study at FEB SWCU.
Recruiting action was not only limited to advocation, but also to help the
registration process and administration required. This was stated by M13, when he
was asked about how to express pride in FEB SWCU in everyday life. M13 said,
"How to show that pride may well like that one, because we are also
indirectly introduces FEB, then if there are relatives who want to study at
the economic Faculty, I love when he wants to go to college here later.
Not only select SWCU, when they say that they want to study at Economic,
I am sure that I will propose The Economic faculty of SWCU. If necessary,
sometimes I take care of the forms and I'll take care of everything, that's
one part of my pride. "(Interview/M13/06-03-2013)
In addition to recruiting new students, students also often invite friends or
relatives to engage in an activity in SWCU FEB. This was usually done by the
students involved in scientific activities at the Faculty SWCU as a committee.
They often promoted these activities to friends and relatives, and invited their
friends to participate in these activities.
These findings were in line with the framework of thinking from Decrop and
Derbaix (2010) in their study findings. Both experts argued that the customers
who were proud of the brand or company had the passion, and a missionary of the
brand or company concerned. A concept that can be identified from these findings
is the customer acquisition. Customer acquisition can be defined as the process to
influence the customer to purchase a good or service (businessdictionary.com). If
a customer proud against an institution that provides a product for his
consumption, then the customer is likely to encourage others to consume the same
product. Thus, the next proposition which can be formed as follows:
P9: The more proud the customers to consume the products of an
organization, the more they tried to persuade others to consume
the same product.
Self Actualization
40
Self-actualization stated here means bring in all the science and values learned in
FEB SWCU, in everyday life. There were four dominant forms of self-
actualization by students FEB SWCU as a manifestation of pride, namely:
applying knowledge, developing knowledge, look good, and well behaved. Some
informants expressed to that they expressed pride as a student FEB SWCU in a
way to apply a range of knowledge and values they learned in FEB SWCU, in
everyday life. For them, the pride did not need to be demonstrated by talking
about the advantages of FEB, but with a real useful contribution. By the way,
others would naturally know their identity as a SWCU FEB student. Contributions
were made in thesimplest way through discussions, informal conversations, or
specific actions. M13 recalled: "... Among my friends, I am considered as the most
frugal, so for example when I was shopping at mall ... sometimes other people did
not check the price, so just grab everything, so I gave my advice "that should be
calculated so… so…" then they said "You must be an economic student"
(Interview/M13/06-03-2013).
Thus, others know identity as a student of Economics through a simple specific
action. Other students also said that others often asked them for an input with
respect to an issue in the company, and the opportunity that they shared the
knowledge gained in SWCU FEB. One informant also expressed pride by making
scientific work on SWCU FEB. It became a contribution to FEB, and intended for
other people who wanted to know the profile of FEB SWCU, they could know
through the scientific work. Another informant applied her knowledge by starting
a small business, which is not for profit only but also to show her identity as a
student of economics. Applying the knowledge in everyday life becomes an
expression of their pride. In the course of scientific activities in the classroom and
outside the classroom, students expressed their pride with an active way of
learning. Some students admitted that they were always try to be active in the
classroom by asking, make summaries, discussions with the lecturers about
interesting articles they find, collect the seminar material to be read back and so
on. There was a sense of pride that encouraged them to take advantage of the
college, and to improve the quality of the lectures. Besides a sense of pride, it was
influenced by the perception of "do not want to waste money". In addition, some
informants admitted that in everyday life they expressed pride as a student at FEB
SWCU through appearance. Especially for postgraduate students, they were no
longer look like mostly S1students, but they gave the impression that they were
S2 students. Consider some of the following interview excerpts,“I want to show
my pride from my appearance, style, dress, because I want to dress in a different
way from S1. I try to dress neatly ... "(Interview/M5/05-03-2013).
"The first way is from my appearance, it shows me as the MM student, in
terms of appearance. In different people we should be able to distinguish
the people with S2 education, moreover Management S2 and S1, in terms
of appearance. From that appearance people can be asked, probably from
his or her neat appearance then someone may ask which college you are
graduated from? It comes from the appearance. "(Interview/M6/15-03-
2013)
41
The last way to express the pride with self-actualization was maintaining good
behavior in order not to harm the name of FEB SWCU or the study programs in it.
This was driven by the faculty good name, alumni good name, professors good
name, and emotional closeness that was built up during the study in FEB SWCU.
In the daily life, the students showed their confidence as part of FEB. M19 said
that although in her family there were several people who studied at other well-
known universities in Indonesia, she was not ashamed to admit that she was a
student of Economics at SWCU. There were also students who wanted to do their
best so that the FEB name could be elevated in the eyes of others through his
behavior. M23 said that he wanted to show pride in it through his responsibilities
in study and played a role in organization as well as possible, so that people may
see that his pride was not as empty pride, but with quality. In addition to students
who were already worked, they really tried to demonstrate the ability because they
brought big names of Alumnus, and big-name of faculty/university they hold, and
it became a liability.
These findings indicated that service customers were proud to higher education
institutions, expressed pride through self-actualization. Self-actualization meant
here is the realization of the potentials and capacities of the individual
(Hergenhahn, 2009: 588). Higher education service customers bring in their pride
by applying knowledge and skills they gained in the educational process,
developing the knowledge and skills, and also display positive behaviors and not
tarnish the good name of the service provider institution concerned.
Self-actualization that is showed by the customer is actually benefits the
institution as a positive image of the institution will be awakened from the way of
the self-actualization. Based on these findings, it can be proposed a new concept
of pro-institution self-actualization, which then can be defined as an individual
effort to realize all the potential and knowledge in certain ways that consciously or
unconsciously will benefit the institution in which the individual is involved. As a
concept which presupposes the existence of self-identification among individuals
and institutions (Mischkind, 1998), organizational pride shows that there is a
psychological attachment between individuals and institutions. That is, an
individual perceives that institution is identical with himself or herself, so that he
or she is able to show the positive things that benefit the institution. Thus, the next
proposition that can be built is:
P10: The more proud the customers in using the product of an
organization, the more inclined they are to actualize themselves
in ways that benefit the organization
Further Study
Pursue further study in FEB SWCU is the last form of pride expression of the
students. This was done by the students who were an alumnus of S1 or S2 FEB
SWCU. One informant M15 said that,
42
"... My enrollment in S2 show that I am quite proud of what I earn in S1, it
means my S1 gave me many advantages, it means that if I enter S2, I could
possibly be better so. Loyalty is probably part of, it means that if we are
loyal to an institution, it means that we also take pride of the institution.
"(Interview/M15/03-05-2013).
One other informant of the Management doctoral program, Alumnus of S2
Management at FEB SWCU, suggested that experience during S2 with faculty,
students, administrative staff, security guards, and all parties in SWCU had
formed a deep sense of belonging. This particular relationship atmosphere
encouraged him to resume studies in the S3 Management Doctoral program at
FEB SWCU. It showed loyalty, as a tangible manifestation of the high emotional
bond between students and FEB SWCU.
This reality showed trust or even loyalty to the service providers institution.
Variable that could be identified in these results was the brand loyalty. Aaker
(1991: 39) defined brand loyalty as an attachment of a customer who possessed
them. Organizational pride that requires the identification between individuals and
institutions may cause in terms of the emotional attachment between individuals
and institutions. The study results of Decrop and Derbaix (2010) also supported
the argument that pride could lead to loyalty. Thus, it can be proposed a
proposition as follows..
P11: The more proud a customer in using the product of an
organization, the more loyal they are to the organization.
Theory Construction
The conceptual discussion of the study results above has emerged a number of
propositions that can be integrally compiled as a micro theory as follow:
CUSTOMER
ORGANIZATIONA
L
PRIDE Achievement
Organizational Culture
Employee Reputation
Employee-Customer Intimacy
Brand Association
Perceived Benefits
1
2
3
4
5
6 Brand Loyalty
Pro-Organization Self-Actualization
Customer Acquisition
Display of Affiliation
Positive Word of
Mouth
7
8
9
10
11
43
Chart 1. Antecedents and Consequences of Customer Organizational Pride
Theory Comparison
To reinforce the novelty dimension of the micro theory of customer organizational
pride constructed above, then the next micro theory was compared with other
micro theory about customer pride that was by constructed by Decrop and
Derbaix (2010), as shown in the following chart:
Chart 2. Antecedents, Dimensions, and Consequences of Pride in Sport
Consumption
(Decrop and Derbaix, 2010)
Criteria reference used to compare the two micro theories was criteria reference
developed by Wallace (Ihalauw, 2008: 148-152). According to Wallace, there
were four benchmarks that could be used to compare the theory, namely scope,
level of abstraction, parsimony), and precision of language. By taking into
account the availability of information required from the comparator theory
(micro theory of Decrop and Derbaix), as well as the analytical power needed to
perform a comprehensive comparison, so in this study a comparison was
performed by using only two criterias, namely scope and level of abstraction.
According to Ihalauw (2008: 148-149), the scope of a theory could be seen from
two dimensions, namely substantive scope and space and time scope. Substantive
scope referred to the content coverage at the core of a particular theory, while
space and time scope referred to where (place) and when (time) aspects where the
theory was applied. In pride theory from Decrop and Derbaix, the first and second
propositions demonstrated the link between the present achievement and the past
achievement as independent variables and pride as the dependent variable. The
44
linkage between the achievement and pride was also found in the organizational
pride theory constructed in this study, although it was not sorted by time.
The third proposition of the pride theory of Decrop and Derbaix showed the
linkage between socio-cultural context as an independent variable with pride as
the dependent variable. This association was not explained in the theory of
customer organizational pride, therefore it was not identified in the study results.
The factor of consumption context differences and also differences in the amount
of analysis unit of both studies allowed it.
The fourth proposition in pride theory of Derbaix and Decrop was the linkage
between pride as the independent variables and the commitment and loyalty as the
dependent variables. Based on this proposition Derbaix and Decrop argued that
the more proud the customers to the company or brand, the higher their
commitment and loyalty to the company or the brand. This argument was the
same as proposed in the proposition that the customer organizational pride theory
had impact on brand loyalty.
The fifth proposition in pride theory of Derbaix and Decrop was pride as a
relationship between pride as the independent variable and increasing
consumption and collection. In the theory of customer organizational pride the
relationship was not found, which was likely due to differences in the
characteristics of the products that were consumed and differences in the term of
consumption. Furthermore, the sixth proposition in pride theory of Decrop and
Derbaix was the relationship pride as an independent variable with WOM and
proselytism as the dependent variables. These relationships were also discussed in
the theory of customer organizational pride, that the customers who were proud of
the institution would convey positive things about the institution to others, and
recruited others to consume products from the same institution.
Next, the seventh proposition in pride theory of Decrop and Derbaix was the
relationship between pride as an independent variable with the customization and
bricolage as the dependent variables. Decrop and Derbaix argued that the
customers who were proud of a company or brand would assist the company in
value creation as they would appear as creative, pro-active, and bricoleur
customers. The theory of customer organizational pride also discussed this
relationship, that customers, who were proud of the institution or brand, would
actualize themselves in certain ways that consciously or unconsciously may be
profitable for the institution. This showed the value co-creation activity between
institutions and customers.
Based on the above explanation, it could be known that there were two
propositions in the pride theory of Decrop and Derbaix which were not covered in
the theory of customer organizational pride, namely the relationship between
socio-cultural context with pride, and pride with the increase in consumption and
collection. Conversely, there were six propositions in the theory of customer
organizational pride which were not covered by the pride theory of Decrop and
Derbaix, namely the relationship between brand association and pride, the
45
relationship between employee-customer proximity and pride, the relationship
between the reputation of the employees and pride, the relationship between the
benefits perceived by pride and pride and relationship between pride and
affiliation expression. Based on this comparison, it could be concluded that the
theory of customer organizational pride had wider substantive scope than
customer pride theory of Derbaix and Decrop.
According to space and time scope, observed from the number of propositions, the
pride theory of Derbaix and Decrop consists of seven propositions, while the
theory of customer organizational pride has eleven propositions. Of seven and
eleven propositions, there are five identical or similar propositions. Six
propositions of the theory of customer organizational pride cannot be explained by
the pride theory of Decrop and Derbaix, while the two propositions of the pride
theory of Derbaix and Decrop customers cannot be explained by the theory of
customer organizational pride. It means, from space and time scope the pride
theory of Decrop and Derbaix can be used to explain some of the phenomenon of
customer organizational pride in the context of higher education services
consumption. In contrast, almost all of the pride phenomena in the context of
sports consumption can be explained by the theory of customer organizational
pride, in which from seven propositions, five are the same or similar, and two are
not.
The customer pride theory od Derbaix and Decrop was not relevant to explain the
brand association, the proximity of the employee-customer, employee reputation,
perceived benefits, and organizational culture, as variables that lead to pride, and
affiliation expression as a result of pride. This may be caused by the
characteristics of the consumption context and the characteristics of the products
consumed. On the contrary, the theory of customer organizational pride was not
relevant to explain the relationship between socio-cultural context and pride,
relationship between pride and the raise of consumption and collection. This may
be caused by the difference in the time required for consumption, switching
barrier, and the amount of the unit of analysis of the study that constructed the two
micro theories. Thus, based on the description above it can be concluded that
micro theory of customer organizational pride had greater time and space scope
than the customer pride theory of Derbaix and Decrop. This can be observed from
the amount of the same and different propositions on both theories, which
describes the ability to explain each phenomenon.
In contrast, according to the level of abstraction, the concepts in the customer
pride theory of Derbaix and Decrop tend to show uneven abstraction level, there
was a concept at the mid or high levels, and there were lower-level concepts, for
example, the concept of socio-cultural context in the theory. It can be observed
that these concepts were at lower or higher level, which could still be translated
into concepts at lower levels such as demographic, economic levels, population
density, etc. But, the concepts such as commitment or WOM in the theory were
only be translated into dimensions.
46
Meanwhile, the abstraction level of the concepts in the theory of customer
organizational pride tent to be spread evenly and are on the lower level. If these
concepts are intended to be elaborated, then the results will only in the form of
dimensions, for example, the concept of positive WOM in the theory. When this
concept is about to set out it will only generate dimensions or attributes, such as
associative positive WOM, or that are comparative. Thus, it can be concluded that
the theory of pride of the Derbaix and Decrop were at a higher abstraction level,
than the theory of customer organizational pride that was constructed in this study.
Based on a comparison between the two micro theories above, it can be reduced a
number of old or are already known propositions about the organizational pride on
the customers, so that the new micro theory will appear as follows:
Chart 3. Antecendents and Consequences of Customer Organizational Pride
after Theory Comparison
CONCLUSION
Customer organizational pride is a positive feeling that is felt by the customers as
the customers a product of an institution, which is sourced from the customer’s
identification for the reputation, excellence, and the unique attributes of the
institution compared to other institutions. That is, the organizational pride is felt
because of the customers perceive the advantages of the institution as the personal
advantages of the customers.
CUSTOMER
ORGANIZATIONA
L
PRIDE
Display of
Affiliation
Organizational
Culture
Employee Reputation
Employee-Customer Intimacy
Brand Association
Perceived Benefits
1
2
3
4
5
6
47
The study results showed that the customer organizational pride was triggered by
the six factors. The first factor was the brand association. Everything that is
perceived in a positive and superior manner of the institution is potential to create
a sense of pride, especially to customers who identify themselves as 'insiders' of
the institution. The second factor was the friendliness of the employees and
customers. The harmonious intimacy that was created between employees and
customers in the process of consumption, made the customers to feel treated
differently and being respected. If intimacy occurs when the customers or the
customers are already perceive themselves as the parts of the institution, it will
display a sense of pride in the institution. The third factor was the reputation of
the employee. By identifying themselves as the parts of the institution, customers
will tend to perceive employees as partners, so that if the employee is deemed to
have a good reputation and respected other parties outside the institution, the
customer will also take pride. The following factor was the achievements of the
institution. The positive achievements of the institution also create pride in
customers who identify themselves as part of the institution. The fifth factor was
the cause of the perceived benefits. The pride of the institution is also determined
by whether or not the benefits that the customers receive from consuming the
products that are supplied by the institution. If these benefits meet or exceed the
expected benefits the customer, he or she will express a pride towards the
institution. The last causative factor was the organizational culture, as factor that
gives identity to the individuals in the institution. This makes the identity of
individuals who perceive themselves as part of the institution including
customers, feel different than other individuals so that they can emerge a sense of
pride.
Besides having a causative factors, organizational pride in customers also have
some impacts. The first impact is positive Word of Mouth. If customers feel proud
because of consuming the products from an institution that is seen as having
advantages and a certain uniqueness, then the customers are likely to tell the
positive things about the product or the institution to others. The second effect is
an affiliate performance. If the customers proud because of consuming the
products of a superior institution, then the customers are likely to inform their
association with the institution to others through specific ownership, both tangible
(T-shirts, stickers, jackets) or virtual through social media. The third impact is
customer acquisition. Customers who take pride against an institution, will try to
invite others to join or consume products from the same institution. The fourth
effect is pro-institution self-actualization. Customers who are proud of the
institution, will actualize themselves in certain ways that consciously or
unconsciously benefit the institution. The last impact, the customers who feel
proud of the institution will purchase or consume other products from the same
institution, because of the psychological attachment between customers and the
institution.
Implications of the Study
48
The results and discussion of this study have a number of implications, both
theoretically and practically. Theoretically, organizational pride is one variable
that does not only applied in the intimacy between the employees and the
institution or company. In the particular consumption context in which high
intensity of interaction between customers and institution and high switching
barrier occur, the customers will perceive themselves as part of a social group that
was created by the organization. Such conditions allow the process of
identification and pride, if the organization is seen as superior to other
organizations in certain aspects.
Judging from the causal factors that were found in this study, organizational pride
was triggered by external factors of the individual. This was consistent with the
arguments of Bohm (Gouthier and Rhein, 2010). Meanwhile, the organizational
pride was one of the constructs of potential that could trigger behaviors such as
voluntary from the customer, but beneficial the institution or company (customer
extra-role behavior), and also cooperative behaviors that were required by the
institution from the customers for to the effectiveness of the consumption process
(customer in-role behavior).
In practical terms, in the paradigm of intimacy marketing today that is focusing
the harmonious-collaborative intimacy between company and all external
stakeholders including customers, organizational pride is one of the key concepts
that is very important. The organizational pride will make the customers identify
themselves as an integral part of the company or organization, which then would
help the company create value. This organizational pride led the pro-social
behaviors that benefit individuals and organizations (Tracy and Robins, 2007).
Thus, organizations and companies need to manage a good intimacy with the
customers or customers, taking into account factors that may trigger such pride
organizational reputation, accomplishments, organizational culture and so on -
which reflect the importance of the management of intangible assets. If thus things
are considered and managed well, then the institution will undoubtedly be
attractive in the sight of the customers and become a source of ideal self-
identification.
The Limitations of the Study and Future Research Agenda
In addition to the theoretical and practical implications, this study also has the
disadvantages. In the conducted interviews, there were a number of informants
who had difficulty in answering the questions since they never had experience
related to the things observed. For example, in answering the question, "how do
you express your pride in the lecture in class?", The Informants had difficulty
because of not knowing or remembering exactly what he or she did when he or
she felt pride. These disadvantages need to be considered by future research,
especially with regard to the selection of informants and data collection
techniques.
For future research, the main agenda is to conduct empirical testing with
quantitative methods to the micro theory of organizational pride on customers that
are constructed in this study. In addition, future research should also explore the
49
possibility of experiencing the pride organization in the context of other
consumption, especially where there is a switching barrier and the interaction
intensity between the customers and the company is low. Specifically in the
context of higher education services consumption, future research may also
explore the phenomenon of organizational pride in the alumni of an institution of
higher education services, and investigating whether there are new causal factors
and the impact.
REFERENCES
Aaker, David A., 1991, Managing Brand Equity, New York: The Free Press.
Ahearne, M., Gruen, T., Bhattacharya, C. B., 2005, Antecedents and
Consequences of Customer-Company Identification: Expanding The Role of
Intimacy Marketing, Journal of Applied Psychology, Vol. 90 No. 3 574-585
Appleberg, Kimberley A., 2005, The Construction of a Nomological Network for
Organizational Pride, Dissertation, USA: Benedictine University.
Bhattacharya, C. B., Sen, Sankar., (2003), Consumer-Company Identification: A
Framework for Understanding Consumer’s Intimacy with Companies, Journal of
Marketing, Vol. 67 76-88
Boezeman, Edwin J., Ellemers, Naomi., 2008, Pride and Respect in Volunteers’
Organizational Commitment, European Journal of Social Psychology, 38 159-172
Bove, Liliana L., Pervan, Simon J., Beatty, Sharon J., Shiu, Edward., 2009,
Service Worker Role in Encouraging Customer Organizational Citizenship
Behaviors, Journal of Business Research 62 698-705.
Decrop, Alain.,Derbaix, Christian., 2010, Pride in Contemporary Sport
Consumption: A Marketing Perspective, Journal of Academy of Marketing
Science, 38: 586-603.
Ellemers, Naomi., Kingma, Lotte., van de Burgt, Jorgen., Barreto, Manuela.,
2011, Corporate Social Responsibility as a Source of Organizational Morality,
Employee Commitment and Satisfaction, Journal of Organizational Moral
Psychology, Volume 1 Issue 2 pp. 97-124
Gouthier, Matthias H. J., Rhein, Miriam., 2011, Organizational Pride and Its
Positive Effects on Employee Behavior, Journal of Service Management, Vol. 22
Iss. 5 pp. 633-649
Gouthier, Matthias H. J., Rhein, Miriam., A Dynamic Perspective of Employee
Pride and Its Positive Effects on Commitment to Customer Service and
50
Fluctuation Intention, The 11th International Research Seminar in Service
Management, 2010, France.
Greenberg, J., 2003, Organizational Behavior: The State of The Science, New
Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates Inc.
Griskevicius, Vladas.,Shiotta, Michelle N., Nowlis, Stephen M., (2010), The
Many Shades of Rose-Colored Glasses: An Evolutionary Approach to the
Influence of Different Positive Emotions, Journal of Consumer Research, Vol. 37
Haslam, Alexander S., 2004, Psychology in Organizations: The Social Identity
Approach, London: Sage Publications Ltd.
Helm, Sabrina., 2011, Employees’ Awareness of Their Impact on Corporate
Reputation, Journal of Business Research, Volume 64 Issue 7 pages 657-663.
Helm, Sabrina., 2012, “A Matter of Reputation and Pride: Associations between
Perceived External Reputation, Pride in Membership, Job Satisfaction and
Turnover Intentions”, British Journal of Management. doi: 10.1111/j.1467-
8551.2012.00827.x
Hergenhahn, B.R., 2009, An Introduction to The History of Psychology, Belmont
USA: Wadsworth.
Ihalauw, John J. O. I., 2008, KonstruksiTeori: Komponendan Proses, Jakarta:
Grasindo.
Ihalauw, John J. O. I., Gouw, W., Tirta, Y., 2011,
DariRealitasBisnisMenujuKeKonstruksi Model, Jakarta: UPH
Ihalauw, John J. O. I., 1998, Total Quality Management di Perguruan Tinggi,
Salatiga: Fakultas Ekonomi
Katzenbach, J., 2003, Pride: A Strategic Asset, Strategy and Leadership, Vol. 31
No. 5, pp. 34-38.
Kondalkar, V.G., 2007, OrganizationalBehaviour, New Delhi: New Age
International Ltd.
Louro, Maria J., Pieters, R., Zeelenberg, M., 2005, Negative Returns of Positive
Emotions: The Influence of Pride and Self-Regulatory Goals on Repurchase
Decision, Journal of Consumer Research, Vol. 31.
Lovelock, Christopher H., 1991, Services Marketing 2nd
Edition, USA: Prentice-
Hall International.
Mark, Eddie., 2013, Students are not Products. They are Customers, College
Student Journal, Vol. 47 Issue 3, p489-493.
51
Mischkind, Louis., 1998, Pride – The Hidden Corporate Asset, available from
http://www.sirota.com/pdfs/Pride_The_Hidden_Corporate_Asset.pdf, [retrieved
by March 5th
2013].
Mukhpadhyay, A., Johar, Gita P., 2007, Tempted or Not? The Effect of Recent
Purchase History on Responses to Affective Advertising, Journal of Consumer
Research, Vol. 33
Mulyanegara, Riza C., 2011, TheIntimacy between Market Orientation, Brand
Orientation, and Perceived Benefits in Non-Profit Sector: Customer Perceived
Paradigm, Journal of Strategic Marketing, Vol. 19 No. 5.
Patrick, Vanessa M., Chun, H., MacInnis, Deborah J., 2009, Affective Forecasting
and Self-Control: Why Anticipating Pride Wins over Anticipating Shame in a
Self-Regulation Context, Journal of Consumer Psychology, 19 (3) 537-545.
Peccei, R., Rosenthal, P., 1997, The Antecedents of Employee Commitment to
Customer Service: Evidence from a UK Service Context, The International
Journal of Human Resource Management, 8:1.
Pereira, Marco A.C., Da Silva, Marcia T., 2003, A Key Question for Higher
Education: Who are the customers? Proceedings of 31st Annual Conference of
Productions and Operations Management Society, POM-2003, Atlanta GE.
Soscia, Isabella., 2007, Gratitude, Delight, or Guilt: The Role of Consumer’s
Emotions in Predicting Postconsumption Behaviors, Psychology & Marketing,
Volume 24 (10) 871-894.
Staton, Mark.,Paharia, Neeru., Oveis, Christopher., (2012) Emotional Marketing:
How Pride and Compassion impact Preferences for Underdog and Top-dog
Brands, Advances in Consumer Research. Vol. 40
Susanti, Dewi., 2011, Privatisation and Marketisation of Higher Education in
Indonesia: The Challenge of Equal Access and Economic Values, High Educ, 61:
209-218
Suwignyo, A., 2008, Pendidikan Tinggi dan Goncangan Perubahan, Yogyakarta:
Pustaka Pelajar.
Tracy, Jessica L., Robins, Richard W., 2007, Emerging Insights into The Nature
and Function of Pride, Association of Psychological Science, Volume 16 No. 3.
Tracy, Jessica L., Robins, Richard W., 2004, Show Your Pride, Psychological
Science, Vol 15. No. 3
Tracy, Jessica L., Shariff, Azim F., Cheng, Joey T., 2010, A Naturalist View of
Pride, Emotion Review, 2: 163.
52
Wilcox, K., Kramer, T., Sen, S., 2011, Indulgence or Self-Control: A Dual
Process Model of the Effect of Incidental Pride on Indulgent Choice, Journal of
Consumer Research, Vol. 38
.Winterich, Karen P., Haws, Kelly L., (2011), Helpful Hopefulness: The Effect of
Future Positive Emotions on Consumption, Journal of Consumer Research, Vol.
38
53
Entrepreneurship and Economic Transformation
(case study: Blimbingsari Community)
Dr. I Wayan Ruspendi Junaedi, SE., MA1
Universitas Dhyana Pura, Bali
Jl. Raya Tegal Jaya, Padang Luwih.
Telpon: 0361-426450/426451
Email: rusfil_2001@yahoo.com
Abstract
In the development of business and the need for a process in which development
is a series of conscious effort made towards a better state than before.
Development is a multidimensional process of socioeconomic change. This
confirms that economic development is not a purely economic process, but rather
a manifestation of the transformation or social change and cultural. Therefore, any
process of economic development always involves a multidimensional factor in it.
The transformation that occurred in Blimbingsari covering economic, social and
cultural, among others, involve changes in the structure, initiator agent of change,
towards more advanced (progress). From the description above, the authors raised
three issues research, as follows: 1). What is the characteristic (unique)
Blimbingsari Village? 2). What is the Types of Entrepreneurial in the village
Blimbingsari? 3). What is the role of entrepreneurship in rural
Blimbingsari? The three issue of the study, the authors raised three research
objectives, namely: 1). To explain the characteristic (unique) Village
Blimbingsari. 2). To find out, the types of Entrepreneurial what is in the village
Blimbingsari. 3). To explain the role of entrepreneurship in the village
Blimbingsari.The research methodology used in this study is a qualitative research
with in-depth interviews, triangulation data and oral history. The village has
happened Blimbingsari economic change (economic transformation), one of
which is caused by the entrepreneurial. The types of entrepreneurship that exist in
Blimbingsari such as poultry, cattle farmers, pig farmers, ranchers catfish, coconut
fruit seller, the seller of chocolate, grocer, refill water seller, the owner of the
fields, forests sengon, food stalls and the owner of the guest house/villa. There are
also other entrepreneurs as employers coconut sugar makers who become
entrepreneurs in the village Blimbingsari. It becomes a matter of interest to the
author, in view of the development of entrepreneurship in villages Blimbingsari.
The role of entrepreneurship in villages Blimbingsari which is to reduce
unemployment and through their efforts, they can survive and even be able to
1 Alumni and Graduated From Doctoral Study in Economics at Satya Wacana Christian University,
Salatiga
54
finance their children for further studies. They were able to improve their living
standards from "nothing into something". The author's suggestion is, there may be
other factors that affect the economic transformation of this village is that the
author has not been through. So that other researchers can continued.
Keyword: Entrepreneurship, Development and Economic Transformation,
Community, Blimbingsari
1. Introduction
Blimbingsari village is now a village with full of new entrepreneurs with various
efforts respectively. Starting from the establishment of 'team irrigation' with the
launch of Irrigation appropriate by the Regent, many new entrepreneurs have
sprung up, because of the desire to improve the economy of rural communities
and to create well-being of the village. However, the authors did not examine the
amount of income per capita of the population in the village Blimbingsari, but just
purely just to make sure that there is the role of entrepreneurship in the process of
economic transformation "from nothing to something".
Blimbingsari this village in 2010, has become a tourism village which was
inaugurated by the Regent, Prof. Dr. drg. Gede Winasa. The opening of this
village into a tourism village is also one trigger Guesthouse and Villa and a
multiplier effect that following them, such as the sale of souvenir "Dancing Blady
the Cross", palm sugar, and brooms made of palm leaves even all the gardens,
fields and farms have water.
This transformation process is the role of entrepreneurship that is driven through
the village government leaders (formal) and spiritual leaders (informal) in moving
the village community Blimbingsari unchanged, resulting in a change of the
village infrastruktrur, economic development and institutional as well as rural
creative economy. Judging from the time period, including a very fast
transformation when this community adopted the Christian religion, they adopt
new values and a new identity as a Christian Bali.
1.1. Research issues
Problem in this study, focusing on How Enterprise Role in the Economic
Transformation element that can move the institution of the church and the
government to make changes and development Blimbingsari village, from the
village of the "poor" became a prosperous village ("forward"), to build morale and
performance of entrepreneurship by performing on agriculture, plantations and
farms, and with the support of a growing village infrastructure, eventually
becoming a tourist village through creative economic transformation. Author
lowering research problems with three more empirical research questions are: 1).
What characteristic (unique) Blimbingsari Village? 2). what is Types of
55
Entrepreneurial in the village Blimbingsari? 3). What is the role of
entrepreneurship in economic transformation in the village Blimbingsari.
1.2. Research Purposes
The issue of the research above, the purpose of this study are as follows: 1). To
explain the characteristic (unique) Blimbingsari village. 2). To find out, the types
of Entrepreneurial what is in the village Blimbingsari. 3). To explain the role of
entrepreneurship in economic transformation in the village Blimbingsari.
1.3. Benefits Of Research
There are two benefits of this research are theoretical and practical benefits. A
comprehensive overview in the transformation and economic growth in the village
Blimbingsari shows that entrepreneurial support the occurrence of an economic
transformation. The process of economic transformation of economic changes that
systematic and planned endorsed by community groups and their leaders. A
community leader in strategic thinking, long-term oriented, and insightful, and
focused on achieving results today, with a full sense of responsibility.
Terapannya implication, that the transformation in the village Blimbingsari can
serve as a reference for other villages across Indonesia to make Blimbingsari
village became a pilot village and can be a reference in comparative studies to
identify and understand the key factors that influence the success of Blimbingsari
Rural development through the transformation process the economy of the village
is 'poor' and hopelessness into a village of the 'forward' and 'affluent'.
Theoretical implication, that the spiritual leader as an informal leader in the
context of the country, although in the context of church pastors as formal leader
capable of cooperation between informal leader (spiritual leader) and formal
(village government), can provide guidance in entrepreneurship.
Under this, the author will explain the theoretical foundation will be used in this
paper is to explain the development and transformation of the economy and
entrepreneurship.
2. Theory Framework
2.1. Development and Economic Transformation
How modern society aspired to be achieved? Rostow put forward the main
requirements of the availability of capital (Fakih, 2006). Another figure in the
theory of modernization is Stauffer, (2002) which departs from the perspective of
social psychology say that the fundamentals of psychology and human behavior is
strongly associated with social change. Added to that, it always involves the
construction of changing perceptions and attitudes towards life as a whole, not in
separate sections (compare with Todaro, 2000).
Structural transformation will only work well if followed with equal opportunity
to learn, decrease in population growth rate, and a decrease in the degree of
economic dualism between rural and urban areas (French, Wendell L et al, (ed.)
2000). Robbins (2007) states, entity or community should be changed. If
unchanged, the entity will die. All entities should be changed in order to survive.
This statement has a meaning that changes in an entity should be formulated in
such a manner for the sake of survival.
56
Results of the research conclusions Widodo (2009) explains that social change
caused Samin, the modernization of agriculture with the use of technology but
does not eliminate institutional mutual cooperation called the "splice" in which
labor needs in agriculture was obtained by means of mutual help among farmer
households in turns without wage system.
Investment climate related to natural resources (as a provider of raw materials)
and sound government policies. Meaning here that to make a shift from the
traditional fisheries sector to the industrial sector is necessary for government
policies that can provide business certainty and guarantee the welfare of coastal
communities (Lewig and Dollard. 2001).
Two studies were conducted Widodo, Utomo (2008) and Hutahuruk (2008),
shows the same direction, where economic transformation is closely related to the
transformation or social change in the community.
Research Gunawan (2012) are more focused on what the elements of social
change in the communities in rural Bali with his findings about the social change
that is duality. While the research conducted Saptana, Syahyuti and Rosganda
(2003) emphasizes that must take place to strengthen the institutional
transformation of the people in the rural economy.
Saptana, et al (2003), in his research "in order to strengthen the institutional
transformation of the people in the rural economy with a case study in the district
of" tracked from the fragility of the people in the rural economy, the main cause is
the fragility of institutions that support it.
2.2.Entrepreneurship
Entrepreneurship is a human process related to creativity and innovation in
understanding the opportunities , manage resources , so the chances of it
materialized into an economic value that is able to generate profits or value for
long periods of time . Understanding focuses on the aspect of entrepreneurial
creativity and innovation , because of the nature of creativity and innovative one
can find opportunities and make the added value that can increase the value of
assets and capital owned .
Literally Entrepreneurship consists of basic word entrepreneur who gets ke- prefix
and suffix -an , so it can be interpreted entrepreneurship are things related to
entrepreneurship . While wira means courage and effort means that commercial
business activities or non - commercial , so that entrepreneurship can be
interpreted as the courage for someone to carry out a business activity .
Frank Knight (1921), Entrepreneurs try to predict and respond to market changes.
This definition emphasizes the role of entrepreneurs in the face of uncertainty on
the market dynamics. An entrepreneur is required to carry out the basic
managerial functions such as guidance and supervision. Therefore, with grown
kembangkanya knowledge about entrepreneurship, will evoke the spirit of the
Indonesian people, especially young people or students, to help create jobs with
entrepreneurship, not only the job seekers (job seeking). In the spirit of
nationalism that Indonesia should be able to compete arena arena of the world
economy, it will be a lot of students who are motivated to drive the quality of her
and spark ideas in the field of entrepreneurship kretaif highly competitive.
According to Peter Drucker (1967), "institutions that have a manager who has the
entrepreneurial spirit is always ready to face any change". Changes, for these
57
leaders, is part of perkerjaannya. Exactly as said Willim Ahmanson, in a field of
work / business no straight path, consisting of three components, namely:
investors (people who are looking for risk), entrepreneurs (people who take risks),
and managers (those who shy away from risk). Under conditions of good
business, entrepreneurial spirit becomes important. Especially in times of
economic crisis, entrepreneurial spirit becomes even more important.
Unlike the leaders who do not have the entrepreneurial spirit, who tend to think
very rationally, like the establishment, and do not want change. These leaders
often have difficulty in following an entrepreneurial style of thinking. He also had
difficulty following the steps entrepreneurial business. Only leaders who have an
entrepreneurial spirit who have an entrepreneurial spirit that can be true
entrepreneurs. The leaders of both when faced with larger hands, for example
managing business units that produce.
Leadership is subject to the execution of development. Leadership that directs the
behavior of others towards the achievement of a particular goal, in this case the
development objectives to achieve better conditions. Leadership directing and
cause others to act in a certain way or follow a certain direction, which of course,
with the charge and the value of entrepreneurship to further improve performance
and optimal results. Leadership based entrepreneurship has advantages where
performance leadership has room to maneuver more freely. Entrepreneurial-based
leadership is more likely to facilitate members of the public with a set of
capabilities to improve their quality of life by optimizing the existing resources.
When examined, the dimensions of innovation greatly affect the outcome of the
performance of members of the community in improving productivity. Innovation
is supported by the dimensions of creativity which ultimately leads to an increase
in economic resources as a logical consequence of increased productivity (Yulk,
2010: 353). One of the responsibilities of leadership is the most important and the
most difficult is to guide and facilitate the process of making a major change in
the community.
Innovation is the process of turning ideas - creative ideas into a product or method
useful work. Therefore, innovative leaders who have the mental will transmit the
virus innovative continuously, also has the ability to channel their creativity to the
community members become useful results. This is a continuous process in
transmitting the entrepreneurial spirit and continue memilihara and encourage
innovation (Stephen P. Robbins and Mary Coulter, 2010: 21).
3. Research Methodology
The method used in this research is qualitative research. Qualitative research is a
method to explore and understand the meaning (Basrowi & Kelvin, 2008;
Riduwan & Kuncoro, Engkos, 2008; Strauss & Corbin, 2007; Marshall, Catherine
& Gretchen, 1989). This qualitative research process involves important efforts,
such as asking questions and procedures, analyze the data inductively from the
specific themes to common themes and interpret the meaning of data. (Creswell,
2013: 4). This research applies research perspective inductive style, focusing on
individual meanings, and translate the complexity of a problem.
In answering the research questions as formulated above, the research process is
relying on the paradigm of interpretative research using qualitative methods.
Definition of interpretative research paradigm is meant here relates to how to
58
acquire knowledge (in order to answer research questions) that is based on the
process of understanding through interpretation and meaning of this research
related to social reality, which of course also involves interpretation and meaning
of the Researchers (subjectively) on field observations or findings during the
research process, so that the research presented here is the basic ingredient of the
results of interpretation and meaning (Gunawan, 2012; Marshall, Catherine &
Gretchen, Rossman, 1989).
While the purpose of interpretative paradigm is that it epistimologi author did not
follow the flow of positivism, because it is precisely the author has a critical
nature and ontological using flow constructionist, arguing that from the results of
the field, the authors construct a data field that led to the results of research.
3.1. Build Communication and Research Equipment
As a researcher, writer to be elegant and humble in order to establish effective
communication with the informant. Because writers need data and information, it
is often the author requested phone number or home phone number in order to
establish communication. Besides, it is also because there is a recommendation
and an appeal from the head of the village, that the author will conduct research
faster then usually familiar with the informant. When trust arises and grows, the
author is no longer considered a stranger but already regarded as insiders or
"brothers" in the community. So influential for data collection 'as is' (Creswell,
2007).
Readiness is very necessary before researchers began to enter the sites. The
related needs such as correspondence, books field notes, interview guides, camera,
and voice recorder (voice recorder).
Results recorded at least very helpful to hear back and made the transcript. Sound
recordings of the informants are vital, thus avoiding the forgotten records or who
could not be accommodated. Sometimes it was so asiknya discussion the authors
did not get recorded, but because there is a recording, it is very helpful for author.
3.2. Processes and Dynamics and Ethics Field Data Collection
At least there is a major process in the process of data collection, observation and
in-depth interviews (Moleong, 2009; Strauss & Corbin, 2007). This process
always carefully, carefully, and critically. Before performing the retrieval of data,
steps should be prepared early is rechecking interview guides that have been
developed, adapted to the purpose of research. Although in the process
(interviews) there are indicators, other questions will arise (usually) to explore in
an interview.
Recording typically done at night. The authors collected data from various
informants categorized, in coding and made in accordance themes after the
perceived saturation. And so on until all the unanswered problem formulation.
From conversations with the head of the village radiates the streets to meet the
elders and the people as a key informant who was very helpful to researchers,
such as Mrs. Ni Wayan Kari, I Gusti score, Pdt. Wayan Sunarya, Pdt. Job Suyaga
as the spiritual head GKPB time (Chief Blimbingsari Peniel Church), and the
author sometimes settled in the house with Pdt. Job and sometimes in the house of
the village to observe and conduct research. Furthermore, traditional village that
once served as the leader of Blimbingsari traditional village, and all the assembly
59
that was once the house of Peniel church in the village of Blimbingsari. Then the
next informants are former Village Head Blimbingsari and former spiritual leaders
in Blimbingsari.
Whenever depth interviews I always look at the situation and condition of the
informants. The easiest thing is to look at facial expression when the expression
on his face is bright, then this is a good and appropriate time to conduct in-depth
interviews. Patience is required when facing a situation like this.
Another thing that is sometimes overlooked is taking pictures and video, or
recording with a tape recorder. Authors seek first obtaining permission from the
parties concerned, as this is the ethics of a researcher.
3.3. The Location of the Research
Research location in the village in the district Blimbingsari Melaya, Jembrana,
Bali (see Figure 1.).
Figure 1. Map of the island of Bali
Blimbingsari () located in the southeast of the mountain Kelatakan as "Alas
Cekik", with an altitude of 698 meters above sea level, Jembrana. So Blimbingsari
was once a terrible forest. Location Blimbingsari be entered into about seven
kilometers from the main road Melaya-Gilimanuk, with paved roads.
Blimbingsari village located transversely from east to west in the administrative
area Jembrana. Most of the area is low-lying, partly plateau of the mountains and
hills. North and west of the village is a teak forest area (hills and mountains
Klatakan). In the southern part Pangkung Blimbingsari adjacent to the Village
Land. While in the east Blimbingsari adjacent to the Village Ekasari. Blimbingsari
village is one of ten villages in the District Melaya, Jembrana. If seen research
sites closer to see only Jembrana as follows (See Figure 2):
60
Figure 2. Map of Jembrana
From Figure 2 above, it appears there are five districts in Jembrana district, the
District Pekutatan, Mendoyo, Jembrana, State and Melaya. While the village is
located in the district Blimbingsari Melaya.
3.4.Teknik Data Collection
3.4.1. Interview
The interview is a technique of collecting data by conducting a question and
answer directly to the informant (citizens / residents) both entrepreneurial
Blimbingsari, the village head, the religious leaders, community elders
Blimbingsari village, some diaspora communities Blimbingsari village, trustees
and village (LPM, LPD), as well as the village Village Blimbingsari and servant
of the Church at Peniel Church Blimbingsari. As proposed by Subagyo (1995:
34), the interview is a data collection activities through debriefing conducted to
obtain information directly to reveal the questions to the informant about any kind
of entrepreneurship and what the role of the entrepreneur in terms of economic
transformation. Koentjaraningrat (1994: 129) argues that in-depth interviews in a
study aimed at gathering information about human life in a society as well as their
establishment.
Mechanical determination informant by purposive, ie informant who has
knowledge of entrepreneurship Village Blimbingsari to happen Blimbingsari
economic transformation. Tourism Committee (Mr. Mutiyasa, Gede Sudigda and
Mrs. Light Herani Job). Some employers Blimbingsari (Mr. Murji, Karyan father,
Mr. Sukerta, Mr. Suwirya, Mr Ketut Suyaga Job), seven Christian community
leaders Blimbingsari, one person Bendesa Indigenous Blimbingsari, Head
Melaya, and the Regent, Prof. Dr. drg. Gede Winasa.
3.4.2. Research Documents and Observation
Documentary method is to collect data through a written heritage, such as archives
and books on theory or legal opinion related to the problem peneliatian (Margono,
1997: 187).
In this study, the authors use the method of documentation through a way of
collecting data obtained from existing documents or records that are stored,
whether it be books, newspapers and so forth. The author also uses the technique
61
of direct observation through the observation and recording of phenomena that
appear on the process of economic transformation Blimbingsari today. As noted
by Nawawi (1995: 94), this technique is a way of collecting data through
observation and recording of symptoms that appear on the object of research
whose implementation directly in place between an event, circumstance or
situation that is happening today. In accordance with the character of qualitative
research, the technique of observation is very important because it is a way to
observe the behavior of the present, and objects used or generated by today's
society to be understood through research.
Likewise observations on the author to obtain data about the various information
concerning the object of study, is through direct observation of the impact of
entrepreneurship on economic transformation Village Blimbingsari, And want to
know what kind of development strategies implemented in the village
Blimbingsari in facing the challenges of globalization, so that people are not "out"
or "moved" to the city. Researchers involved in a systematic and inconspicuous so
as to create an intense social interaction between researchers with village
communities Blimbingsari.
3.4.3. Trianggulation
As previously explained that with the opening of access to do research in
Blimbingsari, then at this stage writers began to meet informants who are able to
provide information based on interview guides that have been previously collated
author. This interview guide writers need as a handle so the questions remain
focused on the direction to answer the research objectives. This method is
overlooked as a triangulation of data from interviews, so according Bungin (2007:
65-66) through observation can eventually be known by the more valid the actual
incident occurred in the observation unit and the involvement of every citizen of
the village Blimbingsari more objectively.
In the data collection techniques, triangulation is defined as data collection
techniques are combining of various data collection techniques and data sources
that already exist. Triangulation method means that the authors use data collection
techniques vary to obtain data from the same source. If the author uses
triangulation, then in fact the authors collected data simultaneously test the
credibility of the data with a variety of data collection techniques and a variety of
data sources.
3.5. Data Analysis
This study is about the role of entrepreneurship on the transformation that is
evolutiv and longitudinal and in the past, so interviews and methods document is
the main source of data for this research. Writers want and work to improve the
validity descriptively, interpretatip and theoretical to the reader, so writer
interviewed two village elders (Mrs. Wayan Kari 105 years old and Mr. I Gusti
Rata more than 100 years old). In addition, the author also uses the document
ancient archives stored in a church or a book that talks about this study.
62
The author conducted interviews with village elders Pastor. I Wayan Sunarya, Pdt.
Ketut Suyaga Job. Selection of informants is because they are the first generation
that is involved in the process of transmigration. Although they are old hearing is
still good so that it can answer the question posed in the language writer Bali and
all of these questions can be understood. The interview did not take place just
once, even the writers often feel less detail (lack of complete data), the authors
came to the informant again, and to obtain the next informants sometimes the
writer asked for a recommendation from previous informant. This method is
known as the Snowball Method (snow bowling alley method). This interview
happened like a snowball in which the interview is not directly mention the names
of informants are necessary and should be interviewed that have relevance /
linkages. To build confidence (trust) can be through informal approach (Creswell,
2013; Krippendorff, 1991).
This study consisted of two phases which are old and were now. For a long phase
of research done using methods pemanfataan oral history and the study of
documents. In the present phase of research using the method of observation and
interview. Once the data is collected through interviews, the author goes on to
make a transcript of the interview wawanvcraa based. After that the author makes
identifying the theme of the data obtained from interviews, and prepare outline
and writer finally wrote (Miles and Huberman, 1992: 17-19).
4. Result and Discussion
4.1 . The Uniqueness of Blimbingsari Village
Although the majority Christian village, but in a still life using art and culture.
The Church has carved as 'temple'. These matters are described below.
• Gamelan
Blimbingsari village has a wealth of art and culture should other areas of Bali.
Typical art owned by Village Blimbingsari is a dance that usually lacks the
gamelan musicians are very melodious and beautiful. Gamelan musical material is
made of bronze and the front of the gamelan contains decoration or carving bali
and usually plays this music performed while sitting.
• Jegog
Arts and other cultures is the art jegog. Jegog art this is a musical instrument
typical of Jembrana. Jegog musical material is made from bamboo options
diameter of 18-20 cm in size (depending on needs) and the front jegog contains
decoration or carving bali. Differences with gambelan, art jegog jegog usually
play music is done while standing. The number of participants who play the
gamelan music and jegog almost the same amount.
Both art and jegog gamelan music is good, usually used as a musical instrument to
accompany the dancers. Art of dance is normally used to welcome a group of
guests who come to visit and stay in the village Blimbingsari. This dance is
performed by young people aged 18-20 years who have been specially trained to
perform a dance of welcome or farewell. Usually this is a female dancer
(interview with Made John Roni as a head of the comunity, 2013).
• Megibung
Other cultural art is when Blimbingsari ber Anniversary (annual event) or
ecclesiastical celebrate the big day, the citizens Blimbingsari cook together with
63
the entire region and divide tasks into each region. They use clothes and eating
megibung bali (sit together in one tray), do not wear their own dishes.
From the aspects of art and culture, different people or groups of guests from
around the world visit to Blimbingsari see the art and culture ..
Visitation and Guest House
Guests who visit the village Blimbingsari in 2013 some 1518 people. Countries
that come to visit the village of Blimbingsari including Australia, USA, France,
Netherlands, Germany, New Zealand, Singapore, Korea, Belgium and Japan.
Most guests coming is Australia. It continues today.
The impact of a visit this very clearly to community empowerment, when guests /
tourists come to Blimbingsari for overnight average of 2-5 nights using the facility
houses or rooms in the village of Blimbingsari's population, is able to improve the
economy of the village in addition to the crop and farm and self-employed.
4.2. Types of Entrepreneurial in Blimbingsari
Villagers Blimbingsari have diverse jobs . There are farming , both as a farmer
coconut , cocoa and vanilla and sengon . Most residents are farmers , like bertenak
beef, pork , and chicken and catfish . So that it can meet its needs by selling their
garden and livestock. (Observations, 2013). In addition there are also people who
work as civil servants (PNS), entrepreneurship, such as brick businessman,
rechargeable (bottled water), food catering, selling pulses and villas (inn) and
sugar bali. (observation, 2013). Figure 3 is one of the types of entrepreneurial
Blimbingsari as below .
Figure 3. Types of Business Blimbingsari.
Farmer
Since 2010, there started a chicken farm that was built and maintained by the
village residents Blimbingsari. Location cages chickens are located on the
64
outskirts of the village Blimbingsari so as not to affect the community, because
the smell of feces are extremely disturbing.
Poultry is meant here is the business of laying hens, which produce eggs that are
sold outside the village Blimbingsari and or consumption by residents
Blimbingsari. The number of laying hens have managed this, each varying in
number. Based on length of effort and capital owned by the manager or owner.
As for the owners of chickens in the Blimbingsari is Mr. Murji, Mr. Korni, Mr
Made Arif, Katon, Mr Nyoman Suyadnyana, Mr Nyoman Suwitra and Mr Ketut
Edi Kusnaedi. All are citizens Blimbingsari. Besides, there are chickens, there are
also people who have pig farms, cows and catfish are also produced for the
fulfillment of life and sold to the market for other needs. Besides, some of the
farmer have abother activity such as cattle farmers, pig farmers, ranchers catfish,
coconut fruit seller, the seller of chocolate, grocer, refill water seller, the owner of
the fields, forests sengon, food stalls and the owner of the guest house/villa. There
are also other entrepreneurs as employers coconut sugar makers who become
entrepreneurs in the village Blimbingsari.
Agricultural and Plantation
Agriculture and farming is the main business Blimbingsari villagers. With these
plantation crops and villagers could send children to school. Meet the needs of
clothing, food and shelter. Since the existence of appropriate clean water piping
initiated by the religious leaders, village administration and the community
together, agriculture and rural estates Blimbingsari it is more greatly improved.
Agriculture is meant here is rice and rice yield. As Figure 3 above are being done
by plowing the soil so that the soil more friable. While the plantation is meant
here is the result of such coconut plantation, coffee, vanilla, chocolate, bananas,
and other outcomes such as copra.
Guest House
Some of the community in Blimbingsari, have guest house. The impact of a visit
this very clearly to community empowerment, when guests/tourists come to
Blimbingsari for overnight average of 2-5 nights using the facility houses or
rooms in the village of Blimbingsari's population, is able to improve the economy
of the village in addition to the crop and farm and self-employed.
4.3.Role of Entrepreneurship Against Economy
Example or explanation indicate that the presence of a guest visit to the village of
Blimbingsari, helping many Blimbingsari village community empowerment. For
example the room for a place to stay, food and drinks as well as some art (good
dance, gamelan and jegog) paid by guests who visit it.
Blimbingsari Blimbingsari developed which have contributed significantly to the
economic empowerment of the flow of funds of Rp. 126 039 000, which was
accepted by the family, Sekehe gong, dancers and musicians set gambelan,
dancing children, mothers cooking, church and village (secondary data, reports
Pniel Church, Blimbingsari 2013).
Impact of transformation materialized/visible by the formation of Village
Blimbingsari be the only tourist village in Jembrana, from the perspective of an
institutional approach that the current position will continue to change. The role of
65
entrepreneurship through the village leaders and spiritual leaders play a role in the
changes affecting rural communities.
From some of the positive impact of entrepreneurship, it can be concluded that
entrepreneurship aims to reduce unemployment.
5.Conclusions
The village leader likened Blimbingsari planters who work in conditions of
available resources needed and of all these resources, the most important thing for
him is the plant or in this case is the most important member of the community.
Planters aware of the importance and power of the leadership value in making
breakthroughs and changes that could improve rural economic sector
significantly. Blimbingsari village leaders in the other party should increase the
capacity of leadership through the intervention of the factors work ethic and
entrepreneurial factor. These factors are growing in the middle of the village
community Blimbingsari understood as a pattern of beliefs, values, and behaviors,
as well as reviewed by Schein (2004) and leaders as agents of change do the role
and intense relationship with the community, because it is influenced by the
historical trend, social attitudes, and socioeconomic factors. Blimbingsari village
leaders have constantly to understand the two main elements of it (work ethic and
entrepreneurial values) has been growing at Blimbingsari Village community, so
that the values that make a positive contribution to the productivity of the
community to improve the living standards in the field of economic and other
aspects as well that support it, such as spiritual values to continue to always love,
like the teachings and values obtained from the Gospel or the Bible.
Leader described as planters understand that changes both the positive value
through the process of socio-economic transformation has beraktualisasi in the
middle of the village community Blimbingsari and occurs for a long time as a
long process in terms of time. Meanwhile, the village leader Blimbingsari as a
change agent trying to make changes directly and dynamically, because it makes
the two main values of variables that interact through transformative leadership
encouragement in the form of order, stability and the ability to make changes in a
systematic and planned. And this requires a real change in the socio-economic
behavior as a pre-requisite to understanding the development of the Village
Blimbingsari such as gardens, where plants and trees grow and develop according
to his character. From some of the positive impact of entrepreneurship, it can be
concluded that entrepreneurship aims to reduce unemployment and increasing
their welfare.
References
[1] Arief, S., 1995, Neo-Kolonialisme, Makalah pada Seminar Ekonomi Rakyat yang diselenggarakan Sekretariat Bina Desa, di Jakarta, 3 Agustus 1995.
[2] Basrowi & Suwandi. 2008.”Memahami Penelitian Kualitatif”. Rineka Cipta. Jakarta.
66
[3] Chandra, W W; Hendro. (2006). Be A Smart And Good Entrepreneur. Tangerang : CLA Publishing
[4] Creswell, John W. 2013. Research Design,Pendekatan Kualitatif, Kuantitatif dan Mixed. Penerbit Pustaka Pelajar.
[5] Coleman, James S. 2008. “Dasar-dasar Teori Sosial”. Bandung. Penerbit Nusa Media
[6] Castells, Manuel. 2002. “The Power of Identity”, United Kingdom. Blakwell Publishing.
[7] Fakih, Mansour, “Runtuhnya teori pembangunan dan globalisasi” , Pustaka Pelajar Offset, 2006
[8] French, Wendell L., at.al. (ed.) 2000. Organization Development and Transformation: Managing Effective Change, Irwin McGrall-Hill Singapore.
[9] Gunawan, Dadd Heryono, 2012, Perubahan Sosial di Perdesaaan Bali, Program Pasca Sarjana Doktor Studi Pembangunan Universitas Kristen Satya Wacana
[10] Koentjaraningrat. 1994. Kebudayaan Mentalitet dan Pembangunan. Jakarta :. Penerbit PT. Gramedia.
[11] Lewig, K.A. & M.F. Dollard, “Social construction of work stress: Australian newsprint media portrayal of stress at work, 1997-98”, Work & Stress, 2001.
[12 ]Marshall, Catherine & Gretchen B Rossman. 1989. “Designing Qualitative Research” Newbury Park, London, New Delhi: Sage Publications.
[13] Robbins, SP & Judge, TA. 2007. Organization Behavior, Pearson International. New Jersey : Upper Saddle River.
[14] Riduwan & Kuncoro, Engkos Achmad. 2008. Cara Menggunakan dan Memaknai Analisis Jalur (Path Analysis). Cetakan Kedua. Bandung : CV. Alfabeta
[15] Saptana, Tri Pranadji, Syahyuti dan Rosganda Elisabeth , 2003, “Transformasi Kelembangaan Guna Memperkuat Ekonomi Rakyat di Pedesaan dengan Studi Kasus di Kabupaten Tabanan Bali”
[16] Stauffer Dennis. 2002. “Innovative Leadership” . Strategi Untuk Mendorong Pertumbuhan, Inovasi, dan Kinerja. BIP. PT. Bhuana Ilmu Populer. Gramedia. Jakarta.
[17] Strauss & Corbin. 2007. “Dasar-dasar Penelitian Kualitatif”. Tatalangkah dan Teknik-teknik Teoritisasi Data. Pustaka Pelajar, Yogyakarta.
[18] Suyaga Ayub, Ketut.1999. “Sejarah Gereja Bali. Dalam Tahap Permulaan”. Departemen Literatur YPPII. Malang. Jawa Timur.
[19] Suyaga Ayub, Ketut dkk. 2004. “Gereja Yang Hidup, Kumpulan Refleksi Hamba-hmba Tuhan’. Gereja Kristen Protestan di Bali. Penerbit GKPB. Bali
[20] Schein, Edgar. 2004. Organizational Culture and Leadership, Jossey-Bass, San Francisco.
67
[21]Todaro, Michael P. 2000: Economic Development: Economics, Institutions, and Development: a Global Perspective
[22] Widodo, Slamet, 2009, Proses Transformasi Pertanian dan Perubahan Sosial pada Masyarakat Samin di Bojonegoro
[23] Wijaya Nyoman. 2003. “Serat Salib Dalam Lintas Bali”. Menapak jejak Pengalaman Keluarga GKPB 1931-2001. CV. Krinon. Yayasam Samaritan, Denpasar.
[24] Yulk, Gary. 2010. Leadership in Organizations, Pearson Education Inc., New Jersey.
Informants interviewed as follows : 1. I Gusti Rata
2. Ni Wayan Kari
3. Sunarya, I Wayan
4. I Ketut Suyaga Ayub
5. Made John Rony
6. Sudigda
7. Murtiyasa
8. Cahya Herani
9. Murji
10. Gede Karyan
11. Sukerta
12. Ketut Suwirya
13. Tujuh tokoh masyarakat Desa Blimbingsari
14. Satu orang Bendesa Adat Blimbingsari
15. Camat Melaya
16. Bupati Jembrana, Prof. Dr. drg. Gede Winasa.
68
PRACTICE ENTREPRENEURSHIP AMONG STUDENTS AS A FORM
OF PREPARATION THE ASEAN ECONOMIC COMMUNITY IN 2015
(CASE STUDY ON THREE STUDENTS DIPLOMA PROGRAM
UNIVERSITYOF BUSINESS AND ENTREPRENEURSHIP 2015
JAKARTA GUNADARMA)
Dassaad, SE., MM
Gunadarma University
Email: Dassaad_z@staff.gunadarma.ac.id
Mulatsih, SE., MM
Gunadarma University
Email: mulatsih@staff.gunadarma.ac.id
ABSTRACT
2015 represents a new chapter for the State of Indonesia in the ASEAN
Economic Community by 2015. In this case Indonesia is required to prepare
human resources in the face of global competition. But ironically, until now the
people of Indonesia are still not fully aware of what is meant ASEAN Economic
Community by 2015. In order to prepare qualified human resources to face of the
ASEAN free market, the role of higher education is very important. They were
instrumental in preparing a generation - the future generation who have sufficient
expertise and skills in the face of Economic ASEAN Community 2015. This study
aims to determine how the shape of entrepreneurial learning practices among
students at the Gunadarma University of three business diploma programs and
entrepreneurship in 2015 through activities revolving fund which is the first step
in preparing students to be an entrepreneur who has the expertise, skills, and
have a wide variety of business innovation as a preparation for the ASEAN
Economic Community in 2015
Keywords: entrepreneurship, students, ASEAN Economic Community
1. Introduction
AEC (ASEAN Economic Community) is a challenge and a great
opportunity for Indonesia to be able to compete globally in the economic field
between the countries - the ASEAN countries. In this regard, Indonesia is required
to prepare the human resources and skilled resilient in the face of the ASEAN free
market.
As we know that the free market of ASEAN (ASEAN Economic
Community) is one of the containers in which the Indonesian nation can compete
globally in the economic field with the States of ASEAN and to mampou compete
69
in that regard, Indonesia is required to prepare human resources who have the
ability, skills and expertise in the field of economy is high, so is deemed
sufficiently reliable in the face of economic competition with the States of
ASEAN. With the AEC in 2015, the domestic market is not is not fully controlled
by the people in the country but also by the economic actors ASEANyang
countries would contribute in controlling the domestic economy and in this case,
the domestic market will also have many opportunities in expanding its business
into emerging markets - ASEAN countries.
Ecomomic ASEAN Community 2015 will be very beneficial for the
people of Indonesia if Indonesia can take advantage of this situation to further
advance in improving competition in the economy. Indonesia country's economy
will be more respected in the countries, especially in the scope of the ASEAN
countries. It means enormous opportunities for entrepreneurs and economic actors
to be able to introduce and market its products not only domestic but also
dilingkup within ASEAN countries.
ASEAN Economic Community (MEA 2015) is a form of free market
southeast Asia established with the aim to improve the economic stability in the
ASEAN region. With the establishment of the MEA, it is expected the various
problems faced by the economy in ASEAN can be resolved and overcome. MEA
itself affect the creation of a free market in the economic field, especially in the
areas of capital, goods and services and labor, in addition to the impact of the free
flow of goods and services, free flow of labor and investment impact the free flow
of capital.
With the MEA in 2015, actually gives a good opportunity for Indonesia to
develop the economy and expand market share. However, good opportunities will
only be achieved by Indonesia when Indonesia has competent human resources,
has the potential, expertise and skills, especially in the economic field. This is a
big challenge for the Indonesian people, especially the challenges in education, in
print skilled workforce and reliable in the field.
As we know that the level of education in Indonesia is still very low when
compared with the level of education in other ASEAN countries. In this case the
roles and responsibilities of universities increased in order to print the human
resources that have expertise that is reliable. Education as a means to deal with
AEC 2015 is oriented education in the formation of student character being an
entrepreneur. Education is embedded is expected to form the independent youth,
kreati and innovative, and daring challenge. Application of entrepreneurship
education in universities is one of the steps taken to create human resources that
have an entrepreneurial spirit in order to face AEC 2015.
70
Based on this background, the authors are keen to take the title research on
the practice of entrepreneurship in higher education as a form of preparation for
AEC 2015 case study on the Diploma program students of Economics, University
Gunadarma 2015.
Formulation Of The Problem:
How to shape the practice of entrepreneurship in higher education as a first step to
prepare students to face AEC 2015
Purpose:
This study aims to determine the practice of entrepreneurship in college as a first
step to face AEC 2015 (case study on students of economics university diploma
three Gunadarma 2015)
Research methodology:
- Samples
The sample used in this research were 185 students of diploma three
businesses and entrepreneurship 2015.
- Data
The data used in this research is the primary data is data obtained from the
report for the results of students who gathered every month for six months
Revolving Fund. This report is a report as a form of accountability for the effort
they have run.
- Data Analysis
Analysis of the data used is descriptive qualitative analysis is to explain
the stages of entrepreneurship education stages and evaluate the final result of the
practice of entrepreneurship.
DISCUSSION
In carrying out entrepreneurial practice there are several steps that must be passed,
the stages are as follows:
Step 1: Entrepreneurship Course
71
This step is the early step of entrepreneurial practices in which
students are given knowledge on how to be a good entrepreneur. In the normal
course organized by the university, they are given training including training
on business proposal writing, report generation business and product
training on marketing techniques.
Step 2: Distribution Business Group
Having followed the entrepreneurship course, the next student
amounts to approximately 185 students of diploma three businesses and
entrepreneurship in 2015 is divided into several business groups, which each
group numbering about five students, so is more or less 39 groups of students
who practiced in revolving funds. In this group, students have a wide range of
tasks, among others, there being the chairman of the group, there is a duty on the
production, marketing, finance and treasurer. The division of tasks is intended
that the division of tasks and responsibilities are clearly among group
members.
Step 3: Preparation of business proposals and submitting a business proposal
After getting the provision of knowledge of the activities of
entrepreneurship courses, then students submit business proposals to the
campus to obtain funds as initial capital in running the business and in this
case, the college selects the proposal submitted by the student, the proposals
are eligible to receive funds for capital business.
Step 4. Distribution of funds from the campus to the students as initial
capital.
After the university selects a business proposal, then the next step
is to distribute funds to each group as initial capital. Prior to distribute funds to the
university students, they provide socialization beforehand about how the
revolving fund will be student run for six month. They were given a briefing
about how to running a business and how mechanism for the results imposed
by the university. In this case the funds are distributed to each group is IDR
600.000. The fund will be screened during the six- month revolving fund system
for the results to be given to the university by 25% of profits each month,
other than that each month of each group of students repay IDR. 100,000.00 per
month and IDR 8000 per month for administrative costs.
Step 5: Product Exhibition
After three months of their businesses running, usually to be held
in activities mentioned activities of the product title. The title of the product is
72
the bazaar activities to promote the product to the public on the creativity
of each product group revolving funds.
Step 6: Reporting of results of operations and Evaluation Results
The final step after a six-month revolving funds are evaluating the
results of each group in running entrepreneurial practice, evaluation results
can be seen from the results that are reported every month. The results achieved
by the 39 groups of students of diploma three businesses and
entrepreneurship, among others, are as follows:
Table 1
Profit Sharing per Month
RESULTS FOR 25% OF BENEFITS PER MONTH ( IDR)
NO GROUP NAME JANUARY FEB MARCH APRIL MEI JUNE
1 199X'S KIDS 66250 38212 24875 12984 12984 16153
2 BUDDY BAG 8875 17500 6625 13500 14000 24000
3 D'BRIEFTACCHE 74500 37750 24000 48375 57500 66125
4 FORTUNE COMPANY 12500 10000 12984 24875 114375 114375
5 KING'S BROOCH 48000 24500 71250 28000 37375 89000
6 PT. ANDS COMPANY 10000 14000 45500 25500 13250 15750
7 PT. BACKAR 86 7625 11500 5000 25500 8125 15000
8 PT. COLIFTA 56250 121250 17500 77625 99375 43375
9 PT. GUILI GOTA 30000 45000 43000 6500 84250 5375
10 PT. ISENGISENG 9000 12984 17500 28625 10000 16000
11 PT. PASSOL FOOD 3750 27750 17500 88500 63500 68500
12 PT. RISE YUDIUM 45000 64250 33125 21875 40625 71875
13 PT. SOLOP ART ENT 20125 26625 64250 16500 18625 48000
14 PT. STAR PROJECT 45000 45000 18250 60000 73750 77500
15 PT. SUKSES BAHAGIA 4125 160750 116250 51125 30000 70000
16 PT. UNIQUI BAG 20875 17500 30000 9125 13000 6625
17 RUMAH SCRAFT FASHION 17500 33750 19000 18250 56500 268500
18 STAR COOKING 5000 5000 713 356250 224750 347500
19 THE FAIRY TELLS PROJECT 7375 7375 21250 39625 46125 52625
20 D'Shirt 11750 25750 31625 31625 36000 35250
21 Perutani 13750 19000 18750 13375 16200 21250
22 Swap Shop 25000 31250 38000 56250 61000 68750
23 PT. PCS 36250 19625 24750 24250 35500 39875
24 Mericeardy Block 41000 31375 31125 71000 92000 100750
25 1'st Handycraft 13500 10000 31000 26132 24500 24506
26 Difars Store 54500 43250 30875 51750 57000 75000
27 My Acsesories 20750 31250 51000 47750 52000 56250
28 Hijab Gaul Collection 9000 49750 33500 28500 15500 10250
29 Maver Zip 7625 12625 53750 25500 27625 32625
73
30 Farisnosa 14500 11625 39250 35125 35750 32000
31 PT. Dichandik 8000 8500 35125 61750 30500 34250
32 SJ Blue 11250 15125 58500 40500 26750 11250
33 I Near Bag 16000 16750 23000 63000 16375 14500
34 Fairy Lampion 5000 41750 4000 55875 52500 73250
35 Gamik Acsesories 7375 9750 33625 39500 41625 19250
36 PT. Ciaobella 0 16875 19500 74250 74500 74500
37 Lampion Collection 16250 30620 17625 52375 54125 64000
38 Flower Crown 9750 9000 73000 30625 34375 36875
39 Slap Case 10000 60000 11250 55560 49750 63000
Source : Monthly Reports Results For Diploma Program student Three Business
and Entrepreneurship
Chart 1
Charts the Development of the Results for Six Months
Based on the results chart for the development deposited by a student for
six months, it can be seen the movement of ups and downs for the results that are
deposited by the students. From the graph it can be seen that the movement of the
result is very stable. For them as entrepreneurs who are still in the early stages of
050000
100000150000200000250000300000350000400000
GR
OU
P N
AM
EB
UD
DY
BA
GFO
RTU
NE
CO
MP
AN
YP
T. A
ND
S C
OM
PA
NY
PT.
CO
LIFT
AP
T. IS
ENG
ISEN
GP
T. R
ISE
YUD
IUM
PT.
STA
R P
RO
JEC
TP
T. U
NIQ
UI B
AG
STA
R C
OO
KIN
GD
'Sh
irt
Swap
Sh
op
Me
rice
ard
y B
lock
Dif
ars
Sto
reH
ijab
Gau
l Co
llect
ion
Fari
sno
saSJ
Blu
eFa
iry
Lam
pio
nP
T. C
iao
bel
laFl
ow
er C
row
n
NO123456789101112131415161718192021222324252627282930313233343536373839
RESULTS FOR 25% OFBENEFITS PER MONTH ( IDR)
74
learning entrepreneurship, the result can be quite good because in running their
business, they have never experienced a loss every month, every month they have
always proven to deposit the proceeds to the campus as a giver of initial capital.
Conclusion
Based on the results of entrepreneurial practice the above it can be
concluded that the diploma program of three business and entrepreneurship at the
University Gunadarma is good enough to run an entrepreneurial practice for six
months. this is evidenced by the profitability and the stable results. With the
entrepreneurial learning about this, students have the provision to face the Asean
Economic Community in 2015.
Reference
Didiek, Ahmad Supadie. 2014. The role and preparedness of students Facing the
AEC in 2015, BEM FAI Seminar UNISULLA
R. Winantyodkk. 2008. The Asean Economic Community in 2015 to strengthen
the synergy ASEAN amid global competition. PT. Elex Media Komputindo,
http://www.bppk.kemenkeu.go.id/publikasi/artikel/150-artikel-keuangan-
umum/20545-masyarakat-ekonomi-asean-mea-dan-perekonomian-indonesia
http://www.kemangmedicalcare.com/kmc-tips/tips-dewasa/2883-pengaruh-era-
mea-masyarakat-ekonomi-asean-2015-terhadap-tenaga-kesehatan-profesional-di-
indonesia.html
75
ENTREPRENEUR STUDENT’S CREATED MODEL BASED ON
BUSINESS INCUBATOR AT STATE POLYTECHNIC OF SRIWIJAYA
Bainil Yulina
Accounting department at state Polytechnic of Sriwijaya
Jl. Srijaya Negara Bukit Besar Palembang, 30139
byulina@gmail.com
Pridson Mandiangan
Business Administration department at state Polytechnic of Sriwijaya
Jl. Srijaya Negara Bukit Besar Palembang, 30139
primaputramando@gmail.com
Indah Indra Andi
Informatics Management department at state Polytechnic of Sriwijaya
Jl. Srijaya Negara Bukit Besar Palembang, 30139
indraandialfarisi@gmail.com
ABSTRACT
State Polytechnic of Sriwijaya since 2009 had a Student Entrepreneurship
Program grant, which is a program initiated by Dikti in an effort of creating an
entrepreneur. Until now it has produced 420 participants from active student or
even alumni. The number should be taken as a reference for the development of
entrepreneurship program especially in State Polytechnic of Sriwijaya to support
the creation of entrepreneurship which is able to provide a reliable changes that
will make a difference for Palembang community. This was expected as a
problem-solving solutionwhere Palembang stated as one of nine districts in South
Sumatera that has the percentage of poverty above the national rate. On its way it
is very difficult to create new entrepreneurships because from year to year there
is a decrease number of both the amount of grant allocated by Dikti and the
output of the implementation of the program, which only 2 percent became an
entrepreneur. There are many phenomenons encountered in the implementation of
entrepreneurship program. This condition made the implementation team
proposed Dikti Science and Technology for Entrepreneurship grant by make it
through the establishment of Business Incubator as a place to accommodate the
improvement of the entrepreneurship program. In 2014, Business Incubator has
programs like socialization activities, tenant selection, provision for assistance
and internship, network expansion, and cooperation in business capital,
promotion, distribution of marketing, and utilization of the website. The
implementation involved participants from both active student and alumni as
many as 26 tenants, which are incubated and coached for one year in Business
Incubator State Polytechnic of Sriwijaya. Using observation method,
documentation, and an interview to tenant and management agencies it can be
76
concluded that an Business Incubator Model is most effective in the development
ofentrepreneurship program in State Polytechnic of Sriwijaya.It can be proved by
the increasing number of entrepreneur and by the achievement acquired by the
coached tenants.
Keyword : Business Incubator, Student Entrpreneurship Program, College
PREFACE
Educated unemployment are really significant with education problem, in
developing country as generally has education problem, educated work force,
human resources, good facilities and view of society. The society have been
growing up, education should pillar as increasing prosperity through using of
work opportunities. These are unemployment data of highest education was
graduated.
Table 1.1
The Open Unemployement Level (TPT) Presidents Above 15 Years Old,
Based On The Highest Education Gained ( In Million people)
Year 2011 until year 2013 No. Highest Education
Graduated from 2011 2012 2013
Februari Agustus Februari Agustus Februari
1 No education at all 92,142 190,370 123,213 82,411 109,865
2 Not graduated from elementary school
552,939 686,895 590,719 503,379 513,534
3 Elementry school(graduated)
1,275,890 1,120,090 1,415,111 1,449,508 1,421,653
4 Junior high school(graduated)
1,803,009 1,890,755 1,716,450 1,701,294 1,822,395
5 Senior high school(graduated)
2,264,376 2,042,629 1,983,591 1,832,109 1,841545
6 SLTA Kejuruan 1,082,101 1,032,317 990,325 1,041,265 847,052
7 Diploma I.II.III/Academy 434,457 244,687 252,877 196,780 192,762
8 University 612,717 492,343 541,955 438,210 421,717
Total 8,117,631 7,700,086 7,641,241 7,244,956 7,170,523
Sumber : Badan Pusat Statistik 2013
77
As data result of BPS that educated unemployment amount in Indonesia are still
high for Diploma and University on August 2012 got 8,98 percent, and on
February 2013 getting increasing 9,80 percent and on August 2013 getting bit
decreased 9,47 percent. The amount will be increasing every year because each
university will be graduation of bachelor category that has billion of students but
not all of fresh graduated want to be job seeker than job creator. These things
cause by learning system that applied at college that focus on how providing
student to get a good job not to be job creator.
Education has influence that significant enough on created of
entrepreneurship spirit (Yulina, 2012). College as place for education that has
supporting entrepreneurship to be entrepreneur. Based on department vision or
education minister year 2025 have a regulation of development on
entrepreneurship sector, first created entrepreneurship education to all of subjects,
materials, extra curriculars, although building themselves, second explore on
education curriculum that has given entrepreneurship education to be able to
increase an understanding about entrepreneurship skill, third growing up on
entrepreneurship culture at campus and school environment.
Almost all of college in Indonesia nowadays, has already to teach
entrepreneurship education. Beside that for grow of entrepreneurship soul and
increasing entrepreneurship activity in order to a fresh graduated more already to
make a plan as a job creator. Education minister has been exploring many
regulations and program which one of the program that has been exploring is co-
op program (Cooperative Education Program) since 1998, that for making
entrepreneur through college, so that in 2003, has producing co-op program that
has given learning opportunity completely on UKM. The regulation and
supporting program that sponsored entrepreneurship activity and make grow of
new entrepreneur with IPTEK based, that has necessity. Based on idea’s director
giving contribute for entrepreneur student’s program, not only at State Polytechnic
of Sriwijaya but also at private college.
In South Sumatera has 99 colleges, that stand of 14 University, 50
Institute, 7 Polytechnic and 24 Academic. Especially in Palembang city, there are
78
62 colleges, namely 11 Universities, 25 Institute, 6 Polytechnic and 20 Academic,
the amount should be standard for developing entrepreneurship program
especially in Palembang city for support of create a good job entrepreneur and can
give a big change and able to giving change to community around him. Hopefully
as solution for Palembang city problem that noted as one of nine regency or citied
in South Sumatera has percentage of poor above on National number (Koran
Sindo, 17 April 2014), but on the reality it is very difficult for create a new
entrepreneur because many phenomenons that found on entrepreneurship program
such as There is no PMW participant is were successful to back of fund, it was get
on start up on business, Many business unite of participants has stopped out on the
middle, There is no communication between manager, mentor and PMW
participants especially they got alumni status.
At state polytechnic of Sriwijaya have 246 student’s of enterpreneurship
participant that has become independent entrepreneur are 26 people’s
(kemahasiswaan polsri : 2014), than at other college in South Sumatera has
executed entrepreneur student’s program. Business incubator forum and south
sumatera technology that made on 2014. It has real fact of South Sumatera
goverment as facilities to developing and connecting enterpreneurship
development activity especially at college in Palembang and national as general.
Where the member’s are still limited for 4 colleges or 6,67 percent and a lot of
department or government institution, south sumatera governor letter’s
no.527/KPTS/BALITBANGNOVDA/2014), is Business Incubator and
enterpreneurship of Sriwijaya University, Palembang centre, state Polytechnic of
Sriwijaya Business Incubator, Business Incubator and technology
enterpreneurship STIMIK/MDP, innovation centre and industry Incubation
Palembang, Research technology Incubator and South Sumatera Inovation.
On the other hand as spirit of of serious Research Team for increase
enterpreneurship program at state polytechnic of enterpreneurship IPTEK
program in 2013, as one of skim to society, that foundation by dikti has been
making Business Incubator, althought it is still young, but the result that can seen
with a ranking got it by tenant at POLSRI Business Incubator as Runner Up of
79
young entrepreneur (WMM) at category cuisine in 2015, and got Big Five on
Indonesia Banking Enterpreneurship (WUBI) in 204 at category agribusiness.
Based on information that get on Business Incubator, through literature
division, best practices business Incubator on a lot of country and the survey to
business incubator in Indonesia could be explained that training and developing
UMKM able to doing in many ways, which one can do it through Business
Incubator, Business Incubator actor’s Becoming a strategic because could be
create new work field, growing up on new enterpreneurship and could be
implementation facilities to expand many innovation that has procedud by many
actor’s at college in general.It very important of Incubator rules, so that Business
Incubator should be support by the government and the financial enough to
Business Incubator, the effort to developing UMKM through Business Incubator
can do by other Institution, especially college and Research Institution that
movement on Research and Development Sectors. Beside that has other
institution (non college) has potential for doing business function, such as
institution or private company or industry has function and incubation program
(BI, 2012).
Interal process of enterpreneurship spirit ca be maximal if it has support
with enterpreneurship culture as comfort of academic atmosphere, the process of
create enterpreneurship culture can be through many form of learning process, the
survey that did by Indonesia Bank can be know that Business Incubator could
create new work force and can be growing up of an new enterprenur, teaching-
learning process step, learning innovation with make strong each process contain
in every steps at Business Incubator, learning process Based on Business
Incubator becoming a learning method because could be explore it student
enterpreneurship potential not all of Business Incubator can growing up as Best
we hope, from 100 incubator that has grown in Indonesia, only 50 that stayed on,
a lot of them with bad condition, because it less of supporting and institution
coordination especially facilities to support and foundation (Dikti, 2008), look of
the problem above, we need a developing Business Incubator model to growing
competency to student’s, so we get Best Practices Business Incubator that more
effective and efficiency. There is a complicated problem in Business Incubator of
80
State Polytechnic of Sriwijaya. The researcher have a formula of the problem is
how could be grow of enterpreneurship competency to student’s ?
Based on these problem, we get a question such as How are the planning
of development Business Incubator model at state polytechnic of Sriwijaya to
growing up of student enterpreneurship competency ?How to developed Business
Incubator model that has suitable to grow student enterpreneurship competency at
State Polytechnic of Sriwijaya ?, How to be good Business Incubator model that
could developing at state polytechnic of Sriwijaya on grow of student’s
entepreneurship competency ? , and How the evaluation that could applied to
know Business Incubator model effectively of increase to student’s
enterpreneurship competency ?
While of that, the experience of a lot of country that executed Business
Incubator program, it has 3 steps to make Business Incubator function are:
1. Forming steps of Business Incubator;
Developing of Business Incubator should be a part of strategic policy of
economic development that need of the goverment support especially to
create work force through growing and developing new exertion.Business
Incubator could be a tools to developing region economic that of the end can
increase competency of economic region through forming of new
exertion.Forming Business Incubator need cooperation the whole of
stakeholders, not only centre goverment and region but also private,
university, nor financial institution.Before build of Business Incubator, the
first thing we do analysis of market, such as market target, market failed,
Business Incubator Service, Infrastructure, Financial and good management,
so on.Need of the financial source fact that enough and continuously.
2. Operational steps of Business Incubator:
In build of Business Incubator, the first should be clear of focus on target,
what of technology based or service, so that the purpose will be
clear.Nessecity of the area large be absolute things for Business Incubator. In
these things we should compare among area wide, it not small so that quite
difficult to Accommodate tenant exertion development, and it not too big
because will be worry that not efficiency.Tenant should participate on the rent
81
fee or fee to supporting of Business Incubator financial.To connected of
success on Incubator process, need of other selection criteria, so that we have
limited time for tenant in Incubator, example 3-5 years.After graduaded,
tenant are still in controls so after-care service to graduate, these things are
service to graduate, these things are very important to give guarantee of
tenant exertion.In exploring of Business Incubator, need of management team
that have qualification standard, in Europe league as general, Business
Incubator explore by 5-6 stafs, 3 are senior manager that have high quality in
Business department, while ratio between manager and tenant 1:3 s.d
1:5.Business Incubator explore steps will be connected on the kind of
incubator namely incubator has by government or private, based on
technology or service.
3. Evaluation steps of Business Incubator Service ; The achievement of
Business Incubator based on the impact that has given to exertion world,
economic development as large through created work force.To give a point of
Business Incubator need feedback directly of tenant.
There method that used are descriptive analysis method that compare
about theory with best practices of Business Incubator in a lot of province that has
developed in Indonesia.Sumbit of Data and information of many library source,
Calculate of information Best Practice from colleges about Business Incubator
through internet, Do the survey about executed Business Incubator at Polsri, Do
focus Group Discussion to getting of knowledge from skill person that connern
with Business Incubator, Arrangement of recommendation for Polsri and
government about Business incubator.
This training included of experiment study Research namely Investigation
Research with controls condition, where, one or more of variable can be
engineering to do of hypothesis (Kuncoro,2003), te Research show the impact of
entrepreneur trained with Business Incubator model to entrepreneur competency
increasing. The population of these Research are student and alumni that tenant of
Polsri Business Incubator 20 people’s, sample in the investigation is Real
Investigation namely 20 people’s that will be giving of training before and after in
Business Incubator. Sampling Random Purposive Sampling technic coosen in
82
Research because student’s of Polsri are doing Business not only for participant’s
but also after student. Data that need is primer data that take as directly of student
as tenant in Inbis, the method that submitted of data with using quisioner.
Determine Method
Determine that using descriptive method that combine Survey Basic
executed and field Investigation, theoritis mindset, relevan pragmatics and logics.
Descriptive will be purpose to know and show of primer data nor
sekunder, especially perception, knowledge and Business Incubator experience to
developing new entrepreneur/UMKM.Analysis : to know relation between primer
data and sekunder that did using instrument or comparison analysis data.
Sample that take on Investigation namely 20 student’s and alumni as
Incubator tenant that have Business and will be going on.Executed Steps
As big line, the step that did for supporting of sample such as Sumbitted
Data and Information Primer Data Submitted of primer data do trough interview
fill of questioner, and observation, Respond will be assume with sampling method
that structural or on schedule. Start from Business Incubator Institution till
UMKM or entrepreneur that will be trained on Business Incubator. Question will
be giving in 2 forms, are questioner for UMKM, for that the responden will be
group in two group namely Incubator with Sekunder Data. will be submitted of
many Institution and library that connected of explore Business Incubator and
UMKM, Beside that will did of the rules of INBIS and UMKM not only rules of
government but also the other rules. Focus Group Discussion will do by Inviting
of people’s that have competency to give solution on Business Incubator process,
such as University, private Instituiton, that has Incubator, te representative of
UMKM and Technic Department, as comparison and order to get best practices,
so will be inviting foreign Institution that as experiences about Business
Incubator. The analysis activity will be do as descriptive (quantitative) Based on
data or primer and sekunder information that got it. Will be analysis as descriptive
and benchmaking with incubator in other country.
83
Mindset Structure
To explained the rules of discussion, these things explained mindset
structure : such as to get a descriptive about Business Incubator start up with
library, from that getting theory and Business Incubator concept. Concept and
theory need implementation with information about Business Incubator from field
or actor directly, not only Business Incubator at college nor other
Institution.Based on Information will get, make a concept best practisesn for ideal
Busines Incubator, picture 1 show about executed of Research.
Pic . 1. Conceptual Framework
Theory Base
Business Incubator was built in developed country, even that of build of
Incubator Start Up Since 1959, the first tenant in Incubator is try on board in New
Ideal Business Incubator
Recomendation
FGD (Focus Group
Discusion)
Analisis (Teori, Best Practices and
Benchmarking)
Information about Business incubator
Tenant Implementationi of Businnes
Incubator in Sriwijaya state of
Polytechnic and other institution
Concept& theory of business
Incubator
RESEARCH PLOT Primary (Interview)
Secondary (Literatur, Website)
84
York with 1.919,6 metre square. The movement of Incubator Building will do it in
United Nation, Canada, Europe, and Australia. In America, for example. The
Incubator was developing since 1980. The development of incubator more
continuous in developing country in the middle of 1990 years such as in India,
China, Malaysia, Singapore, Philiphines, and others. So get 4000, while of
Incubator in 2000 year as 3.450. the differences of amount because there is a
group between government Incubator (university) and private Incubator that
oriented of profit. A lot of reason that based the build of incubator in general is a
lot of effort was failed when growing up. Not all of people’s have talented to be
enterpreneur and the ecomonic condition more competitive. For new exertion has
tried to increase of skills through training nor intensif controls. So that to
challages the world economic condition that competitive need effort to create new
work field.
In Indonesia, Incubator was developed since 1992 years by goverment
initiative of cooperation Department with college. These effort continuous when
in 1997 will be held enterpreneurship culture developing program in college,
which one of the training is new enterpreneur Incubator (INWUB), then in 1999,
the amount of incubator reach 29. Where a lot of the amount are college. In 2004,
only 56 Incubator unit in all of Indonesia and the majority did by colleges, and
among of them only that active.
Based I Wayan Dipta (2003), some factors that cause of less developing of
Incubator in Indonesia (a) limited of operational facilities provider that make
impact be low to absorb inwall tenants, (b) less of seed capital so Incubator is not
professional yet and many inwall tenant that can not get first capital although his
effort is good enough, (c) commitment and supported by goverment is still
relative and not consistent to develop Incubator.
Definition of Incubation and Incubator
Dr. Laurence Hewick dari Canadian Business Incubator (2006) opinions
:Incubation is “the concept of nurturing qualifying enterpreneurs in managed
work spaces calledIncubatos”.Incubator is “a dedicated workspace (building) to
85
support qualifying businessess with : mentorship, training, professional
networking & assistance in finding finances until they graduate & can survive in
the competitive environment”.Based on Corperation State Minister and UKM No..
81.3/Kep/M.KUKM/VIII/2002 :Incubation is training process for small effort and
the developing new product that did by Business Incubator of to provided
facilities and management supporting and technology.Incubator is an Institution
that move on provided facilities and explore the effort, not only management nor
technology for small effort and develop the service and new product in order to
can growing up be enterpreneur that has capability and new product that could be
competitive in long term.
The Purpoe and Incubator Act
Based on I Wayan Dipta (2003), some of reason that basic to presented
Incubator to be important because in a general a small company is very easy to
bankrupt especially on the start up fase small effort as a baby that still premature.
In this time usual need specific treatment, example through incubation so that can
grow up as baby that normal birth and can not be die risk. Incubation system that
prove it. It can be adopted as a part of treatment strategics for small effort in a lot
of country.Based on the Research Result of Dr. Laurence Hewick from Canadian
Business Incubator (2006), that the build of Incubator as general give a purpose
for :Created new work field,Decreasing of small company failed of 80% to be
20%;Treatment of young in one community;Giving a facilities for
comersialisation and ekspor;Giving facilities a enterpreneurship in economic
transition term;Taking of foreign graduated to applied his knowledge. Based on
Hon. Peter Reith, MP (2000), Incubator designed to helped new effort and
developing so can reach profit with providing information, consulting, services,
and other supported.
As general incubator will be treat by some staf with management that very
efficiency. So the present it could give contribute called services “7S” namely :
space, shared, services, support, skill development, seed capital, and synergy,
Space : incubator that provide a place to developing seed in start up,Shared :
86
incubator that provide office facilities that can use together, example recepcionist,
conference room, telephone system, facsimile, computer, and security.,Service :
spread management consulting and market problem, financial aspek and law,
trade information and investment.Support : incubator help access to Researchers
professional networking, technology, international, and investment.Skill
development : can do through training on Business planning, management, and
other skill.Seed capital : can do through internal fund or with helping small
company access on financial source or financial institution.Synergy : tenant
cooperation or competition between tenant and network with university
institution, Research Institution, Private capital, profesional nor international
international community.
The Kind of Incubator
To getting understanding much more about incubator purpose, some
studies that did by midland Bank (1997), based on studies contain four incubator
type such as:Technopoles Incubator : is a part of complete object that connected
with education institution Research Institution and other organization that has
effort to create of regional economic developing.Sector-specific Incubator : the
purpose to explore local Resources to developing new Business on a sector more
be focus that called claster.General Incubators : oriented to general business
developing, sometime there is a pressure on the innovation.Building Business :
the purpose to create Business with making management team that suitable to
explore Business chance and giving a selection to tenant.Based on owner,
Pricewaterhouse Coopers (1999) classification of incubator to be four category
such as:Standalone : to have and to explore by independent institution that not
function as business unit and skereted of the capital.Embedded : as a part not to
spread of capital wxample : to have and to execute by region developing
institution.Networked : to executed based on formal coorperation with other
incubator, not only owner forming but also through service providing or general
information.Virtual : provide a service that most of them through communication
networking from long term distance.
87
Although did of categories like above, but it is not complex and helping to
understanding of treatment as component in market, at least has five Business
Incubator generic form that developed since 40 years (Campbell et al, 1985) such
as :Industrial Incubators : sponsored by goverment and non profit institution with
a purpose to create new work field, and usual as respond of
unemployment.University-related Incubator : designed to create commerse of
knowledge, technology and intellectual that got at college.For-profit Investment
Incubators : as ways to foundation company venture to have company with their
portofolio. The thing can possibility venture fund of company to create of synergy
on portofolio.For-profit Development Incubators : providing office room and
workshop or production place for rent and other services.Corporate Venture
Incubators : as one of incubator model that grown sooner and successful. Big
company provide fund, facilities and expert and marketing to small or private
company then conversion on stock form.
Based on sponsored that supported. At least five of incubator kind to be
sample to developing an incubators in some country, namely Regional
development Incubator : purpose to developing agribusiness, electricity, and
handcraft in Regional market.Research, University, Technology-based Business
Incubator : the purpose to develop Research Result that did by University, with
provide a service for personal to be enterpreneur that usage of technology to fulfill
the market and other chance.Public-private Patnership, Industrial development
Incubator : the purpose to developing small effort as component vendor and it
service for Big company, this Incubator in general stayed in cities environment or
estate Industry.Foreign Sponsors International Trade and Technology : the
purpose to give facility in small and middle of foreign company to local market
(domestics), this Incubator usuall do collaborate with international, technology,
and financial.Others : example, Incubator that focus on group development
program.
88
Incubation Princip
It contain 2 Business Incubator princip in order to can be effectively,
namely :Business Incubator should give poritive impact to community economic
treatment.Business Incubator is a dynamis model that able to follow term and can
be operate efficiency so getting independent.To getting a successful so in each
founder and Incubator management team should do these things :Do two pincip
how to explore Business Incubator,Have mission and strategic planning and the
purpose in developing community,Able to reach financial independent through
developing and execute the reality Business plan,Recruitment of management
team that high capability and suit it.Build the commitment of founder to reach of
Business Incubator mission and get of maximal management act in successful
Incubator development.First give service to tenant including proactive conculting
and make a sample to reach of successful in Incubator.Developing facilities,
Resources, method and incubator tools to giving service to tenant.Integration of
program and incubator activity to community and give contribute to economic
development widely.Giving supporting stakeholder including build of networking
that helped tenant to make mision and incubator operation.Keep management
information system, submitted of statistics data and information in the evaluation
program, so it will get increase effective of program and able to fix to tenant
necessity.
Incubator Development Category
To successful of developing Business Incubator need 5 category, namely
:Have a rules that stimulus of UMKM and providing infrastructure that need of
UKM, Connected cooperation between government and private in giving controls
and marketing, Have a knowledge that based on learning and Research, Created of
professional networking in local, national and international that funded by
acociation, The active of community to promot of enterpreneurship and culture
changes. Meanwhile for getting successful, Business Incubator need suppored of
89
infrastructure means that divided into two kinds namely soft infrastructure and
hard infrastructure, as scheme could be describe such as :
Pic 2. Infrastucture Business Incubator
90
Component of soft infra-structure it has contain such as Incubator to grow small
exertion that successful, create work field, decrease failed, and commeralisation of R & D.
Goverment: the policy to support capital through proverty right and tax intensif.University:
providing skill person, increase of skill and commealisation an idea.Public Figure: create
positive culture.Bank and Investor: Providing a fund.Global Best Practices: sharing best
practice.
Meanwhile that included of component hard infrastructure is has transportation acces,
media adver-tisement, coorperation networking between stakeholder that developing of focus
on Business Incubators.
Business Incubator Development Steps
One aspect that intreted in incubator is there is no incubator that promote same
service. There is only focus on technology industry where as the other could accommodate
manufacture company in same place. Developing incubator through 3 steps namely the
start up phase, the Business development phase, the maturity phase.
1. The Start up Phase (less than 3 years),First, with inisiatif of commu-nity or pemda to build
incubator as part of whole economic development planning. Making maturity study, Looking
location or place to build incubator and the foundation, Make a building and providing
facilities for rent to tenant, In this steps incubator manager focus on developed incubator, This
step will be the end if incubator was fulfill 60-70% and the rernt cost could close it of
incubator operational.
2. The Business Development Phase (2-3 years), Incubator management more focus on
necessity of tenant, Incubator management developing Business networking for tenant, Start
up to make a synergy among incubator owner.
3. The Maturity Phase, Space demand in Incubator was over with facilities, Tenant has
Business consulting service access as good komprehensif to incubator nor local community
incubator was became the important elemen on society to developing of entrepreneurship,
Build incubator was proven give economic benefit, Company was graduated that give impact
to local workforce., with full of stayed degree incubator was start up to think to expand or
build new incubator, There are some model that need need to get of compare to developing
Business Incubator model, first, model that expand by Lacho (2010), in this time did to
explore of model “Enterpreneurship Education” in New Orleans University (UNO) since two
seasons, the ability that educate especially about how to built networking skill and
negosiation, as real skill that has by employee. Model developing just follow by 20 student’s.
91
the result all of student are able to graduate as good and talented. All of tenant applied
enterpreneurship with make small Business Capital, at campus, network during training
practice. The result, this method more effective and applicable on real situation.Second,
model was developing by Kordnaeij et, al (2011), when Research about “Oigins of
entrepreneurial opportunities in e-Banking” model that develop take which one of model have
already use by Plummer (2007:368 on Kordnaeij, et, al (2011) the describe that developing of
enterpreneurship oppor-tunities, design of enterpreneurship strategics, make a new
opportunities in Business, and eksecute these opportunities in Business exsploitation form
that can be benefit.Third, Ardichvili et. al model. (2003 : 118 in Kordnaeij, et, al. 201: 25).
This model more complicated compare than plummer model, to growing up of enterpreneur
ability need : doing trait namely as treatment will be show of creativity and optimistic,
making social network, with try to solve of weakness, make action set, looking for
partnership, developing self skill as continuously, prepare (entrepreneurial alertness), as core
pocess is build a good perception, finding a good things, do creation and innovation to get a
benefit, when you made it, so development, and evaluation of strength and weakness, to
developing in future formation with take attention to type of opportunity that had.Fourth,
model was developing by Neck, Neck and Mayer (1998 was adapted by Lacho, 2010), is
asking student to watches video (film) to training of some concept about enterpreneurship, so
in student’s has growing up of enterpreneurship mindset, enterpre-neurship mindset is really
important to grow on student’s soul, the whole of idea, feeling, action, spoken, discussion,
daily character, and the whole of activity process always be oriented on Business.The five,
model was developing by Wiedy Murtini (2007) to Research of investigation has titled
“Developing Education” design of enterpreneurship at college with UKM models to get a
model of enterpreneurship learning for playing group, and elementary. The result conclude
that to developing of enterpreneur soul need a time has long term. So that need to introduce,
motivated, and teach directly, namely start up from family, that has pressure about discipline
and independent, introducing of success story of enterpreneur. Will be do it to elementary
student even playing group student.Sixth, model was developing by Alma, (2008 : 138) that
the effort of new enterpreneur could be describe through process and people’s characteristics
that has potential to be rich.The first Research that research about Business Incubator was did
it. All of that has difference original and it has different with this study, for example. The
study did by I Wayan Dipta (2003, in Suwandi dkk, 2008), doing study about Incubator
Development in Indonesia, conclude that (a), the operational facility provider was still
limited. It impact low of ability to take inwall tenants, (b), supporting seed capital to incubator
not to extent as professional, and (c), commitment and goverment support is still relative and
92
not consistent to develop of incubator.The result of Wiedy Murtini (2007) to take of grow
enterpreneur soul, discipline, and independent need longterm, so, it introducing, motivate, and
teach start up nowaday, are in the family, and playing group, teach about success story
enterpreneur, it could be start up from elementary and playing group.Yohson research (2003)
that research about University act to motivate of Bachelor that became young enterpreneur,
take a note that university to motivate of Bachelor to be young enterpreneur are very
important, so it will decrease unemployment data, it could increase of work field. The
treatment can do such as giving of enterpreneurship knowledge with build small Business at
campus location.The research did by Fandi Ahmad (2007), it too difference with this
research, he submitted that desire to be enterpreneur, dare to take risk, and the ability to be
enterpreneur it can influence not only parcial but also simultant to intensity to be
enterpreneur.The research did by Pujiastuti, dkk (2008) assumed that Business Incubator
model that suitable to developing soft skill is with give more practice knowledge compare
with giving a theory.
THE RESULT OF RESEARCH
Model Development Planning
Design plan and developing model did based on (a) theory based (b) emphiris fact in
the field as conceptual nor structural, first, theory to Business Incubator model using SWOT
Analysis, the result of SWOT account show that Polsri Business Incubator has strength that
more dominant compare weakness And opportunity that bigger that threat. With take of
SWOT analysis, Polsri Business Incubator position was stayed on growing up position,
namely use as best as possible to get opportunities outside of Polsri Business Incubator
environment.
Second, conceptual emphiris fact show that the support facility Polsri Business
Incubator is not ready yet, the grown and maturity Business through facilities and non
facilities not be do the best. Structure and infrastructure are still lack, disorder administration,
effort network access and information and fund network or fund in participant’s student at
incubation are still lack.
Where as structural emphiris fact show that Polsri Incubator a integration system
under of college. It stayed has strategic value to apply link concept and match. Beside that,
Polsri Business Incubator is a treatment and enterpreneurship developing as Academic that
constant of follow on human Resource developing Based on Academic Concept, the result to
93
Supported Suwandi research (2008) that evaluate Business Incubator model’s that developed
by State University in Indonesia, that assumed that all of college to make a rules of model that
will be using in the first, to model plan’s, so, model developing executed could be best.
Design Process and Model Development
Design process and Business Incubator model developing in Polsri, can summary such
as : (a) First Step, do first study to Business Incubator pramodel developing that has library
study or literature, and field survey. Based on two things will be SWOT Analysis and
emphiris Analysis as conceptual nor structural. First step get Business Incubator Pramodel (b)
second step, will be model developing, that has pramodel validation steps that was by
researcher or expert and Business Incubator model testimony, not only limited scale nor
widely scale. Based on steps it will be good Business Incubator as theory and emphiris (c)
third steps, do test it of model with compare among model that test on limted scup. And
model that test with large scup, so created the end model of Polsri Business Incubator (d)
fourth steps, model implementation so will get output and outcome.
Steps of model developing above, it based on Business Incubator developing steps that
was expand by first expert like Buchory Alma (2008) and Ardichvili et.al (2003).
Business Incubator Model that Developed
Polsri Business Incubator model that oriented of innovation and training on Business
incubator at traditional food (cuisine) specially Palembang and convection, explore it of
Rubber Seed, (tree in one), handycraft that purpose to grow of enterpreneurship competency it
can explaned it.Model Basic Princip, as a system of trained model that continuously, means
that training participant not only success trained but also the participant will be young
enterpreneur and competitive.Model Characteristic contain (a) Business Incubator training as
program unit of learning for student, (b) as form of Polsri Business Incubator taining that
build based on opportunity and resource potency that has by Polsri, (c) Business Incubator
training do as student desire, do in Business Incubator location, (d) this model need of
treatment, controlling, and Business harmony and new Business and (e) press the valve of
honesty, perseverance, and speed to take a good chance, able to take risk analysis and dare o
try to be part of unite on Business Developing. Model componen contain (a) insert input (b)
Business Incubator process that contain theory and training (c) output (d) outcome (e)
monitoring, evaluation and action. For more clear can lok at this model.
94
Operational procedure of Polsri Business Incubator training spread (a) net to raw input
namely student that have graduated or success on Enterpreneur Student’s Program (PMW)
and alumni (b) after get row input, they are giving of Business Incubator training as
interaction of Business Incubator participant, facility and learning resource to tear of
knowledge skill and enterpreneurship competency (c) after skill theory training was done,
they are making a group on developing unit and innovation at Polsri Business Incubator
(Cuisine, Convection, Agribusiness, Handycraft), (d) next, Business Incubator get output is
knowledge increase, attitude, skill and participant’s activity that active in Business Incubator
activity, as enterpreneurship core competency, Preseverance, Successful, Coorpera-tion and
Practising of training Result (e) in finally step, it got outcome namely Bachelor/alumni as new
professional enterpreneur, globally view, innovative and independent, able to created of good
opportunity suit as Result (f). to make of Business Incubation process will be do monitoring,
evaluation, and action as controls tool to successful of Business Incubator process and repair
treatment and Business Inovation as downing of Polsri Business Incubator.
The result of research supported of model that developed by Lacho (2010), Kordnaeij,
et.al (2011), Ardichvill et.al (2003), Neck, Neck, and Mayer (1998 on Lacho, 2010).
SUMMARY AND SUGGESTION
Summary
Based on testimony of model, data analysis, and explanation, the summary of
developing Research of Result at Business Incubator model developing oriented on
innovation could be formulate as :Design planning and model developing will be do based on
(a) theory based and (b) emphiris fact in field as conceptual nor structural, theory of Business
Incubator model using SWOT Analysis, the result of SWOT account show that Polsri
Business Incubator show at grow up position namely use as best as possible of strength to get
a good chance that provided at Polsri Businness Incubator Environment. Design process and
Business Incubator model at state Polytehnic of Sriwijaya can get of point, first, do the first
study cases. Second do of model development, third, try test of model with compare it
between limited scup model and wide scup model, so it will create the end of Polsri Business
Incubator fourth, model implement-tation so it will get output and outcome.Polsri Business
Incubator model that innovation oriented, as a system of training modelthst continuously,
means that participant’s not only graduated but also ready to be young enterpreneur and
competitive. Model component contain (a) insert input (b) Business Incubator Process that
95
contain of theory and training (c) output (d) outcome (e) monitoring, evaluation and more
action.Polsri Business Incubator model oriented on innovation of experiment group it can
called effective. Learning effective can look at, get the purpose of learning as purpose priority
that take of Incu-bation participant with Incubator Development, has a learning nessecity of
Incubation Participant, and get positive impact to increasing of know-ledge, attitude,
behavior, and skill that very good to supporting of increasing enterpreneurship Competency.
Suggestion
Goverment should have political will for executed Business Incubator at college, so, supposed
all of graduated to be enterpreneur, and not to be employee of the goverment nor private.Need
collaborative action and supporting of goverment to research and to apply of community
service in Business Incubator program development at college, because of benefit to
community.Business Incubator model at college need to research of multy discipline cases,
multy model, and paradigm multy, as invention of knowledge to contribute of knowledge to
stronger.
REFERENCE
Alberti, Fernando; Salvatore Sciascia, dan Alberto Poli, 2004, Entrepreneurship Education:
Notes on and Ongoing Debate, 14th
Annual int. Ent. Conference, University of Napoli
Federico II (Italy).
Alma, Buchari. 2003. Kewirausahaan. Bandung: Alfabeta.
Ardichvili, Alexander; Richard Cardozo, dan Sourav Ray, 2003: A theory of Entrepreneurial
opportunity identification and development, Journal of Business Venturing, Vol. 18 pp.
105—123.
Badan Pusat Statistik, 2010, Hasil Susenas, Jakarta: BPS
Brouwer, Maria T., 2002 Weber, Schumpeter, and Knight on Entrepreneurship and Economic
Development, Journal of Evolutionary economics, Springer, Verlag, Vol. 12, 2002, pp
83—105.
Dikti, Depdiknas, 2008, Materi TOT Soft Skill, Hotel Pangrangon Bogor tanggal 28-30
November 2006
Disman, 2004, Efektivitas Pendidikan Ekonomi dalam Pembentukan Nilai-nilai Perilaku
Ekonomi (Studi tentang Faktor-faktor yang Mempengaruhi Efektivitas Pembelajaran
Ekonomi dan Implikasinya terhadap Nilai-nilai Perilaku Ekonomi Berdasarkan Asas
96
Kekeluargaan pada Siswa SMA Negeri di Kota Bandung), Disertasi, Bandung: PPs
Univeristas Pendidikan Indonesia
Pujiastuti, Eny Endah, dkk. (2008). Perpaduan antara Teori dengan Praktek pada Model
Inkubator Bisnis. .
Kordnaeij, et.al., 2011, origins of entrepreneurial Opportunities in e-Banking, Journal of
Global Entrepreneurship Research, Winter & Spring, 2011, Vol.1 No. 1 pp 21-33
Kuratko, Donald F. 2004, Entrepreneurship Education in the 21st Century: from
Legitimization to Leadership, A Coleman Foundation White Paper USASBE National
Conference,.
Lacho, Kenneth, 2010, Entrepreneurship Education: Another Approach, Small Business
Institute Journal, Vol. 5. April 2010 pp 67—82.
Naughton, Michael dan Jeffry Cornwall, 2009, Culture as the Basis of The Good
Entrepreneur, Journal of Religion and Business Ethics, Vol. 1, Issue I, article 2.
Powers, Joshua B dan Patricia P. McDougall, 2005, University Start-up Information and
Technology Licensing with Firms that Go Public: a Resource-Based View of Academic
Entrepreneurship, Journal of Business Venturing No 20 (2005), pp. 291—311.
Setiti, Sri, 2013, Pengembangan Sikap Kemandirian Melalui Pendidikan Kewirausahaan:
Studi pada Mahasiswa Program Studi Pendidikan Ekonomi FKIP UNLAM Banjarmasin,
Disertasi, Bandung: PPS, UPI Bandung
Stevenson, Howard H, 2000, Why entrepreneurship has won!, Coleman White paper,
USASBE Plenary Address, February 17.
Suwandi, dkk. 2008, Pengembangan Model Inkubator Bisnis Perguruan Tinggi, Laporan
Hasil Penelitian, Jakarta: Balibang Depdiknas
Welsch, P Harold, 1993, Entrepreneurship Education and Training Infrastructure: External
Intervention in the Classroom, Paper Presented at the Conference Internationalizing
Entrepreneur-ship Education and Training, Vienna Australia, July 5-7..
Winslow, Erik K; George T. Solomon; dan Ayman Tarabishy, 1997, Empirical Investigation
into Entrepreneurship Education in the United State: Some Results of the 1979 National
Survey of Entrepreneurial Education, Paper Discusses National Survey of
entrepreneurship Education.
Yohnson, (2003). Peranan Universitas dalam Memotivasi Sarjana Menjadi Young
Entrepreneur. Jurnal manajemen & Kewirausahaan. Vol 5 no 2 September (2003).
Surabaya: Universitas Kristen Petra.
97
Yulina, Bainil (2012). Pengaruh Karakteristik Wirausaha dan Sikap Wirausaha Terhadap
Perilaku Kewirausahaan ( Studi pada Mahasiswa Wirausaha Politeknik Negeri
Sriwjaya ), Thesis, Palembang, PPS Universitas Sriwijaya.
98
THE APPLICATION OF GREEN BEHAVIOR:
‘GO GREEN’ FOR CAMPUS THROUGH PLASTIC WASTE MANAGEMENT
FOR UNIVERSITY IN SOUTH KALIMANTAN REGION
Hastin Umi Anisah,
Faculty of Busines and Economics - Lambung Mangkurat University,
Banjarmasin, South Kalimantan
hastin_umi@yahoo.com
Wimby Wandary,
Faculty of Busines and Economics - Lambung Mangkurat University,
Banjarmasin, South Kalimantan
Tinik Sugiati
Faculty of Busines and Economics - Lambung Mangkurat University,
Banjarmasin, South Kalimantan
ABSTRACT
This study aims to shift students and staff behavior to behave green on managing plastic waste by
describing the current condition of the university’s waste management approaches. For university in
South Kalimantan region, shifting the conventional plastic waste management to the greener behavior
is a bit difficult. The future expectation is that the movement of “Kampus Peduli Sampah” inspires the
university level to complete it waste management.
The research is approach by the qualitative method of phenomenology. Top down and bottom up
approaches are being employed to obtain necessary information and support. Its key informant
provide required information about the faculty how they manage their waste, and rector support as
the top down approaches is benefited the research agenda to gain institutional approval.
Research finding shows that in general, almost all of the faculties within university are not yet
behaviorally green in their waste management. It requires significant effort to provide the waste
management necessary attention for campus within region. The basic knowledge equipped with
sufficient consciousness about sustainable environment within campus area is expected as the small
step to achieve its vision. The knowledge about the different kind of waste is already there, but the
enforcement to act is still requires encouragement.
Keywords: Green Behavior, Green Campus, plastic waste, movement.
INTRODUCTION
University is one of the largest waste contributors for its city (Satrian, 2009). Its routine activities
resulted in many forms of waste, whether it is organic waste or inorganic. Even if it is not purely
produce within university itself, external sources are also providing waste for within university when
they are consumed inside the campus area because campus plays as the second home for its members.
This is a problem when rubbish is piled up. Universities’ piled up rubbish represents the conventional
paradigm of waste management, which is usually not yet environmental friendly. Pilling up rubbish
mostly ended up with open combustion which produces smoke that is harmful health. For a certain
area, smoke are uninviteably on dry season because of the natural combustion.
The idea to provide society with a green campus is one of the government movements supporting
agenda to the Gerakan Indonesia Bersih. The movement promoted by the Indonesia’s Ministry of
Environment since university is constitute as the higher level education institution, they are obligates
99
to be the role model for society to socially move the community on levering their environmental
concern. In practice, one of the necessities lies on the potential increase of plastic waste when the
government opens the regional trading to import plastics based products in many forms, such as toys,
house hold products, accessories, automotive products, etc with the largest exporter from China for
toys in 2013. Communities’ ability to produce plastic based waste is aligning with growing up
demographic. Meanwhile, the ability to absorb waste is in the reversal situation. The establishment
and promoting Bank Sampah (Bank for Garbage) by the government is not yet hand over the expected
result. The bank is not yet popular in driving community joint them as their client even they are the
productive plastic waste producers. Under such circumstances, it requires an effective paradigm
transformation in waste management by approaching the higher education level to perform social
engineering activities. Exploring the potential of universities in waste management clarifies its role as
the support system and contributor for the potential establishment and maintenance of future Bank for
Garbage or in the cooperation format within university areas. In terms to bring Green Campus into
reality today is refer to the UIGreenMetric, which provide us with indicators to be a green university.
These made up the movement a framework or parameters to fulfill the green university criteria. And
for the university that is not yet green, UIGreenMetric set aside the basis to increase its quality to be
greener.
Research Objective
Promoting a green campus for Universitas Lambung Mangkurat is under assumption that a university
is one of the largest waste contributors for its city and it plays a significant role to be model for
society. The research objective is to shift academicians’ behavior to be green on plastic waste
management in bringing green campus into reality.
LITERATURE REVIEW
Green Behavior
Green behavior is the environmental – people – and economy friendly behavior, referring to the green
economy concept. According to More, the development of green behavior begin in 1979 in the field of
architecture namely environment behavior (Snyder & AJ, 1979). By the moment it develop into
general terms became pro-environmental or as we know today as green behavior. Steg and Vlek define
Pro-environmental or green behavior is behavior that
minimizes harm to the environment as much as possible, or even benefits it (Commission, 2012). Its
implementation requires shifting people’s behavior. To be behaviorally green, conventional paradigm
must step aside for the green concept. Changing takes place when there are alterations on relevant
behavior, in this term is shifting the conventional behavior towards green behavior.
Managing Change
Managing change through transitional change requires a significant respond to external forces to be
succeeded, which begin when problem are being recognized or chances are to be achieved or
betterments are required in daily operations or even invented to fulfill the future demand. According to
Champy, the necessity for effective change lies on its perspective that reengineering as the
fundamental rethinking and radical redesign of the [business] processes to achieve dramatic
improvements in critical temporary measures performance such as cost, service, quality, and speed
(Abdous & He, 2008). These are necessary because there is moment that people are driven not only by
inner forces, but driven by external forces, align with Bandura’s Social Cognitive and Learning
Theory (Nabavi, 2011). People respond to the stimulant which their environment provides them with.
In this case, the top down approaches in changing behavior is considered to be more effective.
PREVIOUS STUDY
100
Past study about influential motives that influences pro-environmental behavior in form of
participation in green electricity program by integrating the psychology and economics perspectives
for analysis. They found that there are specific motives for participating as internal and external
motives to join the program; they are motives relating to several concerns: ecosystem health, personal
health, environmental quality for residents in southeastern Michigan, global warming, and warm-glow
(or intrinsic) satisfaction. Based on its importance, a statistical ranking of each motive, a found that
biocentric motive ranks first, an altruistic motive ranks second, and an egoistic motive ranks third
(Clark, Kotchen, & Moore, 2003). But, incorporating behavioral principles within existent
organizational models shown effective in altering the behaviors of hundreds of millions of people by
the perfect suitable media that suited today’s interest on practical level (Alavosius & Newsome, 2012).
They considers the cooperative movement by using current communication technologies, social
media, and emerging understanding of interlocked contingencies and verbal networks to address
solutions to global climate through behavioral change. A life cycle assessment of a self-report measure
about ecological behavior and environmental consequences they contrast a behavior’s environmental
consequences with the comparable effect of a reasonable alternative, by means of applying data from
available Life Cycle Assessment, literature and databases. Significant result found that somehow
ecological behavior turned out to be less environmentally effective (Kaiser, Doka, Hofstetter, &
Ranney, 2003).
METHODOLOGY
Key Informant
Key informant provides information about their waste management implementation on faculty. They
are person who are being considered possessing the authority to observed and experiencing the
strategic level of management which comprehensively overview about it.
The university comprises of 10 faculties. Each faculty represent by 1 authority as key informant who
provide information under semi structured interview. Among those 10 faculties, there is 1 faculty that
is abstain to respond under specific circumstances which statement was did not know whether there is
waste management activities. The cleaning activities which produce faculty’s waste considered as
regular agenda without having to know how it is being carry out. This left us with 9 key informants
whom respond are being used to represent the university waste management in general.
Instrument
Question manuals are being distributed to provide the key informant a brief description about subject
matter they will respond. The instrument adapted from GreenMetric - UI World University Ranking
2015 Indicators on Waste. Briefly explain within that waste treatment and recycling activities are
major factors in creating a sustainable environment. University’s staff and students activities in
campus will produce a lot of waste, therefore some programs and waste treatments should be among
the concern of the university, i.e. recycling program, toxic waste recycling, organic waste treatment,
inorganic waste treatment, sewerage disposal, policy to reduce the use of paper and plastic in campus
(Indonesia, 2015). Each respond independently describes the criteria we seek about. 6 Waste criteria in
the GreenMetric UI questionnaire for the faculties were:
Criteria 1: Recycling program for faculty waste. To detect the current condition of the faculty policy
lead effort to encourage staff and students to recycle waste, key informant has been asked to choose
among: None, Partial, or Extensive.
Criteria 2: the handled of toxic waste. In finding out the faculty condition which reflects how they
handling toxic waste under a certain processes, the process itself includes if toxic wastes are dealt
separately, i.e by classifying and handling it over to third party or certified handling companies, key
informant has been ask to choose among: Not Managed; Partly contained and inventoried; or
Completely contained inventoried and handled.
101
Criteria 3: the organic waste treatment. To seek for information about the method of organic waste
treatment within faculty which describes the faculty overall treatment of the bulk of its organic waste,
key informant has been ask to choose among: Open dumping; partly composted; partly composted and
the compost are dumped; or fully composted and the compost are used.
Criteria 4: the inorganic waste treatment. To find out the method of inorganic waste treatment in the
faculty in term to decribe the overall trearment of the bulk inorganic waste. Key informant being asked
to choose among: Burned in open; Taken off campus to a dump site; Partially recycled; or Fully
recycled.
Criteria 5: sewerage disposal. To describe the primary method of how the faculty’s treat their bulk of
sewerage disposal, key informant has been asked to choose among: Disposed untreated to waterways;
Treated individually in septic tank; Centralized treatment before disposal; or treatment for reuse.
Criteria 6: the policy to reduce the use of paper and plastic in campus. To figure out about the current
condition of the faculty in providing formal policy to reduce the use of paper and plastic, key
informant has been asked to choose among: No policy; Policy in preparation; Policy in initial
implementation; Policy implemented with some problem; or Policy in full implementation.
Analysis
There are faculties under university management which their representation informs us about the
university waste management. The 10 faculties of the university are listed as follow:
Table 1. List of Faculties
Code Faculty Name
1 Teaching and Educational Sciences
2 Laws
3 Social Science and Politics
4 Medical
5 Forestry
6 Fishery and Naval
7 Technical
8 Math and Natural Sciences
9 Eeconomics and Business
10 Agriculture
Source: primary data processed 2015.
Among 10 faculties, there is one faculty (Code: 9) which explicitly state that they are abstains to
respond the subject matter in the research instrument. The key instrument claimed that he did not have
any idea about the waste management for his faculty. The, the rest 9 faculty is being considered
qualified to describe for waste management practices in the university.
Criteria 1 - the existence of recycling program for faculty waste probing resulted in the information
that there is/ are not recycling program in most of the faculty, 7 from 10 faculties claimed it.
Table 2. Recycling Program for Faculty Waste
Code Responds
1 None
2 Abstain
3 None
4 None
5 None
6 Partial
7 Partial
8 None
102
9 None
10 None
Source: primary data processed 2015.
There are only 2 faculty claimed that there are only partial in carrying out the recycling program, and
1 faculty is abstaining to respond. In general, it can be said that in the university is not yet provide the
staff and student with a/ some program that promote the recycling activities recently. The ‘partly’
statement by some faculty reflect their day today activities in reuse principle for printing paper waste
only, by using the empty-backside of the paper for distributing informal notification. Even so, this is
still doing it under individual awareness agenda, not yet institutional. There are not yet plastic
recycling program.
Criteria 2 – the handling process for toxic waste probing resulted in the information that not every
faculty is producing toxic waste. Its capability to produce toxic waste is relevant to its field of study. 3
faculty claims that they are not producing toxic waste so they will be excluded for consideration, and 1
abstain faculty. The rest of the 6 faculties are being considered as producing toxic waste from their
laboratory activities. 5 of them, which become 83.33% of the faculties, are not managing their toxic
waste. Only 1 faculty, which makes 16.67%, claimed that they are producing toxic waste partly and it
is inventoried. It only does the inventories, the administrative management only, not completely
managing it.
Table 3. Toxic Waste Handling
Code Responds
1 Not producing
2 Abstain
3 Not producing
4 Not Managed
5 Not Managed
6 Not Managed
7 Not Managed
8 Not Managed
9 Not producing
10 Partly contained and inventoried
Source: primary data processed 2015
Managing toxic waste requires in involvement of the third party. It can be assumed that there are
motives that base the decision for not managing their toxic waste properly, such as: it is in the very
low level so it will not harmful enough to the environment. Under such circumstances, the
conventional disposal being considered is still includes as the safe action to dispose toxic waste.
Criteria 3 - the organic waste treatment probing resulted in the information the most of the faculty treat
their bulk organic waste by open dumping. Among 9 respond, 7 of them acknowledge that they are
open dumped their organic waste.
Table 4. Organic Waste Treatment
Code Responds
1 Open dumping
2 Abstain
3 Open dumping
4 Open dumping
5 Open dumping
6 Open dumping
103
7 Open dumping
8 Open dumping
9 Open dumping
10 Open dumping and
Partly composted and the compost are dumped
Source: primary data processed 2015
There is 1 faculty does the composted partly before it dumped. The partly composted by the faculty
Code 9 have used to supply their business unit in fruit seed supplier.
Criteria 4 - the inorganic waste treatment probing resulted in the information that they are tend to
burned it open or taken off campus to a dump site instead of recycled it.
Table 5. Inorganic Waste Treatment
Code Responds
1 Taken off campus to a dump site
2 Abstain
3 Taken off campus to a dump site
4 Taken off campus to a dump site
5 Burned in open
6 Burned in open
7 Burned in open
8 Taken off campus to a dump site
9 Burned in open
10 Burned in open
Taken off campus to a dump site
Source: primary data processed 2015
Open dumping has been choosing easily by the faculty since it is the easiest way to do. They piled up
the inorganic waste at open space which they are usually to use as pilling up area. The large size
inorganic waste tends to be taken to the dump site off the campus, in cooperation with the local
government agencies.
Criteria 5 - sewerage disposal probing resulted in the information that they are tend not to treat their
liquid waste completely. Among other, there only 1 faculty that does the Centralized treatment before
disposal, 2 of them choose that are none, 1 abstain, 3 of them treat it individually in septic tank, 1 of
the faculty does both the individually septic tank treatment and disposed untreated to waterways, and
the rest 2 of them purely disposed it untreated to waterways.
Table 6. Sewerage Disposal
Code Responds
1 None
2 Abstain
3 None
4 Centralized treatment before disposal
5 Treated individually in septic tank
6 Disposed untreated to waterways
7 Disposed untreated to waterways
8 Treated individually in septic tank
9 Treated individually in septic tank
10 Disposed untreated to waterways
Treated individually in septic tank
Source: primary data processed 2015
104
These situations depicts that there are not yet faculty that treat their sewerage disposal to reuse. It still
a common believe among staffs and students that used water and treatment water are not for reuse.
Criteria 6 - the policy to reduce the use of paper and plastic in campus probing resulted in the
information that some of the faculty that there are no policies and some of them are preparing the
policy to reduce the use of plastics and paper.
Table 7. The policy to reduce the use of paper and plastic in campus
Code Responds
1 No policy
2 Abstain
3 Policy in preparation
4 No policy
5 Policy in preparation
6 Policy in preparation
7 Policy in preparation
8 Policy in preparation
9 Policy in preparation
10 No policy
Source: primary data processed 2015
There are growing concerns among faculties to reduce the use paper and plastics, which shows by
their preparing the policy. Most of them are waiting for the university level policy to be cascade at the
faculty level.
DISCUSSION AND CONCLUSION
Basically, this study aims to shift students and staff behavior to behave green on waste management,
specially in managing plastic waste. Acquired information conveys the faculties condition for the
- Most of the faculties (7 of 9) stated that there were no recycling programs that lead
their students and staffs to recycle the faculty’s waste.
- Some of the faculties (3 of 9) were not producing toxic waste from their academic and
administrative activities. The rest of 6 faculties considered as toxic waste producers
and most of them did not managed their toxic waste, including the faculty which claim
that some of their activities were partly produced toxic waste but only inventoried it.
- Every faculties were only open dumped their organic waste, and there is only 1 faculty
that previously composted it partly before dumped it.
- Faculties maintains their inorganic waste by simply took it off to the dump site and
burned it open in general. There were no recycling programs or activities at all.
- Sewerage disposal treatment shows that most of faculties did not treat it to reuse. They
were only treated it individually in septic tank, disposed it to untreated waterways,
only 1 faculty claimed that they did centralized treatment before disposal. Moreover
there are faculties claimed that they were not treated it at all.
- There were not yet policy to reduce and reuse paper and plastic in campus. Some of
them claimed that the policy is under preparation meanwhile the rest of the faculty
stated that there were no policies yet.
Under such circumstances, there were still strong tendencies for the faculty did not promote the
recycling activities among staffs and student by providing recycling program for faculty’s waste; the
toxic waste producers faculty were not manage their toxic waste; they choose to simply open dumped
their organic waste rather than composted and using it; they tend not to recycle their inorganic waste
by simply throwing it to the dump site rather than recycle it, and the worse is the burn open activities.
105
Afterwards, there were no treatment for sewerage disposal to reuse, they tend to dispose it even it is
already treated. And the last one is that there were no policies to reduce and reuse paper and plastic in
campus. In their practice, some of the faculties reuse their backside printed paper – a non processing
reuse program – under individual concerns and none at all for their plastic waste. These tendencies
show a very low level of green behavior activities because in general it describes the very less concern
of the university to their waste. They had showed very few evident of good waste management to be
considered as green campus.
IMPLICATION FOR UNIVERSITIES
This study reveals several facts on field provided by each faculty’s key informant about their waste
management that now should be the university concern since the growing international demand for
pro-environment behavior namely green behavior for university level. Since 2010, the awareness of
the green behavior was shape into international concern by the university’s green metric promoted by
University of Indonesia. Universities around the world are racing to fulfill the criteria to be green
campus. They were all recognize the today necessities of being green, which this should be also the
Lambung Mangkurat University concern if the university eager to achieve its vision as to be the well-
known and highly competitive university in 2025.
The shifting global environment paradigm leads to the new criteria to be well known and highly
competitive institution, especially for the higher level education. The spreading basic consideration
that brings in the green concept into its operational definition into higher education institution is taking
sustainability efforts into account. It takes more than Webometrics to measure its competitiveness, but
also the today’s Greenmetrics is matter. The Waste (W) management criteria is only one 6
Greenmetrics category in weighting its sustainability. Being green, it taking accounts several
categories of: Setting and Infrastructure (SI), Energy and Climate Change (EC), Water (WR),
Transportation (TR), and Education (ED) to be prominent. Waste management which becomes the
heading of this research considered as the initial step to achieve its vision. Focusing on waste
management is overcome one of the big issue in the city the university resides, which started with the
movement called: Gerakan Kampus Peduli Sampah. This movement meant to provoke faculties to
take the step to behaviorally green in their waste management, not to carrying it out. We seek the
faculty consciousness to join the green activities from their nearest environment. It is important to
know that the university is not yet green, so it will bring betterment in the future.
LIMITATION OF THE STUDY
The limitations of the study lies on it focus which is still on only one categories of the Greenmetric to
describe, the waste management only. There is also on field failure that one of the key respondents
chooses to abstain to respond. So, the proper and effective approach needs more consideration.
Bibliography
Abdous, M., & He, W. (2008, October 10). A Framework for Process Reengineering in
Higher Education: A Case Study of Distance Learning Exam Schedulling and Distribution.
Retrieved April 29, 2014, from www.irrodl.org:
http://www.irrodl.org/index.php/irrodl/rt/printerFriendly/535/1138
Alavosius, M. P., & Newsome, W. D. (2012). Cooperatives, Green Behavior, and
Environmental Protection. Revista Latinoamericana de Psicología , 77-85.
106
Clark, C. F., Kotchen, J. M., & Moore, M. R. (2003). Internal and external influences on pro-
environmental behavior: Participation in a green electricity program. Journal of
Environemntal psychology , 237-246.
Commission, E. (2012, October). Official website of European Commision. Retrieved January
13, 2013, from www.ec.europa.eu:
http://ec.europa.eu/environment/integration/research/newsalert/pdf/FB4.pdf
Indonesia, U. o. (2015, August 24). UI Greenmetric World University Ranking. Retrieved
August 24, 2015, from Greenmetric.ui.ac.id: Greenmetric.ui.ac.id,. (2015). Retrieved 24
August 2015, from http://greenmetric.ui.ac.id/wp-
content/uploads/2015/07/UI_Greenmetric_Guideline_2015.pdf
Kaiser, F. G., Doka, G., Hofstetter, P., & Ranney, M. A. (2003). Ecological behavior and its
environmental consequences: a life cycle assessment of a self-report measure. Journal of
Environmental Psychology , 11-20.
Nabavi, R. T. (2011). Bandura's Social Learning Theory & Social Cognotive Theory.
Retrieved January 13, 2013, from www.reserachgate.net:
http://www.researchgate.net/profile/Razieh_Tadayon_Nabavi/publication/267750204_Bandur
a%27s_Social_Learning_Theory__Social_Cognitive_Learning_Theory/links/545914d90cf26
d5090ad007b.pdf?inViewer=true&disableCoverPage=true&origin=publication_detail
Satrian, A. (2009, June 4). Peran Universitas dalam Pengelolaan Sampah. Retrieved January
13, 2014, from www.detik.com:
http://news.detik.com/read/2009/06/04/102154/1142480/471/peran-universitas-dalam-
pengelolaan-sampah
Snyder, J., & AJ, C. (1979). Introduction to Architecture. New York: McGraw-Hill.
107
ETHICS AS THE BASIS FOR INCREASING ROLE OF HUMAN
RESOURCE MANAGEMENT STRATEGIES IN THE PUBLIC
SERVICE
Yulia Hambo
Lecturer FKIP UNSRI PALEMBANG
Yuliahambo1@gmail.com
Gita Amalia
Dosen Ekonomi PGRI Palembang
Vazandrofirdausinuzula@yahoo.co.id
ABSTRACT
Ethics are standards and rules that are intended to guide the principle of any institution such
as public, private and government that focuses on the challenges and opportunities associated
with the domain integrates macro and macro strategic human resources (HR) and
management literature to identify executive level HR and HR managers operation. This is
caused by the constant changes that affect individual companies also need a higher, more
complex than the year eighties. The proposed system for subsequent ie searching and tracing
files and other documents, gratuities for service make, Deception deliberate, Sales
Information or Espionage, Unlawful Conduct. All this comes under the umbrella of
corruption and discipline. The paper recommended some solutions that may improve ethical
standards in public service. Index Terms-Ethical issues, standards and rules, public service
sector. With the implementation of the recommendations and some solutions ethical standards
in public service, the role of the HR strategist imanajemen in public service are required
dapatmeningkat.
Keywords: Ethics, Strategic Human Resource Management, HR Executive Challenges, Issues
Operational HRM.
INTRODUCTION
In the words of Appleby [1952: 7]. [4] He argued that "Moral performance begins at -
discipline individual on the part of officials, which involves all that is meant by the word"
character ".But this is not enough. Performance moral which also requires a systematic
process that supports individual assessment groups enriched by the contributions of people
with various fittings concerned and differentiation in responsibilities to one another and the
responsibility of society as a whole. The official, individually and organizationally, should be
considered to be beyond the simple honesty to the trust faithful continuity reality of ethical
108
behavior and the environment. Ethics are standards and rules that are intended to guide the
principle of any institution such as public institutions. Sources role Human development
(HRD) in the age of globalization means important changes in the life of the company and the
employees, because the diversification constantly changing environment, consumer society,
fast procedure, adoption constant changes, decreased reaction time, flexibility; human factors
come to the fore, compared with the input .At present, permanent competitiveness is the key
to survival. Human resources strategy should be perdebadaan center of how companies
achieve competitive advantage, because man is an asset and an actual argument quite
encouraging. Judging from the HR function remains among the most influential in most
organizations and competitive strategies that are not usually based on the skills, abilities and
behaviors of employees. Delery JE (1998) noted di eksekutif the past have usually tried to
take the human out of the equation strategies.
Despite this, a large number of companies still think that the cost-effectiveness,
compliance with financial goals or dominance of other factors that are essential to achieve
competitiveness. But, without a skilled, motivated and creative employees, the main objective
can not be realized without the human factor. That is why human resource management
becomes more important to be adopted. Of personnel administration, through personnel
management, human resources management, management of human strategisumber, its role
continues to increase. Strategic interests are the focus in the eighties, through competence,
permanent learning and reform, then. Especially issues of concern including the former
attuning the HR policy with the organization's strategy, manage resources manusiadalam
international context, dealing with mergers and acquisitions, and downsizing. The
penelitibaru just started exsplore critical problems, and much remains to be done. Everyday
problems more attention HR practitioners operating level includes the selection, training,
compensasion, and performance assessment. These topics have been much more thoroughly
researched, thought exixting not applied knowledge as possible.
Viewed from a significant gap between the micro and macro levels and teorianalisis
obviously a lot in the area of science organization. While the increased level of specialization
that is often associated with the growth of the discipline and maturity, the consequences of
this trend can be unfortunate, as the answers to important questions in business increasingly
global and complex context will require scholars to draw strength from both perspectives.
These gaps are very clear in our own field of research, strategic human resources (HR)
management. HR strategy literature has seen tremendous growth over the last two decades,
which is generating considerable interest among both practitioners and academics (Becker &
Huselid, 2006). More specifically, the literature found that the performance of the company is
enhanced when a company may adopt (a) recruiting and selection system consistent with a
competitive strategy, (b) reward system that reflects the implementation of a successful
strategy in assessing the performance and compensation of employees, and (c) training and
Strategy development is guided by a system of performance management and business
purposes (Becker & Huselid, 1998).
ETHICAL AND MORAL KOMPANYE
109
A. The Moral Ethics campaign
Help in formalizing a massive propaganda campaign and calling behavior and the
practice of moral values among public sector discipline. This is the evangelical moral what is
currently in place. The disease is deadly decadence should be addressed in public
organizations, the private sector and government. Dangers inherent in the act of unethical
behavior should be emphasized.
1.) Reward ethical behavior unusual.
In situations or instances when someone displays extraordinary measures of
behavioral disciplines such behavior should be rewarded in status, in cash and kind.
2) the Enlightenment.
Education major, training and development in schools, colleges and universities.
Ethics should be made compulsory cuts in all disciplines. As we all know, education is the
foundation of all development of any society, education kill cancer disease, ignorance,
superstition, poverty and fear.
3.) Revival of cultural excellence
Values, Ethics and Culture must be restored, for example; Africa has a strong culture
of excellence that modernization and civilization have been robbed of their social structure.
4.) Professional codes of conduct
To restore sanity and getting to and get the honor of the outside world and potential
foreign investors, private organizations, communities and governments need to fashion out a
code of conduct. It should be noted that professional bodies, such as medicine, engineering,
law, etc. a code of conduct. Serious problems require serious solutions.
5.) religiosity
This is the application of the doctrine enshrined in a particular religion as the only
framework allowed for determination of right and wrong.
B. Corporate Strategy dan Strategy of Human Resource Management (SHRM)
1. Paradigm change: from traditional HRM to strategiHRM
a.) In the Personnel Administration (PA), this function is limited to only
administrative tasks, which means the current labor affairs ini.b.) Then the place was given to
the Personnel Management (PM), when the activity of human resources become independent
and labor affairs labor and personnel functions dibagi.c.) The novelty of Human Resources
Management (HRM). Novelties tersebutadalah that labor force is not regarded as the only cost
factor, but an important part of the value creation process of the company. So therefore, we
can talk about an integrated system approach and there is high compared to the development
of Personnel Management that appear in the organization as an independent unit, division or
profit center. d.) Then, in the eighties, StrategiManajemen Human Resources (SHRM)
110
appears, and even exceed the functional role, and the emphasis is on the contribution of
competitiveness and the creation of a joint strategy.
2. The definition of SHRM, and the properties of its strategic
a.) According to Milkovich - Boudreau (1988), the company's approach to employees
that means the relationship is consistent with the conditions of organization and strategy. b.)
Fischer and his co-authors (1996) analyze the differences between HRM and SHRM from the
point of view of information, administrative, functional and change management roles; they
formulated the important differences between traditional and strategic HRM.
I think, strategimanajemen human resources is an integral part of our corporate
strategy; participate in the realization of the objectives of the company integrated way and
framing in the long-term competitiveness through added value, building on the potential of
human resources.
SHRM models Bakacsi (2006) shows the strategic role of the function. It can be seen
that SHRM has got a central place in the model. This means coordinating tasksin two
directions: on the one hand, the challenges of the external environment must be answered
more quickly, proactive, creative as possible, and can be reached with the basic competitive
advantage of the company, cost, cultural or competence. On the other hand, human resource
activities should reflect the business strategy and policies is important that every field
facilitates the company's strategy. In fact, four of these strategic tasks are integrated into the
HR, while organizations and individuals also harusdirealisasikan desired behavior.
I think, especially this model shows the strategic tasks of human resources and role in
the organization. Untukmempertimbangkan required environmental challenges with strategy
must abide by all means. Focus core competencies, he must determine the 'labor', and with
this contributes to increase the organization's value growth. In this way, can achieve
permanent long-term competitive advantage.
Relationship corporate strategy and HR showed internal integration: none of them
could become a reality without mutual support. Each factor necessary for success, none of
them can be left out. They are in relation to each other, influence the conformation and
promote the realization of them. By ignoring one factor then it is not the ultimate goal will
become a reality. Taking this fact into account, the goals set to be achieved: appreciation,
proper compensation, employee self-realization; While the purpose of the performance of the
organization will be in line with expectations, and the organization's image as an entrepreneur
(employer) will also be better. mportant matters relating to the strategy of the company is
unable to assess the structure, analyze the efficiency, observe, give nasihatuntuk change it. In
addition, the role of the regulator which became a reality in the practical dimension of law,
economics, and management, social and cultural. In addition, each soft factors related to
human resources, and should be treated for the implementation of appropriate strategies, by
all means. In this way, a very important role in the format, changing the corporate culture. A
good strategy not only consider the objective facts, but also the expectations, needs, value
system employee.
C. Strategy contingency based approach to HRM
111
Some scholars have adopted a mile and Snow (1978.1984) typology search, analysis
and defender; Others prefer (1985) porter strategy of differentiation and cost efficiency; still
others have made suggestions HRM policies depending on the model of the life cycle of the
product or has developed their own typology.
Although the framework is somewhat different, there must be some agreement among
writers on strategic HRM. Individual article contains differences that are much better, but
maybe for illustration purposes group plenty of advice for HR managers around two
categories dirty strategies: a) propector strategic hight tech entrepreneurial growth and b) cost
efficiency strategies mature defender. Business units in the former category requires creative,
innovative and risk-taking behavior; business units in the latter category should repetitive,
predictable, and carefully determined the behavior of the majority of their employees
(Schuler, 1986).
Fisher and shaw ((1987) found very little difference in the predicted HR practices
among companies pursuing the search for strategic analysis defender. Sxhuler and Jackson
(1989) found modest differences in several HR priorities between companies in growth
compared to the stage of maturity and the pursuit of differentiation compared efficiency
strategy costs.
The idea of strategic human resource management has become clearer and better
developed since 1986 annual review, and it seems to have much to offer in the way of
opportunities for research and thought provoking ideas for practiyioners. However, the
orientation of strategic HRM can cause problems and solve them. For example, Baird and
Meshoulam (1986) have suggested that the HRM function within the organization grows
thinking predictable phase, in which the credibility and skills of older players and
sophistication of the HR system at the crease by building on the foundation laid down in the
early stages.
CONCLUSION
Ethical behavior in the system to increase the role of human resources strategy
through an approach based HRM will demonstrate the role of HRM executives will change
and evolve rapidly, and can minimize the cost of HR while motivating behavior right strategy,
with the goal to be as well done in a multi cultural cooperation across national culture or cross
organizational culture following mergers. Strategy of constant change affecting companies
and individuals can be seen from the Hungarian situation hallmark characteristics, namely: a)
human resources in the organization SDM place dual because especially in the first row, but
still have the classic administrative tasks as well, b) the functional managers often decide with
their own opinion, they are not consistent, c) Difference between companies with foreign
ownership or Hungarian, very large, the corporate culture and human resources work system,
d) a proactive approach in several companies, and e) Management can not see Individual HR
value added work is still distinctive, and this inhibits organisasi.Masalah learning major in
HR strategy through the role of ethics should be doing as a whole has been ascertained that
112
the ethics in HR strategy is very important in the company's strategy, and has a role in the
realization of the long-term competitiveness of individual goals and organization.
REFERENCES
BakacsiGy. - Bokor A. - Csaszar Cs. - Gelei A. - Kováts K. - Takacs S. (2006):
Stratégiaiemberierőforrásmenedzsment, p. 51.
Baird, L. & Meshoukm, I. (1988). Mnaging two fits of strategic human resource
management Academy of Management Review, 116-128.
Becker, BE, & Huselid, MA, 2006. Strategic human resources management: Where do
we go from here? Journal of Management, 32: 898-925
Delery, JE (1998) InStrategie Fit Issues Of Human Resource Management
Implycation For Resrarch, In Human Resource Management Review, 8: 289: 309
Fisher, CD - Schoenfeldt, LF - Shaw, JB (1996): Human Resource Management, pp.
818-819.
Miles, R. / Snow, C. (1984), Designing strategic human resource systems. In:
Organizational Dynamics, Summer: 36-52.
Schuler, R. / Jackson, S. (1987) Linking competitive strategies and human resource practices.
In: Academy of Management Executive 1
113
MODERATOR VARIABLE IDENTIFICATION AND ANALYSIS OF
RELATIONSHIP SATISFACTION AND LOYALTY (STUDY IN ISLAMIC BANK
CUSTOMERS IN CENTRAL JAVA)
Mokhamad Arwani
Fakultas Ekonomi, Universitas Muria Kudus
Marthin Nanere
La Trobe Business School, Melbourne, Vic. 3880, Australia
ABSTRACT
The purpose of this study to reveal and interpret the relationship marketing as a mediating
relationship between satisfaction and loyalty. Examine the role of individual characteristics
as moderation of relationship satisfaction and loyalty. The sample of this study using the
criteria and determined by accidental sampling. The collected data is processed using SEM
analysis techniques. The number of samples is compliant using AMOS. The results found that
consumers are educated and and have enough information about Islamic banking will feel
satisfied and loyal. Consumers who are satisfied will believe the performance of Islamic
banks. Consumers who receive positive information related to Islamic banks will improve
relations with the Islamic banking and will have a strong loyalty.
Keywords: loyalty, satisfaction, individual characteristics, trust, commitment
INTRODUCTION
In Indonesia, the development of Islamic banking market share is quite good, but does
not meet expectations when compared with conventional bank growth, especially when
compared to the development of Islamic banks in other countries for example in the UK or
Malaysia. In the UK for example, the majority of non-Muslims, was encouraging the
development of Islamic banks. While in Malaysia, as in Muslim-majority Indonesia, the
increase in the market share of Islamic banks is very fast, which is about 1 in 17 compared to
Indonesia as presented by Hamid et al (2002).
These conditions, as the research presented by Ifham (2008) and Hafasnuddin (2007)
is caused by weak loyalty. In fact, only 33.75% are customers who use the services of Islamic
banking loyal. Loyalty is measured by making Islamic banking as a tool of major transactions
and are willing to convey a positive matters related to Islamic banking. Furthermore, as stated
by Ifham (2008) that loyalty is weak in Islamic banking caused by satisfaction. If customer
satisfaction associated with Islamic banking services, the customer will invite and recommend
to others to utilize the services of Islamic banking.
Research describing the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty is quite a lot and
have a different outcome. In the first group (Liang and Wang, 2006; Caruana, 2007; Yieh et
al., 2007) describes the satisfaction even can increase loyalty. While the next group revealed
that satisfaction does not singnifikan in increasing loyalty (Oliva et al., 1992; Wangenheim,
2003; Zahara, 2007).
114
There are also other groups (Homburg and Giering, 2001 and Wals et al, 2008) which
explains that there is a difference is caused by several different studies on the individual
characteristics of the customers of Islamic banks. The individual characteristics of the
customer in question is of age, income, and knowledge associated with Islamic banking.
Assessment of the results of the study indicate that there are contradictory results of
the study of relationship satisfaction and loyalty. The study showed a map of research on
relationship satisfaction and loyalty needs to be clarified. But until now the development of
the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty are continuing. still arise questions that need
to be answered, whether the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty is reinforced by the
individual characteristics as moderation, which could explain why people are satisfied can be
loyal or not. Moreover if the consumer satisfaction can improve long-term relationships such
as trust and commitment that will ultimately establish loyalty.
The above conditions which need to be clarified, motivated to do further research to
develop a theory of Homburg and Giering (2001), which makes the individual characteristics
as the moderation of the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty. Furthermore, the
concept of a long-term relationship needs to be positioned as the mediation of the relationship
between satisfaction and loyalty, as done by previous researchers.
Consumer loyalty according Leverin and Liljander (2006) is ingrained in the
consumer's commitment to reuse the service / services performed consistently in the future.
There are many factors that influence loyalty to the company. The study of theory and the
results of research conducted by Sirdeshmukh et al. (2002) and Thurau et al. (2002) showed
that the long-term relationship in the context of customer trust to the company influence on
customer loyalty. Furthermore, Knox et al. (2001) and Thurau et al. (2002) proves that the
commitment can increase loyalty. Gerrald and Cumingham (2001) mentions that religion may
be a factor that causes customers loyal to Islamic banks.
The significance of satisfaction in the context of marketing is associated with the
needs and desires of customers. Satisfaction so popular that many found in the marketing
literature. In addition it has a sense of deep satisfaction that is often the goal to be achieved by
the business as it is today.
Satisfaction as expressed by Barnes (2003) is a response to customers for fulfillment.
This implies a form of privilege of the goods / services themselves are able to provide a level
of comfort to consumers associated with fulfillment. In this case the fulfillment of the
requirements in line with expectations or exceed customer expectations.
HYPOTHESIS
In this study, the incidence of long-term relationships with customers is an effort to
build and maintain networks with consumers. The network is maintained and strengthened in
order to be useful for both parties through interactive contact that is both individual and
provide added value in the long-term relationship. Development of a long-term relationship
be based on the structure and long-term benefits of the bond between the buyer and the seller.
The underlying variable is the relationship network that consists of trust and commitment
(Dwyer et al., 1987; Hunt and Morgam, 1995; Peterson, 1995).
Customer satisfaction in the marketing study is the precursor of a long-term
relationship. Furthermore, long-term relationship can improve the satisfaction that can
115
establish loyalty. If the customer's expectations are met, then there will be the satisfaction and
confidence. That belief led to the quality of service provided in the future. Thus between
satisfaction, long-term relationship will be mutually influence (Fanco et al., 2009; Leverin
and Liljander, 2006).
The next concept of relationship satisfaction and loyalty of a moderating variable is
the individual characteristics. This is based on the psychological processes that affect
consumers in obtaining, taking, receiving goods and services, as well as knowledge relating to
the goods / services consumed. Individual characteristics are internal factors that drive
behavior in consumption. On the basis of the above conception of the hypothesis in this study
can be structured as follows:
H1: Consumer satisfaction has positive influence on long-term relationships and increase
customer loyalty.
H2: Individual characteristics strengthen the influence of customer satisfaction and
loyalty.
FINDINGS
The test results demonstrate the validity of all the items had a correlation coefficient of
more than 0.3 and a significance level below 0.01, then the entire item is declared invalid. The
test results of reliability indicators of the variable results with Cronbach alpha values above
0.6, so it can be stated that all the instruments used are reliable. The result of the final model,
is evaluated based on the criteria of goodness of fit indices with the criteria presented models
as well as critical values that have suitability data.
Evaluation of the model shows eight criteria of goodness of fit indices, there are two
that meet the criteria of the CFI and RMSEA while others have suggested approaching the
critical value, so the model can be said to have been in accordance with the data and can be
analyzed further.
Satisfaction direct effect on loyalty. Hypothesis testing with structural equation
modeling approach path coefficient AMOS produce direct influence satisfaction and loyalty
with P = 0.020 (> 0.05) and the value of CR (t <t table 2.500 <1.968) with a coefficient of
0.303. These results provide meaning, customers are satisfied with the service staff, products
and prices in accordance with the desired value customers as well as consumers are satisfied
overall, consumers will be loyal. Loyalty in this case is the Islamic bank will refer customers
to someone else, the increased intensity in interacting with Islamic banks, as well as
customers feel desire has been fulfilled and to make Islamic banks as the main option.
Hypothesis testing with structural equation modeling approach AMOS generates path
coefficient direct influence satisfaction with relationship marketing with P = 0.100 (> 0.05)
and the value of CR (t> t table (5,400> 1,968) with a coefficient of 0.450. This coefficient
gives meaning if the customer is satisfied, then the customer will improve the long-term
relationship between the customer and the Islamic bank. Furthermore, customers will believe
116
and commit. Communications customers with the Islamic banks will be established intensive
and conflict handling can be diselesaikandengan well.
Hypothesis testing with structural equation modeling approach AMOS results direct
influence long-term relationships and loyalty with value P = 0.040 (> 0.05) and the value of
CR (t> t table (2,400> 1,968) with a coefficient of 0.917. This result gives meaning that
customer relationship long term positive effect on loyalty.
The results of hypothesis testing with structural equation modeling approach AMOS
generates path coefficient direct influence of individual characteristics and loyalty with P =
0.010 (> 0.05) and the value of CR (t> t table (4.106> 1,968) with a coefficient of 0.706.
These results conclude that individual characteristics able to be moderating relationship
between satisfaction and loyalty. The result if the data showed satisfaction positive effect on
loyalty. So this can be interpreted Islamic Bank has managed to instill the satisfaction of the
customer, which in turn will increase loyalty. Customer satisfaction is a sense of satisfaction
that grows and evolves over time , therefore the good relations that have been established
between customers and banks need to be maintained.
DISCUSSION
Service Islamic bank employees will be better when supported by considerable
experience and expertise in serving clients. Karayawan way to convey good information and
quality of Islamic products may cause a sense of satisfaction to customers. The relationship
between the customer and the well-developed Islamic banks will generate loyalty. Excellent
service provided to customers will make customers more loyal. If so will be less likely to
switch to another bank customer.
Potential customer migration can occur, due to there are some of the respondents were
dissatisfied with the service. It can be anticipated with increased services in accordance with
the standards of conventional banks. But only spoil the customers with the service alone is not
enough due to the diverse needs of customers. Therefore, support by offering new products of
Islamic banks as well as programs in accordance with the wishes of customers needs to be
improved. Eg savings program without administrative costs, savings pilgrimage, and the rate
for a favorable outcome for customers.
Customer expects Islamic banks are able to provide the same service with
conventional banks and are able to create products of different services that are typical of
sharia. But until now has not been a lot of Islamic banks still relies innovate on products and
layanan.Selain innovative products and services, Islamic banks are also required to provide
more benefits to consumers than other banks. For example, the yield on Islamic banks are
expected promising with low interest rates. This is done because the majority of customers are
more likely to make a profit from the margin of savings / deposits. Satisfaction to Islamic
banks came after the fulfillment of needs such as savings that facilitate transactions for
customers. The need for attention to customer loyalty is because there are some customers
who are not willing to refer Islamic bank to others.
Indeed, the number of customers who are not loyal relatively small, but if not handled
properly will affect either not related denganloyalitas. Results of the study are not different
from the research conducted by Liang and Wang (2006), Caruana (2007), and Yieh et al.
(2007) where the results showed a relationship satisfaction on loyalty is positive and
significant. However, the results of this study do not support research Oliva et al., 1992; Von
117
Wangenheim, 2003; Zahara, 2007, which describes the relationship of satisfaction on loyalty
is not significant.
Long-term relationships between customers and Islamic banks become the main
capital in building loyalty. Trust, commitment, communication, and conflict management
became a cornerstone in building a long term relationship. Positive image held by Islamic
banks can establish customer trust, where people save their money by the bank subsequently
disbursed by the form of loans. Bank trusted by customers to have high confidence that can
make the company overcome the problem. The stronger the relationship, it will be less likely
to end.
Consistent and sincere service provided by Islamic banks will give satisfaction to
customers who can trigger the birth of a long-term relationship. Customer relationship with
the bank is not just a short-term business relationship, but long-term relationship. Good
relations based on kinship and cozy welcome from entering the office to address the bank
teller / customer service to its customers are able to make customers eager to repeat the
experience by making Islamic banks become the main option.
There are some customers less trusting and less committed to the Islamic banks. Thus
is because the customer is not satisfied with the benefits of customers compared to profits
earned in conventional banks. However, customers are thus relatively small number of
Islamic banks so that customers are satisfied will give more benefits in terms of long-term
relationship. Together with the results of the research terdahului (Liang and Wang, 2005,
2006; Nijssen and Herk, 2009; Prasad and Aryasri, 2008).
Long-term relationships can be obtained through the Islamic belief that the customer
obtained from the justice system for the result, security guarantees to assets stored and
honesty of Islamic banks in providing information related to bank products. Good
relationships with customers will get a number of requests and increase profits. Loyalty can
be increased due to the desire of customers for repeat transactions in Islamic banks. Good
relations into a strong motivation to always use the services of Islamic banks.
Empirical studies have shown that the conditions of Islamic bank is able to appeal to
customers if socializing with good communication in order to provide knowledge for the
people that use the services of Islamic banks is more profitable than other conventional banks.
Customer perception regarding long-term relationship is very strong. This shows in general
Islamic banks are able to provide services that are not less good than the other banks.
Most customers have the confidence and commitment to Islamic banks. Only a small
proportion of customers who are less committed and believe in the good services of Islamic
banks. This condition affects the reluctance to refer to others to use the services of Islamic
banks. However, the relatively small number of customers, but if not handled properly will
harm Islamic bank in the long term. Results of this study support the research proved that
conveyed by Ndubisi (2007), Nijssen and Herk (2009) and Prasad and Aryasri (2008). But in
contrast with the results of Leverin and Liljander (2006), which proves that relations can not
improve the long-term loyalty.
Relationship satisfaction in this study is reinforced by the individual characteristics
which become an internal factor that is able to raise and move the customer behavior.
Characteristic of knowledge as a characteristic of the individual be a key driver in influencing
the decision to loyal customers. This indicates that customers have the knowledge after
receiving sufficient information and be able to compare after the use of conventional banking
118
services will make customers loyal. Customer loyalty is reflected by making Islamic banks as
the main option.
Customer knowledge becomes the dominant factor in shaping the behavior due to the
knowledge that emerged from information provided to customers becomes an objective to
make the Islamic bank as the main option. Information submitted to the relevant customers of
Islamic banks would be effective because the customer has a high level of education are
easier to understand and understand than customers who have lower education. Due to access
to information obtained by the highly educated customer related sharia banj more.
Another driving force for the community to utilize the services of Islamic banks is a
network, relationships, and there are other family members who become customers of Islamic
banks. Besides the demands of being members of a religious community into a strong impetus
for a person to become customers of Islamic banks. This is due to the proximity with
members lomunitas study could encourage someone to use Islamic banks as a symbol of
adherence to religious teachings.
In summary, if the Islamic banks have a lot of products that fit the individual aspects
and has compatibility with the income level of the customer, the customer will make Islamic
banks as the main option. With such a strategy Islamic banks will be able to succeed in
maintaining customer relationships in the long term. Security and convenience provided by
Islamic banks to customers will encourage customers to provide good information to others to
use the services of Islamic banks.
More details encouragement to use the services of Islamic banks other than specified
by the trust and commitment that trigger long-term relationship, is also determined by the
characteristics of the individual. Such as age customers have a tendency to avoid illicit goods
and subhat. This will encourage loyalty to Islamic banks due to carry the anti-usury jargon.
Results of this study strengthen and support the research presented by Homburg and Giering
(2001) and Walsh et al. (2008).
Contributions are able to be delivered in this research is the development of the theory
of the characteristics of individuals based on age, education, social roles, income, and
knowledge as the reinforcement of the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty.
Furthermore, the position of a long-term relationship as a mediating relationship satisfaction
and loyalty is able to be an added value to the results of this study, which were perceived
customer satisfaction will make loyal if Islamic banks are able to establish long-term
relationships that benefit our customers and able to maintain good communication.
LIMITATIONS
Limitations of this study was the limited time availability of respondents both in
filling the questionnaire or answer questions posed by researchers. Another limitation is the
reluctance of the Islamic banks to provide respondent data relating to the determination of the
number of samples as well as potential customers who could give important information
related to Islamic banks. For this condition accidental sampling method is used. Another
limitation is that the respondents overall Islamic religion, in fact many bank customers who
are non Islamic sharia. So this study has not revealed what prompted pihik non-Muslims who
are willing to become customers of Islamic banks.
PROPOSITIONS RESEARCH
119
In the discussion above, it can be an expression derived proposition that the findings
have not been proven but it's been proven that; impulse or stimuli customers use the services
of Islamic banks due to considerations of profit or margin obtained compared to other
conventional banks. Besides the ease and services provided by Islamic banks to attract
customers to use the services of Islamic banks and Islamic banks offices strategic location it is
also a stimulus for the community use the services of Islamic banks.
CONCLUSION
Customer satisfaction which is supported by knowledge, adult and higher education
dimilliki customers will be able to make customers loyal and always use the services of
Islamic banks and Islamic banks as an option to make a major. Good communications and
customer anatara sharia tub, trust and commitment which is owned by the customer to the
Islamic bank will build long-term relationships which then customers will willingly refer to
others for harnessing the services of Islamic banks. This study did not reveal whether Islamic
banks using the principles of Islam. For that we need to do further research on whether
Islamic banks based on Islamic sharia will be able to provide more benefits to customers
compared with conventional banks.
REFERENCES
Barnes, James G., 2003. Establishing meaningful customer relationships: Why some
companies and brands mean more to their customers, Managing Service Quality,
Vol.13 No. 3, pp. 178-186
Bitner, M.J., Booms, B.H. and Tetreault, M.S., 1990. The Service Encounter: Diagnosing
Favorable and Unfavorable Incidents, Journal of Marketing, Vol.54, pp. 71-84.
Caruana, Albert, 2002. Service Loyalty The Effects of service quality and the mediating role
of customer satisfaction, Europen Journal of Marketing, Vol. 36, No. 7/8, 2002, pp.
811-828.
Cronin J. Joseph and Steven A. Taylor, 1992. asumg Service Reexamination and Extension.
Journal of Marketing, Vol. 56. 68.
Dwyer, F. Robert, Paul H. Schurr, and Sejo Oh, 1987. Developing Buyers-Seller
Relationships, Journal of Marketing, Vol.51. pp. 11-27.
Franco, Manuel J. Sanchez, Angel Francisco Villarejo Ramos, Felix A. Martin Velicia, 2009.
The moderating effect of gender on relationship quality and loyalty toward Internet
service providers, Information & Management, 46 196–202.
Gerrald, Philip dan J.Barton Cunningham, (2001), Singapore’s Undergraduates: How They
Choose Which Bank to Patronise, International Journal of Bank Marketing, 19/3, hal
104-114.
Hafasnuddin, 2007. Effect Value Care, Trust, and Commitment Loyalty Islamic Bank,
Dissertation, Postgraduate Padjadjaran University, Bandung.
Hamid, H.Abdul, dan Norizaton A.Mohd Nurdin, 2002. A Study of Islamic Banking
Education and Strategy for the New Millenium- Malaysian Experience, International
Journal of Islamic Financial Services, Vol.2. No.4, hal 217-226.
Hellier, Phillip. K,. Gus M. Geursen, Rodney A. Carr, dan John A. Richard, 2003. Customer
Repurchase Intention, European Journal of marketing, Vol 37. No. 11/12, hal 1762-
1800.
120
Homburg, Christian dan Giering, Annette, 2001. Personal Characteristics as Moderators of
the Relationship Between Customer Satisfaction and Loyalty-An Empirical Analysis,
Journal Psychology and Marketing, Vol. 18 (1):43-66.
Hunt, Shelby D. and Robert M. Morgan, 1995. Marketing and comparative Advantage Theory
of Competition, Journal of Marketing, 59 (2), pp.1-15.
Hurriyati, Ratih, 2010. Marketing Mix and Customer Loyalty, Publisher Alfabeta, Bandung.
Ifham, Ahmad, 2008. Growth Optimism Islamic Bank, Business Development Executive
KARIM Business Consulting, http // www.sebi.ac.id / index
Knox, Simon dan David Walker, 2001; Measuring and Managing Brand Loyalty, Journal of
Strategic Marketing, 9 hal. 111-128.
Liang, Chiung-Ju and Wang, Wen-Hung, 2006. The Behavioural Sequence of the Financial
Services Industry in Taiwan: Service Quality, Relationship Quality and Behavioural
Loyalty, The Service Industries Journal, Vol.26, No.2, pp.119–145.
Leverin, Andreas, and Liljander, Veronica, 2006. Does relationship marketing improve
customer relationship satisfaction and loyalty?, International Journal of Bank
Marketing, Vol. 24, No. 4, pp. 232-251.
Lewis, Barbara R., and Soureli, Magdalini, 2006. The Antesedent of Consumer Loyalty in
Retail Banking, Journal of Consumer Behavior, Vol. 5:15-31.
Malhotra, Naresh K., 1999. Marketing Research: An Applied Orientation, Third Edition,
Prentice Hall International Inc, New Jersey.
Metawa, Saad A., And Mohammed Almossawi, 1998. Banking Behavior of Islamic Banki
Customers: Perspectives And Implications, International Journal of Bank Marketing,
Vol. 16, No. 7.
Naser, Kamal, Ahmad Jamal, Khalid Al-Khatib, 1999. Islamic Banking: A Study of Customer
Satisfaction And Preferences In Jordan, International Journal of Bank Marketing, Vol.
17.No. 3.
Nijssen, Edwin J. and Herk, Hester van, 2009. Conjoining International Marketing and
Relationship Marketing: Exploring Consumers’ Cross-Border Service Relationships,
Journal of International Marketing, American Marketing Association, Vol. 17, No. 1,
2009, pp. 91–115.
Ndubisi, Nelson Oly, 2007. Relationship quality antecedents: the Malaysian retail banking
perspective, International Journal of Quality and Reliability Management, Vol. 24
No. 8, pp. 829-845.
Oliva, T.A., Oliver, R.L. and MacMillan, I.C. 1992, A catastrophe model for developing
service satisfaction strategies, Journal of Marketing, Vol. 56, July, pp. 83-95.
Peterson, Robert A.,1995. Relationship Marketing and the Consumer, Journal of the Academy
of Marketing Science, 23, pp.278-281.
Prasad, Ch. J. S. and Aryasri, A. R, 2008. Study of Customer Relationship Marketing
Practices in Organised Retailing in Food and Grocery Sector in India: an Empirical
Analysis, The Journal of Business Perspective, Vol. 12 l, No. 4 l.
Sirdeshmukh, Deepak dan Barry Sabol, 2002, Consumer Trust,Value and Loyalty in
Relational Exchanges, Journal of Marketing, Vol.66 (January), hal 15-27.
Thurau, Hennig Thorsten,Kevin P Gwinner dan Dwayne D Gremble, 2002., Understanding
Relationship Marketing Outcomes, Journal of Service Research, Vol.4.No.3, hal 230-
247.
Wangenheim, F., 2003. Situational characteristics as moderators of the satisfaction-loyalty
link: an investigation in a business-to-business context, Journal of Consumer
Satisfaction, Dissatisfaction and Complaining Behavior, Vol. 16, pp. 145-56.
Walsh, Gianfranco, Heiner Evanschitzky and Maren Wunderlich, 2008. Identification and
analysis of moderator variables Investigating the customer satisfaction-loyalty link,
European Journal of Marketing Vol. 42 No. 9/10.
121
Yieh, Kaili, Yu-Ching Chiao and Ya-Kang Chiu, 2007. Understanding the Antecedents to
Customer Loyalty by Applying Structural Equation Modeling, Total Quality
Management, Vol. 18, No. 3, 267–284.
Zahara, Zakiyah, 2007. Role of the Service Quality Satisfaction, Confidence, Commitment,
and Customer Loyalty in Partnership Relations, Dissertation, Graduate School,
Faculty of Economics, University of Brawijaya, Malang.
122
ANTECEDENTS CUSTOMERS BANKING LOYALTY
Dwy Puspitasari
Faculty of Economic, Universitas Muria Kudus, Central Java, Indonesia
gederiana@yahoo.com
Mokhamad Arwani
Faculty of Economic, Universitas Muria Kudus, Central Java, Indonesia
Suprehatin
Institut Pertanian Bogor, West Java, Indonesia
Marthin Nanere
Faculty of Business, Economic and Law, La Trobe University, Bendigo, Vic. 3550, Australia
ABSTRACT
The purpose of this study was to analyze the effect of service quality, customer
complaints and switching costs on customer satisfaction and customer loyalty. The number of
respondents in this study was 161 respondents. How to determine the respondents with
accidental sampling. Data were analyzed using Structural Equation Modeling (SEM). The
results showed that the switching costs has positive and significant influence on customer
satisfaction. While service quality and customer satisfaction has positive and significant
influence on customer loyalty.
Keywords: service quality, complaints, switching costs, customer satisfaction, customer
loyalty
INTRODUCTION
In Indonesia at this time there are a variety of companies in the banking sector which
compete to provide services that memorable for all customers. Banking company at this time
is more emphasis on the concept of marketing approach to consumers, the company noted that
the importance of customer satisfaction for the survival of the company. Companies pay
attention to the element of customer satisfaction as the basis for building customer loyalty to a
product or service is created.
Increasing competition in the banking industry to encourage the banking industry to
quickly adapt to the development of the surrounding communities. It is characterized by the
increasingly widespread expansion of foreign banks are trying to enter the banking market in
Indonesia. The banking industry is currently vying to improve service to its customers, by
providing facilities that allows the customer to conduct financial transactions. One example is
the implementation of the e-banking or e-Channel that provide convenience to customers to
conduct financial transactions or non-financial without having to come to the bank.
The banking industry has now realized that customers today not only consider the
interest factor or the sophistication and completeness of the features of a banking product, but
123
is currently being sought by the customer is the value (value) to be obtained from what is
offered by the bank, so that the ultimately will be willing to become loyal customers.
The first step in winning the hearts of customers is the quality of service. Bank as one
of the financial services sector, its performance will depend on the good or bad overall service
to clients. The better the service from a bank, it will be relatively easier to gain the trust of the
customer to save money or apply for a loan at the bank. It is proved that the competition was
not only based on improving the quality of a banking product alone but is now more inclined
to incorporate the achievement of satisfaction and fulfillment of customer loyalty as a key
condition, whether the customer loans and customer deposits (Meng and Elliott, 2008;
Olorunniwo and Hsu, 2006).
Furthermore, in addition to quality of service, customer complaints has also become
an important groove when the products are not in accordance with the value / value of the
expected customers. Because none of the products of both goods and services that are perfect
with no weaknesses. On the other hand the tastes and demands of customers changing so fast.
Moreover, some studies have shown that the referral relationship with a customer complaint
sales performance and the company's profits in the long term (Blodgett and Anderson, 2000;
Johnston, 2001). Thus it can be said that the profit or the profit of a bank today is no longer
one of the basic mission, but it has shifted to the creation and value addition (value creation
and value adding) for customers, excellent service (services excellence) to customers become
a major component and real to the banking industry at the moment (Stauss and Seidel, 2006).
The final results are expected to bank with the advanced quality of service and
handling customer complaints is customer satisfaction. Satisfaction is an assessment of
customers that they liked the products offered by the company. If the return on the
understanding of marketing concepts, then obviously the goal of every marketing activity of
the banking company is customer satisfaction. So that if the customer is satisfied with the
products / services banking, then this is a positive indicator that the products produced and
offered by banks to their customers get the recognition for the performance (quality of
service) and the things other support (complaints of customers) (Solvang, 2007) ,
Satisfaction is one of the main factors driving positive word-of-mouth (File, et al,
1994). In the study conducted by Moutinho and Smith (2000) with a sample of 250 banks
found that customer satisfaction has a positive relationship with the displacement (switching)
and loyalty. While Reichheld and Sasser (1990), suggests that customer satisfaction program
is considered an important tool in increasing profits and prevent customer switching.
Customer will make the shift when the tolerance limit is exceeded and depending on the level
of sensitivity of consumers in response to the satisfaction of unmet.
Low cost changes that strengthen the relationship between service quality, perceived
value and image on customer loyalty compared with the high cost changes (Yu Wang, 2010).
This finding is contrary to the findings of Lam, et al. (2004) which says that the change in the
cost of having a positive relationship with customer loyalty. That is if changes are perceived
high costs, so consumers tend to be more willing to stay in a relationship with the company
regardless of the perception of value. Kebalikanya, if the changes are low cost, then the
perception of low value may cause consumers to switch to another company. Meanwhile, the
appeal of competitors refer to consumer perceptions of various alternative options available in
the market that appeal to consumers. The more alternatives, the more consumer choice. The
appeal of a competitor in the competition in a positive impact on customers' willingness to
switch. When consumers perceive only a few alternatives available, then the perception of
benefit to switching to low, meaning that consumers prefer to survive.
Another phenomenon of the background for this study is the problem of Indonesian
Bank Loyalty Index (IBLI). Bank Loyalty Index (IBLI) 2014 is a benchmark assessment of
the level of satisfaction and loyalty of banking customers in Indonesia are carried out done by
markplusinc. Based on the data obtained, Bank Rakyat Indonesia (BRI), which is one of the
largest SOEs conventional banks in Indonesia occupies the third position as a bank that had a
124
high level of loyalty. This condition is far with other state-owned banks such as Bank
Mandiri, which continued to show better results by being in the second position, and Bank
BCA as privately owned banks in the first position. While retaining customers is important
compared to attract new customers, because it can be considered cheaper than the draw back
customers who've gone, customer loyalty will reduce the cost of banks to find new customers,
in addition to the costs of maintaining the customer cheaper when compared to the cost issued
to seek new customers.
This study is also the source of the problem comes from the limitations and gaps in
previous research. Although many agree that the success of a bank is determined by the
bank's ability to build customer loyalty, the loyalty will be one of the goals to be achieved by
a bank in terms of retaining its customers from the threat of competitor banks. However, a
number of studies such as Bloemer et al., (1998); Mittal et al., (2008) explains that although
many studies that discuss satisfaction and quality of service, but in fact only a few studies that
discuss the relationship between satisfaction, quality of service and loyalty in the context of
the banking industry.
The position of this research is to develop earlier research. Where the building and the
formulation of the model in the study refer to several studies such as studies Oliver (1999);
Lyon and Powers (2004), stating that the quality of service is one of the key customer
satisfaction taken into consideration, then customers who are satisfied will re-purchase or
subsequent repetition of these customers would be willing to recommend it to others. Liu and
Wu (2007), reveals some of the attributes that are the object of evaluation of the consumer
when consumers consume services, namely physical evidence (physical evidence), employees
(people) and processes (process). Meanwhile in McCole (2004) explains that the handling of
the complaint to the company (bank) is an important instrument for the realization of
customer satisfaction and loyalty to the banking world.
Service Quality
Service was good being one of the conditions of success in corporate services. Quality
of service in the company's services are often conditioned as a comparison between the
expected services and services received significantly. According to Lewis & Booms in
Tjiptono (2014) definition of service quality in a simple, which is a measure of how good the
level of service provided is able to conform to the expectations of the customers. That is the
quality of service is determined by the ability of a particular company or institution to meet
the needs in accordance with what is expected or desired based on the needs of customers /
visitors. In other words, the main factors affecting the quality of service is a service that is
expected customer / visitor and the public perception of the service. The value of quality of
service depends on the ability of the company and its staff in meeting customer expectations
consistently.
Customer Complaint
One of the reasons why the displacement of customers from one company to a service
company, according Tronvoll other services (2007) is because the customer is not satisfied
with the settlement masalahan or how to deal with the problem of corporate services. When
customers are not satisfied with what has been received or when having problems, customers
might respond with out resorting to other service providers, to try to solve the problem with
grievances or complaints or being faithful together service providers and hope that will better
occur in the future. Handling complaints can be a vital instrument in curbing the conflict
between the company and the customer will be dissatisfaction (You and Loh, 2006). Handling
of complaints by bank becomes a tool to enhance the bank's acquisition of profit.
Response Fee Change
Brand switching behavior associated with changes in the cost / charge switch
(switching costs). According to Porter (1980) in Tjiptono (2014), switching costs is more of a
one-time costs and no ongoing costs. Based on this perspective, Burnham, Frels, and Mahajan
(2003) defines switching costs as one-time costs that customers perceived or associated with
125
the process of switching from providers of services / products to the service providers / other
products.
The cost of switching costs are not only limited to economic costs, but may include
various costs. Fornell (1992) revealed the cost that may arise from the switching costs in it
include search costs, transaction costs, the cost of learning, discount loyal customers, the
habits of consumers (consumer habits), the cost of emotional, businesses cognitive, financial
risks, social risks, and the risk of psychological , In other words, switching costs are factors
that directly affect the sensitivity of the customers at a rate of cost / price to dikelurkan
sehinggan affect customer loyalty.
Customer satisfaction
Customer satisfaction has become a central concept in the theory of marketing
practices, and is one of the essential destination for business activity. Customer satisfaction
contribute to a number of crucial aspects, such as the creation of customer loyalty, increasing
the company's reputation, reduced price elasticity, reduced future transaction costs, and
increased efficiency and productivity of employees. Fornell and Wenerfelt (1987) in Tjiptono
(2014) suggests the fact that attracting new customers is much more expensive than retaining
current customers is also one of the triggers increased attention on customer satisfaction.
Customer satisfaction on an experience of a particular service will give birth to an
evaluation or attitude towards the quality of service from time to time (Oliver, 1993). While
Kotler and Keller (2009) stated the level of customer satisfaction is the feeling of pleasure or
disappointment resulting from comparing a person's perceived performance of products (or
result) to their expectations.
Customer satisfaction is formulated as an after-purchase evaluation, where the
perception of the performance of alternative products / services are chosen meet or exceed
expectations before purchase. If the perception of the performance can not meet the
expectations, then there is dissatisfaction. Based on these definitions, customer satisfaction is
an evaluative assessment purnabeli resulting from the selection of the specific purchase of
products / services are chosen.
Customer loyalty
Repeat purchase behavior often associated with brand loyalty (brand loyalty).
According to Kapferer and Laurent (1983, cited in Odin, et al., 2001) in Tjiptono (2014),
repeat purchase behavior (repeat purchasing behavior) can be translated into two possibilities,
namely loyalty and inertia. Loyalty is actually a repetition of behavioral habits of purchase,
association and involvement are high on his choice, starting with external information search
and evaluation of alternatives to existing products. In his article Dick and Basu (1994)
attempted to integrate perspectives and behavioral attitude into one model. By combining the
components of the attitudes and behavior of repeat purchase, then obtained four situations
possibility of loyalty. Based on the concept and previous research findings as a reference, the
researchers want to reexamine theories will prove the role of the variables that have been
described in the previous chapter and its influence on other variables.
The source of the problem comes from the limitations of this study and previous
research gap. Although many agree that the success of a bank is determined by the bank's
ability to build customer loyalty, the loyalty will be one of the goals to be achieved by a bank
in terms of retaining its customers from the threat of competitor banks. However, a number of
studies such as Bloemer et al., (1998); Mittal et al., (2008) explains that although many
studies that discuss satisfaction and quality of service, but in fact only a few studies that
discuss the relationship between satisfaction, quality of service and loyalty in the context of
the banking industry.
The position of this research is to develop earlier research. Where the building and the
formulation of the model in the study refers to some research as empirical research conducted
by Cristobal, et al. (2007). View researchers concluded that the most important element in
customer satisfaction is the quality of service. In the service industry is an absolute quality
126
demands. This study illustrates the triangular relationship that affects the positive synergy
between service quality, customer satisfaction and loyalty. Relating to quality of service,
customer satisfaction and loyalty Goddess, et al. (2014) conducted a study on the effect of
service quality on customer satisfaction and loyalty. Results of these studies is the quality of
service, satisfaction and loyalty has a positive and significant relationship. That is, the good
quality of service led to the level of satisfaction and the desire to apply loyal customers
increased, otherwise the quality of poor service resulting in customer satisfaction and loyalty.
Hypothesis
Based on the literature review and development of a model as described above, then the
hypothesis developed in this study are:
1. The quality of service has a positive effect on customer satisfaction
2. The complaint customers have a positive effect on customer satisfaction
3. Response of changes in costs have a positive effect on customer satisfaction
4. Complaints customers have a positive effect on customer loyalty
5. Quality of service has a positive effect on customer loyalty
6. Response cost changes have a positive effect on customer loyalty
7. Customer satisfaction has a positive effect on customer loyalty
Method
Target population in this study were all customers of Bank BRI, Bank Mandiri and
Bank BNI in the Holy City. Selection of Bank BRI, Bank Mandiri and Bank BNI, considering
that three of the Bank is the largest SOE conventional bank in Indonesia.
Proportion of questionnaires at each branch office of Bank BRI, Bank Mandiri and
Bank BNI is based on estimates of the number of samples given by the conventional three-
Bank, but the three parties of the Bank are reluctant to give exact information about the
number of customers. While the sample size depends on the number of indicators used in all
variables multiplied by 5 to 10 (Hair, et al. In Ferdinand, 2014). In this study the number of
indicators is 23 multiplied by 10, then circulated the questionnaire as much as 230. How to
determine respondents with accidental sampling. If the initial question, the customer qualifies
as respondents. From the results of the questionnaire administration, a total of 130
respondents was circulated at Bank BRI and workplaces of respondents, 4 respondents
requested that the questionnaire be taken at home, 9 respondents requested that the
questionnaire be taken in the workplace, and 12 respondents promised to send a questionnaire
to the researchers address. Of the 230 questionnaires returned as many as 161, and that does
not return the questionnaire by 69 respondents (30%). Therefore, the sample size of 161
people. But the number of these samples have met the requirements, the number of indicators
(23) multiplied by 7, which is between 5 to 10. The number of samples have also been
eligible to use the technique SEM analysis suggested that the sample size is between 100 -
200. Sampling is done in July - August 2015.
Descriptive analysis is used to describe and interpret the characteristics of respondents
and each of the variables used. In this study the characteristics of respondents include five (5)
it is; gender, age, education, occupation, and duration of a customer. While the description of
the variables include the variable quality of service, customer complaints, response to changes
in costs, customer satisfaction, and customer loyalty.
Basically this research would like to see a model that describes the relationship
between variables simultaneously. On the basis of these considerations used statistical
techniques Structural Equation Model (SEM) with AMOS software 21. By modeling is made
possible through SEM can unanswered questions that are regressive and dimensional.
Result
127
Description of respondents were male sex as much as 67.7%, whereas the female sex
as much as 32.3%. Based on this data the conventional bank customers is dominated by men.
A total of 13.7% of respondents are students / students, 32.9% of civil servants, private
employees 11.8%, 29.2% and 12.4% are self-employed. 100% of the customers, 93.7%
worked. The percentage of the age group most at the age of 46-55 years is as much as 32.3%,
while the least is the oldest age group, namely by 2.5%. It shows that most respondents are
most productive age. At the age of the respondents have the greatest opportunity to build a
career and increase their income as well as more able to set aside a portion of their savings to
institutions that they trust.
Respondents were educated diploma / undergraduate has the largest percentage
(42.9%). While based on long become customers, 53.4% of respondents who are customers of
more than 3 to 5 years, which indicates that the level of loyalty of respondents who become
customers of Bank of conventional high enough.
The test results demonstrate the validity of the three items had a correlation coefficient
of less than 0.4. Thus these three items is invalid. While the results of reliability testing all
indicators of exogenous and endogenous variables showed Cronbach alpha values above 0.6
so that it can be concluded that all the instruments used are reliable.
The average index of indicators to variable quality of service at 77.17 and this value is
within the range of the three categories of high, so it can be concluded that the perception of
consumers regarding the quality of service is quite high. Of the five indicators used to
measure the variables of service quality, perception of respondents to variable quality of
service are all almost equal. Indicators of reliability (reliability) has the highest index score,
followed by responsiveness (responsiveness), physical evidence (tangibles), empathy
(empathy), and last guarantee (assurance). The average index of indicators to variable
customer complaints at 70.06 and this value is within the range of 70.01 to 100 with the
higher category, so it can be concluded that the perception of respondents regarding customer
complaints is quite high.
The response variable cost changes have an index value of 72.31 where the index
value is included in the high category. Of the eight indicators used to measure the response
variable cost changes have almost equal value. It can be concluded that the respondents'
perceptions regarding the response to changes in the cost is quite high.
The average index of indicators to variable customer satisfaction at 73.77 and this
value is within the range of the three categories of high, so it can be concluded that the
perception of respondents regarding customer satisfaction is quite high. Of the three
indicators used to measure the variables of customer satisfaction, perception of respondents to
variable customer satisfaction are all almost equal.
Customer loyalty variables shows that customer loyalty has an index value of 75.31
where the index value is included in the high category. Of the four indicators used to measure
customer loyalty variables, indicators of perceived highest first choice by the customer.
Evaluation of the model shows eight criteria of goodness of fit indices there are seven
who meet the criteria while only one is approaching the critical value suggested, thus
referring to the principle of parsimony, the overall model can be said to have been in
accordance with the data and can be analyzed further.
Based on empirical models proposed in this study can be tested against the hypothesis
put forward by testing the path coefficients in the structural equation model. Hypothesis test
results to see p value. If the p value ≤ 0.05, a significant relationship between variables.
Model relationships between exogenous and endogenous variables are presented in Figure 1.
128
Figure 1: Hypothesis Testing
Description: S = significant
NS = not significant
Parameter estimation of the influence of service quality on customer satisfaction
shows the value of CR 0.679 with probability equal to 0.497. CR value of <1.96 and a
probability of> 0.05, it can be concluded that the quality of service is not positive and no
significant effect on customer satisfaction with the direct effect (direct effect) of 0.055. In
addition there is an indirect effect (indirect effect) of 0.000 with a total effect of 0.055.
Parameter estimation of the effect of customer complaints on customer satisfaction
showed CR values of 0.844 to 0.399 probability CR value <1.96 with a probability value>
0.05 then it can be concluded that no customer complaints and no significant positive effect
on customer satisfaction with the direct effect (direct effect ) amounted to 0,074. In addition
there is an indirect effect (indirect effect) of 0.000 with a total effect of 0,074.
Parameter estimation of the effect of changes in the cost of the response on customer
satisfaction shows the value of 6.382 with probability CR ***. CR values> 1.96 with a
probability value *** (significant) it can be concluded that the response to changes in costs
and significant positive effect on customer satisfaction with the direct effect (direct effect) of
0.696. In addition there is an indirect effect (indirect effect) of 0.000 with a total effect of
0.696.
Parameter estimation of influence on customer loyalty customer complaints indicate
CR value of 0.804 with probability 0.421. CR value <1.96 with a probability value> 0.05 then
it can be concluded that no customer complaints and no significant positive effect on
customer loyalty with immediate effect (direct effect) of 0.051. In addition there is an indirect
effect (indirect effect) amounted to 0,067 with a total effect of 0.117.
Parameter estimation of the influence of service quality on customer loyalty shows the
value CR of 1,975 with probability 0.054. CR values> 1.96 with a probability value ≤ 0.05, it
can be concluded that the quality of service is positive and significant impact on customer
loyalty with immediate effect (direct effect) 0.112. In addition there is an indirect effect
(indirect effect) amounted to 0,050 with a total effect of 0.162.
Parameter estimation of the effect of changes in response to customer loyalty costs
showed CR values of 0.519 with probability 0.604. CR value <1.96 with a probability value>
0.05 then it can be concluded that the costs do not change response and no significant positive
effect on customer loyalty with immediate effect (direct effect) amounted to 0,046. In
addition there is an indirect effect (indirect effect) of 0.632 with a total effect of 0.678.
Parameter estimation of the influence of customer satisfaction on customer loyalty
shows the CR value of 8.492 with probability ***. CR values> 1.96 with a probability value
*** (significant) it can be concluded that customer satisfaction and significant positive effect
0,06 NS
0,07 NS
0,70 S
0,91 S
Satisfaction
(Y1)
Loyalty
(Y2)
Service
Quality
Complaint
(X2)
Switching cost
(X3)
0,05 NS
0,05 NS
0,11 S
129
on customer loyalty with immediate effect (direct effect) of 0.907. In addition there is an
indirect effect (indirect effect) of 0.000 with a total effect of 0.907.
Discussion
The analysis showed that the quality of service is not a positive effect on customer
satisfaction. Conventional banks have not succeeded in establishing the quality of services
that can ultimately build customer satisfaction. Customer satisfaction as satisfied feeling
dynamically growing and growing all the time, therefore the good relations that have been
established between customers and banks could be increased again. Good relations between
customers and the bank will allow the bank to anticipate the next plan.
Conventional bank employees have knowledge and expertise in serving the customers,
especially in services related to the bank's ability to provide the maximum of information
about bank products konvensional.karyawan conventional banks also mapu providing a fun,
friendly, empathetic and polite.
Along with the times as well as the diverse needs of customers, pamper customers with
service alone is not enough, but must be supported by a conventional bank products and
programs in accordance with the wishes of customers. Conventional banking is not only
required to create the same service with the bank competitors, but also must be able to create
products of different services that represent the image of a conventional bank. Innovations
that can be done by conventional banks are expected to provide more benefits to customers
compared to the benefits provided by conventional banks competitors.
Superior products such as Simpedes and BritAma (product BRI) managed to attract
customers not only in urban but also dipelosok area. Conventional banks in addition to
product innovation, is also expected to be increasingly aware of the desire of the customer
deposit interest rates are high. Customer loyalty built up through a conventional bank
perceived customer satisfaction. The customer satisfaction occurs when conventional bank
has a wide array of products that meet customers' needs.
The results of this study do not support research Cristobal, et al. (2007), Dewi, et al
(2014), You and Loh (2006), Tronvoll (2007), Abdurrahman and Suryadi (2009), Hidayat
(2009), Karsono (2008), Kusmayadi and Hidayat (2014), Burnham, et al. (2003), and Darpito
(2010) prove the existence of significant influence variables of service quality on customer
satisfaction.
The analysis showed that customers do not complain positive effect on customer satisfaction.
The higher the complaints of customers it will cause dissatisfaction on conventional bank
customers.
Customer expects when customers encounter problems with the services of the bank,
then the conventional bank is able to solve problems that customers face is to offer a
satisfactory solution. In addition customers also expect simplicity in the complaint to be filed
by the customer quickly, whenever and wherever the customer is located. Therefore,
conventional banks provide Call Center facility as addressing the needs of banking customers
when experiencing problems. This is done as an effort to fulfill the customers' needs for speed
and quick response service as a means of forming customer satisfaction.
These results are consistent with studies that have been conducted by Karsono (2008)
which states that the complaint was not a positive influence on customer satisfaction.
However, the results of this study do not support research You and Loh (2006) and Tronvoll
(2007) which states that the positive influence between variables complaint against
complacency.
The analysis showed that response to changes in the cost of a positive effect on
customer satisfaction. Conventional banks have managed to build customer satisfaction
derived from the responses change banking charges. Changes in rates of banking services that
are currently going on to prove the existence of a considerable influence on customer
satisfaction response to conventional banks. The higher the cost of the changes experienced
130
by the customer, then the customer intentions to switch over to other service providers are
also getting bigger, and vice versa.
It needs to be balanced by educating customers about any changes of rates of banking
services as well as other information relating to the matter. So that customers will feel
comfortable when transacting in conventional banks because they feel a lack of transparency
transformation of banking services rates. When customers feel the uncertainty regarding rates
of banking services customers feel, then the customer will be thinking of migrating to other
service providers.
The results of this study do not support research and Suryadi Abdurrahman, 2009; Karsono,
2008; Kusmayadi and Hidayat, 2014; Burnham, et al. , 2003; and Darpito 2010 which proves
the existence of significant influence variable costs change in response to customer
satisfaction.
The analysis showed that customer complaints are not a positive effect on customer
loyalty. The higher the complaints of customers, the customers of conventional banks would
not be loyal. Customers expect when customers encounter problems with the services of the
bank, then the conventional bank is able to solve problems that customers face is to offer a
satisfactory solution. This is also consistent with the influence of the complaint to the
satisfaction. In addition, customers also expect simplicity in the complaint to be filed by the
customer quickly, whenever and wherever the customer is located.
The availability of call center facilities in all conventional bank is expected to address
the issue of complaints / customer complaints quickly, precisely and accurately. Call center
facilities in all conventional bank is expected able to accommodate all customer complaints
naturally for 24 hours so reduce the number of customer dissatisfaction in conventional banks.
The faster the conventional banks in terms of handling complaints experienced by customers,
the level of customer satisfaction will also increase. In addition to 24-hour call center facility
in conventional banking, the grievance directly to customer service on each bank is also still
performed. In addition, media suggestion box also still be applied as a medium of
communication of complaints from customers when performing banking transactions. All
these things can not be separated from the main purpose as a means of forming satisfaction,
so as to create customer loyalty.
The results of this study do not support research You and Loh (2006), Tronvoll (2007) which
states that the positive influence between the variables of customer complaints on customer
loyalty.
The analysis showed that service quality has positive influence on customer loyalty.
Conventional banks have managed to build quality services that can ultimately build customer
loyalty. Customers who obtain good quality services of conventional banks, the customer will
be loyal. When a loyal customer, then the customer would make conventional banks as the
first choice for banking transactions and make recommendations to the relatives and
colleagues as a form of customer loyalty to the conventional banks.
Conventional banks need to pay attention to the loyalty of its customers, because there
are some customers who are not willing to give good information to others, are not willing to
do a transaction re in conventional banks, and some customers still consider his wishes can
not be met by conventional banks. Although the number of customers who are not loyal to the
conventional banks are relatively small, but it can give no good effect with regard to customer
loyalty. This is because customers feel dissatisfied with conventional banks, would give bad
information to others associated with conventional banks. However, the number of customers
of conventional banks are not loyal relatively small so that the customers of conventional
banks are loyal will donate more related to the willingness of customers to provide good
information to others (worth of mouth positive) and was able to convince others as a strategy
to attract new customers.
These results are consistent with studies that have been conducted by Cristobal, et al.
(2007), Dewi, et al (2014), You and Loh (2006), Tronvoll (2007), and Abdurrahman and
131
Suryadi (2009) which states that the positive influence between the variables of service
quality on customer loyalty. However, the results of this study do not support research
Hidayat (2009) which stated the quality of service is not a positive influence on loyalty.
The analysis showed that response to changes in the cost is not a positive effect on customer
loyalty. Conventional banks have not managed to build customer loyalty derived from the
responses change banking charges. Changes in rates of banking services that are currently
going on to prove the existence of a considerable influence on the response to conventional
bank customer loyalty.
The higher the cost of the changes experienced by the customer, then the customer intentions
to switch over to other service providers are also getting bigger, and vice versa. This resulted
in the formation of customer loyalty.
These results are consistent with studies that have been conducted by Abdurrahman
and Suryadi (2009), Karsono (2008), Kusmayadi and Hidayat (2014), and Burnham, et al.
(2003) which states that the positive influence between variable costs change in response to
customer loyalty. However, the results of this study do not support research Darpito (2010)
which states no fee change response positive effect on loyalty.
The analysis showed that customer satisfaction has positive influence on customer
loyalty. Customer satisfaction as satisfied feeling dynamically growing and growing all the
time, therefore the good relations that have been established between customers and banks
could be increased again. Good relations between customers and the bank will allow the bank
to anticipate the next plan. Conventional bank employees have knowledge and expertise in
serving the customers, especially in services related to the bank's ability to provide maximum
information about conventional products. Well-developed relationships will generate loyal
customers. Competition banking charges will not affect the customers in this case (the interest
rates and rates on the services of Islamic banks) does not affect the customer to switch from
conventional banks.
For conventional banks, the position of the customer is very important. Because of the
many ways you can do to satisfy customers so that the customers will be loyal. For example,
by providing excellent service through friendly service, employees are nimble, ATM, e-
banking and e-channel. With excellent service, the bank hopes more loyal customers. If so
slim possibility of customers switching a customer of another bank.
These results are consistent with studies that have been conducted by Cristobal, et al.
(2007), Dewi, et al (2014), You and Loh (2006), Tronvoll (2007), Abdurrahman and Suryadi
(2009), Hidayat (2009), Karsono (2008), Kusmayadi and Hidayat (2014), Burnham, et al.
(2003), and Darpito (2010) which prove the positive influence of variables of customer
satisfaction on customer loyalty.
Research Contributions
Theoretically, this research could contribute to reinforce the concept of change
response relationship and the cost of customer satisfaction Karsono (2008) which states that
the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty has a positive and significant relationship.
Development theory is based on the reliability of service quality (reliability), responsiveness
(responsiveness), assurance (assurance), empathy (empathy), and physical evidence
(tangibles) in conventional banks. The measurements refer to the theories expressed by
Parasuraman, et al. (1988) which states that the quality which consists of reliability
(reliability), responsiveness (responsiveness), assurance (assurance), empathy (empathy), and
physical evidence (tangibles) against conventional banks influence the development and
formation of loyalty. This study shows that service quality has positive influence on customer
loyalty. Results of this study explained that the better the quality of the services provided by
conventional banks, the conventional bank customers will be more loyal. So this is consistent
with the theory Cristobal, et al. (2007), Dewi, et al (2014), You and Loh (2006), Tronvoll
(2007), Abdurrahman and Suryadi (2009).
132
Strengthen the concept of relationship satisfaction and loyalty of Cristobal, et al.
(2007), Dewi, et al (2014), You and Loh (2006), Tronvoll (2007), Abdurrahman and Suryadi
(2009), Hidayat (2009), Kusmayadi and Hidayat (2014), Burnham, et al. (2003), Darpito
(2010) which states that the relationship between satisfaction and loyalty has a positive and
significant relationship.
The results can be used to increase the resources of employees in the customer
satisfaction program. Satisfied customers will trigger a long-term relationship with
conventional banks can strengthen loyalty in conventional banks.
Results of this research show the importance of giving a good understanding of
conventional banks to customers, because customers are loyal customers who have a
sufficient level of knowledge will be a product / service at a conventional bank.
Conclusion
Changes in the cost of banking services that are currently happening positively affects
customer satisfaction conventional bank. Meaning that if the perceived high cost of change,
then the customers tend to prefer to seek alternatives other services are considered more
satisfactory and in accordance with customer expectations. Conversely, if a low cost changes
then clients will respond satisfaction with banking services that customers use today.
Conventional banking service quality has positive effect on customer loyalty.
Customers who obtain good quality services of conventional banks, the customer will be
loyal. When a loyal customer, then the customer would make conventional banks as the first
choice for banking transactions and make recommendations to the relatives and colleagues as
a form of loyalty to the conventional banks. Although the number of customers who are not
loyal to the conventional banks are relatively small, but it can give no good effect with regard
to customer loyalty. This is because customers feel dissatisfied with conventional banks,
would give bad information to others associated with conventional banks.
Customers who are satisfied will be loyal to a conventional bank. Loyalty in this case
the customer will provide good information to others on a conventional bank, so as to attract
convince others to capitalize on Conventional banks, willing to reuse services of conventional
banks, to feel their needs have been met by conventional banks and make conventional banks
as the primary choice.
References
Abdurrahman, T., & Suryadi, N., 2009, Effect of Service Quality, Customer Satisfaction and
Switching Cost to Customer Loyalty: Study on Mobile Telephone Subscribers in
Malang, Journal Application Management, ISSN: 1693 to 5241, 7 (1), 188-210.
Aydin, S., Ozer, G. & Arasil, O., 2005, Customer Loyalty and the effect of switching as A
Moderator Variable Costs: A Case in the Turkish Mobile Phone Market, Journal of
Marketing Intelligence & Planning, 23 (1) , 89.
Bauman, C., Burton, S., Elliott, G., & Kehr, HM, 2007, Prediction of Attitude and Behavioral
Intentions in Retail Banking, International Journal of Bank Marketing, 25 (2), 102-
116.
Bendapudi, N., & Berry, LL, 1997, Customers Motivations for Maintaining Relationships
with Service Providers, Journal of Retailing, 73, 15-37.
Blodgett, J.G. & Andeson, RD, 2000, A Bayesian Network Model of The Consumer
Complaint Process, Journal of Service Research, 2 (2), 321-338.
Bloemer, J., Ruyter, K., & Peeters, P., 1998, Investigating Bank Drivers of Loyalty: The
Complex Relationship Between Image, Service, Quality and Satisfaction,
International Journal of Bank Marketing, 16 (7), 276-286 ,
Burnham, FY, Frels, J.K. & Mahajan, V., 2003, the Consumer Switching Costs: A Typology
antecedents and Consequences, Academy of Marketing Science Journal, 31 (2), 109-
126.
133
Cristobal, E., Flavian, C., & Guinaliu, M., 2007, e- Perceived Service Quality (PeSQ)
measurment Validation and Effects on Customer Satisfaction and Loyalty Web Site,
Managing Service Quality, 17 (3), 317-340 ,
Darpito, SH 2010, The role of Switching Costs on Strengthening Effect of Service Quality on
Customer Loyalty, Karisma, 4 (2), 118-131.
Dewi, GAPRK, Yasa, NNK, and Sukaatmadja, PG, 2014, Effect of Service Quality on
Customer Satisfaction and Loyalty PT BPR Hockey in Tabanan, E-journal
Economics and Business, University of Udayana 3.5, ISSN: 2337 to 3067, 257-275.
Dick, AS, & Basu, K., 1994, Customer Loyalty: Toward an Integrated Conceptual
Framework, Journal of the Academy of Marketing Science, 22 (2), 99-113.
Ferdinand, A., 2006, Structural Equation Modelling in Management Research, Issue 4,
Semarang, Publisher Agency Diponegoro University.
___________. 2014, Methods of Management Research: Research Guidelines for Thesis
Writing Thesis and Dissertation Management Science, Issue 5, Semarang, Publisher
Agency Diponegoro University.
File, KM, Cermak, DSP, and Prince, RA, 1994, Word of Mouth Effects in Professional
Services Buyer Behaviour, Service Industries Journal, 14 (3), 301-314.
Fornell, C., 1992, A National Customer Satisfaction Barometer: The Swedish Experience,
Journal of Marketing, 55 (1), 6-21.
Foster, BD, & Cadogan, JW, 2000 Relationship Selling and Customer Loyalty: An Empirical
Investigation, Marketing Intelligence and Planning, 18 (4).
Griffin, J., 2002, Customer Loyalty, Jakarta, Erland.
Harsasi, M., 2006, WOM In Service Industries: Possible Relation to Attitudes and Buying,
Business Journal Vol 15.
Hidayat, R., 2009, Effect of Quality of Service, Product Quality and Customer Value on
Customer Satisfaction and Loyalty Bank Mandiri, Journal of Management and
Entrepreneurship, 11 (1), 59-72.
Infobanknews, 2015 Banking Service Excellence Awards 2015, infobanknews.com,
http://www.infobanknews.com/2015/06/penghargaan-banking-service-excellence-
2015-majalah-infobank-bekerjasama-dengan-marketing-research-indonesia-mri-
menyelenggarakan-banking-service-excellence-2015-bsepada-kamis-4-juni-2015-
acara/ accessed July 3, 2015.
Johnston, R., 2001, Linking Complaint Management to Profit, International Journal of
Service Industry Management, 12 (1), 60-69.
Kang, G.D. 2006 The Hierarchical Structure of the Service Quality: Integration of Technical
and Functional Quality, Managing Service Quality, 16 (1), 37-50.
Karsono. 2008, Analysis Antecedents of Customer Loyalty: The Role of the complaint and
Customer Satisfaction Telkom Flexi Trendy in Surakarta, Media Business and
Management Research, 8 (1), 93-124.
You, A., & Loh, EW, 2006, The Effects of Service Recovery on Consumer Satisfaction: A
Comparison Between Complaint and Non-Complaints, Journal of Services
Marketing, 20 (2), 101- 111.
Kotler, P., & Keller, KL 2009, Marketing Management, 13th ed., Sabran, B. (translator),
Marketing Management, Volume 1, Issue 13, Jakarta, Erland.
Kuncoro, M., 2009, Research Methods for Business and Economics: How Researching &
Writing Thesis ?, Jakarta, Erland.
Kusmayadi, T., & Hidayat, S., 2014, Effect of Satisfaction to Customer Loyalty with Variable
Switching Cost For Mediation: Study on PT Aplikanusa Lintasarta West Java Area,
Journal of Management Science & Accounting, 6 (1), 23-45.
Lam, S.Y., Shankar, V., Erramilli, M.K. & Murthy, B., 2004 Customer Value Satisfaction
Loyalty and Switching Cost: An Illustration from a business-to-business service
Context, Journal of the Academy of Marketing Science, 32 (3), 293-311.
134
Levesque, T., & McDougall, GHG., 1996, Determinants of Customer Satisfication in Retail
Banking, International Journal of Bank Marketing, vol.14 (7), 12-21.
Liu, TC, & Wu, LW, 2007, Customer Retention and Cross-Buying in the Banking Industry:
An Integration of Service Atttributes, Satisfaction and Trust, Journal of Financial
Services Marketing, 12 (2), 132-145.
Lyon, DB, & Powers, TL 2004, The Impact of Structural and Process Attributes on
Satisfaction and Behavior Intentions, Journal of Services Marketing, 18 (2), 114-121.
Markplus, inc. 2014 Indonesian Bank Loyalty Award 2014, markplusinc.com,
http://www.markplusinc.com/ibla/indonesian-bank-loyalty-award-2014/ accessed
July 3, 2015.
McCole, P., 2004, Dealing with Complaints in Services, International Journal of
Contemporary Hospitality Management, 16 (6), 345-354.
Meng, J., & Elliott, KM, 2008, Structural Investigation Relationship Between Service
Quality, Switcing Costs and Customer Satisfaction ", Journal of Applied Business
and Economics, 1, 1-14.
Mittal, V., Huppertz, JW, & Khare, A., 2008, Customer Complaining: The role of Tie
Strength and Information Control, Journal of Retailing, 84 (2), 195-204.
Mowen, JC, & Minor, M., 2001, the 5th edition of Consumer Behaviour, Harcrot College
Publisher, Inc.
Oliver, R.L. 1999, WHENCE Consumer Loyalty, Journal of Marketing, 63, 33-44.
Olorunniwo, F., & Hsu, MK 2006, A Typology Analysis of Service Quality, Customer
Satisfaction and Behavioral Intentions in Mass Services, Managing Service Quality,
16 (2), 106-113.
Patterson, PG, & Smith, Y., 2003, A Cross-Cultural Study of Switching Barriers and
propensity to Stay with Service Providers, Journal of Retailing, 79 (2), 107-120.
Powers TL, & Lyon, DB, 2002, the Complaint Using Behavior to Improve Quality Through
the Structure and Process of Service Delivery, Journal of Consumer Satisfaction,
Dissatisfaction and Complaining Behavior, 15, 13-21.
Reichheld, F., & Sasser, Jr.WE, 1990, Zero defections: Quality Comes to Services, Harvard
Business Review, 68 (September-October), 105-111.
Saleh, A., M., 2010, Public Service: Communication, Malang: UMM Press.
Santoso, S., 2002, SPSS Multivariate Statistics, Jakarta, Alex Media Komputindo.
Have now, U., 2003 Research Methods for Business: A Skill Building Approach. Fourth
Edition, New York, John Wiley and Sons Inc.
Setyawan, A., A., & Ihwan, S., 2004, Effect of Service Quality Perception on Purchase
Intention, businessman No. 07 Th. XXXI, July 11, 2014
Sheth, JN, & Mittal, B. 2004, Customer Behavior: A Managerial Perspective, Ohio: South-
Western, Mason.
Solvang, B.K. 2007, Satisfaction, Loyalty, and Repurchase: A Study of Norwegian Customer
of Furniture and Grocery Stores, Journal of Customer Satisfaction, Dissatisfaction
and Complaining Behavior, 20, 110-122.
Stauss, B., & Seidel, W. 2006, Complaint Management: The Heart of CRM, The Journal of
Consumer Marketing, 23 (1).
Sugiyono, 2002. Methods of Research Administration, Bandung, Alfabeta.
Szabo, T., D., 2009, Connected Viral, Buzz and Word of Mouth Marketing, Hungary,
Budapesta Corvinus.
Szymanski, DM, & Henard, DH, 2001, the Customer Satisfaction: A Meta-Analysis of
Empirical Evidence, Journal of the Academy of Marketing Science, 29 (1), 16-35.
Tjiptono, F., 2007, Marketing Strategy First Edition, Yogyakarta, Andi Offset.
________. 2014, Marketing Services: Research Practice Principles, Yogyakarta, Andi Offset.
Tronvoll, B., 2007, complainer Characteristics When Exit Is Closed, International Journal of
Service Industry of Management, 25 (1), 25-51
135
Ueltschy, LC, Laroche, M. Eggert, A., & Bindl, U., 2007, Service Quality and Satisfaction:
An International Comparison of Professional Services Perceptions, Journal of
Services Marketing, 21 (6), 410-423.
Wibowo, E., & Widodo, UH, 2005, the Islamic Bank ?, Why Choose Bogor, Indonesia
Ghalia.
Yu Wang, C., 2010, Service Quality, Perceived Value, Corporate Image, and Customer
Loyalty in the Context of Varying Levels of Swithing Cost, Journal of Psychology
and Marketing, 27 (3), 252-262.
Zhang, Y., Chen, X., Zhao, Y. & Yao, Q., 2014, Exploring the Impact of Switching Cost on
Customer Retention in the technology Standard Competition Market, Journal of
Service Science and Management, 7, 267-276 ,
136
AN EXPLORATORY STUDY ON CONSUMERS’ BEHAVIOR
OF CANANG IN BALI: THE IMPLEMENTATION OF SOCIAL MARKETING
CONCEPT TOWARDS ECO-FRIENDLY BEHAVIOR
Ni Wayan Sri Suprapti
Faculty of Economics & Business, Udayana University
e-mail: cening_prapti@yahoo.com
Ni Ketut Purnawati
Faculty of Economics & Business, Udayana University
Ni Made Rastini
Faculty of Economics & Business, Udayana University
Sudarsana Arka
Faculty of Economics & Business, Udayana University
Eka Ardhani Sisdyani
Faculty of Economics & Business, Udayana University
ABSTRACT
This study aims to investigate consumers’ behavior of housewives in using canang. Data are
collected from 150 housewives as consumers of canang that are classified into three categories based on
the origin of the husbands and area of living. Data are also obtained from three experts in Hindu religion
and concept of canang. The result shows that in terms of daily usage of canang there are indeed
differences between consumers’ behaviors in Southern and Eastern of Bali. The difference is contributed
solely by customs and traditions. However, when warned with the scarcity of materials in the future, they
aware of the condition and start showing green behavior in using canang. They state that they are willing
to use modified canang as long as it does not alter the meaning.
This study implies that the movement of green consumer in the usage of canang materials has
emerged. Massive acceleration towards green behavior needs to be done by involving related parties
through delivery of education and socialization by adopting social marketing concepts. People should
aware that this behavior is crucial to support natural conservation.
Keywords: canang; eco-friendly consumer; social marketing
INTRODUCTION
Marketing concept has evolved from production concept to social marketing concept.
The marketing concept expands to social marketing by including the long-term welfare and
interest of the consumers and society. This encourages natural and environment conservation
in order to improve the quality of human lives. For Hindu people in Bali, in fact, the social
marketing concept has been practiced through religious rituals or customs for such a long
period of time. For instance, the Pecaruan Agung ritual that is conducted to rebalance the
137
universe after a natural disaster takes place. Another example would be the ritual of Tumpek
Bubuh to thank The God for providing us with all the plants for the wealth of human lives.
One essential product used in the rituals is called canang that is made of young coconut
leaves and fresh flowers. Both are renewable resources provided that land for planting is
available. Recently, however, the scarcity of the resources has emerged due to the decrease of
agricultural land in Bali. This situation has forced to bring in canang materials from outside
Bali. Even though the agricultural land is still widely available outside Bali, this could not
guarantee the availability of canang material in the long run; because the value added of
agricultural land is likely lower than when the land is functioned in non agricultural field.
The form and size of canang can be classified into two groups, namely (1) the style of
southern part of Bali (adopted from tradition in Badung and Denpasar city); and (2) the style
of eastern part of Bali (based on tradition in Bangli, Gianyar, Klungkung, and Karangasem
regencies). Canang of southern part of Bali is relatively bigger with more flowers in it
compare to canang of eastern part of Bali. Consequently, the price of canang of southern part
of Bali is higher. This price should have been able to lower, for example by decreasing the
size or substituting the materials with the more readily available materials. This small
innovation would work only if both the producer and consumer have the same understanding
that the changes do not lower the religious value of canang. In this case, both can be
considered acting green or eco-friendly behavior.
Consumer’s green behavior can be shown by consuming eco-friendly products, like (1)
buying product with reuse package; (2) using recycle product; and (3) using renewable raw
materials. This study aims to identify several steps to balance religious ritual with the
responsibility of eco-friendly behavior in consuming canang. Specifically, the purposes of
this research are: (1) to compare consumer behavior of buying and using canang in South and
East Bali; (2) to explain consumer attitude towards eco-friendly canang in South Bali; and (3)
to explain the intention of South Bali consumers to buy eco-friendly canang.
The term eco-friendly concerns with the base of the canang, called ceper. There are two
types of ceper, namely: (1) ceper bungkul that uses one whole of young coconut leaf; and (2)
ceper sibak that uses only one half of young coconut leaf. The concept of eco-friendly is also
limited to the following aspects: (1) the use of smaller size ceper bungkul; (2) the shift from
the use of canang ceper bungkul to canang ceper sibak; (3) the combination of ceper
materials, not only made of young coconut leaf but combined with older coconut leaf, palm
leaf, and banana leaf; or (4) the change of canang itself, without ceper at all.
LITERATURE REVIEW
138
Social Marketing
Social marketing concept is different from traditional marketing. The traditional
concept discusses various business oriented marketing activities, while social marketing focus
more on influencing people behavior in ensuring healthy lives, preventing accidents,
protecting environment, donating to the society, and increasing financial welfare. Many
definitions of social marketing exist, two of them are as follows (Lee and Kotler, 2011:7).
“Social marketing is a process that uses marketing principles and technique to
influence target audience behaviors that will benefit society as well as the individual.
This strategically oriented discipline relies on creating, communicating, delivering, and
exchanging offering that have positive value for individuals, clients, partmers, and
society at large (Nancy R. Lee, Michael L. Rotchild, and Bill Smith, 2011).”
“Social marketing is the application of commercial marketing concepts and tools to
influence the voluntary behavior of target audience to improve their lives or the society
of which they are a part (Alan Andreason, 2011).”
Based on the two definitions, it can be stated that social marketing includes various
activities to change people behavior from negative to positive. All are targeted to protect
individual and society from unwanted negative impacts, now and in the future.
Green Behavior
In business, both producers and consumers are expected to have green behavior.
Producers should conduct sustainable marketing that is to arrange, promote, price, and
distribute the product in a way to protect the environment (Polonsky, 2011). The main idea of
green marketing is to increase people awareness on environmental issues and help to save the
environment by switching to green products. Thus, the purpose of green marketing is to
provide more information and choices for consumers to switch to green life style. These
aspects would drive business to develop eco-friendly products (Rex and Baumann, 2007).
Green marketing needs a strong relationship with all suppliers, middleman marketers, and
customers at most (Chan et al., 2012).
Related to green behavior, theories about attitude are applied to explain the
phenomenon (Ajzen, 1991; Kalafatis et al., 1999; Cheah & Pau, 2011). A person’s positive
attitude and intention toward green behavior can be built since the early age. Previous studies
(Rokicka, 2002; Suki, 2013; Tarkiainen and Sundqvist, 2014) that use theory of attitude show
that good attitude, subjective norms, and perceived behavioral control positively affect the
purchase intention. A study of Rashid (2009) in Malaysia finds that when consumers aware
about eco-friendly product label then they would react positively towards green marketing
139
and are willing to buy green products. Furthermore, Cheah & Pau (2011) find that social
influence determines one’s intention to consume green products.
The studies mentioned above show that consumers’ green behavior is determined by
their knowledge about environment, their attitude towards environment, subjective norms or
social pressures from the environment, and their intention to conduct green behavior.
Theories, concepts, and research findings are very relevant to adopt in social contexts,
specifically in order to increase people’s green behavior.
Green Behavior according to Hindu Perspective
Preserving green environment to Hindu Balinese has been considered important, as
stated on Hindu holy books. In Arthava Veda XVIII.I.17 (in Wiana, 2011: 67) it is stated that:
Wise people maintains and preserves three primary things that cover the universe, mainly the
earth. The forms are difference, but complement each others. The three things are water, air, and
plants as sources of food and medicines, and thus the source of lives.
For Hindu people, contact to the God can be done in four ways that is called Catur
Marga, namely: (1) Bhakti Marga, meaning Number dedication; (2) Karma Marga that is
work without expecting reward; (3) Jnana Marga, meaning dedication through science; and
(4) Raja/Yoga Marga, meaning unity with the God, (Widana, 2009: 65).
In implementing Bhakti Marga, Hindu people do yadnya by presenting holy offering
to the God, ancestors, the universe, and other living creatures. The offering takes the form of
banten or upakara, including all things related to the art of hand work from the available
materials provided by the God (Swastika, 2010:6). The materials of the offerings should
include fresh flower, fruit, water, flame, and leaf. The holy book of Bhagawadgita IX: 25:29
(in Wiana, 2009: 11 and Swastika, 2010:2) states that:
“Anyone who prays to ME offering a piece of leaf (Pattram), a flower (Puspam), one kind of
fruit (Phalam), a sip of holy water (Toyam), as long as the offerings are based on love and
sincere, I will accept”.
In Bali, these all materials are combined in an offering medium called canang.
Because the offering media always needs flowers, leaves, fruits, water, and flame, people
would learn either directly or indirectly that they have to maintain and preserve the natural
environment, as all the materials come from nature. In Atharva Veda VIII.2.25 and VIII.7.10
it is stated that human and other living creatures will have welfare lives when atmosphere is
maintained properly; fertile and preserve plants/forests will clean polluted atmosphere
(Wiana, 2011:70).
140
RESEARCH METHOD
Data Collection
Research population consists of housewives categorized by husband origins. First
group is from South Bali (Badung Regency and Denpasar City) and the second group is from
East Bali (Gianyar and Klungkung Regency). In Balinese Hindu tradition, married women are
obligated to behave and adjust culture in accordance with husband origin culture, including in
preparing canang for offerings. Based on variation in canang appearance in South and East
Bali, the behavior in buying and using canang is classified into three categories.
1. Consumers with husbands’ origin of South Bali, who buy and use canang based on
tradition of this area (Group A).
2. Consumers with husbands’ origin of East Bali but live in Denpasar City or Badung
Regency. This type of consumer could show one of these two possible behaviors:
using canang according to husband’s origin; or following tradition where they live in
Denpasar or Badung (Group B).
3. Consumers with husbands’ origin of East Bali and live in Klungkung or Gianyar
Regency. Like the first group, this kind of consumers is certain to buy and use canang
in accordance with tradition of these areas (Group C).
Sample consists of 150 housewives with composition as follows: 85 persons from
Group A, 34 from Group B, and 31 from Group C. Most sample are taken from Group A
because it is the behavior of this group that is targeted to be changed to be more eco-friendly.
Data is also gathered from three experts of Hindu Religion.
Measurement
The main variables in this research are: (1) consumers’ attitude towards the eco-
friendly canang; and (2) intention to buy the eco-friendly canang. Consumers’ attitude is
measured with the following questions. How is your perception of canang that: (a) has ceper
sibak as the base, instead of ceper bungkul?; (b) has a smaller ceper as the base?; (c)
combines materials with green coconut leaves and palm leaves or banana leaves?; and (d) has
no ceper base at all? Variable of consumers’ intention is measured by the questions as
follows: Are you willing to buy canang that (a) has ceper sibak as the base, instead of ceper
bungkul?; (b) has a smaller ceper as the base?; (c) combines materials with green coconut
leaves and palm leaves or banana leaves?; and (d) has no ceper base at all?
Every question has four alternative answers, agree, less agree, not agree, and not
know. Respondent has to provide reason for every chosen answer. Before asked about the two
141
main variables, respondents are asked about their habit of buying canang, and their awareness
of the increasingly scarce materials.
Data Analysis
Data are analyzed using statistic descriptive, including mean, frequency distribution to
reduce respondents’ answers regarding the main variables. The explanation of research
variables is combined with explanation of the three Hindu experts.
RESULTS
Behavior of Buying and Using Canang
Table 1-3 show information about consumers’ behavior in buying and using canang,
including the frequency of offering the canang, basic materials of the canang, and the average
of monthly expenditure for buying canang. Below is the data of the three groups of
consumers.
Table 1. Sample Distribution Based on Frequency to Offer Canang
Frequency Group A Group B Group C Total
Number % Number % Number % Number %
Everyday 76 89,4 33 97,1 27 87,1 136 90,7
Only holiday 9 10,6 1 2,9 4 12,9 14 9,3
Number 85 100,0 34 100,0 31 100,0 150 100,0
Table 2. Sample Distribution Based on Basic Materials of Canang
Basic Materials of
Canang
Group A Group B Group C Total
Number % Number % Number % Number %
Coconut Leaves 36 47,4 12 36,4 17 63,0 65 47,8 Banana Leaves for
everyday, coconut
leaves for holidays
40 52,6 15 45,5 5 18,5 60 44,1
Others - - 6 18,2 5 18,5 11 8,1
Number 76 100,0 33 100,0 27 100,0 136 100,0
Table 3. Sample Distribution Based on Monthly Expenditure for Buying Canang
Monthly
Expenditure for
Canang (IDR)
Group A Group B Group C Total
Number % Number % Number % Number %
Offering Canang Everyday
<200.000 19 25,0 5 15,2 5 18,5 29 21,3 200.000 - <400.000 29 38,1 20 60,6 13 48,1 62 45,6 400.000 - <600.000 19 25,0 5 15,2 5 18,5 29 21,3 600.000 - <800.000 5 6,6 2 6,1 3 11,1 10 7,4
142
≥ 800.000 4 5,3 1 3,0 1 3,7 6 4,4 Sub Number 76 100,0 33 100,0 27 100,0 136 100,0 Offering Canang only on Holidays
<100.000 5 55,6 1 100,0 - - 6 42,9 100.000 - <200.000 1 11,1 - - 1 25,9 2 14,3 200.000 - <400.000 2 22,2 - - 3 75,0 5 35,7 400.000 - <600.000 1 11,1 - - - - 1 7,1
Sub Number 9 100,0 1 100,0 4 100,0 14 100,0
Table 4 presents information regarding canang with ceper base that bought daily. The
data is gathered from respondents of Group A and B, because they are the target consumers of
South Bali style of canang, while Group C is certain using canang without base as it is Bali
East tradition.
Table 4. Sample Distribution Based on Habits of Buying Canang
Canang that is usually bought Group A Group B Total
Number % Number % Number % Always buy ceper bungkul, although
know about ceper sibak
39 45,9 9 26,5 48 40,3
Always buy ceper bungkul, not know
about ceper sibak
2 2,4 12 35,3 14 11,8
More often buy ceper bungkul, rarely
buy ceper sibak
39 45,9 - - 39 32,8
Always buy ceper sibak 5 5,9 - - 5 4,2 Always buy canang in accordance with
husband’ origin tradition
- - 6 17,6 6 5,0
Depends on availability - - 7 20,6 7 5,9
Number 85 100,0 34 100,0 119 100,0
The large amounts of respondents that buy canang made of coconut leaves with ceper
bungkul state the following reasons (listed based on the most provided answer).
1. More interesting appearance, more complete ingredient, thus more confidence to
offer to the God.
2. It has been in the family tradition.
3. Only this kind of canang provided by the seller.
4. Do not know or difficult to find the seller of canang with ceper sibak.
Attitude and Intention to Buy Canang in Accordance with Eco-Friendly Concept
Before asking respondents’ attitude and intention to buy and use eco-friendly canang,
they are asked about their awareness of canang materials that become rare. This situation
indeed stresses the importance of wise usage of materials without reducing the meaning of
religious rituals and customs. Table 5 shows that most respondents (87.3%) are aware that
canang materials have become scarce, however, those who are not is still in considerable
143
amount (12%). The interesting fact is that the aware respondents are from Group A whose
relatively spend more on canang compared to other groups.
Table 5. Sample Distribution based on Awareness about Canang Materials’ Scarcity
Aware about the
scarcity of materials
Group A Group B Group C Total
Number % Number % Number % Number % No 10 11,8 4 11,8 4 12,9 18 12,0 Yes 75 88,2 29 85,3 27 87,1 131 87,3 Not concern - - 1 2,9 - - 1 0,7
Number 85 100,0 34 100,0 31 100,0 150 100,0
The aware consumers then are questioned about solutions to overcome materials’
scarcity. The followings are the answers listed based on the most mentioned.
1. Canang is made simpler and smaller, as long as in accordance with the rule.
2. Canang is made of combined materials.
3. Self-planting flowers and other plants that supply canang materials.
4. Use alternative or durable materials.
5. Offer canang only on holidays.
6. Other answers, like: (a) pray for the continuous availability of the materials; (b)
canang is only a medium, without canang praying to the God can still be done and
believe that it will not decrease the meaning of praying.
To ensure that the aforementioned solutions are to be followed up, respondents are asked
further about attitude toward eco-friendly ceper and intention to buy those product.
Data presented by Table 6 and 7 is from Group A that is potential market to
materialize eco-friendly behavior in buying and using canang.
Table 6. Sample Distribution of Group A Based on Attitude towards Eco-friendly Canang
Attittude towards
eco-friendly Canang
Canang ceper
sibak
Smaller Canang
ceper bungkul
Canang of
combination
materials
Canang without
ceper base
Number % Number % Number % Number %
Agree 51 60,0 77 90,5 79 92,9 46 54,1
Not Really Agree 23 27,1 4 4,7 1 1,2 22 25,9
Not Agree 7 8,2 2 2,4 2 2,4 15 17,6
Not Know, just follow
tradition
4 4,7 2 2,4 3 3,5 2 2,4
Number 85 100,0 85 100,0 85 100,0 85 100,0
Table 6 shows that consumers have good attitude towards eco-friendly canang. It is
indicated by agreement of using the four alternatives canang to anticipate materials scarcity.
The highest proportion is those who agree to use combination or substitution materials,
followed by smaller size of canang ceper bungkul, next is canang ceper sibak, and the last is
144
canang without ceper base. For the last case, some respondents state that their agreements are
limited, only for daily offerings not for holidays. On holidays they remain using canang with
ceper bungkul made of coconut leaves.
The positive attitudes should drive intention to buy and use eco-friendly canang. The
intention is shown on Table 7, which states that all respondents are willing to buy the four
types of canangs. Overall, proportion of intention to buy canang is lower than proportion of
attitude towards eco-friendly canang as is stated on Table 6.
Table 7. Sample Distribution of Group A Based on The Intention To Buy Eco-friendly Canang
Intention to Buy
eco-friendly
canang
Canang ceper
sibak
Smaller Canang
ceper bungkul
Canang of
combination
materials
Canang without
ceper base
Number % Number % Number % Number %
Willing to 46 54,1 76 89,4 75 88,2 43 50,6
Not Willing to 39 45,9 8 9,4 8 9,4 36 42,3
Not Know - - 1 1,2 - - 4 4,7
Not Answer - - - - 2 2,4 2 2,4
Number 85 100,0 85 100,0 85 100,0 85 100,0
DISCUSSION
The data shows that all respondents have conducted religious activities by offering
canang to the God, and more than 90 percent state that they do the offering everyday, both
respondents from East and South Bali. Those who do the offering everyday spent more
money than those who do only on holidays. To reduce the expenditure some efforts could be
done, for example, by combining the purchase of canang, that is buying coconut leaves
canang in holidays and banana leaves canang for everyday offering. As seen on Table 2, the
proportion of those offering banana leaves canang is higher than coconut leaves canang,
except for respondents from Group C. This is understandable because the price of coconut
leaves canang is higher than banana leaves canang. However, this would not be the case for
Group C, because coconut leaves canang in this area (East Bali) is smaller and does not use
ceper base. Thus, the price is also cheaper, half price in average of canang with ceper base.
Furthermore, the price of canang without ceper base (in East Bali) almost equal to banana
leaves canang sold in South Bali. Thus, it can be said that expenditure of consumers from
Group A and B (in South Bali) who use banana leaves canang for daily offerings is equal to
expenditure of consumers from Group C (in East Bali).
Combining the use of coconut leaves canang and banana leaves canang, from
economy point of view, is one effort to reduce expenditure. Indirectly, this would be an effort
to substitute canang materials, since banana leaves are easier to find than coconut leaves.
145
Whereas, for most respondents, coconut leaves canang should absolutely be used on the
holidays because of the tradition and also influenced by heart feeling. People feel more
comfortable and confidence to offer coconut leaves canang.
The use of combined canang when seen from the meaning can be explained based on
interview results with the experts, as follows.
That all Hindu obligations are sourced from the holy book of Wedha. According to the experts
there is no specific word on the book that canang has to be used in Hindu rituals. In fact, canang is
used by most people because of inability to connect to the God directly. So they need a medium to
connect, like canang. This condition is called “immanent”. On the other hand, some people are able
to connect to the God without any medium, called “transcendental” that needs high concentration. In
this case, no medium is necessary.
Considering that most of us have some kind of constraints then it would be necessary to have
media to connect with the God. The most easily used media are water, leaves, flowers, and fruits. All
these materials are assembled to become canang. Thus, it implies that in order to be able to continue
praying to the God using canang, environment must be preserved to ensure the availability of canang
ingredients.
Data also shows that most consumers have realized the scarcity of canang materials.
They provide some solutions to overcome the scarcity. Below is the discussion of the solution
alternatives.
Solution alternatives like: (a) making simpler and smaller canang; (b) using combined
materials; (c) using substitution and durable materials; and (d) offering canang only
on holidays, are short-term solutions. These are only help to cut cost of canang and
expenditure to the consumers. However, these alternatives indeed are in line with one
of eco-friendly concepts, but not included in the effort to renewable materials.
Solution alternative that proposes to cultivate canang materials plants is the basic long-
term solution. This proposal indeed needs land, but it can always be done in the own
backyard or garden. This would be in accordance with renewable concept of eco-
friendly canang. The next solution alternative says that canang is only a medium,
praying can still be done without canang. This is a transcendental solution. If more
people are able to do this then the needs of canang materials would not be worried.
However, this condition needs to be related with concept of culture in Bali. Bali has
been known as one of tourism destination that relies on its culture and customs,
including Hindu rituals. Tourism sector has been the main contributor of Bali
economy.
Awareness of canang materials scarcity together with various solutions to overcome the
problem is consistent with respondents’ attitude towards eco-friendly canang. Most of
them state that they agree with the four alternatives to overcome the scarcity, namely:
(1) using canang with ceper sibak; (2) using smaller canang with ceper bungkul; (3)
using canang with combined materials; and (4) using canang without ceper base.
These attitudes have driven respondents’ intention to buy eco-friendly canang,
although the proportion of respondents having intention to buy is smaller than those
having positive attitude towards eco-friendly canang.
The lower intention to buy can be explained by attitude theory perspective, including
Theory of Reasoned Action and Theory of Planned Behavior. Both theories state that
one’s intention to act is not only determined by his/her attitude toward a specific
object or behavior, but also by subjective norm and perceived behavioral control.
However, in the context of intention to buy eco-friendly canang, positive attitude
would be a good starting point, because attitude shows one’s tendency to like or not
146
like towards an object or specific behavior. Additionally, attitude is an internal
tendency that comes from inside and thus taken under the control of self.
Meanwhile, the subjective norm that determines consumers’ intention to buy eco-
friendly canang is one’s tendency that shows how far that person would obey other people’s
opinion. Other people in this context would include respected figures or role models who are
believed to influence people to use canang in the rituals, such as the parents who pass down
tradition, community leaders and religious experts.
CONCLUSION AND IMPLICATION
This study shows that consumption of canang in South Bali is higher than East Bali,
because differences in type, size, and material usage. But, both groups have shown
high awareness to the scarcity of canang materials. They also have positive attitude
towards four alternatives of eco-friendly canang, and show high intention to buy it.
Positive awareness, attitude, and intention to buy eco-friendly canang have driven the
exsistence of alternative solutions to the problem of scarcity. Although the alternatives
are limited to short-term solutions. The long-term solution is constrained by the land
availability to self-plant canang materials.
Positive attitude shown by individual consumer would be not sufficient to push intention
to buy. Therefore it would be necessary to involve other parties, like the role models
or respected figures to educate people about eco-friendly canang. Education is not
only important to the consumers, but also to the producers, because both of them have
equal responsibility in overcoming materials’ scarcity, preserving and renewing the
sources of materials to be used in the long term of periods. Education and socialization
should primarily consider philosophical meaning of the use of canang in accordance
with religion, and at the same time could maintain cultural side of Hindu rituals that
has been known as primary tourism attraction to support Bali economy. REFERENCES
Ajzen, I. (1991). “The Theory of Planned Behavior”. Organizational Behavior and Human Decision
Processes. Vol. 50, Iss. 2, pp. 179-212.
Baker, J.P. and Ozaki, R. (2008). “Pro-environmental products: marketing influence on consumer
purchase decision” Journal of Consumer Marketing. 25/5. pp. 281–293
Banerjee, S. B., Iyer, E.S., & Kashyap, R. K. (2003). “Corporate Environmentalism: Antecedents and
Influence of Industry Type”. Journal of Marketing, 67(2), 106-122.
Bhattacharya, S. (2011). Consumer Attitude towards Green Marketing in India. The IUP Journal of
Marketing Management, 62-70.
Chan H. K., He H., & Wang W. Y. C. (2012). Green marketing and its impact on supply chain
management in industrial markets. Industrial Marketing Management, 41(4), 557-562.
Cheah. I and I. Phau (2011). “Attitudes towards environmentally friendly products: The influence of
ecoliteracy, interpersonal influence and value orientation”. Marketing Intelligence &
Planning. Vol. 29 No. 5. pp. 452-472.
Chen, Y.S. (2008), “The driver of green innovation and green image – green core competence”.
Journal of Business Ethics. Vol. 81 No. 3. pp. 531-43.
147
Chen, Y.S. and C.H. Chang (2012). “Enhance green purchase intentions: The roles of green perceived
value, green perceived risk, and green trust. Management Decision. Vol. 50 No. 3. pp. 502-
520.
Cherian, J. and J. Jacob. (2012). “Green Marketing: A Study Of Consumers’ Attitude Towards
Environment Friendly Products”. Asian Social Science Vol. 8, No. 12. pp. 117-126.
Dono, J., Janine, W., & Ben, R. (2010). “The relationship between environmental activism, pro-
environmental behaviour and social identity”. Journal of Environmental Psychology, 30(2),
178-186.
D'Souza, C. (2004). “Eco-label programmes: a stakeholder (consumer) perspective”. Corporate
communications: An International Journal, 9(3), 179-188.
Eriksson, C. (2004). “Can green consumerism replace environmental regulation?—A differentiated-
products example”. Resource and Energy Economics, 26(3), 281-293.
Kalafatis, S.P., M. Pollard., R. East., M.H. Tsogas. (1999). “Green marketing and Ajzen's theory of
planned behaviour: a cross-market examination”. Journal of Consumer Marketing, Vol. 16
No. 5. pp. 441-460.
Kotler, P. and G. Armstrong. (2014). Principles of Marketing. 15th edition. Boston: Pearson Education
Limited.
Laroche, M., Bergeron, J., Forleo, G.B., (2001). “Targeting consumers who are to willing to pay more
for environmentally friendly products”. Journal of Consumer Marketing. 18(6). Pp. 503-520.
Lee, K. (2009). Gender Differences in Hong Kong Adolescent Consumers Green Purchasing
Behavior. Journal of Consumer Marketing, 26(2), 87-96.
Lee, N. and P. Kotler. (2011). Social Marketing: Influencing Behaviors for Good. 4th edition. Los
Angeles: Sage.
Noor, N.A.M., A. Muhammad, A. Kassim, C. Z. M. Jamil, N. Mat, N. Mat, and H. S. Salleh. (2012).
“Creating Green Consumers: How Environmental Knowledge And Environmental Attitude
Lead To Green Purchase Behaviour?” International Journal Of Arts & Sciences. 5(1):55–71
Polonsky, M. J. (2011). Transformative green marketing: Impediments and opportunities. Journal of
Business Research, 64 (12), 1311-1319.
Rahbar, E., & Wahid, N. A. (2011). Investigation of green marketing tools' effect on consumers'
purchase behavior. Business Strategy Series, 12(2), 73–83.
Rashid N. A. (2009). Awareness of eco-label in Malaysia’s green marketing initiative. International
Journal of Business and Management, 4(8), 132–141.
Rex, E., & Baumann, H. (2007). Beyond ecolabels: what green marketing can learn from conventional
marketing. Journal of Cleaner Production, 15(6), 567-576.
Sentosa, I. and N.K. Nik Mat (2012). “Examining A Theory Of Planned Behavior (TPB) and
Technology Acceptance Model (TAM) in Internet Purchasing Using Structural Equation
Modeling”. Journal of Arts, Science & Commerce. Vol. 3. 2(2). pp. 62-77.
Sudarsana, I.B.P. Ajaran Agama Hindu: Manifestasi Sang Hyang Widhi. 1998. Denpasar: Yayasan
Dharma Acarya.
148
Suki, N. Mohd. 2013. Young Consumer Ecological Behaviour: The effects of environmental
knowledge, healthy food, and healthy way of life with the moderation of gender and age.
Management of Environmental Quality: an International Journal. Vol. 24. No.6. pp: 726-737.
Swastika, I K.P. 2010. Penutuk Yadnya dan Rerahinan Hindu. Cetakan Pertama Denpasar: CV.
Kayumas Agung.
Tarkiainen, Anssi & Sundqvist, Sanna. 2005. Subjective norms, attitudes and intentions of Finnish
consumers in buying organic food. British Food Journal.Vol. 107. No. 11. Pp: 808-822.
Wiana, K. 2011. Kumpulan Artikel Weda Wakya. Edisi 2. Disunting oleh Putu Nugata. Yayasan
Mandira Widhayaka.
______. 2009. Sukmaning Banten. Surabaya: Paramita.
_______. 1999. Arti dan Fungsi Sarana Persembahyangan. Surabaya: Paramita.
149
STRATEGY FOR WOODEN CRAFT INDUSTRY DEVELOPMENT IN GIANYAR
REGENCY
I Gusti Ayu Ketut Giantari1)
, Ni Wayan Ekawati2)
. I Komang Ardana3)
and I Made Jatra4)
1234)
Management Department, Faculty of Economic and Business, Udayana University
Bukit Jimbaran Campus, Badung, Phone: (0361) 224133
ayugiantari@gmail
ABSTRACT
The purpose of this study was to determine 1) the internal and external factors affecting
the company's performance, 2) the company's business position and 3) strategy forwooden
craft industry development in Gianyar Regency. The study was conducted by taking 22
respondents through purposive sampling. The respondents are 10 mask and barong craftsmen
from Batuan District of Sukawati, 10 eagle sculpture craftsmen from Pakudui District of
Tegalalang and two barong expert barong and eagle sculpture in Gianyar. Sampling using
purposive sampling. Analysis technique used SWOT and Matrix Internal-External (IE). The
analysis shows the company's business position in IE Matrix is currently in quadrant IV while
the future of it is in quadrant I (grow and build). The proper strategy is by implemented
differentiation strategy, spesifically on the image, distribution, and promotion of the product.
Implications of this result on marketing strategy is by creating unique innovation on the
product, competitive pricing, as well as strategic distribution and promotion. Promotion can
be conducted through printed, electronic, and social media.
Keywords: development strategic, wooden craft industry, differentiation
INTRODUCTION
Gianyar is one of regions in Bali which has a variety of art works and artists. Half of the
population depend on art work. This society actively create a variety of works of art and craft
that can provide a source of life. Many companies have started to run the business and
develop it through the creative industries (Chaston, 2008). One of craft products which based
on local wisdom is wooden craft, in the form of garuda and barong statue (Atmojo, 2013).
Adaptation of local wisdom into cultural and religious ethos can be packed into a creativity
that crafts. Business management is need to be implemented in this community activitiy
(Kahane, 2012).
Baswir in Suweca (2011) states that the creative economy can not only be seen in the context
of economics, but also in the cultural dimension. Creative ideas that emerged are cultural
products. Therefore, the cultural strategy determined the direction of creative economy
development. Openness to innovation is enabling the business leadership by exploring the
ability of the organization (Lee and Ko, 2000). It is an application of creative economy as
welll. Innovation that focuses on the consumer is able to create an orientation to face the
market competition (Lewrick et al., 2012). Established companies have a notion that it is
important to develop their creativity and ensure capability of leading innovation (Johannessen
and Hugo, 2013).
One of the sectors that contribute in increasing the GDP of Gianyar Regency is the craft
industry sector (Son and Aswitari, 2012). The good reputation of the organization on the
150
domestic market is able to generate income (Ahmed et al., 2006). Barong and wood sculpture
artists are one of the SME sector in Gianyar. SMEs are recognized to have a very vital role in
the economic development of the region, as supported by previous studies (Kalpande et al.,
2010). The objectives of this study were 1) to identify opportunities and threats from external
environment that may affect the business of wooden craft in Gianyar, 2) to identify the
strengths and weaknesses from the internal environment of wooden craft in Gianyar, 3) design
the best strategy for wooden craft industries in Gianyar and 4) implement marketing strategies
for wooden craft industries in Gianyar.
THEORITICAL REVIEW
Strategy Definition
Definition of a strategy first proposed by Chandler (Rangkuti, 2003: 3) which states that
strategy is a long-term goal of an enterprise, as well as the utilization and allocation of all
necessary resources to achieve its goals. Strategy is a tool to create competitive
advantage. According to Hitt et al. (2011: 1), strategy is an integrated and coordinated set
through designed commitment and actions to improve core competencies and achieve
competitive advantage. Strategy of an organization is enable to identify a condition that
can potentially provide the best benefits and help to achieve the expected goals and direct
all resources toward a managerial system.
Vision, Mision, and Objectives
Vision and mission statements are defined as means to communicate an attitude, ethos, and
work culture that will be applied by each individual. Hoping to achieve the objectives of
the organization. Developing a vision and mission is an initial step in strategic planning
related to the achievement of organizational goals in the future (Darbi, 2012).
David (2011: 36) stated that a vision is presented briefly about the system description of its
target due to changes in science and unpredictable situations during this long period.
Vision is the early process in the development of an organization's mission. In other
words, the vision is an expectation to be achieved in the future by an organization or
company. Vision which is owned by a corporation is an ideal state in the future to be
realized by the entire personnel of the company, starting from the top level to the bottom.
Company Environment
Company environment consists of the internal and external environment. External
environment greatly affects the survival of the company. David (2011) divides the external
environment into three interrelated categories, namely remote environment, industry
environment, and operate environment. The entire environmental factors provide a number of
opportunities and threats for the company. The linkage between the environment and the
company can be described as follows.
Figure 2.1
Company Environment
Remote Environment
151
Source : Pierce & Robinson (2000:94)
Internal Environment
Umar (2001: 84) expressed the understanding to the company's internal conditions is a line
factor in the use of an effective strategy. The formulation of corporate strategy must consider
the strengths and weaknesses of the company. In order to understand the company's internal
condition, strategic internal factors through a functional approach and a "value chain" of
Porter and evaluation of internal factors strategic approach can be identified by steps as
follows: comparing these factors with the achievement of the company's competitors;
assessing the importance of each factor on industry life cycle; assessing these factors
compared to the existing competitors; and assessing these factors by comparing the key
success factors in the industry.
Strategic Planning
Strategic planning is defined as activities of the company to seek compatibility between
internal or external forces of companies in a market. The activities include observation of the
competition carefully, regulations inflation, business cycles, desires and expectations of
consumers, as well as other factors that can identify opportunities and threats (Rangkuti,
2003: 2). To determine the main strategy, made use of several matrixes with three stages of
implementation; the data collection phase, analysisphase, and decision-making stage.
Strategic Levels
In a company, basically there are three levels of strategies, which will be described in the
following sections. According to Andrews (in Rangkuti, 2003: 10)
Corporate strategy is strategy in a business, where the company will compete by altering the
distinctive competence into competitive advantage. This strategy formulated by the top
management that regulate the activities and operations in the organization which has more
than one lines or business units. At this level, it is important to determine the corporate
mission, what business is being cultivated by the company, what goals and expectations
regarding the business, and how to allocate resources.
The strategy at this level is more focused on the management of the activities and operations
of a business. Charles et al. (2012) and David (2011: 10) stated that business-level strategy is
critical to an organization. The implementation of a strategy covering all lines within the
organization, from managerial to operational role. Porter (2007: 71) in Hitt et al. (2011: 107)
states that each company must develop and implement business-level strategy that aims to
achieve a strategic market position. This can be done through the creation of different
products or services among all competitors. There are three methods of business-level
strategies, which are the low-cost strategy, differentiation, and focus strategies.
Industry
Operation
Company
152
According to Umar (2003: 25), the strategy of functional levels is a strategy that is more
operational and lead to a framework of corporate functions (traditionally it is consisting of
research and development, finance, production and operations, marketing, personnel or
human resources) that can supports the strategy at the business unit level. At this level, more
specifically formulated strategy relies on the functional activity of the management.
RESEARCH METHOD
Research Design This research uses descriptive analysis, which attempts to search and disclosure relevant
information contained in the data through more concise and simpler presentation. This
ultimately leads to the need for explanation and interpretation (Simamora, 2004). Analysis of
the company's internal environment is described in the matrix of the Internal Factor
Evaluation (IFE) and the external environment analysis outlined in the matrix of External
Factor Evaluation (EFE). Based on the IFE and EFE matrix, various combinations of the
SWOT matrix can be identified.
IFE matrix is used to determine the factors associated with the company's internal strengths
and weaknesses that are considered important and affect the performance of the company, for
example, from the aspect of management, finance, human resources, marketing, information
systems, and production (Umar, 2003). Internal analysis is important to note so that the
company can exploit to the maximize the strength and identify wether there is a source of
weakness to be corrected by the management company.
Matrix EFE (External Evaluation factor) was used to analyze matters relating to issue of
economic, social, cultural, demographic, political environment, government, law, technology,
competition in the industrial market where the company located, as well as other relevant
external data. This is important because of external factors impact directly or indirectly on the
company. This identification is very important for companies to be aware of the opportunities
and threats for the company either currently or in the future. SWOT analysis is based on the
logic that maximizes the strengths and opportunities, but simultaneously to minimize
weaknesses and threats. Strategic decision making process is always associated with the
development of the mission, goals and policy strategy. According to Koo (2004), the
formulation of a framework is developed based on the capabilities that the company is on the
right track.
Location and Scope of Research
Research will be conducted on the wooden craft industries in Gianyar. Object of research is
the development strategy of the wooden craft industry. The scope of the research is focused
on the identification and analysis of internal and external environmental conditions on
wooden craft industries in Gianyar. Considering the tight current competition, it is important
to design wooden craft business development strategies for the future.
Research Sample and Population The population in this study are business owners and decision makers in the company and
experts of wooden craft and barong mask-making in Bali. Wooden craft industry center in the
form of a mask (tapel), Rangda and Barong are in Banjar Puaya, Batuan Village, District
Sukawati, Gianyar where there are about 200 artisans. There are around 100 craftsmen of
Garuda statue in the village Pakudui, District Tegalalang. Samples for craftsmen and barong
153
mask is 10 people. Samples for eagle sculpture artisans is 10 people and as many as two-
person expert. Therefore, the total respondents were 22 people. Selection of the craftsmen
who chose sample was using purposive sampling, which is based on certain considerations.
The considerations are 1) a wood carving craftsmen in Gianyar, especially for craft barong
and statue of Garuda, 2) policy makers in the company, and 3) have extensive insight about
the condition of the internal and external environment.
RESULT AND DISCUSSION
Wooden Craft Industries in Gianyar Regency
Wooden craft industry in Gianyar has been around since 1980 but the number of craftsmen is
not so many. In 2003 the number of craftsmen who started wooden craft grown to 20.9
percent. This is in line with the development of tourism in Bali to meet the both home and
abroad both (Lestari, 2012). Potential of wooden craft in Gianyar mostly are private
companies. This showed people's interest in wooden crafts entrepreneurship Gianyar regency
quite high and opening opportunities for other communities. Wooden crafts can be considered
as the transformation of social and cultural life in the middle of the advancement of tourism
so as to provide confidence and motivation for the craftsmen to pursue the wooden craft
entrepreneurship. Wooden craft industry in Gianyar still constrained by still many industries
that do not have a patent on craft products. It proved to be only 40.78 per cent of craftsmen
who have registered a patent on the ownership of product innovation. The role of government
is needed to improve data collection and re-registration of patents on the wooden craft
products.
Analysis and Diagnosis on Existing External Strategic Environment To conduct an analysis on the external environment including opportunities and threats, we
then conducted interviews with policy makers in crafting company located in the village of
Puaya and Pakudui. We identified 10 external variables lock, namely national economic
conditions, the rate of inflation, the rate of growth of population income, government
regulation, government assistance, changes in consumer tastes, infrastructure,
communications and information easily accessible, competitors, bargaining power with the
buyer and bargaining power with suppliers.
Further analysis is to determine the weight of each variable and the rate that reflects the
condition of each variable. Lastly, the incorporation of weight with a rate that describes the
general condition of wooden craft business in Gianyar that have an opportunity or a threat.
By the weighting of each variable, it appears that there are three indicators that have the
greatest influence and affect the performance of the company, the weight communication
infrastructure and information that easily accessible indicator indicator is 0.13 (13 percent),
weight of competitor existence is 12 percent, andthe weight ofbargaining power to buyers
indicator is11 percent, while the seven other factors that influence varies between 6 percent to
8 percent.
Rate represents the respondents' perceptions to the level of importance of each factor affecting
the performance of companies which value is between 1 and 4. In Table 4.1 it can be seen that
there are six factors that represent an opportunity, namely the economy, the rate of revenue
growth, government regulation, government assistance, changes in consumer tastes and
communication infrastructure and information. There are four factors that became threat that
is, the rate of inflation, competitors, bargaining power with buyers, and bargaining power
154
with suppliers.Further calculations determined the score of each indicator by multiplying the
weight and rate. Calculation of the overall score indicator showed the value of 2.74.
Table 4.1 Existing External Factor Analysis Summary
No Opportunity / Threat Factor Weight Rate Score
Opportunities
1 National economy condition 0,10 3,00 0,30
2 Income growth in Bali 0,08 3,10 0,25
3 Government regulation 0,10 3,00 0,30
4 Government aid 0,08 3,50 0,28
5 Change of consumer desire 0,09 3,00 0,27
6 Easy access of communication and information
infrastructure 0,13 3,40 0,44
Threats
7 Inflation rate 0,09 2,10 0,24
8 Competitior existence 0,12 2,00 0,19
9 Bargaining power with buyer 0,11 2,20 0,24
10 Bargaining power with distributor 0,10 2,25 0,23
Total 1,00
2,74
Source : processed data
This figure shows that the external condition of wooden craft industry in Gianyar today in
general is an opportunity because it is greater than 2.50. Total score between 1.00 to 2.50 are
considering as threats and score from 2.51 to 4.00 are considering as opportunities. The result
of the weighting, rate, and scores are presented in Table 4.1 EFAS (External Factor Analysis
Summary).
Analysis and Diagnosis on the Future External Strategic Environment In accordance with the predictions made by the respondents, it can be explained that the
variables of competitors and bargaining power with buyers has the greatest effect on the
company's performance, which amounted to 0.12 (Table 4.2). While the second most
influential variable is the power to bargain with suppliers as well as information and
communication infrastructure by the weight of 0.11. Variable that have the third greatest
influence are aid from the government, economic conditions and changes in consumer tastes
by the weight of 0.10.
Indicators that has the highest rate is the information and communication infrastructure which
is 4.00, while the second is consumer tastes with rate 3.80 and revenue growth rate of the
population of Bali with rate of 3.70. From the calculation of the overall score of existing
indicators, the results of the calculations showed a value of 3.02. This figure shows that the
external conditions in Gianyar wooden craft industry in general is an opportunity because it is
greater than 2.50. Total score between 1.00 to 2.50 is considering as threats and from 2.51 to
4.00 is considering as opportunities. Results of prediction weights, rates and weighted values
are presented in Table 4.2 EFAS (External Factor Analysis Summary) for the future is as
follows.
Analysis and Diagnosis on Existing Internal Strategic Environment Through interviews with respondents, we identified 12 indicators that are the elaboration of
five functions contained in the company. Those function is a function of marketing (product
quality, has unique features, promotions and product prices which are relatively stable),
155
production function (quality of raw materials and low productivity), the human resources
function (abundant labor, the quality of human resources and labor skills), and function of
Research and Development (lack of support and lack of innovation).
Indicators of lack of access to sources of capital has the greatest influence on the performance
of companies with a weight of 0.12 (12 percent). While the second most influenced indicators
is a unique feature with the weight of 11 percent, followed by quality of raw materials with a
weight of 10 percent. Other indicators have a weight with variation between 0.07 to 0.09.
Table 4.2 Future External Factor Analysis Summary
No Opportunity / Threat Factor Weight Rate Score
Opportunities
1 National economy condition 0,10 3,20 0,35
2 Income growth in Bali 0,08 3,70 0,30
3 Government regulation 0,08 3,65 0,29
4 Government aid 0,10 3,50 0,35
5 Change of consumer desire 0,10 3,80 0,38
6 Easy access of communication and
information infrastructure 0,11 4,00 0,44
Threats Threats
7 Inflation rate 0,08 2,30 0,18
8 Competitior existence 0,12 2,20 0,26
9 Bargaining power with buyer 0,12 2,00 0,24
10 Bargaining power with distributor 0,11 2,00 0,22
Total 1,00
3,02
Source: processed data
Indicator of product has unique features has a rate of 3.75, the second biggest rate second rate
is the quality of the product (3.73), and the third one is abundant labor with rate of 3.65. The
rate indicates that those three indicators were considered important by respondents. While
other indicators are in the value range of rate between 2.20 to 3.60.
The last stage is the determination of the score is done multiplying the weight with the rate.
The highest score was 3:15 which is owned by indicator of product innovation. This figure
shows that the internal conditions in Gianyar's wooden craft business in general is strong
because the score is greater than 2.50. Calculation results of the weight, rate, and scores are
presented in Table 4.3 Internal Factor Analysis Summary.
Table 4.3 Existing Internal Factor Analysis Summary (IFAS)
No Strength / Weakness Factor Weight Rate Score
Strengths
1 Product quality 0,08 3,73 0,30
2 Unique feature 0,11 3,75 0,41
3 Promotion 0,07 3,50 0,25
4 Relatively stable product’s price 0,06 3,50 0,21
5 Low productivity 0,08 3,60 0,29
6 Abundance workforce 0,09 3,65 0,33
7 Human resource quality 0,08 3,50 0,28
8 Workforce skill 0,07 3,55 0,25
Weaknesses
9 Access to financial capital 0,12 2,30 0,28
10 Research and development support 0,07 2,40 0,17
156
No Strength / Weakness Factor Weight Rate Score
11 Raw materials quality 0,10 2,20 0,22
12 Product innovation 0,07 2,50 0,18
Total 1,00
3,15
Source: processed data
Analysis and Diagnosis on the Future Internal Strategic Environment Table 4.4 shows the weight calculation, rate, and scores of key internal strategic factors that
affect the company's performance. The indicators that have the highest weight is a quality
product with a weight of 0.12. This means that this indicator has a 12 percent influence on
corporate performance. While indicators of access to venture capital has the second highest
weight of 0.11, which means that this indicator has the effect of 11 percent on company
performance. Indicators which has the third highest weight is an indicator of the unique
features with a weight of 0.10. This indicator has the effect of respectively 10 percent of the
company's performance. Meanwhile, other indicators have a weight in the range of 0.06 to
0.09 so that the total weight of these indicators is 1.
The perception of respondents is then analyzed to rate each indicator. Indicator of has unique
features has the highest rate of 3.85. Indicator of abundant labor has the second highest rate,
at 3.75, while the indicators of quality of products has the third highest rate with a rate of
3.73.
Calculation result of the overall indicator score indicates the value of 3.22. This value shows
that the internal condition of the wooden craftindustries in Gianyar in the future in general is
strong because it is greater than 2.50. More detail are shown in Table 4.4
Table 4.4 Future Internal Factor Analysis Summary
No Indicator Weight Rate Score
Strengths
1 Product quality 0,12 3,73 0,45
2 Unique feature 0,10 3,85 0,39
3 Promotion 0,07 3,6 0,25
4 Relatively stable product’s price 0,08 3,5 0,28
5 Low productivity 0,08 3,65 0,29
6 Abundance workforce 0,07 3,75 0,26
7 Human resource quality 0,06 3,65 0,22
8 Workforce skill 0,06 3,55 0,21
Weaknesses
9 Access to financial capital 0,11 2,4 0,26
10 Research and development support 0,09 2,4 0,22
11 Raw materials quality 0,08 2,45 0,20
12 Product innovation 0,08 2,45 0,20
Total 1,00
3,22
Source : processed primary data
157
Strategic Position of Wooden Craft Industries in Gianyar Regency The company's strategic positioning is done after analyzing the internal and external
environment, by moving the total score into the Matrix of Market Attractiveness - Corporate
Competitiveness. At the present time, the total weight of EFAS score is 2.74, while for IFAs
is 3.14 for the present (2014). Thus, the company's position in the matrix is in Cells II (A). In
the future (year 2015-2020), total score IFAS EFAS is 3.02 and 3.22, so that its position is
increased in cells I (B). Depiction as shown in Figure 4.1.
Figure 4.1
Strategic Position of Wooden craft Industries in Gianyar Regency on Market Attraction
– Company Competitiveness Matrix (2015 – 2020)
Source: Processed data
Strategy Formulation on Wooden Craft Industries Development in Gianyar
Regency If the product of a company has a unique value or considered unique in the market, it can be
said these products have the advantage of differentiation. This strategy can be an effective
strategy to maintain market position.Differentiation strategy requires wooden craft industry to
offer something different, especially in terms of: product differentiation, is a corporate
strategy to offer products of different wooden craft product in terms of shape, size, color, and
physical structure in comparison to other companies; differentiation of the image, where the
wooden craft industry can build an image that appeals to consumers based on the good name
of the company, promotion which done by advertising, interesting company logos, and unique
product design; differentiation of services, where the craft industry of barong and eagle statue
can create differences among its competitors by providing good quality services, such as
hospitality, speed of service, and accuracy of the services; differentiation of distribution
channels, by putting its industry in a strategic location that is easily accessible to customers;
differentiation personnel, which the company may have employees who are well trained and
able to provide the best performance in products produced and hospitality in serving
consumers.
158
Marketing Strategy Formulation on Wooden Craft Industries Development
in Gianyar Regency Based on the proper competitive strategy, in this case the differentiation strategy, and when
applied to the marketing mix strategy, it can be formulated as follows: product strategy should
offer productswhich innovative and different, such as barong craft products with unique
features that further emphasize local culture. Likewise, the eagle statue should be designed
with a more attractive design; pricing strategies offer competitive price level according to the
quality of the resulting wooden crafts. Each of these craftsmen is unique so the price will be
very varied; distribution strategy, more emphasis on strategic locations to offer wooden crafts.
The strategic location should be taken into consideration in determining the store where the
product was offered, making it easier for consumers to get it; promotion strategy, which
communicates the various types of products to the public through print and electronic media.
This can be done also through social media (facebook, twitter or instagram) for cost
efficiency, in order to reach a wider and not spend any cost.
Research Limitation and Future Orientation The limitations of this study are: this study only conducted in wooden craft industry in
Gianyar thus limiting the ability to generalize the findings of this study in a larger area; this
study used a survey method in which the data collection process in a particular point in time
or in cross section while the environment is change quickly, that so important to do this
research in the future.
Future research directions can be: future researchers can conduct studies on different craft
industry, such as ikat fabric industries (endek) in Bali Province; for future studies, it is
necessary to add some new variables, such as competitive advantage and company
performance were used as basis for the formulation of corporate strategy.
CONCLUSION AND RECOMMENDATION
Conclusion Based on the analysis in the previous sections of the internal and external strategic
environment of wooden craft industry in Gianyar, it can be drawn some conclusions as
follows:
Key external strategic variables which are good opportunities in the present and in the future,
namely national economic conditions, the growth rate of population incomes in Bali,
government regulation, government assistance, changes in consumer tastes, as well as
communications infrastructure and the information easily accessible. Key external strategic
variables which are a threat to both in the present and in the future, namely inflation,
competitors, bargaining power with buyers, and bargaining power with suppliers.
The key internal strategic variables which are the strength of both the present and the future,
namely the quality of the products, unique features, promotions, relatively stable, low
productivity product prices, abundant labor, the quality of human resources, and labor skills.
While the key internal strategic variables that is a weakness are access to venture capital,
support research and development, raw material quality and product innovation;
159
Based on the business position of the wooden craft industry in Gianyar at the present time is
in Quadrant IV, while in the future are condition in quadrant I, then the proper strategy to
apply is to grow and build strategy.
Proper competitive strategy implemented by wooden craft industry in Gianyar is a
differentiation strategy. This strategy can be an effective strategy to maintain market position.
Differentiation strategy requires companies to offer different products, especially in terms of:
Differentiation of products, by givin uniqueness and accommodate the local culture;
Differentiation image, by giving a good image to customers; Differentiation of services, by
providing the best service to customers; Differentiation channel, by determining strategic
business location; and Differentiation personnel, by hiring well-trained employees so as to
provide the best performance both in the products produced and hospitality in serving
consumers.
Based on the appropriate competitive strategy in this case is the strategy of differentiation and
applied to the marketing mix are product, price, promotion and distribution.
Recommendation For wooden crafts owner / employeer: Innovate new products that emphasize culture of Bali
so unique and different from other wooden crafts business; Have partnership other wooden
craft industry to strengthen the promotional efforts in order to be better known by people all
over Indonesia; Participate in the training carried out by government-sponsored mainly by
state-owned enterprises and local owned-enterprises to obtain information on the management
of associated related to access to financial resources; Working with suppliers of raw materials
so as to produce a barong, tapel and eagle statue with the best quality; Providing the best
service to customers.
For the Government: Provide ease of access to financial resources, allowing the company to
further develop; Provide training in management sector in order make adequate financial
statements; Provide means of communication and information to promote their products to a
wider area.
REFERENCES
Abankina, T. (2013). Regional Development Models Using Cultural Heritage Resources.
International journal of Culture, Tourism And Hospitality Research, 7 (1), 3-10.
Agarwal, R., W. Grassl., J. Pahl. (2012). Meta-SWOT: Introducing a New Strategic Planning
Tool, Journal of Business Strategy, 33 (2), 12 – 21.
Ahmed, A.M., M. Zairi. K.S Almarri (2006). SWOT Analysis for Air China Performance
And Its Experience With Quality, Benchmarking: An International Journal, 13 (1), 160-173.
Atmojo, W. T. (2013). Pariwisata dan Seni Kerajinan Kayu di Gianyar Bali Kelangsungan
dan Perubahannya, http://digilib.unimed.ac.id/public/ UNIMED-Article-23579-
Wahyu%20Tri%20Atmojo.pdf diakses tanggal 7 Juli 2014.
Baykal, J., & Delagarde, M. (2011). Differentiation Strategies in the Fashion Industry.
Linneuniversitetet Degree of Bachelor in Business Administration.
160
BPS. (2014). Gianyar Dalam Angka. Badan Pusat Statistik Kabupaten Gianyar.
http://gianyarkab.bps.go.id/. diakses tanggal 7 Juli 2014.
Chaston, I. (2008). Small Creative Industry firms:a Development Dilemma?, Management
Decision, (46) 6, 819-831.
Darbi, W. P. (2012). Mission and Vision Statements and Their Potential Impact on Employee
Behaviour and Attitudes: The Case of A Public But Profit-Oriented Tertiary Institution.
International Journal of Business and Social Science , 3 (14) 95-109.
David, Fred. (2011). Strategic Management, Manajemen Strategis, Konsep. Jakarta: Penerbit
Salemba Empat.
Hitt, M. A., Ireland, R. D., & Hoskisson, R. E. (2011). Concepts Strategic Management
Competitiveness & Globalization 9th Edition. Mason, OH 45040: South-Western Cengage
Learning.
Huang, Y.F., C. J Chen., H. H. Chang. (2009). A multiple criteria evaluation of creative
industries for the cultural creativity centre in Taiwan, International Journal of
Entrepreneurial Behaviour & Research. 15 (5), 473-496.
Johannessen, A.J. dan J. Hugo. (2013). The Systemic Leaders: New Leaders in The Global
Economy, Kybernetes, 42 (1), 13 – 34
Kahane, B. (2012). Tikkun Olam : How a Jewish Ethos Drives Innovation, Journal of
Management Development, 31 (9), 938-947.
Kalpande, S.D., R.C. Gupta, M.D. Dandekar, (2010). A SWOT Analysis of Small and
Medium Scale Enterprises Implementing Total Quality Management, International Journal of
Business, Management and Social Sciences, 1(1), 59-64.
Koo, YK. Ip, L.C. (2004). BSC Strategic Formulation Frame work:A Hybrid of Balanced
Scorecard, SWOT Analisys and Quality Function Deployment. Manajerial Auditing Journal,
19(4), 33-543.
Kotler, P., dan G. Amstrong. (2012). Dasar-Dasar Pemasaran. Jilid 1. Edisi Bahasa
Indonesia. Jakarta: Penerbit Prenhalindo.
Kotler, P. (2007). Manajemen Pemasaran, Analisis Perencanaan, Pengendalian, Prentice
Hall, Edisi Bahasa Indonesia, Jakarta: Salemba Empat
Lee, S. F., & K. O. Ko., (2000). Building Balance Scorecard with SWOT Analysis, and
Implementing “Sun Tzu’s The Art of Business Management Strategies” on QFD
Methodology. Managerial Auditing Journal, 15 (1/2), 68 – 76
Pearce and Robinson. (2000). Strategic Management: Formulation, Implemenation, and
Control,UOP Special Edition Series, Irwin: Mc Graw Hill
Putra, K.A.T., L.P. Aswitari. (2012). Kebutuhan Investasi Sektor Basis Industri Per
Kecamatan Di Kabuapaten Gianyar Dalam Rangka One Village One Product (OVOV). E-
Jurnal EP Unud, 2 (12), 555-562.
161
Rangkuti, F. (2003). Analisis SWOT Teknik Membedah Kasus Bisnis. Jakarta : PT. Gramedia
Pustaka Utama.
Rangkuti, F. (2003), Riset Pemasaran. Jakarta : PT. Gramedia Pustaka Utama.
Suweca, I K., (2011). Ekonomi kreatif berbasis budaya lokal, http://economist-
suweca.blogspot.com/2011/12/ekonomi-kreatif-berbasis-budaya-lokal.html diakses tanggal 7
Juli 2014.
Umar, H., (2003). Metode Riset Bisnis, Jakarta: PT. Gramedia Pustaka Utama.
Umar, Husein. (2001). Strategic Management In Action. Jakarta : PT. Gramedia Pustaka
Utama.
Umar, H., (2010). Studi Kelayakan Bisnis: Teknik Menganalisis Kelayakan Rencana Bisnis
secara Komprehensif (Edisi 3). Jakarta : Penerbit Gramedia.
162
SOCIAL MEDIA: BRINGING REAL WORLD PRACTICES INTO BUSINESS EDUCATION
AND LEARNING
Harriet Perryer
School of Design and Art, Curtin University
Kent Street, Bentley, Perth, Western Australia, 6102
Tel: +61 8 9266 2273
E-mail: harriet.perryer@curtin.edu.au
ABSTRACT
Social networking has changed the face of interpersonal interactions outside the workplace. The
widespread use of smartphones and the introduction of Web 2.0 have rendered many traditional
communication channels obsolete. Business is now beginning to adopt these new technologies, but
anecdotal evidence suggests that business educators have been slow to recognise their value. This
paper examines options open to business and business educators in their social media communication,
concluding that there are many benefits to be gained from closer engagement with these emerging
platforms.
INTRODUCTION
Business degrees offer students a range of study opportunities designed to expand their knowledge of
the subject, whilst preparing them for the industry. With the growing number of technological
advances in recent years, the world has changed dramatically, and likewise the landscape of the
business industry has evolved. The tools available have become more sophisticated, and readily
available. Smartphones have altered the way we engage with people and online material, and the Web
2.0 Paradigm Shift occurred, making static unidirectional websites an outdated notion (Duran 2010),
along with countless other technological innovations having taken place. However, the two
aforementioned key points have played a role in the rapid emergence of social networking sites in
modern society. There is a need for this real world shift to be reflected in the teaching environments of
business educators. This paper explores the options open to businesses for their social media
communication. It goes on to compare these options and discuss emerging platforms. Finally the paper
examines the implications for business educators, concluding that there is an urgent need for faculty to
engage more with social media in order to present students with a better understanding of the business
environment in which they will be working.
CURRENT BUSINESS EDUCATION PRACTICES
At university level, typically a business degree involves a range of courses on marketing, HRM
(Human Resource Management), accounting, finance, strategy, and similar. Some degrees include
courses on business communication, but this is often limited to developing writing skills, and
addressing issues of business writing protocols. Now, 21st century companies are beginning to
comprehend the value of social networking sites as viable and effective means for reaching
consumers, clients, and potential employees. Around the world more universities have begun to offer
business degrees, which incorporate social media marketing at a basic level. However there is a need
for students to graduate with a thorough understanding of the role social media plays in their industry.
Whilst social media should not necessarily be the focus of the degree, it should definitely be a
carefully considered, and balanced component.
163
That is not to say that social media isn’t utilised in the learning environment. Many universities and
higher education institutes employ social media in an attempt to engage with students on a more
personal level. For example, the five universities of Perth, Western Australia all make use of platforms
such as Facebook and Twitter to reach students online. The University of Western Australia (News
and Media 2015), Edith Cowan University (Social Circle 2015), Murdoch University (Murdoch
University Website 2015), Curtin University (Our Social Media 2015), and The University of Notre
Dame (Contact Us 2015) each have their own unique Facebook and Twitter accounts, sharing news,
updates, and other relevant information targeted at the student body. The next step is to move beyond
using social media to reach students, and bring the concept of teaching social media theories and
practices into the classroom.
INDUSTRY: BUSINESS MARKETING
If we shift our focus from the classroom to the outside world for a moment, it can be seen that many
small and large businesses use social media for a variety of purposes. Businesses of all sizes use social
media in their daily operations, and one widely recognised use of social media for business is
marketing. However, it is important to keep in mind that there are other applications. Social media has
opened doors in the world of marketing, allowing companies to gain greater insights to their customers
and clients, resulting in more tailored products, services, and interactions. Furthermore, having a
thorough understanding of social media applications in a business can result in a competitive edge
being held over rival companies. Furthermore, social media usage has opened the lines of
communication between the message sender and message receiver, allowing for a dialogue between
consumer and company to occur. This dialogue is happening faster and more frequently yielding
positive outcomes and advancements for many involved (Kerr 2014). As a result more businesses are
now bringing social media into their marketing strategies.
INDUSTRY: PROFESSIONAL ENGAGEMENT & COMMUNICATION
Whilst the concepts of engagement and communication are both evident in marketing practices, it is
important that they are explored independently. Communication is important in any industry, and
having the ability to connect and engage with other likeminded individuals is crucial. Users have
access to a myriad of social networking sites, which will allow them to do this, however finding the
right one, and then navigating it successfully is something that takes time and practice. Professional
online engagement and communication starts with identifying the appropriate platform. It then
requires the necessary skills to engage with the right people in the right way. Often this process is
informal, and many people simply figure it out rather than have it taught to them. The connections that
are cultivated must then be maintained in order to produce real world results. This type of
communication goes beyond possessing interpersonal skills. There is a specific style to online
communication, and those wishing to engage in this form of interaction must know how to do so
effectively. Ultimately this comes down to language, and the ability to comprehend and react aptly to
online interactions.
Additionally, social media has removed many of the barriers that previously existed between online
users, whether customer, client, consumer, company, employee or employer. As a result, online
communities and forums are evidently much less formal, hosting casual dialogue, different to the
formal correspondences of the past. This change in formalities must be reflected in they way people
are engaging online. Therefore understanding the complexities of conducting online communications
is crucial. The balance between professional and approachable must be recognised, and the
conversation must constantly be evolving to ensure a level of professionalism is maintained.
164
EMERGING PLATFORMS
According to online statistics, the largest social networking site with the highest number of users is
Facebook (Sareah 2015). Other popular platforms include Twitter, LinkedIn, Instagram, and many
more. There are certain sites that are specific to individual industries, for example Dribbble is a social
networking site aimed at graphic designers, as is The Loop and Behance. These platforms have been
developed to allow this particular profession to showcase their work, build meaningful connections
with industry participants, and promote themselves in their chosen career path. In the business world,
the most widely used social networking site is LinkedIn. There are countless others that offer similar
services, however according to online statistics LinkedIn remains the most popular (Mandese 2014).
Other platforms include Biznik, a supportive space for small businesses and entrepreneurs; Focus, an
online community targeted at IT professionals; Google+, Google’s contribution to social media; and
many more (Gottlied 2015). The social media landscape is constantly changing and growing, with new
social networking sites becoming available everyday(Sollis 2013). Users have access to online
statistics, recommendations, and other sources of information that identify, and rationalise what
networks are suitable to use in a business environment. However having a comprehensive
understanding of what platforms are best suited to one’s needs, how to use them, and how to engage
with other users effectively is not always clear.
TEACHING & LEARNING APPLICATIONS
Many schools offer optional electives, which provide an introduction to social media and online
communication. However, social media learning opportunities in higher learning is limited at this
point in time. Technology and design based degrees across various universities offer students the
chance to study basic units relating to the subject. For example, in Curtin University’s Internet
Communications undergraduate degree, students are able to undertake a second year unit titled
‘Internet Communities and Social Networks’. This unit focuses on user interaction in an almost
anthropological way, encouraging students to observe and analyse how users engage with one another
in online communities (Internet Communities and Social Networks 2015). On the other hand the same
university’s Marketing major under the Bachelor of Commerce offers a second year unit titled,
‘Internet Marketing’. This unit takes a more marketing based approach, focusing on digital marketing
in an Internet setting. (Internet Marketing 2015). Whilst both these study options are valuable, there
are still vast pockets of potential content waiting to be identified and developed into teaching
packages.
This leads to the potential for teaching and learning applications, focusing on the importance of a
comprehensive understanding of social media tools, and their potential uses in a business setting.
Young generations have been raised in a world of technology. Navigating social networking sites is
second nature to many, and a large number of students enter university already with a thorough
understanding of what platforms are available and how they function. However, they don’t have a
complete understanding of how they can be used as a business professional, nor the practices involved
in using them in a professional environment.
It is imperative that a structured social media component, offering students a series of units that build
on from one another is developed for business educators. Theoretically this could start with a
foundation class outlining the basic functionality of social media, the history, the current landscape,
and the potential for future developments all presented in relation to the business environment. This
could then progress into a second unit teaching students the key concepts related to social media use in
business. This unit could potentially focus on the issues of identity and image, examining how
individuals can use social media in their professional practice. The final unit available to students
could examine how businesses use social networking sites. This could involve a practical project in
which students approach a real business without a social media presence and effectively implement
one for them. This would be accompanied by a written report discussing how the company should be
using their social media for marketing purposes, how staff should be engaging with social media,
165
policies, procedures, and such. It is important to highlight the ongoing developments in theories
concerning social media communication for educational purposes. Currently there is a plethora of
working theories and expert opinions on the subject, but there is a need for more finite and applicable
concepts to be developed.
CONCLUSION
The world is evolving, and technology is advancing at a staggering rate. The way in which social
networking sites can be used in a professional setting is changing everyday, providing new
opportunities to users. As more companies incorporate a social media approach in their marketing
strategy, understanding how to successfully navigate these platforms is becoming a necessary skill.
Furthermore, as technology has evolved so have teaching practices in order to reflect real world
situations in the classroom. For example, the Internet was once a mysterious and exclusive technology,
but now has entire degrees dedicated to the subject. Similarly social media was once an unfamiliar
concept, but now with the multitude of sites available and the billions of companies and individuals
using them, it is crucial that this development is recognised in teaching practices. Social networking
sites are growing exponentially, with new platforms being developed and released every day. There is
a need for these changes to be reflected in the teachings of business educators as they prepare students
for the real world. Not providing students with the learning resources to develop an understanding of
social media applications in a real world setting may potentially limit their future success. Therefore it
is a business educator’s duty to ensure students graduate with an understanding of the tools available
as well as how to use them.
REFERENCES
Contact Us. 2015. University of Notre Dame. http://www.nd.edu.au/contact-us.
Duran, Laura, "Social Media, Web 2.0 and the Paradigm Shift," Laura Duran & Associates:
Laura's Blog, May 10, 2010,
http://lauraduranpr.com/2010/02/social-media-web-2-0-and-the-paradigm-shift/.
Gottlied, Mark. 2015. 42 Leading Social Networking Sites for Business Professionals and
Entrepreneurs You May Not Know https://www.linkedin.com/pulse/42-leading-social-
networking-sites-business-you-may-know-gottlieb.
Internet Communities and Social Networks. 2015. Curtin University.
http://handbook.curtin.edu.au/units/31/318200.html.
Internet Marketing. 2015. Curtin University.
http://handbook.curtin.edu.au/units/31/318471.html.
Kerr, Douglas. 2014. 2014 Statistics and Trends for Businesses on Social Media.
https://www.marketingtechblog.com/2014-statistics-trends-businesses-social-media/.
Mandese, Joe. 2014. Ana: Linkedin Is 'the' Social Net, Finds Ad Execs Extremely Active on
All Platforms.
http://www.mediapost.com/publications/article/238788/ana-linkedin-is-the-social-net-finds-
ad-execs.html.
Murdoch University Website. 2015. Murdoch University. http://www.murdoch.edu.au/.
News and Media. 2015. University of Western Australia.
http://www.uwa.edu.au/engage/media.
Our Social Media. 2015. Curtin University. http://www.curtin.edu.au/socialmedia/.
Sareah, Faiza. 2015. Interesting Statistics for Th Top 10 Social Media Sites.
http://smallbiztrends.com/2015/07/social-media-sites-statistics.html.
Social Circle. 2015. Edith Cowan University. http://www.ecu.edu.au/social-circle/overview.
166
Sollis, Brian. 2013. The Conversation Prism by Brian Solis and Jess3. Accessed May 23,
https://conversationprism.com/.
167
SPATIAL ANALYSIS TO DETERMINE OPTIMAL LOCATION
FOR RETAIL STORE IN SLEMAN DISTRICT,
SPECIAL REGION OF YOGYAKARTA PROVINCE
Sa’duddin
1), Kuncoro Harto Widodo
2)
1,2 Center for Transportation and Logistic Studies UGM
Jalan Kemuning M-3 Sekip Sleman Yogyakarta
Phone : (+62274) 556928, 563984, 6491075, Fax : (+62274) 6491076, 552229
E-mail : saduddin@ugm.ac.id1)
, kuncorohw@ugm.ac.id2)
Abstract
The selection of retail store location is one of the most significant decisions in retail marketing mix, and a key
element for the success of retail store. Some approaches have been implemented to find the best location for
retail stores and this research focuses on a spatial approach to find the suitable and optimal location for retail
store in Sleman District. This research uses a spatial analysis method, using overlay operation to find suitable
location for retail store, and location allocation model to find selected optimal location for retail store in
Sleman District. The criteria used are buffer of selected road networks, land use (cultivated area), existing
modern stores service area, traditional markets service area, service area point of interest, natural disasters
region, population density, and building parcels centroid. The result of the spatial analysis indicates 61 most
suitable locations for retail store in Sleman District which are: Desa Sindudadi in Mlati Sub District, Desa
Condong Catur and Catur Tunggal in Depok Sub District, and Desa Purwomartani in Kalasan Sub District.
Furthemore five optimal locations: 1) Jalan Adisucipto, Desa Catur Tunggal, Depok, 2) Jalan Perumnas, Desa
Catur Tunggal, Depok, 3) Jalan Road Ring Utara, Desa Condong Catur, Depok, 4) Jalan Mozes Ghatotkacha,
Desa Catur Tunggal, Depok, and 5) Jalan Candi Sambisari, Desa Purwomartani, Kalasan.
Keywords: Location, Retail Store, Spatial Approach, Location Allocation Model
1. INTRODUCTION
The selection of retail store locations is one of the most significant decisions in retail marketing because in store-
based retailing, good locations are key elements for attracting customers to the outlets and sometimes they can
even compensate for an otherwise mediocre retail strategy mix. A good location, therefore, can lead to strong
competitive advantages, because location is considered one of the elements of the retail marketing mix that is
“unique” and thus cannot be imitated by competitors (Zentes, et.all, 2011: 203). According to Mendes and
Themido (2004: 1) one of the most important decisions a retailer can make is where to locate a retail outlet.
Because convenience is so important to today’s consumers, a retail store can prosper or fail solely based on its
location.
In terms of determining retail locations, multiple approaches are attempted to obtain the desired location,
because the accuracy of getting an ideal location is the key to the success of a retail business. Some formulas in
getting a retail location ideal is based on the criteria as well as the experience factor of the company to carry out
the determination of the location of cannibalization process by looking at competitors’ store location that have
been considered in determining retail locations.
This study tried to determine the appropriate location for the placement of minimarket retail stores with spatial
approach, so it can be used as a candidate in the addition or expansion of existing retail store location, after
which more optimal site selection can be done, tailored to the needs of the adding locations. The purpose of this
study were 1) determine the criteria used as guidelines in determining the location and placement of minimarket
retail stores; 2) determine the candidate locations appropriate to be used as a minimarket retail stores; and 3)
determine the location of minimarket retail stores.
2. LITERATURE REVIEW
168
The word retail comes from the French retail, ritelier, which means to cut or break something. According to
Levy and Weitz (2012: 6), retailing is the set of business activities that adds value to the products and services
sold to consumers for their personal or family use. According to Berman and Evans (2010: 4) retailing
encompasses the business activities involved selling goods and services to consumers for their personal, family,
and household use, while the retail trading / retailing according to Kotler and Keller (2009: 140) including all
activities involving the sale of goods or services on end consumers for use of a personal nature, and not a
business.
According to Utami (2010: 141), selection of retail locations is a strategic decision. Once the location is selected,
the retail owners must bear all the consequences of that choice. For example, considering a food retail store
locations in the area that is still new. Retail owners chose two places, opposite another store location or occupy
completely new with no other food store competitors. In making decisions regarding site selection, retailers
should think of three levels: regional, trade area, and more specific place.
Geographic Information Systems (GIS) is an important tool to help companies make successful analytical
decisions, relating to the location. Geographic information systems store and show information that can be
linked to geographic location. (Heizer and Render, 2009: 506). Geographic Information Systems (GIS) was
identified as an information system that is integrated as processed spatial data. According to the ESRI (2004) in
Irwansyah (2013: 2) GIS is a system to manage, analyze and display geographic information. Components to
build a geographic information system are hardware, software, data, methods, and people (users) as in Figure 1.
Figure 1. Components of Geographic Information System
Source: http://www.enggpedia.com/images/Components-of-GIS.jpg
Location-allocation models are mathematical formulations (Cromley and McLafferty, 2002), which aim to
identify the optimal geographical location for facilities based on the demand distribution (Alshwesh, 2014: 2).
The location-allocation model can be used to determine the best location for a new facility that provides services
and commodities for users, and people who need supplies. The location-allocation models each contains three
primary components: 1) the demand locations; 2) the candidate locations for service facilities; and 3) a distance
and/or time matrix holding distances or traveling time between services facilities and demands locations. The
demand locations represent the distribution of people or commodities that seek services or to be allocated. The
demand locations may also possess attribute information such as client locations, population and socio-economic
characteristics of the demand locations. The candidate locations for service facilities represent feasible sites that
meet a set of criteria as specified by analysts for issues such as the land size, cost and accessibility of the service
facilities. A distance matrix or a time matrix stores the distances or travel times between candidates for service
facilities and demand locations by considering the physical and social barriers such as traffic congestion,
political structure of administrative units, nature of services and others (Keane & Ward, 2002).
3. RESEARCH METHODS
This study used spatial analysis, using overlay operation to generate suitability of retail store locations, as well as
location allocation model to determine the optimal location of retail stores in Sleman. Some of the criteria were
set for the analysis. Diagram of research can be seen in Figure 1, whereas the criteria used as the basis for
determining the location can be seen in Table 1.
169
Start
Identification and
Research Question
Research
Objective
Literature Review
Determining Location
Criteria of Retail Store
Spatial Analysis
(Overlay Operation)
Suitable
Location for
Retail Store
Location Allocation
Model
Optimal
Location
Primer and Secondary
Survey
Locations
Finish
Figure 2. Research Diagram
Tabel 1. Criteria Used
No Criteria Proses Data
1. Selected network Buffer of selected road network
2. Existing Modern Store Service Area Network Analyst
3. Traditional Existing Market Service Area Network Analyst
4. Disaster Zone Area to exclude
5. Population Density Join population density data
6. Land use (cultivated area) Area to include and area to exlude
7. Point of Interest (Terminal, Train Station, Hospital, Schools, Government Offices / Private, bank, gas station, ATM, etc.)
Network Analyst
Source: 2015 analysis
4. RESULTS AND DISCUSSION
The criteria used as the basis for site selection of minimarket outlets based on spatial data in this research are
buffer of selected road network, land use (cultivated area), existing modern stores service area, traditional
markets service area, service area point of interest, natural disaster area, population density, building plots
centroid. The results of spatial analysis such as overlay technique, there are 61 candidates point of highly
suitable location for the placement of minimarket outlets namely in Desa Sindudadi in Mlati, Desa Catur
Tunggal and Desa Condong Catur in Depok, and Desa Purwomartani in Kalasan. Figure 3 shows the suitability
of locations for retail stores in Sleman.
170
Figure 3. Suitable Location of Retail Store/Minimarket in Sleman
Source: 2015 analysis
This study conducted optimization for five (5) optimal locations for the suitability of very appropriate
minimarket location. Figure 4 shows the results of optimization for five (5) selected optimal locations of location
allocation models. For more details and the address of the location coordinates of all five (5) locations can be
seen in Table 2.
Figure 4. Scenarios for five (5) selected optimal minimarket locations
1
2
3
4
5
171
Source: 2015 analysis
Table 2. Scenarios for five (5) selected optimal minimarket locations
Optimal Location
Street Name Address Demand Count Coordinates
mE mS
1 Jalan Laksda Adisucipto
Desa Catur Tunggal, Kecamatan Depok
845 433.314,22 9.139.613,66
2 Jalan Perumnas Desa Catur Tunggal Kecamatan Depok
801 434.299,18 9.140.242,36
3 Jalan Ring Road Utara
Desa Condong Catur Kecamatan Depok
678 432.812,86 9.142.240,90
4 Jalan Mozes Gatotkaca
Desa Catur Tunggal Kecamatan Depok
598 432.669,07 9.140.376,84
5 Jalan Candi Sambisari
Desa Purwomartani Kecamatan Kalasan
591 438.960,44 9.141.660,82
Source: 2015 analysis
5. CONCLUSIONS AND RECOMMENDATIONS
5.1 Conclusions
Based on the results and discussion, it can be concluded as follows:
1. The criteria used as the basis for site selection of minimarket outlets based on spatial data in this
research are buffer of selected road networks, land use (cultivated area), existing modern stores service
area, traditional markets service area, service area point of interest, natural disasters region, population
density, building parcels centroid.
2. There are 61 candidates of very appropriate location for the placement of minimarket outlets namely
Desa Sindudadi in Mlati, Desa Catur Tunggal and Desa Condong Catur in Depok, and Desa
Purwomartani in Kalasan.
3. The optimal location for the placement of minimarket outlets of five locations will be built in a row,
namely 1) Jalan Adisucipto Desa Catur Tunggal Kecamatan Depok, 2) Jalan Perumnas Desa Catur
Tunggal Kecamatan Depok 3) Jalan Ring Road Utara Desa Condong Catur Kecamatan Depok 4) Jalan
Mozes Gatotkaca Desa Catur Tunggal Kecamatan Depok dan 5) Jalan Candi Sambisari Desa
Purwomartani Kecamatan Kalasan.
5.1 Recommendations
Based on the results and discussion, some suggestions can be given as follows:
1. Keep data more updated in spatial analysis for determining the location of the minimarket outlets.
2. Need more macro analysis in determining the location of minimarket outlets so that the results
generated can be valid.
172
3. Keep the addition of several criteria in the placement location of minimarket outlets so that the results
generated can be more valid and accurate.
6. REFERENCES
Alshwesh, I. O. 2014. GIS-Based Interaction of Location Allocation Models with Areal Interpolation
Techniques, (Thesis for Doctor of Philosophy), Leicester: Department of Geography, University of
Leicester.
Berman, B. and Evans, J. R. 2010. Retail Management: A Strategic Approach, Elevent Edition, Pretince Hall:
Pearson Education, Inc.
Heizer, J., dan Render, B. 2009. Manajemen Operasi, Buku 1, Edisi 9, Jakarta: Penerbit Salemba Empat.
Irwansyah, E. 2013. Sistem Informasi Geografis: Prinsip Dasar dan Pengembangan Aplikasi, Yogyakarta:
Penerbit Digibooks.
Keane, J. & Ward, T. 2002. A computational Framework for Location Analysis. IEEE 32 (5):574-581.
Levy, M., dan Weitz, B. A. 2012, Retailing Management 8th
Edition, International Edition, New York: Mc Graw
Hill.
Mendes, A. B. dan Themido, I. H. 2004. Multi-outlet Retail Site Location Assessment. International
Transactions in Operational Research, 11: 1–18. doi: 10.1111/j.1475-3995.2004.00436.x
Kotler, P., dan Keller, K. L. 2009. Manajemen Pemasaran, Edisi ketiga belas, Jakarta: Penerbit Erlagga
Utami, C. W. 2010. Manajemen Ritel: Strateg dan Implementas Operasional Bisnis Ritel Modern di Indonesia,
Jakarta: Salemba Empat
Zentes, J., Morschett, D., dan Klein, H. S. 2011. Strategic Retail Management, Text and Internatioal Cases, 2nd
edition, Netherland: Gabler Verlag.
http://enggpedia.com/images/Components-of-GIS.jpg accessed 27 May 2015
173
AN ANALYSIS OF FACTORS INFLUENCING
REGIONAL ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT: A CASE STUDY ON THE ECONOMIC
DEVELOPMENT OF THE SPECIAL REGION OF YOGYAKARTA, INDONESIA
Fitra Prasapawidya Purna
Didin Wahyudin
Imamudin Yuliadi
Economic Department, University Muhammadiyah of Yogyakarta, Indonesia
Jalan Lingkar Selatan, Tamantirto, Kasihan, Bantul, Yogyakarta 55183, Indonesia
Wahdi Salasi April Yudhi
wyudhi@gmail.com
Sampoerna University
Mulia Business Park, Building D, Jl. MT Haryono Kav 58-60, Pancoran , South Jakarta,
Indonesia 12780
ABSTRACT
A regional economic development is a development strategy to improve the welfare of
the community in regions. The data used in this research are secondary data, in the form of
time series (2006-2012) and cross section (5 districts/cities in DIY (the Special Region of
Yogyakarta). The used analysis tool is panel data with the help of eviews 6. These results
indicate that Domestic Investment had a positive and significant effect. A one-percent
increase in Domestic Investment led to 0.10 increases in the economic growth in each
district/city. Foreign Direct Investment had a positive and significant effect; a one-percent
increase in Foreign Direct Investment led to 0.019 increases in the economic growth in each
district/city. Regional budgets had a positive and significant effect; a one-percent increase in
regional budget led to 0.10 increases in the economic growth in each district/city. Labor had
a negative and significant effect. A one-percent labor increase caused -0.67 decrease in
economic growth in each district/city. This is because a marginal increase in the number of
workers will increase marginal production. A marginal increase in production will continue
increasing if the number of workers continues being added up to a total of maximum
production. At the time of maximum total production (TP max), the increase of the number of
workers will decrease the amount of production (TP) so that production would have negative
worth.
Keywords: Regional Economic Growth, Domestic Investment, Foreign Direct Investment,
Regional Budget
INTRODUCTION
174
Development is essentially a multidimensional process which includes changes in the social
structure, changes in the attitudes of society and changes in national institutions. Development
also includes a change in the rate of economic growth, the reduction of income inequality and
poverty eradication. To achieve the desired goals, the development of a country can be
directed at three main areas, namely: improving the availability and distribution of basic
needs for the community, improving people's living standards and improving the public's
ability to access both economic activities and social activities in life (Todaro, 2004).
Economic conditions of a region may reflect the level of prosperity of a region. Economic
growth shows an increase in production in an area at a particular time period. An increase in
production is expected to increase incomes as well as an increase in the welfare of society.
Similarly, the economy in DIY (the Special Region of Yogyakarta) is not only influenced by
economic activities of its societies but also is influenced by external factors such as the
condition of the national economy and the global economy
TABLE 1 TARGET AND REALIZATION OF INVESTMENT IN DIY (in million
Dollars)
Year PMDN Growth
PMDN (%) PMA
Growth PMA
(%) Total Growth
2004 184.7666
116.8668
301.6335
2005 173.1589
-6.28 141.8212
21.35 314.9802
4.42
2006 164.9907
-4.72 144.599
1.96 309.5897
-1.71
2007 138.5795
-16.01 175.2435
21.19 313.8231
1.37
2008 138.9558
0.27 185.8047
6.03 324.7606
3.49
2009 144.8088
4.21 192.9332
3.84 337.7419
4.00
2010 144.9942
0.13 207.3882
7.49 352.3825
4.33
2011 177.9339
22.72 316.1874
52.46 494.1214
40.22
2012* 223.215
25.45 321.1032
1.55 544.3182
10.16
2013* 268.9082
20.47 329.8257
2.72 598.734
10.00
Source :BKPM Provinsi DIY(2013)
Development of investment in DIY showed significant growth in the last five years, as
presented in the above table. The greatest increase occurred in 2011, due to the realization of
new companies, the expansion of the companies which have realized their investment in
previous years, and company remodeling/renovation/restructuring which also had
implications for investment addition. The amount of the contribution of investment growth
from the Domestic Investment companies is USD 32.939.832,77 (22.72%) and Foreign Direct
Investment companies is IDR 1.414.389.366.777 (52.46%) of the total value of investment
growth until December 2011 which amounted to USD 141.739.014,8.
175
The Special Region of Yogyakarta Province is one of the areas which rely on investment as
the main foundation for its economic growth in addition to its tourism sector. Investment by
the local governments is by allocating funds for development projects to build public facilities
and infrastructures. Private investment is in the form of Domestic Investment and Foreign
Direct Investment as well as more public investment. In line with this, various policies are
implemented to facilitate the entry of private and foreign direct investment in DIY.
RESEARCH OBJECTIVES
Based on the formulation of the problem, the objectives of this research are:
1. To analyze the effect of Domestic Investment on the economic growth in DIY per
regency/city
2. To analyze the effect of Foreign Direct Investment on the economic growth in DIY per
regency/city
3. To determine how much the influence the government’s spending on the economic growth
in DIY per regency/city is
4. To determine how much the influence of labor to the economic growth in DIY per
regency/city is
LITERATURE REVIEW
Economic growth is defined by Todaro (2004) as an increase in the national product (GNP,
GDP) because there is an increase in the quantity of production factors used in the production
process. Economic growth is a change in the level of economic activity that takes place from
year to year, so to assess economic growth, the value of GNP/GDP from various years should
be compared.
Harrod-Domar’s theory (1939 and 1946) on economic growth states that the GDP growth rate
is determined jointly by the savings ratio (s) and the national capital-output ratio (k) as written
as follows:
S=sY (1)
Then the net investment (I) is defined as the change of the capital stock (K) which can be
represented by ΔK and written as follows:
I = ΔK (2)
However, as the amount of capital stock (K) has a direct relationship with the amount of
national income or output (Y), as shown by the capital-output ratio (k) then:
K/Y = k or ΔK/ΔY = k
or
ΔK = kΔY (3)
Then considering the net saving (S) must be equal to the net investment (I), then the following
equation can be written as follows:
S = I (4)
If you look at the equation (1) S = sY, equation (2) I = ΔK, and equation (3) ΔK = kΔY, it is
found out that:
I = ΔK = kΔY
Thus it can be written that:
S = sY = kΔY = ΔK = I (5)
and summarized as follows:
ΔY/Y = s/k (6)
Harrod-Domar theory clearly states that the rate of growth of GNP (ΔY/Y) is determined
jointly by the national savings ratio (s), as well as national output capital ratio (k).
176
I1 I2
In the long-term economic growth, Harrod-Domar analysis uses the following analogies: (i)
capital goods have reached full capacity, (ii) savings are proportional to the national income,
(iii) the capital-output ratio has the same value and (iv) the economy consists of two sectors.
Harrod and Domar give a key role to investments in the process of economic growth,
especially on dual character owned by investment. First, an investment has a dual role which
can create income, and the second, investment increases the production capacity of the
economy by increasing the capital stock (Jhingan, 1999). Almost all economists emphasize
the importance of the formation of investment as a major determinant of economic growth
and economic development.
The importance of the formation of investment here is that the community does not use all of
its income for consumption, but there is some which is saved and the saving is necessary for
the formation of investment. Furthermore, the establishment of this investment has been
regarded as one of the factors -even a major factor -in economic development. As an example,
investment in capital equipment or capital formation not only increases economic growth, but
also gives employment opportunities in the community. Thus there is a positive relationship
between the formation of investment and economic growth in a country (Prasetyo, 2009). In
the form of the production function, a level of output can be created by using various
combinations of capital and labor by assuming the use of a certain technological level.
FIGURE 1. NEO-CLASSICAL PRODUCTION FUNCTION
Capital
K3
K2
K1
Labor
0 L3 L2 L1
Graph 1: There were several choices to get a maximum output which refer to the production
functions as capital and labor. In point K1 with the small capital it need more in labor and the
moderate one is in point K2 and L2 the last with the small number of labor and big capital in
point K3 and L3.
Source: Todaro, 2004
According to Todaro (2004) population growth and labor force growth (AK) is traditionally
regarded as one of the positive factors that spurs economic growth. A greater number of
workers will increase the level of production, while a larger population growth means a larger
177
size of its domestic market. However it is still questionable whether the rapid growth rate will
actually give a positive or negative impact on economic development.
In a simple model of economic growth, the general understanding of labor is defined as a
homogeneous workforce. According to Lewis, unskilled and homogenous workforce is
considered to be able to move and shift from a traditional sector to a modern sector
seamlessly and in limited quantities. In such a circumstance the labor supply contains high
elasticity. Increasing demand for labor (from the traditional sector) originates in the expansion
of the modern sector activities. Thus one of the factors that influence economic growth is
labor.
According to Nicholson (1991), the production function of a good or services (q) is q = f (K,
L) in which is capital and L is labor which show the maximum number of goods/services that
can be produced by using alternative combinations between K and L. Therefore, one of the
inputs plus one additional unit and other inputs considered constant would cause additional
output that can be produced. Additional output produced is called the marginal physical
product.
Furthermore, it is said that if the amount of labor is added continuously while other
production factors remain constant, then at first it will show an increase in productivity, but at
a certain level it will show a decline in productivity. Also, after reaching the maximum output
level, each additional manpower will reduce spending.
HYPOTHESES
1. The realization of Domestic Investment value positively affects economic growth.
2. The realization of Foreign Direct Investment value positively affects economic growth.
3. Regional budget positively affects economic growth.
4. Labor positively affects economic growth.
RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
The data used in this research are secondary data - the data which are in the form of
publication data. The data are in the form of time series for the period of 1971-2012. Data
were taken from Bank of Indonesia (BI), the Central Statistics Agency (BPS), books, internet,
and a wide range of literature relevant to the title of this study.
Variable Description of this research uses Unit Root Test which is used to determine whether
the data have been stationary or not, stability test (Vector Auto Regression), Johansen Co-
integration Test followed by Granger causality test, Engle- Granger Error Correction Model
(ECM), and VECM (Vector Error Correction Model) to determine whether there is an effect
among variables and then continued with the Impulse Response Function (IRF).
According to Gujarati (1995), a significance test is a procedure used to test the truth or falsity
of the null hypothesis of the sample results. Basic thought which underlies the significance
test is a statistical test (estimator) of the sample distribution of a statistic under the null
hypothesis.
The decision to treat H0 is made based on the value of the statistical test obtained from
existing data. This study uses multivariate analysis of Vector Error Correction (VECM). Data
178
were analyzed using Eviews software and Microsoft Excel. The model in this study is as
follows: Unit Root Test, Johansen Co-integration Test, Granger causality test based on Error
Correction Model (ECM). Augmented Dickey- Fuller Test (ADF Test) is a standard
procedure to test a null hypothesis (H0) on the existence of unit root against the alternative
hypothesis (H1) of stationary series. If Yt is a series with a lag length p, then:
Yt= 0+Yt-1+t-i+1+t
Wheret follows the process of white noise;
In the first equation above the null hypothesis is γ = 0 against the alternative hypothesis γ <0.
If the absolute value of the ADF is seemingly smaller than the MacKinnon critical value, then
there is the acceptance of the null hypothesis. In other words, Yt contains a unit root. A series
which is not stationary can be made to be stationary through a process called differentiation.
Yt differentiation at the level of the first degree can be expressed as follows:
ΔYt = α0 + β1ΔYt-1 + εt
If the null hypothesis β1 = 0 is rejected then it can be concluded that Yt has been stationary in
the first degree. If this occurs then the series is said to be mutually co-integrated. Test co-
integration is done among inflation, population growth projections, the money supply, exports
and economic growth based on the approach of Johansen vector auto regression (VAR). If the
vector Xt is an endogenous vector invar with a lag length p then:
Xt = A1X1t-1 + A2Xt-2 + ... + ApXt-p + βYt + εt
In which;
Xt = endogenous variable vector
Ap = parameter matrix
βYt = d-vector of the determinant variables
εt = vector of innovation
The VAR specification can also be expressed in the form of the first difference as follows:
If there is no co-integration relationship, unrestricted VAR models can be applied. However,
if it turns out there is a co-integration relationship between the series, Vector Error Correction
Models (VECM) will be used. The number of co-integration vector can be obtained by
looking at the significance of the II, through two likelihood tests:
Maximum eigenvalue: λmax = -Tln(1-λr+t)
λ = eigenvalue obtained from the estimation of the mariks II
T = number of observations done
Statistical Trace: λtrace = (1- λi)
Causality test was done between factor variables and economic growth based on the Granger
causality. Granger Causality was conducted to determine whether there was an effect of one
variable with another variable. Granger causality only examines the relationship between
variables but does not estimate the models.
179
Causality model between the two series X1t and X2t in VAR order:
ΔCX1t = μ1 + γ11 (L) ΔX1t-1 + γ12 (L) ΔX2t-1 + α1 (β'Xt-1) + ε1t
ΔCX2t = μ2 + γ21 (L) ΔX1t-1 + γ22 (L) ΔX2t-1 + α2 (β'Xt-1) + ε2t
In which:
μ1dan μ2 = Constant drift IIij
B'Xt-1 = stationary linear combination of X1t-1 and X2t-1
The above equation can be written in a concise model as follows:
ΔXt = μ + r L ΔX + IIX + εt
Which is:
Xt = (X1t, X2t)
μ = (μ1, μ2)
r (L) = Y
II = αβ '
Δ = first difference operator
εt = vector of impulse
If the data being analyzed is not stationary but co-integrated with each other, it means that
there is a long-term relationship or can be a balance between these two variables. However, in
the short term there may not be an imbalance. Because of this imbalance, error correction
with ECM (error correction model) is needed.
Using IRF provides the possibility of researchers to be able to trace the time path of a shock
to a variable in the VAR or VECM system. IRF impact is seen from the shock of one standard
deviation of the variable and the variable itself from the first, second, third and so on.
Dynamic multiplier can be seen through IRF, but does not indicate the size of the magnitude
of the IRF. IRF can also be used to see the contemporary influence of a dependent variable if
it gets shocks or innovations of independent variables by one standard deviation.
DATA ANALYSIS AND DISCUSSION
Based on Park Test, Park test is a test for heteroscedasticity. The test is based on the method
proposed by Rolla Edward Park for estimating linear regression parameters in the presence
of heteroscedastic error terms. The probability value of all independent variables is
insignificant at the level of 1%. This indicates that there are the same variants or
homoscedasticity occurred between independent variable values and the residual of each of
the variable itself (VarUi=). Below is the result of Heteroscedastisity Test using Park Test
shown in Table 2.
TABLE 2.
HETEROSCEDASTISITY TEST USING PARK TEST
Variable Prob.
C 0.2236
LOGINVDLM? 0.0311
LOGTK? 0.2710
LOGINVAS? 0.0660
LOGREGIONAL BUDGET? 0.2976
Note: ***=significant 1%, **=significant 5%, *=significant 10%
Source : Analyzed data
180
From the table above it can be concluded that the data used as independent variable is free
from heteroscedastisity. Based on the table above, it can be concluded that multicolinearity
among independent variables does not exist. This is shown from the fact that there is no
correlation co-efficiency among variables bigger than [0,9]. The selection of this model used
the best analytical test. The complete information is presented in the table below:
TABLE : 3.
ESTIMATION RESULT OF THE INFLUENCE OF DOMESTIC INVESTMENT,
FOREIGN DIRECT INVESTMENT, REGIONAL BUDGET, LABOR
TOWARD THE ECONOMIC GROWTH IN THE SPECIAL REGION POF
YOGYAKARTA
Dependent Variable :
PDRB
Model
Common Effect Fixed Effect Random Effect
Constanta 14.85402 12.63995 14.04644
Standard error 0.768984 2.108406 0.309131
Probability 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000
Domestic investment 0.107496 -0.008014 0.109817
Standard error 0.035390 0.019457 0.006011
Probability 0.0049 0.6838 0.0000
Foreign Investment 0.019578 0.006760 0.019549
Standard error 0.008774 0.003633 0.001670
Probability 0.0333 0.0741 0.0000
Regional Budget -0.000808 -0.002225 0.102865
Standard error 0.005989 0.002285 0.034246
Probability 0.8936 0.3390 0.0062
Labor -0.632432 0.028985 -0.670749
Standard error 0.124179 0.382403 0.022955
Probability 0.0000 0.9402 0.0000
R2 0.604206 0.953926 0.620553
Fstatistik 11.44926 67.28909 3.925001
Probability 0.000009 0.000000 0.002921
Durbin-Watson Stat 0.748405 0.457604 0.763497
Source: Analyzed data
Based on model specification test conducted as well as the comparison of the best selection
test, it is decided that the regression model used in estimating the influence of domestic
investment, foreign direct investment, Regional Budget, as well as workforce toward the
economic growth of Yogyakarta Special Region is a random effect model. This model is
selected because its probability of each independent variable is more significant compared to
a fixed effect model or common effect model where each independent variable is not
significant so that a better model is the random effect model. Based on the test of model
specification conducted as well as the comparison of the best value, the regression model used
is then the random effect model. The table below shows the result of data estimation from 5
regencies during 2006-2012 (6 years).
TABLE: 4
MODEL ESTIMATION RESULT
Dependent Variable :
PDRB
Model
Random Effect
181
Constanta 14.04644
Standard error 0.309131
Probability 0.0000
Domestic
Investment
0.109817
Standard error 0.006011
Probability 0.0000
Foreign Investment 0.019549
Standard error 0.001670
Probability 0.0000
Regional Budget 0.102865
Standard error 0.034246
Probability 0.0062
Labor -0.670749
Standard error 0.022955
Probability 0.0000
R2 0.620553
Fstatistik 3.925001
Probability 0.002921
Durbin-Watson Stat 0.763497
Source: Analyzed data
From this table, the analysis model of panel data toward factors influencing PRDB (Economic
Growth) in each regency and city in Yogyakarta Special Region is then arranged and
interpreted as follows:
PDRB Bantul = -1.99E-12 (Region Effect) + Time Effect + 14.04644 +
0.109817*INVDLM Bantul + 0.019549*INVAS Bantul -
0.670749*TK Bantul + 0.102865*Regional Budget Bantul
PDRB Gunung Kidul = 7.11E-13 (Region Effect) + Time Effect + 14.04644 +
0.109817*INVDLM GunungKidul + 0.019549*INVAS
GunungKidul -0.670749*TK GunungKidul +
0.102865*Regional Budget GunungKidul
PDRB Kulon Progo = -4.06E-12 (Region Effect) + Time Effect + 14.04644 +
0.109817*INVDLM KulonProgo + 0.019549*INVAS
KulonProgo - 0.670749*TK KulonProgo+ 0.102865*Regional
Budget KulonProgo
PDRB Sleman = 1.31E-12 (Region Effect) + Time Effect + 14.04644 +
0.109817*INVDLM Sleman + 0.019549*INVAS Sleman -
0.670749*TK Sleman+ 0.102865*Regional Budget Sleman
PDRB Kota Yogyakarta = 4.03E-12 (Region Effect) + Time Effect + 14.04644 +
0.109817*INVDLM Kota Yogyakarta + 0.019549*INVAS
Kota Yogyakarta - 0.670749*TK Kota Yogyakarta +
0.102865*Regional Budget Kota Yogyakarta
In the above estimation model, it appears that the influence of cross-section variable that is
different in each regency and city in The Special Region of Yogyakarta toward PDRB
(Economic Growth) of the regencies and cities in The Gunung Kidul and Sleman Regencies,
182
and Yogyakarta have a cross-section effect (territorial effect) that each having a positive
value. Each territory has a coefficient value of 7.11E-13 (Gunung Kidul Regency), 1.3E1E-12
(Sleman Regency), 4.03E-12 (Yogyakarta). Meanwhile, in Bantul and Kulon Progo Regency
each has a negative cross-section effect (territorial effect) that is -1.99E-12 for the Bantul
Regency and -4.06E-12 for the Kulon Progo Regency.Time effect added to the analysis model
also contributes in giving different influence toward the economic growth of regencies in The
Special Region of Yogyakarta as well as the city. This can be seen from the value of the
coefficient of time variable that varies each year (table 5.3). The year of 2006 has a time
effect of -0.159927. It experienced a negative time effect because an earthquake happened
that year so that the economic growth is negative. After the earthquake, a regulation was
made (The Regulation Of Bank Indonesia Number : 8/10/Pbi/2006 About Special Treatment
Toward Post-Natural Disaster Bank Loan In The Special Region Of Yogyakarta In The
Surrounding Area In Central Java Province to help the process of economic growth recovery
in The Special Region of Yogyakarta and Central Java Province.
The year of 2000 has a time effect of -0.151458. It experienced a negative time effect because
it was still in a recovery period. The year of 2008 has a time effect of -0.163836. It has
negative value because an economic crisis occurred in USA in 2008 and since the value of
Rupiah depends on the value of Dollar, the crisis which occurred in USA affected the
economy in Indonesia especially in The Special Region of Yogyakarta. The year of 2009 has
a time effect of -0.119542 with a negative value. This was caused by the changing of
legislation in 2006 about (The Changing Of Indonesian Banking Regulation Number
8/10/Pbi/2006 About Special Treatment Toward Post-Natural Disaster Bank Loan In The
Special Region Of Yogyakarta In The Surrounding Area In Central Java Province Into The
Regulation Of Bank Of Indonesia Number : 11/27/Pbi/2009) because banking performance
and economic conditions in The Special Region of Yogyakarta and the surrounding area in
Central Java Province had not fully recovered since the earthquake on 27 May 2006. The year
of 2010 has a time effect of 0.886791 with a positive value. This was because there was the
influence of a positive trend due to the changing in legislation about banking performance in
helping the process of economic recovery in The Special Region of Yogyakarta and Central
Java. The year of 2011 has a time effect of -0.171310 that is negative because of the Merapi
eruption that happened at the end of 2010 had caused a decrease of economic growth in 2011.
The year of 2011 has a time effect of -0.120719 that is negative because of the process of
economic recovery in The Special Region of Yogyakarta due to Merapi eruption.
The statistical test in this research covers the coefficient of determinant (R2) of significance
test together (F statistical test), and individual parameter significance test (t statistical test).
Coefficient of determinant (R2) basically measures how far a model can elaborate groups of
independent variable variation. The value of coefficient of determinant is between zero and
one. The value of R2 that is small means that the ability of independent variables on the
dependent variable variation is very limited, when the value is close to one it means that
independent variables provide almost all information needed to predict dependent variables.
The result of regression from domestic investment, foreign direct investment, Regional
Budget, and workforce toward economic growth in The Special Region of Yogyakarta in each
regency and city from 2006 to 2012 shown in table 5.3 is that R2is achieved using a random
effect model of 0.620553. This means that 62,05% variable variation of economic growth in
The Special Region of Yogyakarta can be elaborated by groups of independent variable
variation of domestic investment, foreign direct investment, Regional Budget, and workforce.
The rest, that is 37,95%, is elaborated by other variables outside the models used.
The F test is used to observe whether there are influences together, i.e domestic investment,
foreign direct investment, Regional Budget, and workforce toward economic growth of The
Special Region of Yogyakarta in each regency and city from 2006 to 2012 by using the
183
random effect model with a probability value of 0.002921 (significant at 5%) that means
independent variables together influence dependent variables. Below is the t statistical test
table of PMDNPMA (domestic and foreign direct investment), Regional Budget, and
workforce toward economic growth from 2006 to 2012.
TABLE: 5
STATISTICAL TEST t
Variables Co-efficient
Regression
Prob Standard Prob
Domestic Investment (INVDLM) 0.109817 0.0000 5%
Foreign Investment (INVAS) 0.019549 0.0000 5%
REGIONAL BUDGET 0.102865 0.0062 5%
Labor (TK) -0.670749 0.0000 5%
Source : The analyzed data of the Central Statistics Agency
Table 5 shows statistic t for PMDN (domestic investment) variable of 0.109817 with the
probability of 0.0000 is significant for α = 5%. Therefore PMDM influences positively and
significantly α = 5% toward economic growth of The Special Region of Yogyakarta. PMA
(foreign direct investment) variable with t statistic of 0.019549 with the probability of 0.0000
is significant in α = 5%. Therefore, PMA influences positively and significantlyα = 5%
toward economic growth of The Special Region of Yogyakarta. Regional Budget variable
with t statistic of 0.102865 with the probability of 0.0062 is significant in. Therefore the
Regional Budget influences positively and significantly α = 5% toward economic growth of
The Special Region of Yogyakarta. Workforce variable with t statistic of 0.670749 with the
probability of 0.0000 is significant in α = 5%. Therefore the Regional Budget influences
positively and significantly α = 5% toward economic growth of The Special Region of
Yogyakarta
Based on the results of the research or model estimation above, an analysis and discussion about
the influence of independent variables (Domestic Investment, Foreign direct investment,
Regional Budget, and workforce) toward economic growth of The Special Region of
Yogyakarta is interpreted as follows:
It can be elaborated that the PMDN (domestic investment) variable influences positively and
significantly with a coefficient value of 0.109817 toward economic growth of The Special
Region of Yogyakarta from 2006 to 2012. This shows that the influence of PMDN toward
economic growth in The Special Region of Yogyakarta has a positive value. This is in
accordance with a theory proposed by Harrod and Domar that provides a key role to
investment toward its role in the process of economic growth.
Similar research had been conducted by Afrizal (2013) where PMDN significantly influenced
PDRB. The bigger PMDN conducted by government the bigger in number the availability of
public goods are. This will encourage the increase of PDRB. Based on the research above, it
can be elaborated that the PMA variable influences positively and significantly with a
coefficient value of 0.019549 towards economic growth in Yogyakarta from 2006 to 2012.
This shows that the influence of PMA toward economic growth in The Special Region of
Yogyakarta has a positive value. This is in accordance with the research by Arwiny (2011).
Foreign direct investment has an active role in encouraging the economy of a region both in
the role of technology advancement of foreign countries and a strong bond toward
international institution and the global market.
184
Based on the research above, it can be elaborated that the Regional Budget variable has a positive
and significant influence with coefficient value of 0.102865 toward economic growth in The
Special Region of Yogyakarta from 2006 to 2012. This shows that the influence of Regional
Budget toward economic growth in The Special Region of Yogyakarta has a positive value.
This is in accordance with a research by Mubaroq et al(2013). The research indicates that
Regional Budget influences positively towards economic growth. It can be elaborated that the
workforce variable influences negatively and significantly with a coefficient value of -
0.670749 towards economic growth in The Special Region of Yogyakarta from 2006 to 2012.
This indicates that the influence of the workforce toward economic growth in The Special Region
of Yogyakarta is negative and does not match with the theory by Harrod Domar that states
that the increase in output level and workforce can be achieved with the existence of capital
accumulation (investment) and saving. This is in accordance with a research by Dimas and
Woyanti (2009) that proposes that the discrepancy with the theory is because of the
characteristic of the investment. Developed countries have production factors that are capital
intensive, therefore the investment they make in developing countries similar to Indonesia
tends to be capital intensive. This is the reason why foreign direct investments tend to have
better productivity and efficiency, therefore so in order to produce as big an output, fewer
workforces is needed. Other obstacles are the lack of structural conditions, institutional, and
certain necessary attitudes (well integrated commodity market and money market, well
trained workforce in skills and planning management, motivation to be successful, and
efficient government bureaucracy) to change new capital effectively and efficiently into
bigger output and provide new employment.
Research by Siagian (2010) entitled “The Impact of Fiscal Decentralization toward regional
Economic Growth and Inequality of Region (A Case Study of West Java Province), using the
recursive model, supports this finding. The theory used – Neo-classical Production Function
Theory (Sukirno, 2004) states that the workforce will influence economic growth where the
marginal increase of workforce will increase the marginal production. Marginal increase of
production will continue to occur if the workforce is added continuously until the maximum
total production is reached. When the total production is maximum (TP max), the increase of
workforce will decrease the total production (TP) so that production will have negative value.
This finding is also supported by research done by Irawan (2012) entitled “ Factors Influencing
Post-Regional Autonomy PDRB (A Case Study in The Special Region of Yogyakarta)” that
uses GLS panel data method and states that the increase of an unskilled workforce
encourages the application of the law of diminishing returns.
CONCLUSION AND RECOMMENDATIONS
Based on the result of panel data regression on the influence of PMDN (Domestic Investment),
PMA (Foreign direct investment), Workforce, and Regional Budget toward economic growth
(PDRB) that covers each region/city in The Special Region of Yogyakarta, it can be
concluded that:
Based on the test result, Domestic Investment influences positively and significantly toward
PRDB of each region/city in The Special Region of Yogyakarta with coefficient value of
0.109817.
1. Based on the test result, Foreign direct investment influences positively and significantly
toward PDRB of each region/city in The Special Region of Yogyakarta with coefficient
value of 0.019549.
185
2. Based on the test result, Regional Budget influences positively and significantly toward
PDRB of each region/city in The Special Region of Yogyakarta with coefficient value of
0.102865.
3. Based on the test result, workforce influences positively and significantly toward PDRB
of each region/city in The Special Region of Yogyakarta with coefficient value of -
0.670749.
Based on the test result and the conclusion, the suggestions provided by the researcher in this
research are as follows:
1. Local government should be able to increase Domestic Investment in each district/city in
DIY through supporting policies. It can be done by improving infrastructure and
simplifying investment regulations so that it can increase the economic growth in DIY
by optimizing good sectors in the districts in DIY.
2. Local government is expected to attract Foreign Direct Investment by creating a
conducive investment environment as a result of quick and supporting licensing
processes. Also, the quality of human resources should be improved so that they can
increase the economic growth in DIY by optimizing good sectors in the districts in DIY.
3. Local government is expected to optimize labor in an effort to improve people’s welfare
by undertaking training to improve performance quality. In this way, labor is able to
compete and broaden job opportunities which eventually can increase the economic
growth in DIY.
4. Local government is expected to allocate regional budget effectively in the public
interest by improving infrastructure that supports development in areas which can
increase the economic growth in DIY.
REFERENCES
Afrizal, Fitra, 2013, Analisis Pengaruh Tingkat Investasi, Belanja Pemerintah. Dan Tenaga
Kerja Terhadap PDRB Di Provinsi Sulawesi Selatan, Thesis of Under Graduate,
Universitas Hasanuddin
Bank Indonesia, 2006 ,The Regulation of Bank Indonesia “Number : 8/10/Pbi/2006 About
Special Treatment Toward Post-Natural Disaster Bank Loan In The Special Region
Of Yogyakarta In The Surrounding Area In Central Java Province”, Jakarta, Bank
Indonesia.
Bank Indonesia, 2009, The Regulation of Bank Indonesia “The Changing Of Indonesian
Banking Regulation Number 8/10/Pbi/2006 About Special Treatment Toward Post-
Natural Disaster Bank Loan In The Special Region Of Yogyakarta In The
Surrounding Area In Central Java Province Into The Regulation Of Bank Of
Indonesia Number : 11/27/Pbi/2009”, Jakarta, Bank Indonesia.
Boediono, 1979, Econometric Models of The Indonesian Economy for Short Run Policy
Analysis, Dissertation of Ph.D, University of Pensylvania
Branson, W, 2000, Macroeconomic Theory and Policy, third edition, United States, Harper
and Row Publisher
Bird, R.M. and Vaillancourt,F. 2000, Desentralisasi Fiskal di Negara-negara Berkembang,
Jakarta,Gramedia.
186
BKPM, 2013, Laporan Tahunan Provinsi D.I. Yogyakarta, Yogyakarta.
Domar, Evsey, 1946, "Capital Expansion, Rate of Growth, and
Employment". Econometrica 14 (2): 137–147.
Dimas and Nenik Woyanti, 2009, “Penyerapan Tenaga Kerja di DKI Jakarta”, Jurnal Bisnis
dan Ekonomi Vol. 16, no.1, Universitas Diponegoro Semarang.
Fajriah, Arwiny, 2011, “Analisis Pengaruh Utang Luar Negeri Dan Penanaman Modal Asing
Terhadap Produk Domestik Bruto Di Indonesia Periode 2000-2009”, Thesis of Under
Graduate, Universitas Hasanuddin
Granger, CWJ and Newbold, P. 2002, Forecasting Economic Time Series, New York, San
Francisco, London, p. 333, Academic Press.
Gujarati, D. N, 2002, Basic Econometrics, fifth edition, London, McGraw-Hill.
Henderson, J. M, and Quandt R.E, 1980, Microeconomic Theory a Mathematical Approach,
third edition, International Student Edition, McGraw-Hill International Book
Company.
Hill, H, 1996, The Indonesian Economy since 1966 Southeast Asia’s Emerging Giant,
London, Cambridge University Press.
Harrod, Roy F, 1939, "An Essay in Dynamic Theory". The Economic Journal 49 (193): 14–
33.
IMF World Economic Outlook, May, Washington DC, International Monetary Fund, 1998
Intriligator, M. D, 1996, Econometric Models, Techniques and Application, Englewood
Cliffs, New Jersey USA, Prentice-Hall Inc.
Irawan, 2012, Faktor yang Mempengaruhi Pasca Otonomi Daerah PDRB (Studi Kasus di
Daerah Istimewa Yogyakarta), Under Graduate Thesis, Universitas Muhammadiyah
Yogyakarta.
Jhingan, M.L, 1999, Economic Development and Planning, Delhi, Vrinda Publications.
Kmenta, J., 2000, Elements of Econometric, second edition, London, McGraw-Hill.
Leighton, T.R. 1985, Introductory Econometrics Theory and Application, first edition, British
Library Catalog in Publishing Data, Printed in Singapore
Mankiw,G N, 2000, Macroeconomics, New York, , Worth Publisher Co.
Mubaroq et.al. (2013). Pengaruh Investasi Pemerintah, Tenaga Kerja, dan Desentralisasi
Fiskal terhadap Pertumbuhan Ekonomi Kabupaten di Indonesia Tahun 2007-2010.
Jurnal Ekonomi Pembangunan. UNPAD. Bandung.
Nopirin, 1983, A Synthesis of Monetary and Keynesian Approach to The Balance of Payments
the Indonesian Case 1970-1979, Ph.D dissertation, Washington State University,
1983, Unpublished
187
Nicholson, Walter, 1991, Microeconomic Theory: Basics and Extensions, fifth edition,
Sandiego, California, Harcourt School.
Prasetyo, Rindang and Muhammad Firdaus, 2009, “Pengaruh Infrastruktur Pada Pertumbuhan
Ekonomi Wilayah Di Indonesia” Jurnal Ekonomi Keuangan dan Pembangunan, vol 2
no. 2 Mei 2009.
Sadoulet E.and de Janvry, A. 1995 Quantitative Development Policy Analysis,
Baltimore, The John Hopkins University Press.
Scarth, W.M, 1988, Macroeconomics an Introduction to Advanced Methods, Sandiego,
California, Harcout Brace.
Siagian, 2010, Dampak Desentralisasi Fiskal terhadap Pertumbuhan Ekonomi Daerah dan
Ketimpangan Daerah (Studi Kasus Provinsi Jawa Barat), Thesis of Under Graduate,
Universitas Diponegoro
Sukirno, Sadono, 2004, Pengantar Teori Makroekonomi, Jakarta, Grafindo.
Todaro, Michael, 2004, Economic Development 8th
Edition, Boston MA, Addison Wesley.
Turnovsky, S.J, 1981, Macroeconomic Analysis and Stabilization Policy, USA, Cambridge
University Press.
Jaya , Wihana, 1990, “Seleksi Model Permintaan Uang di Indonesia 1973-1983,
JournalEkonomi dan Bisnis Indonesia, No. 2 tahun V
Zhaoyong, Zhang,1999, “China’s Exchange Rate Reform and Its Impact on The Balance of
Trade and Domestic Inflation”, Asia Pacific Journal of Economics and Business, vol.
3 No. 2 p 4-22.
188
BUSINESS MANAGEMENT AND NATIONAL CULTURE IN MONGOLIA: A
LITERATURE REVIEW
Bolormaa Boldbaatar
Business School, University of Western Australia
M261, 35 Stirling Highway, Crawley, Western Australia 6009
E-mail: Bolormaa Boldbaatar <21162583@student.uwa.edu.au>
ABSTRACT
This paper provides a review of the limited literature on business and management in
Mongolia from a cultural perspective. Mongolia is a country which is attracting significant
interest from foreign industry, but which has received little attention from business and
management scholars. The paper examines the Mongolian business culture using Hofstede’s
culture dimensions and the “Big Five” personality dimensions.
INTRODUCTION
Mongolia is a landlocked country, neighbouring Russia to the north and China to the south.
Mongolia is perhaps best known as the birthplace of Chinggis Khan, whose armies created
one of the largest empires in world history, stretching at its height from the Sea of Japan to
the Mediterranean, and from the South China Sea to the Baltic in the 12th
and 13th century
(May 2008). The Mongol Empire has not only influenced world history profoundly, but also
its distinctive management and leadership had been recognized in the world. The empire
united and regulated ethnically and culturally diverse nations for hundreds of years
successfully (Gombodorj & Tuvd 2011). However, internal struggles over succession and
leadership led to gradual collapse in 14th
century.
Having been through three different political systems, feudalism, socialism, and finally
democracy, since 14th
century, Mongolia is once again on the rise due to its cultural
distinctiveness and natural resources. Mongolia has been listed as one of the eleven countries
seen as important to world economic growth (Buiter & Rahbari 2011).
189
However, Mongolia and its culture are still not well known despite the fact that it is a rapidly
emerging country with huge business potential. As increasing numbers of multi-national
companies begin operating in Mongolia, and foreign investment pours into the country, it is
critical that foreign enterprises strategically align their business and people management to
Mongolian cultural values and beliefs for harmonious business relationships and commercial
success, since national culture can be the major determinant of the success of a multinational
organization (Dartey-Baah, 2013).
The purpose of this paper is to review literatures written on Mongolian management,
especially cross-cultural management. Considering that Mongolia has been an almost
unknown country for centuries, there is a limited body of literature available in English, and
access to literature written by Mongolian scholars is very restricted due to database
availability.
CROSS CULTURAL MANAGEMENT
Cross-cultural studies conducted by Mongolian and other nations’ researchers have used
different types of research methods and theories such as Hofstede’s 5-D cross-cultural study
model and The Big Five personality dimensions (McShane & Von Glinow 2005). Due to the
limited number of studies available, comparing research findings in the same topic or issue
was almost impossible.
Most of the cross-cultural researchers are conducted using Hofstede’s five dimensions
research model internationally. Hofstede asserts that management behaviour appear to be
appropriate in one culture may be inappropriate in another culture (Hofstede 2001).
Therefore, it is valuable to explore a nation’s cultural values, beliefs and assumptions to better
suit the nation’s management values. There are five dimensions identified: Power distance,
Individualism, Masculinity, Uncertainty avoidance, and Long-term orientation.
Power distance
190
Power distance refers to the view how less powerful people view and expect power
distribution. High in power distance means the society has high level of hierarchy. Low in
power distance signifies that people question authority and attempt to distribute power.
Scholars of Newman and Nollen (1996) propose that in low power distance countries, more
participative work units perform higher than less participative work units, and the visa versa
in high power distance countries.
Uncertainty avoidance
This refers to society’s tolerance to ambiguity, the extent to which people accept or avert by
uncertain, unknown, or unstructured situations. In organisations, planning and amending clear
procedures and policies, and system are measurements taken to avoid uncertainty.
Individualism/collectivism
This is the extent to which identity is acquired from the self as opposed to the group.
Individual cultures are loose in that individuals look out for themselves and their immediate
family. Collective society is tied to integrated relationships with extended families, groups
and communities. Individualism in organisational practices is characterised by autonomy,
individual responsibility for results, and individual rewards (Newman). Management for
collective organisations emphasize work unit solidarity and team-based rewards (Newman &
Nollen 1996)
Masculinity/femineity
Masculinity is defined by characteristics of heroism, assertiveness and material rewards for
success. Femineity refers to a preference for cooperation, modesty, caring for the weak and
quality of life.
Long-term orientation
191
This refers to a country’s time orientation to long or short term. Long-term-oriented cultures
demonstrate patience, perseverance, respect for one's elders and ancestors, and a sense of
obedience and duty toward the larger good (Hofstede 1991). Short term-oriented cultures take
a more pragmatic, according to Rarick et al (2014)
MONGOLIAN CULTURE
The scholars Rarick, Winter, Barczyk, Pruett, Nickerson & Angriawan (2014) contributed to
Mongolian cross-cultural research extensively by developing a Mongolian Cultural Portrait
with Hofstede’s 5-D model. The research findings are compared with countries of Korea,
China, Russia, India and USA. They found that Mongolian cultural values significantly differ
from these countries, except the USA in certain extent. The results indicate that Mongolian
culture is low in power distance, high in individualism, very high in masculinity, and high in
uncertainty avoidance. It can be characterized as being short-term in its orientation towards
time. Table 1 shows the scores for each dimension.
TABLE 1: RARICK ET AL’S CULTURE DIMENSIONS FOR MONGOLIA
Dimension Score Rating
Power Distance 18 Low
Masculinity 103 Very high
Individuality 71 High
Uncertainty Avoidance 92 High
Long Term Orientation 41 Short term
The low power distance score reflects Mongolians’ preference for equality in the society as
well as great power sharing in the workplace.
Masculinity score for Mongolian found to be one of the highest in the world. It indicates that
Mongolians have a preference for competition, materialism, rigid role relationship, and more
aggressive behaviour.
Low power distance coupled with high masculinity is challenging to management in that
power sharing and competitive behavior need to be taken a careful consideration.
192
Individualism is found to be significantly higher than other countries in the region. This
reflects Mongolian’s preference for individual rights and responsibilities. The downside is the
lack of a group focus. Uncertainty avoidance was scored to be the highest in comparison with
China, Russia, Korea and India, and slight lower than America. It defines that Mongolians’
strong resistance or dislike for changes, and strong policy and procedural focus. Mongolia is
significantly more short term oriented than the countries in the region. It means Mongolians
expect quick results and expect quick results. Managerial focus is generally on the present and
problems.
This study was the latest attempt of evaluating Mongolian cultural values. The study was
conducted among 50 Mongolian students between 20 and 29 years old ages. Even if there
was an equal participation between male and females, and the respondents were equally from
urban and rural areas of Mongolia, age demographic appears to have limited the survey
significantly. All of the respondents are students, and generally they do not have work
experience in the organization.
Wuet al (2011) conducted a study on personality and values used both the Big Five and the
Hosfstede’s 5-D models. It was a significant study aimed to explore personality and values
differences between North and Southeast Asian countries. The empirical study data were
collected from 18 persons belong five different hospitals in Mongolia and Taiwan.
It was found that most of the doctors and nurses from Mongolia experience high power-
distance than Taiwanese, in particular, female doctors and nurses. It is contradicting to the
Hofstede’s study result mentioned above, which found Mongolians have low power distance
in general. However, it was explained by the facts such increasing social and life pressure for
women in Mongolia, low payment, and bureaucratic management system.
Individualism in Mongolia was rated higher than in Taiwan, that Mongolian doctors and
nurses prefer to work individually, which proves the Hofstede’s research result.
Dimensions of the Big Five such as conscientiousness, agreeableness, openness, neuroticism
and extroversion were found to be neutral to the respondents from both countries. However,
Taiwanese male respondents were mostly agreeable, sociable, and conscientiousness. It is
worth mentioning that the Taiwanese medical sector employees experience better working
environment, and benefit from a insurance policy and high payment while Mongolians work
193
in the poorer working environment with low salary. Interestingly, productivity and motivation
level for work was at the same level in both countries. Another contrasting finding was that
Mongolians are found to be less talkative, which suggests that the management needs to
recognize that Mongolians are likely to be prone to express their opinions during any
negotiations at work. In contrast, Mongolians are interested in looking for different solutions
to a problem. Primary reasoning behind the personality is assumed by their traditional
nomadic lifestyle.
This was the first study aimed to explore cultural values and personality at the same time in
Mongolia; however, it was limited by its research methods such as telephone interview and
the number of participants, which is deemed to be less substantial and reliable. Further
researches need to be conducted in comparison with wider number of people from different
industries.
In contrast to these research models, scholars in Mongolia take a different approach, arguing
that imitating directly foreign management theories for Mongolians who have domination of
nomadic culture may bring huge challenges to the society. In 2011, Gombodorj & Tuvd
(2011) developed Mongolian management theory, which is considered to be one of the most
influential scientific researches in Mongolia. He argues that his Mongolian Management
theory, which originated from nomadic culture, is very significant not only to management of
state and private sectors of Mongolia, but also to foreign invested and international
organizations operating in Mongolia or employing Mongolians.
Mongolian Management theory was result the of the following extensive research activities:
Identified the development approaches of Mongolian economic and management
thought in the historical seven periods: Pre-Mongol Empire, Mongol Empire Period,
Yuan Dynasty, the 3rd
-17th
centuries, Mongolia under Qing rule or the beginning of
the 20th
century, the period of centrally planned system and the transition period into
free market economy.
Conducted comparative studies on theories, laws, concepts and models of economy
and management that are followed internationally.
Investigated personal, leadership and administrative characteristics of over 100
Mongolian khans, state activists, thinkers and outstanding political and business
194
leaders comparatively and defined their common characteristics in the complex
methodological way.
Gombodorj & Tuvd (2011) outline that management in Mongolia can be effective if the
following practices are taken into account:
Employment duration- management should consider providing short and medium term
employment in the dynamic environment because Mongolian are likely to get bored
easily.
Decision making-Employees need to be part of decision making, but they are likely to
rely on elder’s or a leaders’ decision making power.
Duty and responsibility- individual responsibility
Performance evaluation-Mongolians are the most favourable to the evaluations on
their talent, knowledge and skills.
Punishment- Mongolians highly value their reputation among others. It is likely to be
effective if a leader or a team together take corrective actions for misbehaving
employees in private setting.
Promotion-should be based on individual’s capacity for innovation, knowledge, skills
and experience.
Employee motivation-is triggered by individual’s career goals and development.
As mentioned before, the Mongolian management literature is highly reliant on literatures and
studies of nomadic cultures and history. It might be the most effective approach for
developing the country specific management practices, however, comparing and analysing the
findings with internationally recognized theories appear to make studies more reliable.
Moreover, publishing Mongolian researches and scientific studies in the international journals
will contribute to the development of Mongolian management significantly.
To better understand, what motivates professionals in Mongolia, I would like to discuss the
research conducted by Australian scholars, Pearson & Chatterjee (1999). The scholars
assessed work goals of Mongolian managers using Harpaz’s research model during the
transition period of Mongolia from socialism to free market society in 1999. The research
model is widely used in North America and European countries. The survey included 208
Mongolian managers to explore what aspects of work are more important than others.
According to the research findings, the opportunity learn was the most important goal, and
195
equally, the opportunity to improve was found to be quite important while both of these work
goals were considered to be relatively less important in the Harpaz’s studies of the
industrialised countries. Interestingly, younger managers had a substantial preference for good
interpersonal relations, however for the managers who had worked longer, matching of job
and employee, was found to be more relatively important.
This study was probably the first to record effects of macro-context changes (in Mongolia,
transition from socialist economy to free market) on the micro-level managerial work goals.
The research appears to have been limited by language barriers and interpretation of the
findings in the cultural context.
CONCLUSION
Mongolia is rich in mineral resources, and distinctive its culture. Its location between Russia
and China makes it a very important country, which once connected Europe and Asia through
Silk Road for trade. As shown in the researches, Mongolian cultural belief and values as well
as motivational factors demonstrate significant differences from the countries in the region.
Stating that performance is higher when management practices are congruent with a national
culture (Newman), international businesses operating in Mongolia should tailor their
management practices to the Mongolian’s values and beliefs for harmonious business
relationships and business success.
Literatures written on Mongolian management study are limited in both quality and quantity.
Even if there is an extensive research notion for Mongolian management theory among
Mongolian researchers, acceptability by the international standard and journals appears to be
challenging.
REFERENCES
Buiter, W. and Rahbari, E 2011). Global growth generators: Moving beyond emerging
markets and BRICs. Centre for Economic Policy and Research, April, 1-9.
Gombodorj, B & Tuvd, D 2011, 'Mongolian management theory ', in, ed. G
Enkhtuvshin, Naranbulag Printing Ulaanbaatar, Mongolia
Dartey-Baah, K 2013. The cultural approach to the management of the international
human resource: An analysis of Hofstede’s cultural dimensions. International Journal of
196
Business Administration, 4(2), 39-45
Hofstede, G 1991, Cultures and organisations-software of the mind: intercultural
cooperation and its importance for survival, McGraw-Hill.
Hofstede, GH & Hofstede, G 2001, Culture's consequences: Comparing values,
behaviors, institutions and organizations across nations, Sage.
May, T 2008, The Mongol Empire in World History, vol. 05, World History
Connected. Available from: http://worldhistoryconnected.press.illinois.edu/5.2/may.html.
McShane, S & Von Glinow, M 2005 Organizational Behavior 3e, McGraw Hill NY.
Newman, KL & Nollen, SD 1996, 'Culture and congruence: The fit between
management practices and national culture', Journal of international business studies, pp.
753-779.
Pearson, CAL & Chatterjee, SR 1999, 'Work goals in a country in transition: A case
study of Mongolian managers', International Journal of Manpower, vol. 20, no. 5, pp. 324-
334.
Rarick, GW, Barczyk, C, Pruett, M & Inge Nickerson, C 2014, 'Mongolia: A Cultural
Portrait Using the Hofstede 5-D Model', Global Journal of Management And Business
Research, vol. 14, no. 9.
197
Effect of Minumum wage, GDP and population against
Open unemployment rate in West Java in 2010-2013
Helin Garlinia Y
Faculty of Business and Management, Widyatama University
Helin.garlinia@Widyatama.ac.id
ABSTRACT
The open unemployment rate is the working age population or labor force who have never
worked and was trying to get a job, who have never worked but for some reason stopped or
terminated and is trying to get a job back, and they were relieved assigned either to be
recalled or not, but was trying to find a job. The purpose of the study is to determine how
much influence the factors that affect the rate of open unemployment in West Java. The
independent variable in this study is the GDP, the minimum wage and population. Because
the researchers wanted to see the effect of each independent variable on the open
unemployment rate. The data used to use panel data by taking 26 districts / cities in West
Java 2010-2013. The data were taken in the form of secondary data drawn from the literature
and previous research. The data is processed by using analysis of Random Effects Model
(REM) assisted with software Eviews 8 in operation. The results showed that the influence
GDP to open unemployment coefficient is 0.2464. In the minimum wage to open
unemployment coefficient is -0.1780. Population to open unemployment variable coefficient is
0.7665. The results show that the model can predict correctly used by 73.18% of the
observations for the periods.
Keywords: GDP, Minimum wage, Population, Open unemployment, Panel data, Regression
1. INTRODUCTION
Economic growth is a benchmark assessment of national economic growth. In other words,
economic growth is an indicator of the development of activity in the economy and an
indicator of prosperity and improvement of goods and services produced. Therefore, to
calculate the rate of economic growth in real national income should be calculated according
to a fixed price, which is the price prevailing in the base year chosen. So the measure of
economic growth in the presentation of the development of an economy. Since 2010 until
2013 in West Java always has a value higher economic growth compared with Indonesia.
Figure 1 below shows a comparison of economic growth in West Java, Indonesia's economic
growth.
Figure 1: Comparison of Economic Growth in Indonesia
And West Java Year 2010-2013
198
Source: Bappenas (Data processed)
Behind the good economy in West Java there are also problems of employment, one of which
is the problem of unemployment. The open unemployment rate in West Java were high as the
average unemployment rate in West Java open more than 8% during the study period.
Definition of open unemployment rate (TPT) is a working-age population or labor force has
never worked and was trying to get a job, who have never worked but for some reason
stopped or terminated and is trying to get a job back, and they were relieved assigned either
will be called back or not, but was trying to find a job. High open unemployment rates shows
that there are a lot of labor force which is not absorbed in the job market. Based on data from
BPS (2015), unemployment rate in Indonesia in 2010-2013 showed annual unemployment
rate continued to decline. In 2010 the open unemployment rate amounted to 7.14% of the total
labor force, in 2011 the open unemployment level fell to 6.56%, 6.14% in 2012 and by 2013
the unemployment rate decreased to 5.92%. The same trend in the rate of open unemployment
in Indonesia occurred also in West Java. The open unemployment rate continued to fall over
time. In 2010 the open unemployment rate of 10.33%, 9.83% in 2011, the year 2012
amounted to 9.08% and in 2013 by 8.9%. According to BPS, the open unemployment rate is a
good no more than 4%. Figure 2 shows the comparison of the level of open unemployment in
West Java with an open unemployment rate of Indonesia.
Figure 2: Open Unemployment Rate comparison
Indonesia and West Java Year 2010-2013
Source: BPS, Processed Data
According (Setiawan, 1997) open unemployment rate is the working age population or labor
force has never worked and was trying to get a job, who have never worked but for some
reason stopped or terminated and is trying to get a job back, and they were relieved assigned
either which will be called back or not, but was trying to find a job.
Research Radewa Rizki Mirma Wijaya (2014) on the effect of minimum wages, GDP and
population Polulasi against open unemployment rate (Case Study Gerbangkertasusila 2007-
2012) revealed that there is a positive and negative effect of the minimum wage variable,
GDP and population against the open unemployment rate The Gerbangkertasusila in the year
2007-2012. Another study from Rini Sulistiawati (2012) on the effect of minimum wages on
2010 2011 2012 2013
Jawa barat 6.2 6.48 6.21 6.31
Indonesia 6.13 6.32 6.23 5.78
5.4
5.6
5.8
6
6.2
6.4
6.6Persen
2010 2011 2012 2013
Jawa barat 10.33 9.83 9.08 8.9
Indonesia 7.14 6.56 6.14 5.92
02468
1012Persen
199
employment and the welfare of society in the provinces in Indonesia shows that a significant
and negative influence wages on employment. Based on two studies that have been conducted
regarding the level of unemployment shows that the variable GDP, population and UMR
partially and simultaneously used to establish the test variable to the problems of open
unemployment rate. The study was conducted in West Java with the topic "Effects of GDP,
UMR and the population against the open unemployment rate".
1.1 Problem Statement
Based on the description above description, the problem in this research can be formulated as
follows:
1. How much influence the GDP, UMR and the population against the open unemployment
rate in West Java in 2010-2013?
1.2 Research Purposes The purpose of this study is as follows:
1. To find out how much influence the GDP, UMR and population against the open
unemployment rate in West Java in 2010-2013
2. LITERATURE REVIEW
2.1 Theoritical review
a. Open unemployment rate theory
The open unemployment rate is the working-age population or labor force has never worked
and was trying to get a job, who have never worked but for some reason stopped or
terminated and is trying to get a job back, and they were relieved assigned either to be called
back or not , but was trying to find a job. The open unemployment rate (TPT), a comparison
between the number of unemployed to the total labor force. Mathematically can be calculated
using the formula to calculate the rate of open unemployment:
𝑂𝑝𝑒𝑛 𝑈𝑛𝑒𝑚𝑝𝑙𝑜𝑦𝑚𝑒𝑛𝑡 𝑟𝑎𝑡𝑒 =𝑢𝑛𝑒𝑚𝑝𝑙𝑜𝑦𝑚𝑒𝑛𝑡 𝑟𝑎𝑡𝑒
𝑙𝑎𝑏𝑜𝑟 𝑓𝑜𝑟𝑐𝑒𝑥100%
The usefulness of this indicator open unemployment in both the unit and the percent is useful
as a reference for the government for the opening of new jobs. In addition, its development
can determine the success rate of employment programs from year to year. This is more
important indicator is used as an evaluation successful development of Indonesia's economy
in addition to poverty.
Specifically, the open unemployment rate in Sakernas, consisting of:
1. Those who do not work and looking for work
2. Those who do not work and preparing a business
3. Those who are not working and not looking for work because they feel it is impossible
to get a job
4. Those who do not work, and not looking for work because they accepted to work, but
have not yet started work
The open unemployment rate calculation methods:
1. Sakernas
National Labour Force Survey (Sakernas) is a household survey used to collect detailed
information on employment and specifically designed to determine the general condition /
situation of employment. This survey uses the concepts and definitions refer to internationally
200
accepted concept, which is the ILO concept approach, so it can be compared with other
countries.
2. Sensus Penduduk dan SUPAS
The main source of population data is the census population (SP), which is held once every
ten years in the year ending in "0". To bridge the availability of demographic data for 10
years, BPS conducted a survey among the population census (SUPAS).
b. Regional Minimum Wage
Below there is a picture that explains the mechanism for setting the minimum wage.
Figure 3: Minimum wage setting mechanism
Source : Siduruk 2011
Minimum wage Regency / City is the prevailing minimum wage in the District / City.
Minimum Wage Fixing kabupaten/kota done by the Governor are decided to be greater than
the provincial minimum wage. Minimum wage fixing is conducted once a year and in charge
no later than 40 (forty) days before the effective date as January 1.
c. GDP
In theory, there are two (2) methods for calculating the gross regional domestic revenue, the
method of direct and indirect methods. By using the direct method may be calculated by
production approach, income approach and expenditure approach. While the indirect method,
a calculated value-added economic groups by allocating the value added into each group of
economic activities at regional level.
In this research, we will clarify how to calculate GDP, which is:
5. Production approach
The approach is to calculate the net goods and services produced by all sectors of the
economy during the year in all regions. Goods and services produced starts from the producer
price which is the price does not include transport and marketing costs because transport costs
will be calculated as the transport sector revenues while marketing expenses are calculated as
revenue trade sector.
6. Income approach
GDP is defined as the total remuneration received by the factors of production (salaries,
wages, rents, profits), which participate in the production process of the production of an area
within a specified period, usually 1 (one) year.
7. Expenditure approach
GDP is calculated the sum of all components of final expenditure, including expenditure and
consumption of households and private non-profit, government consumption expenditure,
gross domestic fixed capital needs as well as export and import in an area within a certain
period.
d. Population
According Srijanti and A. Rahman, a resident is a person who inhabits a place in a specific
region regardless of citizenship status adopted. A similar opinion came from Dr. Kartomo
201
which states that the population is all the people living in a certain area, regardless of the
citizen or non-citizen.
Modern population theory of mercantilism view saying that the number of people who many
as an important element in the power of the State which is an important factor in the strength
of the State and play a role in increasing income and wealth Country. A large number of the
population is like two sides of a coin, there is a positive side and a negative side. The positive
side of this is the large number of population as many number of people a lot, but is
accompanied by ability and effort in improving productivity led to many new jobs. This
resulted in an increase in economic growth. However, if the large number of this population is
not accompanied by the ability and productivity is good, then it will hamper employment
opportunities and can lead to unemployment and the impact on poverty.
2.2 Research framework and hypotheses
Research framework is an important part in a research report. In addition to describing the
conceptual model of research, as well as a general overview of the research process
conducted. Framework in this study is that the open unemployment rate is influenced by three
independent variables, which is GDP, UMR and populations. Then these variables as
independent variables and together, with the dependent variable is the rate of open
unemployment measured by means of regression analysis to obtain the level of significance.
With the regression results are expected to gain a level of significance of each independent
variable in affecting the rate of open unemployment. Based on the problems and the research
framework as above, then the hypothesis in this study are as follows:
5. The higher the GDP, the open unemployment rate rise
6. The higher the minimum wage, the open unemployment rate fell
7. The higher the population, the open unemployment rate rose
In the schematic framework can be described as follows.
Figure 4: Schematic framework
3. Research Methods
3.1 Object Research
The data used in this study was using panel data. Panel data is the combination of times
series data and cross section data in which the author uses 4 (four) years which is 2010 to
2013 by taking the 26 districts in West Java. The data taken is secondary data from BPS and
BI as methods of collecting. The variables used in this study are the independent variables
which is GDP, UMR and populations. While the dependent variable is the rate of open
unemployment.
The equation used
Y = a + bX1 + cX2 + dX3 +e
Dimana:
a : constants
GDP
Minimum wage
Population
Open unemployment
202
b : GDP coef
c : Minimum wages coef
d : Populasi coef
X1 : GDP variable
X2 : Minimum Wages variable
X3 : population variable
e : error term
3.2 Panel Data Analysis
This study uses panel analysis of data as a means of data processing using Eviews program 8.
In the analysis of the data panel model is known, two kinds of approaches that consist of a
fixed effects approach (fixed effect), and the approach of random effects (random effect).
Both the approach taken in the analysis of panel data can be explained as follows:
Fixed effect model
One of the difficulties of data panel procedure is that the assumptions consistent intercept and
slope difficult fulfilled. To overcome this problem, which is done in the data panel is to
include a dummy variable (dummy variable) to allow for the difference parameter values vary
both across units (cross section) and between time (time-series). Approach by including a
dummy variable is known as fixed effects model (fixed effect) or Least Square Dummy
Variable (lSDV).
Random effect model
The decision to enter a dummy variable in the fixed effects model (fixed effect) can not be
denied can lead to consequences (trade off). The addition of these dummies will be able to
reduce the number of degrees of freedom (degree of freedom), which in turn will reduce the
efficiency of the estimated parameters. Model panel data there in involves correlations
between error term due to the changing times because different observation can be overcome
with the approach of the component model error (the error component model) or also called
random effects model (random effect).
According to the Judge, there are four key considerations for choosing between using a fixed
effects approach (fixed effect), and the approach of random effects (random effect) in the data
panel:
1. If the number of time-series (T) while the number of large cross-section (N) is small, then
the results of the fixed effect and random effect is not much different so it can be chosen
approach is easier to calculate which is the fixed effect model (FEM).
2. If N large and small T, the estimation results of both approaches will differ greatly. So, if
we believe that the cross-section unit we choose in the study drawn at random (random),
the random effect should be used. Conversely, if we believe that the cross-section unit we
choose in the study were not taken at random then we must use the fixed effect.
4. RESULT AND DISCUSSIONS
4.1 Classical assumption test
Classical assumption needs to be done because the regression model should pay attention to
the existence of irregularities on the classical assumption, because in fact if classical
assumptions are not met then the variables that explain would be inefficient.
1. Autocorellation test (Durbin Watson test)
Durbin Watson statistic test used to detect problems autocorrelation in a regression model.
0 dL dU 4 4-dL 4-dU
203
Source: Gujarati, N, D,
Basic Econommoetric.
DW stat on the calculation result is 1,873. That is located in the free area autocorrelation. So
it concluded there was no problem autocorrelation in the data used.
2. Heteroscedasticity test
Heteroscedasticity test is used to test whether the regression model occurs or there is
inequality variance of the residuals of an observation to observation else.
3. Multikolinearity test
Multikolinearitas test is used to test whether the regression model found a correlation between
the independent variables. In this study to test whether there multikolinearitas seen from the
comparison between the value of the partial regression R2 (auxiliary regression) with major
regression R. When the R2 value of partial regression (auxiliary regression) larger than the R
primary regression, it can be concluded that in the equation occurs multikolinearitas. Table 1
below shows a comparison between the value of the partial regression R (auxiliary regression)
with major regression R value.
Table 1: R Auxiliary Regression Effect of GDP, UMR and Population Against
Unemployment levels in West Java Open year 2010-2013
Auxiliary
Regression
Main
Regression
GDP Population Minimum wage 0.1115 0.7318
Minimum wage Population GDP 0.1167 0.7318
Population Minimum wage GDP 0.0056 0.7318
The results above show that the calculation results of auxiliary partial regression R2 is smaller
than the main regression or major regression. So that it can be concluded that there is no
problem in the model multikolinearitas.
1,592 1,758 2,242 2,408 1,873
204
4.2 Panel data analysis
Partial test (t-test)
This test is used to determine whether the dependent variable individually associated with the
independent variable. Here are the results obtained from the calculation of the model used and
can be seen in Table 2 below
Table 2 : Results of the t test value of the regression model Variable t-stat t-table Result
GDP 5.3168
1,98
Signifikan
Minimum Wage -2.1106 Signifikan
Population 12.5240 Signifikan Description: df = n-k; k = number of regression coefficients, n = number of observations, α = level of
confidence
Source: Gujarati, N, D, Basic Econometric.
If seen in the table above, then all the coefficients show significant results. This means
partially, the variable GDP, Minimum wages and the population is able to explain the change
in the dependent variable (open unemployment).
F test
F test is used to determine whether the overall regression coefficients are significant in
determining the dependent variable.
Tabel 3 N2 (n-k) N1 (k-1) F statistic F table (α=5%) Hasil
100 3 90.98556 2,68 Signifikan
Description: df = n-k; k = number of regression coefficients, n = number of observations, α = level of confidence
Source: Gujarati, N, D, Basic Econometric.
The coefficient of determination test (R2)
In this study calculated the coefficient of determination (R2) which is figures that show the
magnitude of the variation ability / deployment of variables. The independent variable to
explain the spread of the dependent variable for the purpose of assuring the truth of these
functions. From research obtained coefficient of determination for this function where the
dependent variable of 73.18% can be explained jointly by the input variables. The remaining
portion of 26.82% is explained by variables outside the model used.
Research result
From the results of tests and calculations obtained by the following equation econometric:
Y = a + bX1 + cX2 + dX3 + e
Y = -1.3933 + 0.2464X1 – 0.1780X2 + 0.7665X3 + e
(1.248594) (0.046347) (0.061205) (0.084346)
Interpretation of the independent variable
The influence og GDP on the level of unemployment
205
GDP variable has a coefficient of 0.2464. This means indicates a change of 1% GDP will
increase open unemployment rate of 0.24%. The proportional relationship because due to the
nature of the relationship GDP is positive proportional to the rate of open unemployment.
The influence of UMR on the level of unemployment
UMR has a value to a variable coefficient of -0.17. This means UMR shows changes of 1%
would lower the open unemployment rate amounted to 0.17%. The relationship is inversely
proportional since due to the nature of the relationship UMR negative towards the open
unemployment rate.
The influence of population on the open unemployment rate
A population variable has coefficient value of 0.7665. This means showing population change
by 1% would increase the open unemployment rate of 0.76%. The proportional relationship
because due to the nature of the population is a positive relationship towards the open
unemployment rate.
5. CONCLUSION
This study is intended to look at the effect of GDP, UMR and the population against the open
unemployment rate in West Java in 2010-2013. Based on the results of data analysis has been
done, it can be concluded as follows:
1. The result of the coefficient of determination (R2) was obtained 0.7318. This value
means that the model is fairly well established that 73.18% of the variation
unemployment level open the dependent variable can be explained very well by all three
independent factors, namely GDP, UMR and Population. The remaining portion of
26.82% is explained by variables outside the model used. GDP variable has a positive
and significant impact on the level of unemployment. This is because the increase in
GDP is an indicator of economic growth that is not in line with the increase in production
capacity will cause the number of unemployed continues to rise. UMR variable has a
negative and significant effect on the level of unemployment. This can be assumed to be
an excess supply of labor supply and labor demand in the formal sector into decline when
the minimum wage increases so that the excess supply of labor to migrate to the informal
sector. Variable population has a positive and significant influence. It is caused due to the
higher population in West Java will cause a higher rate of open unemployment.
206
6. REFERENCES
Badan Pusat Statistik Indonesia. National Economic Growth. bps.go.id. Accessed in February
2015
Badan Pusat Statistik Jawa barat. 2010. Jawa Barat dalam angka. Bandung.
Badan Pusat Statistik Jawa barat. 2011. Jawa Barat dalam angka. Bandung.
Badan Pusat Statistik Jawa barat. 2012. Jawa Barat dalam angka. Bandung.
Badan Pusat Statistik Jawa barat. 2013. Jawa Barat dalam angka. Bandung.
Badan Pusat Statistik Jawa Barat. Jawa Barat dalam angka. Jabar.bps.go.id. Diakses Februari
2015.
Damodar, N Gujarati. 2001. Basic Econometric. 4th
ed. McGrowHill,Inc
Keputusan Gubernur Jabar no 561/Kep.-Bansos/2009 tentang upah minimum kabupaten/kota
di Jawa Barat 2010
Keputusan Gubernur Jabar no 561/Kep.1405-Bansos/2012 tentang upah minimum
kabupaten/kota di Jawa Barat 2013
Keputusan Gubernur Jabar no 561/Kep.1540-Bansos/2011 tentang upah minimum
kabupaten/kota di Jawa Barat 2012
Keputusan Gubernur Jabar no 561/Kep.1564-Bansos/2010 tentang upah minimum
kabupaten/kota di Jawa Barat 2011
Nordhaous, Samuelson. Economics. 19th
ed. McGrawhills.
Rizki, Radewa. 2014. Pengaruh Upah minimum, PDRB, dan Populasi penduduk terhadap
tingkat pengangguran terbuka (Studi Kasus Gerbangkertasusila tahun 2007-2012). Jurusan
Ilmu Ekonomi. Fakultas Ekonomi dan Bisnis, Universitas Brawijaya Malang.
Sulistiawati, Rini. 2012. Pengaruh upah minimum terhadap penyerapan tenaga kerja dan
kesejahteraan masyarakat di Provinsi di Indonesia. Fakultas Ekonomi, Universitas
Tanjungpura.
Simreg.bapenas.go.id. Diakses Maret 2015.
Todaro, Michael. 1998. Pembangunan Ekonomi di Dunia Ketiga. Jakarta: Gelora Aksara
Pratama.
Wyrick, Thomas. 1994. The Economics’s Handbook: a research and writing guide. West
Publishing Company.
6. APPENDICES
The data used in this studies are :
207
lnpdrb lnpopulasi lnUMR InTPT
a 2010 16.89441883 14.97066038 13.50762578 11.93882045
a 2011 16.95214486 15.11651769 14.01747133 11.88562631
a 2012 17.01186364 14.98972958 14.10693537 12.06436506
a 2013 17.0841843 15.04089499 14.36679056 11.97347202
b 2010 15.89996725 14.22780827 13.91555949 11.26716558
b 2011 15.95587491 14.43294178 14.02819238 11.03275836
b 2012 16.01453906 14.24560454 14.14940734 11.09067527
b 2013 16.08685972 14.29453277 14.36851943 11.05510334
c 2010 17.82265112 14.78232367 13.971637 11.64042998
c 2011 20.1859816 14.60952292 14.21553824 11.72017538
c 2012 17.9437377 14.80044301 14.50965724 11.44437892
c 2013 18.01605836 14.9148266 14.71055518 11.49192652
d 2010 17.29756416 15.37826181 13.8708639 12.23092134
d 2011 17.35723625 15.41825029 14.05399188 12.31330241
d 2012 17.41366474 15.39605752 14.50965724 12.20080379
d 2013 17.4859854 15.44705609 14.62298592 12.11246502
e 2010 15.82101717 14.35799763 13.45857129 10.57075266
e 2011 15.87080835 14.38061753 13.58452383 11.05122328
e 2012 15.9195502 14.26020984 13.65777429 10.63983789
e 2013 15.99187086 14.13239652 13.85562318 10.71303904
f 2010 15.9317521 14.59082787 13.51912404 11.56330484
f 2011 15.97808721 14.78321506 13.68369198 11.48760766
f 2012 16.02759802 14.60862388 13.78505135 11.64523361
f 2013 16.09991868 14.62657632 14.22097567 11.88815127
g 2010 15.91111146 14.54070955 13.62313867 11.62095442
g 2011 15.96019264 14.68620207 13.77119288 11.44962351
g 2012 16.00715616 14.55949961 13.89367458 11.8888519
g 2013 16.07947682 14.64540427 14.00840107 11.80225368
h 2010 16.22548055 14.69392745 13.5670492 11.15261535
h 2011 16.27881105 14.81119862 13.68767719 11.38931046
h 2012 16.31731874 14.71049062 13.77988338 11.06371221
h 2013 16.3896394 14.74194289 13.89709054 11.31107852
i 2010 16.47970375 14.32444399 13.65785625 11.36568916
i 2011 16.52712938 14.50941745 13.81036132 11.27743095
i 2012 16.57649869 14.3423729 13.93329359 11.02758888
i 2013 16.64881935 14.34081703 14.0594915 11.24505909
j 2010 16.88890645 14.57059491 13.92077107 11.85895899
j 2011 16.96017969 14.59957556 14.05391861 11.49699931
j 2012 17.04786068 14.58839086 14.50865774 11.66448708
j 2013 17.12018134 14.61543959 14.71055722 11.47818908
k 2010 15.19353809 13.93095842 13.45883561 10.48170076
k 2011 15.24639628 14.05384612 13.59859756 10.6491323
k 2012 15.29256978 13.86827662 13.68197917 10.45184015
k 2013 15.36489045 13.94513345 13.81750856 10.59197389
l 2010 15.3034326 13.96971809 13.48700649 10.41199048
208
l 2011 15.34910447 14.03339149 13.59236701 10.63207427
l 2012 15.39559463 13.98729092 13.65299163 10.59805872
l 2013 15.46791529 13.98168071 13.81551056 10.68352319
m 2010 15.79577796 14.57059491 13.69897674 10.5065459
m 2011 15.85783041 13.74127289 13.86191693 10.48170076
m 2012 15.91899804 13.67374882 14.3421113 10.5546141
m 2013 15.9913187 13.70825937 14.5574479 10.53470614
n 2010 15.80848476 14.20585052 13.52301693 10.98634302
n 2011 15.85686309 14.29737359 13.66759043 11.04221759
n 2012 15.90111358 14.21526875 14.01436142 11.00786652
n 2013 15.97343424 14.22735925 14.2716428 10.85907592
o 2010 15.97211382 14.66626344 13.41726929 11.4530693
o 2011 16.01195961 14.76158919 13.69334292 11.48075345
o 2012 16.05443909 15.29334664 13.9986651 11.54677602
o 2013 16.12675975 14.69448024 14.26398535 11.60291241
p 2010 15.53983648 13.96892154 13.66698039 10.63224316
p 2011 15.58691306 13.98456702 13.82298257 10.5955091
p 2012 15.63270822 13.92278344 14.13882518 10.57403119
p 2013 15.70502888 14.08374066 14.2716428 10.40843594
q 2010 15.52334044 14.33164845 13.45857129 11.06479291
q 2011 15.56560549 14.36845212 13.75999785 11.02195149
q 2012 15.6416072 14.34952308 13.84991198 10.64002942
q 2013 15.71392786 14.36825191 14.06184628 10.89340042
r 2010 17.27174149 14.68884076 13.87425105 11.78564363
r 2011 17.35541515 14.74635448 14.05580617 11.88562631
r 2012 17.44140546 14.70663691 14.24645041 11.58559955
r 2013 17.51372612 14.72537146 14.50865774 11.77568965
s 2010 13.5276258 12.12834351 13.44415698 8.351846739
s 2011 13.57973506 12.16994275 13.5670492 8.616133139
s 2012 13.63096493 12.09123402 13.76421726 8.530504205
s 2013 13.70328559 12.95414826 13.84020317 8.62389281
t 2010 16.55480797 14.6634672 13.9596109 11.72046795
t 2011 16.62319732 14.55687869 14.16775209 11.66384235
t 2012 16.68943677 14.68126308 14.5574479 11.4475973
t 2013 16.76175743 14.76825626 14.7083091 11.62358989
u 2010 15.38108728 13.76323362 13.9596109 11.18462971
u 2011 15.44111371 13.68676427 13.97609762 10.71408438
u 2012 15.5003546 13.78236527 14.50965724 10.58195247
u 2013 15.57267526 13.82844455 14.67092539 10.68866682
v 2010 15.68874448 13.20150168 13.91743879 10.42353057
v 2011 15.74285252 13.31578807 14.01799579 10.16569796
v 2012 15.793941 13.21929769 14.10693537 9.959347902
v 2013 15.86626166 13.25512873 14.36679056 10.3041411
w 2010 15.47314093 12.59731712 13.64115717 9.617271072
w 2011 17.83333301 12.7058444 13.79530785 9.566615236
w 2012 15.58489643 12.61722488 13.89478374 9.720525791
209
w 2013 15.65721709 12.62581206 14.01967514 9.458059456
x 2010 15.69028155 14.36741958 13.96134101 11.08324963
x 2011 15.7540368 14.39387127 14.16953991 11.36659248
x 2012 15.823142 14.38636976 14.52944028 11.26560448
x 2013 15.89546267 14.48956768 14.68972851 9.608310798
y 2010 14.46821432 12.61124771 13.65299163 9.731571668
y 2011 14.52942559 12.7092632 13.69897674 9.507551895
y 2012 14.5809277 12.62492771 13.86430072 9.57366317
y 2013 14.65324836 12.65018779 14.11561515 9.608310798
z 2010 15.17101653 13.36047278 13.56061831 10.05195066
z 2011 15.22753163 13.60294338 13.76421726 10.14741364
z 2012 15.23906048 13.37990681 13.85952744 9.940253332
z 2013 15.31138114 13.40253129 14.02819965 9.912149926
Source: data processed
210
OPTIMIZING DIGITAL MARKETING STRATEGY THROUGH
CUSTOMIZATION SYSTEM DEVELOPMENT FOR OUTFIDES
R. Dewintha Nur Annisa, Intan Rizky Mutiaz
Master of Business Administration, School of Business and Management
Bandung Institute of Technology, Indonesia
dewintha@sbm-itb.ac.id
intanrm@yahoo.com
Abstract
The past two years has seen a noticeable shift in Indonesia with many starting to shop online from
fashion to electronics, where Indonesian digital consumers enjoy online shopping along with the growth of
connected device ownership. The existence of a free market in world trade makes the competition of promotion
more exciting, so, in order to exist in fierce fashion market competition, online shop need to discover the
differentiation that is not did by another company, provide value added of the product, and manage their
business through promotional and marketing strategies in order to reach a wider market, overcoming challenges
in the level of trust and create new programs and procedures to meet any demand in order to maintain customer
satisfaction. Since Outfides still a new online business that has been running for almost a year, marketing
activity undertaken by Outfides still not well organized, lack of development, and also does not meet the Break
Even Point yet.
Optimizing the digital marketing strategy is very necessary and useful for Outfides to achieve the
company goals. From the root cause analysis that categorized based on 4-Ps (Product, Placement, Price,
Promotion) Marketing Mix supported with OASIS that based on scanning the situational analysis both internal
and external using 5C analysis including: Porter’s 5 Forces, PEST, and SWOT, STP analysis, and current
digital marketing analysis. Methodology that implemented in this final project is observation using purposive
sampling, which from 12 websites there are 4 of them that fit all the criteria. The main goals of the observation
is to find some input for further development of Outfides website as their main channel of digital marketing.
Final result of this final project is a set of recommendation strategy that should be implemented by
Outfides to achieve company goals and objectives. The recommendation is a plan to optimize the digital
marketing which consist of web marketing, website layout design and customization system development. The
business implementation timeline that consist of the entire plan to optimize the digital marketing, marketing Mix
and OASIS strategy are expected to be execute for the next 6 months, which started in October 2015.
Keywords: Digital Marketing Strategy, Web Marketing, Customization, Fashion Business, Start-up
211
1. Introduction The fashion industry is a product of the
modern age. The fashion industry inarguably
accounts for a significant share of world
economic output. In Indonesia, the fashion
industry's contributions are IDR 181 trillion of
IDR 642 trillion the total 15 sectors of the
creative economy, or about 2%. Fashion
sector is growing rapidly; its growth in the last
year was 6.4%, higher than the national
growth of 5.7%. Then, with the growing
middle class groups, today, more and more
people in Indonesia are willing to pay a little
more for fashion products are designed
better, even for a local brand.
Nowadays, more and more brands are
moving to the world of online shopping. At
the overview of the fashion industry in 2013,
it’s more online today then it was in 2008;
there are more people today buying clothing
online then ever before. More people today
are spending more cash online then in real
retail stores. The great thing about online
shopping is people can do shop anywhere
and anytime when the Internet is available.
The past two years has seen a noticeable shift
in Indonesia with many people starting to
shop online, for everything from fashion to
electronics. Online shopping is a growing
trend in the region, with 63% of survey
respondents reporting that they shop online
at least occasionally. The key drivers of online
shopping growth are mainly Internet
penetration, income level and cultural
factors. As shown in Figure 1, according to
data from APJII that Internet users in
Indonesia, many of whom have an experience
in online shopping where Central Java make a
online purchases at most (79%), followed by
Yogyakarta (33%), Jakarta (23%) and West
Java (26%).
Figure 1. Proportions of the Users Who Have an
Experience in Online Shopping (Source: APJII, 2012)
And with the increase in online shopping
which is supported by a growing middle-class
society who is very responsive to innovation in
products. Many people are increasingly
seeking comfort and exclusivity with the
increase of their economic the ability. Buying
mass-produced clothing is often brought
dissatisfaction to some people because it does
not comply with their desire to be different
and exclusive. Associated with that,
companies need to determine differentiation
that is not owned by another company, either
by providing custom products, in accordance
with the wishes and preferences of
consumers.
Since Outfides is still a new online business that has been running for almost a year, marketing activities for Outfides is still not well organized and lack of development, and also did not meet its Break Even Point (BEP) yet. It is not because none of the customers come into and do purchase of Outfides product, but more because Outfides still could not reach the daily maximum capacity and revenue.
The existence of a free market in world trade
makes the competition of promotion more exciting, because of the type of products that each company offered. So, to be able exist in fierce market competition, especially in the world of fashion, the online shop must be think extra, discover the differentiation that is not did by another company, and provide value added of a product according to customer’s wants but in an efficient manner
212
to survive and win in this competition. Beside of that, the online shop need to manage their business through promotional marketing strategies in order to increase their products and reach a wider market, also how the online shop is able to overcome the challenges in level of trust that must be build, create new programs and procedures to meet any demand in order to maintain customer satisfaction of company’s services.
Optimizing the digital marketing strategy are very
necessary and useful for Outfides to achieve the company goals, especially to achieve and implement the market-of-one-perspective through customization on website to differentiate the product from competitor. Scanning the situational analysis both internal and external are needed in this process, so the author would know more detail of the current situation and condition of Outfides and could formulate the right strategy into it.
2. Business Issue Exploration
A. Conceptual Framework
Outfides needs to optimize their current
digital marketing strategy to differentiate the
product from competitor in this fashion
industry, especially who doing their business
online. This study will be supported by
literature study, internal data usage,
company’s document, and observation in the
field. The conceptual framework as shown
below (Figure 2) used to give a brief how this
research work flows.
Figure 2. Conceptual Framework
B. Situation Analysis (5Cs) 1. Customer
Outfides main segments are women with
an average age of 18 - 26 years old, most of
them expend more than IDR 300,000 for
clothes or come from middle-up class in
social and economic status, a college
student and a newcomer in the office,
youthful and dynamic, familiar with online
shopping or they understand how to buy
clothes online, aware of the latest fashion
trends, and they tend to choose limited
and good quality product but still at an
affordable price.
Young people drive the market and always
an opportunity to attract this segment,
who have a casual dress sense, who shun stereotypes and who want to feel good in
whatever they are wearing. Therefore, in
order to search the required information,
doing survey, and decision-making; the
direct personal approach used to see
clearly what is desired and needed by this
segment, which can be done through
digital media that has very close with the
young people and the social media that
accessed daily by them.
2. Competitor
213
From the author’s survey result, there are
four stores located and based in Bandung
that could be the most potential
competitors for Outfides that compete to
provide the same benefit and same
customer resources.
- Has its own web store: All Day Long (http://itsalldaylong.com) and Miroir
(http://miroirstore.com) - Do not have their own web store:
NOZEIL and Its ORCA Indonesia
In addition, Porter’s 5 Forces Analysis (Hill and Jones, 2009) also used to anticipate future moves, predict expected reaction to company moves and analyse further about competition in this fashion business. - Threat of new entrants may be
considered as high, because clothing included in the basic human needs. For that reason, fashion business get upper ranks to gain a business advantage that people are trying to take these opportunities.
- Moreover, Outfides is facing a high threat of substitution since it is a clothing line, which sell ready-to-wear product in small scale and create their own design based on knowledge of current market trends.
- The bargaining power of customers also relatively high, because there are so many clothing lines that sell ready-to-wear product, which can be freely chosen by the customer.
- The bargaining power of suppliers is categorized as low, because there are a lot of suppliers of fabric and textile that offer similar product and similar quality at competitive price, both local sellers and importer.
- Competitive rivalry within an industry is relatively high for Outfides, because competitors of Outfides itself as already mentioned above both has own web store and not has yet. They all must be have the competitive advantages which provide the same benefit, same customer resources, and can be customer’s consideration to choose.
3. Collaborators Increased competition is occurred between
networks, rather than individual
organizations. So as in order to meet and
fulfil customer needs and also give a good
quality product, Outfides consider and try
to strengthen relationship with business
partners and resources such as tailors,
vendors, suppliers, web hosting, and web
designer.
4. Context
This analysis is to understand the dynamics
of the market place and what they imply
for the decision at hand that is contained in
the PEST Analysis.
- Political As a clothing line, do the business online
and of course a player in fashion industry in Indonesia, Outfides is also an object that is regulated in Act No. 7 of 2014 on Trade (Undang-Undang Nomor 7 Tahun 2014 tentang Perdagangan). Government Regulation No. 82 Year 2012 on the Implementation of the System and Electronic Transactions (Peraturan Pemerintah Nomor 82 Tahun 2012 tentang Penyelenggaraan Sistem dan Transaksi Elektronik) and Director General of Tax Regulation No. PER-32 / PJ / 2010 on the Implementation of Article 25 Imposition of Income Tax for Individual Tax Payer Certain businessmen (Peraturan Dirjen Pajak No PER-32/PJ/2010 tentang Pelaksanaan Pengenaan PPh Pasal 25 bagi Wajib Pajak Orang Pribadi Pengusaha Tertentu (WP OPPT)).
- Economic Bandung as a center for the creative
industries and SMEs will certainly give a real picture of the economic activity of its citizens. And as a location for home base of Outfides product, it cannot be denied if Bandung now become one of the areas that have the
214
bright potential for the fashion industry in the future.
The fashion industry has a great
opportunity in the future in Indonesia and will continue to grow and develop, it can be seen from Figure 3 that the fashion industry especially ready-to-wear provide the largest contribution to GDP Indonesia (55.5%).
Figure 3. Fashion Sector Contributions to GDP (Source:
Ministry of Trade, 2015)
- Social/Cultural
Bandung noted as the most populated area in West Java. Bandung population density reaches 14.847 persons per square kilometer. According to the Badan Pusat Statistik (BPS) of Bandung report 2012, total population reached 2.483.977 persons that consist of 1.260.565 men and 1.223.412 women. The number of households in Bandung is 661.194 households with an average of 4 persons each household and from National Labor Force Survey is known that Labor Force Participation Rate in Bandung in 2013 was 63.61%, while Unemployment Rate (TPT) was 10.98%. Bandung has a majority of the population is at productive age who showed that human resources in Bandung is so high, which mostly of them work in the trade sector and then followed by the services and industry sector.
- Technological
Outfides still categorized as a small player, which is also included as a player of
SMEs, so in terms of the production process to distribution of the product until reached by the consumer; Outfides has not used any sophisticated and advanced technology. In running the business, such as in doing the production process in convection, Outfides still use conventional pattern machine, conventional material cutting machines and conventional sewing machine. So far no sophisticated tool or machine used by Outfides in its production process like, labeling process is also done manually.
- In sales and distribution process,
Outfides do it online so that automatically uses Internet technologies such as uses of social media and website. However, Outfides has not been used the Internet technology at the advanced level. Therefore, it is necessary to do further development of website which is the main channel of Outfides in order to achieve and implement the market-of-one-perspective through customization on website to differentiate their product from competitors.
5. Company The following is an internal analysis of
Outfides consisting of organizational goals,
strategies, and capabilities aimed to
evaluate the strength of Outfides current
business model and to identify the areas
that need to be repaired and / or changes.
Some of organizational goals to be
achieved by Outfides, that are: has a loyal
customer, have a successful and top of
minds online fashion brand, being a
sustainable business that shown from a
good financial performance, become a
leader in fashion industry especially in
young women segment and continuously
grow and innovating.
After the elaboration of organizational
goals and strategies undertaken by
Outfides, here are Outfides capabilities and
Ready to wear
(fashion), 55.5%
Shoes, 29.4%
Jewelery, 15.34%
215
shortcomings. Table 1 show the summary
of Outfides’ SWOT analysis based on
company’s current competencies.
Table 1. Oufides SWOT
C. Segmentation, Targeting, Positioning - Segmentation
According to Kotler (2003), segmentation could be done by looking for consumer characteristic based on its geographic, demographic and psychographic, as follows (see Table 2).
Table 2. Oufides Segmentation
- Targeting Outfides using concentrated marketing for
its market and business targeting,
which also referred to as niche marketing that involves going after a larger share of one or a few segments.
By using this marketing strategy, the
company can market more effectively due to a strong position and great knowledge of the customers’ needs within each segment. Although concentrated marketing can be highly profitable it also involves a high risk due to the fact that the company rely on one or a few segments for their
Strenghts:
1. Own design
2. Premium quality
3. On-trend
fashion with
affordable price
4. Limited items in
every season,
not restock the
same items
Opportunities:
1. High demand of young
women clothing
2. Fashion is always
evolving, especially
young women segment
3. Doing business online
so attractive because
the manufacturing
process is fast and
relatively little capital
needed
Weaknesses:
1. New entrants in
fashion industry
2. Low brand
awareness
3. Lack of product
uniqueness
4. Produced on a
small scale
Threats:
1. Competitor in same
industry
2. Temporary supplier of
fabrics and tailor
3. Low customer loyalty
Outfides Segmentation
Geographic Bandung as home-base
Java Island
Around Indonesia area
Major cities or urban area
Metropolitan and semi
metropolitan
High density population
Demographic Female
Young urban women
18 – 26 years old
College student and
newcomer in office
Expend more than IDR
300,000 for clothes
Middle-up class
Psychographic Youthful and dynamic
Familiar with online
shopping
Aware of the latest fashion
trends
Have a casual dress sense
Tend to choose limited and
good quality product but
still at an affordable price
216
whole business and will suffer greatly if the segment turns sour (Armstrong and Kotler, 2005). As mentioned above, Outfides has chosen to be focus and serve the customer on certain group, which is for the group of young urban women and only in middle-up class. By using this strategy, Outfides can be highly profitable because the company can reduce the production cost, and also marketing and distributions cost.
- Positioning
Positioning is concerned with how the customers perceive the products and how the customers define it in order to maximize the potential benefit to the company, where the result is a persuasive reason why the target market should buy the product or products (Kotler and Keller, 2009); then Dibb and Simkin (1996) stated that a successful positioning occurs when the target customers find that the product or brand satisfies their expectations and desires. To determine how customers perceive the Outfides’ product compared with other products, the author uses perceptual mapping.
Figure 4. Outfides Perceptual Mapping
The previous Figure 4 show Outfides’
positioning compared to other company
and competitor based on the
perceptions of customers and with
these perceptual mapping, Outfides can
find out how customers and potential
customers view the brand. This
information can also help Outfides to
identify the image and reaction of
brand, product, service and Outfides
other offering from the customer, so
the company can make a decision to
formulate and build an effective and
competitive new marketing strategy.
D. Current Digital Marketing The following digital marketing that has been
done and used by Outfides for the last years
to market and promote their products, are
Outfides own website, Instagram and Twitter
account.
- Website Outfides choose and use website as a main
channel of marketing, promotion and distribution in order to achieve and implement the market-of-one-perspective through customization on website to differentiate the product from competitors. So, all kind of Outfides sales processes are done in their website. Customer can see all new collection, last season collection, choose and select the product, and do a purchase in one channel.
- Social Media
Outfides also use the social media as one of its digital channels to promote and sell their products. As for social media are selected and used actively by Outfides are Instagram and Twitter.
Outfides using Instagram to enhance their
product promotion and sales. With the large number of users in Indonesia, company can use Instagram as a channel to selling the product. In using Instagram, the
217
company just only has to make a great and also very cool product photo and sell them without having to pay the cost of marketing. If talking about the number of users, Instagram may be more superior to Twitter. However, about the popularity Twitter was still superior to that photo-sharing site which is also a member of Facebook family. Therefore, Outfides also use Twitter as a one of the digital channel to promote and sell their products.
E. Methodology and Analysis Broadly, this research aims to optimize the
digital marketing primarily in order to
maximizing the use of the website in Outfides
daily business activities. While to know more
deeply the development of what is needed for
managing the website, the observation
method is selected and used in this research
to analyse the problem, find some input for
further development and formulate the right
strategy.
The object of observation used in this
research is a company engaged in fashion
industry that has a website. This research
using purposive sampling, thus, samples or
objects that do not meet the criteria as
described in the following will be excluded
from this research. The criteria were:
- Engaged in the fashion industry, particularly clothing for women
- Selling similar products with Outfides products
- Has a website - Website is the main channel of digital
marketing and sales - Making sales through their own
website, and - Can make an order directly on the
website
After observing several specific objects
described previously, the author found at
least 12 websites as an examples which
accordance with these criteria and there are 4
of them that fit all the criteria. Then, after
observed all the sample, seeing the overall
look, design and content of the website, all of
them did not do a customization system, and
the following are the strength and weakness
of The Hallyu, STYLENANDA, COTTONINK, and
The Stylish by Sallyns.
Strengths
1. Provide membership benefit 2. Offers EMS as worldwide shipping service to the
fastest and safest international delivery service 3. Provide bulletin board in form of reviews of product
purchased 4. Customer can make payments using credit card,
debit card and PayPal
Weaknesses
1. Too many pictures in one page 2. The pages is too long because each picture shown is
too big 3. Cannot zoom-in to see more detail of product
selected (material textures, clothing accessories such as buttons, lace and stitching)
4. Not introduce and provide information about their latest product or collections in their homepage
218
Table 3a. TheHallyu Website Strengths &
Weaknesses
Table 3b. STYLENANDA Website Strengths &
Weaknesses
Table 3c. COTTONINK Website Strengths &
Weaknesses
Table 3d. The Stylish by Sallyns Website Strengths
& Weaknesses
F. Root Cause Analysis To analyse the problems and based on the
situational analysis explained, the author use
Fish-Bone Diagram to found some root cause
of the marketing problem, especially digital
marketing problem faced by Outfides
nowadays in order to develop its business.
The business problems of Outfides could
appear because of the things that categorized
by the author based on 4-Ps (Product,
Placement, Price, and Promotion) Marketing
Mix as shown below in Figure 5.
Figure 5. Fish-Bone Diagram of Outfides
The business problem faced by Outfides as a start-
up online business they were not meet its Break Even Point (BEP) yet. It is not because none of the customers come into and do purchase of Outfides products, but more
Strengths
1. Accessible in four languages (English, Japanese, Indonesian, French)
2. Customer service 24/7 3. Customer can make a wishlist of product they want 4. Provide worldwide delivery service 5. The website contains size charts 6. Provide a slideshow of new arrival product on their
homepage
Weaknesses
1. The product price relatively expensive plus postage from Korea
2. In addition to payment by credit card and PayPal, customer can only use Mandiri Clickpay for debit card.
Strengths
1. Make a theme of each collection 2. Presents a new arrival products or a new collection
included with a supporting article on main page 3. Give a featured looks or product mix and match
from the stylist 4. Get informed of the last orders status and can track
the orders that have been carried out 5. Cooperating with several companies, so the
customer can get some discounts when purchase directly on website
Weaknesses
1. Not yet provide free shipping to all over Indonesia area
2. Unresponsive customer service, does not provide 24/7 customer support or shopping assistance service
Strengths
1. Get informed of that product status, that are available or already sold out
2. Could see the details of products from the collection page, customer do not need to click or go to product selection page to see the details.
3. Do restock on high demand product
Weaknesses
1. Do not serve a purchase from overseas, only serve domestic purchases (Indonesia area only)
2. Do not serve a payment using a credit card 3. Do not have online customer service yet
219
because some root causes in 4-Ps, such as: 1. Product
- Produced on small scale - Lack of product uniqueness
2. Placement
- Lack of channel development - Challenges in the level of trust - Low customer loyalty
3. Price
- High production cost - Price war among competitors
4. Promotion - Marketing activities were not - High competition in promotion - Low brand awareness
3. Business Solution
A. Product
Figure 6. 4-Ps: Product Solutions
As seen above in Figure 6, there are solutions for product problems faced by Outfides. A problem faced by start-up and small business is not other that their production is still on a small scale, so often it inhibits the development of the company to achieve their Break Even Point (BEP) and face the competition in this fashion industry. To solve this problem, that Outfides should do is increasing the flexibility of its production which in addition to their regular and fixed production, the production also conducted by special order or custom orders from customers. Flexibility in production through a custom system or produced by orders also give an answers to customer dissatisfaction of the products that are not in accordance with their wants. And of course support the desire of customers who want to be different and
exclusive, because now many people are increasingly seeking comfort and exclusivity with the increase of their economic ability.
Lack of uniqueness in their product is also faced by
Outfides. With increasingly fierce competition and encounter with many similar products on the market, so the company needs an idea of creating a different new product that provides added value to the customers and employ a designer. During this time, product design done by the owner based on the market survey, unify existing trend and reworks them into comfortable and easy to wear garments as Outfides collection. Typically, because of those limitations, the designs of Outfides product become similar to the products currently on the market. It necessary for company to focus and determine the products featuring the uniqueness and create a product that is different from the other by providing added-value to the customer where the customer can modify and customize the Outfides products in accordance with their needs and desires. In addition, Outfides need to hire a designer who is working to develop the product design in accordance with the company’s character. It is also intended to achieve different and unique products as well as increase efficiency in production.
B. Placement
Figure 7. 4-Ps: Placement Solutions
As an online fashion company, Outfides use the website as their online stores and main channel or the media to conduct marketing activities, display the catalog and products as well as a sales process including orders and distribution. But as a start-up business, the
220
layout design and appearance and the content of Outfides website is still very simple, standard and straightforward so that necessary for further development, as redesign the website to be more professional to give the business a greater confidence. As for the development to be carried out by Outfides is to make the website which able to respond the customer’s desires, needs and different preferences. Those website development is to achieve the market-of-one-perspective, that allow the customization system of products to suit the need and preferences of each customer efficiently.
To solve the problem about trust and security in
Outfides online store is by boosting customer’s trust to transact with the company, such as by providing guarantees to customers. This program is given in the form of money guarantees, return and exchange products if the product received did not match their expectations or in accordance with the terms and conditions of money guarantees, return and exchange policy. Another way to solve customer’s trust problem by offers a good quality product, which Outfides must ensure their product using a great material for the whole collections. In addition, because of the customer cannot see and hold the product directly, then via the website, Outfides must display the products they offer in detail and clearly.
Other issue is low customer loyalty. Because its
only an online store, the intensity of customer to surf the website for a long time is still very difficult to achieve, which affect to the purchase they made. One way to increase customer loyalty is by binding the consumers with Customer Relationship Management (CRM) intensely. Through CRM, consumers can feel treated special by the brand owners, if consumers feel more valued, then the consumer will feel closer emotionally to the brand or product of company. The CRM that Outfides can do including: provide a convenient communication between the company and customers, make the order and payment procedure easier, give a timely delivery service, and ensure conformity of the product that they order with the catalog.
To overcome and maintain the customer loyalty, Outfides should use a kind of variety of communication channels that make the customer can contact the company easily through various ways such as email, social media, SMS, and instant messenger; always respond every inquiry and question of customers well and quickly; provide accounts of several different banks to enable customers to make payments, then immediately confirm the payment when received and mention the number of delivery receipt; be open to criticism and suggestions; and also ask for positive testimonials from the satisfied customer, so they indirectly disseminate the information about Outfides product such as the quality of products, about the price, and about the services.
C. Price
Figure 8. 4-Ps: Price Solutions
The third problem is about price, as a start-up business Outfides has to deal with high production costs and price war among competitors. Because Outfides still producing on a small scale, to avoid losses the company seek to obtain the revenue that can cover almost all production costs. To solve the issue about high production cost, the author suggests Outfides to increase the product perception and customizing the product.
One thing that must be done by Outfides is formed
and improve customers perception of the product through price which image oriented; which is product at a high price showed good product quality, or in other words the company provides a guarantee that high prices set to maintain the image of the
221
company. As for how to formed and improve customer perception of quality and high prices due to high production cost is by doing an intensive promotion through media publication and advertising in personal experience (e.g. testimonials) that will eventually lead to a purchase intention.
Then, to solve the high production costs problem is
by creating a difference with the competitors but still remain with the intention of obtaining a cheaper cost; so many products over by the company all this time should be re-evaluated to only produce a product that really give more profit to the company and support the company’s operational efficiency policies by doing the customization of the products. Customers can do special orders or customization of Outfides products; with this strategy, the company can adjust the selling price by an order made by the customer and it will help to resolve the problem of high production cost because the company will only produce a product that make profit. So it give an advantageous for both parties, which is the customers can get the product in accordance with their needs and the company solve the problem of high production costs through trimming product costs by not producing a product that is less attractive to potential consumers and produce more specific or custom orders.
Nowadays, especially in Indonesia where the middle-upper society are rising, then appeared the challenges of demand and desire from consumers for something different and exclusive as well as their involvement, personal attachment and experiences of any products they consume. For that, the solution to be done by Outfides is to customize product that are intended to provide added value and increase the uniqueness of its products. With this innovation, customer can be able to modify and customize the Outfides products in accordance with their needs and desires and to respond the demand of consumers who want to be different and exclusive. It also helps Outfides to face the competition among large companies who produce the similar products massively and sell at a lower price.
Furthermore, to solve the price issue is by creating promotion and discount program. The programs for example are promotion program like buy 1 get 2, reduction sale, discounts, bonuses, rebates for the purchase of a certain amount, or a gift if someone successfully invited other potential customers to buy a product. Therefore, Outfides will do these programs, which is intended to attract more customers; and because the company also engaged in online business then the use of the Internet will make it easy to compare one store to another store, so these programs will make Outfides different and more attractive. Then since Outfides has competitive and affordable price, provide a good quality product, these will makes the promotion and discount program are easy to be applied.
D. Promotion
Figure 9. 4-Ps: Promotion Solutions
The last problem is about promotion; such as
Outfides marketing activities were not well organized, there are high competition in promotion itself and low brand awareness issue. To face and solve these problems, the author suggests Outfides to hire a employee to handle marketing activities; do an endorsement and create a promotion program that involve the customers to face the competition; and also maintain the social media and do an above the line marketing to increase brand awareness.
During the last year, marketing activities
undertaken by Outfides not managed properly and regularly, in other words is not done maximally. Outfides should hire a digital media admin to do all activities related to website and social media, such as: receiving order, communicate with potential customers
222
and followers, respond complain and comments, give a tips and update an information on a regular basis.
Then, because of many similar products sold
online, makes competitor getting tougher in marketing and promoting their product. Building a marketing strategy and brand campaign through endorsement can draw attention to the product. As for person who is chosen to be endorser is someone who give a great impact, high appropriateness and recognition to the product; a well-known person or we can say a celebrity. So, with do an endorsement and using it as a promotion tools to gain a high brand exposure and attention, it will help Outfides to face the high competition in promotion because this strategy provides a distinct differentiation for Outfides.
Beside of that, Outfides requires a good
promotional strategy that is able to awaken the interest of the society and potential customer such as: the participation of customers in such promotional program and activities, so there is a sense of involvement and attachment between the customer and the company and because sometimes consumers expect rewards in the form of goods or in other forms. The promotion program and activities intended are like photo contest, giveaway program, free vouchers and so on. By give the customers a voucher or clothes to who participate and win in these programs; and give a discount if they follow or mention Outfides on Instagram and Twitter, it will increase customer’s intention of purchase and the company also knows what kind of promotion that customer interested in.
And the last problem faced by Outfides related to
promotion is the low brand awareness. So, to solve it, Outfides should maintain the social media and do an above the line marketing. One way to maintain the social media is by doing social media management through online software like Hootsuite, Buffer, SocialOomph, Social Media Rush, and so on; using paid ads on Facebook, Youtube Ads, Tweet sponsor, and SFS (shoutout for shoutout) in Instagram; and also do a cooperation with some city account information center in Twitter who already
have thousands followers on their account like @infojakarta and @infobdg. As an start-up business, Outfides has never spend budget for advertising in mass media like radio, TV, newspaper, magazines, billboard and so on which is a good tool to increase brand awareness in society. Outfides first step to start trying an above the line activities is cooperating with local radios by providing free voucher or free gift for the winner in the quiz; then make an agreement with local free magazines, which are distributed in Jakarta and Bandung, it will be great to Outfides first step of above the line activites because the media space in that media will be more cheaper than paid magazine. E. OASIS
The OASIS framework is a 5-step plan to integrate Social Media into the daily business. Based on the information and analysis before, there is a summary of OASIS Framework for Outfides that possible to support the root cause analysis (Exhibit 1).
4. Implementation Plan
A. Digital Marketing Optimization
According to business solution formulation that been generated and discussed before, the next step is designing an implementation plan for Outfides. Considering of Outfides current situation and condition, the author would suggest a plan to optimize the digital marketing strategy. The first step in starting digital marketing is through a website, it because website the most critical point and a place where the sales took place then also has a role to representing the brand/product of the company. The key points in build a website are as follows: 1. Designing a website for the convenience of
visitors and potential buyers 2. Utilizing search engine ads (e.g. Google
AdWords) 3. Optimizing a website through SEO 4. Building brand awareness by using display
ads or banner (e.g. Google Display Network)
Whereas, for social media as the marketing
support which is intended to improve customer trust and brand loyalty of product, Outfides should be enhance the use of
223
Instagram and Twitter and coupled with the use of other social media, that is Facebook through Facebook Page and Facebook Ads. Currently, have a Facebook fan page is a necessity in the business activity of inbound marketing.
After developing Facebook Page, the next step is
to make and implement Facebook Ads, which is a Facebook's advertising program that designed to help companies promote products, services or its Facebook fan page accordance with the target audience. Via Facebook Ads, ads will be more effective because it only focused and appear in people who have the location, interests, and demographic which corresponds to the target; information would quickly spread and create virality on fellow Facebook users; the target can be routed directly to the company’s website as their landing page; and in addition, the payment system of Facebook Ads are based on cost-per-clicks and cost per impressions. Figure 4.6 is an illustration of Facebook Ads.
The implementation of digital marketing strategy
optimization suggested and recommended by the author to be done first is emphasize on the usability, convenience in use, effectiveness, and development of the website itself, includes web marketing, web layout design and customization system development of Outfides website.
- Proposed Web Marketing
The key points of web marketing development are as follows, and the summary of Outfides web marketing can be seen in Table 4. 1. Setting goals and specify objectives for the
website 2. Rearranging the marketing mix to reach
the audience and define the target market 3. Finding and understanding the right
domain name of the website 4. Applying the marketing communication
and branding with logo 5. Designing and developing content of the
website, which is should be effective, accessible, easy to use, and can attracts new visitors then bring them back for more
6. Maintaining the web presence
Table 4. Web Marketing Summary
- Proposed Website Layout Design
Implementing a market-of-one-perspective
through customization on website can be
viewed through the development and
updating of website design that aims to
achieve the custom system. According
Wiraspati (2014) that refers to the study of
Phan (1998), market of one perspective itself
is the system that allows the customization
process on the products and services to be
adapted to the needs and desires of each
customer efficiently.
Based on the analysis and observations that
have been made that generate and provide
input and key points in the development of
the website as the main channel digital
marketing of Outfides, as shown in Exhibit 2 is
the layout of the proposed design of the new
website of Outfides that supports optimize
digital marketing strategies. As for these
layout aims to improve the efficiency and
effectiveness of the process of ordering
products, providing added value and
convenience for customers through design
accessible and easy to use.
Outfides Proposed Web Marketing
Domain outfides.com
Goals Branding and generating
Target
Market
Female, young urban women, aged
18-26, live in Java Island and around
Indonesia area in major cities or
urban area with high density
population, a college student or
newcomer in office, expend more
than IDR 300,000 for clothes, a
middle-up class, youthful and
dynamic, familiar with online
shopping, aware of the latest fashion
trends, have a casual dress sense and
tend to choose limited and good
quality product but still at an
affordable price
224
In Exhibit 2, figure A illustrates the layout design of the website as a whole, followed by figure B which illustrates Outfides collection, as well as figure C and D which illustrates a custom order. As can be seen in Figure A, is an illustration of the home screen on the website, which on this page visitors and customers can instantly see the entire new collection of Outfides through the slideshows. On the left side of the page is a site map of a website that consists of: new arrivals, sale, outfides store, customize and lookbook. When a visitor or customer clicks the “New Arrivals”, it will appear a page as in figure B. On this page they can see what products are launched and produced in the latest collection of Outfides along with the price of each product. Furthermore, in accordance with the goals Outfides to implement market of one perspective through customization on their website, so when visitors or customers click on the "Customize" or click "Customize Yours" that shown on the product's photo, then it will show a page to make a custom order which can be seen in figures C and D. On this customization page, customers can make changes and able to modify Outfides products according to their needs and desires, which is expected to provide added value and convenience of those customers.
- Customization System Development Try to answer the challenges, seize the
opportunities and realize it, then the author
suggests Outfides to implement a
customization system in manufacturing
process of their products. As for customization
approach adapted by Outfides for this
customization system development on their
website is Customizers Adaptive. According to
Gilmore and Pine (1997), Customizers
Adaptive approach is the approach where the
company offers standard products, but still
can be adjusted. The products are designed in
standard form is made in such a way, so that
the user or customer can still make changes
personally.
With this approach, customer can do
adjustment on selected Outfides products to
be tailored to their tastes. As for the
adjustments that can be made are: the
preferences of materials used, the color of the
fabric, the processing time and size, so that it
creates comfortability and satisfaction to the
customer. In addition, through this system
consumers do not need to adjust it to the
tailor again or do direct measurement at the
tailor. Because, through the Outfides website
which is already developed with this
customization system, consumers can make
their own order and measurement online. So,
there is no longer a problem within location,
wherever they were, this online system surely
can make they can do a custom order easily.
As for the illustration and further explanation
about the layout design of Outfides website
that have been developed with customization
system is as follows. The following Figure 10
shows the proposed website layout of
Outfides, that is the home screen of the
website. This home screen look has not much
changed from the first display; there remains
a slideshow content of Outfides products. The
web designer adds a “Customize” menu
before “Lookbook” menu. “Customize” menu
created to implement the custom system,
where the customer can choose a custom
orders option.
225
Figure 10. Development of Outfides Website:
Home
Furthermore, as shown below in Figure 11,
when a customer clicks on the “New Arrivals”
menu, then it will show the page of Outfides
latest collections. The picture below is the
latest Spring/Summer 2015 collections named
SEA, with blue shades and using denim fabrics
or materials for all products in this collection.
Like the previous collections, this collection
also consists of: overalls, outerwear, skirts,
dress, and trousers. In this menu, customers
can make purchase ordinarily (common) by
clicking on the desired product to put in the
shopping cart as a list of items selected or
purchased. However, with the development
and implementation of customization,
customers can also make changes or custom
orders on the selected product by clicking the
"Customize Yours".
Figure 11. Development of Outfides Website:
Collection
With an option of custom orders, customers
can make change and able to modify
the Outfides products in accordance to their
needs and desires. The following Figure 12 is
the display of the website when customers
click the “Customize” or click "Customize
Yours" on the products they select. For
example, when a customer selects the skirt,
then they want to make changes or ordering
custom as they want, it will appear as follows.
On the “Customize” above, customers can
choose what material is used, the color, the
processing time, and size, which for size,
customers can choose the common size as S,
M, L or they can put their body measurement
specifically in the box provided, then in the
last box will come out the final price of the
additional custom orders they did.
Figure 12. Development of Outfides Website:
Customization
B. Implementation Timeline The entire plan to optimize the digital marketing
strategy, solution of on 4-Ps (Product, Placement, Price, Promotion) Marketing Mix and OASIS explained would be turn into an implementation timeline, which started from October 2015 until March 2016 and up. The business implementation timeline of Outfides will show in Exhibit 3.
5. Conclusion From the explanation before, it can be
concluded that the business issues faced by
Outfides is about a start-up business that has
been running for almost a year but did not
meet its Break Even Point (BEP). After
scanning the situational analysis both internal
and external, so the author would know more
detail of the current situation and condition of
Outfides then formulate the right strategy as a
solution, according to the root cause of
226
business problem that faced by Outfides on
marketing side. The solution is optimize digital
marketing strategy, through web marketing,
web layout design and customization system
development, because Outfides choose and
use website as their main channel of digital
marketing, promotion and distribution, where
all kind of Outfides sales process are done in
their website. Related to the solution offered,
the digital marketing strategy optimization
that has been formulated should be
implemented in real action plan by
implementation business timeline. This action
plan needs to be monitored and maintained
by Outfides to discover whether it make a
significant impact to the company in achieving
goals to solve the problem well.
References
Armstrong, Gary & Kotler, Philip, 2005,
Marketing: An Introduction 7th Edition.
Upper Saddle River, N.J.: Prentice Hall.
Dibb, Sally & Simkin, Lyndon, 1996, The
Market Segmentation Workbook: Target
Marketing for Marketing Managers.
Routledge, London.
Gilmore, James H & Pine II, B. Joseph, 1997,
The Four Faces of Mass Customization.
Harvard Business Review; Vol.5 Issue 1
page 91 – 101 Jan/Feb 1997. United States.
Herawan, Didit, 2013, Profil Pengguna Internet
Indonesia. Indonesia Internet Service
Provider Association, www.apjii.or.id.
Kotler, Philip & Keller, Kevin, 2009, Marketing
Management: 13th Edition. New Jersey:
Prentice Hall.
Anonymous, 2014, Pengguna Internet 2014,
Berapa Data Nielsen? available on
http://sosmedtoday.com/2014/09/penggu
na-internet-2014-berapa-data-nielsen/
Anonymous, 2014, Indonesia to lead SE Asian online shopping boom available on http://www.channelnewsasia.com/news/asiapacific/indonesia-to-lead-se/1507832.html
Anonymous, 2014, Online Shopping Trends in
Indonesia available on
http://dotugo.com/blog/advertising/online
-shopping-in-indonesia.html
Anonymous, 2014, E-Commerce di Indonesia
Sudah Diatur Dalam UU Perdagangan on
http://www.pajak.go.id/content/e-
commerce-di-indonesia-sudah-diatur-
dalam-uu-perdagangan
Anonymous, 2010, Penjual Barang Online
Bayar PPh available on
http://www.hukumonline.com/berita/baca
/lt4c49c44c5a5be/penjual-barang-online-
bayar-pph
Caroline, 2013, How to Optimize Your Digital
Marketing Strategy available on
https://retargeter.com/blog/strategy-
2/optimize-your-digital-marketing
DG Team, 2014, Kampanye & Strategi Digital
Marketing available on
http://www.slideshare.net/jejualan/materi
-compile-seminar-jejualan-revisi-final-
33531370
Dimed, Cabo and Joulyana, Saouma, 2005,
Celebrity Endorsement - Hidden Factors to
Success. Jönköping University available on
http://www.diva-
portal.org/smash/get/diva2:3943/FULLTEX
T01.pdf
Janssen, Cory, 2015, Digital Marketing on
http://www.techopedia.com/definition/27
110/digital-marketing
Martin, 2014, Marketing 101: Understanding
the Marketing Mix Concept – 4Ps available
on http://www.entrepreneurial-
insights.com/understanding-marketing-
mix-concept-4ps/
227
Mitra, Wyndo, 2014, Belajar SEO: Bagaimana
Cara Memaksimalkan Penggunaan Google
Keyword Planner Bagi Toko Online Anda
available on
http://startupbisnis.com/belajar-bisnis-
online-seo-bagaimana-cara-
memaksimalkan-penggunaan-google-
keyword-planner-bagi-toko-online-anda/
Taylor-Powell E, Steele S, 1996, Collecting
Evaluation Data: Direct Observation.
University of Wisconsin Cooperative
Extension. Available on
http://learningstore.uwex.edu/pdf/G3658-
5.PDF
Ulum, M. Miftahul, 2011, Pentingnya CRM
Untuk Meningkatkan Loyalitas Pelanggan
available on http://ryu-
fkm10.web.unair.ac.id/artikel_detail-
36186-Marketing-
Pentingnya%20CRM%20(Customer%20Rela
tionship%20Management)%20Untuk%20M
eningkatkan%20Loyalitas%20Pelanggan.ht
ml
Wiranata, Sandika, 2014, 5 Perspektif E-
Commerce available on http://web-
teknikinformatika.blogspot.com/2014/03/
5-perspektif-e-commerce.html
Wiraspati, Rangga, 2013, Inilah Jurus
Menggarap Kelas Menengah available on
http://swa.co.id/business-
strategy/management/inilah-jurus-
menggarap-kelas-menengah
228
Exhibit 1
OASIS
Framework Recommendations
OB
JEC
TIV
ES
" Your Outfit Ideas! "
Corporate Objective:
1. Has a loyal customer 2. Have a successful and top of minds online fashion brand 3. Being a sustainable business that shown from a good financial
performance 4. Become a leader in fashion industry especially in young women
segment 5. Continuously grow and innovating
Social Media Objective:
1. Achieve the market-of-one perspective 2. Maintaining social media already owned to increase brand awareness
AU
DIE
NC
E
Customer who is:
Female, young urban women, aged 18-26, live in Java Island and around
Indonesia area in major cities or urban area with high density population,
a college student or newcomer in office, expend more than IDR 300,000
for clothes, a middle-up class, youthful and dynamic, familiar with online
shopping, aware of the latest fashion trends, have a casual dress sense
and tend to choose limited and good quality product but still at an
affordable price
STR
ATE
GY
1. Do a website development and update the content that allow customization system or the customer can do a custom order
2. Conducting Customer Relationship Management (CRM) through website and social networks
3. Do a celebrity endorsement and promotion programs through social media
IMP
LEM
ENTA
TIO
N
(IN CHAPTER 4)
1. Optimize digital marketing strategy, include: - Web marketing - Website layout design - Customization system development
2. Create an implementation timeline
229
OASIS Framework for Outfides Exhibit 2
SUST
AIN
MEN
T
After do the digital marketing and launched the website, the next step
are: keep measuring the goals and make adjustment with doing website
monitoring and analytics, then provide a convenient communication,
listen and interact with the customers, gauge the reactions, ask for
feedback and question, and also provide satisfactory service to make
them return and make a purchase again in the future. Establish new
publication and promotion channels if it needed.
230
231
SMALL MEDIUM ENTERPRISE (SMES) DEVELOPMENT STRATEGY IN
ENHANCING THE LOCAL COMPETITIVENESS BY USING CLUSTER
MANAGEMENT APPLICATION
Mochamad Edris
Faculty of Economic, University of Muria Kudus, Central Java, Indonesia
gederiana@yahoo.com
M. Zainuri
Faculty of Economic, University of Muria Kudus, Central Java, Indonesia
Mamik Indaryani
Faculty of Economic, University of Muria Kudus, Central Java, Indonesia
Marthin Nanere
Faculty of Business, Economic and Law, La Trobe University, Australia
ABSTRACT
The purpose of this research is to make Padurenan village as productive village of
excellent local areas production centers (embroidery and convection), through pilot project
of productive village that implements cooperative-based cluster management that can be
used as a model for other regions in the development of SMEs into the global market. Method
of the data were collected with a combination of secondary data and primary data through
surveys, interviews, and Focus Group Discussion. The survey was conducted to embroidery
and convection employers in Padurenan village, Kudus regency that are members of
Koperasi Serba Usaha “Padurenan Jaya”. Diamond cluster used in the development of
clusters of SMEs especially in Padurenan village could give a discourse for SME cluster
development with the involvement of various parties, ranging of the production chain
(suppliers, distributors and marketers), the government of SMEs, universities, and banking in
accordance with their respective capacities. To penetrate the export market, it takes products
which have standard of abroad market demand as well as the design they want (market
driven). Cooperatives as the economic center for the management proved to be very
supportive of SMEs in the cluster, so that entrepreneurs can be mutually supportive with each
other and create a good synergy.
Keywords: SMEs, Competitiveness, and Cluster Management
INTRODUCTION
232
SMEs in Kudus Regency has a vital and strategic role, particularly in terms of the
number of business units that until the year 2010 reached 10.542 units with absorption of at
least around 50% of the existing workers. Although the numbers are quite large and
dominant, but an increase in the role of the regional economy is still considered relatively
slow. Therefore, this sector should be encouraged and facilitated to be able to optimize
existing resources, in order to have a value and highly competitive, so it can play a role in the
growth and accelerating economic in the future.
The focus of this study is the development of clusters of SMEs that implement cluster
management using diamond cluster model approach based on cooperative in supporting the
acceleration of development of the economy of the region into the global market.
Making Padurenan village as productive village of excellent local areas production
centers (embroidery and convection), one of pilot projects of productive village that
implement cluster management cooperative-based that can be used as a model for other
regions in the development of SMEs into the global market .
The interaction among universities, government and SMEs is a description of the triple
helix in which academics to be an actor in the development of science and technology or the
motor of a knowledge-based economy, the government as a regulator and facilitator in the
development and mastery of science and technology as well as the creation of the market,
while SMEs contribute as spearhead of national economic development. Related research
conducted by Bank Indonesia shows that in Kudus Regency, cigarette industry sector,
embroidery, and convection get 1, 2, and 3 ranks, then convection trade and peddlers get 4
and 5 ranks. The results of Fauzi (2010) shows that trust, communication, commitment,
conflict resolution and raw materials have an influence on the success of buyer supplier
relationships 67,6%. And the remaining 32,4% is influenced by other factors. While the
construct of the performance gets R square value of 0.569504, which means that the
performance is influenced by the success of supplier buyer relationships 56,95%. It can be
concluded that there are other factors that affect the performance of Enterprises Cluster
outside buyer supplier relationships constructs success of 43.05%.
Cluster-Based SMEs
Definition of cluster is defined as the center of activities of SMEs in centers that have
developed, characterized by the emergence of more advanced entrepreneurs employers, and
happens specialization in the production process of each SME is accompanied by economic
activities are interrelated and mutually supportive. In practice, though operationally cluster
233
has different characteristics to the centers but it is not uncommon for people to use it in
interrelationship. (Desrochers and Sautet, 2004)
In Indonesia there are many development programs of group-based SMEs that have
been done, such as through: (1) extension workers, (2) the provision of a motivator to the
business group, (3) provision of technical support through technical assistance units and
BDS, (4) the implementation of trade fairs to develop marketing networks of SMEs, (5) the
manufacturing of trading house, and others. Some names have also been linked with the
model of this group approach, for example: SME centers, Cluster, Small Industrial Village
(PIK), Small Industrial Environment (LIK), Enclave, Agropolitan and others.
Institutions/Agencies that implement these efforts were diverse, ranging from the
Government through the Departments of government to community groups through Non
Government Organizations (NGOs). (Canela, Eduardo, 2001)
Growth of SMEs starts to become a quite warm topic since the emerge of the thesis of
flexible specialization in the 1980s, based on the experience of the centers of Small Scale
Industries (ISK) and Medium Scale Industries (ISM) in several countries in Western Europe,
particularly Italy (Becattini, 1990; Tambunan, 1999). As an example of case, that in 1970-
1980s, when the Large Scale Industries in England, Germany and Italy got stagnancy or
sluggishness, apparently Small Scale Industries (concentrated in specific locations to form
centers) that make traditional products experienced rapid growth and even develop export
markets for these goods and absorb a lot of labors. This experience indicates that small
industries in the centers can be developed more rapidly, more flexible in facing market
changes, and it can increase the production rather than small individual industries outside the
center.
Taiwan’s experience, as a comparison, it shows the economy can grow rapidly because
it is supported by a number of small and medium enterprises called community-based
industries. Industry development in Taiwan which successfully penetrate the global market, it
is supported by the dynamic SMEs contribution. Though it is not as fast as the growth of
SMEs in Taiwan, Indonesia, SMEs in Indonesia have also proved to have an important role,
especially when judging in terms of number of business units and labor absorbed. (Koizumi,
Hajime, 2003)
Based on the above explanations, then it is appropriate when SMEs as one of the
activators of economic activity in Indonesia needs to be developed. The participation of all
parties needs to be generated simultaneously. Both central and local government in
empowering them with the role of SMEs in developing and creating a policy in favor of
234
SMEs. While businesses, communities and other stakeholders give thought contibutions and
facilitations according to their respective capabilities, but remains concentrated in a
representative forum. SME development patterns corresponding paradigm developed at this
time and is still regarded effectively done through SME development program with group
and territorial approach (clusters based).
Porter Diamond Cluster
The cluster approach of Porter’s model is the development of industrial district or
industrial areas developed by Alfred Marshall in 1920 (Desrochers and Sautet, 2004). Unlike
Marshall who only focuses on similar companies, the cluster approach of Porter’s model does
not limit to just one industry, but more broadly. Diamond Cluster Model, including related
industries, as well as other companies that have relevance in the technology, the same input.
By working together in a cluster, then the company / related industries will get benefit from
the synergy and high efficiency compared to working alone. According to Porter (2002)
clusters can be formed in the cities, the regions, and even countries.
Hypothesis
Government has an important role in maintaining macroeconomic and political
stability. This is done through government institutions through fiscal policy, monetary policy,
trade and others. In addition to maintaining macroeconomic stability, the government also has
a vital role to improve the microeconomic capacity in industrial clusters.
This can be done by the government, among others by applying the law enforcement for
the distorted industry, reducing costs and cutting bureaucratic rules and laws that impede
economic activity or industry. The government is also authorized to create a climate of
healthy competition. In the input factors, government must build the infrastructure needed by
industry.
Meanwhile, the private sector can work together with universities to develop research
and establishing training centers to improve the skills of the labor, inventory provisions that
hampering business and discuss with the government to find a solution. From the
proposition, it can be constructed a hypothesis as follows;
Universities, private enterprises (SMEs), and government can improve local
Competitiveness by using Cluster Management Application.
Methods
235
This study uses Cluster Diamond of Porter’s model method and value chain approach.
Value chain is a series of productive processes from the input provider of a product,
production, marketing and distribution of the last consumers. This approach systematically
takes into account all stages from production and also the analysis of the various linkages and
flow of information throughout the chain. The application of the value chain in the context of
industrial clusters will create linkages and tighter integration among actors to strengthen the
cluster itself, and increase the competitiveness of the sub-sector concerned. Method of
collecting the data was conducted with a combination of secondary data and primary data
through surveys, interviews, and Focus Group Discussion. The survey was conducted to
embroidery and convection employers in Padurenan village, Kudus that are members of
Koperasi Serba Usaha “Padurenan Jaya”.
Results and Discussions
Training to improve understanding of the global market potential and intelligent market.
Marketing information system is essential for market participants to make decisions in
buying and selling. Therefore, delivery of market information quickly and accurately will
help in estimating their business opportunities so that they are able to anticipate any
developments and market opportunities at an early stage. Arising opportunities from
globalization should be supported by global market information systems that are reliable as a
basis for market intelligence in the future. Businesses that must be anticipated is how to
obtain a wide variety of market information which is used to deal with competitors and
market penetration (domestic and international). To obtain the data / information that is used
as a work around the market, it is needed a market information system that can access the
information provider globally, accurately and timely. To gain information network access to
the global market, it is needed information system that is one of them with the use of the
internet network.
Training of embroidery crafts
Craft industry is now experiencing rapid development, especially in terms of design.
Design is determining the value of a handicraft product. A handicraft product can be valuable
if it is designed properly even though the material is cheap, and on the contrary expensive
materials if the design is not good will be worth cheaper. So it can be said that design plays
an important role in determining the value of a work of craft. With the implementation of the
training activities, it is expected embroidery designs can be varied so that it can improve the
quality of products produced.
236
Workshop on improving the quality of the embroidery skills to support export activities
Business people are required to produce the products according to consumer tastes or
demand of the market, which have a tendency to rapidly change, so that the circulation of a
product on the market has a relatively short cycle. This will further trigger the creativity and
innovation to improve product competitiveness. However, it is also a weakness owned by
SMEs. SMEs have difficulty in producing a product specification in accordance with the
development of consumer tastes. Therefore, SMEs need training and internships to enhance
skills in generating competitive products. SMEs require facilitation related to the needs of
equipment / technology in an effort to improve the quality and product innovation.
The introduction of the product to the consumer with the exhibition (expo)
The exhibition has a plus in the business world. Besides it can be used as a platform to
introduce products to the public, the exhibition also serves to bring together entrepreneurs
with potential customers, buyer, and agents. The exhibition can also create relationships
among fellow businesses so that they can establish business networking equally profitable.
For most businesses, the exhibition is considered as the most effective marketing
strategies. Often the exhibition organized by the government or the private sector is like a
door to success for their business expansion as well as solving the crisis could hinder
business competition.
The benefits that can be gained by businesses by following a number of exhibitions.
Introducing new products. There’s no perfect event to showcase new products in addition to
the exhibition. Provision of a brochure or pamphlet and card companies is a mandatory. This
also applies to introduce products with new innovation. To strengthen the image of the
company. Exhibition is shown that it can strengthen the image of the company. Although the
business is stable and gained recognition from the market but not the means to participate in
the exhibition shall not be on the agenda again for the businesses. Actually participating in
the current exhibition when it has been steady effort can prove the existence of the company.
In this case, businesses can give the best service to customers in order to improve
relationships and to implant the company’s image towards the comsumer’s view. Market
surveys. The exhibition can also act as a means of surveys for businesses. Through the
exhibition, businesses can find out how much the interest of the visitors to their products. In
addition, proceeds from the sale during the exhibition can be used as an evaluation to
237
improve the quality and to determine the business strategy in the future. Collecting
information about Competitors. In addition to marketing the products, at fairs, businesses can
also collect information related to competitors as much as possible. A chance to get to know
the characteristics of the products of competitors, ranging from price, excellence, equipment
to open wide marketing area at the exhibition which is usually followed by a lot of
participants from various regions. Realizing and Improving Quality of Human Resources.
The best time to assess the performance of the team owned by a business entity is when
participating the exhibition. The ability and expertise of human resources in promoting
products and serve visitors could be seen and developed in this event. Once the exhibition is
over, the business owner can evaluate the quality of its human resources and to increase by
auditing the performance of each employee.
Revitalization of the website as a means of promotion are centralized and managed by the
cooperative entrepreneurs.
One key to the success of SME clusters Embroidery is the availability of a clear market
for SME products. While the fundamental weaknesses encountered in the field of marketing
is the low market orientation, weak in the complex and a sharp competition and inadequate in
marketing infrastructure. Easy and availability of market information for SMEs Embroidery
will greatly help in expanding its business to the export market. If the market information is
now accessible easily and quickly, at least it will be a motivation for SMEs to run their
businesses more seriously, so that it will grow more advance. Abroad experience has proved
that through the application of information technology, small and medium companies can
become great companies in the world-class in a short time. Through a web-based promotional
activities, will encourage the growth and development of micro, small and medium
enterprises in the era of information technology today.
Training to improve understanding of the global market potential and intelligent market
Internet marketing, also known as digital marketing, web marketing, online marketing,
search marketing or e-marketing, is the marketing (generally promotion) of products or
services through Internet. Internet marketing is considered broader in scope because it is not
only refers to marketing on the Internet, but also includes marketing that is done via e-mail
and wireless media Digital customer data and electronic customer relationship management
(eCRM). Systems are also often grouped together under internet marketing. Internet
marketing ties together creative and technical aspects of the Internet, including design,
development, advertising, and sales. Internet marketing also refers to the placement of media
along the various stages of the customer engagement cycle through search engine marketing
238
(SEM), search engine optimization (SEO), banner of advertisement on specific websites,
email marketing, and Web 2.0 strategies.
Challenges faced for export via the internet today is how to become number one in
Google searching. Google has changed its search algorithm so that this time it took a long
time to learn to become number one in the search results, or at least on the first page. This
situation develops over the last three years. Other challenges faced Indonesian exporters who
use the internet is a matter of licensing. Currently there are additional procedures such as
SPLK that add costs to exporters. This problem can not be solved solely by the exporter. It
needs help from the government to facilitate licensing.
Development Strategy
In relation to the development of SMEs in the future there are several possible
scenarios. SME and padurenan’s cluster will continue to grow. This is assuming that the
growth of SMEs at this time will continue to happen and obstacles to developing can be
overcomed. SMEs, especially convection did not develop (stagnant) due to the circumstances
and obstacles to developing insurmountable. It will decline steadily, because of the current
labors are more enfibled and no replacement. On the other hand, other factors of production
(raw materials and equipment) does not develop, while competition with similar products
occurs. In order to develop new markets, namely foreign markets then, in the short term is
more focused on helping SMEs in managing the market through product benchmarking,
market surveys, promotion via the Web of Padurenan Jaya, and human resources (including
managing the structure of labor’s salary)
239
Picture 1. Development Model
Conclusion
Diamond cluster method used in the development of clusters of SMEs especially in the
village of Padurenan could give a discourse for the development of SME clusters with very
good results with the involvement of various parties, ranging from the production chain
(suppliers, distributors and marketers), the government in this case the Department of Trade,
Industrial, and Cooperative of SMEs, universities, and banking in accordance with their
respective capacities. To penetrate the export market, it takes products which have standard
of the demand of the abroad market as well as the design they want (market driven).
Cooperatives as the economic center proved to be very supportive for the economic
management of SMEs in the cluster, so that entrepreneurs can be mutually supportive with
each other and create a good synergy. Indicator of achievements in the implementation of this
3-years program is improving the quality of embroidery products according to standards of
export market and oriented market (market driven). The success of SME development
programs in enhancing the local competitiveness in the implementation of Cluster
Management depends on the synergies and the coordination of various parties both
academics, government and industry as well as other components of society who have the
commitment and the authority in accordance with the basic tasks functions held. Particularly
through the development of selected SMEs which have the capacity as a trigger of the
development of SMEs in the region and have impact on the region economic. Universities
Training and
Mentoring
Computer
Embroidery
Machine
Skilled
Labor
Website ,
Accounting
Computer
Supplier
Distributor
Marketers
Cooperative of
Padurenan Jaya
Stall Areal of
Commerce
Villages Around
Domestic
Market
Overseas
Markets
Related
Industries
Stakeholders : Governments , Banks , CSR (SOE ) , MSE
, GIZ , Community , Donor / BDS / NGOs, Etc.
240
through the Tri Dharma can accomplish its mission to become agents of change and
development for real.
References
Abdullah, Piter, dkk., (2002). Daya Saing Daerah: Konsep dan Pengukurannya di
Indonesia.Pusat Pendidikan dan Studi Kebanksentralan Bank
Indonesia.BPFE.Yogyakarta.
Canela, Eduardo, (2001). Business Development Services for Small and Medium Enterprises
and Cooperatives in Indonesia: Some Key Guidelines and Needs. Laporan Kajian.
USAID dan BPSKPKM.
Desrochers dan Sautet. 2004. Cluster Based Economic Strategy, Fasilitation Policy and The
Market Process, The Review og Austrian Economics, Vol. 17. P. 233 – 245.
Feri Fauzi, 2010, Analisis Keberhasilan Hubungan Pembeli Pemasok Untuk Meningkatkan
Kinerja Usaha Klaster(Studi kasus : Klaster Industri Bordir dan Konveksi Desa
PadurenanKecamatan Gebog Kabupaten Kudus), Laporan Penelitian.
Humprey, John and Schmitz, Robert, (1995). Principles for Promoting Clusters and
Networks of SMEs.UNIDO. Austria.
Japan International Cooperation Agency, (2003). Studi Mengenai Peningkatan Kapasitas
Kluster Usaha Kecil dan Menengah (UKM) di Indonesia. Laporan Perkembangan. KRI
International Corp. Tokyo.
Kementerian Koperasi dan Usaha Kecil dan Menengah RI, (2001). Petunjuk Teknis
Perkuatan Permodalan UKMK dan Lembaga Keuangannya dengan Penyediaan Modal
Awal dan Padanan (MAP) Melalui Koperasi Simpan Pinjam/Unit Simpan Pinjam
Koperasi.
Koizumi, Hajime, (2003). Strengthening Capacity of SME Clusters : Master Concept and
Strategy for SME Cluster Development from Lessons Learnt. JICA Study Team.
Mosselman, Marco dan Prince, Yvonne, (2004). Review of Methods to Measure The
Effectiveness of State Aid to SME.EIM.European Community.
Nadvi, Khalid, (1995). Industrial Clusters and Networks: Case Studies of SME Growth and
Innovation. UNIDO. Austria
Porter, Michael E. (2000). Clusters and New Economics of Competition. Harvard Business
Review. Boston
Rofi, Abdur,(2012). Padurenan Cluster Situation Analysis 2012 (Propinsi Jawa Tengah,
Wilayah Pakudjembara). Laporan Kajian. GIZ
Shaw, Alastair, (2005). A Guide to Performance Measurement and Non-Financial Indicators.
The Foundation for Performance Management.
Soetrisno, Noer, (2003). Providing Financial Support for Micro Enterprise Development in
Indonesia. Kementerian Koperasi dan UKM Indonesia
241
Soetrisno, Noer, (2002). Strategi Penguatan UKM. Melalui Pendekatan Klaster Bisnis;
Konsep, Pengalaman Empiris, dan Harapan Kerjasama. Bina Masyarakat Madani
dengan Asosiasi BDS Indonesia
_ _ _, 2010. Cetak Biru Desa Produktif Bordir dan Konveksi Padurenan Melalui Pendekatan
Diamond Cluster.
242
THE INFLUENCE OF SERVICE MARKETING MIX TOWARD STUDENTS
DECISIONS TO STUDY AT THE CENTER FOR COMPUTING
INFORMATION AND TECHNOLOGY FAKULTAS TEKNIK
UNIVERSITAS INDONESIA
Siska Purnama Manurung1, Management Department, Harapan Bangsa Business
School, Jl.Dipatiukur 80-82, Bandung-40132, Indonesia, siska@ithb.ac.id
Ikhlas Nurzaman2, Management Department, Harapan Bangsa Business School,
Jl.Dipatiukur 80-82, Bandung-40132, Indonesia, ikhlas99nurzaman@gmail.com
Tasya Aspiranti3, Management Magister Department, Universitas Islam Bandung,
Jl. Purnawarman 59, Bandung-40116, Indonesia, ad_tasya@yahoo.com
ABSTRACT
Education is a fundamental factor in an effort to improve the quality of life of a person and
also a decisive factor for economic and social development towards a better condition.
According to Wijaya (2012), education service product is a product, service, or any school
property that provides benefits for education services customers, both internal and external.
Center for Computing and Information Technology (CCIT) Fakultas Teknik Universitas
Indonesia (FTUI) realized the importance of services marketing in establishing the existence
of the institution need to be done. This research aims to explain the responses of the
respondents regarding the services marketing mix, students decisions to study, and how big
the influence of service marketing mix of students to study. The result showed that services
marketing mix is a significant and positive influence towards the students decisions to study
at CCIT FTUI. The result also showed that the current of services marketing mix already
proven to affect the students decisions to study at CCIT FTUI.
INTRODUCTION
Education is one of the very fundamental factors in an effort to improve the quality of life
and also a decisive factor for economic and social development towards a better condition.
Education was also seen as a means to raise the most strategic the dignity of a nation
(Subandowo, 2009). The development of skills and expertise can be achieved through formal
and non-formal education. Through formal education level, the individual will get a proof
that every individual has gone through a process of learning that is feasible and can be
empowered to think independently and critically and to develop abilities and skills in a
globally competent.
IMAGE 1. GROWTH FACILITIES OF HIGHER EDUCATIONAL SERVICES IN
INDONESIA
243
Source: BPS (2014)
Education in Indonesia today is growing with the emergence of colleges. Based on the data of
the Central Bureau of Statistics of Indonesia (BPS), the quantity of higher education
(academic, technical colleges, high schools, institutes and universities) in Indonesia in 2011
is 3,794 colleges, consists of 140 universities and 3,654 private colleges. By 2012, the
quantity is rising to 3.815, consists of 144 universities and 3,671 private colleges. The rising
number of colleges also rising the competition starts from the curriculum, utilization of
technology, information, and communication in learning, improved quality of educators and
educational personnel, procurement of a wide range of educational facilities and
infrastructure to perform networking with other institutions or industries. This competition
requires the educational services agencies to provide information about their services that
relevant and tailored to the needs of the students. Marketing becomes a factor that can be
used to influence the decisions of college students in selecting and further study. According
to Nirwana (2012), the existence of the marketing mix owned by educational institutions have
a great influence in the decision process of students to conduct studies on an ongoing basis,
which is equipped with an integrated marketing mix 7P, which consists of product, price,
place, promotion, people, physical evidence, and process.
Since the number of colleges and insistence on the need for education arise, CCIT FTUI as
one of the engineering institutions in Indonesia provides opportunities for the public to get
the need of education. CCIT FTUI comes with the most comprehensive curriculum which
offers a curriculum of Master Mind Series National Institute of Information Technology, a
unique curriculum combination of Key Technologies and Skills Acquired. The activity of
these components exists on each semester plus a unique learning methods of National
Institute of Information Technology that will make students ready to plunge into the real
world of work. In addition, there are other curriculums such as Islamic banking information
technology curriculum and cloud campus curriculum.
The purpose of this research is to find out and analyse the students responses of regarding
service marketing activities carried out by CCIT FTUI, how the students response against the
decision of the students who study at CCIT FTUI, and how big is the influence of service
marketing mix decisions students make studies in CCIT FTUI.
LITERATURE
MARKETING
Marketing is a means of introducing your product/service to consumers which
products/services based on the needs and environment. Marketing is important, as a marketer
is required to understand the basic problems in their fields and strategize in order to achieve
the objectives of the company. According to Sunyoto (2012), marketing is a human activity
that aims to satisfy the needs and wants of customer through a process of exchange and
stakeholders in the company. Marketing is not only aimed at satisfying the customer needs
alone, but also to pay attention to the interests of all the parties involved in it, such as the
social welfare of employees, the interests of the surrounding community, the interests of the
244
shareholders, environmental pollution and others. According to Gitosudarmo (2012), in
reality, marketing is a business activity which is an effort to meet the needs and desires of the
people, organizations and society at large. While according to Nirwana (2012), marketing is
part of a social and managerial process, in which marketing activities are part of the process
of interaction between the parties providing products with parties who need and want the
product.
SERVICES
According to Lovelock (2011), services traditionally is a phenomenon with many meanings,
especially the way in which services are produced and delivered to the customer are often
difficult to understand, because services are abstract. Here are two approaches regarding the
notions of services (Kotler, 2009):
a) Services is an action or performance offered by one party to the other party, though in the
process associated to a physical product, the performance is essentially intangible and does
not usually result in ownership.
b) Services are economic activities that create value and deliver benefits to customers in a
certain place and time.
According to Nirwana (2012), service is a form of performance that can be identified. Service
product has characteristics that are different from the product non-service. Service is a form
of performance that was given to the customer in order to feel the existence of the service.
While according to Sunyoto (2012), service is an activity that can be identified, which are not
palpable, which is planned for the gratifications on consumers. Basically, the service is
something that is given by one party to the other party, which are intangible and not have the
impact of the transfer of ownership (Wijaya, 2012).
CHARACTERISTIC OF A SERVICE
Services have different characteristics of goods especially in the process of provision, the
embodiment, as well as operational. The characteristics of the services is a part of the form of
performance (Nirwana, 2012). Therefore, Nirwana (2012) outlines the characteristics of
services include:
1) Lack of ownership
Services cannot be stored like a product. The service is used or hired for a certain
period. For example, when buying a plane ticket, the service has a due date and time
stamped ticket usage.
2) Intangibility
Physically intangible, because performance is merely the service, unlike products that
can be touched, felt or seen physically.
3) Inseparability
The existence of the service with the service providers cannot be separated. Meaning,
the process of producing services and the process of service consumption occurs at
the same time.
4) Perishability
The resulting services will be utilized at the time consumed services. The utilization
of the service occurs at the time the services are needed or requested by the customer.
245
5) Variability
Services are formed in accordance with the quality and type of service variation and
depending on the performance desired by the customer.
CLASSIFICATION OF SERVICES
Wijaya (2012) classify services into the service process matrix. In the matrix, the services are
classified into two dimensions that can significantly affect the characteristics of the process
of the service delivery. Compared with the customizable services, services that require
standardized products has a little interaction between customers and service providers.
1). Vertical Dimension
The vertical dimension measure the magnitude of the labour intensity, i.e. the ratio of
labour cost to the cost of capital. Therefore, the service requires a large capital, such as a
car repair shop who was in the position of the bottom row because the initial investment
in the form of facilities and equipment far above the cost of labour. Meanwhile,
educational services are labour intensive, as the school is in the top line of the position
because of the cost, the workforce is relatively larger than the working capital needs.
2). Horizontal Dimension
Horizontal dimension measures the level of interaction and customization of the
customer. The marketing variables that describe the capabilities customers may affect the
nature of the services to be delivered to him. Compared with the customizable services,
services that require standardized products has a little interaction between customers and
service providers.
IMAGE 2. SERVICE PROCESS MATRIX
Source: Wijaya (2012)
MARKETING OF EDUCATIONAL SERVICES
Marketing of educational services is a way to do something where students, students’
parents, school employees, and the public, consider the school as a supporting communities
institution which are dedicated to serving the needs of customers of educational services.
Therefore, the marketing of educational services include activities and tools to promote the
school consistently and effectively as the best educational options for students and parents of
students who are an asset to the community.
MARKETING MIX IN HIGHER EDUCATION
246
1) Product
Product is the major part of the overall marketing mix variables (the marketing mix),
bearing in mind the product is the answer to the wants and needs of consumers.
Product within the scope of marketing is something that can be offered to the market,
but it is not limited to goods, but everything with a value in it.
According to Wijaya (2012), education service product is a product, service, or any
school property that provides benefits for customer education services, both internal
and external. Education service product is a product, service, or any school property
that provides benefits for customer education services, both internal and external.
2) Price
Price is the only strategy that able to affect directly the revenue from an educational
institution such as the price of education programs and school fees (donations for
education/SPP) (Enache, 2011). According to Wijaya (2012), the price of educational
services is equal to the cost of education. Education costs are the value of the rupiah
from all the resources (inputs) in any kind (any retribution received or retrieved by the
employees, the employees family in the form of money from an employer), sacrifice,
and the money, which was issued for the entire educational activity. In this context,
the price is the cost incurred by the student to obtain educational services offered by
the college. Things that need to be considered in product pricing in college, among
other things are, the cost of development, laboratory fees, granting scholarships,
payment procedure and terms of repayment (Hurriyati, 2009).
3) Place (distribution)
According to Nicolescu (2011), service distribution refers to the ways where the
organization makes the product/service to be available to the consumers. According to
Nirwana (2012), the service distribution is an activity related to the service delivery to
the customer as well as the activities of service placement to the locations that are
needing services because the distribution activity is an attempt to further bring closer
the services on the market.
4) Promotion
A higher educational institution has many important channels which should be
transferred with information. The promotion strategy is focused on finding the
efficient ways to reach its recipients. One of the most important categories of
recipients is represented by the students. The first challenge is to adequately present
and explain the educational product to potential students. In this phase, an important
communication channel is the web site. A web site able to inform and to direct the
candidate to the next step is a useful tool for a good enrolling process (Enache, 2011).
According to Kotler and Keller (2009), the promotion was a variety of means to
inform, persuade, and remind consumers directly or indirectly about a product or
brand that is sold. According to Alma (2011), promotion is a form of communication
that give a convincing explanation of potential consumers of goods and services.
5) People
People is an element that cannot be separated from the product, because educational
services connected with people who are involved in it. Faculty and administrative
staff are instrumental in attracting students because it happened to contact directly
(direct contact) between the customers and employees in marketing the service to
enter into the college by providing satisfactory services. According to Wijaya (2012),
services education is individuals who are motivated to develop, coordinate, conduct
and execute the marketing of educational services. Service education include
principals of educational services and customer education services.
6) Physical Evidence
247
The intangibility of service products makes it difficult for consumers to evaluate
service offerings, particularly quality and value for money, prior to purchase. Also
this intangibility can make it difficult for the marketer to position new service product
offerings. In view of this, marketers often need to make the service offering be seen
through the way they manage the physical evidence that accompanies the service.
Physical evidence includes aspects such as building/facilities of service providers and
staff appearance, personal hygiene and uniforms. According to Nirwana (2012), the
physical evidence is the presence of a service charge of goods to be identified.
Especially with regards to the display of the products and services form or display
physically who can show the quality level of the service.
PROCESS
Along with the administrative staff strategy, the process strategy is responsible for a smooth
service delivery. As long as the educational services will imply paperwork and bureaucracy,
the process strategy can be considered as an important factor that can reduce the
dissatisfaction among all the people involved.
One of the major roles played by the process strategy is the enrolment process. Being the
only process that transforms a candidate into a student all the strategies involved in it are
important (Enache, 2011). According to Nirwana (2012), the process was structured elements
that are built to deliver services to its customers. According to Wijaya (2012), the process of
educational services is the core of educational world because the quality of education on all
elements that support the process of educational services are the most important thing to
determine the success of the learning process, as well as the evaluation of the management of
the school, the school's image that will be formed, and the customer satisfaction of
educational services.
PURCHASING DECISION
According to Nirwana (2012), purchasing decisions can be influenced by internal and
external factors. Internal factors are factors that can be controlled such as marketing mix
services and external factors are factors that are uncontrollable factors such as socio-cultural,
psychological, and situational factors.
a) Internal Factors
The marketing mix is the set of variables of marketing which is owned by the company
and this variable is used as a marketing tool that can be controlled by the company to reach
the target market. The existence of services marketing mix affect the decision process of
students because of the element of product, price, promotion, channel of distribution,
human resources, physical infrastructure and processes involved in the delivery of services
(Nirwana, 2012).
b) External Factors
a. Factors psychology include motivation, personality, perception, learning, values,
attitudes, and lifestyles.
b. Situational Factors include social, situation and time.
c. The socio-cultural Factors include individual, family, group, reference, social, and
cultural.
248
Consumers are often confronted with different products. These things make the consumers
(students) must select and perform a decision on one or more product/service education being
offered as a way to meet their needs. According to Wijaya (2012), the decision of educational
services customers (students) to buy products of educational services is a key event for
marketers of educational services, where students choose one decision-making process
among many alternative decisions that have been made available.
THE STAGES OF PURCHASING DECISIONS
Nirwana (2012) outlined the process of purchasing decisions that consumers do is divided
into several stages. The first thing that is done by consumers is to know the problem (problem
recognition), in which a person feels the presence of stimuli to buy something. Stimuli can
derived from yourself (internal) with an example of the need for education or encouragement
from the outside (external), with an example of the willingness to treat friends. After
understanding the problem, information search will be done related to the problem. The
process of information search required prior services consumption decisions, especially
against a relatively unknown services but has been required. Information can be obtained
directly or indirectly, directly can be done by doing a direct contact with the service
providers, while indirectly can be done by utilize media such as television, the internet,
newspapers, or brochures and dig up information from parties who have used the service.
After performing the search process information, then look for alternatives that can be taken
(evaluation of alternative). An alternative can be obtained from competitors, and product
substitution of services. Utilize alternative materials needed as a comparison against the
service. The next step is the process of purchasing decision. The process of purchasing
decisions include when to do the purchase, place of purchase, and who make a purchase.
Furthermore, consumers doing an assessment of merit that have been consumed. The results
of the assessment of a product that is consumed influence the behaviour of the next buying
decision (post-purchase behaviour).
IMPACT MARKETING MIX TO PURCHASE DECISION
The need for education will encourage individual learners attempt to recognize their
needs. They start by looking for information about a provider as expected. Educational
institution as the service provider can give you information about the products/services
offered through the internal factors that can be controlled by provider institutions namely the
marketing mix of product, such as brochures, banners, ads, newspapers or other parties/PR
(public relation). The result of the information obtained, students will try to compare it with
other service providers of alternative institutions. After that the students do and give more
weight to any characteristics of the services offered then make the decision to do the study
and extend.
METHODOLOGY
Descriptive research is research that attempts to describe a group of variables, or social
symptoms that occur in the community. Descriptive research here is associated with
quantitative data. According to Sugiyono (2013), quantitative data is one of the
249
characteristics of a variable that its values are stated in numerical form by using simple linear
regression analysis techniques. Quantitative methods use the system of sampling from a
population and use structured questionnaires as a means of data collection.
The hypothesis testing showed that the influence of services marketing mix is a significant
and positive at the CCIT FTUI against student's decision to conduct the study. This is due to
the use of indicators such as product, price, place, promotion, physical evidence, people and
process to contribute by 22.9% to influence students' decision.
The impact of service product core and formal service product (real) could be developed
further through additional service product (Augmented product) (Wijaya, 2012). Reputation
can be built when the service product core (curriculum) and the real service product (brand
and quality standards of education) have a good level of credibility which the CCIT FTUI has
built a good reputation by giving relevant products. FTUI CCIT's reputation will affect the
decision of the student doing the study, due to its good reputation, which mean CCIT FTUI is
credible, reliable and receive its benefits (Wijaya, 2012).
Giving graduates an access to the world of work has been done by CCIT FTUI with a fairly
high effort. This gives influence because the student will be directed at the job market so the
students need not worry about job information whereby CCIT has put up an announcement
about the latest jobs info both on site and in the magazine of the wall.
Fairly appropriate of tuition fees of FTUI CCIT has an influence on the student decision of
conducting the study considering an economical price according to the ability and readiness
of the economic factors on enough students (Wijaya, 2012). The tuition fees in CCIT FTUI
allow the onset of negotiations. It affects student decisions because the price can be
negotiated between the student and CCIT FTUI with attention to aspects of ability, position,
and occupation of students’ parents (Wijaya, 2012).
CCIT FTUI media promotion such as schools visits and invitations has a fairly good quality.
This will give an impact on student decisions of conducting study because the students will
get information directly from CCIT FTUI marketer.
Human resources is an inseparable element of a product, because of educational services that
are passed between facultys and students or employees and students (Enache, 2011),
(Asiegbu, 2012). CCIT FTUI has the credibility of good facultys who exert influence on
student decisions of conducting study because credentials can persuade students to achieve
educational objectives as well as the locally abundant student needs and desires through the
Ministry of Education. In addition to its own employees, CCIT FTUI has the credibility of
good employees. It will provide leverage to attract and retain students because qualification
owned by employees can assure students through service. Besides, hospitality will add extra
values (Wijaya, 2012) to influence students and prospective students.
250
CCIT FTUI faculty and staff responsiveness this will give influence on student decisions of
conducting studies as one form of service that fast and agile to meet the student needs and
wants. The nameplate is a brand that is designed and visualized to attract students and
prospective students. Design of signage which is less clear from the shape and the writing
will be difficult to be noticed by students and prospective students. The outer appearance of
the design such as CCIT FTUI nameplate have a high effect to student decisions since the
signboard is easy to read and remember.
CCIT FTUI class conditions have a high appeal because the class is always clean and
presentable as well as the students are not allowed to use shoes in laboratory classes. It will
affect student decisions to conducting studies as the condition of class is clean, presentable,
and air of good that will make students became focused on the teaching-learning activities
and it can improve student satisfaction.
CCIT FTUI library conditions has high appeal due to the condition of the library and its
regular book which can increase student satisfaction because students become easier to
conduct their activities. The process is one way to transforms a student (Enache, 2011). The
registration process to enter CCIT FTUI fairly easily understand because each process are at
successive stages and logical. This will affect the student decision of conducting study due to
the fast and easy bureaucracy that will not reduce the student satisfaction.
CONCLUSION AND SUGGESTION
CONCLUSION
The results of the research in CCIT FTUI a conclusion as follows:
1. The results showed that the responses of the respondents against the services
marketing mix consists of indicators of product, price, distribution channels,
promotions, human resources, physical infrastructure and the process of obtaining the
ideal score (criteria) of 0.701. That means the services marketing mix has been done
already proven good.
2. The results showed that the responses of the respondents against the decision of the
student did a study of indicators of problem recognition, information search,
evaluation of alternative, and post-purchase behavior obtained score is ideal (criteria)
of 0.754. It's been proven high student's decision to conduct a study on the CCIT
FTUI.
3. Sign 0000 < alpha 0.05 means there is significant influence and the p-value is positive
(when the marketing mix up within 1 unit of the students' decisions will increase). So
the marketing mix of CCIT FTUI contributing significantly and positively against the
student decision of conducting the study.
SUGGESTIONS
As for the advice that can be given to improve students decision to conduct studies at CCIT
FTUI are as follows:
1. In taking strategic policy, CCIT FTUI should pay more attention to student desire by
making feedback survey of suggestions and criticisms in CCIT FTUI lobby, student
services, and its website. This is certainly going to make students happy because
251
student satisfaction or prospective students obtained by managing student
expectations with the reality brought by marketers. In addition, forming an effective
and efficient promotion methods by word of mouth because when students are
satisfied they will tell relatives, kinsmen, and parents.
2. CCIT FTUI should continue to maintain and improve the high responses of the
students who stated their decision to conduct the study in a manner of marketing mix
services through indicators of product, price, distribution channels, promotion,
physical evidence, human resources and processes that have been examined in this
study. This need to be done to convince students that educational services are relevant
to the needs of the student, well known and understood by the students, and also to
maintain the potential students.
3. Suggestions for each indicator the marketing mix is as follows:
a) Products
CCIT FTUI should socialized its curriculum massively both inside and outside
CCIT FTUI.
b) Price
Maintain compliance rates by student economics factor who currently done by
considering factors such as pricing, demand, cost, and competitors.
c) Place (Distribution Channel)
The strategic location of CCIT FTUI needs to be maintained, given the students
response to the strategic location of CCIT FTUI said it is easily accessible.
d) Promotion
The quality of the information from both the content and the arrangement of the
message needs to be facilitated at the promotion time by visiting schools/ or by
invitation that can be understood by prospective students considering several
respondents feedback about the poor information of CCIT FTUI visits.
e) People (Human Resource)
Several students said officials of the academic, financial, and other quite responsive.
CCIT FTUI employees need to increase students' desire in the service of alacrity
such as speeding up the service time.
f) Physical Evidence
Means the physical part of CCIT FTUI needs to enhanced its appeal, such as
laboratories, classrooms, and the library conditions by adjusting the display color,
the temperature, tables and chairs layout which is a learning tool that support the
purpose of education. Considering there are several students who argued its
low/medium appeal against the internal physical evidence.
g) Process
Creating flow charts incoming process of FTUI CCIT in magazines or in a wall that
has been adjusted. This is necessary to facilitate the students or prospective students
desire to know the registration process.
Keywords: service, marketing mix, education, students.
252
REFERENCES
Alma, B. (2011). Manajemen Pemasaran dan Pemasaran Jasa. Bandung: Alfabeta.
Alma, B., & Hurriyati, R. (2009). Manajemen Corporate dan Strategi Pemasaran Jasa
Pendidikan. Bandung: Alfabeta.
Asiegbu, I. F. (2012). Physical Evidence and Marketing Performance of Commercial
Airlines in Nigeria , Vol. 2 No. 12; December 2012 hlm. 137-149.
Badan Pusat Statistik (2014). Pembangunan Fasilitas Pendidikan Diperoleh Maret 24,
2014, Badan Pusat Statistik: www.bps.go.id
Enache. (2011). Marketing Higher Education Framework, Vol. 4 No. 53 hlm. 124-128.
Gitosudarmo, I. (2012). Manajemen Pemasaran. Yogyakarta: BPFE-Yogyakarta.
Kotler, P., & Keller, K. L. (2009). Manajemen Pemasaran, Jilid I, Edisi 13. Jakarta:
Erlangga.
Lovelock, C. H. (2011). Services Marketing Edinburg Business School, hlm. 1-4.
Nicolescu, L. (2009). Applying Marketing To Higher Education : Scope and Limits, Vol. 4,
No. 2. hlm 35-44.
Nirwana. (2012). Pemasaran Jasa. Malang: Alta Pustaka.
Priyatno. (2012). Belajar Cepat Olah Data Statistik dengan SPSS. Yogyakarta: Andi.
Subandowo. (2009). Peningkatan Produktivitas Guru dan Lembaga Pendidikan Tenaga
Kependidikan Pada Era Global. Jurnal Ilmiah Kependidikan, Khazanah Pendidikan
hlm. 111-125.
Sugiyono. (2013). Metode Penelitian Kuantitatif Kualitatif dan R&D. Bandung: Alfabeta.
Sunyoto, D. (2012). Dasar-dasar Manajemen Pemasaran. Jakarta: CAPS.
Undang-Undang No.20 (2003) tentang Sistem Kependidikan Nasional.
Wijaya, D. (2012). Pemasaran Jasa Pendidikan. Jakarta: Salemba Empat.
Wijaya, D. (2008). Pemasaran Jasa Pendidikan Sebagai Upaya untuk Meningkatkan Daya
Saing Sekolah, 42-54.
253
EMPOWERMENT MODEL OF BUSINESS OWNED BY WOMEN IN INFORMAL
SECTOR : CASE IN YOGYAKARTA PROVINCE, INDONESIA
Sauptika Kancana, M.Si. Faculty of Political and Social Sciences
University of Pembangunan Nasional “Veteran” Yogyakarta
Dr. Puji Lestari Faculty of Political and Social Sciences
University of Pembangunan Nasional “Veteran” Yogyakarta
ABSTRACT
From previous research conducted by Kancana (2013) found that some problems in the
development of businesses owned by women in the informal sector namely, marketing and
financial management. Unprofessional marketing and financial management pattern
affect the level of success of the business they have. There are two main points in this
study: the caracter of the carried-on : informal sector and women as the owner of the
business. As Women with a distinct character with men in managing the business has a
different businesses character tendency. It is not separated from the natural role of women
in family besides as a housewife that having socio-economic role they also as business
women as well. The purpose of this study is to find the appropriate empowerment model
for business owned by women in the informal sector, especially in Yogyakarta province.
Research Method of this study is a qualitative by using Focused Group Discussion
technique representing five districts those are Kulon Progo, Gunung Kidul, Bantul, Sleman
regency and municipality.. These participants identified their business type and can be
broadly grouped into four 4 categories: clothing, food and grocery, services and livestock
farming. From the results of in-depth interviews during FGD found some issues affecting
the development of business owned by women in running their informal sector business are
the work etics, social and economic culture, and mindset in which these factors affects the
management of marketing, production and financial management. These three issues have
a significant impact on the productivity of their enterprises. Interestingly, some problems
arise in a certain business type that is not experienced by different business groups and
even vice versa. It means that they can help among the existing business group, by sharing
experiences, knowledge and skills among the business groups. However, it is also
determined by the absorption capacity as well as the ability to implement it to get an
innovation capability. In addition, the parties related to the empowerment of businesses
owned by women in the informal sector, such as government and non-government agencies
is still needed to support the strengthening and development of their businesses as it
provides skills training and new knowledge concerning with the business that they are
developing.
INTRODUCTION
254
Informal sector is one of the economic power of community supports. The informal sector
is able to mobilize and increase revenues, especially for the economically weak. From the
results of research conducted in India by Patgaonkar, Sadashiv and Barhat (2012) that
businesses in the informal sector has a very significant role in the field of entrepreneurship,
especially female entrepreneurs in the suburban areas. Their efforts have a major impact in
terms of addressing unemployment and increased revenue. SMEs developed at this time is
not only done by a group of men, but more than 60% owned by women (Linda, 2013).
However informal sector products owned by women have some obstacles such as:
Packaging is still modest, no label, no permission from BPOM (National Agency of Drug
and Food Control), no effective promotion, lack of attractive grocery layout, poor financial
management (Kancana 2013)
LITERATURE
Spring (2009) states Enterprises in the Informal sector usually refers to business activities
that are not listed, are not regulated and do not pay taxes, which include, among other
types of business services company, home production activities, and business street. In
contrast, the formal sector including a business activity that is taxed, registered and
regulated businesses. Businesses in the informal sector tends to be dominated by women,
especially in developing countries (ibid). Productivity women-owned businesses in the
informal sector is a major problem often encountered. The lack of skills and knowledge in
the field of business result the major problems. As stated by Chen (2012) that
entrepreneurs in the informal sector requires productive assets, technical and business
skills, and infrastructure services to better compete in the marketplace.
Chirwa research (2004) indicate that between gender and business performance is a matter
that is complex. There is no significant difference terms of profits, businesses owned by
women tend to grow faster in terms of number of employees rather than businesses owned
by men but businesses owned by women tend to decrease or no change in the increase in
sales than those owned by men. Besides that education is a determinant of the success of a
business owned by a woman. However, from the results of the survey conducted by
Williams and Gurtoo, (2011) turns out women are more successful when they have their
own business than working for someone else but it does not mean that women do not have
problems in running the business. From research conducted by Jayawarna, Woodhams,
Jones (2012) women also face obstacles in accessing capital loan from banks than men,
this is reinforced by the results of the study by Åstebro & Bernhardt ( 2003) that women
need a loan extra to run their businesses and it is so important in the early stages of
business to survive. In addition to the results of research conducted by Patgaonkar,
Madhavi Sadashiv and Barhat (2012), women can not get full support from the government
while they should be able to manage a small business better, one of them by providing
training.
255
This study is a continuation of research that has been done before with regard to the
empowerment and strengthening of women's businesses, especially in the informal sector.
From research conducted by Muqorrobin, et al conducted in Solo, Central Java in 2009 the
role of women in the informal sector, especially street vendors tend to be important and
there is such a dominant. This increase is also reasonable to see the involvement of women
in the informal sector businesses also improve the family economy, as the results of
research conducted by Nilakumawati in Bali in 2009 stated that the contribution of women
traders in improving the economic security of households contributed financially 35.79%.
But that does not mean women's enterprises in the informal sector have no constraints in
productivity, the results of research conducted by Oktavina in 2013 on traders in the
informal sector in Malang productivity levels are low so it needs to be improved. The
findings are corroborated also by the results of research conducted by Kancana in 2013 on
women-owned business in the informal sector in the area of Depok Sleman Yogyakarta is
still weak on marketing activities and financial management of the business. From the
results of these findings showed the need for a study to find an appropriate model for
improving the productivity of women's businesses in the informal sector, especially in the
area of Yogyakarta.
METHODS
This research including the category of qualitative research. For data collection was done
by using in-depth interviews by Focus Group Discussion (FGD) among women-owned
business in the informal sector. The area of the research was in Yogyakarta Province
coverage 5 regencies :Bantul, Sleman, Kulon Progo, Gunung Kidul and city of
Yogyakarta.
The population in this study are all women who have a business in the informal sector in
the region of Yogyakarta. While the technique of sampling done by cluster sampling,
namely the representation of women who have small businesses in the informal sector of
some scattered areas in Yogyakarta.
Data analysis methods used vary according to the stage of the research conducted.
Identification of business constraints with in-depth interviews were collected and then
analyzed in the reduction using affinity diagrams.
FINDINGS
In this section we will describe the results of the data collection was done through the FGD
(Focus Group Discussion) of some groups of women in the informal sector SMEs in the
province who came from five (5) regions, namely the District. Sleman, Kab.Kulon Progo
Regency. Gunung Kidul Regency. Bantul and municipality.
256
From the results of the identification of the type of business can be broadly grouped into
four (4) categories, namely: Clothing, food, services and livestock. From the collection of
data from all four groups were found several problems experienced by SMEs in the
informal sector are owned by women, namely:
1. Lack of human resources
2. Poor Financial Management
3. Weak Branding
4. Competitors
5. Moody
6. Raw-Material
7. Place (Location of business)
8. Waste Management
9. Security
10. Livestock Disease (specifically for the farm sector)
1. Clothing
From interviews and in-depth discussions with clothing group of women has constraints
first especially in the availability of employees who have skills. Usually already skilled
employees who are often out and had to recruit new ones. It was not easy because they
have to teach them from the beginning again for example sewing, embroidering techniques
etc. Not a few of those who have come out as the employee continues to open itself and
also become a new competitor. In addition to the employee shortage problems other
problems faced by them who do business in the field of convection or clothes is a matter of
difficulty in obtaining the desired material. Obtained orders from customers not necessarily
be fulfilled because wanted material is not necessarily available easily in the market. It is
of course disappointing customers because there are two possible they would cancel the
order or fulfillment needs in a rather long time. Second they have not dare to open in other
places because they still lack the employees they have. Third they have problems in
financial management. This happens especially in the financial records relating to income
and expenditure. Initially they can be recorded on a regular basis to the exit and entry of
money from their business activities, but over time mixed with the use of the financial
needs of the family.
2. Food and grocery
Most of the members in the food and grocery business group encountered major problems:
257
So many competitors, having similar products sold on the market as it is made the harder is
when competitors run a cheaper price. In addition difficulties to obtain raw materials with
the same quality for this problem sometimes make them do not sell regularly. More proble
For food and grocery business still do not have employees, but assisted by their family
members. In contrast to hire employees who can fully carry out appropriate work to be
done, family members who help their businesses tend to not focus because they are often
busy with their activities. So that sometimes it opens unregularly
3. Services
Most of the members in the group business services face major problems in:
From interviews conducted with a group of mostly business services, laundry obtained
information that the mothers have problems in the capital, place of business, packaging,
competitors, promotion, as well as clothes of laundry customers are often lost. The
problem faced by mothers who do business in the field of laundry is more complex, not
only the problem of shortage of venture capital but the problems associated with marketing
in general, among others packing, promotion, unstrategic place, competitor also. In
addition to issues that have not been widely known brands.
4. livestock farming
The main problems faced by majority members in the group livestock farming on:
It is delivered by the mother who has the catfish farming, which at the time of disposal of
waste water catfish. Besides catfish often unhealthy with the appearance of mold the
disease for these catfish, not to mention the security issues of theft. In particular for their
security and getting employees who want to look after. So they often do alone (with
family) and do not have employees. Besides that do not yet manage livestock farming
financial in a professional manner, sometimes still mixed with money for the family needs.
DISCUSSION
Women play an important role in the economic development of the family, especially in
the informal sector. It is closely related to efforts to achieve the Millennium Development
Goals (MDG's) or the millennium development goals aimed at achieving the basic rights of
the necessities of life for all the people of Indonesia, especially in relation to tackling
poverty and hunger to the extreme, promote gender equality and empowerment of women,
and develop a global partnership in development, in particular by developing decent and
productive work for youth. Based on data from more than 50% of SMEs economic actors
are women (Mudrajad konconro: 2009). Based on data from the Cooperation Ministry
SMEs of the Republic of Indonesia in 2010 approximately 60% of SMEs are managed by
women in Indonesia. (Nahiyah: 2010). The data indicates that women an important role in
258
improving the economy of the country. The role of women in economic activities not only
for strengthening the economic security of families and communities, but also reduce the
effects of the economic matters; contribute to reduce poverty and ensure sustainable
economic growth.
Related to the important role of women, this study developed a model SME empowerment
of women in the informal sector in Yogyakarta. This is done considering the rapid growth
in the business sector at this time women were largely not yet have a model and a clear
direction in running a business. The model can improve the economic empowerment of
women in the informal sector so that public welfare will also increase and contribute to
reducing poverty.
On the empowerment model that became the study's findings, some women's groups of
SMEs aware of the importance of work ethic, community culture that supports women's
efforts, and mindset regarding; Knowledge Sharing, Absorptive Capacity, Capability
Innovation. Some of it can be used to develop marketing strategies, financial management
and production management can improve the productivity of SME Women in the informal
sector, especially in DIY.
Work ethic and Mindset
Weber in Van Ness et al (2010) highlighted the value of work commitment and raised
questions as to why some people place a greater importance on work and appear more
conscientious than others. It means that commitment in running a business is a part of
success. Work etics and the mindset of women as the owner of business in informal sector
need to improve by enhancing commitment especially in continuity for doing the business.
As we got the data they have the problem of continuity when the lack of raw material, bad
mood and in facing the competitor, lack of skilled worker, less capital. These mindset must
be eradicated in performing a business. As Work Ethic is a collection of values and
behaviors that most employers feel are moral and appropriate for the work place.
(http://www.operonresource.com/wpcontent/themes/operon/assets/pdf/seekers/Demonstrati
ng-Good-Work-Ethic.pdf). This coralated with social pressure which the women experiece
in daily life, as stated by Saripudin, Komalasari, Sarimaya (2007) Social pressure in the
family have a relationship with a work ethic, the magnitude of the effect of social pressure
on families also showed some possibilities: first, women are the backbone of the family,
because of the possibility of the husband can not be sufficient or meet the needs of the
family or women as widows and single parent families. Meanwhile informal sector
business has different traits compared with formal one as explained by Marleni that
Household industries (home industry) including types of small industries. According to
Eugene Staley, as cited by Putra (2003: 67), one of the small industrial employment system
is a system family. Family system is the basis of rural industry, most workers come from
the families themselves, often do not receive wages and the relationship between labor
with their owners more family-oriented. The characteristics of the domestic industry are as
259
follows:a) is a small industry with a workforce of less than five people, b) using simple
technology, c) raw materials come from the local village or surrounding villages
(www.kafaah.org/index.php/kafaah/article/.../pdf). Having such a business caracters it
often come up some problem while running a business, Lutfiyah (2013) discribed that
instead women have the same weaknesses that could be the cause of the failure as a
business, among others: take advantage of the opportunity for personal gain, do not dare to
take risks, lack of confidence, or too confident, too ambitious to handle business outside
ability, insight narrow so lack of information, it can not divide the time on its dual role,
busy with family affairs so that the flow of time to their business activities is minimal, less
patient or high emotion, issue a decision in haste, still dependent or dominated by their
husbands, consumptive, do not open, did not mean really.
Socio-economic culture of SME Women in the informal sector
At the end of 2015, the ASEAN countries are ready to enter the regional free market
known as the ASEAN Economic Community (AEC). ASEAN leaders since a decade ago
have designed that ASEAN will become a single market at the same time an integrated
economic area. By implication, there is no longer an obstacle to the movement of goods,
services, investment, and labor across boundaries of nation-states.
Indonesian government welcomed the AEC is with great optimism. To the participants in
the National Conference (National Conference) XV Indonesian Young Entrepreneurs
Association in Jakarta, dated January 12, 2015, President Jokowi convinced that Indonesia
would be 'invaded' markets of other countries in ASEAN. However, the optimism of
President Jokowi turmoil can not cover the majority of the Indonesian people, especially
the socio-economic layers of the bottom (workers, peasants, urban poor, and others), which
are very vulnerable to become victims of free trade, including women. Why women? There
are socio-cultural and economic factors that make women Indonesia is vulnerable to
economic policy. Including the effects of free trade. According to Rini analysis S.Pd,
Coordinator of International Relations of Action Women Indonesia (API) Kartini
(http://www.berdikarionline.com/opini/20150508/nasib-perempuan-dihadapan-mea-
2015.html#ixzz3hDUa1Vio) there are several obstacles to SMEs women, namely; First, the
socio-cultural construction that almost women to take on the role of the wider realm of
social life, education, politics, and others. Social construction that is assumed that it is in
the area of women within the household (domestic). It is inseparable from the strong
patriarchal ideology gripped the women today.
Second, neoliberal economic policies that increasingly rid women of the factors and means
of production. Especially in subsistence agriculture and small-scale production enterprises.
According to Vandana Shiva, an Indian feminist, neo-liberal economic system which is
based on calculations of growth, not counting the economic contribution of women in
small-scale production (Vandana Shiva, 2013). Women were excluded from the production
arena is losing the support of his life. Then, because the pressure of the necessities of life,
260
many of them are forced into the informal sector workers, migrant workers, labor ready
paid cheap, and others.
By calculating the vulnerability above, AEC 2015 which rules out liberalization of the
economy in all aspects will certainly greatly impact on women Indonesia.Pertama, AEC
2015 brings free trade agenda that could potentially destroy the production sector in the
country, both agricultural and industrial sectors. In that context, small and medium-scale
producers will be forced to compete with large-scale producers (large corporations),
supported by higher production techniques and strong capitalization. Impact is clear: small
and medium-sized manufacturers that will in ruins. The structure of the production
business in Indonesia is dominated by micro, small, and medium enterprises (SMEs).
Based on data from the data of the Ministry of Cooperatives and Small and Medium per
June 2013, the number of SMEs in Indonesia reached 55.2 million units, or 99.98% of the
total business units in Indonesia. Women become the backbone of the SME. Note the
Ministry of Women's Empowerment and Child Protection said that as many as 60% of
SMEs business operators in Indonesia are women. If the free trade agenda in the style of
AEC destroy small and medium-scale producers, the greatest potential victims are women.
Women working in the agricultural sector will be affected by the liberalization of food
imports.
Secondly, AEC will also carry the liberalization of the labor market. In this case, the
countries that joined the AEC, including Indonesia, are required to remove all of the rules
or regulations that impede the recruitment of foreign labor. Here people talk labor
competitiveness. Its size is the level of education, the power of knowledge and skills,
Readiness Indonesian workers, including women in it, competition with foreign labor? In
this context, it is women victims because of social prejudices, that women do not need high
school because anyway later on duty in the kitchen, still very strong in people's minds.
This affects the level of education and skills of women in Indonesia. Female education
statistics. until today, there are about 5.1 million Indonesian women are illiterate.
Enrollment rates for female gender, especially for secondary education and higher
education, are also lower: senior high school (18.59%), Diploma (2.74%), and the
University (3.02%).
With the above conditions, if will be forced to compete, Indonesian women will fall in jobs
that are not far away from domestic affairs, such as a housekeeper, babysitter, and
administrators elderly. Evidently, the majority of Indonesian female workers who work
abroad are domestic workers, economic impact will be 'let the weak become the prey of the
strong. "
Gender differences have spawned injustice which impact on the position of women.
According mansyur Fakih (Sugihastuti.2010: 278-279) gender differences are based on
assumptions and assessments by social construction in the end lead to the characteristics or
stereotypes as cultural coordinates, and the lengthy process has resulted in injustice for
261
women. Injustice against women is divided into six sections. First, differences and gender
division manifested in sub ordination of women in the presence of men, particularly
regarding; The first, about the process of decision and control power. Secondly, differences
and gender distribution of the marginalization of women giving birth in the economy and
culture, bureaucracy, as well as development programs Third, gender differences and
divisions forming stereotypes against women that result in oppression of women.
According Fakih (Sugihastuti 2010: 279), the stereotype is a form of oppression and
cultural ideology, namely labeling cornered the women so the impact on the position and
conditions of women. Fourth, differences and gender divisions make women work harder
in terms of the maintenance of the domestic sphere, especially if women worked outside
the home that cause them to receive double burden (care of the household and work). Fifth,
gender differences also resulted in the emergence of violence and torture against women
both physically and mentally. Sixth gender differences and division following
manivestasinya above, according Fakih image resulting in socialization, the nature of the
position, and the acceptance of the fate of women. Socialization image of the position,
nature, and the acceptance of the woman's fate leads to the assumption on the women
themselves that the conditions and positions that have been there for them is a normal and
natural.
Related to the injustice against women SMEs analysis on women in the informal sector in
the province, they urgently need to increase the competence of business in order to face the
AEC. This study provides an alternative through training in marketing communication
strategy, financial management and production management in each business sector.
Model of marketing, management and production in SME for women in the informal
sectorin DIY
Women play an important role in the fulfillment of economic family, but their role in the
economy is often overlooked and is still underestimated. According Primadi,
(http://mitramandiri.org/index.php/sarasehan-penguatan-ukm-perempuan-se-
jabotabek.html) This can be proved by the data of women in the workforce is only done in
the formal sector, while the labor force in domestic and informal sector has not been
considered a productive activity so that women working in this sector are not counted in
the labor force. In fact, many women play an important role in the micro and small
businesses. This type of business is in great demand by women's groups because it can
support the family economy, improve the actuality of self and allowing an increase in the
quality of family welfare (Sumapaouw et al, 2000). There are no exact figures of women's
involvement in the micro and small entrepreneurs. But the estimated portion of micro
enterprises is quite large compared with the share of women in small businesses about
40%. Besides the existence of women's SMEs are less publicized widely so that issues
concerning their efforts to be less precisely known.
262
The main problems in the economic empowerment of women can not be separated from
the lower women's access to ownership of the factors of production, including capital. It is
indicated to be a factor causing the backwardness of women in economic development is
that the limited access to information capital, technology, raw materials, the market for the
distribution of the resulting product, poor knowledge of business management. In addition
to micro and small businesses are started by women more non-legal (informal) making it
difficult to develop. Labor problem does not seem too big felt by SMEs female. This is
related to the characteristics of the resulting product is relatively simple and does not
require high skills.
The solution requires the development of business partnerships. This relationship is
developed through partnerships that patterns of nature, condition, and business objectives
that partnership by creating a conducive business climate both in the field of product
quality, promotion, marketing, mentoring and coaching. Partnership on relations between
actors who rely on the business ties of mutual support based on the principle of equality
and togetherness. This research is to find alternatives to solve the problems related with the
inhibiting factors of SMEs development of women in the informal sector DIY. Models of
marketing communications, financial management, and production will be supplied by
several sources that actually competent in order to directly listen the problems and the real
need felt by the SME for women entrepreneurs. And then the resource is expected to
provide important information that should be known by the SMEs of women and how they
can access the information to improve their business in the future. The activity will be
conducted in the second year of this study.
Knowledge Sharing, Absorption capacity and Innovation capability
From data analysis it is found that a certain problem which is come up in a certain type of
business it is not exist in another type of business or vice versa. On the other side they can
handle it very well. Sudjono (2011) conducted a research about this issue, he found that
someone who has a spirit of helping others people is having tendency want to conduct
knowledge sharing with other people. It proof that knowledge sharing can be used to
overcome a certain business problem. In this case the women can tacle by sharing
kowledge and skills among the groups. Besides this the study conducted by Sudjono (ibid)
show that knowledge sharing activites has influenced on innovation capability.
However SMEs especialy in informal sector in general lack both managerial and technical
skills for their effectiveness (Rahman and Ramos in Hossain 2015) because of their
particular characteristics such as organization, culture and strategy. Moreover to be
effective in acquirng new knowledge and skills it is influenced by absorptive capacity.
Absorptive capacity means firms’ ability to sense, value, assimilate, and apply new
knowledge and desorptive capacity means a firm’s capability of external knowledge
exploitation (Lichtenthaler, in Hossain :ibid). The absorptive capacity will determine the
capability of innovation in small medium entreprises, as stated by Krstić and Petrović
263
(2011) medium enterprises that are used for research and development of their innovation
processes are also relevant besides the key aspect of absorptive capacity : knowledge
acquisition, knowledge assimilation, knowledge transformation and knowledge
exploitation (Zahra, George G in Krstić and Petrović: ibid). Nevertheless it does not mean
that there are no obstacle in knowledge sharing process. Here some of them : No integrated
planning, Less motivation, Less initiatives, No clear definition of role and function and
Budget (Tjakraatmadja et al, 2011).
Below a purposed model for empowering business-owned by women in informal sector
after analysing the data from FGD. Findings of this study is Work Etics, Socio-Economics
Culture and Mindset influence to performance of Women informal Sector SME, those
generate some problems especially in Marketing, Financial Management, Production
Management, consequently it affects on productivity of the business itself. However some
type of business does not experieced the problem otherwise the group has good
performance in it, this happen in vice versa. So by using concepts of knowledge sharing,
absorptive capacity these group of business-owned by women can increase the innovation
capability. As the women having easy-sharing partner character.
EMPOWERMENT MODEL OF BUSINESS OWNED BY WOMEN IN INFORMAL
SECTOR : CASE IN YOGYAKARTA PROVINCE
264
Women informal Sector SME
Work Etics
Socio-Economics Culture
Mindset
Marketing Financial Management
Production Management
ABSORPTIVE CAPACITY
INNOVATION CAPABILITY
KNOWLEDGE SHARING
Productivity
PROBLEMS
265
CONCLUSIONS AND FURTHER RESEARCH
Women with different characters with men in managing the business has a tendency
character different businesses. It is not separated from the natural role of women in the
family than as a housewife who has the role of socio-economic as well as women who do
business as well.
The purpose of this study was to find the exact model of empowerment for women-owned
businesses in the informal sector, particularly in the province of Yogyakarta.
From the results of in-depth interviews during the FGD, there are several findings. Some of
the problems affecting the development of businesses owned by women in the informal
sector to run their business is business work ethic, social and economic role, and the
mindset in which these factors affect marketing management, production and financial
management. These three issues have a significant impact on their business productivity.
Interestingly, a problem arises in certain types of business groups that are not experienced
by business groups are different and even opposite.
From the results mentioned above, they or the business group that has a problem can be
learned from the experience, knowledge and skills among groups other businesses.
However, the success of this process is also determined by their absorption capacity and
the ability to implement it. In addition, the parties related to the empowerment of
businesses owned by women in the informal sector, such as government agencies and non-
government still needed to support the strengthening and development of their business by
providing skills training and new knowledge about the business they are developing
To get more appropriate model so the purposed model need to be tried (Pilot Project) and
evaluated after that will be improved to find the proper one. So it will be got an appropriate
model for empowernmet of business-owned by women in informal sector.
REFERENCE
Chen, M. A, (2012) The Informal Economy: Definitions, Theories and Policies. WIEGO
Working Paper No, 1August 2012
Åstebro, T; Bernhardt, I; (2003) Start-up financing, owner characteristics, and survival ;
Journal of Economics and Business 55 (2003) 303–319
266
Chirwa, E.W, (2004), Gender and Performance of Micro and Small Enterprises in
Malawi , Working Paper WC/01/04, March
Gumelar, Linda, http://www.koran-sindo.com/node/328306 Minggu 10 November 2013
Hossain, M (2015), A review of literature on open innovation in small and medium-sized
enterprises , Journal of Global Entrepreneurship Research (2015) 5:6 DOI
10.1186/s40497-015-0022-y Journal of Global Entrepreneurship Research a Springer Open
Journal
Jayawarna, D; et all, (2012) Gender and Alternative Start-Up Business Funding, SEED
Working Paper No. 47 Series on Women’s Entrepreneurship Development
Kancana, S, (2013), Constraints on Women’s Business : Case Study in Informal Sector,
Proceeding IICES 2013, pp. 3-9
Krstić, Petrović (2011) “The role of knowledge management in developing capabilities for
increasing enterprise's absorptive capacity “FACTA UNIVERSITATIS Series:
Economics and Organization Vol. 8, No 3, 2011, pp. 275 – 286
Lutfiyah (2013) – Pemberdayaan wanita berbasis potensi unggulan lokal, SAWWA
Volume 8, Nomor 2, April
Marleni ..Jurnal Ilmiah Kajian Gender 77 Pola dan etos kerja perempuan dalam industri
rumah tangga di jorong cangkiang nagari batu taba kecamatan ampek angkek kabupaten
agam www.kafaah.org/index.php/kafaah/article/.../pdf
Muqorrobin, Agus, Nasir, M, Murwanti, S, (2014), Analisis Sosio-Ekonomi Terhadap
Pemberdayaan Perempuan : Kasus Pekerja Sektor Informal di Kota Solo, Jawa Tengah,
http://asp.trunojoyo.ac.id/wp-content/uploads/2014/03/24.-ANALISIS-SOSIO-
%E2%80%93
Nilakusmawati,D, (2009), Kajian Aktivitas Ekonomi Pelaku Sektor Informal di Kota
Denpansar (Studi Kasus Wanita Pedagang Canang Sari)
ojs.unud.ac.id/index.php/piramida/article/download/2993/
Oktavina, C. W , (2013) Analisis Produktifitas Pekerja Wanita Sektor informal (Studi
kasus: Pedagang di Kota Malang),
http://jimfeb.ub.ac.id/index.php/jimfeb/article/viewFile/329/276
Patgaonkar, Sadashiv and Barhat, G.H., (2012), Rural Women Entrepreneurs in the
Informal Sector of India (October 1, 2012). The IUP Journal of Entrepreneurship
Development, Vol. IX, No. 1, pp. 69-79,
267
Richardson, P, ett.all, (2012) WEDGE The Challenges of Growing Small Businesses:
Insights from Women Entrepreneurs in Africa, Volume 16 Issue 4 (October 2012), pp. 303-
322
Saripudin, Komalasari, Sarimaya (2007 ), Pengaruh sosial-budaya terhadap etos kerja
tukang kiridit perempuan di kabupaten tasikmalaya,
ihttp://file.upi.edu/direktori/fpips/jur._pend._sejarah/197005061997021-
didin_saripudin/penelitian_dan_pengabdian/ringkasan_kajwan.pdf
Spring, A; (2009) African Women in the Entrepreneurial Landscape: Reconsidering the
Formal and Informal Sectors, Journal of African Business, 10:11–30
Sudjono, R.S (2011) The development of innovation capability of small medium
enterprises through knowledge sharing process: an empirical study of indonesian creative
industry International Journal of Business and Social Science Vol. 2 No. 21 [Special Issue
– November 2011]
Tjakraatmadja, J. H, Martini ,Anggoro (2011) Knowledge sharing in small and medium
enterprises a case study of creative clothing industry in Bandung, West Java, Indonesia ,
Tech Monitor • Jul-Aug 2011
Williams, Colin C., Gurtoo, Anjula , (2011) "Women entrepreneurs in the Indian informal
sector: Marginalisation dynamics or institutional rational choice?", International Journal
of Gender and Entrepreneurship, Vol. 3 Iss: 1, pp.6 – 22
Van Ness, et al (2010) “Work Ethic: Do New Employees Mean New Work Values?” 2010
Journal of Managerial Issues, 22 (1), 10-34
268
THE INFLUENCE OF ENTREPRENEUR BEHAVIOR, BUSINESS MOTIVATION AND
MANAGERIAL ABILITY TOWARD THE BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND ITS
IMPLICATION ON THEIR BUSINESS SUSTAINABILITY
(Study on Small Scale Businesses in Kendari City).
Mahmudin AS (Student of Doctoral Program of Management – Halu Oleo University)
(mahmudinudin123@yahoo.co.id)
Muslimin (Student of Doctoral Program of Management – Halu Oleo University)
(muslimin_penlat@yahoo.co.id)
Mansyur Asri (Student of Doctoral Program of Management – Halu Oleo University)
(mansyur.asri@yahoo.co.id)
Muhidin (Student of Doctoral Program of Management – Halu Oleo University)
(muhidin501@yahoo.com)
Sharman (Student of Doctoral Program of Management – Halu Oleo University)
(lisalindoatompe@gmail.com)
Abstract: This study seek to find out : (1) the effect of entrepreneur behavior on business
performance, (2) the effect of business motivation on business performance, (3) the effect of
managerial skill on business performance, (4) the effect of entrepreneur behavior on business
sustainability, (5) the effect of business motivation on business sustainability, (6) the effect of
managerial skill on business sustainability, (7) the effect of business performance on business
sustainability. This study was an associative explanative study. The population of the study were all
small businesses in Kendari City that was enlisted in The Department of Commerce and Industry in
Kendari city, which were 663 businesses units. The sample of the study were 200 business units
that were taken using cluster random sampling. The data was collected using observation
technique, questionnaire, and documentation. The data analysis employed descriptive statistic
analysis and partial least square (PLS). The result of the study concluded that : (1) business
behavior significantly affect business performance, (2) business motivation insignificantly affect
business performance, (3) managerial ability significantly affect business performance, (4) business
behavior significantly affect business sustainability, (5) business motivation significantly affect
business sustainability, (6) managerial ability significantly affect business sustainability, (7)
business performance significantly affect small businesses sustainability in Kendari City.
Keywords : entrepreneur behavior, business motivation, managerial ability, business performance,
business sustainability
269
INTRODUCTION
Strictly speaking, small bussinesses aim to gain optimal profit and guaranteed-
business sustainability. In order for a business to sustain is particularly subject to its
performance. Small businesses performance is affected by various factors among which is
entrepreneur behavior (Meredith, 2006). Besides the entrepreneur behavior, motivation can
also be the factor affecting small businesses performance (Amstrong, 2000), supported by
research outcome of Pantja Djati, 1999). Another determinant to business performance and
sustainability is managerial skill (Mueller, 2007; Fiedler in Munandar, 2001).
In correspond to entrepreneur behavior, research study shows that entrepreneur
behavior/characteristics affects the business performance significantly (Saparudin, 2008).
Despite this, however, other researcher found that the one having the most significant
influence is the ownership of working-network system (Meng Low, 2006). In concern
with business motivatin, resarchers (Djati Sundring, 1999; Amstrong, 2000; Cooper and
Makin, 2005) found that motivation has a significant effect on business performance. In
contrast, other researchers found that the interference of motivation toward business
performance is debatable. In correspond to this, Werther and Devis (2005) argue that
motivation gives a relatively small contribution in the development of business
performance.
Research studies also showed that the minimum managerial ability is one of the
factor to cause small business to collapse (Meng Low, 2006). In correspond to this, Urata
(2000) has investigated 2000 small businesses of manufactur in seven towns in Indonesia.
This study revealed that most of the businessman have low managerial skill and is urgent
to solve. Besides, Fiedler in Munandar (2001) has studied and found that managerial skills
have significant effect on small businesses performance. Even so, howeverm other
researchers have found that managerial skills do not effect business performance
significantly because the businessmen do not manage their business structurally (Dyah
Sawitri, 2008; Elisabeth, Alexandra, 2007).
To refer to the results of studies revealed, it seems that there are differences among
what the researchers have found. Therefore, there is a strong reason to conduct further
research regarding the effect of entrepreneur attitude, business motivation and managerial
skills on business performance and their implcation on the sustainability of small
businesses.
Data from Department of Industry and Commerce of Kota Kendari shows that
there was a decreasing number of small businesses around 2007 and 2009, each 17.27%
and 2.21% respectively. This condition reveals that small businesses are insustainable.
This is, for sure, particularly related to businesses performance. On the other hand, there is
a debatable premise that business performance is affected by such factors as entrepreneur
behavior, business motivation, and managerial skill. Given this, the researcher was
interested to conduct an empiric study on the effect of the three aforementioned factors on
small businesses performance in Kendari City and their implication in business
sustainability.
I. METHODOLOGY
270
This study is an explanative asociative study and was located in Kendari City, South
East Sulawesi. The population of the study were all small businesses in Kendari City that
were enlisted in the Department of Industry and Commerce, which were 663 units of
businesses (Source: Department of PERINDAGKOP and PKM of Kendari City, 2014).
The sample of the study were 200 units of businesses chosen using cluster random
sampling technique. This number included 107 units of businesses working on farm
produce, 20 units of businesses working on chemicals, 19 units of business managing
metal and machine, and 54 units of other various small businesses. The data was collected
using observation technique, questionnaire, and documentation. The data was, then,
analyzed using descriptive statistic analysis and partial least square (PLS).
Definition of Oprational Variable
Entrepreneur behavior is all aspects related to characteristics or attitudes of business respondents.
This variable is a construct variable that is observed through six indicators adopted from some
experts premises (Meredith, 2006, McClelland dalam Sumarsono, 2010, Justin, 2001, Tunggal
Wijaya, 2009), which are self-confidence, task and outcome oriented, risk-taking, future oriented,
high energy reverse, and views of money.
Business motivation is an impulse to fulfill the need of particular motive. This variable is a
construct variable that is observed through four indicators adopted from theories (McClelland,
2005 and Abraham Maslow in Dessler, 2000), which are motive of achievement, affiliation, motive
to be of power, and prestige/pride.
Managerial skills is the respondent skills in managing their businesses. This variable is a
construct variable that is observed through four indicators adopted from Terry’s argument in
Hasibuan (2000) that are to plan, to organize, to direct, and to control businesses.
Business performance is the working ability of outcomes of small businesses. This variable
is a construct variable that is observed through four indicators adopted from Kaplan and Norton
opinion, (2001); Widjaya Tunggal (2009) that are finance prespective, costumers, learning and
development and prespective on internal businesses processes.
Business sustainability is the guaranty of small businesses continuity. This variable is a
construct variable that is observed through three indicators adopted from Warhust (2002), Burton
Hamner (2008) and Alessia D’Amato, est (2009) that are small businesses economy, social, and
environment.
In this study, small businesses refer to businesses managed by individuals, households or
industries producing goods or services to be traded commercially and owning the net wealth
between Rp. 50 million and Rp. 500 million, excluding land assets and buildings with selling
omsets reaching Rp. 300 milion and Rp. 2.5 billion at most and employing around 5-19 workers.
271
III. RESULT AND DISCUSSION
1. Model
2. Result
No Direction of
Direct Effect
Path
Coefficient
Critical
ratio Probability Hypothesis
Note
(Accept/Reject)
1 X1 Y1 0,331 3,401 0,001 H1 Accept
2 X2 Y1 -0,050 0,669 0,504 H2 Reject
272
3 X3 Y1 0,694 13,524 0,000 H3 Accept
4 X1 Y2 0,267 3,589 0,000 H4 Accept
5 X2 Y2 -0,172 2,545 0,012 H5 Accept
6 X3 Y2 0,679 12,929 0,000 H6 Accept
7 Y1 Y2 0,213 3,892 0,000 H7 Accept
Source: Analysis result
3. Result
The effect of entrepreneur behavior on small businesses performance in Kendari City
The implication of the well attitude of entrepreneur cause the fine business performance,
which descriptively reach 85.21%. This is supported by the hypothesis testing showing that
entrepreneur behavior significantly affect business performance, which is marked by the number of
path coefficient 0.331 and probability 0.001 < 0.05. This means that the good behavior of
entrepreneur can spur on the improvement of business performance, if seen from the indicator of
finance perspective, costumers, internal business growth and perspective.
The result of this study is in line with the theory suggested by Meredith (2006) that
entrepreneur behavior is one of the determinants of business performance for it is related to self-
confidence, is task and outcome oriented, is related to risk-taking, originality and future orientation.
The result of this study also supports the previous empirical study conducted by Saparudin (2008)
that observable entrepreneur characteristics such as self-confidence, outcome oriented, risk-taking,
and future orientation has significant effect on business performance when seen through finance
indicator (income margin, ROA, and ROI).
The effect of business motivation on small business performance in Kendari City
A good business motivation of a respondent gives good implication on business
performance. This is supported by the hypothesis testing that showed that business motivation had
insignificant effect, in negative direction, on business performance, which was marked by the value
of path coefficient that was -0.050 and probability value 0.054 > 0.05. This means that good
business motivation cannot spur on the improvement of business performance when seen through
the indicator of finance perspective, costumer, growth, and internal business perspective. The
insignificant effect of business motivation on business performance was because the motive to be
of power was not carried out well, which was marked by the insignificant effort of the leaders or
owners of the business in getting their employee to follow their instruction. In addition, the
business owners did not put it all in leading their worker and did not seriously encouraging their
employee to perform better in carrying out their job.
273
The result of this study does not approve the theory suggested by Amstrong (2000) that
motivation is begun from the way people meet their needs by doing particular activities and so this
will affect the goal achievement, which is reflected from the optimal performance where the
relationship between motivation and performance is positive. In other words, the increasing of
motivation will result in better work performance. The result of this study also disapprove with the
previously conducted empirical study by Djati Sundring (1999) that business motivation that is
seen from achievement motive, affiliation, and dominance affect the business performance
significantly.
The effect of managerial skill on small businesses performance in Kendari City
In line with the result of the study, the managerial skill of most of the respondents
(86.15%) is in good category of assessment when seen from the indicator of planning ability,
organizing, leading, and controlling ability.
A good managerial skill provides good implication on business performance. This is
supported by hypothesis testing showing that managerial skill has a significant effect on business
performance, which was marked by the value of path coefficient that was 0.694 and probability
value 0.000 < 0.05. This implies that an improved managerial skill will improve business
performance as well when seen from such indicator as finance perspective, costumers, growth, and
internal business perspective.
In addition, a good managerial skill was backed up by the respondents’ characteristic that
was age-related where most of them were in productive age and about 69 of the respondents were
bachelors and the other 102 graduated from high schools.
The result of this study supports the theory proposed by Fiedler in Munandar (2001) that in
business world, managerial skill is one of the key factors to put cooperation among employee in
harmony. Furthermore, it also supports Mueller (2007) who argued that a good managerial skill
could fix working performance.
This study support the result of empirical study conducted by Mulyanto (2007) that
managerial skill covering technical skill, humanistic skill, and conceptual skill has a significant
effect on business performance when seen through the indicator of revenue and net income.
The effect of entrepreneur behavior on small businesses sustainability in Kendari City
274
A good behavior of entrepreneur gives a good implication on a business sustainability,
which descriptively reach 85.39%. This is supported by the result of hypothesis testing showing
that entrepreneur behavior had a significant effect on business sustainability, which was marked by
the value of path coefficient that was 0.267 and probability value 0.012 < 0.05. This means that a
good behavior of entrepreneur can promote the enhancement of business sustainability when seen
through the indicator of small business economy, small business-social, and small business-
environment.
The result of this study supports the theory suggested by Meredith (2006) that entrepreneur
behavior is one of the determinants of business sustainability. The behavior to refer here is related
to self-confidence, task oriented, daring to take risk, originality, and future oriented.
The result of this study also supports the previous empirical study conducted by Sri Hadiati
(2008) that entrepreneur behavior seen through the indicator of internal factors (research and
development, marketing, production, human resources, and finance) and external factors (new
comers, existing rivals, buyers, suppliers, alternative products, and macro-economy) has a
significant effect on business competitiveness and so can assure a business to sustain, which is
reflected from the superiority of its competitiveness.
The effect of business motivation on small businesses sustainability in Kendari City
The implication of good business motivation does not provide assurance to business
sustainability. This is supported by the result of hypothesis testing showing that business
motivation significantly affect, in negative direction, business sustainability, which was marked by
the value of path coefficient that was -0.172 and probability value 0.012 < 0.05. this implies that
good business motivation cannot assure greater chance of business sustainability.
The result of this study does not approve the theory suggested by Stoner (2002) that long-
term business sustainability can be maintain as long as the owner has the will to do efficiency, to
keep a healthy environment, and to create unique product. If this condition can be maintained, it
will affect a business sustainability. The high requirement of motivation is commonly stimulated by
someone’s fear from failing their business. A leader can be motivated to do activities because he is
assure that his achievement can help him bring into reality what he has been expecting. One with
no hope that they will achieve something will not be trying to enhance their achievement. For this
reason, the fear of being bankrupt can be a motive.
275
The result of this study also does not support the empirical study conducted by Koesmoyo
(2005) that business motivation observed through intrinsic indicators (fear from failing business) is
one of the major determinants to business sustainability.
The effect of managerial skill on small businesses sustainability in Kendari City
A good managerial skill provides good implication on the insurance of business
sustainability. This is supported by hypothesis testing showing that managerial skill has a
significant effect on business sustainability with path coefficient value reaching 0.679 and
probability value 0.000 < 0.05. This implies that an improved managerial skill can as well increase
the surety of business sustainability when seen through such indicator as small businesses
economy, social, and small businesses environment.
The result of this study supports Meng Low (2006) opinion that good managerial skill can
be the determinant of business sustainability. This outcome also supports other opinions proposed
by some experts, such as : 1) Mintznberg (2005) that managerial skill could be the determinant of
business sustainability; 2) Alma (2004) that it is important for a leader to be able to manage a
business that involve many people working in it, to manage other production factors, and to give
instruction for the costumers optimal service so that his business can enhance continuously; 3)
Orser (2004) that for business to sustain is depend on the managerial skill; (4) Wheelen (2002) that
being able to join together managerial skill and other basic skill as technical skill, humanistic skill,
and conceptual skill accurately and balance can guarantee a business to sustain; 5) Sudrajati (2007)
that managerial skill that is observed from such indicator as technical skill, humanistic skill, and
conceptual skill can be a determinant to business sustainability.
The effect of business performance on small businesses sustainability in Kendari City
In line with the research outcome, the respondents’ business performance was in good
category of assessment when observed from the indicator of finance perspective, costumer
perspective, learning perspective and growth, and internal business process perspective. Result of
hypothesis testing revealed that business performance significantly affect business sustainability,
which was marked by the value of path coefficient that was .213 and probability value 0.000 <
0.05. This implies that good business performance can stimulate better chance of business
sustainability.
Result of this study supports the theory suggested by Gibson (2006) that working
performance can be categorized as success if the targeted goal is fully achieved. Performance is
also viewed as a function of interaction between skill, motivation, and chance (Robbins, 2003).
Performance includes performing skill through particular processes or procedures that focus on
276
targeted goals, performance standard and outcomes quality. If this condition can be kept
continuously through creative creation, then a business will most likely to sustain. In addition,
Sudrajati (2007) stated that business performance is relevance to business sustainability. A business
sustainability can be maintained if a firm can manage all the activities related to resources well, by
focusing on the firm’s capability in collecting resources.
The result of this study also supports the empirical study conducted by Laila Nagib and
college (2000) that a business sustainability is affected by several factors, both internal and external
factors. Internal factors include the skills or ability to manage both the business and the human
resources.
4. Limitation of the study
The writer is fully aware that the realization of this study is not apart from limitations. These
limitations are:
1. The data collection was carried out only in one step/phase (one shot study) or cross sectional.
Furthermore, this study employed the non experimental explanative associative study so it is
not highly accurate.
2. The sample of the study were only 30% (200 business units) of a total 663 units of businesses
enlisted in the Department of PERINDAGKOP and PKM of Kendari City so it probably does
not represent all the small businesses.
3. The developed structural model is limited in the use of indicator in measuring construct
variable, particularly the variable of entrepreneur behavior and business motivation.
IV. CONCLUSION AND SUGGESTION
1. Conclusion
a. Entrepreneur behavior has a significant effect on small businesses performance in Kendari
City. This implies that better change of entrepreneur behavior can spur on the improvement of
business performance.
b. Business motivation does not significantly affect small businesses performance in kendari City.
This suggests that a change of motivation in a better direction cannot stimulate better business
performance.
c. Managerial skill significantly affects small businesses performance in Kendari City. in means
that an improved managerial skill will increase small businesses performance in Kendari City.
d. Entrepreneur behavior has a significant effect on small businesses sustainability in Kendari
City. This means that a change of entrepreneur behavior for better can spur on the increase
chance of business sustainability.
e. Business motivation has a significant effect on small businesses sustainability in Kendari City.
This means that a better change of motivation can increase the chance for a business to sustain.
f. Managerial skill significantly affect small businesses sustainability in Kendari City. theis
implies that a good managerial skill can increase the surety of business sustainability.
g. Business performance significantly affect small businesses sustainability in Kendari City. This
means that a better change of business performance can as well increase the chance of a
business to sustain.
277
2. Suggestion
a. For the local government of Kendari City, the concerned institute in particular (Department of
PERINDAGKOP and PKM), to pay attention on small businesses in Kendari City by giving
the entrepreneurs technical training on business management for most of the respondent
(51.50%) have never given the chance to join a training. The same goes for the support of
financing access because there are about 66.50% of the entrepreneurs who have never been
given business finance support.
b. For some of the small businesses owner whose both behavior (14.85%) and business
motivation (13.38%) are not good and whose managerial skill (13.85%) is low to try to be
better so as to improve their business performance and to gain more assurance of the business
sustainability.
c. For the following researcher to use longitudinal data and experimental study to gain a highly
accurate result of study. Besides, the researcher can investigate micro small businesses and is
better to enhance this study by using other indicator in measuring entrepreneur behavior and
business motivation. Other indicators in the variable of entrepreneur behavior are originality,
responsibility, preference on business risk, perception on chance of success, stimulus, skill,
solving problem skill, modesty, spirit, self-satisfaction, internal control focus, and tolerance on
ambiguity. On the other hand, the variable of business motivation includes physical and
biological needs, safety and security, social needs and self-actualization. In addition, it is
necessary to continue analyzing the effect of business performance mediation on business
sustainability.
REFERENCES
[1]. Agusty Ferdinand, 2005. Structural Equation Modeling dalam Penelitian Managemen.
Badan Penerbit Undip, Semarang.
[2]. Allen Louis A, 2007. Karya Management. Prehallindo, Jakarta.
[3]. Alma Buchori, 2004. Kewirausahaan. Alfabeta, Bandung.
[4]. Amstrong Michael, 2000. Manajemen Sumberdaya Manusia (Terjemahan). PT. Alex Media
Komputindo, Jakarta.
[5]. Arikunto Suharsimi, 2006. Prosedur Penelitian Suatu Pendekatan Praktik. Rinneka Cipta,
Jakarta.
[6]. Arul, M.J. 2004. Managerial Skills. Harvard Business Review, didownload dari:
http://www.answers.com/topic/management.
[7]. Atmosoeprapto Kisdarto, 2001. Produktivitas, Aktualisasi Budaya Perusahaan. PT. Elex
Media Komputindo, Jakarta.
[8]. Bernardin dan Russel, 2002. Critical Incident Technique in Gael. Handbook for Job
Analysis, John Wiley and Sons, New York.
[9]. Bovespa Corporate Sustainability Index-ISE, (tanpa tahun), didownload dari :
http://www.ifc.org.
[10]. Burton Hamner, 2008. Financial Statements For Sustainable Business. didownload dari :
http.www.cleanerproduction.com.
[11]. Cahayani Ati, 2003. Dasar-Dasar Organisasi dan Manajemen. PT. Widiasarana Indonesia,
Jakarta.
278
[12]. Child, 2007. Perspective in Economic Psychology A Tribute to Karl-Erik Warneryd. Journal
of Economic Psychology.
[13]. Cooper dan Makin, 2005, A Motivational Perspective on Risky Behaviors : The Role of
Personality And Affect Regulattory Processes, University Of Missouri, Columbia.
[14]. Deci, Edward L, R Koestner, and Richard M, Ryan. 2004. A Meta-Analytic Review of
Experiments Examining The Effect of Extrinsic Rewards on Intrinsic Motivation.
[15]. Dessler Gary, 2000. Human Resources Management. 8th Prentice Hall International, Inc.
Calivornia.
[16]. Djati Sundring Pantja, 1999. Pengaruh Variabel-Variabel Motivasi Terhadap Kinerja
Perusahaan pada Industri Rumah Tangga di Kabupaten Sidoarjo.
[17]. Dyah Sawitri, 2008, Pengaruh Faktor Manajerial Terhadap Kinerja Perusahaan dan Nilai
Tambah Pada Industri Kecil Makanan di Jawa Timur, Post Graduate Airlangga University.
[18]. Frey Bruno, 2002. Not Just For The Money An Economic Theory of Personal Motivation.
Brookfield. PT. Edward Elgar Publishing Company.
[19]. Gibson James. L. 2004. Organization and Management. University of Kentucky
[20]. Gibson James, L, John M. Ivancevich dan James H. Donnelly., 2006. Organisasi, Perilaku,
Struktur, Proses (Terjemahan). Binarupa Aksara, Jakarta.
[21]. Gozali Imam, 2008. Model Persamaan Struktural, Konsep dan Aplikasi dengan Program
Amos 16.0, Badan Penerbit Undip., Semarang.
[22]. Hasibuan Malayu, S.P, 2000. Organisasi dan Motivasi. PT. Bumi Aksara, Jakarta
[23]. ..................................., 2000. Manajemen Dasar, Pengertian dan Masalah. PT. Gunung
Agung, Jakarta.
[24]. Hisrich Robert D. dan Michael P. Peters, 2003. Entrepreneurship. MA : Irwin Internasional,
Inc, Boston.
[25]. Hisrich, Robert D. Michael P. Peters dan Shepherd Dean A. 2005. Entrepreneurship. Six
Edition, Boston, USA : McGraw Hill.
[26]. Justin, G. Longenecker. 2001. Kewirausahaan. Manajemen Usaha Kecil, Salemba Empat,
Jakarta.
[27]. Kaplan and Norton, 2001. The Balanced Scorecard : Translating Strategy into Action
Harvard Business Review, Kenyon Stores.
[28]. Koesmoyo T., 2005. Motivasi dan Kepuasan, Kinerja Serta Kelangsungan Usaha Sub Sektor
Pengolahan Kayu Skala Menengah di Jawa Timur, Jurnal Manajemen dan Kewirausahaan
No. 2 September 171-188.
[29]. Koontz, Harold, Cyrill O’Donnell, dan Heinz Weihrich, 2004. Manajemen Strategis,
(Terjemahan), Erlangga, Jakarta.
[30]. Kreitner Robert, Kinicki Angelo, 2003. Perilaku Organisasi. (Terjemahan), Salemba Empat,
Jakarta
[31]. Laila Nagib dkk, 2000, Kelangsungan Hidup dan Pengembangan Industri Kecil di Tengah
Krisis : Kajian Cepat di Kabupaten Tasikmalaya. Jawa Barat, PPT-LIPI, Jakarta.
[32]. Lee and Miller, 2003. Person-Entrepreneurship Fit : Why Some People are More Successful
as Entrepreneurs Than Others Human Resource Management.
[33]. Locke Edwin A., 2007. Esensi Kepemimpinan: Empat Kunci Untuk Memimpin Dengan
Penuh Keberhasilan. Spektrum, Jakarta.
[34]. Machfoedz Mas’ud, 2008. Kewirausahaan Metode, Manajemen dan Implementasi Edisi
2005/2006, BPFE; UGM.,Yogyakarta.
[35]. Mahoney dan Pandian, 2002. The Reseource-Based View Within The Conversation of
Strategic Management, Journal.
[36]. Maris Masri, 2002. Manajemen Sumberdaya Manusia. Media Asri, Jakarta.
[37]. Meng Low Aik, Wee Liang Tan, 2006. Entrepreneurs, Entrepreneurship and Entreprising
Culture Paris. Addision-Wisley, Publishing Company, Singapore.
[38]. Meredith Geoffrey G. 2006. Kewirausahaan Teori dan Praktik. Pustaka Binaman Pressindo,
Jakarta
279
[39]. Mintzberg Henry, 2005. The Manager’s Job Folklore and Fact. Harvard Business Review,
Prentive Hall-Inc.
[40]. Montgomery Collins, 2003. Corporate Strategy A Resource Based Approach Mic Grow-Hill
Internasional Edition, Singapore.
[41]. Mueller, Elisabeth, Spitz, Alexandra, 2007. Managerial Ownership and Firm Performance in
German Small and Medium-Sized Entreprises Research in Economics. Elsevier.
[42]. Mulyanto, 2007. Pengaruh Motivasi dan Kemampuan Manajerial Terhadap Kinerja Usaha
Pedagang Kaki Lima Menetap (Suatu Survai Pada Pusat Perdagangan dan Wisata di Kota
Surakarta, Benefit Jurnal Manajemen dan Bisnis, vol 11 (no.1) pp. 73-86. ISSN 1410-4571
[43]. Munandar, 2001. Psikologi Industri dan Organisasi. UI Press, Jakarta.
[44]. Nasution Mulia. 2004. Manajemen Personalia. Rineka Cipta, Jakarta.
[45]. Ndraha Talizuhu, 2007, Budaya Organisasi, Rineka Cipta, Jakarta.
[46]. Orser, B.J. 2004. Managerial Capacity and Growth Motivation Intentions : An Impirical
Investigation. Management Decision.
[47]. Pace Wayne R dan Don F. Faules, 2003. Komunikasi Organisasi, Strategi Meningkatkan
Kinerja Organisasi (Terjemahan), PT. Remaja Rosdakarya, Bandung.
[48]. Pambudy, R., Burhanuddin dan D. Rahadian, 2002. Hubungan Perilaku Wirausaha Peternak
Dengan Produktivitas Kelompok Peternak Domba Garut, didownload dari :
http://katalog.ipb.ac.id/jurnale/files/Pambudy
[49]. Porter Michael E. 2002. Competitive Strategy. The Pree Press New York.
[50]. Riduwan, 2002, Skala Pengukuran Variabel-Variabel Penelitian. Alfabeta, Bandung.
[51]. Riduwan dan Akdon, 2007. Rumus dan Data Dalam Analisis Statistika Untuk Penelitian
(Administrasi Pendidikan-Bisnis-Pemerintahan-Sosial-Kebijakan-Ekonomi-Hukum-
Manajemen-Kesehatan). Alfabeta, Bandung
[52]. Robbins Stephen P, 2002. Prinsip-Prinsip Perilaku Organisasi. Erlangga, Jakarta.
[53]. .............................., 2003. Teori Organisasi : Struktur, Desain dan Aplikasi. Penerbit Arena,
Jakarta.
[54]. Ruky Achmad S., 2002. Sistem Manajemen Prestasi Kerja. di download dari
:http//www.geocitios.com.
[55]. Rully Setiadi, 2009. Sustainable CSR, didownload dari: http://www.
dinsoslampung.web.id/artikel/66-sustainable-csr-.html
[56]. Saiman Leonardus, 2009. Kewirausahaan, Teori, Praktik dan Kasus-Kasus. Salemba Empat,
Jakarta.
[57]. Salusu, J., 2004. Pengambilan Keputusan Strategik untuk Organisasi Publik dan Organisasi
Non Profit. Grasindo, Jakarta.
[58]. Santoso Singgih, 2007. Structural Equation Modelling Konsep dan Aplikasi dengan AMOS.
PT. Elex Media Komputindo, Jakarta.
[59]. Santosa Purbaya Budi dan Ashari, 2005. Analisis Statistik dengan Microsoft Excel dan
SPSS. Andi Offset, Yogyakarta.
[60]. Saparudin Nandang, 2008, Pengaruh Karakteristik dan Kompetensi Kewirausahaan Terhadap
Kinerja Usaha dengan Implementasi Kebijakan Pengembangan UKM Sebagai Intervening
(Studi Kasus Pada UKM Binaan PT. Telkom Kandatel Kendari), Tesis Unhalu, Kendari.
[61]. Sarwono Jonathan, 2007. Analisis Jalur Untuk Riset Bisnis Dengan SPSS. Andi, Yogyakarta.
[62]. Sedarmayanti, 2001. Sumberdaya Manusia dan Produktivitas Kerja. Mandar Maju,
Bandung.
[63]. Setiyadi Iwan, 2003. Memperkenalkan Manajemen Personalia Dalam Praktek, Rineka Cipta,
Jakarta.
[64]. Sigauw, J.A. Brown G dan Widing, R.E. 2004. The Influence of The Market Orientation of
The Firm on Sales Force Behavior and Attitudes. Journal of Marketing.
[65]. Simanjuntak Payman J. 2005. Manajemen dan Evaluasi Kinerja. Lembaga Penerbit Fakultas
Ekonomi Universitas Indonesia, Jakarta.
[66]. Sinaga Pariaman, 2004. Balanced Scorecard Sebagai Pengukuran Kinerja Koperasi dan
Usaha Kecil Menengah.
280
[67]. Singarimbun dan Effendi, 1995. Metode Penelitian Survey, Edisi Revisi, LP3ES. Jakarta
[68]. Solimun, 2004, Multivariate Analysis : Structural Equation Modelling (SEM) Lisrel dan
AMOS, Aplikasi di Manajemen, Ekonomi Pembangunan, Psikologi, Sosial, Kedokteran, dan
Agrokompleks, Fakultas MIPA Universitas Brawijaya. Malang.
[69]. Sri Hadiati, 2008, Perilaku Wirausaha Industri Keramik Berskala Kecil untuk Meningkatkan
Daya Saing Produk di Malang, Journal Manajemen dan Kewirausahaan, didownload dari :
http://www.google.co.id
[70]. Sudrajati, 2007, Pengaruh Kemampuan Manajerial Terhadap Kelangsungan Hidup Usaha
Industri Kecil Makanan dan Minuman di Bandung. Journal Manajemen dan Kewirausahaan,
didownload dari : http://www.google.co.id
[71]. Sumarsono Sonny, 2010. Kewirausahaan. Graha Ilmu, Yogyakarta.
[72]. Stoner James AF. 2002. Manajemen Alih Bahasa Benyamin Molan. Surya Usaha Ningtias.
PT. Prenhalindo, Jakarta.
[73]. Sugiyono, 2005. Metode Penelitian Administrasi. Alfa Beta, Bandung
[74]. …………, 2008. Metode Penelitian Bisnis. Alfa Beta, Bandung.
[75]. Sule Ernie T., dan K. Saefullah, 2005. Pengantar Manajemen. Kencana, Jakarta.
[76]. Suliyanto, 2005. Analisis Data Dalam Aplikasi Pemasaran. Ghalia Indonesia, Jakarta.
[77]. Supranto, J. 2004. Perkembangan Konsep Pemasaran dan Konsekuensinya Terhadap
Kebutuhan Informasi. Majalah Usahawan, No. 6th XXXII
[78]. ....................., 2006. Statistik Teori dan Aplikasinya Edisi Keenam, LP3ES. Jakarta.
[79]. Suryana. 2003. Kewirausahaan. Pedoman Praktis, Kiat dan Proses Menuju Sukses. Salemba
Empat, Jakarta.
[80]. Susilo Sarwoto, 2001. Membangun Motivasi Kerja. Media Asri, Jakarta.
[81]. Tony Wijaya, 2008, Kajian Model Empiris Perilaku Berwirausaha UKM DIY dan Jawa
Tengah, Journal Manajemen dan Kewirausahaan, didownload dari : http://www.google.co.id
[82]. Tunggal Widjaja Amin, 2009. Pokok-Pokok Balanced Scorecard. Harvarindo, Jakarta.
[83]. …………………………., 2009. Intisari Entrepreneurship. Harvarindo, Jakarta.
[84]. Tunti Maria Elerina, 2008. Analisis Motivasi, Kemampuan Manajerial, Komitmen
Organisasi terhadap Kepuasan Kerja, Kinerja Organisasi, BPFE.,UGM. Yogyakarta
[85]. Umar Husein, 2003. Evaluasi Kinerja Perusahaan. PT. Gramedia Pustaka Utama, Jakarta.
[86]. Urata Sujiro, 2000. Policy Recommendation for SME Promotion in The Republic of
Indonesia. Japan Internasional Cooperation Agency.
[87]. Warhurst, A. 2002. Sustainability Indicators and Sustainability Performance Management,
Warwick Business School, University of Warwick, United Kingdom.
[88]. Werther dan Devis, 2005. Administrade Pessoal e Recursos Humanos. Paulo:McGraw-Hill
do Brazil.
[89]. Wheelen Hunger, J. David, Thomas. L., 2002. Management and Business Policy, Addision
Wesley Publishing Co Hill USA.
[90]. Widjaja Albert, 2003. Manajemen Strategik Perusahaan Dalam Dekade 1990an. Manajemen
dan Usahawan Indonesia, Jakarta.
[91]. Winardi, 2002. Manajemen Perilaku Organisasi. PT. Citra Aditya Bakti, Bandung.
[92]. Wirawan, 2003. Kapita Selekta Teori Kepemimpinan. Yayasan Bangun Indonesia dan
Uhamka Press, Jakarta.
[93]. Yukl Gary. 2001. Kepemimpinan dalam Organisasi. Alih Bahasa oleh Jusuf Udaya.
Prenhallindo. Jakarta.
[94]. Zulkifli Amsyah, 2005. Manajemen Sistem Informasi. PT. Gramedia Pustaka Utama, Jakarta.
281
282
THE INFLUENCE OF OPERATIONAL FLEXIBILITY CAPABILITIES
TOWARD
TRUST (STUDY AT SMALL AND MICRO ENTERPRISE)
Wirdah Irawati, SE. M.Sc
Syiah Kuala University, Banda Aceh
email: wirdahfe@gmail.com
Yurnalis,
Syiah Kuala University, Banda Aceh
email: Yoernalis 2005 @yahoo.Com.
ABSTRACT
The purpose of this study is to examine the operational flexibility of suppliers toward
company’s trust. The study conducts operational flexibility capabilities as independent
variable and trust as dependent variable. The study uses a survey method on small and
micro enterprises (SME’S) in the handicraft industry as respondents. The research
methodology used Structural Equation Modeling (SEM) through Software Partial Least
Square (PLS) with a sample of 106 SME’s in Bantul regency, Jogyakarta. The results show
a significant influence between operational flexibility capabilities toward the company’s
trust.
Key words: operational flexibility capability, Trust, Partnership, PLS.
INTRODUCTION
Business environment competition is changing rapidly. This results in companies finding
out the patterns that are flexible and creative to meet the competition‘s
challenge. Companies’ efforts in responding this challenge vary, one of them is by
building collaborative partnerships between suppliers and customers (Dertouzos et
al.,(1989), Donney and Cannon, 1997). Companies expect the benefits of this partnership
283
collaboration to improve the ability to compete through the relationship with their supply
chains. Similar to medium and large industries that do supply chain activities, the micro
and small industries also do the same to increase the competitive value through supply
chains activities.
The supply chain is defined as a system where organizations distribute the
production of goods and services to their customers (Indrajit and Pranoto, 2006). Supply
chain management was originally also known as material management (Dobbler, 1990) in
Qualey p.4, (2006). A supply chain is an integrated process where raw materials processed
into final products, and then delivered to customers, through distribution activities
(Beamon, 1999).
The goal of any supply chain is to optimize the operational performance of the
organization by providing products or services to potential customers with minimal cost in
time required. In many industries today, competing success is influenced by the improved
performance of the supply chain which requires a lot of ability to innovate and improve the
relationship among business partners. Optimalization of working time of either industry
suppliers who are in the industry upstream or downstream must be effective (Lee, et
al., 2007). The level of correlation in related to the supply chain activities will vary based
on the implementation consideration of good supply chain strategy.
Indrajit and Pranoto (2006), states that the concept of the supply chain is a new concept in
the matter of logistic problem. Old concept see logistics more as internal problem of each
company and it can be solved internally. While the new concept, logistic problem is
considered as serious issue that lies from basic materials to finished goods used by end
consumers, a chain of goods supply. Harland (1996) in Tan (2000) describes the supply
chain management as a business management activities, and relationship within
organization through a major supplier or suppliers of suppliers and customers that are
involved along the supply chain.
Here is a picture showing the activities and companies involved in the supply chain.
Source: New and Payne (1995) in Tan (2000)
Figure 1.1 The Company and Activities in Supply Chain
Miners/raw Material
Extractors
Raw material
manufacturers
Component Manufacturer
s
Final product
manufactur
wholesalers Retailers Final consumer
Recycling
Physical distribution & warehousing
The earth
284
Currently, the competition is becoming increasingly competitive, that is characterized by
short product life cycles, rapidly changing technologies and increasing global competition,
that make the supply chain management is the key to the success of any business venture.
Selection of suppliers is the basic activity in the inbound logistics that includes;
Accepting, Saving/storage, and distributing the incoming material or materials to be
used. Furthermore, selection of supplier is one of the key issues of supply chain
management because, as mentioned above, the cost of raw materials and related
components acts as a major cost of product management. As a result, this field has become
the focus of much research both theoretical and empirical (Ordobadi, 2009).
When suppliers has become part of the company and managed properly, it will have an
effect on the competitiveness of the entire supply chain (Choi and Hartley (1996)
inWang et al., 2005). This explains that a strong relationship impacts on the companies
power to compete. When the company’s supplier partnerships has built a good relation for
such a long term, this will create a strong barrier to the competitors to persuade.
The success of supply chain management system (SCM) related to the development of
specific capabilities (Chandra and Kumar, 2000 in Othman and Ghani, 2008).Furthermore,
Chandra and Kumar (2000) and Ghani Othman (2008) mention that the specific
capabilities include the ability to develop organizational flexibility, the ability to develop
relationships of trust with suppliers, the ability to find a number of supply chain
coordination, improve communication ability to reduce the risk of uncertainty, has a
competence of build-to-order, outsourcing capabilities on competencies that are non-
core, the ability to reduce inventory levels, as well as the ability to reduce costs. Capability
of the organization is DNA to win the competition (Ulrich, 1996). This means that the
capability of a company plays an important role to do something better than its
competitors. The competence is referred to technological competence in terms of the
ability to create new effects of financial flexibility that can be seen from the ability to
respond aggressively to the various demands of the market at the same time.
In addition, the company has a different approach that is used as the
basis interdependency relationship toward the parties that have an interest in the
organization. Gianakis (2007) explains that the trust or confidence to business partners is
among four characters of relationships in the supply chain activities, while the others
are; power in decision making, involvement in the supply chain relationships, and the
development of commitments that will contribute to the success of the supply chain. In the
supply chain activities, it is important to establish a partnership based on a solid foundation
of trust (Sally and Kourdy (2007).
Furthermore, the trust has an important position when the situation occurs become less
effective than it was planned (Sahay, 2003 in Ghost and Fedorowicz, 2008). Trust reflects
the confidence of one of the parties in a two-way relationship that the other party will not
285
exploit (Sako 1991; Svensson 2001 in Ghost and Fedorowicz, 2008). The existence of trust
becomes increasingly important when the two conditions in a transaction that is situational
uncertainty and asymmetric information (Agarwala et al., 2007 in Ghost and Fedorowicz
2008). Thus, the scope of the relationship with the suppliers in the supply chain
management activities, managing good relationships will affect the sustainability of
business cooperation for achieving a win-win solution for both parties. Trust is one of the
very few constructions that can be performed by individuals, groups, companies, industry
groups, political entities, and supply chain (Lewicki and Bunker 1996; Sako and Helper
1998; Svensson 2004 in Ghost and Fedorowicz, 2008).
Studies that explicitly examine whether the capabilities of operational flexibility in the
selection of the basis of assessment of suppliers to establish trust are very few (Donney and
Cannon, 1997). So that, examining the influence of operational flexibility capabilities to
the formation of trust be the main issue of this study. This is because the trust can create
and enable economic transactions become more efficient by giving a chance to related
parties to access more information. In addition, mutual trust allows them to coordinate
activities for mutual benefit.
From the literature, it is understood that the trust is an important element in the features of
a partnership. Trust also used by the buyer company as a criterion in evaluating suppliers
involved in the collaboration (Donney and Cannon 1997). In addition, the research findings
Ghost and Fedorowicz, (2008) revealed that the trust in the supply chain partnership serves
as a liaison between the written agreement (the contract) and power supply on the
information exchange management. Previous studies of Ghost and Fedorowicz (2008)
found that trust is important for information sharing activities in the partnership activities,
and it is also related to regulatory mechanisms, strength, and contract agreement. All these
three will affect the activities of sharing information in the relationship seen in utility and
quality information obtained by the two parties engaged in business relationships.
Based on the description above, this study is a continuation and development of previous
studies, which will test the capabilities of operational flexibility and trust (confidence) as
a variable to be studied.
The object of this study is the micro and small industries or called IMK. IMK is chosen
because it is considered having a specific character in the supply chain management. The
limitations of micro and small industries both in terms of capital and technology
capabilities, makes the activity of the partnership that is based on the belief, sometimes
even in the absence of a written agreement, made relations activities go naturally. In an
established industry, there is an integrated management process related to material flow
through the channels of distribution from the supplier to the end user, so that all the
complexity of the process of managing the flow of materials become interrelated, and the
job description is clear and synergy. While the micro and small industries (IMK) run the
supply chain activities uncomplicatedly. Raw materials obtained from suppliers who are
286
able to meet the primary needs of material and the amount is not much, and the factors of
trust and reliability of partners has become basis in establishing a partnership.
Large and midlle industries are in an attempt to protect against the risks that may arise
through the efforts made to reduce the risk of partnership. Efforts to reduce this risk by
choosing the leading company in the field in order to meet the criteria of credibility, using
a list of suppliers which has been approved previously (familiarity), making a partnership
with some selected suppliers (multiple sourcing), visiting and learning the supplier
activities by the purpose to build a good perception communication (honesty) with
suppliers. The limitations owned by IMK make it unable to manage and control the risk of
suppliers behavior as partnerships, as some of IMK do not have a legal entity.
Although there are limitations by micro and small industry (IMK) such as limited sources
of funding, but IMK sector is seen as one of the leading sectors of national development
and can be seen from year to year continues to increase (CBS, 2006). The increasing of
IMK is not only in business units but also in the amount of employment, the variety of
processing the production and the variety of the product, especially its contribution to
the Gross Domestic product (CBS, 2008).
Every production business requires raw materials, either produced by the company itself
or ordered from other parties outside the business. Cooperation to meet the needs of
industrial raw materials involving another party, called partners or suppliers which would
involve a series of assessment so that cooperation can run smoothly as the partner has a
relationship with the company's business orientation. A partnership between business units
and suppliers leads an interdependence between suppliers and IMK business. Suppliers are
also called as stakeholders should get a considerable attention as the IMK and suppliers are
in a symbiotic relationship that benefit equally great for business sustainability.
Micro and small industries that will be the object of this research took place in the
Province of Yogyakarta, especially the district of Bantul. Bantul region selection based on
several considerations; it is known as a center of the non-oil industry that contributes
substantially to economic growth in the region of Yogyakarta and it is also known as a
craft industry area which has considerable variation crafts like pottery in Kasongan, shoes,
bags, box jackets, souvenirs, leathers crafts(Manding), wooden masks craft (Krebet),
leather puppet craft in Gendeng, stone crafts (sculpture) in Lemahdadi, wooden flowers
craft in Pundong village , and Bantul region is very popular with its batik industries in
Giriloyo, Imogiri, Trimulyo, and Jetis. (Bernas.co.id, 2008).
The ability of suppliers to meet the demand of micro and small industrial enterprises must
be based on good faith that will increase the confidence of the business entrepreneurs
suppliers.
287
Empirical research in Indonesia, which examines the effect of operational flexibility
capabilities of suppliers to the establishment of trust is still limited. It's like described by
Modi and Mabert (2007) in Carr et.al (2008) that the studies discussed both theoretically
and empirically to benefit the development of relationships with suppliers for the suppliers’
company is still very few. Previous studies measure the performance of the partnership
through the perspective of the buyer company.
This study is important because of the limited research that tests the capabilities of
operational flexibility of the trust. So the researcher will combine aspects of operational
flexibility and trust in one model study.
LITERATURE REVIEW AND HYPOTHESIS DEVELOPMENT
Supplier Capability Influence Toward Company Trust
The decision to choose a suitable supplier necessarily involves a series of assessment of the
capabilities possessed by the supplier as well as the nature of trust involved in this
process. Ulrich (1996), defines the capability refers to what the company's ability does or
what the company needs to enhance its strategy. Capability is a process and application
within the company that enables companies to add value or motivate customers in a unique
way. Capability of the organization can be shown through creativity, and qualified leading,
being able to offer a low cost, ensure confidence, having a high-
quality engineering techniques, and cultural flexibility.
Suppliers Capability can also be judged through internal aspects which are owned by the
suppliers. These aspects include: the ability to develop organizational flexibility, the ability
to develop a relationship of mutual trust (trusting), the ability of collaboration, effective
communication skills, ability to reduce inventory costs, the ability to place an order and the
ability to reduce costs (Othman and Ghani, 2008). In addition, the capability of the supplier
can be seen in its responsibilities to lower supply costs and the quality improvement of the
product (Gunasekaran, et al., 2008 in Othman and Ghani, 2008).
Sinkovich and Roath (2004) then divide capability in two forms, namely the capability of
operational flexibility and collaboration capabilities. Operational flexibility capability is
used to identify a company's ability to respond dynamic market (Ling-Yee Li and
Ogunmokum 2000; Sanchez 1995 in Sinkovich and Roath 2004), while Carlson (1989),
Suarez, Cusmano and Fine (1995) in Sinkovich and Roath (2004) explain that the
operational flexibility demonstrated the ability of the company to meet the shortage
of inventory, to respond to fluctuations in demand in a short span of time or the ability of
the company to respond to the problems which appears in the production activities in the
event of the need for modification of the product. Furthermore, operational flexibility can
also be seen on the company's daily operations and response to disturbances in the system
of organization (Sinkovich and Roath 2004).
288
Based on these two explanations, the operational flexibility associated with the response
given within a short time span as issues related to inventory and demand fluctuations.
Based on the above explanation, the research hypothesis are as follows:
Hypothesis 1: Operational Flexibility Capabilities suppliers have a positive
influence on the trust company.
The research model can be described by the hypothesis proposed in hypothesis formulation
as shown in the following picture:
Figure 1.2:
Effect of Operational Flexibility Capability Suppliers
Toward Trust Company
METHODOLOGY
In this study, conducted survey method to collect data through questionnaires or
interviews (Cooper and Schindler, 2008). This study used a cross section which is done
only once and represents a specific period. The object of this study was small and micro
enterprises or commonly referred to as micro and small industries (IMK) in Bantul,
Yogyakarta, Indonesia.
Model analysis used in this study is based on SEM component (component-
based) with smart software PLS (Partial Least Square) Ver.2 M3 (Chin, 1998 in Hartono
and Abdillah, 2009). An appropriate sample size for PLS is 10 x the most complex
indicator . The construct of trust is an indicator of the most complex one as it consists of 8
items of questions that can satisfy the rule of thumbs PLS, then the minimum sample size is
80 respondents.
The number of respondents are 120 to anticipate questionnaires were not returned. The
number of questionnaires that can be analyzed is 106 respondents. To test the measurement
model constructing indicators performed by testing stages of Ghozali (2006)testing (1)
construct validity (convergent validity anddiscriminant with validity), and (2) the internal
consistency (reliability measurement with composite reliability).
kapabilitas fleksibilitas
operasional
kepercayaan
289
Indicators proposed at the beginning were 15 indicators, but most of them did not meet
the test indicator measurement models, then 5 indicators of trust constructions were
also dropped 2, so that the remaining three indicators were used in testing the structural
model. Structural model testing performed after testing the measurement model. These
tests include estimating path coefficients that identify strengths relationship between the
independent and dependent variable. Testing structural models generate significant value
relationship paths between latent variables using bootsrapping function.
ANALYSIS AND DISCUSSION
Here is a picture showing the two structural models and hypothesis testing results.
Figure 2: Structural Model and Hypothesis Testing Results
The results above show that the hypothesis test of the capability on the operational
flexibility has a positive effect on trust. This is indicated by the coefficient of FLX Ã TR
(0.310219) and the t value is 2.993045. These findings answer the purpose of the study that
is to explore the effects of operational flexibility capabilities toward the trust. The
hypothesis of this research is supported by the finding as the capabilities of operational
flexibility has a positive effect on trust at 95% confidence level.
Operational flexibility is one of the indicators that can take the company to gain
efficiencies in supply chain management. Competitive advantage possessed by the partners
(suppliers) for micro and small enterprises such as technological superiority, dynamic
capability and efficiency will strengthen the trust toward the ability of a partner in a
business partnership.
For supplier companies , ability to meet the demands of customers or adjustment will
increase the trust of the customers so that customers get superior benefits of partnering
relationships. This study indicated the level of trust of customers to suppliers of raw
materials, the belief that the supplier be honest in transactions, as well as the belief that the
supplier has in serving and selfish concern for customer affairs.
FLX1
FLX2
FLX3
FLX
9,369
4,944
12,501
18,087
17,346
27,400
TR
TR1
TR3
TR2
2,993
290
This will bring the company a competitive advantage when the supplier is able to maintain
the confidence of small and micro entrepreneurs through the ability to respond dynamically
to each customer characteristics. It is also as expressed in the research Fawcett (1996), that
the pattern of competition has now expanded to a global market space so that the industry
must come out of traditional manufacturing activities to build a sustainable competitive
advantage. Competitive advantage can be achieved through the ability to increase
operating activities more efficiently and effectively so that the results will be seen from the
increasing customer loyalty.
This picture shows the capability of the supplier company in the activities of operational
flexibility shown by the indicator is able to adapt to the needs of customers or the ability to
adjust the face of changing market environment situation can increase customer confidence
in the partnership activities that occur daily.
CONCLUSION
This research in general, analyze the impact between the supplier flexibility capabilities
toward trust into the micro and small industry in Bantul.
The results of this research supported the researchers' expectations. This study shows that
the findings of the research that is the capability to answer allegations of operational
flexibility and significant positive effect on trust.
The results of this study in addition to providing theoretical implications are also expected
to provide practical implications for the industry in assessing the capabilities of suppliers
through operational flexibility capability to produce policies that can improve the trust of
business owners to suppliers. The results of this study are expected to provide input for
the buyer company formed a partnership with another company. Implications obtained
includes inputs for decision-making process in the selection of suppliers that will affect on
increasing confidence in the company's suppliers.
For supplier companies, the results of this study will be the basis of the evaluation of the
company to improve the capabilities of operational flexibility to be able to increase trust of
small and micro entrepreneurs to the partnerships built over the years. The ability of the
company to increase operational flexibility and trust capabilities will indirectly affect the
competitive advantage of the company's suppliers.
REFERENCES
Cooper DR, and Schindler, PS, (2008). Business Research Methods, 10 th
edition, N ew
York: The Mcgraw-Hill Companies, Inc.
Patricia M. Doney and Cannon P. Joseph. (1997). An Examination of the Nature of Trust
in Buyer-Seller Relationships. The Journal of Marketing, Vol. 61, No. 2 pp. 35-5.
291
Dyer, H. Jeffrey. (1997). Effective Interfirm Collaboration: How Firm Minimize And
Maximize Transaction Cost Transaction Value. Strategic Management Journal, Vol. 18
No. 7 pp. 535-556
Fawcett, E. Stanley and Clinton, Steven R. (1996). Enhancing Logistics Performance To
Improve The Competitive Of Manufacturing Organizations. Production And Inventory
Management Journal, First Quarter; 37 pp, 40-46
Ghosh, Anupan. Fedorowicz, Jane. (2008). The Role of Trust in Supply Chain
Governance. Business Process Management Journal Vol. 14, pp, 453-470
Ghozali, I, (2008), Applications Multivariate Analysis With SPSS, S emarang:
Diponegoro Publisher Agency.
Mihalis Giannakis, (2007), Performance Measurement of Supplier Relationships; Supply
Chain Management: An International Journal VOL 12 NO. 6 pp. 400A € "411.
Ha, Byoung-Chun. Park, Yang-Kyu. Cho, Sungbin (2011). Suppliersâ € ™ Affective Trust
and Trust in Competency In Buyers Its Effect on Collaboration and Logistics
Efficiency.International Journal of Operations and Production Management Vol. 31 No. 1,
2011.pp. 56-77.
Hartono, Jogiyanto and Abdillah, Willy. (2009). Concepts and Applications PLS For
Empirical Research. BPFE. Yogyakarta. First edition.
Helper, Susan and Kiehl, Janet. (2004). Developing Supplier Capabilities: Market and
Non-Market Approaches. Industrial And Innovation, Volume 11, Number I / 2, pp 89-107.
Huxham, Chris (1993). Coolaborative Capability: an Intraorganizational Perspectives on
Collaborative Advantage. Public Money and Management Journal. July-September 1993.
Kannan, Vijay R. and Tan, Keah Choon. (2006). Buyer-Supplier Relationships The Impact
of Supplier Selection and Engagement Buyer-Supplier Relationship and Firm Performance
on; International Journal of Physical Distribution and Logistics Management Vol. 36
No. 10, 2006 pp. 755-775
Kwon, Ik-Whan G. Suh, Taewon. (2005). Trust, Commitment and Relationships in Supply
Chain Management: A Path Analysis. Supply Chain Management: An International
Journal 10/1 pp. 26a € "33.
Laeequddin, .Mohammed. Sardana, GD and Sahay, BS. Abdul Waheed K. and Sahay,
Vinita. (2009). Supply Chain Partnersâ € ™ Trust Building Process Through Risk
Evaluation: The Perspectives of the UAE Packaged Food Industry. Supply Chain
Management: An International Journal vol.14 4, 2009, pp. 280â € "290
292
Moorman RM., Desphande, R. & Zaltman, G. (1993). Factors Affecting Trust In Market
Research Relationship. Journal of Marketing. 57 (1): 81-101.
Morgan, RM., & Hunt, SD (1994). The Commitment Trust Theory of Relationship
Marketing, Journal of Marketing. 58 (3): 20-38.
Moser, Roger and BLOME, Constantin. (2008). The Influence of
Strategic Supplier Selection Criteria on PSM and Company Performance. The Icfai Journal
of Supply ChainManagement, Vol. V, No. 2.
Ordoobadi, Ordobadi M. (2009) Development of a Supplier Selection Model Using Fuzzy
Logic. Supply Chain Management: An International Journal Vol. 14 No. 4 pp. 314â €
"327.
Othman, Rozhan and Ghani, RA (2008). Supply Chain Management and Suppliers HRM
Practice. Supply Chain Management: An International Journal 13/4 (2008) 259A € "262.
Sally Bibb and Jeremy Kourdi (2007), A Question of Trust: The Crucial Nature of Trust in
Business, Work and Life- and How to Build It. Pp. 29-42
Sinkovics, Rudolf R and Roath, Anthony S. (2004). Strategic Orientation, Capabilities,
And Performance In Manufacturer - 3PL Relationships. Journal of Business Logistics.
Vol.25 No. 2. ABI / INFORM Global. pg. 43.
Ulrich, Dave (1996), Human Resource Champions. The Next Agenda for Adding Value
and Delivering For Results. Harvard Business School Press. Boston. Massachusetts.
Wang, Tian Yezhuang And Yunquan, Hu. (2005). Empirical Study of Supplier Selection
Practices in Supply Chain Management in Manufacturing Companies. International
Journal of Innovation and Technology Management Vol. 2, No. 4 pp 391â € "409.
293
THE EFFECT OF ORGANIZATIONAL JUSTICE ON JOB SATISFACTION AND
ORGANIZATIONAL COMMITMENT
Lino Da Silva Saldanha
Student of Magister Program University of Udayana
Member Polícia Nacional De Timor-Leste (PNTL)
linosaldanha@yahoo.com
Wayan Gede Supartha
Faculty Economic and Business, University of Udayana - Bali
yandepartha@gmail.com
I Gede Riana
Faculty Economic and Business, University of Udayana - Bali
gederiana@yahoo.com
ABSTRACT
The term of organizational justice was the degree to which organization member perceived
about the overall organizational procedures, rules, and policies which are connected to
their job. The aim of this study was to explore the quality, strength, and significance of the
relationship between three types of organizational justices (procedural, distributive and
interactional) to job satisfaction and organizational commitment. The study would
investigate the relationship between organization chief agent in the Polícia Nacional De
Timor-Leste (PNTL). Data was collected through questionnaire and the data which had
been collected would be analyzed using descriptive and path analysis. The results showed
that the perception of chief agent member in the PNTL about organizational justice had a
positive effect on their job satisfaction. This research also found that the job satisfaction
of chief agent member had a positive effect on organizational commitment in the Polícia
Nacional De Timor-Leste (PNTL).
Keywords: organizational justice, job satisfaction, organizational commitment.
INTRODUCTION
Organizational justice have an impact on a person's attitudes and reactions. Everyone wants fair
treatment both in terms of distribution and procedures or referred to as distributive justice and
procedural justice (Tjahjono, 2007). Distributive justice refers to a number of sources of income
and appreciation to employees and related to resource allocation fairness (Milkovich & Newman,
2005; in Samad, 2006). Procedural justice refers to the process used to make the payment decision
(Brockner et al, 2000; in Samad, 2006). Procedural Justice considers that a decision how payments
are made to be important for the employees (Milkovich & Newman, 2005; in Samad, 2006).
Meanwhile, interactional justice as the individual's perception of the degree to which employees are
treated with dignity, attention, and respect (Robbins and Judge, 2008).
294
Some of research in the field of organizational justice shows that, when employees are
treated fairly, they will have the attitudes and behaviors needed for successful organizational
change even in difficult conditions though (Sugiarti, 2005). Conversely, when the decision of
organizational and managerial actions are considered unfair, the employee will feel dissatisfied and
reject efforts to change organizational improvement. This will cause some employees the
possibility to get the results they expect, while other employees got the opposite possibility.
Thibaut & Walker (1975) assessment of a person of fairness is not only influenced by
what they receive as a result of certain decisions, but also on the process of how the decision was
made (Greenberg, 1990 ; Sugiarti, 2005). If they judge that they receive fair treatment, it will
affect the satisfaction and commitment. Cropanzano et al. (2007) states that there are three reasons
why employees are concerned about fairness. First, the long-term benefits, employees prefer a
justice that is consistent rather than a person's decision, due by the justice employees can predict
the outcome in the future. Employees can also receive rewards that are not profitable throughout
the payment process is fair and treated with dignity. Secondly, social considerations, everyone
expects accepted and valued by employers in no way rude and not exploited. Third, ethical
considerations, people believe that justice is morally appropriate way to treat someone. Cropanzano
et al. (2007) defines organizational justice as a personal assessment of the ethical and moral
standards of managerial behavior. In assessing organizational fairness there are at least three areas
that must be evaluated, namely: remuneration, processes, and interpersonal relationships
(Cropanzano et al., 2001).
Several studies have tested the organizational justice with three components, namely:
distributive, procedural, and interactional (Cohen-Carash and Spector, 2001). Related to the
allocation of rewards individual assessment refers to distributive justice (Leventhal, 1976), while
the assessment of the procedure used to determine the allocation refers to procedural fairness
(Cropanzano and Greenberg, 1997). While the interactional justice refers to the way management
behaves to the recipient justice (Cohen-Carash and Spector, 2001). If the organizational justice has
been met, then the employee is likely to feel satisfied. Job satisfaction is part of the attitude that is
widely studied as a consequence of organizational justice. For companies, job satisfaction means
they are motivated and committed to achieve high performance. Job satisfaction is an important
indicator of treatment related to how employees feel the organization. Odom et al. (1990) suggested
that job satisfaction is basically how much positive or negative feelings shown to employees. Job
satisfaction relates to the general affective appraisal related employees.
Elamin and Alomaim (2011), concluded there is a significant positive effect between
organizational justice to job satisfaction. Similarly, research Bakhshi et al. (2009), Memarzadeh
and Mahmoudi (2010), and Al-Zu'bi (2010) stated organizational fairness significant positive effect
on job satisfaction. Furthermore, Clay-Warner et al. (2005) examined the effects of distributive and
procedural justice on job satisfaction concluded that both types of justice has a positive and
significant relationship to job satisfaction. This study also concluded that procedural fairness is a
stronger predictor than distributive for employee satisfaction. Whisenant and Smucker (2006)
conducted a research relationship with job satisfaction organizational justice. Results of research
shows three dimensions of organizational justice (distributive justice, procedural and interpersonal)
has a positive relationship with job satisfaction.
One the consequences of employee satisfaction is increased employee performance.
According Robbins and Judge (2008), job satisfaction is a positive emotion that is obtained from
the evaluation of a person's work experience. Job satisfaction affect the performance of the
employees that will affect the objectives of productivity, quality, and service. Performance can be
295
interpreted as the result of a process. Therefore, every employee required to have job satisfaction,
namely, a series of pleasant or unpleasant feelings and emotions that are involved in the viewpoint
of the employee (and Newstorm Davis, 2002). Research Ho et al. (2009) stated that job satisfaction
is positive and significant effect on commitment. Ho et al. (2009), also explained that both
distributive justice and procedural fairness had an important role even said to be both a significant
effect on the increase in employee commitment. Cheung and Wu (2012) conducted a study of
procedural and distributive justice influence on organizational commitment. Research results
conclude that the procedural and distributive justice significantly influence organizational
commitment.
The aim of this study was to analyze the significance of the relationship between the
three types of organizational justice (procedural, distributive and interactional) on job satisfaction
and organizational commitment. The research will be carried out on members of the National
Police of East Timor (PNTL). Based on the research objectives and some previous studies can be
described the conceptual framework of research in the following figure.
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN ORGANIZATIONAL JUSTICE AND JOB SATISFACTION
Research conducted Ambrose and Arnaud (2005), showed that organizational justice is a
significant positive effect on job satisfaction. Research conducted Son (2014), showed that
organizational justice positive effect on employee satisfaction. According to Dailey and Kirk,
(1992), the organization must maintain and always pay attention to how much the perceived sense
of justice employees and employee satisfaction at work.
According Fatima et al. (2011), there is a significant and positive effect of organizational
justice on job satisfaction. Furthermore McFarlin and Sweeney (1992), states that organizational
justice positive and significant impact on job satisfaction. Likewise, Nadiri and Tanova (2010),
McAuliffe et al. (2009), Zainalipour et al. (2010), Dundar and Tabancali (2012), states that
organizational justice significant positive effect on job satisfaction.
Based on the description above, the hypothesis of this study are as follows.
H1: Distributive justice have a significant positive effect on job satisfaction
H2: Justice procedural have a significant positive effect on job satisfaction
H3: Justice interactional have a significant positive effect on job satisfaction
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN JOB SATISFACTION AND ORGANIZATIONAL
COMMITMENT
Kim, et al., (2005), states that a significant difference between distributive justice,
procedural justice and interactional justice on organizational commitment. Furthermore, Kim, et al.,
Interactional
Distributive
Procedural Job Satisfaction commitment
Organizational
296
(2005), also explained that the working attitude has a strong positive relationship with
organizational commitment. Research conducted Azeem (2010) and a Nagar, (2012), shows that
job satisfaction as a significant predictor of organizational commitment. Similarly, research
Humborstad, and Perry, (2011) concluded that the nature of work, salary satisfaction and quality
control is a significant predictor of organizational commitment. De Gieter, et al, (2011) found that
employees are very satisfied with their superiors, co-workers, compensation, work itself and
advancement opportunities in higher education can increase organizational commitment. Ho et al.
(2009) and Humborstad, and Perry, (2011), states that job satisfaction is positive and significant
effect on organizational commitment. In line with this is the research conducted by: Cheung and
Wu (2012), Yang (2012), and Bowling & Hammond (2008).
Based on the description, the hypothesis of this study is as follows.
H4: Job satisfaction significant positive effect on organizational commitment
RESEARCH METHODS
This research was conducted at the National Police of East Timor (PNTL). PNTL is the
National Police of Timor - Leste which was responsible for internal security of East Timor under
the Ministry of Defense and Security (Ministerio da Defesa e Segurança) in particular the
Secretariat of State for Security (Secretaria de Estado da Segurança). In the previous government
PNTL are in control of the Interior Ministry (Ministerio do Interior). This study used a sample of
115 members of the chief agent in the PNTL, the data collected by conducting interviews and
questionnaires. The data has been collected will be tested first by the validity and reliability test.
Then, the data that has been analyzed using descriptive and path analysis. Characteristics of
respondents were used as the samples we presented in the Table 1. bellow.
Tabel.1
Respondent characteristics
Characteristics Amount Percentages
(%)
Ages
1. 25 – 30 years
2. 31 – 36 years
3. 37 – 42 years
4. 43 – 48 years
5. ≥ 49 years
13
33
41
21
7
11,3
28,7
35,7
18,2
6,1
Amount 115 100
Gender
1. Men
2. Women
82
33
71,3
28,7
Amount 115 100
Education
1. Senior High School
2. Diploma
3. S1
4. S2
88
1
24
2
76,5
0,9
20,9
1,7
Amount 115 100
Table 1 shows the characteristics of the 115 respondents can be explained that, the
majority of respondents are men that is equal to 71.3% of respondents, while only 28.7% of
297
women. This indicates quite a lot of women who have the desire to become a member of PNTL.
Judging from the age factor, it can be seen that most respondents aged 37 to 42 years is 35.7%,
followed by the age of 31 to 36 years 28.7%, respondents aged 43 to 48 years of 18.2%, age 25 up
to 30 years of 11.3%, and 6.1% were above 49 years of age. The age factor shows the level of
productivity and maturity of a member of the PNTL. Based on age distribution suggests that most
or the majority of PNTL members own a working power and good productivity.
By level of education, it is known that the dominant senior high school respondents
PNTL members amounted to 76.5%, followed by education Strata - 1 (S1) as much as 20.9% of
respondents, educated Strata 2 (S2) by 1.7%, while the members of the PNTL Diploma level
educated smallest rank as many as 0.9%. With the majority of the members of the PNTL as a high
school-educated respondents deemed necessary to provide education and training on an ongoing
basis in order to increase their ability and competence to be able to work in accordance with the
vision and mission of the organization. In addition, the career development needs to be done to the
PNTL members who have the potential and capability for assessment in order to develop
themselves toward higher levels of education to appreciate and motivate themselves.
RESULTS
Using path analysis begins with an examination of the assumptions underlying the
relationship between the variables is linear and additive. The results of the analysis are described
path of regression analysis. The model can also be expressed in the form of equations or diagrams
track so no calling system of simultaneous equations, or there is also mention the structural model.
substructures 1
Y1 = β1 X1 + β2X2 + β3X3 + e1 ................................................ .. ( 1 )
Results of regression analysis to the equation substructure can be seen in Table 1 below .
Table 2
Path Result analysis substructure 1
Based on path analysis substructure 1, the equation structural as below.
Y1 = β1 X1 + β2X2 + β3X3 + e1…………………………………………..(1)
Y1 = 0,295 X1 + 0,170 X2 + 0,472 X3 + e1
F = 90,001
R2
= 0,701
Error Term (e1) = √ 1 – R2
= √ 1 – 0,7012
= √ 1 – 0,491
= √ 0,508
Coefficientsa
.000 .051 .000 1.000 -.101 .101
.295 .077 .295 3.830 .000 .142 .447 .729 .342 .196 .443 2.257
.170 .082 .170 2.073 .040 .008 .333 .717 .193 .106 .389 2.574
.472 .077 .472 6.141 .000 .320 .624 .788 .504 .315 .445 2.248
(Constant)
Keadilan Distributif
Keadilan Prosedural
Keadilan interaksionnal
Model
1
B Std. Error
Unstandardized
Coeff icients
Beta
Standardized
Coeff icients
t Sig. Lower Bound Upper Bound
95% Conf idence Interv al for B
Zero-order Part ial Part
Correlations
Tolerance VIF
Collinearity Statistics
Dependent Variable: Kepuasana.
298
= 0,712
Table 3
Regression analysis substructure 2
Substructure 2
Y2 = β4Y1 + e2 ………………………………………………………………….(2)
Y2 = 0,788 Y1 + e2
F hitung = 185,276
R2
= 0,621
Error Term (e1) = √ 1 – R2
= √ 1 – 0,6212
= √ 1 – 0,386
= √ 0,614
= 0,784
The next step in the analysis is the examination of the validity of the model lines. The legitimacy of
a result of analysis is met or not depends on the underlying assumptions. There are two indicators
of the validity of the model in which path analysis coefficient of determination of total and theory
trimming. The coefficient of determination total is the total diversity of the data. To calculate the
total coefficient of determination can be used the following equation:
R2m = 1-(e1)
2(e2)
2…………………………………………(3)
R2m = 1-(0,712)
2(0,784)
2
R2m = 1-(0,507)(0,615)
R2m = 0,688
Based on the calculation coefficient obtained total value of ( R2m = 0.688 ). This means that the
diversity of data that can be explained by the model is equal to 68.80 %, or in other words the
variation of the value contained in the data can explain the models used by 68.80 %. While the
remaining 31.20 % is explained by other variables that are not used in the model and error.
DISCUSSION
EFFECT OF DISTRIBUTIVE JUSTICE ON JOB SATISFACTION
The result showed that distributive justice significant positive effect on job satisfaction.
This means distributive justice as measured by remuneration corresponding to the work done,
remuneration in accordance with the stated eligibility, reflecting the contribution of the
organization, and performance-based rewards are proven to increase job satisfaction.
Coefficientsa
.000 .058 .000 1.000 -.114 .114
.788 .058 .788 13.612 .000 .673 .903 .788 .788 .788 1.000 1.000
(Constant)
Kepuasan
Model
1
B Std. Error
Unstandardized
Coeff icients
Beta
Standardized
Coeff icients
t Sig. Lower Bound Upper Bound
95% Conf idence Interv al for B
Zero-order Part ial Part
Correlations
Tolerance VIF
Collinearity Statistics
Dependent Variable: Komitmena.
299
These findings can be interpreted that the benefits in accordance with the resulting
performance, remuneration in accordance with the level of employment, remuneration reflects the
effort exerted, and the benefits granted in accordance with a contribution to the organization is able
to contribute significantly to an increase in job satisfaction PNTL members. Thus the procedural
fairness perceived by members of the PNTL proved capable of providing a sense of satisfaction
with the work, satisfied with the involvement of co-workers.
The results are consistent with the results of several studies that have been done by some
previous researchers that distributive justice significant positive effect on job satisfaction. Research
Mc.Farlin and Sweeney (1992) on the banking industry find distributive justice is a strong predictor
than procedural justice in influencing job satisfaction. Similarly, research Cohen and Spector
(2001) revealed distributive justice is a stronger predictor than procedural justice and interactional.
Another study which found significant effect of distributive justice on job satisfaction among
others carried out by Nadiri and Tanova (2010), McAuliffe et al. (2009) on health personnel,
Zainalipour et al. (2010), and Dundar and Tabancali (2012) in primary school teachers.
EFFECT OF PROCEDURAL JUSTICE ON JOB SATISFACTION
The analysis also showed that procedural fairness significant positive effect on job
satisfaction. This means that procedural fairness is measured among others by: the opportunity
given to express a view, the same treatment to all members, decisions are made based on accurate
information proven to increase job satisfaction PNTL staff. These findings can be explained that
the rules of the PNTL made based on information that is accurate, reflecting the PNTL regulations
uphold moral and ethical standards, and decisions are made based on accurate information able to
make an important contribution in improving job satisfaction PNTL members. Thus distributive
justice felt by the members of the PNTL proved capable of providing a sense of satisfaction with
the work, satisfied with the involvement of colleagues and satisfied with the opportunity to
progress and develop themselves.
The findings are consistent with studies that have been conducted by several researchers
such as; Masterson et al. (2000) and Lambert (2007) which concluded that procedural fairness is to
build a strong predictor of job satisfaction. The better the perceived procedural justice, then the
feelings of employees towards work will increase. Results of the study which concluded a
significant positive effect of procedural justice is done among others by: Cohen and Spector
(2001), Nadiri and Tanova (2010), McAuliffe et al. (2009), Zainalipour et al. (2010), Dundar and
Tabancali (2012).
EFFECT OF INTERACTIONAL JUSTICE ON JOB SATISFACTION
The result showed that interactional fairness significant positive effect on job
satisfaction. This means that interactional justice as measured by: the boss treats in a way that is
polite and respectful, boss explain the rules / procedures thoroughly and reasonable, and the boss
refrained from commenting inappropriate proven to increase job satisfaction PNTL staff.
These findings can be explained that the boss who is able to explain the rules / procedures overall,
tops explanations related to regulations / procedures are reasonable, and the boss who treats
subordinates with courtesy and honest communication is able to make an important contribution in
the form of job satisfaction PNTL members. Thus interactional justice felt by the members of the
PNTL proved capable of providing a sense of satisfaction with the work, satisfied with the
involvement of colleagues and satisfied with the opportunity to progress and develop themselves.
300
The results are consistent with research Masterson et al. (2000) which states that
interactional fairness significant effect on job satisfaction. Some other research results by: Cohen-
Carash and Spector (2001), Nadiri and Tanova (2010), McAuliffe et al. (2009), Zainalipour et al.
(2010), and Dundar and Tabancali (2012), concluded that interactional fairness significantly
positive effect on job satisfaction.
EFFECT OF JOB SATISFACTION ON ORGANASISIONAL COMMITMENT.
The result showed that job satisfaction is significant positive effect on organizational
commitment. This means that job satisfaction is measured by: the satisfaction of their salary,
supervision, self-development, and satisfaction of the interaction is done within the organization
proved to increase organizational commitment PNTL staff. These findings can be explained that
satisfaction with work, satisfied with the involvement of colleagues and satisfied with the
opportunity to progress and develop themselves able to make an important contribution in shaping
the organizational commitment PNTL members. Thus job satisfaction felt by the members of the
PNTL proved capable of contributing positively to their commitment to the organization.
The results are consistent with research conducted Azeem (2010) and a Nagar, (2012),
that job satisfaction as a significant predictor of organizational commitment. Humborstad research
and Perry, (2011), De Gieter, et al, (2011) that employees are satisfied with their superiors, co-
workers, compensation, job, and advancement opportunities may increase organizational
commitment. Ho et al. (2009), Humborstad and Perry, (2011), concluded job satisfaction and
significant positive effect on organizational commitment. Similarly, research: Cheung and Wu
(2012), Yang (2012), Bowling and Hammond (2008).
CONCLUSION
Based on the problems, objectives and hypotheses of the study and the results of the
analysis that has been done before conclusions can be drawn as follows. Distributive justice have a
significant positive effect on job satisfaction on PNTL staff. This means that the better
implementation of distributive justice in the PNTL, will increase job satisfaction the PNTL staff.
Procedural justice have a significant positive effect on job satisfaction. Means that the sense of
justice felt by the employees associated with the provision of allocation to employees in procedures
in the decision-making process can improve job satisfaction of PNTL staff. Interactional justice
significant positive effect on job satisfaction. This means that the value of justice felt by employees
due to the process of interaction with others in the organization of leaders and co-workers will
increase job satisfaction of PNTL staff. Job satisfaction have a significant positive effect on
organizational commitment. This means that the higher level of job satisfaction will increase
organizational commitment of the PNTL staff.
RESEARCH IMPLICATIONS
The results of this study are expected to enrich some previous research results related to the effect
of organizational justice (distributive justice, procedural, and interactional) on job satisfaction and
organizational commitment. In addition, this study has provided evidence of a consistent
relationship between variables were analyzed. This study empirically proved that organizational
justice significant positive effect on job satisfaction. The analysis showed that, although the PNTL
staff perceive that they have not gotten a good distributive justice, but overall procedural fairness
301
and justice interactional able to provide a valuable contribution in building the satisfaction of the
staff of PNTL. Therefore PNTL should begin an evaluation of policies related to the
implementation of organizational justice so that the PNTL staff feel part of the organization.
National Police of East Timor (PNTL) evaluating the reward system has been implemented in view
of the PNTL staff feel that they are not satisfied with the reward received today. Reward system
eventually leads to the question whether a performance-based reward so that employees get the
reward according to the workload carried. With performance-based reward system is expected to
build organizational commitment PNTL staff so that they become more emotionally attached to the
PNTL.
REFERENCE LIST
Al-Zu’bi, H.A., 2010. A Study Of Relationship Between Organizational Justice And Job
Satisfaction. International Journal of Business and Management, Vol. 5, No. 12, p. 102 – 109.
Azeem, Syed Mohammad. 2010. Job Satisfaction and Organizational Commitment Among
Employees in the Sultanate of Oman. Journal of Psychology, Vol.1, No. 1, pg 295-299.
Antoncic, J.A., & Antoncic, B., 2011. Employee Satisfaction Intrapreneurship And Firm Growth :
A Model. Industrial Management And Data Systems, Vol. 111, No. 4, p. 589 – 607.
Ambrose, M.L., & Arnaud, A., 2005. Are Procedural Justice And Distributive Justice Conceptually
Distinct ?, Handbook Of Organizational Justice. Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, Inc.
Aquino, K., Lewis, M.U., & Bradfield, M., 1999. Justice Construct, Negative Affectivity, &
Employee Deviance : A Proposes Model & Empirical Test. Journal Of Organizational
Behavior, Vol. 20, p. 1073 – 1091.
Bakhshi, A., Kumar, K., & Rani, E., 2009. Organizational Justice Perceptions As Predictor Of Job
Satisfaction And Organization Commitment. International Journal Of Business And
Management, Vol. 4, No. 9, p. 145-154.
Bowling, N. A. & Hammond, G. D., 2008.A Meta-Analytic Examination Of The Construct
Validity Of The Michigan Organizational Assessment Questionnaire Job Satisfaction Subscale.
Journal of Vocational Behavior, No. 73, p. 63 – 77.
Cheung, M. F. Y. & Wu, W-P, 2012.Leader-Member Exchange & Employee Work Outcomes In
Chinese Firms: The Mediating Role Of Job Satisfaction. Asia Pacific Business Review, Vol. 18,
No. 1, p. 65 – 81.
Clay-Warner, J., Reynolds, J., & Roman, P., 2005. Organizational Justice And Job Satisfaction: A
Test of Three Competing Models. Social Justice Research, Vol. 18, No. 4, p. 391 – 409.
Cohen-Carash, Y., & Spector, P.E., 2001.The Role of Justice in Organizations :A Meta-Analysis.
Journal Of Organizational Behavior and Human Decision Processes, Vol. 86 No. 2, p. 278 –
321.
Colquitt, J.A., & Shaw, J.C., 2005. How Should Organizational Justice Be Measured ?, Handbook
Of Organizational Justice. Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, Inc.
Colquitt, J.A., 2001. On The Dimensionality Of Organizational Justice : A Construct Validation Of
Measure. Journal Of Applied Psychology, Vol. 86, No. 3, p. 386 – 400.
Colquitt, J.A., Wesson, M.J., Porter, C.O.L.H., Conlon, D.E., &Ng, K.Y., 2001. Justice At The
Millenium : A Meta-Analytic Review Of 25 Years Of Organizational Justice Research. Journal
Of Applied Psychology, Vol. 86, No. 3, p. 425 – 445.
302
Coomber, B. & Barriball, K. L., 2007. Impact Of Job Satisfaction Components On Intent To Leave
& Turnover For Hospital-Based Nurses: A Review Of The Research Literature. International
Journal of Nursing Studies, No. 44, p. 297 – 314.
Cropanzano, R., & Greenberg, J., 1997. Progress In Organizational Justice : Tunneling Through
The Maze. International Review Of Industrial & Organizational Psychology. New York : John
Wiley & Sons.
Cropanzano, R., Byrne, Z.S., Bobocel, D.R., & Rupp, D.E., 2001. Moral Virtues, Fairness
Heuristics, Social Entities, & Other Denizens of Organizational Justice.Journal Of Vocational
BehaviorVol. 58, 2001, p. 164 – 209.
Cropanzano, R., Bowen, D.E., & Gilliland, S.W., 2007. The Management Of Organizational
Justice. Academy Of Management Perspectives.
Dailey, R.C. & Kirk, D.J., 1992. Distributive & Procedural Justice As Antecedents Of Job
Dissatisfaction & Intent To Turnover. Human Relations, Vol. 45, No. 3, p. 305 – 317.
De Gieter, S., Hofmans, J., & Pepermans, R., 2011.Revisiting The Impact Of Job Satisfaction &
Organizational Commitment On Nurse Turnover Intention: An Individual Differences
Analysis. International Journal of Nursing Studies, No. 48, p. 1562–1569.
Dundar, T. & Tabancali, E., 2012.The Relationship Between Organizational Justice Perceptions &
Job Satisfaction Levels. Procedia - Social and Behavioral Sciences, No.46, p. 5777 – 5781.
Elamin, A.M., & Alomaim, N., 2011. Does Organizational Justice Influence Job Satisfaction And
Self-Perceived Performance In Saudi Arabia Work Environment ? International Management
Review, Vol. 7, No.1, p. 38-49.
Greenberg, J., 1987. A Taxonomy Of Organizational Justice Theories. Academy Of Management
Review, Vol. 12, No. 1, p. 9 – 22.
Greenberg, J., 1990. Organizational Justice: Yesterday, Today, And Tommorow. Journal Of
Management, Vol. 16, No. 2, p. 399 – 432.
Ho, W-H, Chang, C. S., Shih, Y-L., & Liang, R-D, 2009. Effects Of Job Rotation & Role Stress
Among Nurses On Job Satisfaction & Organizational Commitment. BMC Health Services
Research 2009, No. 9, p. 1 – 10.
Humborstad, S.I.W., & Perry, C., 2011. Employee Empowerment, Job Satisfaction, And
Organizational Commitment: An In-Depth Empirical Investigation. Chinese Management
Studies, Vol. 5, No. 3, p. 325 – 344.
Kim, W. G., Leong, J. K., Lee, Y-K., 2005. Effect Of Service Orientation On Job Satisfaction,
Organizational Commitment, & Intention Of Leaving In A Casual Dining Chain Restaurant.
Hospitality Management No. 24, p. 171–193.
Koh, Hian Chye dan El’fred H.Y. Boo. 2004. Organizational Ethics and Employee Satisfaction and
Commitment. Management Decision, Vol.42, No.4, pg 677-693.
Kim, W.G. & Brymer, R. A., 2011. The Effects Of Ethical Leadership On Manager Job
Satisfaction, Commitment, Behavioral outcomes, & Firm Performance. International Journal
of Hospitality Management No. 30, p. 1020– 1026.
Maier, C., Laumer, S., Eckhardt, A., & Weitzel, T., 2012. Analyzing The Impact Of HRIS
Implementations On HR Personnel’s Job Satisfaction & Turnover Intention. Journal of
Strategic Information Systems, No. XXX, p. 1 – 15.
Masterson, S.S., Lewis,K., Goldman, B.M., & Taylor, M.S., 2000. Integrating Justice & Social
Exchange : The Differing Effects Of Fair Procedures & Treatment On Work Relationships.
Academy Of Management Journal, Vol. 43, No. 4, p. 738 – 748.
303
McAuliffe, E., Manafa, O., Maseko, F., Bowie, C., & White, E., 2009. Understanding Job
Satisfaction AmongstMid-Level Cadres In Malawi: The Contribution Of Organisational
Justice. Reproductive Health Matters, Vol. 17, No. 33, p. 80 – 90.
McFarlin, D.B. & Sweeney, P.D., 1992.Distributive & Procedural Justice As Predictors Of
Satisfaction With Personal & Organizational Outcomes. Academy Of Management Journal,
Vol. 35, No. 3, p. 626 – 637.
Memarzadeh, G. & Mahmoudi, R.K., 2010. Applying Organizational Concepts In The Iran Public
Sector: A Preliminary Empirical Work On Justice. European Journal Of Social Sciences, Vol.
14, No. 4, p. 594 – 605.
Meyer, J.P., & Allen, N.J., 1991. A Three – Component Conceptualization Of Organizational
Commitment. Human Resource Management Review, Vol. 1, No. 1, p. 61 – 89.
Meyer, J.P., Allen, N.J., & Smith, C.A., 1993. Commitment &Occupations : Extension & Test Of
A Three-Components Conceptualization. Journal Of Applied Psychology, Vol. 78, No. 4, p.
538 – 552.
Meyer, J.P., Stanley, D.J., Herscovitch, L., & Topolnytsky, L., 2002. Affective, Continuance, &
Normative Commitment To The Organization : A Meta-analysis Of Antecedents, Correlates, &
Consequences. Journal Of Vocational Behavior No. 61, p. 20–52.
Nadiri, H. & Tanova, C., 2010. An Investigation Of The Role Of Justice In Turnover Intentions,
Job satisfaction, & Organizational Citizenship Behavior In Hospitality Industry. International
Journal of Hospitality Management, No. 29, p. 33 – 41.
Nagar, K., 2012. Organizational Commitment & Job Satisfaction Among Teachers During Times
Of Burnout. The Journal for Decision Makers, Vol. 37, No. 2, p. 43 – 60.
Noe, R.A., Hollenbeck, J.R., Gerhart, B., & Wright, P.M., 2011. Manajemen Sumber Daya
Manusia: Mencapai Keunggulan Bersaing, Edisi 6. Penerbit Salemba Empat.
Odom, R.Y., Boxx, W.R., & Dunn, M.G., 1990. Organizational Cultures, Commitment,
Satisfaction, & Cohesion. Public Productivity & Management Review, Vol. 14, No. 2, p. 157 -
169.
Robbins, S.P., & Judge, T.A., (2008). Perilaku Organisasi, Edisi 2. Penerbit Salemba Empat.
Samad, 2006. Predicting organizational justice: The case of Malaysian Government Doctors, The
Juornal of American Academy of Business Cambridge. Vol.8 No. 2 Maret.
Samad, Sarminah, 2006, “Procedural and Distributif Justice: Differential Effects on
Employees’ Work Outcomes”, The Business Review, Cambridge, Summer, 5 (2), 212-218.
Simamora, Henry. 2004. Manajemen Sumber Daya Manusia, Edisi Ketiga. Yogyakarta: Bagian
Penerbitan Sekolah Tinggi Ilmu Ekonomi YKPN.
Sugiarti, T., 2005, Reaksi Pekerja Terhadap Downsizing: Anteseden dan Konsekuensi dari
Keadilan Prosedural, Interpersonal dan Informasional. Makalah Simposium
Nasional Mahasiswa dan Alumni PascaSarjana Ilmu Ekonomi, dalam acara Dies Natalis 25
Program Magister Sains Dan Doktor Ilmu Ekonomi Universitas Gadjah Mada Yogyakarta.
Tjahjono, Heru, 2007, Keadilan Distributif dan Keadilan Prosedural Dinilai Adil Bagi Sebagian
Karyawan, Universitas Gadjah Mada, 2010
Thibaut, J. & Walker, L., 1978. A Theory Of Procedure. California Law Review, Vol. 66, Issue 3,
p. 541 – 566.
Whisenant, W., & Smucker, S., 2006. Organizational Justice And Job Satisfaction : Perceptions
Among Coaches Of Girls’ Teams. Journal Of Research, Vol. 2, Issue 2, p. 47 – 53.
304
Yang, J-T., 2010. Antecedents & Consequences Of Job Satisfaction In The Hotel Industry.
International Journal Of Hospitality Management, No., p. 29 609–619.
Yang, M-L, 2012.Transformational Leadership & Taiwanese Public Relations Practitioners’ Job
Satisfaction & Organizational Commitment.Social Behavior & Personality, Vol. 40, No. 1, p.
31 – 46.
Zainalipour, H., Fini, A.A.S., & Mirkamali, S. M., 2010. A Study Of Relationship Between
Organizational Justice & Job Satisfaction Among Teachers In Bandar Abbas Middle School.
Procedia - Social and Behavioral Sciences,
305
DATA ENVELOPMENT ANALYSIS METHOD TO ESTIMATE STOCK RETURN
IN BANKING FIRMS
Joni Devitra
STIKOM Dinamika Bangsa, Jambi, Indonesia
devitrajoni@yahoo.co.id
ABSTRACT
The development of the banking industry requires substantial funding source
coming from internal and external. Sources of external funding may come from investors
who invest their funds in banks listed on the stock exchange. The choice of investors to
invest in bank shares in the hope of maximum yield (return), either in the form of dividends
and capital gain from the increase in the price of shares held. For that investors need to
pay attention to the performance of the company and expectations of future stock
movement by way of analyzing the factors that affect the movement of the stock price of the
bank. One is the efficiency factor that is associated with the concept of output-input ratio.
Measurement of the efficiency of banking can be done with several approaches or methods,
one of which is the Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA), In this study conducted an analysis
of the bank efficiency connection to stock returns of banks in Indonesia Stock Exchange
during the period from 2009 to 2011 using Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA) method.
Hypothesis testing research using panel data analysis. The test results show the method of
DEA as an indicator of the bank efficiency affect stock returns are positive and significant.
The results are consistent with the hypothesis of the study and some previous research.
INTRODUCTION
The banking industry is increasingly developing into a very important sector in
supporting economic activity through its intermediary function is to channel funds from
those who have excess funds (surplus units) to the parties that need funds (deficit units).
The vital role of the banking sector needs to be supported by the source of substantial
funding from various sources, primarily sourced from external funding, one of which came
from the investors in investing their funds in banks listed on the stock exchange
Increasing number of banks that have gone public in the capital market provide
many options for investors to invest in bank shares in the hope of maximum yield (return),
either in the form of dividends and capital gain from the increase in the price of shares
held. For that investors need to pay attention to the performance of the company and
expectations of future stock movement by way of analyzing the factors that affect the
movement of the bank stock price.
That Factors influence the stock prices of banks can be grouped into two
classifications, are external factors and internal factors. External factors can be divided into
macro-economic variables and the banking industry-specific factors, while internal factors
can be divided into factors of financial performance and efficiency. Assess the bank's
performance with efficiency, it would be obvious if it is associated with the concept of
output-input ratio. Efficiency is the ability to produce maximum output with existing input.
306
Each organization is absolutely necessary to hold the principle of efficiency. Simply put
the principle of efficiency basically means avoiding any form of waste
At the time of measurement of efficiency is done, the banks faced with the
challenges of how to get optimal output level with an input level, or gain a certain level of
output with minimum input level. With it identifies the allocation of inputs and outputs,
can be analyzed further to see the causes of inefficiencies. For the measurement of the
efficiency of banking can be done with several approaches or methods, one of which is the
Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA) method.
DEA method is a technique of mathematical programming is used to evaluate the
relative efficiency of a set of Decision Making Units (DMUs) in managing resources
(input) with the same type so that it becomes the result (output) of the same type as well,
where relationships form the function from input to output is unknown. The term DMU in
DEA method can be various units, and in this study are the banks listed on the Indonesia
Stock Exchange during the period 2009-2011
Research on the bank efficiency as measured by the method of DEA (Data
Envelopment Analysis) in estimating the return has been done by Gue and Yue (2010),
which examined the banks listed on the Chinese stock exchanges. Another study was also
conducted by Aftab, et al (2008) on the banks in the Karachi Stock Exchange. While this
study analyzed the bank efficiency connection with stock returns of banks in Indonesia
Stock Exchange during the period 2009-2011 using Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA)
method.
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK
1. Bank Efficiency
Efficiency is defined as the ratio between output to input, or the amount generated
from one input used. A company can be said to be efficient when using the number
of units fewer than the number of input units used other companies to produce the same
output, or use the same input units, can produce a greater of output. (Permono, 2000).
In economic theory, the efficiency of distinguished on technical efficiency and
economic efficiency. Economic efficiency has a macro point of view that the broader scope
than technical efficiency. In financial institutions, there are four factors that lead to
efficiency. The main factor is the efficiency due to arbitrage information, both efficiency
because accuracy assessment its assets, the third is the efficiency due to the financial
institution is able to anticipate the risks that arise, and the fourth is functional efficiency,
which is related to the administration and mechanisms of payments made by a financial
institution, Included in the functional efficiency is risk pooling, general insurance,
administration, and the mobilization of public funds. (Atmawardhana, 2006
Bank efficiency is one of the important indicators to analyze the performance of a
bank and also as a means to further enhance the effectiveness of monetary policy.
Efficiency can be seen from two sides, namely are cost efficiency and profit efficiency,
which consists of the Standard Alternative profit efficiency and profit efficiency (Berger
and Mester in Astiyah and Husman, 2006). Cost Efficiency basically measure the level of
the cost of a bank as compared with a bank that has the best operating costs that produce
the same output with the same technology. While the Standard Profit Efficiency basically
measure the efficiency of a bank based on the bank's ability to generate maximum profit at
a certain price level of output compared to the bank operating profit level best in the
sample. This model is often associated with a condition of a perfectly competitive market
where prices of inputs and outputs is determined by the market. Alternative profit
307
efficiency occurs in imperfectly competitive market. At these market conditions, the bank
is assumed to have market power in setting the price of output, but not at the price of
inputs. Because different types of markets, the most notable difference between the two
models (standard profit efficiency and alternative profit efficiency) is the determination of
the exogenous variables in the attainment of maximum profit.
In the measurement of efficiency, can be done by two methods, namely the method
of parametric and non-parametric methods. Parametric approach is a measurement by
using econometric stochastic and seeks to eliminate the interference of influence of
inefficiency. Meanwhile, nonparametric linear programming approach is a measurement
without using a stochastic approach and it combines disruptions and inefficiencies that
exist. This measurement is built based on observation of the population and evaluate the
relative efficiency of the units observed
In the parametric approach, the methods used in the measurement of efficiency is
the Stochastic Frontier Approach (SFA), which assumes that the inefficiency follow a
normal distribution asymmetrical half, while the random fluctuations follow a normal
distribution symmetrical. Results efficiency is very dependent on the slope of the
distribution of the data, wherein if the distribution component of efficiency are more or
less distributed symmetrically will have a tendency to be measured as a random error, and
the distribution of the random component of error that is more or less distributed
asymmetrically would tend to be measured as an in-efficiency , Then the method Thick
Frontier Approach (TFA), which assumes that the deviation of the estimated cost with the
lowest average kuatil of banks that represents random error. In addition to the deviation of
the estimated costs between the lowest quartile representing the highest in-efficiency. The
following methods are Distribution-Free Approach (DFA), which assumes that the
difference in efficiency is stable for all times for an average of random error is not
included. A function of cost or estimated profit for each period in a panel data set. Residual
for each separate regression formed by inefficiency and random error. Since the random
error component is assumed to average the time span, the average residual bank of all the
regression is an estimate of the inefficiency of bank
While the non-parametric approach, the methods used in the measurement of
efficiency is the Free Disposal Hull (FDH) as a special case of the DEA model, in which
the points on the lines corresponding peak was not included in the DEA frontier. Therefore
frontier FDH is another form of the same with or inside the DEA frontier. FDH will
typically wider age in estimating the average efficiency of the DEA (Tulkens et al, 1995).
The second method is the Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA), which is a technique of
mathematical programming is used to evaluate the relative efficiency of a set of units of
decision makers or Decision Making Units (DMUs) in managing resources (input) of the
same type to be results (output) of the same type as well, where relationships form the
function from input to output is unknown. The term DMU in DEA method can be various
units, a case of banks, hospitals, shops, and any that have similar operational
characteristics (Siswadi and Purwantoro, 2006)
2. Data Envelopment Analysis Method
DEA method is a non-parametric frontier method that uses linear programming
models to calculate the ratio of output and input for all the units are compared in a
population. The purpose of the DEA method is to measure the efficiency of decision-
making unit (DMU) relative to similar bank when all these units are at or below the
308
"curve" of its efficient frontier. So this method is used to evaluate the relative efficiency of
several objects (benchmarking performance).
DEA approach is more emphasis on the task-oriented approach and focus on the
important task, namely to evaluate the performance of DMU. The analysis is based on the
evaluation of the relative efficiency of DMU comparable. Furthermore, an efficient DMU
will form the frontier line. If the DMU is at the frontier lines, the DMU can be said to be
efficient DMU relative to others in its peer group. In addition to generating the value of the
efficiency of each DMU, DEA also shows the units that serve as a reference for units that
are not efficient. Some of the excess DEA approach are :
- DEA method is a procedure that is designed specifically to measure the relative
efficiency of a DMU that use a lot of input and output so it can produce a score or
value.
- DEA method does not require the assumption of a functional relationship between
input and output variables.
- DMU (decision making unit) can be compared directly with each other.
- The unit of measuring inputs and outputs can be different
While the DEA limitations include :
- DEA method requires all inputs and outputs must be specific and measurable.
Mistakes in entering input and output will provide the results of refraction
measurement.
- The values resulting from the DEA is a relative value instead of absolute values.
- Statistical hypothesis testing and the results of DEA difficult.
- Using linear programming formulation separately for each DMU
- Weight of input and output produced by the DEA can not be interpreted in economic
value, although coefficient have the same mathematical formulation.
- Highly sensitive to extreme observations. The assumption used is no random error.
- One outlier can significantly affect the calculation of the efficiency of each company
3. Stock Return
Stock is a securities issued by a limited liability company (issuer) which states that
the owner of these shares is also part-owner of the company. Husnan (2009) mentions that
the securities (stocks) is a piece of paper that shows the investor the right (ie the party who
has the paper) to acquire part of the prospect or organization that publishes a wealth of
such securities and the conditions that allow the investor to run right. The stock is divided
into two types, namely ordinary shares and preference shares. Preferred stock in some
ways similar to bonds, preferred stock dividends paid as akin to interest payments of bonds
with a fixed amount and generally must be paid in advance before the payment of common
stock dividends (Weston and Brigham, 2005).
On the stock exchange, the stock traded at a certain price level. Stock prices will
always fluctuate from time to time. Stock prices are determined through the process of
supply and demand on the secondary market. Price is formed in accordance with the price
of the auction, the bidding process is based on price priority and time priority (Husnan,
2009). Consideration of investors to invest will influenced by the availability of
information that can be used in the assessment of an investment. Even in estimating and
assessing securities (stock), investors pay attention to the market situation, however, the
company's performance becomes an important factor to note investors who can reflect the
309
degree of effectiveness of the management of the company with the aim of maximizing the
welfare of stockholders (Weston and Brigham, 2005).
In general, the better the financial companies and the more benefits enjoyed by
shareholders, the possibility of stock prices will rise, which also resulted in an increase in
stock returns are concerned. Stock return is the rate advantage enjoyed by investors on a
stock investment does. (Angbazo, 1997). Meanwhile, according to Hanafi and Halim
(2009), the return is defined as the change in value between the period t + 1 in period t plus
other earnings that occurred during the period t. Stock return is also a variable that arises
from changes in stock prices as a result of the reaction of the market due to the delivery of
an entity's financial information to the capital markets. According to Jones (2009), the
return is the yield and capital gain (loss). (1) Yield, that cash flow is paid on a periodic
basis to shareholders (in the form of dividends), (2) Capital gain (loss), namely the
difference between the stock price at the time of purchase and the stock price at the time of
sale. This is reinforced by Corrado and Jordan (2008) which states that the return from
investment security is cash flow and capital gain/ loss
From above definition, the return on a stock consisting of capital gains (losses) and
dividend yield. Dividend yield is the distribution of net income to shareholders of the
enterprise that was decided by the general meeting of shareholders which was decided by
the general meeting of shareholders. While the capital gain (loss) represents the difference
between the purchase value of shares with the stock sales. Revenue derived from capital
gain due to stock price is greater than the purchase price. Capital gains occur if market
prices were assessed now higher than its cost. While the capital loss is a shareholders
losses because its sold at lower price than the purchase price
Hartono (2009), distinguishes the concept of stock returns into two groups: a single
return and portfolio return. Single return is the return earned on an investment in the form
of realization of return and return expectations. Return realization is a return that is
calculated based on historical data and serves as a measure of corporate performance.
Historical returns are also useful as a basis for determining the expected return in the
future. Return expectations are expected to earn a return that an investment in the future.
Return realization used in this study is the capital gain/ loss is also often called the actual
return
In this study the definition of the stock return is equal to capital gains, because
there is no distribution of dividends. Return of shares is a change in the stock price will be
used as the dependent variable in this study, is calculated by adding the change in price of
a stock on a daily basis during the period of observation.
According Adenso (1997) the performance of a stock can be used as one way to
gauge the efficiency of the company. If the stock prices reflect all information regarding
the company's past, present and future, the increase in stock prices can be considered as an
indication of an efficient company. But stocks that have a good level of profits may also
experience a decrease in price. This may be caused by the state of the stock market. Things
like this will not be lost if investor confidence has not recovered, the economic situation
has not improved or other things are improving. One risk of shareholders is declining stock
prices.
RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
In this research will be focused on bank efficiency analysis using Data
Envelopment Analysis (DEA) to estimate the stock return. Object of research are bank’s
310
listed in Indonesia Stock Exchange for the period of three years between 2009 to 2011. For
the analysis of the bank efficiency will be sourced from the bank's financial statement
(secondary data) issued by each bank and obtained by Bank Indonesia. Analysis of the data
will be examined by statistical tools consist of :
1. Descriptive statistics
Descriptive statistics will provide an overview on the characteristics of the studied
sample bank, the bank category, the value of the input-output bank. The output of this
descriptive statistics such as average value, maximum-minimum value, standard
deviation value and that distribution.
2. Hypothesis Test
Hypothesis test conducted using panel data which is a combination of time series data
and cross section data. The hypothesis in this study are:
- H0 : β7 = 0, DEA has not influence on stock returns of banks
- Ha : β7 ≠ 0, DEA has influence on stock returns of banks
RESULT OF STUDY
1. Description of Data Statistics
Description of statistical data comprise the mean, median, maximum, minimum,
standard deviation, skewness, kurtosis and Jarque-Berra statistic and p-value. Value of
mean, median, maximum, and minimum for each variable used in study have different
numbers, but the highest rate of variables is a variable return. The standard deviation to
measure the dispersion or dissemination of the data shows that the numbers fluctuate. The
standard deviation value experienced by the variable stock return that is equal to 1.358341,
which means that the variable stock returns have a higher risk level than the variable Data
Envelopment Analysis (DEA). It also shows that the share price according to their
characteristics are always changing very volatile, resulting in bank stock returns can have a
capital gain or capital loss.
Skewness is a measure of the asymmetry of dissemination of statistical data around
the average (mean). Skewness of a symmetrical distribution (normal distribution) is zero.
Positive skewness indicates that the distribution of the data has a long tail on the right side
(long right tail) and negative skewness has a long tail on the left side (long left tail). For all
variables (Return and DEA) has a negative value. Kurtosis measures the height of a
distribution. Kurtosis of a normal distribution of data is 3. When kurtosis exceeds 3, the
data distribution is said leptokurtis to normal. When kurtosis less than 3, the distribution of
flat data (platykurtic) compared with the normal distribution of data. All variables has a
kurtosis value of less than 3.
Jarque-Bera (JB) is a statistical test to determine whether the data used in the study
are normally distributed. This test measures the difference skewness and kurtosis data and
compared with the data if it is normal. With H0 the normal distribution of data, JB test
distributed with degrees of freedom of 2. Probability indicates the likelihood JB value
exceeds (in absolute value), value observed under the null hypothesis. The statistical
results showed that the Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA) which applicate the regression
model of panel data during the period of 2009-2011. concluded that α = 5%, which means
that H0 is accepted and the normally distribution of data.
2
311
Table. 1
RETURN? DEA?
Mean 6.732805 0.944362
Median 6.796184 0.984050
Maximum 8.987197 1.000000
Minimum 4.330733 0.785400
Std. Dev. 1.358341 0.068167
Skewness -0.117985 -0.867812
Kurtosis 1.888161 2.379123
Jarque-Bera 3.552638 9.344176
Probability 0.169260 0.009353
Sum 444.3652 62.32790
Sum Sq. Dev. 119.9309 0.302042
Observations 66 66
Cross sections 22 22
Source: Data processed
2. Estimate Result of Data Panel Regression Model
Panel data regression model used in this research is based on three models, namely
common effect, fixed effect and random effect, with test results are :
a. Common Effect Model
Common effect model is a model that does not see the difference between
time and individuals. It is assumed that the behavior of data between companies
together in some period (Widarjono, 2007). Means panel data regression models were
estimated assuming that both the intercept and slope coefficient equal over time and
the company. Estimation of panel data regression model showed the value of common
effect Prob (F-statistic) of 0.2562. As for testing goodnes of fit, demonstrate the value
of the coefficient of determination R2 = 0.0201 and the coefficient of determination
adjusted R2 = 0.0048:
b. Fixed Effect Model
Fixed effect model assumes that the intercept is different between companies
while slopenya remained the same between the companies. The existence of the
variables that are not all included in the model equations allow for the intercept are
312
not constant (Nachrowi, 2006). In other words, the intercept may be changed for each
individual and time. Estimation of panel data regression with fixed effect model
showed the value of Prob (F-statistic) of 0.390032. As for testing goodnes of fit,
demonstrate the value of the coefficient of determination R2 = 0.3587 and the
coefficient of determination adjusted R2 = 0.0305
c. Randon Effect Model
In random effects models, differences characteristics of individual and time to
be accommodated in the error of the model. The error variable consists of two
components, namely the error variable of the same individual in different periods
correlated. Because of the assumption that this model can not be used to obtain an
efficient estimator. Estimation of panel data regression with random effects models
showed the value of Prob (F-statistic) of 0.2575. As for testing goodnes of fit,
demonstrate the value of the coefficient of determination R2 = 0.0200 and the
coefficient of determination adjusted R2 = 0.0047
d. Model Summary
Table 2 shows the summary of the estimated results of panel data regression
model. To choose which model is best for further analysis to estimate using
terminated coefficient criteria R2 and adjusted terminated coefficient R
2. Based on the
calculation results, concluding that the fixed effect model is better than the other panel
data regression model. From this conclusion, it will be fixed effect model was used to
estimate the influence of bank efficiency variable with Data Envelopment Analysis
(DEA) to stock return of bank listed on the Indonesia Stock Exchange during the
period of 2009-2011.
Table 2
No Model R-
Squared
Adjusted
R-Squared
F-
statistic
Prob (F-
statistic)
α = 0,01
Probabilitas
α = 0,05
1 Common
Effect 0.0201 0.0048 1.3127 0.2562
not
significant
2 Fixed
Effect 0.3587 0.0305 1.0930 0.3900
not
significant
3 Random
Effect 0.0200 0.0047 1.3051 0.2575
not
significant Source: Data processed
3. Estimate Analysis of Data Panel Regression Model
Based on estimates that the best use of criteria coefficient terminated R2 and
adjusted coefficient terminated R2, the data panel regression model is used to estimate the
influence of variable bank efficiency using Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA) on stock
returns in this study is a fixed effect model. Fixed effect model applied in this study is a
model that eliminates the problem of heteroscedasticity by using residual constants in
white-heteroskedasticity, while the autocorrelation problem is not required under the fixed
effect model to test so the test of autocorrelation can be ignored (Nachrowi, 2006).
The estimation results of data panel regression using a fixed effect model with
white-heteroskedasticity shown in Table 3. The test results showed that the variables of
bank efficiency as measured by the non-parametric approach Data Envelopment Analysis
(DEA) with a regression coefficient β1 = 1.1133, influence stock returns of bank are
positive and significant at a confidence level of 95 percent, with a probability value of t-
313
statistic (0.0417) is smaller than α = 0.05, which means that H0 is rejected. Interpretation
β1 = 1.1133 is any increase in DEA efficiency of 10 percent, the bank stock returns will be
increased by 11.13 percent. This empirical findings are consistent with the research
hypothesis which states that the variable bank efficiency as measured by the method of
Data Envelopment Analysis (DEA) positive effect on stock returns of banks listed on the
Indonesia Stock Exchange during the period of 2009-2011.
Estimation of data panel regression model with fixed effect that eliminates the
problem of heteroscedasticity by using residual constants in white-heteroskedasticity
showed that the variables of Bank efficiency measured by DEA method influence bank
stocks return are significantly with the level of confidence 99 parsen. As for testing
goodnes of fit, demonstrate the value of the coefficient of determination R2 = 0.9773,
which means that the independent variables (DEA) could explain the variation ups and
downs of the stock return change is amounted to 97.73 percent. While the coefficient of
determination adjusted R2 = 0.9656 which means that after consideration degree of
freedom, the independent variables used in this study (DEA) could explain the variations
that occur in the stock returns of banks amounted to 96.56 percent.
Tabel 3.
Dependent Variable: RETURN?
Method: Pooled Least Squares
Date: 08/15/15 Time: 10:17
Sample: 2009 2011
Included observations: 3
Cross-sections included: 22
Total pool (balanced) observations: 66
White diagonal standard errors & covariance (d.f. corrected) Variable Coefficient Std. Error t-Statistic Prob. C 5.681412 0.502208 11.31287 0.0000
DEA? 1.113338 0.530427 2.098944 0.0417
Fixed Effects (Cross)
_BBCA--C -1.911040
_BABP--C 1.951245
_BBKP--C -0.428775
_BBNI--C 1.327512
_BBNP--C 0.442684
_BBRI--C 1.749449
_BDMN--C 1.668533
_BEKS--C -1.937796
_BKSW--C 0.063444
_BMRI--C 1.889308
_BNBA--C -1.741400
_BNGA--C 0.280827
_BNII--C -0.592500
_BNLI--C 0.392120
_BSWD--C -0.397820
_BVIC--C -1.778397
_INPC--C -2.217299
_MAYA--C 0.594313
_MEGA--C 1.389911
_NISP--C 0.384043
_PNBN--C 0.094681
_SDRA--C -1.223046 Effects Specification Cross-section fixed (dummy variables) R-squared 0.977260 Mean dependent var 6.732805
Adjusted R-squared 0.965625 S.D. dependent var 1.358341
S.E. of regression 0.251842 Akaike info criterion 0.348486
Sum squared resid 2.727249 Schwarz criterion 1.111547
Log likelihood 11.49998 Hannan-Quinn criter. 0.650007
314
315
4. Data Panel Regression Model for each Banks
Use of fixed effect model for data panel regression can show constant differences to
banks as sample in this study, although the same regressors coefficient. Fixed effects referred to
in this research is that each bank has remained constant magnitude for various periods of time.
Likewise, the regression coefficient, fixed the amount of time (time invariant). In regression
analysis of data panel by fixed effect model for each bank can be concluded :
- Banks that had average stock return biggest change during the period 2009-2011 is Bank
ICB Bumiputera Tbk, with total constant value of [Ci + 5,6814] = 1,9512 + 5,6814 = 7,6326.
- Banks that had average stock returns smallest change during the period 2007-2011 is Bank
Artha Graha Internasional Tbk, with total constant value [Ci + 5,6814] = -2,2173 + 5,6814 =
3,4641
Data envelopment analysis (DEA) method is a non-parametric technique that is used for
the measurement of bank efficiency that specifically define the use of many inputs (multiple
inputs) to produce many outputs (output multilpe). The purpose of DEA method is measuring
the relative efficiency of a bank to similar bank when these units are at or below the "curve" of
its efficient frontier. DEA efficiency value lies between 0 and 1, if DEA value nearby of 1 means
the bank's efficiency performance is getting better, otherwise DEA value close to 0 means that
the bank is increasingly inefficient. Bank with a better level of efficiency shows that the bank is
able to maximize output with inputs available, or is able to minimize input to a certain output
level
In this study were used as output variables in measuring the level of relative efficiency
DEA, are loans, and total revenue consists of: interest income and other operating income.
Meanwhile, the input variables are third party funds, interest expense, and other operating
expenses consist of cost of Human Resources and general and administrative expenses. The
empirical results of this study indicate that the DEA efficiency values are positive and significant
influence on stock returns of banks, meaning that if the bank's performance efficiency is getting
better (shown DEA value close to 1), then the bank stock returns increased. It also shows that the
bank is able to carry out their intermediation function optimally so that the positive impact on
stock prices.
Results of this study are consistent with previous research, including that conducted by
Gu and Yue (2011) which concluded that the change in the efficiency of the bank as measured
by the method of DEA significant and positive correlation with stock returns of banks listed on
the Chinese stock exchanges. This research is also consistent with the results of research
conducted by Aftab, et al (2008) on the banks in the Karachi Stock Exchange. Likewise the
results of research Ioannidis, et al (2008), which indicates a strong positive relationship between
changes in efficiency as measured by the method of DEA on stock returns of banks
CONCLUSION
This research, analyzing the effect of bank efficiency variable measured by data
envelopment analysis (DEA) method on stock returns of banks in Indonesia Stock Exchange
during period 2009 - 2011. The results of this study concluded that :
316
1. DEA Method as an indicator of bank efficiency, affecting bank stock returns is positively
and significantly. These empirical findings are consistent with the research hypothesis
which states that the variable efficiency of banks as measured by Data Envelopment
Analysis (DEA) method positive effect on stock returns of banks listed on the Indonesia
Stock Exchange.
2. Of all the banks in object of research, can concluded that Bank ICB Bumiputera, tbk is the
bank with the highest level of efficiency and Bank Artha Graha International, Tbk which is
the bank with the lowest level of efficiency as measured by data envelopment analysis
(DEA) method in relation with stock returns
REFERENCES
Adenso-Diaz B., Gascon F, (1997), Linking and Weighting Efficiency Estimates with Stock
Performance in Banking Firms, Working Paper, Financial Institutions Center, The
Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, Pages 1-18.
Afanasief, Tarsila Segala; Priscilla Maria Villa Lhacer dan Marcio L Nakane, (2004), The
Determinants of Bank Interest Spread in Brazil, JEL Classification, Published in Money
Affairs, G21;E43;E44, Pages 183-207.
Aftab M, Ahamad S, Ullah W and Sheikh RA (2008), The impact of bank efficiency on share
performance: Evidence from Pakistan, African Journal of Business Management,
Volume 5, Pages 3975-3980.
Angbazo, L, (1997), Commercial Bank Net Interest Margin, Default Risk, Interest- Rate Risk,
and Off-Balance Sheet Banking, Journal of Banking and Finance, Vol 21, Pages 55-87.
Atmawardhana, Angga (2006), Efficiency Analysis of Islamic Banks and Conventional Bank
which have Sharia unit in Indonesia, after the enactment of Act 10 of 1998 (Data
Envelopment Analysis Approach), FE-UII,Yogyakarta.
Bank of Indonesia (2009), Indonesian Banking Booklet of 2009. Bank of Indonesia :
Directorate of Bank Licensing and Banking
Beccalli E, Casu B, Girardone C (2006). Efficiency and stock performance in European banking.
Journal of Business Finance and Accounting, Volume 33, Pages 245-262.
Corrado, Charles and Bradford Jordan (2008), Fundamentals of Investments, 5nd Ed, Publisher:
McGraw-Hill Companies
Gue, Hongmei and Yue, Jiahui (2011). The Relationship between Bank Efficiency and Stock
Returns: Evidence from Chinese Listed Banks, World Journal of Social Sciences, Volume
1, Pages 95-106.
Gujarati, D (2010), Basic Econometrics 5th Edition, McGrow Hill, New York
Hardius, Usman dan Djalal Nachrowi (2006), Popular and Practical Approach of Econometrics,
Economic and Financial Analysis, LPFE-UI, Jakarta
Ioannidis C, Molyneux F, and Pasiouras F (2008), The relationship between bank efficiency and
stock returns: evidence from Asia and Latin America, University of Bath School of
Management, Working Paper Series, Pages 1-27.
Jogiyanto Hartono (2009), Portfolio Theory and Investment Analysis, 6th Edition, BPFE UGM,
Yogyakarta.
Jones, Charles P (2009), Investment Analysis and Management, John Wiley an Sons, Inc
317
Manduh Hanafi M. dan Abdul Halim. (2009). Financial Statement Analysis. UPP AMP YKPN,
Yogyakarta:
Permono, Iswandoro S. (2000), Efficiency Analysis Banking Industry in Indonesia (Case Study-
Bank Foreign Exchange Bank in Indonesia during 1991-1996), Jurnal Ekonomi dan
Bisnis Indonesia, Volume 15. pages. 1-13.
Sekaran, Uma (2010), Research Methods for Business : A skill-Building Approach, 5th Ed, John
Willey & Sons
Siswadi, Erwinta dan Purwantoro Nugroho, 2006. Application Method of DEA with DMU
Classification for measuring Operational Performance of Bank Branch Office,
Manajemen Usahawan Indonesia, Volume 35, Pages 33-39.
Suad Husnan, (2009), Basics Portfolio Theory and Securities Analysis, UPP-AMP YKPN,
Yogyakarta
Tulkens, Henry & Vanden Eeckaut, Philippe (1995), Non-parametric efficiency, progress and
regress measures for panel data: Methodological aspects, European Journal of
Operational Research, Elsevier, Volume 80, Pages 474-499
Weston, J Fred and Brigham, Eugene F (2005), Financial Management, Erlangga Offset, Jakarta
Widarjono, Agus (2007), Econometric: Theory and Applications to Economics and Business,
Second Edition, FE-UII, Yogyakarta.
318
INTEGRATION OF ASEAN 5 +3 STOCK MARKETS AND RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN
STOCK MARKETS WITH EXCHANGE RATE AND CRUDE OIL.
Umi Mujahadah
Department of Management
Faculty of Economics and Business
Syarif Hidayatullah State Islamic University Jakarta, 15412, Indonesia.
Umimujahadah22@gmail.com
ABSTRACT
This study examines the integration of the stock markets ASEAN 5 +3 countries and the
relationship between stock markets with exchange rate and crude oil. These countries include
Indonesia, Malaysia, Philippines, Singapore, Thailand, China, Japan, and South Korea period
starting from January 2009 to December 2013. Unit root, Cointegration tests, Vector
Autoregressive (VAR), Impulse Responses Function (IRF) and Granger Causality Tests are
employed. The findings of this study are as follows. First, Stock markets of ASEAN 5 +3
countries are integrated with other stock markets. Second, the results show that significant long-
term links exist between the stock market index, exchange rate and crude oil for two countries,
China and South Korea. Third, the shock of exchange rate can push up Malaysia, Singapore,
Filipina, Thailand and South Korea stock markets but can depress Indonesia, China, Japan stock
markets and responses for all countries to shock of crude oil is positive. Fourth, evidence also
highlights that there is granger causality from stock market to exchange rate for Malaysia,
Singapore, Thailand and South Korea. Moreover, crude oil prices are affecting the stock markets
in all countries.
Keywords: Cointegration, stock prices, crude oil, exchange rates, VECM, VAR, Granger
causality, impulse response.
INTRODUCTION
Globalisations in capital markets and reduction of restrictions on international cross listings have
led to greater flows of capital between economies, easier ownership and trading in securities
from around the world. With increased market integration, the current world financial markets
have become more closely correlated and interdependent over time. Understanding the
information linkages and correlations between markets are important for policy makers and fund
319
managers in their financial decisions in relation to investment and risk management (Khan and
Aslam, 2014)
Rapid economic growth in several East Asian economies prior to the Asian currency crisis in
1997 brought increased integration to countries in the South-East Asian region, and strengthened
its position in the world economy. The Association of Southeast Asian Nations (ASEAN) is the
fourth largest trading region in the world, with a market of about 568 million people and a
combined gross domestic product of US$ 1,073 billion. ASEAN was established in 1967 to
promote economic, social and cultural operation, and to safeguard economic and political
stability in the region competitive edge in the global market, eliminate intra-regional trade
barriers, encourage greater economic integration among member economies, and attract more
direct foreign investments into the region (Lim, 2007)
FIGURE 1: COUNTRY THAT OFFERS THE BEST PROSPECTS ORGANIZATION’S
OUTWARD FOREIGN INVESTMENTS OVER THREE YEARS (2013-2015).
According to Wong and Wirjo, 2013, the majority of businesses perceived ASEAN economic
integration to present more of an opportunity rather than a threat. In addition, investor interest in
the ASEAN region remains strong and more businesses are seeing ASEAN as one region in
making their investment decisions. These are some of the key findings from the 2013 ASEAN-
BAC (ASEAN Business Advisory Council) Survey on ASEAN Competitiveness as ASEAN
pushes on with its efforts to realize the ASEAN Economic Community (AEC) by the end of
2015. The figure shows that businesses continued to view the ASEAN region’s competitiveness
for investments positively. More than half of the businesses that had internationalized [engaged
in export or outward foreign direct investment (OFDI) activities] or planned to do so within the
next three years (2013 – 2015) indicated an ASEAN country as the most attractive country in the
world for their OFDI. ASEAN’s attractiveness also continued to be rated higher than China’s
Singapore 8%
Thailand 3%
Indonesia 7%
Philippines 1%
Malaysia 12%
Brunei 1%
Vietnam 6% Laos
4% Myanmar
13% Cambodia
3%
USA 7%
China 17%
India 3%
Others 15%
Source : Wong, M-H and Wirjo, A, 2013.
320
both as a market for goods and services and as a production location. The main reason for
investing in ASEAN countries, as identified by the largest share of businesses, was to ‘access a
new or growing market’ which attests to business optimism in the growth prospects of the
ASEAN region. This was followed by ‘supply main or leading customers’ and ‘low-cost
production facilities’.
The process of ASEAN +3 started in 1997 and since then the cooperation between ASEAN,
China, Japan and the South Korea has broadened and deepened in many areas. The timeline for
the remaining ASEAN-countries and China is set to 2015. Furthermore the ASEAN- Japan
Comprehensive Economic Partnership (AJCEP) was signed in 2008 in order to strengthen the
economic ties between the countries and to create a larger and more efficient market. A fully
functioning free trade agreement with the South Korea is set with a timeline of 2016, however
the implementation started already in 2008 (www.aseansec.org). It can be concluded that
ASEAN has increased its integration and is still doing so.
The relationship between exchange rate and stock prices has significant implications, especially
from the viewpoint of recent large cross-border movement of funds and investments. Two
theories about the relationship between exchange rate and stock prices are the traditional
approach and portfolio approach (Lee and Zhao, 2014). The traditional approach argues that a
depreciation of domestic currency makes local firms more competitive, which leads to an
increase in exports, and consequently raises stock prices. The traditional approach implies that
exchange rates lead stock prices. The portfolio approach, on the contrary, argues that an increase
in stock prices induces investors to demand more domestic assets and thereby causes
appreciation of the domestic currency, which implies that stock prices lead exchange rates (Nieh
and Yau, 2010).
Oil is an important commodity and vital for the world's economy. Consequently, changing oil
prices have a significant impact on the economy. Oil prices' high variation makes oil a primary
macro-economic factor, which generates unstable economic conditions and affects global
financial stability. Oil price volatility has an impact on both oil-exporting and oil-importing
countries (Naifar and Dohaiman, 2013).
LITERATURE REVIEW
Although the research topic of whether international stock markets are integrated or relationship
between stock markets with exchange rate and crude oil has been hotly discussed and analyzed,
both in academia and in the financial service industry, it still represents a moot point that is
perhaps surprisingly not yet fully resolved.
The Vector Autoregressive (VAR) model was used in several studies to investigate integration
stock markets. The VAR analysis in the study by Mevlud Islami and Paul J. J. Welfens (2013)
conducted a generalized VAR analysis to confirm the findings integration the stock markets in
Eastern European countries seems to be rather week except for the Hungarian stock market. This
321
means that only the Hungarian stock market is integrated. Leila C. Kabigting (2013) studied
financial integration of the stock markets of the ASEAN 5 +3 countries found that there is the
presence of integration and co-integration with Philippine with the following countries:
Indonesia, Singapore, and Thailand. She also pointed out that any news in any of these stock
markets may increase volatilities not only in the country but also in the region.
Recent papers have analyzed the relationship between stock markets with exchange rate and
crude oil with VAR model. K. S. Sujit dan B. Rajesh Kumar (2011) examine any potential links
between nominal stock market index and nominal exchange rate. The results show that exchange
rate is highly affected by changes in other variables. However, stock market has fewer roles in
affecting the exchange rate. Lee and Zhao (2014) examine the short-run and long-run causal
relationship between stock market prices and exchange rate in Chinese stock markets. They
found long-run causality from exchange rate to stock prices in Chinese stock markets and short-
run causality from Japanese yen and Korean won exchange rate to stock prices in the Shanghai
Stock Exchange strongly prevails while in the Shenzhen Stock Exchange weakly prevails.
Other econometric tools applied to stock market analyses were unit root, Johansen co-integration
test, impulse response function (IRF) and Granger causality tests. The last four mentioned tests
represent recent advances in time-series econometrics. All these tools are mostly used in stock
market studies so the researcher decided to formulate hypotheses anchored on them.
Data and Countries
The data employed in this study were daily closing stock market indices. The stock markets
includes the Jakarta Composite Index (Indonesia), Kuala Lumpur Stock Exchange (Malaysia),
Strait Times Index (Singapore), Philippines Stock Exchange Composite Index (Philippines),
Stock Exchange of Thailand (Thailand), Shanghai Stock Exchange (China), Nikkei 225 (Japan),
Korea Stock Exchange Index (South Korea). The sample is restricted to the period in which daily
data are available from January 2009 to December 2013. All prices are based on daily close, all
exchange rate are expressed as number of local currencies per US dollar and world crude oil data
in Dollars per Barrel.
METHODOLOGY
A stationary time series is significant to a regression analysis based on the time series, because
useful information or characteristics are difficult to identify in a nonstationary time series.
Therefore, a nonstationary time series would lead to a spurious regression. However, most
economic time series are nonstationary in practice. Hence, time series should be made stationary
after differencing. Useful information or characteristics can still be identified in the time series
after differencing. A time series is said to be stationary if its mean and variance are constant and,
the covariances depend on upon the distance of two time periods. The unit root test is used to test
stationarity of variables and the order of integration. The Augmented Dicky-Fuller unit root test
322
(ADF) (Dicky and Fuller, 1979) and the Phillips-Perron unit root test (PP) (Phillips and Perron,
1988) are often used to test stationarity.
In this study, the Johansen and Juselius (1990) Trace and Maximum Eigenvalue tests are
employed to test the long-run relationships among the stock market indices of the ASEAN 5+3
Countries and relationship between stock markets with exchanges rate and world crude oil. If
two or more variables are found to be cointegrated, it implies that there is a long-run equilibrium
relationship between them, and even though the variables themselves may be non-stationary,
they will nevertheless move closely together over time.
The unrestricted vector autoregression (VAR) approach used in this study was developed by
Sims (1980). The VAR was developed to account for problems with intervention and transfer
function analysis. This model provides a multivariate framework where changes in a particular
variable are related to changes in its own lags and to changes in other variables. The VAR treats
all variables as jointly endogeneous and imposes no a priori restrictions on the structural
relationships, if any, between variables being analyzed. Because the VAR expresses the
dependent variables in terms of only predetermined lagged variables, the VAR model is a
reduced form model. Another argument that arises in the context of an unrestricted VAR is
whether this model should be used where the variables in the VAR are cointegrated. There is a
body of literature that supports the use of a vector error correction model (VECM), or
cointegrating VAR if variables are integrated, I(1). Because the cointegrating vectors bind the
long run behavior of the variables, the VECM is expected to produce results in the impulse
response analysis and variance decomposition that more accurately reflect the relationship
between the variables than the standard unrestricted VAR. Augmented Dickey-Fuller are used to
investigate the degree of integration of the variables used in the empirical analysis. If a I(1)
process does exist, the second step involves estimation of the VAR model with first differences,
otherwise VAR is estimated in levels.
One of the important aspect of VAR model is to select the optimal lagged term. Traditional way
of selecting the lag length was by repeating VAR model by reducing lag length from a large lag
term until 0. In each of these models, the smallest value of the Akaike information criterion and
the Schwarz criterion are used to select the optimal lag length. In this study however, five
criteria: Sequential modified LR test statistics (LR), Final prediction error (FPE), Akaike
information criterion (AIC), Schwarz criterion (SC) and Hannan-Quinn information criterion
(HQ), which have been introduced by Lutkepohl (1993) were inspected. Similarly, the smallest
value of these 5 criteria points to the optimal lag length.
In next step Granger Causality test was applied. According to Granger (1969), a variable X is
said to ‘Granger cause’ Y if past values of X help in the prediction of Y after controlling for past
values of Y, or equivalently if coefficients on the lagged values of X are statistically significant.
The null hypothesis of no direction of causality was tested against the alternative that there exists
a direction of causality amongst the variables. The conclusion was arrived based on the fact that
their F-statistics were statistically significant at 5% as indicated by their p- values.
323
Impulse Response Function (IRF) are used to trace out the dynamic interaction among variables.
It shows the dynamic response of all the variables in the system to a shock in each variable. The
impulse response shows the response to one standard deviation shock in the error terms of other
variables.
EMPIRICAL RESULTS
Stock market integration in ASEAN 5 +3 countries
Table 1 presents the unit root tests with level and first difference. The results shows that all the
index data series are not stationary at the level but stationary after the first difference. In other
words all the data series are I(1) which denotes that the time series is integrated at the first
difference level.
TABLE 1: UNIT ROOT TEST RESULTS
Va
riab
le
Augmented Dickey-Fuller Test
Level First Difference
ADF
t-statistics
ADF
t-statistics
IHSG -1.9645 -23.1055
KLSE -1.4003 -27.1473
STI -2.2608 -30.0287
PSEi -1.2248 -29.8508
SET -1.4315 -30.8126
SSE -2.0705 -32.9931
N225 0.1859 -32.1320
KOSPI -2.4526 -31.09162
Test critical values: 5% critical value -2.86433
One of the important aspect of VAR model is to select the optimal lagged term. Table 2 shows
the summary results of VAR lag order selection criterion. The first left hand column shows the
model for which the lag length has been selected using The LR, FPE, AIC, SC and HQ criterion.
The numbers are the smallest value in each of criteria. Based on the results, the study chose two
lag to be appropriate.
TABLE 2: OPTIMUM LAG-LENGTH
Lag LR FPE AIC SC HQ
0 NA 1.65e+36 106.09 106.13 106.11
1 26351.6 1.51e+24 78.374 78.74* 78.514
2 329.735 1.21e+24* 78.157* 78.84 78.421*
3 109.237 1.23e+24 78.174 79.19 78.561
4 70.4939 1.31e+24 78.231 79.57 78.743
5 98.6258* 1.34e+24 78.257 79.92 78.893
6 73.1799 1.41e+24 78.310 80.30 79.071
7 7.85849 1.48e+24 78.358 80.67 79.242
324
LR: sequential modified LR test statistic (each test at 5% level), FPE: Final prediction error, AIC: Akaike information crit erion, SC: Schwarz information criterion, HQ: Hannan -Quinn information criterion.
The Johansen cointegration test (1988) represents each variable as a function of all the lagged
endogenous variables in the system. It uses two ratio tests, a trace test and a maximum
eigenvalue test, to examine the number of cointegration relationships. Both tests could be used to
determine the number of cointegrating vectors present, although they do not always indicate the
same number of cointegrating vectors.
Table 3 reports the results of the Johansen cointegration test. Trace test and maximum
eigenvalue indicates that at least one cointegrating equations exist at the 0.05 level. Therefore,
there exists cointegration between stock market ASEAN 5+3 countries.
TABLE 3: JOHANSEN COINTEGRATION TEST
Hypothesized No. of CE(s)
Trace Statistic
0.05 Critical Value
Max-Eigen Statistic 0.05 Critical Value
None * 160.54 159.52 58.733 52.362
At most 1 101.80 125.61 29.468 46.231
At most 2 72.339 95.753 24.077 40.077
At most 3 48.261 69.818 21.215 0.6679
At most 4 27.045 47.856 10.654 0.9735
At most 5 16.391 29.797 10.467 0.6999
At most 6 5.9233 15.494 4.9766 0.7448
At most 7 0.9467 3.8414 0.9467 0.3306 Trace test indicates 1 cointegrating eqn(s) at the 0.05 level
Max-eigenvalue test indicates 1 cointegrating eqn(s) at the 0.05 level* denotes rejection of the hypothesis at the 0.05 level
Cointegration between variables implies existence of long-run causality for at least one direction.
Thus, testing cointegration and causality should be considered jointly. The present study adopted
the same lag structure for both tests. Results of the Granger causality test shown in Table 4.
TABLE 4: GRANGER CAUSALITY TEST
Null Hypothesis Lag p-value Causality Relationship
KLSE does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause KLSE
2 0.1200 8.E-12
IHSG KLSE
KOSPI does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause KOSPI
2 0.5377 5.E-05
IHSG KOSPI
N225 does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause N225
2 0.0192 0.0175
N225 IHSG
PSEI does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause PSEI
2 0.0120 2.E-19
PSEI IHSG
SET does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause SET
2 0.2584 5.E-05
IHSG SET
SSE does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause SSE
2 0.9835 1.E-05
IHSG SSE
STI does not Granger Cause IHSG IHSG does not Granger Cause STI
2 0.5575 0.1498
INDEPENDENT
KOSPI does not Granger Cause KLSE KLSE does not Granger Cause KOSPI
2 1.E-06 0.1143
KOSPI KLSE
325
N225 does not Granger Cause KLSE KLSE does not Granger Cause N225
2 0.0274 0.4920
N225 KLSE
PSEI does not Granger Cause KLSE KLSE does not Granger Cause PSEI
2 0.0004 0.5004
PSEI KLSE
SET does not Granger Cause KLSE KLSE does not Granger Cause SET
2 4.E-06 0.7377
SET KLSE
SSE does not Granger Cause KLSE KLSE does not Granger Cause SSE
2 0.1521 0.0065
KLSE SSE
STI does not Granger Cause KLSE KLSE does not Granger Cause STI
2 5.E-09 0.4236
STI KLSE
N225 does not Granger Cause KOSPI KOSPI does not Granger Cause N225
2 0.9002 0.7578
INDEPENDENT
PSEI does not Granger Cause KOSPI KOSPI does not Granger Cause PSEI
2 0.7277 0.0197
KOSPI PSEI
SET does not Granger Cause KOSPI KOSPI does not Granger Cause SET
2 0.0253 0.2439
SET KOSPI
SSE does not Granger Cause KOSPI KOSPI does not Granger Cause SSE
2 0.8267 0.0003
KOSPI SSE
STI does not Granger Cause KOSPI KOSPI does not Granger Cause STI
2 1.E-05 0.9935
STI KOSPI
PSEI does not Granger Cause N225 N225 does not Granger Cause PSEI
2 0.2972 0.2785
INDEPENDENT
SET does not Granger Cause N225 N225 does not Granger Cause SET
2 0.0843 0.2428
INDEPENDENT
SSE does not Granger Cause N225 N225 does not Granger Cause SSE
2 0.4222 0.1015
INDEPENDENT
STI does not Granger Cause N225 N225 does not Granger Cause STI
2 4.E-05 0.4388
STI N225
SET does not Granger Cause PSEI PSEI does not Granger Cause SET
2 9.E-09 0.0468
SET PSEI
SSE does not Granger Cause PSEI PSEI does not Granger Cause SSE
2 0.1877 0.0056
PSEI SSE
STI does not Granger Cause PSEI PSEI does not Granger Cause STI
2 1.E-08 0.6927
STI PSEI
SSE does not Granger Cause SET SET does not Granger Cause SSE
2 0.2087 2.E-05
SET SSE
STI does not Granger Cause SET SET does not Granger Cause STI
2 0.1220 0.8377
INDEPENDENT
STI does not Granger Cause SSE SSE does not Granger Cause STI
2 5.E-10 0.9173
STI SSE
From Table 4, the causality test revealed that Nikkei 225 (Japan) PSEi(Philippines) influence
IHSG (Indonesia) and IHSG also influenced both of them. SET (Singapore) also Granger cause
the PSEi (Philippines) and PSEi also Granger cause SET, their values were 9.E-0.9 and 0.0468
respectively. This showed there existed bidirectional granger causality between some ASEAN 5
stock markets and Japan.
The results also indicated that some countries in ASEAN 5 +3 were unidiretional phenomenon.
For example, PSEi (Philippines) Granger cause the KLSE (Malaysia) but KLSE did not Granger
cause the PSEI, their values were 0.0004 and 0.5004 respectively.
Based on Johansen Cointegration Test, VECM and Granger causality it can be concluded that
there is integration between the ASEAN 5 +3 countries stock markets. Integrated stock market
will provide benefits such as the costs of capital will become smaller. The reduced cost of capital
will boost investment and employment. In addition, foreign funds can also be used to accelerate
economic growth in the country.
326
But if the stock markets are integrated with other stock markets can also have negative effects.
First, the domino effect when happened financial crisis like in the United States on 2008 where
the stock exchanges in other countries also decreased. Second, the diversification across these
markets may be less beneficial for international investors because all of countries will have a
common trend.
Relationship between stock markets with exchange rate and world crude oil
The first step in the analysis consists of testing time series to determine whether they fulfil the
property of non-stationarity as it is a requirement for the employment of the cointegration
concept. Therefore, the ADF test will be employed in level and in first differences.
Table 5 indicates the null hypothesis of a unit root cannot be rejected in the level but after first
differencing, all null hypothesis of a unit root is rejected at the 5% significance level for these
variables. The results in Table 5 confirm that all variables are integrated of order one I(1).
TABLE 5: UNIT ROOT TEST RESULTS
Countries Variable
Augmented Dickey-Fuller
Level First Difference
ADF
t-statistics
ADF
t-statistics
Indonesia
IHSG
IDR/USD Crude Oil
-1.964505
-0.029011 -2.391512
-23.10553
-35.92285 -32.73554
Malaysia
KLSE
MYR/USD
Crude Oil
-1.400332
-1.750180
-2.391512
-27.14734
-40.71311
-32.73554
Singapore
STI SGD/USD
Crude Oil
-2.260806 -1.679591
-2.391512
-30.02879 -33.60069
-32.73554
Philippines
PSEi
PHP/USD Crude Oil
-1.224864
-1.751209 -2.391512
-29.85082
-35.19013 -32.73554
Thailand
SET
Baht/USD
Crude Oil
-1.431571
-1.911270
-2.391512
-30.81269
-15.31529
-32.73554
China
SSE
CNY/USD
Crude Oil
-2.070594
0.770298
-2.391512
-32.99318
-38.66905
-32.73554
Japan
N225
JPY/USD
Crude Oil
0.185950
-0.764467
-2.391512
-32.13206
-32.42485 -32.73554
South Korea
KOSPI
KRW/USD
Crude Oil
-2.452666
-1.980801
-2.391512
-31.09162
-34.34818
-32.73554
Test critical values:
5% critical value -2.86433
Next step employ LR, FPE, AIC, SC and HQ criterion to determine the optimum lag.
327
TABLE 6: OPTIMUM LAG-LENGTH
Countries LR FPE AIC SC HQ Optimum lag
Indonesia 6 2 2 2 2 2
Malaysia 3 3 3 2 2 3
Singapore 6 2 2 2 2 2
Philippines 8 2 2 1 2 2
Thailand 4 2 2 2 2 2
China 2 2 2 2 2 2
Japan 8 3 3 1 2 3
South Korea 2 2 2 2 2 2
Engle and Granger (1987) pointed out that a linear combination of two or more non-stationary
series may be stationary. If such a stationary, or I(0), linear combination exists, the non-
stationary (with a unit root), time series are said to be cointegrated. The stationary linear
combination is called the cointegrating equation and may be interpreted as a long-run
equilibrium relationship between the variables. The result of cointegration test is presented in the
table 7.
TABLE 7: JOHANSEN COINTEGRATION TEST
Indonesia
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None 26.25969 29.79707 14.04315 21.13162
At most 1 12.21654 15.49471 12.08955 14.26460
At most 2 0.126989 3.841466 0.126989 3.841466
Malaysia
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None 16.99101 21.13162 16.99101 21.13162
At most 1 5.949178 14.26460 5.949178 14.26460
At most 2 0.024139 3.841466 0.024139 3.841466
Singapore
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None 25.40688 29.79707 14.56207 21.13162
At most 1 10.84481 15.49471 6.375943 14.26460
At most 2 4.468865 3.841466 4.468865 3.841466
Philippines
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None 20.36011 29.79707 11.13368 21.13162
At most 1 9.226436 15.49471 6.412778 14.26460
At most 2 2.813658 3.841466 2.813658 3.841466
Thailand
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None 16.76160 29.79707 10.54901 21.13162
At most 1 6.212591 15.49471 4.747937 14.26460
328
At most 2 1.464654 3.841466 1.464654 3.841466
China
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None* 30.00232 29.79707 15.31470 21.13162
At most 1 14.68762 15.49471 14.39013 14.26460
At most 2 0.297484 3.841466 0.297484 3.841466
Japan
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None 23.85145 29.79707 19.49577 21.13162
At most 1 4.355676 15.49471 4.336659 14.26460
At most 2 0.019017 3.841466 0.019017 3.841466
South Korea
Hypothesized
No. of CE(s)
Trace
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
Max-Eigen
Statistic
0.05
Critical Value
None* 39.45137 29.79707 17.44104 21.13162
At most 1 22.01033 15.49471 15.07922 14.26460
At most 2 6.931108 3.841466 6.931108 3.841466
* denotes rejection of the hypothesis at the 0.05 level
Johansen cointegration test result shows that there are no cointegration relationship among stock
markets, exchange rate and crude oil in Indonesia, Malaysia, Singapore, Philippines, Thailand
and Japan. Otherwise, China and South Korea stock markets are cointegrated with exchange rate
and crude oil. If the series are cointegrated, there is a long-term, or equilibrium relationship
among the series. Their relationship can be expressed as VECM. On other hand, if the series are
no cointegrated it can be expressed as VAR. In this study also want to examine if variables has
Granger causality with other variables and responses of stock market with exchanges rate and
crude oil shock for each country.
Based on Appendix I (Impulse Response Function), The shock of exchange rate can push up
Malaysia, Singapore, Filipina, Thailand and South Korea stock markets. This means the stock
market will rise when the exchange rate depreciates. Exchange rate depreciation can improve the
price competitiveness of local products in international trade.
Meanwhile, shock of exchange rate can depress Indonesia, China and Japan stock markets. This
means the stock market will decline when the exchange rate depreciates. When the exchange rate
depreciates, the cost of imported raw materials or products that related with imported products
will increase. This leads to increased production costs and profit of the company will be dropped
so that the dividends will be reduced.
Response of Indonesia, Malaysia, Singapore, the Philippines, Thailand, China, Japan and South
Korea stock markets due to crude oil price shock is positive. This means the stock market will
increase when crude oil prices rise. The increase in oil prices could pushing the mining sector,
so that mining company makes a profit and will lead the company's stock price increases and
reflected to the increased of composite index.
Based on the results of Granger causality (Appendix 2) test showed Philippines, China and Japan
follow the traditional approach that the exchange rate affects the stock market. On other hand,
329
only Indonesia follow the portfolio theory that the stock market affects the exchange rate.
Another results showed that there is granger causality between stock market and exchange rate in
Malaysia, Singapore, Thailand and South Korea. Granger causality test results also showed that
crude oil prices are affecting the stock market in all countries.
CONCLUSIONS AND RECOMMENDATIONS
This study examines the integration among the stock markets of the ASEAN 5+3 countries and
relationship with exchange rate and crude oil. In general, the empirical results reveal that the
long-run cointegrating relationship among these markets were strengthened during the period.
There also exists significant influence among stock markets.
If stock markets share a common trend, it implies that markets move together and any one
market will be representative of the behavior of that group of markets. This means that short-
term gains from international diversification would be limited because markets are constrained
by common shocks manifesting temporary effects.
This study also examines relationship between stock market with exchange rate and crude oil.
The results of relationship between stock markets with exchange rate and crude oil show
that significant long-term links exist between the stock market index, exchange rate and
crude oil for two countries, China and South Korea.
Shock of exchange rate can push up Malaysia, Singapore, Filipina, Thailand and South
Korea stock markets but can depress Indonesia, China and Japan stock markets. Responses
of Indonesia, Malaysia, Singapore, Philippines, Thailand, China, Japan and South Korea
stock markets due to shock of crude oil is positive.
There is granger causality from stock market to exchange rate for Malaysia, Singapore,
Thailand and South Korea. This results also showed that crude oil prices are affecting the
stock market in all countries.
According to the results of this study I would like to give the following recommendation. First,
the international investors should not invest in ASEAN 5+3 at same time. Because, stock
markets are positively correlated with each other. They should choose one of them for
investment. Second, if policy makers are interested in promoting stable and sustainable growth in
stock prices, a more stable exchange rate policy should be pursued.
REFERENCES
Dickey, D. and W. Fuller (1979). Distribution of the Estimators for Autoregressive Time Series
with a Unit Root,” Journal of the American Statistical Association, 74, 427-431.
330
Engle, R. F. and Granger C.W.J. (1987). Cointegration and error correction: Representation
estimation and testing. Econometrica. 55: 251-276.
Granger, C. W. J. (1969). Investigating causal relations by econometric models and cross-
spectral methods. Econometrica. 37: 424-438.
Islami, Mevlud and Paul J J. Welfens. (2013). Financial market integration, stock markets and
exchange rate dynamics in Eastern Europe. International Econ Econ Policy 10:47–79.
Johansen, S. (1988).Statistical analysis of cointegrating factors. Journal of Economic Dynamics
and Control, 12, pp. 231-254.
Johansen, S. and K. Juselius (1990). Maximum likelihood estimation and inference on
cointegration--with applications to the demand for money. Oxford Bulletin of Economics and
Statistics, 52, pp. 169-210.
Kabigting, Leila C. and Rene B. Hapitan. (2013). Financial Integration Among the ASEAN 5 + 3
Stock Markets: A Preliminary Look at the First 10 Years of the New Millenium. Chinese
Business Review, ISSN 1537-1506 Vol. 12, No. 5, pp 305-314.
Khan, Salleh Nawaz and Mohammad Saad Aslam. (2014). Co-integration of Karachi Stock
Exchange with Major South Asian Stock Exhanges. International Journal of Accounting and
Financial Reporting.Vol. 4 No. 1.
Lee, Jung Wan and Tianyuan Frederic Zhao. (2014). Relationship between Stock Prices and
Exchange Rates: Evidence from Chinese Stock Markets. Journal of Asian Finance, Economics
and Business Vol. 1 No. 1.
Lim L. K. (2007). Linkages Between ASEAN Stock Markets: A Cointegration Approach.
MODSIM International Congress on Modelling and Simulation. Modelling and Simulation
Society of Australia and New Zealand, December 2007, pp. 1818-1824.
Lütkepohl, H. (1993). Testing for causation between two variables in higher dimensional VAR
models, in H. Schneeweiss and K.F. Zimmermann (eds), Studies in Applied Economterics,
Physia-Verlag Heidelberg. pp 75-91.
Naifar, Nader and Mohammed Saleh Al Dohaiman. (2013). Nonlinear analysis among crude oil
prices, stock markets' return and macroeconomic variables, International Review of Economics
and Finance 27, 416-431.
Nieh, Chien-Chung and Hwey-Yun Yau. (2010). The Impact of Renminbi Appreciation on Stock
Prices in China. Emerging Markets Finance & Trade, January–February 2010, Vol. 46, No. 1,
pp. 16–26.
Phillips, P.C.B. and P. Perron (1988). Testing for Unit Roots in Time Series Regression,”
Biometrika, 75, 335-346.
331
Sims, C. A. (1980). Macroeconomics and reality. Econometrica. 48: 1-48.
Singh, Gurcharan and Pritam Singh. (2010). Chinese And Indian Stock Market Linkages With
Developed Stock Markets. Asian Journal of Finance & Accounting. Volume 2, No. 2, E 2, pp.
21-39.
Sujit, K. S. and B. Rajesh Kumar. (2011). Study on Dynamic Relationshiop among Gold Price,
Oil Price, Exchange Rate and Stock Market Returns. International Journal of Applied Business
and Economic Research, Vol. 9, No. 2, 145-16.
Wong, M-H. and Wirjo, A. (2013). Findings from 2011-12 ASEAN-BAC Survey on ASEAN
Competitiveness, Jakarta: ASEAN Business Advisory Council, pp. 13,
http://www.spp.nus.edu.sg/docs/2011-12_ASEAN_BAC_Survey_Report.pdf
332
333
APPENDIX 1 (Impulse Response Function)
Response of IHSG:
Period CRUDE_OIL IHSG K_IDR
1 8.676005 48.93362 0.000000
2 16.86776 50.60353 -0.167310
3 17.05116 50.21107 -0.094828
4 17.24523 49.90720 -0.084530
5 17.44480 49.60700 -0.061680
6 17.63676 49.31138 -0.040841
7 17.82190 49.01965 -0.019164
8 18.00031 48.73188 0.002774
9 18.17217 48.44794 0.025074
10 18.33764 48.16775 0.047706
Response of KLSE:
Period CRUDE_OIL K_MYR KLSE
1 1.568114 3.482572 15.35005
2 3.544910 3.392475 9.741916
3 3.168250 3.691135 10.10573
4 3.237726 3.198451 10.75291
5 3.355666 3.288224 10.43402
6 3.326259 3.174872 10.41383
7 3.353609 3.078434 10.45469
8 3.375481 3.002660 10.41226
9 3.387911 2.919551 10.39787
10 3.402124 2.836727 10.38624
Response of
STI:
Period CRUDE_OIL K_SGD STI 1 9.738187 7.593205 28.12305
2 14.35416 12.79172 26.25241
3 13.36399 12.02476 25.79021
4 13.49930 11.82833 25.67310
5 13.59030 11.67700 25.49863
6 13.66266 11.51466 25.32642
7 13.73275 11.35590 25.15686
8 13.79858 11.20007 24.98888
9 13.86021 11.04690 24.82255
10 13.91781 10.89640 24.65786
334
Response of
PSEI:
Period CRUDE_OIL K_PHP PSEI
1 3.514057 14.82089 61.23825
2 12.06148 21.39709 61.31394
3 11.88381 21.17701 60.76824
4 12.11122 21.71492 60.35397
5 12.32890 22.16483 59.94057
6 12.54656 22.61534 59.53021
7 12.76319 23.05590 59.12324
8 12.97895 23.48798 58.71959
9 13.19376 23.91154 58.31923
10 13.40758 24.32672 57.92216
Response of
SET:
Period CRUDE_OIL K_BHT SET
1 3.187264 3.493872 13.62833
2 5.100763 5.228668 12.79059
3 4.815832 5.177926 12.87848
4 4.877325 5.205164 12.82032
5 4.893704 5.221536 12.76461
6 4.912605 5.237210 12.70996
7 4.930985 5.252995 12.65526
8 4.948782 5.268679 12.60083
9 4.966069 5.284300 12.54661
10 4.982844 5.299852 12.49261
Response
of SSE:
Period CRUDE_OIL K_CNY SSE 1 5.208874 -2.014270 41.92278
2 13.06922 -1.078481 38.59623
3 11.84545 -1.530716 40.62681
4 12.38008 -1.514824 40.64787
5 12.27491 -1.476801 40.71078
6 12.25773 -1.482803 40.75381
7 12.22325 -1.473052 40.77643
8 12.18730 -1.465406 40.80288
9 12.15340 -1.458205 40.82684
10 12.11974 -1.450994 40.85050
Response of
N225:
335
Period CRUDE_OIL K_JPY N225
1 27.99914 -54.39612 155.5945
2 64.71271 -88.16413 129.0757
3 71.03734 -85.13481 133.5378
4 71.21809 -82.92344 133.2583
5 73.28339 -84.57817 131.4500
6 74.33878 -85.47597 130.2520
7 75.34375 -86.09383 129.2096
8 76.37664 -86.83813 128.1273
9 77.36425 -87.56993 127.0764
10 78.30366 -88.26866 126.0661
Response of
KOSPI:
Period CRUDE_OIL K_KRW KOSPI
1 5.125386 9.475889 19.97917
2 10.02967 9.944850 17.69236
3 11.37868 9.138986 15.77529
4 11.33742 8.727005 15.73490
5 11.56772 8.461362 15.68626
6 11.83287 8.199263 15.50936
7 12.07854 7.932933 15.34143
8 12.31356 7.679026 15.18722
9 12.54221 7.432829 15.03747
10 12.76420 7.194325 14.89171
APPENDIX 2 (Granger Causality Test)
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
336
Date: 07/05/14 Time: 13:17
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 2
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
IHSG does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 1.88259 0.1528
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause IHSG 12.1316 6.E-06
K_IDR does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 0.08692 0.9168
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_IDR 7.33018 0.0007
K_IDR does not Granger Cause IHSG 961 0.24699 0.7812
IHSG does not Granger Cause K_IDR 13.1600 2.E-06
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/05/14 Time: 14:16
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 3
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_MYR does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 960 0.26991 0.8471
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_MYR 3.31147 0.0195
KLSE does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 960 2.33634 0.0723
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause KLSE 8.28078 2.E-05
KLSE does not Granger Cause K_MYR 960 3.59038 0.0134
K_MYR does not Granger Cause KLSE 5.23401 0.0014
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/05/14 Time: 14:29
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 2
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_SGD does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 0.62918 0.5332
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_SGD 4.18958 0.0154
STI does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 0.85711 0.4247
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause STI 10.5779 3.E-05
STI does not Granger Cause K_SGD 961 3.15404 0.0431
K_SGD does not Granger Cause STI 24.0007 7.E-11
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/05/14 Time: 15:58
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 2
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_PHP does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 0.37736 0.6858
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_PHP 0.97515 0.3775
337
PSEI does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 1.20403 0.3004
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause PSEI 8.83077 0.0002
PSEI does not Granger Cause K_PHP 961 0.14243 0.8673
K_PHP does not Granger Cause PSEI 8.35938 0.0003
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/06/14 Time: 14:59
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 2
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_BHT does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 1.17005 0.3108
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_BHT 1.58479 0.2055
SET does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 1.78984 0.1675
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause SET 8.93253 0.0001
SET does not Granger Cause K_BHT 961 3.38662 0.0342
K_BHT does not Granger Cause SET 12.2519 6.E-06
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/05/14 Time: 21:36
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 2
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_CNY does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 1.67526 0.1878
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_CNY 2.85895 0.0578
SSE does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 0.36686 0.6930
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause SSE 21.8817 5.E-10
SSE does not Granger Cause K_CNY 961 0.08783 0.9159
K_CNY does not Granger Cause SSE 5.87000 0.0029
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/05/14 Time: 21:55
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 3
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_JPY does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 960 0.12786 0.9436
338
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_JPY 0.00657 0.9993
N225 does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 960 0.12866 0.9431
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause N225 16.3722 2.E-10
N225 does not Granger Cause K_JPY 960 1.44140 0.2292
K_JPY does not Granger Cause N225 21.0364 3.E-13
Pairwise Granger Causality Tests
Date: 07/06/14 Time: 00:00
Sample: 1 963
Lags: 2
Null Hypothesis: Obs F-Statistic Prob.
K_KRW does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 0.54950 0.5774
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause K_KRW 5.47256 0.0043
KOSPI does not Granger Cause CRUDE_OIL 961 2.31977 0.0988
CRUDE_OIL does not Granger Cause KOSPI 27.2775 3.E-12
KOSPI does not Granger Cause K_KRW 961 4.40902 0.0124
K_KRW does not Granger Cause KOSPI 4.64670 0.0098
339
TESTING PECKING ORDER THEORY AND TRADE OFF THEORY MODELS
IN PUBLIC COMPANIES IN INDONESIA
Arief Yulianto Notonegoro
ariefyoelianto@gmail.com
ABSTRACT
The purpose of this paper was to test the trade off and pecking order theory of capital structure. We
started with identifiying variables that influenced capital structure based on both theory. The data in the
study were gathered from statistics and annual report of IDX in 2009. There were 46 companies that
distributed dividends in 2008 (this year was as the base year to discover the changes) and 2009.
Subsequently there were two companies were excluded because the availability of data and the reports
were submitted in US Dollars. From 44 companies, there were 28 companies were excluded because
there was not any financing deficits and the remaining 16 manufacturing companies were used as
samples in this study.
Despite the fact these results support the POT model; they were weak to elaborate the POT model as
there were only 45.1% of the companies taking financing decision through debt. This can be explained
based on market timing theory in the decision making of capital structure
Keywords: Trade off Theory, Pecking Order Theory, Capital Structure
1. Introduction To this date, the theoretical explanations related to any factors that may affect the optimal capital
structure remain controversial. Miller and Modigliani-MM (1958) put the basic foundation for a theory to
explain this theoretical explanation in the form of capital structure irrelevance. As the assumption is
difficult to obtain reality, i.e. perfect capital markets and no taxes, and then the fundamental theory
develops into pecking order theory (POT) and trade off theory (TOT)
POT as explained by Myers and Majluf (1984) describes the optimal capital structure of one particular
company which is determined by the order of the source of funding of the company, starting from the
next internal to external financing sources. If the company uses external funding then it is prioritized in
340
debt to equity issuance. Several studies which have supported the POT apparently showed inconsistent
results
Shyam-Sunder and Myers (1999) who conducted a study involving 157 companies in the United States
found that most companies meet the funding by deriving the financing source from debt; and this result
support for the pecking order theory. In line with this finding,Fama and French (2002) explain that in the
short term, investment and income are partially used to repay debt (the financing is absorbed by debt).
Other support is such as the research Frank and Goyal (2003) and Atiyet (2012). Siefert and Gonenc
(2010) who conducted the research in 23 developing countries show that in order to meet the deficit of
financial of the companies, they decide to issuing equity. Darminto and Manurung (2008) concluded that
in the long-term financing, based on market timing, is not a source of funding.
TOT model as proposed by Kraus and Litzenberger (1973) describes the optimal capital structure is
influenced by the benefits and the costs due to the issuance of debt. TOT model describes both static and
dynamic models, which is the dynamic model is to explain the speed of adjustment of actual debt and
debt targets. If there is any difference, there should be adjustment. Static model assumes that if the
determinants of decision to debt are static, so that companies do not need to adjust with the factors.
In order to increase the value of the company, we may refer to the level of debt in the optimal capital
structure of the company. Therefore, the company should adjust to the optimum level of debt. So the
optimal level of debt will move from time to time. Several studies which test the TOT model still showed
inconsistent results.
Fama and French (2002) describe that in the company with a high level of investment it will make
adjustments to its capital structure, even from 7 % to 18%. Babalola, Yisauand Abiodun (2012)
describethat the optimal capital structure of the food company is 34.31% while for the beverage company
is 34.64%. Labba and Östholm (2011), however, only describeas long as the debt gives benefits in the
form of tax advantage, it means that the capital structure is normal even though it is not explained for the
optimal point.
As there were several inconsistent results from previous studies, so the objectives of this study are to
investigate how the fulfillment of the companies based on the sources of funding of the companies. Based
on POT financing deficit can be met through the issuance of debt compared to issuance of equity
beforehand. Based on TOT, the companies will consider the tradeoff of benefits and cost of debt. If the
tradeoff is known that there are more costs than the benefits of the debt, the company will look for
funding sources through the issuance of equity. This research was conducted on manufacturing companies
that pay dividends (Fama and French, 2002). Companies that are profitable and to increase the possibility
of investing it will pay dividends, so that the companies that pay dividends may either choose the sources
of funding which are from the profits or from debt. This study was conducted in 2009 to 2010 with some
considerations namely (a) the merger Jakarta Stock Market (JSX) and Surabaya Stock Market (SSX) to
become be Indonesia Stock Market (IDX) in 2007, so the year of 2008 was considered as a t-1 and 2009
as the year t; (b) the data available at the time of the study in 2011 were data in 2010. Another reason was
there have been few researches that focus on testing TOT and POT models.
341
This article will be described in Section II which describes Review of Literatures and Hypotheses, Section
III for data and methodology; section IV describes the results of research and discussion, and part V of
the conclusions.
2. Riview of Literatures and Hypotheses Shyam-Sunder and Myers (1999) conducted TOT and POT testing in the United States. The POT model
was performed with regression variable net debt and net financing deficit issues. The findingof net
financing deficit (DEF) was close to 1. Furthermore it was interpreted to support the theory of POT
because in the short term, the company prefers the use of debt funding needs. In other testing at the same
time, it was found that the TOT was better than POT. The hypothesis for POT was rejected by the DEF
model added with an additional variable in TOT. The equation for POT model is as follows:
∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜶 + 𝜷𝑷𝑶𝑫𝑬𝑭𝒊𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕 … … … (𝒊)
Where:
ΔDitis net debt issued by company i in year t, DEF is the financial deficit, and e is the error term, β is the
DEF coefficient in the POT model and α is a constant
The equation mentioned above is based on the model by Shyam-Sander and Myers (1999). This
model is based on the predictions on categories of financing company used to cover the “financing
deficit” (DEF). DEF in this case is defined as the use of the company’s cash flow in order to increase the
assets of the company which is supposed to have been less than the increase of current liabilities (except
for the proportion of the long-term debt) and less than the retained earnings. This means that the retained
earnings of the company should be able to guarantee the current liabilities, and the current liabilities
should be bigger than the asset purchases. In case of financing deficit, when the retained earnings are
smaller than the liabilities and the assets purchase is bigger than the current liabilities, it needs “filled”
through external financing. In short based on POT, priority of mechanism from the external funding is
through the issuance of debt.
The condition of financing deficit occurs when the company needs to pay dividends (Div),
investment (I) and to increase the working capital (ΔWC) which is bigger than the profit of the company
(C) in year t of the company i, so the equation for the DEF can be formulated as follows:
𝑫𝑬𝑭𝒊𝒕 = 𝑫𝒊𝒗𝒊𝒕 + 𝑰𝒊𝒕 + 𝚫𝐖𝐂𝒊𝒕 − 𝑪𝒊𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕 … … … (𝒊𝒊)
Where
DEF is financing deficit
342
DIV is dividends
I is investment
ΔWC the difference of working capital of the company added with cash dan cash equivalents
C is cash after tax and interest
ΔD is net debt issued which is issuance of long-term debt subtracted by the payment of the long-
term debt
ΔE is the net equity which is the issuance of shares issuance subtracted by share buyback
The implication of equation (ii) is that at the time of the condition of DEF so it can be met with the
increase of the issuance of debt and equity, so the condition can be formulated in the following equation
(iii), such as:
𝑫𝑬𝑭𝒊𝒕 = 𝑫𝒊𝒗𝒊𝒕 + 𝑰𝒊𝒕 + 𝚫𝐖𝐂𝒊𝒕 − 𝑪𝒊𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕 = ∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 + ∆𝑬𝒊𝒕 … … … (𝒊𝒊𝒊)
The testing of POT is aimed at determining how the company should choose the external source for
financing, due to the issuance of debt as the priority compared with the issuance of equity, thus the
equation becomes the following:
= ∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝑫𝒊𝒗𝒊𝒕 + 𝑰𝒊𝒕 + 𝚫𝐖𝐂𝒊𝒕 − 𝑪𝒊𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕 … … … (𝒊𝒗)
∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜶 + 𝜷𝑷𝑶𝑫𝑬𝑭𝒊𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕 … … … (𝒗)
The model of POT can be predicted that is when the company avoids or the external funding becomes the
final option through the issuance of equity, and in other words it is only through the issuance of debt, then
α = 0 and βPO = 1.
The model of TOT aims to determine the optimal capital structure of the company. Various
results of previous studies have employed this optimal capital structure as the determinants. Darminto and
Manurung (2008) and Dang (2008) stated that the determining factor or determinant (a) the collateral
value of assets (CVAS) which is the book value of fixed assets divided by the book value of total assets,
(b) non-debt tax shield which is the book value depreciation divided by the total assets, (c) profitability
uses EBITDA (earnings before interest tax depreciation and amortization), (d) growth as measured by the
changes in the total assets, and (e) the size of the company measured by Ln of total assets.
343
Ruslim (2009) conducted a study by using the determining factor, namely costs of the operation,
depreciation, the level of sales, costs of sales, interest expense and income tax expense.
The model of TOT by Fama and French (2002) is then described related to the presence of difference
between the target and the actual capital structure, so that it is necessary to make adjustmenttowards these
conditions. The big difference in Dit- D(it-1) it is necessary to make adjustment which is δ. At the time of
the target leverage in the capital structure is not enough to meet the financial needs; the company may
increase the leverage. This capital structure is dynamic so that company needs to make adjustments if the
target capital structure is considered not in accordance with the actual. As there is this adjustment, the
equation is changed as follows:
𝑫𝒊𝒕 − 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏 = 𝜹(𝑫𝒊𝒕∗ − 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏) + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜹(𝑫𝒊𝒕∗ − 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏) + 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜹𝑫𝒊𝒕∗ − 𝜹𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏 + 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜹𝑫𝒊𝒕∗ + 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏(𝟏 − 𝜹) + 𝒆𝒊𝒕 … … … . (𝒊
Where
Ditis as actual debt ratio and Dit* is the debt ratio target of company i in year t, while δ is the rate of
adjustment of the speed of the target leverage after it was found the difference in the reality.
In short, the debt ratio target for the companies is affected by determining factor for the company (X) and
the specific effects of the companies that do not depend on time (U) and λ specific effects of time is not
dependent on the company. The equation for the target leverage can be formulated as follows:
𝑫𝒊𝒕 − 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏 = (∑ 𝜷𝒌𝑿𝒌𝒊𝒕 + 𝑼𝒊 + 𝝀𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
𝒏
𝒌=𝟏
) … … . . (𝒊𝒊)
Various determining factors are significantly affected by the speed of adjustments towards the condition,
so the condition can be formulated as follows:
𝑫𝒊𝒕 − 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏 = 𝜹 (∑ 𝜷𝒌𝑿𝒌𝒊𝒕 + 𝑼𝒊 + 𝝀𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
𝒏
𝒌=𝟏
) … … . . (𝒊𝒊𝒊)
344
If the determining factor is not affected by the company and time excluded from the capital, then:
∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜶 + 𝜷𝑻𝑶𝑻(𝑫𝒊𝒕∗ − 𝑫𝒊𝒕−𝟏) + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
This model may predict that in time of βTA> 0, then the company makes adjustment towards the target
leverage, but it is also when βN< 1, then the cost of the adjustment towards the leverage will be positive
(smaller).
Based on the mode of determining factors by Darminto and Manurung (2008) in static TOT TOT,
then the equation becomes:
∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜶 + 𝜷𝟏 𝑪𝑽𝑨𝑺 + 𝜷𝟐 𝑵𝑫𝑻𝑨 + 𝜷𝟑 𝑬𝑩𝑰𝑻𝑫𝑨 + 𝜷𝟒 𝑮 + 𝜷𝟓 𝑺 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
Where: (a) collateral value of assets (CVAS), (b) non-debt tax shield (NDTA), (c) profitability (earning
before interest tax depreciation and amortization (EBITDA), (d) growth (G), and (e) the size of the
company (S)
Explanation by Shyam-Sunder and Myers can be illustrated in the research findings. It is known
that POT may predict that (α) = 0 and βPO = 1, then the issuance of debt is used to cover the financing
deficit (DEF) or to support POT. If the coefficient on the POT is βPO = 0.75 and R2 is 0.68, then it can be
predicted that POT is more capable to explain the fulfillment of corporate funding than the TOT (68%).
The findings based the coefficient is a target adjustment based on the TOT model, which is not really
reliable to predict the fulfillment the debt financing in the capital structure (35%)
Hypotheses
POT Testing
H1 = following the model by Shyam-Sunder and Myers (1999), if the regression coefficient βPOis positive
and close to 1, then the POT is more capable to explain the changes in the use of debt in the capital
structure
345
TOTTesting
H2 = following the model by Shyam-Sunder and Myers (1999), if the regression coefficient βPO is
positive and close to 1, then the TOT is more capable to explain the changes in the use of debt in the
capital structure
3. Data and Method This study aims to test the hypotheses of TOT and POT models in two different equations. The data in the
study were gathered from statistics and annual report of IDX in 2009. There were 46 companies that
distributed dividends in 2008 (this year was as the base year to discover the changes) and 2009.
Subsequently there were two companies were excluded because the availability of data and the reports
were submitted in US Dollars. From 44 companies, there were 28 companies were excluded because there
was not any financing deficits and the remaining 16 manufacturing companies were used as samples in
this study.
Variable testing
In the POT model, the variable testing can be elaborated through the following aspects:
DEF is the payment for Div, changes in the working capital, the availability of cash and investments
divided by the total assets (Atiyet, 2012. Divis the payment for dividends in year t (Frank and Goyal,
2003); I is the investments, that is the sum of the fixed assets, depreciation, transfer fees and amortization
divided by the total assets (Atiyet, 2012); ΔWC is the changes in the working capital added with the cash
and cash equivalents (Frank and Goyal, 2003); C is the cash after tax and interest (Frank and Goyal,
2003); ΔD is net debt issued which is long-term debt issuance subtracted by the payment for the long-
term debt (Frank and Goyal, 2003); ΔE is the net equity issued which is the issuance of shares subtracted
by share buyback (Frank and Goyal, 2003).
In the static TOT model, the variable testing can be elaborated through the following aspects (Darminto
dan Manurung, 2008):
(a) the collateral value of assets (CVAS) which is the book value of fixed assets divided
by the book value of total assets, (b) non-debt tax shield which is the book value depreciation
divided by the total assets, (c) profitability uses EBITDA (earnings before interest tax
depreciation and amortization), (d) growth as measured by the changes in the total assets, and (e)
the size of the company measured by Ln of total assets.
4. Results and Discussion
4.1. Research Result The description of the data can be presented in the following table:
346
Variable Mean Var
CVAS 0.264619894 0.02196
NTDS 0.208593422 0.01759
EBITDA 2,037,401,648,277 3,128,646,251,823
Growth 0.161038478 0.00545
Size 28.1070276 2.67431
DEF 373,173,079,793 489,655,097,297
Based on the CVAS it showed that the average companies have fixed assets amounted to 26.46% and
with the variance (0.021) of each company is relatively small. The proportion of the fixed assets
compared to the total assets of the company is relatively homogeneous sample. NTDS showed the
average depreciation of the total assets of 20% with the variance 0.017. EBITDA showed the average
income before tax, amortization and depreciation amounted to 2,037,401,648,277 with the variance was
more than 100%. This is an interesting description where the revenue of the companies as samples varies
or significantly varies. This may happen due to some reasons like the sub-sectors in the manufacturing
industry have different income levels. Growth showed the development of the companies than the
previous period with the average of 16.1% and with small variance. The size of the company showed that
the total assets Ln of 28.173 with the variance was relatively small (around 10%), thus it can be
concluded that the total assets of the sample companies are relatively homogeneous.
POT model testing through the following equation
∆𝑫𝒊𝒕 = 𝜶 + 𝜷𝑷𝑶𝑫𝑬𝑭𝒊𝒕 + 𝒆𝒊𝒕
It was gained the following results presented in the table:
347
From the equation was discovered that DEF is significant with the𝜷𝑷𝑶was far more than 1 and 𝜶was not
equal to 0. The next was disclosed the R2 amounted to 0.451.
Those results can be interpreted that the use of debt in the capital structure of the company in Indonesia
significantly prefers POT, but the result was very low due to the coefficient β of POT was far away from
1 and the contribution to the model was only 45.1%.
Coefficientsa
-7,39E-02 ,032 -2,343 ,034
,175 ,052 ,671 3,390 ,004
(Constant)
DEF
Model
1
B Std. Error
Unstandardized
Coeff icients
Beta
Standardi
zed
Coeff icien
ts
t Sig.
Dependent Variable: DDDEa.
Model Summary
,671a ,451 ,412 4,985E-02
Model
1
R R Square
Adjusted
R Square
Std. Error of
the Estimate
Predictors: (Constant), DEFa.
Coefficientsa
-2,5E+12 1,6E+12 -1,567 ,148
8,6E+11 5,0E+11 ,607 1,713 ,117
1,7E+11 5,2E+11 ,106 ,323 ,754
-6,18E-02 ,031 -,922 -1,986 ,075
1,4E+11 7,7E+11 ,049 ,182 ,859
8,6E+10 5,8E+10 ,668 1,487 ,168
(Constant)
CVAS
NTDS
EBITDA
GROWTH
SIZE
Model
1
B Std. Error
Unstandardized
Coeff icients
Beta
Standardi
zed
Coeff icien
ts
t Sig.
Dependent Variable: DDEBTa.
348
TOT model testing with no significant results with the student test (t-test) was noted that the significance
was more than 5%. Those results were the indication that the use of debt in the capital structure does not
comply with the TOT model.
4.2. Discussion The results of regression showed the level of confidence was 5% that the TOT model is not
significant on all variables. This means that debt decisions of the company are not influenced by
determinants such as hypothesis as proposed by Darminto and Manurung (2008) and Dang (2006).
However the result of POT model testing showed significant results despite the fact it could provide
complete elaboration. The POT model with only 45.1% showed that the financing decisions of the
company is based on the order the issuance of debt and equity. In this static POT model does not measure
the speed of adjustment of the level of debt with the assumption determinant variable is particular variable
in a static model
The POT model testing was adopted from the model testing by Shyam-Sunder (1999) and modified by
Frank and Goyal (2003), thus it is assumed that if the internal capital of the company is limited to meet
the funding for investments and dividends, the company would access external funding. External funding
priorities will take precedence to prioritize the issuance of debt compared to equity.
Only variable EBITDA gave negative influence, but not insignificant. These results can be interpreted
that the greater the profit of the company will use smaller debt. This is consistent with the predictions of
POT model which is prioritizing internal financing through retained earnings, and then if the condition of
internal funding is limited, external funding is considerable.
Variable CVAS, NDTS, the growth of the company and the size of the company had positive but not
significant influences. It can be interpreted that at the time of the fixed assets of the company are smaller
than the total assets, so to increase the assets of the company will use debt financing than equity issuance.
Despite the fact these results support the POT model; they were weak to elaborate the POT model as there
were only 45.1% of the companies taking financing decision through debt. This can be explained based
on market timing theory in the decision making of capital structure (Baker and Wurgler, 2002). The
company does not have preference towards the source of funding, but choosing the best alternative is
based on the market opinion at that time. As the market gives negative opinion due to the issuance of
equity, then company would issue debt, and vice versa.
The reaction towards the equity issuance in order to meet the financing of the company can be predicted.
The company will attempt to reduce the asymmetry of information to the market if it will issue equity. In
these conditions, the company will issue equity compared with debt. Constantinides and Grundy (1989)
argued that the information asymmetry is that lead to the weak explanation of the POT model. When there
are many funding alternatives, the company does not always followthe hierarchy on this POT model.
References
349
Amidu, M. 2007. Determinants of Capital Structure of Banks in Ghana: An Empirical Approach. Baltic
Journal of Management Vol 2 Iss 1
Byoun, 2002. Emprical of Dynamic Capital Structure: Pecking Order VS Trade Off. 2002 Proceedings of
the Midwest Business Economics Association
Chen, J. J. 2004. Determinants of capital structure of Chinese-listed companies. Journal of Business
Research, 57(12), 1341-1351
Chen, Lli Ju dan Chen, Shun-Yu. 2010. How the Pecking-Order Theory Explain Capital Structure. Paper
at Chang Jung Christian University, Taiwan.
Darminto dan Manurung, AH. 2008. Pengujian teori Trade Off dan Pecking Order dengan Satu Model
Dinamis pada Perusahaan Publik di Indonesia. Jurnal Manajemen Bisnis Vol 1 No 1 Mei, 2008
Deesomsak, R., Paudyal, K., dan Pescetto, G. 2004. The determinants of Capital Structure: Evidence
from The Asia Pacific Region. Journal of Multinational Financial Management, 14(4–5), 387-405.
Flannery, M.J dan Rangan, K.P. 2006. Partial Adjustment Toward Target Capital Structures. Journal of
Financial Economics 79 (2006) 469 – 506
Frank, M.Z dan Goyal V.K. 2003. Testing the Pecking Order Theory of Capital Structure, Journal of
Financial Economics, 67, pp. 217-248.
Goldstein, Robert; Ju, Nengjiu dan Leland, Hayne. 2001. An Ebit-Based Model of Dynamic Capital
Structure. Journal of Business, 2001, vol. 74, no. 4
Graham, John R. 2000. How Big Are the Tax Benefits of Debt. The Journal of Finance, Vol. 55, No. 5.
(Oct., 2000), pp. 1901-1941
Halov, Nikolay.2006. Dynamics of Asymmetric Information and Capital Structure. Paper Discussion
November 2006, NYU Stern School of Business
Klien, L.S; O’Brien, T.J dan Peters. S.R. 2002. Debt vs Equity and Asymmetric Information: A Review.
The Financial Review 37 (2002) pp 317-350
Kraus dan Litzenberger (1973
Matemilola, BT; Ahmad, Rubi, Kareem, S.D; Mautin O.D dan Sakiru, Oladipo, KS. 2015. Dynamic
Relationship between Debt and Cash Flow in Pecking Order Theory: Evidence From Panel GMM.
Journal of Marketing and Consumer Research Vol 6
Miglo, A. 2010. The Pecking Order, Trade-off, Signaling and Market Timing Theories of Capital
Structure: A Review. MPRA Paper No. 46691, posted 6. May 2013 19:07 UTC
Modigliani, Franco dan Miller, Merton H. 1963. Corporate Income Taxes and the Cost of Capital: A
Correction. The American Economic Review, Vol. 53, No. 3. (Jun., 1963), pp. 433-443
350
Myers S.C dan Majluf N. 1984. Corporate Financing and Investment Decisions when Firms Have
Information that Investors do not Have. Journal of Financial Economics, 13, 187-221
Myers, S.C. 1993. Still Searching for Optimal Capital Structure. Journal of Applied Corporate Finance
Vol 6 Issue 1
Oolderink, Pim. 2010. Determinants of Capital Structure: Static Trade-off Theory vs. Pecking-Order
Theory Evidence from Dutch Listed Firms
Rajan, R.G dan L. Zingales. 1995. What do We Know about Capital Structure? Some Evidence from
International Data. Journal of Finance. 50, 1421-1460
Titman, Sheridan dan Wessels, Roberto. 1988. The Determinants of Capital Structure Choice. The
Journal of Finance, Vol. 43, No. 1. (Mar., 1988), pp. 1-19
Wendells, Thomas Hartmann; Ingrid Stein dan Alwin Stöter. 2012. Tax Incentives and Capital Structure
choice: Evidence From Germany. Discussion Paper Deutsche Bundesbank No 18/2012
351
CREATIVITY AND INNOVATION: CONTRIBUTION OF EMPLOYEE
EMPOWERMENT AND ASTA BRATA LEADERSHIP
Desak Ketut Sintaasih
Management Department, Faculty of Economics and Business,
Udayana University, Indonesia
e-mail: sintaasih@yahoo.com
Ayu Desi Indrawati
Management Department, Faculty of Economics and Business,
Udayana University, Indonesia
Ni Wayan Mujiati
Management Department, Faculty of Economics and Business,
Udayana University, Indonesia
ABSTRACT
Creativity plays a very important role in the implementation of innovation. It is part of
innovation, and innovation is the implementation of the outcome of creativity. This present study
is intended to explore and analyze what employee empowerment and asta brata leadership
contribute to creativity and innovation. It was conducted in the small, micro and middle
manufacturers ‘usaha kecil, mikro dan menengah (hereinafter referred to as UMKM) in Gianyar
Regency, Bali Province. The sample was determined based on a 30-UMKM quota and the
sample in each type of UMKM was proportionally determined. The respondents of the study
totaled 90, 3 from each UMKM. The data were analyzed using PLS.
The result of the study shows that the structural empowerment and asta brata leadership proved
to positively and significantly contribute to creativity. The psychological empowerment proved to
positively but insignificantly contribute to creativity. Creativity proved to positively and
significantly contribute to innovation. The structural empowerment positively but insignificantly
contributed to innovation. The psychological empowerment and asta brata leadership proved to
positively and significantly contribute to innovation. The implication of the study, as far as the
attempt made to inspire creativity and innovation is concerned, is that it is important to empower
the key employees by making them free to develop their innovative ideas when designing
products and having access to the information needed for doing their works.
Keywords: structural empowerment, psychological empowerment, asta brata leadership,
creativity and innovation
352
1. Introduction
As far as the Indonesia’s economic structure is concerned, the small, micro and middle
businesses can importantly strengthen the people’s economy to face the economic crisis. They
should be perpetually strengthened through creativity and innovation in order to maintain their
competitiveness, face the globalized competition which is getting tighter, the rapid technological
development, and the rapid change in the consumer need and desire.
Similarly, the UMKM in Gianyar Regency, especially those which are involved in the
processing industry (manufacturer), are one of the five sectors which have significantly
contributed to the local economy (18.11per cent). As a business sector which uses the local input
and is competitive enough to face the economic crisis, various steps should be taken to inspire
high creativity and innovation especially in presenting the design as the superiority of UMKM,
especially if related to the Balinese local wisdom. It is important for the manufacturing UMKM
to give more attention to the intangible assets such as the human resources, and the other
intellectual assets (Zuhal, 2010). The most successful company is the one which can create
creativity and innovation (Vicenzi, 2000). Creativity has proved to positively and significantly
contribute to innovation (Reychav et al., 2012). It is also affirmed by Alves et al. (2007) that
creativity is part of innovation, and that innovation is the implementation of the outcome of
creativity.
The human resources (employees) of a company can be affected by several factors. Sun
et al. (2012) proved that empowerment significantly contributes to the employee creativity. In
several studies, empowerment is explored from two aspects; they are structural and
psychological aspects (Yang and Choi, 2009; Ayupp and Chung, 2010; Sun et al., 2012). From
the structural perspective, empowerment cannot be separated from the managerial practices
which are intended to delegate power, making decision authority and responsibility to the lower
level in an organization. From the psychological perspective, empowerment is conceptualized in
four cognitions (Spreitzer, 1996 in Sun et al., 2012); they are meaning, competence, self-
determination, and impact.
Apart from the employee empowerment, Garcia-Morales et al. (2008) proved that
transformational leadership positively contributes to innovative behavior. Furthermore, it was
also stated that the transformational leadership contributes to the intrinsic motivation, and
stimulates creativity through a transformational leader, who more effectively and creatively
353
stimulates his/her subordinators to be creative as well (Robbins & Judge, 2015). The
transformational leadership which gives emphasis on individuals is the behavior which
empowers the leader’s subordinators individually to develop and improve their capabilities and
effectiveness. The study conducted by Reuvers et al. (2008) which explored the relationship
between the transformational leadership with the innovative working behavior also proved that
the transformational leadership is positively and significantly related to the innovative working
behavior. In an organization, a leader may contribute to the employee creativity and the
company’s innovation (Jung et al., 2003)
One of the Hindu teachings which contains the highly meaningful leadership philosophy
is what is referred to as the Asta Brata teaching, the eight great natures of Gods. It is guidance to
the teaching of leadership; in other words, it is the humanity-based governing teaching, through
which a leader may attain authority. It can be understood that the basic nature which a leader
should have based on Asta Brata is that he/she should be a model to his/her subordinates. In
addition, he/she should be honest, fair and side with his/her subordinates. This indicates that the
leadership concepts which the Asta Brata leadership contains do not become into existence as a
scientific-academic theory; instead, they have strong roots in regard to both the societal-human
relationship and transcendental relationship with God. As claimed by Dharmanegara et al.
(2013) that the asta brata leadership significantly contributes to the employee performance.
The human resources play a key role in the success achieved by UMKM; therefore, they
should innovate in such a way that they can cope with all the internal affairs of the company and
improve the competitiveness of the products they produce in the market. Soleh (2008) affirms
that the manufacturing UMKM can be improved by implementing the innovative strategy. The
better the innovative strategy is implemented, the better the performance will be.
Based on the empirical studies described above, this present study is intended to analyze
the contribution of empowerment and the asta brata leadership to the creativity and innovation
of the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency to encounter the globalized competition which
is getting tighter and the rapid change in the consumer need and desire. In this relation, the
human resources of a company play a key role in to what extent the UMKM can face such a
change. The problems of the study can be formulated as follows:
1) To what extent the creativity of employees contributes to the manufacturing UMKM;
354
2) To what extent the employee empowerment and asta brata leadership contribute to the
employee creativity of the manufacturing UMKM;
3) To what extent the employee empowerment and asta brata leadership contribute to the
innovation made by the manufacturing UMKM.
Paying attention to the problems of the study formulated above, the objectives of the present
study are: 1) exploring and analyzing the contribution of the employee creativity to the
innovation of the manufacturing UMKM, 2) exploring and analyzing the contribution of the
employee empowerment and asta bratha leadership to the employee creativity; 3) exploring and
analyzing the contribution of the employee empowerment and asta brata leadership to the
innovation of the manufacturing UMKM.
In the following sub sections, the relevant literature review used as the framework of the
hypothesis of the study, the research method, and the discussion of the result of the study are
presented.
2. Literature and Hypothesis
2.1 Creativity and Innovation
The employee creativity is one of the important components of the company which uses
knowledge intensively (Huei Chen and Kaufmann, 2008). Creativity is also important in the
process of innovating a product as well as service. It can contribute to the innovation which is
needed by a company in order to be more competitive than and perform differently from other
companies. Consumers will always look for the products or services of the company which are
not produced or provided by its competitors. There will be no innovation if there is no creativity.
Alves et al. (2007) affirm that creativity is part of innovation, and that innovation is the
implementation of what is creatively produced. Meer (2007) stated that innovation is a set of
activities which are aimed at the new things produced to strengthen the competitiveness of a
company. Guijarro et al. (2009) discussed the variables of innovation from three aspects. They
are (1) the product innovation which includes the change in the product or commercialization of
the new product; 2) the process innovation which includes the change in the manufacturing
process or the use of the new production equipment; and 3) the management innovation which
includes management or administration, purchase and sales.
355
Creativity can be assessed using two main approaches; they are the cognitive approach
and personality approach. Such approaches can measure to what extent someone is creative and
to what extent a process is creative. The personality approach is used to measure the creativity of
a set of attributes or characteristics which are developed at the earlier age and are stable from
time to time (Faizah, 2013). Creativity is an idea or a concept which can lead to a change in a life
activity (Wawan Dhewanto et al., 2014). Munandar (2012) defines creativity into four
dimensions referred to as Four P’s Creativity; they are Person, Process, Press and Product.
As far as the dimension of person is concerned, creativity refers to the ability or
capability which someone has; this is the point in which the three psychological attributes such
as intelligence, cognitive style, and personality or motivation meet. Such three attributes
contribute to the understanding of the background of a creative individual.
The dimension of process focuses on the thinking process which can lead to unique or
creative ideas. Creativity is a process or an ability which reflects fluency, flexibility, original
way of thinking, and the ability to elaborate (to develop, enrich, and specify) things. From what
was defined above, it can be inferred that creativity is a process occurring in the human brain in
order to find out and develop more innovative and varied new concepts (thinking divergence).
From the dimension of press, creativity gives emphasis on the press or motivation.
Motivation can be classified into internal motivation and external motivation. The internal
motivation includes the desire to create things, and the external motivation comes from the social
and psychological environments.
From the dimension of product, creativity focuses on the product or what is produced by
individuals. What is produced can be either a new/original thing or an innovative
combination/elaboration of things. Creativity refers to the ability to produce/create something
new and new combinations which are socially meaningful. Thus, creativity does not only refer to
the creation of a new thing but also to the combination of what has become into existence.
From the definitions given above, it can be stated that creativity refers to a mental process
which causes a new concept or idea to appear, or to a new relationship between the concepts and
ideas which have become into existence. Creativity refers to the ability to create something new;
it refers to the construction of the ideas which can be used to settle problems; it also refers to a
useful activity. Creativity and knowledge are highly important when implementing an innovation
(Wawan Dhwanto et al., 2014).
356
Based on what was empirically described above, hypothesis 1 can be formulated as
follows:
The more creative the employees the more innovated a company will be.
2.2 Employee Empowerment, Creativity and Innovation
The approach of human resources based on initiative, creativity, competence,
autonomous behavior and empowerment has become a very important issue (Tutar et al., 2011).
Empowerment is a process through which someone becomes strong enough to participate in a
company; it affects his/her life. Empowerment means making someone feel appreciated by
involving him/her in the decision making, giving him/her an opportunity to participate in the
planning process, praising him/her, and perpetually giving training and support to him/her
(Lawson, 2006). According to Noe et al. (2006), empowerment means giving responsibility and
authority to an employee to develop a product or serve customers. Empowerment can make a
company close to costumers, able to improve services, send products, improve productivity, and
finally, to win competition (Wibowo, 2010).
By paying attention to the concept of empowerment in the studies discussed above, it
seems that empowerment is analyzed using two approaches; they are organizational approach,
which, according to Sun et al. (2012), is conceptualized as a structural empowerment, and
psychological empowerment. Furthermore, Yang and Choi (2009) stated that empowerment is
explained in 2 (two) ways; they are the situational approach and psychological approach. The
situational approach gives emphasis on the delegation of power from the higher level of
management to employees by making them involved in the decision making process. Such an
approach is also known as the rational approach or managerial approach.
From the structural approach, empowerment focuses on the policy and practice
implemented by the management intended to delegate power, decision making authority, and
responsibility to the lower level in an organization. According to Seibert et al. (2004) in Sun et al
(2012), the structural empowerment is the atmosphere of empowerment, representation of the
employee perception of the managerial structure, and the policy and practice which are related to
empowerment.
In the study conducted by Ayupp and Chung (2010), it was stated that the effective
program of empowerment is paying attention to important factors such as various types of
357
information, implementation of the participatory working environment, and performance-based
appreciation. Furthermore, it is stated that the management should pay attention to
communication, partnership, participation, training, and appreciation for the employees to make
sure that they feel empowered.
The atmosphere of the structural empowerment implemented in a company allows it to
develop the skill and creativity of its employees. The support from the working environment is
needed for mutual interaction and information exchange in order to obtain creative ideas. In a
company the creative ideas tend to vary; the diverse ideas produced and developed by employees
and individuals can be combined to complete one another. In this way, the strength and
weakness of the ideas produced by such individuals can be maximized in order to improve
creativity, and cope with the problem which the company faces. Isaksen and Lauer (2002) (in
Wawan Dhewanto et al., 2014), identified the main factors which give contribution to creativity
and collaborative atmosphere, some of which are confidence, team motivation, leadership, and
participation in making decisions. It is also stated that creativity and knowledge are highly
important in the implementation of an innovation (Wawan Dhewanto et al., 2014), and that
creativity is part of an innovation, and that an innovation is the implementation of the outcome of
creativity (Alves et al, 2007). Kahreh et al. (2011), in his study, viewed empowerment from to
what extent the autonomy given affects competitiveness from the innovation dimension.
Based on what was discussed in the sub section above, hypothesis 2 and 3 can be
formulated as follows.
Hypothesis 2: The better the structural empowerment the better the employee creativity
will be.
Hypothesis 3: The better the structural empowerment the better the employee innovation
will be.
From the psychological perspective, empowerment gives emphasis on the motivational
process of an employee. The psychological approach views that empowerment is a psychological
cognition which contributes to the improvement of intrinsic motivation (Yang and Choi, 2009).
Furthermore, Spreitzer (1996) in Sun et al. (2012) affirmed that the psychological empowerment
is conceptualized into four cognitions; they are meaning, competence, self-determination, and
impact. From the meaning aspect, the psychological empowerment reflects the meaning or value
358
of employment to the employee life objective. From the competence aspect, the psychological
empowerment is related to what extent an employee is confident about his/her ability in doing
his/her work. From the self-determination aspect, the psychological empowerment is related to
the autonomy and independence which an employee has to do his/her work. From the impact
aspect, the psychological empowerment refers to the impact which an employee has to control
employment in the organization. Chiang and Hsieh (2012) constructed the psychological
empowerment into four aspects which are measured using four indicators. Such aspects of
empowerment can be described as follows.
1) The psychological empowerment from the meaning aspect can be measured using three
indicators; they are (1) the work I do is very important to me; (2) my job activities are personally
meaningful to me, and (3) the work I do is meaningful to me.
2) The psychological empowerment from the competence aspect is also measured using three
indicators; they are (1) I am confident about my ability to do my job; (2) I am self-assured about
my capabilities to perform my work activities; and (3) I have mastered the skills necessary for
my job.
3) If viewed from the self-determination aspect, the psychological aspect is measured from two
indicators; they are (1) I can decide on my own how to go about doing my work; (2) I have
considerable opportunity for independence and freedom in how I do my job.
4) Finally, from the impact aspect, the psychological empowerment is measured using three
indicators; they are (1) my impact on what happens in my department is large; (2) I have a great
deal of control over what happens in my department; (3) I have significant influences over what
happens in my department.
As to the relationship between the psychological empowerment and creativity, Sun et al.
(2012) proved that the psychological empowerment significantly affects the creativity of
subordinates. This indicates that when an employee feels that his/her job is meaningful or
valuable to his/her life objective, and he/she is supported by his/her competence, then he/she will
be made to be creative in doing when he/she is supposed to do by the company. Similarly, when
he/she has autonomy and independence, he/she will feel motivated to do what he/she is supposed
to do. As stated by Wawan Dhewanto et al. (2014) that creativity and knowledge are highly
important when implementing an innovation. Furthermore, Alves et al. (2007) affirmed that
creativity is part of innovation, and that innovation is the implementation of the outcome of
359
creativity. Based on the empirical evidences and the analysis of concepts described above, the
following hypothesis can be formulated as follows.
Hypothesis 4: The better the employee psychological empowerment, the better the
employee creativity will be.
Hypothesis 5: The better the employee psychological empowerment, the better the
employee innovation will be.
2.3 Asta Brata Leadership, Creativity and Innovation
Leadership is the capability of affecting one group of people in order to achieve a vision or a set
of objectives already determined (Robbins and Judge, 2015). A leader determines whether an
organization or company will be successful or fail. As far as the theories of modern leadership
are concerned, Luthans (2006) proposes the theory of transformational leadership to which many
researchers have paid attention (Reuvers et al., 2008; Garcia-Morales et al., 2008). The
transformational leaders greatly affect their subordinates (Robbins and Judge, 2015). Luthans
(2006), who quoted the study conducted by Bass (1990), mentioned four characteristics of the
transformational leadership. They are 1) charisma which includes vision and mission, being able
to contribute to pride, being respected and trusted; 2) being inspired, which is shown by
communicating high expectations, using symbols to focus on what is undertaken, expressing
important objectives in a simple fashion; 3) intellectual simulation, meaning that a leader should
show intelligence and rationality, and should solve problems carefully; and (4) paying attention
to individuals, meaning that a leader should show attention to personals, and treat, train and
advise employees individually.
A transformational leader is made to be more creative by his/her creativity; in addition he/she
should also motivate his/her subordinates to be creative as well (Robbins & Judge, 2015). The
companies headed by the transformational leaders have more decentralized responsibilities; they
tend to take more risks, and compensation is aimed at achieving the long term outcome. The
transformational leadership which gives emphasis on individuals is a behavior which
individually empowers subordinates to develop and improve their self-effectiveness.
360
In Hinduism, the philosophy of leadership is explained using the terms which are highly
meaningful, one of which is what is referred to as Asta Brata, the eight great natures of Gods.
Asta Brata is guidance to the leadership teaching or the humanity-based leadership teaching. It
can be found in Kekawin Ramayana (the Old Javanese Poetry of Ramayana) written by a great
poet named Walmiki. The Asta Brata was taught by King Rama to Wibhisana in the framework
of the succession of the Alengka royal kingdom after Rahwana was killed (Yasasusastra, 2011).
In Yasasusastra (2011), the natures of Almighty God, Ida Hyang Widhi Wasa, which are used as
the people’s strength, are further discussed. All leaders should have such natures. Lord Indra,
Lord Yama, Lord Surya, Lord Chandra, Lord Anila/Bayu, Lord Kuwera, and Lord Agni are the
eight lords which constitute the body of a leader. They are all referred to as Asta Brata (Kariyadi,
2013). Furthermore, Wiratmaja (1995) affirmed that the eight strengths which constitute the
body (ability) of a leader are the strengths which cannot be separated from one another in their
implementations. If they are implemented as a totality, then Asta Brata will greatly contribute to
the authority which a leader has; therefore, it will be easy for him/her to motivate his/her
subordinates to do their respective obligation. They all reflect the ideal behaviors of a king or
leader and are the manifestations of the great natures of Gods. In Ariastha (1999), it is stated that
Asta Brata means the main leadership eight teachings instructed by Sri Rama to Bharata who
was crowned the King of Ayodya. Asta Brata is symbolized using the great natures of the
universe which need to be referred to as guidance by a leader.
The eight components of Asta Brata are as follows (Wiratmaja, 1995; Ariasna, 1999;
Yasasusastra, 2011):
1) Indra Brata
Indra is the synonym of Apah, that is, the God’s nature which takes care of everything. Lord
Wisnu/Lord Indra is the King of Water, who waters the hot and exhausted world. What is meant
is that a leader who implements Indra Brata does his/her best to fulfill the food and clothing
needed by his/her subordinates, as what Lord Indra, who gives rain and water, does, allowing the
plants and creatures on earth to be alive.
2) Yama Brata
In the mythology Lord Yama is the manifestation of the God’s power which takes life, and in
Asta Brata he symbolizes a leader who should punish those who have made mistakes. Based on
361
the karmic law, punishment should be educative; it should be intended to repair mistakes,
making a subordinator do what he/she is supposed to do.
3) Surya Brata
A leader should have the natures which the sun has (Sûrya); he/she should be able to motivate
and give strength to life which extraordinarily fluctuates and to be the source of energy. From
Surya Brata it can be inferred that a leader should give enlightenment and strength to his/her
subordinates. As the sun which rises to eliminate the world’s darkness, subordinates should be
made to be really aware of their responsibilities, meaning that they do what they are supposed to
do without many instructions.
4) Casi Brata
Casi or Candra is the moon which gives cool and comfortable illumination at night to the
universe and all creatures. A leader should have the natures which the moon has, namely, he/she
should give illumination to his/her subordinators who are in darkness through a cool and
sympathetic appearance to make them feel comfortable and safe. Someone will be happy and
faithful if what he/she needs materially and spiritually can be fulfilled.
5) Bayu Brata
A leader should be like the wind; he/she should always be among the members of his/her
organization; he/she should give freshness and always know the problems which the society he
leads faces. He/she should be able to identity everything which his/her subordinators have in
mind; he/she should be able to understand the difficulties which his/her subordinates have in
regard to their lives and what they are supposed to do. Bayu (the wind) shows strong opinions
which cannot be disturbed by egoism. He/she should pay attention to the graph describing how
the initiatives of his/her subordinators are and how active they are when they do their activities.
6) Dhanaba Brata
Dhanaba Brata is usually referred to as Kuwera Brata. Kuwera is Lord of Wealth. A leader
should have the natures which the earth mainly have, that is, he/she should be the basis where
his/her subordinators step on; he/she should give everything he/she has for the prosperity of
his/her subordinators. The meaning which such a teaching contains is that a leader should satisfy
his/her subordinators physically and spiritually; he/she should always pay attention to the
prosperity of his/her subordinators. He/she should organize that everything is neatly done, and
should be a model for his/her subordinators.
362
7) Paça Brata
Paça refers to Lord Baruna or Lord of Sea who has a highly powerful weapon called Nagapasa.
What makes a leader powerful is the wide knowledge he/she has. He/she should have the nature
which the ocean has; he/she should have a wide insight; he should be able to cope with every
fluctuation wisely and properly. He/she should be wise. Having wide knowledge and being
friendly are required in order to be wise. He/she should be wise, listen to the conscience or
opinion of his/her subordinators, and should be able to make accurate inferences; as a result,
his/her subordinators will feel satisfied. In addition, they will be easily made to complete what
they are supposed to do.
8) Agni Brata
Agni Brata means that a leader should always be motivated and should also be able to motivate
his/her subordinators in such a way that they are easily made to do what they are responsible for.
He/she should have the nature with the fire has, that is, he/she should be able to motivate his/her
subordinators to participate in everything; he/she should maintain his/her principles strongly and
punish those who make mistakes objectively.
If further contemplated, it is no exaggeration to say that Asta Brata should be used as
guidance by a leader. It greatly affects management. By observing again the concepts of
leadership, especially the concept of the transformational leadership, as stated by Bass in
Luthans (2006), it seems that such a concept of leadership is identical with the basic natures
which a leader should have in Asta Brata. Robbins and Judge (2015: 262) describe a model
leadership which shows which leadership is effective and which one is not. From such a model,
it is explained that a transformational leader is more effective as he/she is creative; in addition,
he/she also motivates his/her subordinators to do what they are supposed to do. In this relation, it
can be understood that a leader should at least have the following characteristics: a) he/she
should be a model for his/her subordinators, b) he/she should be honest and fair, and c) he/she
should side with his/her subordinators. This indicates that the concepts of leadership which Asta
Brata contains are not created as a scientific-academic theory, but it is strongly rooted in the
societal and human relationship and in the transcendental relationship with God.
In relation to innovation, Reuvers et al. (2008) analyzed the relationship between the
transformational leadership with the innovative working behavior. The result of the study they
conducted showed that there was a significant and positive relationship between the
363
transformational leadership and the innovative working behavior. Garcia-Morales et al. (2008)
proved through their study that the transformational leadership positively contributed to the
innovative behavior. Furthermore, it was stated that through the intellectual stimulation, the
transformational leader contributes to the intrinsic motivation and stimulates creativity.
Creativity and knowledge are two highly important aspects of innovation, and innovation is the
implementation of what is creatively produced (Alves et al., 2007). The leader of an organization
can contribute to the creativity of his/her employees and the company innovation (Jung et al.,
2003).
Based on what was described above, hypothesis 6 and 7 can be formulated as follows:
Hypothesis 6: The better the implementation of the Asta Brata leadership, the better the
employee creativity will be.
Hypothesis 7: The better the implementation of the Asta Brata leadership, the better the
employee innovation will be.
3. Research Method
3.1 Research Variables and Their Measurements
The variables of the present study are made up of the hexogen variable and endogen
variable. The hexogen variable includes the Structural Empowerment (X1), the Psychological
Empowerment (X2), and the Astra Brata Leadership (X3). The endogen variable includes
Creativity (Y1) and Innovation (Y2). Each variable is an unobserved variable which is measured
using several indicators. Each indicator is made up of several items, which are presented in the
form of items of question in the research instrument as the observed variable.
Operating definition of variables
1) Creativity (Y1) is the ability which employees have to create, repair and combine things as
their responsibilities using the experiences, skills and knowledge they have to make their jobs
valuable to the company. The variable of creativity is measured using four indicators referred to
as Four P’s of Creativity such as person, process, press, and product (Rhodes in Munandar,
2009).
2) Innovation (Y2); in this present study, it refers to a set of activities done by the key human
resources of the manufacturing UMKM which are aimed at introducing new things which
364
strengthen the company competitiveness, the product innovation, the process innovation, and the
managerial innovation (Meer,, 2007 and Guijarro et al., 2009).
3) The Structural Empowerment (X1); in this present study, it refers to the employee
empowerment which focus on the policy and practice implemented by the manufacturing
UMKM management which are intended to delegate power, the authority of making decisions
and taking responsibilities, to give support to the employees, and to facilitate the access to
information for the key employees related to their jobs (Sun et al., 2012; Lawson, 2006).
4) The psychological empowerment (X2); in this present study, it refers to the empowerment
which is conceptualized into four cognitions; they are meaning, competence, self-determination,
and impact (Chiang and Hsieh, 2012; Tutar et al., 2011).
5) The Asta Brata leadership (X3); in this present study, it refers to the leadership which
exemplifies the essential natures of Almighty God, Hyang Widhi, which are implemented as a
totality which greatly contributes to the great authority which a leader has; as a result, he/she can
easily activate the human resources, especially his/her subordinators when doing their jobs
(Wiratmaja, 1955; Yasasusastra, 2011; Kariyadi, 2013). Such eight natures are referred to as
follows: Indra Brata, Yama Brata, Surya Brata, Casi Brata, Bayu Brata, Dhanaba Brata or
Kuwera Brata, Paça Brata, and Agni Brata.
The variables of the present study are measured using the Likert Scale with the interval of
assessment which starts from score 1 (completely disagreeing) to score 5 (strongly agreeing).
Each indicator of the variable made up of several items is measured using the average value.
3.2 Population, Sample, and Research Respondent
This present study was conducted at the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency, Bali
Province. The manufacturing UMKM includes wood craft, rattan craft, precious metal craft,
textile industry, batik and tenun ikat industries. The samples were taken using the quota sampling
approach, totaling 90 key human resources taken from 30 manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar
Regency.
3.3 Types, Sources and Method of Collecting Data
The data needed in the present study include the qualitative and quantitative data. The
quantitative data include the number of UMKM, the number of employees, the respondents’
365
ages. The qualitative data include the in-depth descriptions of the respondents’ perception of
creativity, innovation, structural empowerment, psychological empowerment, and the asta brata
leadership. The data were taken from the primary and secondary data sources. The primary data
source included the research respondents, and the secondary data source included the Center of
Statistics (Badan Pusat Statistik ‘BPS’) and the Bank of Indonesia’s publications in the
Economic and Financial Statistics of Bali Province. The data were collected through the research
instrument (questionnaire) and interview.
Before the research instrument was used to collect the data, its validity and reliability
were examined. The product moment correlation was used to examine the validity of the
instrument. The instrument is stated to be valid if the coefficient value of the correlation between
the score for each item of question and the total score for every variable is positive and higher
than 0.30 or r > 0.30. The reliability of the internal consistency was used to examine the
reliability of the instrument in which Alpha Cronbach (ά) was calculated. The research
instrument is stated to be reliable if the score for the Alpha Cronbach is higher than 0.60
(ά≤0.60).
The result of the examination of the instrument validity proved that the instrument can be
stated to be valid as the coefficient value between the score for each item of question and the
total score for every variable showed that the coefficient value was higher than 0.30 (r > 0.30).
Similarly, the result of the reliability of the instrument proved that the instrument can be stated to
be reliable, as the value of the Alpha Cronbach for every variable is higher than 0.60 (ά ≤ 0.60).
3.4 Data Analysis Technique
This present study employed the quantitative approach supported with the descriptive
analysis. The technique of analysis used was the variance-based structural equation model or
what is referred to as Component-based SEM, namely, the Partial Least Square (PLS).
4. Results
4.1 General Description of UMKM Used as Sample
UMKM plays a strategic role in the economic growth and supports the government’s
program to create job opportunities. The competition which is getting tighter and the fact that
there are more and more overseas products and services have been challenges to UMKM,
366
especially the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency. What has seriously challenged the
manufacturing UMKM is how to survive such an uncertain situation. Those who are involved in
UMKM should be creative and innovative to make use of the opportunities available.
Those who were used as the samples of the study were creative and innovative enough to
make use of the opportunities available in order to survive. In this present study, innovation
includes the innovation in creating new products and modifying the existing products. In the last
two years, several manufacturers created new products which had never been produced before
such as lamp shades, ketzel painting, silver bracelets with the black dragon as the motive,
bracelets with what is called cangkang kerang as the motive, Balinese carved bracelets with the
face as the motive, bracelets with red garnet as the stone, dragon bones, rings with the topaz blue
stone flower as the motive, and so forth.
Such products are marketed in local markets and are exported. Out of the UMKM used as
the samples in the present study, 7 (23 percent) market their products in domestic markets, while
23 (77 percent), the rest, market their products in local markets and overseas.
4.2 Respondents’ Characteristics
The respondents of the present study were the employees who played key roles in the
success achieved by the Manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency, totaling 90. Based on the
result of the study, it was identified that the dominant employees were females (84 percent). This
indicates that the UMKMs involved in the creative industry were activated by mothers. If viewed
from their ages, they were between 20 and 50 years of age. Most of them (62 percent) were
senior high school graduates; some (8 percent) were university graduates. However, viewed from
their working experience, they had been involved in the manufacturing business for a relatively
long time. Out of them, 21 (23 percent) had been involved in the manufacturing business for 11 –
15 years, and 16 percent were involved in the creative industry for more than 20 years.
4.3 Results of Data Analysis
In the present study, PLS with Program SmartPLS was used to analyze the data. Based
on the result of the data analysis, the empirical model of research was produced as shown in
Figure 1 as follows.
367
Based on what is shown in the Figure 1, the result of the outer model is described in order to
identify the validity and reliability of the indicators used to measure the latent variable. In
addition, the evaluation of the inner model is also described in order to identify whether the
accuracy of the model and the result of the examination of the research hypothesis.
1) The Result of the Outer Model
The evaluation of the outer model was used to examine the validity and reliability of the
indicators used to measure the construct or the latent variable. In this present study, the variable
of the Structural Empowerment (X1), the Psychological Empowerment (X2), Creativity (Y1),
and Innovation (Y2) are classified as the outer model with reflective indicators, whereas the
variable of the Asta Brata leadership (X3) is classified as the formative outer model. In the
reflective outer model, evaluation was made by examining the convergent and discriminant
validity of the indicator and the composite reliability of the indicator block. In the variable of the
formative outer model, evaluation was made based on the relative weight. The results of the
evaluation of the outer model are described as follows.
(1) Convergent Validity
368
The result of the examination of the outer model showed that the outer loading of every
indicator of the Structural Empowerment variable (X1), the Psychological Empowerment (X2),
Creativity (Y1), and Innovation (Y2) is higher than 0.5; in addition, it also showed that the T-
statistics is higher than 0.96 (the critical point in the 5% alpha), meaning that all the indicators
are valid for measuring the variables.
The evaluation of the measurement of the Asta Brata Leadership variable (X3), if viewed
from the Outer Weights, showed that the T-statistics of several indicators (X3.2, X 3.4, X 3.5, X
3.6, X 3.7) is less than 1.96, meaning that it is insignificant. However, in relation to this, it is
impossible to delete the insignificant formative indicator. The reason is that if the insignificant
formative indicator were deleted, then the essence of the construct would change (Hair et al.,
2013 in Sholihin and Ratmoni, 2013). Therefore, if viewed from the outer loading, the validity of
the construct shows that all the indicators of the Asta Brata Leadership variable are higher than
0.5 and the T-statistics is higher than 1.96, meaning that all the indicators are valid for measuring
the variable.
(2) Discriminant Validity
The discriminant validity was examined by comparing the score for the square root of
average variance extracted (AVE) of every variable with the correlation among the other latent
variables in the model. The related data are presented in Table 1.
Table 1 The score for the square root of average variance extracted (AVE) of every variable and
correlation among the variables
Variables AVE √AVE Innovation Asta Brata
Leadership
Creativity Psychological
Empowerment
Structural
Empowerment
Innovation 0.8067 08.898
3
1
Asta Brata
Leadership
0.7519 0.8671 0.8272 1
Creativity 0.8835 0.9399 0.8446 0.8009 1
Psychological
Empowerment
0.7597 0.8716 0.8397 0.7226 0.7728 1
Structural
Empowerment
0.9319 0.9653 0.8051 0.7377 0.8513 0.8065 1
Based on the data in Table 4.8, it can be identified that the AVE values of the five
variables which were analyzed are higher than 0.5, and that the AVE root value of every variable
is higher than the correlation among the variables, meaning that the latent variables such as the
369
Innovation variable (Y2), the Creativity variable (Y1), the Psychological Variable (X1), the
Structural Empowerment variable, and the Asta Brata leadership variable predict that their
indicators are better than the other latent variable indicators. Based on the result of such an
analysis, it can be explained that the discriminant validity of the model is enough.
(3) Composite Reliability
The composite reliability was used to examine the values of the reliability among the
indicator blocks of the Structural Empowerment variable (X1), the Psychological Empowerment
variable (X2), the Creativity variable (Y1), the Innovation variable (Y2), and the Asta Brata
Leadership variable (X3) which form it. The values of the Composite Reliability are presented in
Table 2 as follows.
Table 2 The Values of the Composite Reliability
Variables Composite Reliability
Innovation (Y2) 0.943286
Creativity (Y1) 0.968081
Structural Empowerment (X1) 0.976200
Psychological Empowerment (X2) 0.926646
Asta Brata Leadership (X3) 0.960010
Based on the values of the Composite reliability as presented in Table 4.9, it can be identified
that the values of all the research variables are higher than 0.70, meaning that the indicator
blocks are reliable for measuring the variables.
Based on the results of the evaluation of the convergent and discriminant validity of the
indicators and the composite reliability of the indicator blocks, it can be inferred that the
indicators used to measure the Structural Empowerment variable (X1), the Psychological
Empowerment variable (X2), the Creativity variable (Y1), and the Innovation variable (Y2) are
valid and reliable, meaning that the goodness of fit model can be identified by evaluating the
inner model.
2) Result of the Structural Model (Inner Model)
The structural model is evaluated by referring to Q2 predictive relevance model, and is
based on the coefficient of the determination of all the dependent variables. The value of Q2
370
ranges 0 < Q2 < 1, meaning that the closer to the value 1 the better the model will be. The
determination coefficients (R2) of the dependent variables are presented in Table 3.
Based on the value of R2, Q
2 can be identified based on the following calculation:
Q2 =
1 – (1-R12) (1 – R2
2)
= 1 – (1-0832511)(1-0.79488) = 0.9656 = 0.97
Table 3 The Value of R-Square (R2)
Variable R Square
Innovation 0.832511
Creativity 0.79488
The fact that the value of Q2 is 0.97 proves that the goodness of fit of the structural model is
very good. This result reflects that 97% of the information which the data contain can be
explained by the model, and that the rest, 3%, can be explained by the error and the other
variables which are not included in the model.
3) Result of the Examination of Hypothesis
The hypothesis was examined using t-test in every lane of the partial impact of the
variables. The result of the path coefficient test in every lane is presented in Table 4 as follows.
Table 4 The Result of Hypothesis Examination
Relationship among Variables
Original
Sample (O)
T Statistics
(│O/STERR│)
Remarks
The Structural Empowerment (X1) Creativity (Y1) 0.494168 4.287788 Significant
Psychological Empowerment (X2) Creativity (Y1) 0.110215 1.281721 Insignificant
Asta Brata Leadership (X3) Creativity (Y1) 0.347938 3.302404 Significant
Creativity (Y1) Innovation (Y2) 0.261187 2.418521 Significant
Structural Empowerment (X1) Innovation (Y2) 0.024062 0.256907 Insignificant
Psychological Empowerment (X2) Innovation (Y2) 0.334554 3.492114 Significant
Asta Brata Leadership (X3) Innovation (Y2) 0.374291 3.458552 Significant
Based on what is presented in Table 4, the result of the hypothesis examination can be described
as follows.
371
The Structural Empowerment (X1) turns out to positively and significantly contribute to
Creativity (Y1), as shown by the value of lane coefficient, that is, 0.494168; the T-statistical
value is 4.287788, which is higher than the T-critical value, that is, 1.96, meaning that the better
the structural empowerment, the better the employee creativity will be, and that hypothesis 1 in
which it was stated that the structural empowerment positively and significantly contributed to
the creativity of human resources can be proved.
It is evidenced that the Psychological Empowerment (X2) positively but insignificantly
contributes to Creativity (Y1), as shown by the fact that the lane coefficient value is 0.110215
and the T-statistical value is equal to 1.281721, which is lower than the T-critical value, which is
1.96, meaning insignificance. Thus, hypothesis 2 in which it was stated that the psychological
empowerment significantly contributed to creativity cannot be evidenced.
The Asta Brata leadership (X3) turns out to contribute positively and significantly to
Creativity (Y1), as shown by the lane coefficient, that is, 0.347938, and the T-statistical value,
that is, 3.302404, which is higher than the t-critical value, which is 1.96. Thus, it can be inferred
that the better the implementation of the asta brata leadership the better the employee creativity
will be, meaning that the asta brata leadership significantly contributes to creativity can be
evidenced.
Creativity (Y1) turns out to positively and significantly contribute to Innovation (Y2).
The result of the data analysis shows that the lane coefficient is 0.261187 and that the T-statistics
value is equal to 2.418521, which is lower than the T-critical value, which is 1.96. Such a result
of examination indicates that the better the creativity, the better the innovation will be. Thus,
hypothesis 4 in which it was stated that creativity significantly affected creativity can be
evidenced.
The Structural Empowerment (X1) turns out to positively but insignificantly affect
Innovation (Y2), as can be identified from the lane coefficient, which is 0.024062, and the T-
Statistical value, which is equal to 0.256907, which is lower than the T-critical value, which is
1.96. Thus, hypothesis 5 in which it was stated that the structural empowerment significantly
affected innovation cannot be evidenced.
The Psychological Empowerment (X2) positively and significantly contributes to
Innovation (Y2), as shown by the lane coefficient value, which is 0.334554 and the T-statistical
value, that is, 3.492114, which is higher than the T-critical value, that is, 1.96. Thus, hypothesis
372
6 in which it was stated that the psychological empowerment significantly affected innovation
can be evidenced.
The Asta Brata leadership (X3) positively and significantly contributes to Innovation
(Y2). Based on the result of data analysis obtained from the lane coefficient value, which is
0.374291, and the T-statistical value, which is 3.458552 and higher than the T-critical value,
which is 1.96, hypothesis 7, in which it was stated that the Asta Brata leadership significantly
affected innovation can be evidenced.
5. Discussion
5.1 Impact of the Structural Empowerment on the Employee Creativity
Based on the result of the examination of hypothesis, it can be evidenced that the
structural empowerment positively and significantly contributes to creativity, meaning that the
better the structural empowerment which is felt by the key human resources of the manufacturing
UMKM, the more creative they will be. This indicates that the key human resources in the
manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency has been well empowered, as can be identified from
the support given by the companies by appreciating the innovative ideas given and attempts
made by the key employees in their jobs. In addition, opportunities are given to them to improve
their skills through internal trainings and the access to information. In addition, the support given
to the employees to develop their innovative ideas for their jobs has also improved their
creativities in creating new products, repairing the existing products, or making new
combinations as their responsibilities. The empowerment which is felt by the employees can
make them more motivated as the creative concepts proposed to the companies for which they
work are appreciated. The companies also appreciate the concepts proposed by their employees
as they are meaningful to the achievement of the companies’ objectives.
The result of the study is supported by the result of the study conducted by Ayupp and
Chung (2010) in which they affirmed that the effective empowerment program pays attention to
important factors such as various types of information, the implementation of the participatory
working environment and the performance-based appreciation. The atmosphere in which the
structural empowerment is implemented in a company can develop the skills and creativities of
its employees. Isaksen and Lauer (2002) (in Wawan Dhewanto et al., 2014), stated that the main
factors such as confidence, team motivation, and participation in making decisions contribute to
creativity.
373
5.2 Impact of the Psychological Empowerment on the Employee Creativity
The result of the hypothesis examination proved that the psychological empowerment
positively but insignificantly contributes to creativity, meaning that the better the psychological
empowerment which is felt by the employees, the better their creativities will be. However, such
an empowerment does not give any real contribution. The result of the study proves that the
psychological empowerment which is felt by the key employees in the manufacturing UMKM in
Gianyar Regency can be classified as good. In this present study, there are four cognitions which
reflect the psychological empowerment; they are meaning, competence, self-determination, and
impact. Among the four aspects, the aspect of meaning turns out to be the strongest indicator
which shows such an empowerment, meaning that there is an opinion that the jobs done by the
employees are important and highly meaningful to themselves. This is completed with
competence, that is, being confident about the ability and skill which someone has to be able to
do his/her job perfectly. Such a condition of empowerment positively contributes to the
employee creativity.
In this case, creativity mainly refers to the good motivation which someone has as the
company for which he/she works highly appreciates the creative concepts he/she proposes. In
addition, the company also appreciates the concepts given by its employees which can make the
achievement of the company’s objective more valuable. Creativity is also related to the personal
human resources who creatively make new combinations in their jobs, making the products
produced more valuable to the company. Apart from that creativity is also related to the
improved ways of doing someone’s job as his/her responsibility, making the products produced
more valuable to the company.
In this case, the result of the present study does not support the result of the study
conducted by Sun et al. (2012) as far as the contribution of the psychological empowerment to
creativity is concerned. In this present study, it turns out that the psychological empowerment
significantly contributes to the creativity of subordinators. It is affirmed that one employee who
feels that his/her job is meaningful and valuable to the objective of his/her life, strengthened by
the competence he/she has, will become more creative in his/her job.
5.3 Impact of the Asta Brata Leadership on the employee creativity
374
In this present study it is proved that the Asta Brata leadership positively and
significantly contributes to creativity. This indicates that the better the implementation of the
asta brata, the better the employee creativity will be. In this present study, the asta brata
leadership is perceived of being good, and the employee creativity is too, as indicated by the
Casi Brata. In this relation, the company’s leader welcomes the opinion given by his/her
subordinators and appreciates every achievement achieved by his/her subordinators. In addition,
he/she always behaves pleasantly. Apart from that, the surya brata also shows that the asta brata
leadership is perceived of being good. In this case, the leader supervises his/her subordinates
well and clearly, making them aware of they are supposed to be able to do their jobs. If further
observed from the descriptive analysis, it seems that the good leadership can also be seen from
the Paca Brata-Baruna aspect. The company’s leader is willing to listen to what his/her
subordinators complain of. In addition, he/she does his/her best to settle any problems properly,
as reflected by the Agni Brata. If one employee breaks any regulation already stipulated, then
the leader will punish him/her proportionally.
Such a condition of leadership affects the employee creativity; the employees feel
motivated as their creative opinions are appreciated. This is valuable to the achievement of what
is aimed at by the company. In addition, creativity is also shown by the creative employees. The
new combinations they make and the ways in which they complete their jobs are valuable to the
company. Creativity is also shown by the employees by creating products with different designs,
and doing their jobs innovatively. In this way, they can contribute to the company. From the
process, the creativity of the key employees is shown by the product designs they propose and
the way in which they do their jobs which is different from that which used to be implemented
by the company. In this way, what they do will be more valuable to the company.
5.4 Impact of the Employee Creativity on Innovation
Based on the result of the examination of hypothesis, it is proved that creativity positively
and significantly contributes to innovation, meaning that the better the employee creativity, the
better the innovation will be. As explained in the descriptions of the variables, the creativity of
the employees of the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency can be classified as good
(creative), indicated by the fact that they feel motivated to do their jobs as the companies for
which they work highly appreciate the creative opinions they propose. In addition, the companies
375
for which they work also highly contribute to the ideas they propose. This contributes to the
achievement of what is aimed at by the companies. The employee creativity is also shown by the
fact that the employees creatively make new combinations when they do their jobs. Apart from
that, they also improve the ways in which they do their jobs. The outcome makes the products
they produce more meaningful to the companies.
The creativity of the key employees is also shown by creating creative product designs,
the innovative ways in which they do their jobs. From the process point of view, the key
employees propose different product designs and the ways in which they do their jobs is different
from the ways in which they did their jobs before, meaning that what they do will be more
valuable to the companies. The creativity which is shown by the key employees of the
manufacturing UMKM can lead to innovative products, innovative processes and innovative
management which can strengthen the companies’ competitiveness.
In relation to the process innovation, the employees show innovation by improving the
product making process using newer tools in order to produce the products which can be
accepted by the market. As far as the product innovation is concerned, the product design is
modified, the main and supporting raw materials are used, the same as before. In this product
innovation, the uniqueness of the Balinese local culture is also shown; the main raw materials are
modified and the supporting ones are too; the objective is to produce innovative products.
The result of the present study supports the study conducted by Alves et al. (2007) in
which it was stated that creativity is part of innovation, and that innovation is the implementation
of the outcome of creativity. It is also supported by the study conducted by Wawan Dhewanto et
al. (2014) in which it is stated that creativity and knowledge are highly important when
implementing an innovation.
5.5 Impact of the Structural Empowerment on Innovation
This present study proves that the structural empowerment positively but insignificantly
contributes to innovation, meaning that the better the structural empowerment which covers
authority delegated to subordinators, the better support given by the companies, and the better
access to information, the more innovative the employees will be. As presented in the description
of variables, the structural empowerment undergone by the key employees of the manufacturing
UMKM in Gianyar Regency can be classified as good. That is indicated by the support given by
376
the companies which appreciate the attempts made and the innovative ideas given by the key
employees. In addition, opportunities are also provided to them to improve their skills through
internal training and easy access to information, making them more empowered to develop their
innovative ideas in their jobs. They are empowered to innovate the process, modify the products,
and to innovate the management. The structural empowerment is also shown by giving freedom
to the key employees of the companies to develop their innovative ideas and to design the
products. They are also trusted to make the innovative attempts in their jobs. This is supported by
the result of the study conducted by Kahreh et al. (2011), in which it was evidenced that the
empowerment which is viewed from autonomy positively contributes to the competitiveness of
the dimension of innovation.
5.6 Impact of the Psychological Empowerment on Innovation
The psychological empowerment turns out to positively and significantly contributes to
innovation, meaning that the better the psychological empowerment of the employees, the more
innovative they will be in their jobs. In this present study, the psychological empowerment is
conceptualized into four cognitions; they are meaning, competence, self-determination, and
impact. As presented in the description of variables, the psychological empowerment of the key
employees of the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency can be classified as good. This is
indicated by the view that the jobs done by the employees are considered important and highly
meaningful to their lives. They are also confident that they have the ability and skill needed to do
their jobs. Apart from that, the psychological empowerment is also indicated by self-
determination, meaning that the key employees are provided with freedom and opportunities to
decide what to do in their jobs. As well, their existence also affects where they are supposed to
work. In addition, they can also control what happens in the divisions in which they work.
Such a condition of the psychological empowerment turns out to significantly affect the
innovation of the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency. In this case, innovation includes
the process innovation and the management innovation. The innovation which is made to
improve the process through which the products are produced using newer tools is intended to
produce the products which are acceptable to the buyer. Innovation also includes modifying the
designs of the products, the raw and supporting materials. The uniqueness of the Balinese local
culture is attached to the products, making the market interested in the products. This is done to
377
innovate the products. The management innovation is made by implementing the more modern
system in the buying and selling activities. Email, internet, e-banking are used as an attempt to
follow the technological development. In addition, innovation is also made by implementing the
computer-based administrative system in the companies’ administrative activities.
5.7 Impact of the Asta Brata Leadership on Innovation
Based on the result of the examination of hypothesis, it was proved that the Astra Brata
positively and significantly contributes to innovation, meaning that the better the implementation
of the asta brata leadership the more innovative the key employees of the companies will be. In
this present study, the asta brata leadership is the leadership which refers to the eight essential
natures of Hyang Widhi, Almighty God as a totality, making a leader able to motivate his/her
subordinators when they do their jobs. As explained in the description of variables, the asta
brata leadership implemented in the manufacturing UMKM in Gianyar Regency can be
classified as good, especially if viewed from what is referred to as Casi Brata. In this relation,
the ideas and input given by the subordinators and every achievement achieved by them is
appreciated. In addition, the heads of the companies also show pleasant behaviors. Apart from
that, a leadership is stated to be good if it refers to what is called surya brata, meaning that the
heads of the companies clearly direct the subordinators where they should go. In this way, they
will consciously do their responsibilities. A leadership can also be viewed from to what extent
Paca Brata – Baruna is implemented. In this case, the heads of the companies do not mind
listening to what the subordinators complain of. At the same time, they will also do their best to
give solutions. If the subordinators break the regulations already determined, then the heads will
punish them as an attempt made to educate them.
Such a leadership can motivate the key employees to be more innovative. Such
innovation is referred to as the process innovation, namely, the innovation which is made by
repairing the product making process to make the products acceptable to the buyers. Such
innovation is also related to the product innovation; the designs are modified, the raw materials
used are new, and the products produced are really new.
378
The result of the present study is supported by the result of the study conducted by
Reuvers et al. (2008). They explored the relationship between the transformational leadership
and the innovative working behavior.
Garcia-Morales et al. (2008) also proved that the transformational leadership positively
contributes to the innovative behavior. Furthermore, they stated that a transformational leader
contributes to the intrinsic motivation and stimulates creativity through intellectual stimulation.
As stated by Alvest et al. (2007) that creativity is part of innovation, and that innovation is the
implementation of the outcome of creativity.
In this relation, it can be identified that the characteristics of the transformational
leadership is similar to those of the astra brata leadership. As affirmed by Robbins & Judge
(2015) that a transformational leader is more effective and motivates his/her subordinators to be
creative. The transformational leadership which gives emphasis on individuals is the behavior
which empowers the subordinators to develop and improve their effectiveness.
5.8 Implication
The result of the study can enrich the references which provide empirical evidences of the
relationship between empowerment and leadership with creativity and innovation. An interesting
finding which can be learned from the present study is that it is important to empower the key
employees by giving them freedom to develop their innovative ideas in order to make them more
creative and innovative. They need innovative ideas and access to information when they do
their jobs.
References
Alves, Jorge, Maria José Marques, Irina Saur and Pedro Marques. 2007. Creativity and
Innovation through Multidisciplinary and Multisectoral Cooperation. Journal compilation ©
2007 Blackwell Publishing. Volume 16 Number 1.
Ariasna. 2000. Kepemimpinan Hindu. Surabaya, Penerbit paramita
Ayupp, Kartinah and Then Hsiao Chung . 2010. Empowerment: Hotel employees’ perspective.
Journal of Industrial Engineering and Management, 3(3): 561-575
Chiang, Chun-Fang dan Tsung-Sheng Hsieh. 2012. The impacts of perceived organizational
support and psychological empowerment on job performance: The mediating effects of
organizational citizenship behavior. International Journal of Hospitality Management
31,180–190.
Dharmanegara, Ida Bagus Agung , Made Sudarma , Noermijati, Solimun. 2013. Mediation Of
Tri Hita Karana Organizational Culture In Effect Of Spiritual Intelligence And Asta Brata
379
Leadership On Employee Performance. Interdisciplinary Journal Of Contemporary Research In
Business, Vol 5, No 6, October.
Garcia-Morales , Victor J., Francisco Javier Llorens-Montes and, and Antonio J. Verdu-Jover.
2008. The Effects of Transformational Leadership on Organizational Performance through
Knowledge and Innovation. British Journal of Management, Vol. 19, 299–319.
Guijarro, Antonia Madrid, Domingo Garcia, and Howard Van Auken. 2009. Barriers to
Innovation among Spanish Manufacturing SMEs. Journal of Small Business Management ,
47(4), pp. 465–488
Huei Chen Ming and Geir Kaufmann. 2008 Employee Creativity and R&D: A Critical Review.
Creativity And Innovation Management Journal compilation Blackwell Publishing Volume 17
Number 1.
Job P A dan Sanghamitra Bhattacharyya. 2013. Creativity and Innovation for Competitive
Excellence in Organizations. http://dspace.iimk.ac.in/bitstream/ download 9 pebroari 2013.
Jung, Dong I. , Chee Chowb, Anne Wuc. 2003.The role of transformational leadership in
enhancing organizational innovation: Hypotheses and some preliminary findings. The
Leadership Quarterly, 14. 525-544. Kahreh, Mohammad Safari, Heidar Ahmadi, and Asgar Hashemi. 2011. Achieving competitive
advantage through empowering employees: An empirical study. Far East Journal of Psychology
and Business, Vol 3 No 2 May .
Kariyadi, I Kayan. 2013 Rekontruksi Kepemimpinan Dalam Nilai-Nilai Ajaran Asta Brata dan
Politik Multikultur Masyarakat Global. Shopia Dharma, Volume I Edisi 1 Nomor 1, hal 107-120
Lawson, Karen . 2006. Four Keys to Employee Empowerment. Lawson Consulting Group,
Inc. http://www.GrowingGreatness.com.
Luthans, Fred. 2006. Organizational Behavior, 10th Ed. Vivin Andhika Yuwona, Shekar
Purwantti, Th. Arie P. dan Winang Rasari (penerjemah). Perilaku Organisasi. Yogyakarta.
Penerbit Andi.
Meer, Han van der. 2007. Open Innovation – The Dutch Treat: Challenges in Thinking in
Business Models. Creativity And Innovation Management Volume 16 Number 2.
Munandar, Utami. 2012. Pengembangan Kreativitas Anak Berbakat. Jakarta, Rineka Cipta.
Noe, Raymond A., John R. Hollenbeck, Barry Gerhart & Patrick M. Wright. 2008. Human
Resource Management, Gaining a Competitive Advantage, 6th
Ed. David Wijaya (Penerjemah).
Manajemen Sumber Daya Manusia: Mencapai keunggulan Bersaing. Jakarta: Penerbit Salemba
Empat.
Reuvers, Mark; Marloes L. van Engen; Claartje J. Vinkenburg, and Elisabeth Wilson-Evered.
2008. Transformational Leadership and Innovative Work Behaviour: Exploring the Relevance
of Gender Differences. Creativity And Innovation Management. Journal compilation © 2008
Blackwell Publishing. Volume 17 Number 3.
Reychav, Iris, Eric W Stein, Jacob Weisberg , Chanan Glezer. 2012. The Role of Knowledge
Sharing in Raising the Task Innovativeness of Systems Analysts. International Journal of
Knowledge Management, 8(2), 1-22.
Robbins and. Judge. 2015. Organizational Behavior. 16th ed. Ratna Saraswati dan Febriela Sirait
(penerjemah). Perilaku Organisasi. Jakarta, Penerbit Salemba Empat.
Sholihin, Mahfud dan Dwi Ratmono. 2013. Analisis SEM-PLS dengan WarpPLS 3.0.
Yogyakarta, Penerbit Andi.
380
Soleh Mohamad. 2008. Analisis Strategi Inovasi Dan Dampaknya Terhadap Kinerja Perusahaan
(Studi Kasus: UKM Manufaktur di Kota Semarang). Tesis. Program Studi Magister Manajemen
Program Pasca Sarjana Universitas Diponegoro Semarang.
Sun , Yun Li, Zhen Zhang, Jin Qi,, Zhen Xiong Chen. 2012. Empowerment and creativity: A
cross-level investigation. The Leadership Quarterly, 23, 55–65.
Tutar, Hasan, Mehmet Altinoz and Demet Cakiroglu. 2011. The effects of employee
empowerment on achievement motivation and the contextual performance of employees. African
Journal of Business Management Vol. 5(15), pp. 6318-6329.
Wawan Dheawanto, Hendrati Dwi Mulyaningsi, Anggraeni Permatasari, Grisna Anggadwita,
dan Indriany Ameka. 2014. Manajemen Inovasi: Peluang Sukses Menghadapi Perubahan.
Yogyakarta. Penerbit Andi.
Wibowo.2014. Manajemen Kinerja. Edisi ke-4. Jakarta, Rajawali Pers.
Wiratmandja, G.K. Adia. 1995. Kepemimpinan Hindu. Denpasar,Yayasan Dharma Naradha.
Yasasusastra, J. Syahban. 2011. Asta Brata: Delapan Unsur Alam Simbol Kepemimpinan.
Yogyakarta, Pustaka Mahardika.
Yang, Seung-Bum and Sang Ok Choi. 2009. Employee empowerment and team performance :
Autonomy, responsibility, information, and creativity. Team Performance Management, Vol. 15
No. 5/6, pp. 289-301.
Ying, Hon Hiu. 2008. When Creativity Requirement Does Not Enhance Employee Creativity:
The Limits of Goal-Directed Behavior. Thesis. Submitted in partial fulfillment of the
requirements for the degree of Doctor of Philosophy. Hong Kong Baptist University.
Zuhal. 2010. Knowledge dan Innovation, Platform Kekuatan Daya Saing. Jakarta, PT Gramedia
Pustaka Utama.
381
BRIDGING THE GAP BETWEEN PROFESSIONAL ACCOUNTANT AND SMALL
MEDIUM ENTERPRISE: INDONESIA CASE
Novita Puspasari
Universitas Jenderal Soedirman
Novita.puspasari@yahoo.com
Agus Faturrokhman
Universitas Jenderal Soedirman
Kiky Sri Rejeki
Universitas Jenderal Soedirman
Margani Pinasti
Universitas Jenderal Soedirman
ABSTRACT
Small and Medium Enterprise (SME) is the largest business sector and the biggest contributor to
Indonesia’ GDP. SMEs also absorb 90.12% of the total workforce in Indonesia. In addition, this
sector proved to be able to survive the severe economic crisis in 1998. All this time, professional
accountants have been concentrated in serving large corporations. This is the result of
accounting course they obtained in universities and accounting professional education which are
more concern with accounting for large corporation. The purpose of this study is to bridge the
gap between professional accountants and SMEs, so that professional accountants can
contribute more to SMEs. This study used a qualitative method with in-depth interview
techniques. Respondents composed of representatives of SME association and representatives of
SME enterpreneurs in Banyumas, Central Java, Indonesia. Results from this study indicate that
SMEs need support from professional accountants for financial administration. In addition,
SMEs require simpler accounting standards because the standard that exists today does not
respond to their needs. The implications of this study are twofold. First, changes in the SME
accounting curriculum in accounting professional education which are made in accordance with
the real needs of SMEs as well as to prepare candidates for professional accountants contribute
to SMEs. Secondly, recommendations for the Accounting Standards Board to revise the
accounting standards for SMEs so that it is simpler and more helpful.
Keywords: SME, professional accountants, gap, small business accounting, Indonesia
INTRODUCTION
Small and Medium Enterprises (SMEs) globally has been growing rapidly in recent
years. In general, due to economic growth, SMEs contribute to the Gross Domestic Product
382
(GDP) significantly (Gupta et al). According to Tilley and Parrish (2011) entrepreneurship
through SMEs has the potential to create sustainable development and reduce poverty in
developing countries. In Indonesia, based on data in 2008, SMEs contribute 53.6% of total GDP
in Indonesia. Even in 2011, the number of SMEs business units reached 55,206,444 (Purwati,
2014). According to the Statistics Central Agency (Badan Pusat Statistik/BPS), the portion of
2012 SMEs was 98.82% of the total number of business entities in Indonesia. SMEs also absorb
90.12% of the total workforce in Indonesia.
Those figures show that SMEs are vital sector for Indonesia economy. As a vital sector
and become the foundation of the national economy, the government should supports and
facilitates the development of SMEs. If not, the case of failure of SMEs as happened in the
United States could also occur in Indonesia. Seventy-five percent of the SMEs new businesses
failed within the last three years in the United States. The biggest cause of failure was the
accounting and tax (Pleis, 2014).
According to Magginson et al., (2000), accounting information has an important role in
achieving the business success, including for SMEs. Accounting can not be separated from all
forms of businesses, also for SMEs, but accounting is also the biggest obstacle faced by SMEs
owner today (Pleis, 2014). The purposes of accounting for SMEs are: better accountability,
measurement of the true earnings and most importantly, help management achieve its objectives
(Nwobu et al., 2015). However, most owners of SMEs do not even know basic accounting even
though they know that accounting is important for the survival of their businesses (Pleis, 2014).
In Indonesia, government has conducted a variety of ways to support and facilitate the
development of SMEs. One way was by issuing various laws that serve to regulate and stimulate
the growth of SMEs. Indonesian Accountants Association (IAI) as a forum for professional
accountants in Indonesia also contributed to SMEs. Because of the different characteristics with
large corporations, then in the year 2011, IAI issued Accounting Standards for Entities Without
Public Accountability (SAK ETAP). Accounting standards are very important for SMEs so that
they can manage their business professionally and grow bigger.
Unfortunately, from various studies conducted (Senoaji, 2014, Adriani et al., 2014,
Auliyah, 2012, and Armando, 2014) showed that SAK ETAP was not effective for SMEs.
According to Adriani et al. (2014), the failure of the implementation of SAK ETAP on SMEs
due to internal factors such as lack of understanding, discipline and human resources. While
external factors due to the lack of supervision of stakeholders with an interest in the financial
statements. Similar results were also found in the study Senoaji (2014) which stated that the SAK
ETAP ineffective due to the lack of competent human resources in the field of accounting. SAK
ETAP which is expected to facilitate the needs of SMEs financial records were not much help.
Those results also indicates that there are different perspective among the professional
383
accountants and SMEs businesses regarding the usefulness of accounting, so that in the level of
implementation, there is a gap between the standards of professional accountants understanding
of SMEs and SMEs own practices.
According to Pleis (2014), one of the causes of the gap between professional accountants
and real world accounting is because the accounting curriculum that exists today does not
prepare future accountants to assist SMEs. Most of the current accounting subjects discuss large
corporations and students are encouraged to specialize in one particular field (financial, audit, or
managerial). According to Gupta et al. (2014), at present, accounting education faced with the
problem of reducing the dissonance between theory and practice. American Accounting
Association (AAA) in 1984 had stated that while other professions also change from time to
time, accounting educational institutions fail to evolve as fast as his professional practice. The
AAA study also reinforced by Siegel et al. (2010).
Accounting education should be flexible and relevant in the face of change (Amsworth,
2001; Mohammed, 2003). If the accounting education can not address the needs of SMEs, there
should be an effort made to harmonize the two. According to Pleis (2014), accounting education
should create professional accountants to help small business owners with accounting issues.
Accounting assistance is meant in terms of taxes, cost control, pricing, budgeting, payroll and
dealings with the bank. Meanwhile, according to Nwobu et al. (2015), some of the benefits of
accounting services are to increase the accountability of business operations, reduce fraud and
measure earnings correctly.
This study aims to bridge the gap between professional accountants and SMEs through
education as a media, especially accounting professional education. Why ?, because professional
education will produce professional accountants who would contribute in the real world,
including SMEs business world. In the real world learning laboratory in professional education,
professional accountants candidate will be educated therefore their knowledge can be useful
when they go directly into practice. If previously the focus of professional education was for
large corporation, it is time to answer the challenges of the time by sharing the focus for SMEs.
First of all, this study will identify the problems and needs of SMEs in Banyumas,
Central Java. Results from the identification of problems and needs will then be a
recommendation for the preparation of the accounting curriculum for SMEs which will be
deployed in elective courses in Professional Accounting Education (PPAk) as a producer of
professional accountants. Expected with curriculum development involving SMEs practitioners,
will produce output in the form of a professional accountant ready to plunge into SMEs. If
professional accountants are result from a curriculum that reflects the real SMEs needs, it is not
possible that gap between professional accountants and SMEs will be able to be narrowed.
384
LITERATURE REVIEW
Accounting for Small and Medium Enterprises (SMEs)
In Law 20/2008, small businesses are productive economic activities that stand alone,
which is carried by an individual, or entity that is not a subsidiary or branch of the company not
owned by, or be directly or indirectly part of a medium or large businesses have a small business
criteria as defined in the Law:
1. Has net worth of more than US $ 50,000,000.00 (fifty million dollars) up to a maximum
of Rp 500,000,000.00 (five hundred million rupiah) not including land and buildings.
2. Has annual sales of more than Rp300,000,000.00 (three hundred million rupiah) up to a
maximum of Rp 2,500,000,000.00 (two billion five hundred million rupiah).
According to Swasono (2009), SMEs are the backbone for Indonesian economy. The
number of SMEs until 2011 reach about 52 millions. SMEs in Indonesia is very important for the
economy because it accounts for 60% of GDP and holds 97% of the workforce (Purwati, 2014).
However, the access of SMEs to financial institutions is still very limited at only 25% or 13
million SMEs have access to financial institutions. One of the problems that make SMEs fail is
because the accounting and tax (Pleis, 2014).
Meanwhile, according to Law No. 20 of 2008 on Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises
(SMEs), Small Business is a productive economic activities that stand alone, which is done by
the individual or business entity that is not a subsidiary or branch of the company not owned,
controlled, or be a part either directly or indirectly, of a medium or large businesses that meet the
criteria for Small Businesses referred to in this Law. Medium is economically productive
activities that stand alone, which is done by the individual or business entity that is not a
subsidiaries or branches of companies owned, controlled, or be a part either directly or indirectly
by the Small Business or large enterprise with total net assets or annual sales revenue as
stipulated in this Law. The following table business criteria based on Law No. 20 of 2008.
Table 1. Criteria Based Business Law 20 of 2008
No. Commentary Criteria
Asset Turnover
1. Micro Business Min 50 million Max 300 million
2. Small Business > 50 million-500
million
> 300 million to 2.5
billion
3. Medium Enterprises > 500 million to 10
billion > 2.5 billion-5 billion
Financial Accounting Standards for Entities Without Public Accountability (SAK ETAP)
was set by Ikatan Accounting Indonesia (IAI) with the aim to simplify financial reporting for
385
small and medium enterprises. SAK ETAP is intended for all business units to prepare financial
statements in accordance with established standards. SAK ETAP is considered to be quite simple
and will not be difficult for users. SAK ETAP was launched by the end of 2011. Therefore, for
companies that have decided to use the SAK ETAP should have adjusted its report since 2010.
The use of this standard should be consistent for subsequent years. For companies that have
decided to use the general GAAP in preparing the financial statements, the next should not revise
its policies to SAK ETAP and vice versa.
In practice, SAK ETAP is not always been a reference for SMEs. SAK ETAP considered
too complex for the majority of SMEs (Tanugraha, 2012, Auliyah, 2012). According to Andriani
et al. (2014), the failure of the SAK ETAP implementation caused by less skilled human
resources and lack of supervision of stakeholders with an interest in the financial statements.
According to Armando (2014), SAK ETAP only accommodate reporting of Level 4 SMEs
which are quite complex. While the majority of SMEs in Indonesia is at Level 1,2, and 3 which
requires a simpler accounting standards.
Accounting in Higher Education
To become a professional accountant in Indonesia is not enough just graduated from the
Accounting Department with a degree in Economics. Prospective professional accountants
should first follow the Professional Accounting Education (PPAk) and or take the exam for
obtaining the title of certified accountant (Chartered Accountant / CA). Professional Accounting
Education (PPAk) is additional education in higher education after the Bachelor of Economics
program in the course of accounting based on the Decree of the Minister of National Education
Republic of Indonesia No. 179 / U / 2001 dated November 21, 2001 on the Implementation of
Professional Education that was held in the college. PPAk in accordance with the requirements,
procedures and curriculum set by the Indonesian Institute of Accountants (IAI). The one who
graduates from accounting profession entitled Accountant (abbreviated Ak.).
In 2001, there was a change in the education system of accounting. Previously,
accounting alumnus of the economic faculty of public universities automatically earned
accountant title (Akt). Unlike the private college graduates who have to follow the National
Examination Accounting (UNA) to achieve a similar degree. This system is deemed to constitute
discrimination against private universities, not even guarantee the standardization of the
accounting profession. Therefore, based on the Minister of National Education No. 179 / U /
2001, accounting degree can only be obtained through PPAk.
Implementation of Accounting Profession is not a substitution for Accounting Program
Department. Both are complementary, mutually complement one another. PPAk goal is to
produce graduates who master the skill areas of the accounting profession and provide
386
accounting services. Thus, the PPA is actually not an extra that was created to make it difficult
for someone to become an accountant. Precisely, PPAk directed to a prospective accountant who
previously received only one formal education strata more exposed to the world the profession /
practice. Accountants who are expected to graduate from PPAk will have a strong concept of
undergraduate education and have adequate professional skills.
PPAk curriculum and syllabus largely containing material that is not or has not been
given at undergraduate level or as an application of a concept or theory. PPAk’ curriculum and
syllabus also pay attention to the needs of accountant’s service users. PPAk’ curriculum and
syllabus are not expected static, but constantly evolving according to the changing environment.
According to the Finance Minister Regulation (PMK) No. 25/2014, state registered
accountant is a professional accountant who graduates from Accounting Profession or pass the
professional accountant certification exam, experienced in the field of accounting and as a
member of the association. PPAk plays an important role here in preparing candidates for
professional accountants to plunge into the world of practice.
Bridging The Gap Through Education: Between Candidates for Professional Accountants
and SMEs
According to Siegel et al. (2010), most of accounting courses core at undergraduate level
focus on topics that assumes students will become employees at large companies, become
employees in public accountant office or pass the certified public accountant (CPA). Very few
materials have been given to students in order to create their understanding of SME business,
therefore it was not surprise if the students became not familiar with the SMEs. This leads to a
gap when the students would become a professional accountant, down to the community to help
SMEs.
To be a professional accountant, a student who has graduated from the accounting
department must follow PPAk or take a professional accountants certification examination (CA).
In PPAk they will be prepared to work with the picture of the real world practice. PPAk is an
appropriate place for preparing candidates for the professional accountant to deal with SMEs.
Not only prepared to serve big business, but also to serve SMEs.
Gupta et al. (2014) captured the gap phenomenon between accountants and SMEs in
India. His research output is a method of accounting education namely customized accounting
education, i.e learning by designing a customized accounting (meet user needs). Gupta
conducted a short-term accounting training for SMEs and created Accounting Lab named
Portable Kiosk as a one-door center for information, education and accounting training. The
target audience of this training are students, researchers, practitioners, academicians, SMEs
businessmen etc.
387
In Indonesia, to overcome the problems of this gap, we should begin from higher
education. Particularly from PPAk program. By making SMEs as part of studying, PPAk is
expected to produce output that is a professional accountant for SME businesses. This means that
professional accountants can contribute more in improving the accountability of business
operations, reduce the occurrence of error and fraud, the profit measure correctly and other
contributions for SMEs.
RESEARCH METHODS
This study used a qualitative approach. According to Molelong (2007), qualitative
research is research that is able to provide an understanding of the phenomenon that is happening
thoroughly with descriptive depiction in the form of language and words. This study uses data
collection techniques such as in-depth interviews with the form of semi-structured interviews in
order to find the problem openly and deeply. Sugiyono (2012) suggested that a semi-structured
interview is an interview conducted with the instrument, but the question is open and can thrive
without having to be glued to the instrument that has been set in order to get a deeper answer,
detail and explore the entire perception and condition of the informant. Researchers will be asked
by the instruments which have been prepared, then the instrument evolved to explore the answer
given in accordance with the needs of the research informants.
Respondents are representatives of the Chamber of Commerce and Industry Banyumas
(Kadin) and representatives of SMEs in Banyumas. Kadin is a representative respondent that is
being perceived as the official SMEs body in Banyumas. Kadin can see the problems faced by
SMEs in Banyumas in general. Selection of survey participants as representative of SMEs is
based on several criteria including: businesses should represent a form of business (services,
trade and manufacturing), it also represents bankable and non-bankable enterprises. Reason for
the selection of bankable SMEs is because it usually prepare financial statements for bank
purposes (Purwati, 2014). Researchers want to examine the constraints during the financial
reporting process. Selection of non-bankable SMEs is due to it typically make financial
statements that do not conform with the standards established. Researchers want to examine the
reasons why SMEs do not make financial statements in accordance with established standards.
RESULTS AND DISCUSSION
Researchers interviewed eight participants representing predetermined characteristics:
small business association, bankable, non-bankable, business types (service, manufacturing and
merchandising). One person representing the small business association (Kadin), four SMEs
represent merchandising businesses, three SMEs represent services businesses, and one represent
388
SME manufacturing business. From seven SMEs, five SMEs are bankable and the other three
SMEs are non-bankable. Here is a list of participants:
Table 1. List of Respondents Research
No. SMEs Name Type of Business Bankable/Non-Bankable
1. La Pizza Merchandising Non-bankable
2. Auto 168 Service Bankable
3. Hulala Ice Cream Merchandising Non-bankable
4. Orlando Salon Service Bankable
5. Lembaga Bahasa IEC Service Bankable
6. Wijaya (car rent, deposit store,
photocopy store).
Service and
merchandising
Bankable
7. Omah Batik Banyumasan Merchandising Non-bankable
8. Kamar Dagang dan Industri
Banyumas (KADIN)
- -
9. PT. Sung Chang Indonesia Manufaktur Bankable
Of the eight SMEs which participated, only one SME which has financial records in
accordance with SAK ETAP namely PT. Sung Chang Indonesia. Request from stakeholders
(owners, partners and government) makes PT. Sung Chang Indonesia must make an adequate
financial statements. Owner of PT. Sung Chang is a South Korean citizen who is not always in
Indonesia, so as to control the business, he requires a detailed financial statement. For the
purposes of payment of taxes, it is necessary also standards-compliant financial statements. In
preparing the financial statements, PT. Sung Chang has a finance manager and a finance staff.
Educational qualifications for finance manager is S1 Management, while the finance staff is D3
Accounting.
Four other bankable SMEs did not know about SAK ETAP. They prepared financial
statements with the example of the financial statements of other existing SMEs. Instead of asking
help from a professional accountant, most owners claiming to work on its own financial
statements or asking employees to do it. Reason for not asking for professional accountants help
was because they did not know whom to ask for help, anyone or any institution. Other reasons,
even with the financial report financial statements that have been made without the help of a
professional accountant, the bank could still disburse credit. Financial records that had been
made including cash flow, receivables and debt report.
Three other SMEs which are non-bankable have made a simple financial reports. Most of
the financial reports containing the cash incoming, outgoing and operational costs. IEC only has
the Income Statement, and has fixed asset depreciation account. However, the depreciation
accounts are not filled for years by reason of difficulty calculating depreciation. The other three
non-bankable SMEs others only make limited statements of cash flows in and out is reduced by
389
operating expenses. Reason does not make financial reports according to the standard is because
they do not know and therefore do not really need. The other three non-bankable SME owners
think they do not really need it because they are not or has not been dealing with the bank, in
addition to make financial reports according to the standard rated complex and spend resources,
both energy and money. However, they are eager to expand their business by borrowing money
to banks in the future. So they began to think to improve the recording system to match the
prevailing standards.
The results of in-depth interviews with representatives of the Chamber of Commerce
Banyumas strengthen the results of interviews with SMEs before. According to representatives
of the Chamber of Commerce, more than 90% of SMEs in Banyumas and surrounding
businesses run by instinct and not by the system. No wonder if they are not too concerned with
the business accounting system. The new SME entrepreneurs feel the need for accounting
systems when they are going to deal with the bank. This is consistent with research from Pleis
(2014) which found that many small business owners did not know and did not understand the
importance of basic accounting system. According to representatives of the Chamber of
Commerce, in addition to the limitations of financial administration skills, SME business owners
are also limited in terms of time if you want to learn about basic accounting. If using third party
services, such as finance or accounting professional staff, they consider that the cost is too
expensive.
The main problems include lack of knowledge and accounting skills, lack of time to
create a standards-compliant report, which is considered a complex accounting standards, and the
inability to pay staff who are competent in the field of accounting are actually the same as the
issues raised by previous studies (Auliyah, 2012, Andriani et al., 2014, Senoaji, 2014, Armando,
2014, Pleis, 2014, Chabra and Pattanayak, 2014, Nwobu, 2015). From various studies in several
countries related SMEs undertaken in recent years, factually accounting standards for SMEs
which set by the government or profession body were not effective.Why not effective? Because
it is not used by the majority of SMEs. Then come the question again, why it is not used by the
majority of SMEs ?, the main issues presented in the beginning of this paragraph that appears.
SMEs business people actually realize the importance of making financial reports
according to the standard. However, the results of research and Pattanayak Chabra (2014)
reinforced again by this study stated that the biggest obstacle in the application of accounting
standards for SMEs is the time. SMEs business people do not have time to make good the
financial statements. While they were not able also to pay staff who are competent in the field of
accounting.
Results of this research is a homework for the accounting profession, also with the
accounting profession education. Opportunities of professional accountants and prospective
390
professional accountants widely open to contribute to SMEs. As the results of research from
Pleis (2014) which states that the assistance of the accountants accounting required by SMEs.
Existing accounting profession education should also be directed at accounting for SMEs.
Additional courses, if necessary, should be held specifically addresses SMEs accounting. The
SMEs are invited to give a real picture of the condition of SMEs. Because educated to become
professionals, then the students of PPAk should also discuss the problems of real cases that
happened in the business world. This approach in education is known by problem-based solving
method.
The problems are discussed and should be completed in class are the real problems faced
by SMEs. To design a case study, a lecturer should ask for help SMEs directly. In addition,
several supporting activities such as visits to companies (company visit) and internships can also
be done in the business of SMEs, not only in large companies. Through this method, students
will be more familiar with the SMEs world, therefore when they graduate from PPAk, they can
contribute to SMEs. Approach to the introduction of SMEs through education media is once
again changing the paradigm that is already developed in the community for SMEs, that SMEs
business is grade two business. In he next few years, it would not be impossible that SMEs will
become the firm foundation of the economy of a country.
CONCLUSIONS, RECOMMENDATIONS AND IMPLICATIONS
According to Magginson et al. (2000), in order to achieve success, small businesses
require accounting systems. Results of this study and studies carried out in Indonesia indicate
that the applicable accounting standards for SMEs (SAK ETAP) has not yet to be implemented
by the majority of SMEs. The standard is not applied is because it is complicated, time
consuming and costly.
In order to contribute to SMEs, the professional accountant should be familiar with the
characteristics of its business. Including knowing the obstacles faced when dealing with
accounting. The closeness between professional accountants and SMEs can be created early on,
since the process of making prospective professional accountant in the accounting profession
education. The ideal professional education is to provide a picture as real as possible about what
will be done accountants when they plunge into the community. In order to provide the real
picture, accounting professional education should involve SMEs professionals to participate in
formulating the material and teaching methods and supporting activities. Media education will be
a bridge to fill the gap between the professional accountant in business SMEs.
Education in addition to bridging the gap between the professional accountant with SME
business, can also be a mediator for SMEs business with the government, in this case the
accounting standard setters. Results from these studies, class discussions and discussions with
391
SMEs business people can be formulated into an academics recommendation for standard setter.
Recommendations are then submitted to the Accounting Standards Board to be considered in
setting accounting standards for SMEs.
Future studies should be conducted by academics in the form of action research (action
research) to follow up on these results. In action research scholars will intervene in the process
of preparing learning materials, teaching methods and supporting activities involving SMEs
businesses directly. Results of the preparation can be simulated in advance to the accounting
profession education program students.
The implications of this study is twofold. First, changes in the educational curriculum
SME accounting profession made in accordance with the real needs of SMEs as well as to
prepare candidates for professional accountants contribute to SMEs. Second, recommendations
for the Accounting Standards Board to revise the accounting standards for SMEs so that a more
simple and useful.
REFERENCES
Adriani, L., A. T. Atmadja., N. K. Sinarwati. 2014. Analisis Penerapan Pencatatan Keuangan
Berbasis SAK ETAP Pada UMKM. E-journal Universitas Pendidikan Ganesha Vol 2 No.
1.
American Accounting Association. 1986. The Bedford Report-Future Accounting: Preparing for
the Expanding Profession. Available at www.aaahq.org/AECC/future/index.htm diakses
pada 15 Juni 2015.
Ainsworth, P. 2001. Changes In Accounting Curricula: Discussion And Design. Accounting
Education, 10(3): 279-297.
Armando, Zipo Rahman. 2014. Eksplorasi dan Remodelling Akuntansi Pada Usaha Mikro dan
Kecil (UMK). Artikel Ilmiah Universitas Brawijaya.
Auliyah, Iim Ma’rifatul. 2012. Penerapan Akuntansi Berdasarkan SAK ETAP Pada UKM
Kampung Baik di Sidoarjo. Artikel Ilmiah STIE Perbanas Surabaya.
Badan Pusat Statistik. 2014. www.bps.go.id diakses pada 19 Oktober 2014.
Chabra, K. S., J. K. Pattanayak. 2014. Financial Accounting Practices Among Small Business:
Issues and Challenges. The IUP Journal of Accounting Research & Audit Practices. Vol
XIII No. 3: 37-55.
392
Gupta, V, K., P. K. Singh., V. Sriranga. 2014. A Framework for Dissemination of Accounting
Education. Academic of Business Research Journal.
Ikatan Akuntan Indonesia. 2009. Standar Akuntansi Keuangan Entitas Tanpa Akuntabilitas
Publik.
Molelong, L. J. 2007. Metode Penelitian Kualitatif. Bandung: PT. Remaja Rosdakarya.
Mohamed, E. K. A. 2003. Accounting Knowledge And Skills And The Challenges Of A Global
Business Environment. Managerial Finance, 29 (3).
Nwobu, O, S. O. Faboyede., a. T. Onwuelingo. 2015. The Role of Accounting Services in Small
and Medium Scale Business in Nigeria. Journal of Accounting, Business and Management,
Vol 22 No. 1: 55-63.
Peraturan Menteri Keuangan Republik Indonesia No. 25 tentang Akuntan Beregister Negara.
Pleis, Letitia Meier. 2014. A New Graduate Accounting Course for the Small Business
Accountant. Business Education Innovation Journal. Vol. 6 No. 2: 70-73.
Purwati, A.S., I, Suparlinah dan N. K. Putri. 2014. The Use of Accounting Information in the
Business Decision Making Process on SME in Banyumas Region, Indonesia. Economy
Transdiciplinary Cognition, Vol 17 No. 2: 63-75.
Senoaji, Aditya Rizal. 2014. Gap analysis penerapan SAK ETAP Pada Penyusunan Laporan
Keuangan UKM di Kabupaten Kudus. Skripsi Universitas Diponegoro.
Siegel, G., J. E. Sorensen., T. Klammer. S. Richtermeyer. 2010. The Ongoing Preparatiom Gap
in Accounting Education: A Call to Action. Management Accounting Quarterly (Spring)
Vol 11 No. 3: 41-52.
Sugiyono. 2012. Memahami Penelitian Kualitatif. Bandung: Alfabeta.
Swasono, Sri Edi.2009. Keparipurnaan Ekonomi Pancasila: Menegakkan Ekonomi Pancasila.
Penerbit Universitas Gadjah Mada.
Tanugraha, Jevon. 2012. Evaluasi Penerapan Standar Akuntansi Keuangan Entitas Tanpa
Akuntabilitas Publik Pada PT TDMN. Berkala Ilmiah Mahasiswa Akuntansi Vol 1, No.
3.
Tilley. H dan F. Perrish. 2006. Small Industries in Developed Countries. Australia: Wombat
Press.
Undang-Undang Republik Indonesia No. 20 Tahun 2008 tentang Usaha Mikro, Kecil dan
Menengah.
393
394
BUDGETING ADMINISTRATION OF AUTONOMOUS UNIVERSITIES
Asst.Prof.Dr.Wasan Kanchanamukda
The Faculty of Economics and Business Administration, Thaksin University,
Songkhla, Thailand
granjanamukda@hotmail.com
ABSTRACT
An autonomous university in Thailand is defined as a government agency that receives a block
grant, operates outside the government bureaucracy and is overseen by the Minister of
Education. This includes freedom to determine salaries and staff benefits. The policy objective
was to allow flexibility to increase fiscal and academic efficiencies. The study concluded that the
budgetary processes essential for good governance and management of an autonomous
university produce fiscal and academic benefits, and that these could be even greater if more
flexibility of government grants was allowed. Autonomous universities shared similar benefits
and constraints and require enhanced non-government sources of revenue. The relevance of
Australian experience is considered marginal since it related more to governmental policy than
to governance and management within a university. Nevertheless, the flexibility and strict
control systems within Australian universities provides a model for autonomous Thai
universities. An example of this full budgeting is highlighted by the above mentioned anomalous
costings for personnel, which is often seen as increases in salary costs when it is mainly a
difference in accounting. Autonomous universities now offer a useful benchmark for government
395
universities with their higher accountability and budget-aligned plans, which are major tools for
enhancing a university’s quality and its sustainability.
Key Word: Budgeting Administration, Autonomous University, Thailand
Introduction
In the 1990s, Thailand made plans to create a path for transition from government departmental-
style public university management towards an autonomous public university system. The first
challenge recognized was the determination of a method to allocate government funds to a
university that was both fair and transparent as well as allowing management of quality as part of
an overall policy of continuous improvement in higher education. Preparation for the transition
included a series of inputs from Australia under an aid project with the Thai Ministry of
University Affairs (West, 1999).
That project recommended a distributive model for resource allocation, which the Ministry
termed a ‘relative funding model’, which was essentially a predetermined formula based on such
specific purposes as teaching, research and general operations. This relies on ‘relative unit costs’
rather than absolute unit costs and allows a degree of performance assessment against objectives
defined in the allocation process.
Autonomous Universities
396
“An autonomous university has the status of a government agency that is neither within the
government bureaucracy nor a state enterprise. It becomes a legal entity under state supervision
after approval by the Minister of Education. The University Council can formulate rules and
regulations for personnel administration, as well as stipulating staff welfare and benefits”
(Higher Education in South-East Asia, 2006, p.198).
This innovative way of university administration has been introduced to promote flexibility of
university operation. Such universities have their own administrative structure and budgeting
system for self-governance and full autonomy, allowing decision making on administrative and
management matters of the university to be handled by the university itself. Currently, there are
13 autonomous universities and efforts are being made to encourage existing public universities
to move out of the bureaucratic system.2
Autonomy and Academic Freedom
University autonomy and academic freedom are said to be fundamental to quality, yet as the
above illustrates, government continually intervenes in both (Russell, 1993) and universities
have not acted consistently with their rhetoric (Encel, 1965) usually being willing to compromise
if incremental funds are offered. The debate in Australia seems to have been confused by linking
autonomy and academic freedom when they are in fact quite different principles. Academic
freedom relates to scholarly independence unfettered by outside requirements, while autonomy
relates to the university’s independence of governance and management (Brubacher, 1977).
2 http://inter.mua.go.th/main2/page_detail.php?id=3
397
Autonomy is interpreted to mean that only scholars can understand the complexity of university
management and hence must administer universities. This is an ideal, and is not accepted by
funding agencies, nor is it in evidence in the higher performing universities, which employ
competent specialists in administration to work beside academic managers. In the Seventh
Report of the Higher Education Council, Australian Universities indicated that they felt their
autonomy was compromised by: government requests for information; curriculum demands from
professional associations; government policies on foreign students, and special incentive funding
(Higher Education Council, 1993). Such facts indicate that, in contrast to being truly
autonomous, universities in Australia enjoy certain freedoms under their respective Acts of
Parliament, but remain responsible for detailed financial budgeting and accountability. It is this
aspect of sound financial management for optimal educational outcomes that define the adoption
of aspects of the Australian system by Thailand, notwithstanding the distinctly different origins
of the Thai university system.
The Meaning of ‘Autonomy’ in the Thai University Sector
Adapting to globalizing free trade in higher education has been difficult for Thailand (OHEC,
2008a) because it is a culture based on consensus, national needs and a minority language. The
language has some utility in neighboring countries, but their low educational status does little to
enhance that of Thailand, and much of it is offered as a form of development assistance. From
that insulated environment, Thailand’s agreement to include education in the GATS multilateral
schedule, the ASEAN Free Trade Agreement, and bilateral free trade agreements with Australia,
Bahrain, China, India, and New Zealand (and possibly Japan, Mexico, South Korea, Switzerland
and the US) has placed a burden of change on the sector that has in turn increased concern within
398
Thai universities (Suwanwela, 2005). At the same time as changing to suit global systems, Thai
universities are expected to continue to meet political ends such as expounding the philosophy of
a self-sufficient economy (OHEC, 2008a) and to ameliorate violence in the Deep South. It is
through such a window that the Thai version of ‘autonomy’ may be viewed.
Autonomy quickly grew into a major issue for Thai higher education. Discussed for more than
30 years, university autonomy was first formalized in the First 15-Year Long Range Plan on
Higher Education of Thailand (1990-2004). From that date, all new public universities were to be
autonomous universities and existing public universities were to move in that direction
(Kirtikara, 2002; OEC, 2006). Yet despite that policy, as of August 2005, there are only four
autonomous universities. The other 21 public universities remained traditional public
universities. While it was expected that new institutions would be created under a new
autonomous legislation, the newest established in the South, Princess of Narathiwat University,
was established in 2005 as a traditional university under the civil service system;
(http://www.pnu.ac.th/eng). As such it is effectively a government department and has to follow
the same rules and regulations as other public universities.
Suranaree University of Technology and Walailak University were established in the 1990s as
new autonomous institutions. But a 1991 attempt to force 15 existing public universities into the
model failed (Kirtikara, 2002). By 1998, the pioneering exit of King Mongkut University of
Technology Thonburi from the fully-government controlled system was expected to remove
fears from other institutions – but it did not. In fact, autonomous universities in Thailand have
had limited success for a number reasons. One key issue has been the new employment contract
399
system, with which university staff employed as civil servants were not familiar. It was claimed
that autonomous universities would find it more difficult to recruit qualified staff without the
diverse welfare benefits attached to civil service positions in traditional public universities.
However, the case of the prestigious Bangkok-based King Mongkut University of Technology
Thonburi becoming the first public university to date to make the transition to autonomy and its
restructuring of governance and management processes and systems set the scene for other
innovative institutions (Bovornsiri, 2006).
The President of KMUTT (Kirtikara, 2004, p.38) defines autonomy as:
“The State allows autonomous universities to manage their own three major internal affairs,
namely, academic matters (academic programs, university structures), personnel matters
(personnel system, recruitment, remuneration, benefits), and finance and budgets (budget
management, procurement system). The State can direct, supervise, audit and evaluate
autonomous universities. Autonomous universities have to follow government policy and the
Minister in charge. The State Auditor audits accounts and assets of autonomous universities. In
the case of KMUTT, two members of the University Council are appointed by the Minister of
MUA.”
The official translation of the meaning of ‘autonomy’ in the Thai university system (OHEC,
2007b,) includes concepts of flexibility of operations under self- governance. But perhaps a
better explanation can be gained from careful consideration of other translations, since
‘autonomous universities’ as used in OHEC documents is in fact a translation of the Thai term
that means something more like state-supervised universities (OHEC, 2007b).
400
The term ‘autonomy’ may be better understood as a process of transforming from fully-
government controlled public universities to government-supervised and partially/majority
funded independent universities with the ultimate long-term objective of creating something akin
to self-supporting universities. It can be seen as a masterful culturally-astute means of reform
that avoids offending traditional values while conveying to those who count the longer-term
intent of the policy. But it would not be correct to assume that this has been fully successful
because student resistance, with some staff support, checked the speed of reform and led to the
government thenceforth requiring University Councils to achieve staff and student consensus
before applying to become autonomous.
By 2007 there were seven autonomous universities among the 97 public higher education
institutions in Thailand (76 public universities, 19 community colleges and two Buddhist
universities). Meanwhile, while Thailand procrastinated in its adapting to the international
university system, globalization forces acted on innovative Thai universities leading to an
increased interest and activity in research (Liefner and Schiller, 2008). As elite performers within
the Thai university system noted the advantages of being part of an international knowledge
fraternity linking research to education, old critiques of universities being sluggish bureaucracies
that were inflexible and incapable of sustained research and graduate training supported moves
for increased autonomy (Kirtikara, 2004). One critical outcome of these developments was a
recognition that budget processes were a constraint on innovation and motivation (Fry,
Wisalaporn, Lertpaithoon, Sinprasert, Peerapornratana and Larpkesorn, 1999) as is discussed
further in a later section.
401
Governance and the Centrality of Finances
Autonomy in academic, personnel and financial management are three legs to the stool of
university autonomy. Academic autonomy is to be limited in the Thai case, while autonomy over
personnel management has faced much apprehension and some militant resistance among staff
that have become dependent on bureaucratic rules and civil service conditions. Nevertheless, the
use of improved financial management has allowed monetary distinctions to be made in
employment conditions, with incentives for those outside the civil service conditions if they
perform well as academics. Thus financial management becomes an important tool for overall
autonomy, including innovative academic measures, particularly at post-graduate level. Such
autonomy requires increased responsibility and accountability, which is foreign to many
university personnel that have enjoyed freedom without responsibility and accountability under
university regulation, and so improved university council governance must accompany improved
financial management. Performance evaluation of faculties, functional units as well as senior
administrators are to be carried out by a university Council. Acting in the public interest for use
of government funds has been perfunctory for most past university councils in Thailand. In an
autonomous university, the council is supreme in:
setting the vision and direction
formulating policy on education and research
overseeing the personnel system which formulates policy and regulates personnel
management, does not the operations of the system.
budgeting and finance
performance evaluation, faculties, functional units as well as senior administrators.
402
internal audit (in addition to the external auditing of the National Audit Office).
As reporting, internal auditing and assessment become more regular features of university
councils, increased transparency and accountability become indicators of good university
governance (Kirtikara, 2002).
Flexibility in Budget Administration
In all the budgetary contexts in an autonomous universities allow much smoother operation than
is possible in a government university. This is due to the flexibility possible in formulating the
overall budget in the first place, aligning functional units demands in a unified plan and the
ability to adjust and transfer funds during the year according to justified demands. As this
flexibility extends across all budgetary units, it makes overall management a more professional
and efficient task since unused government income is not returned to the Budget Bureau by
autonomous universities but is a requirement of government universities. This need for
government universities to return unspent funds to the government creates anomalies when
circumstances change or new initiatives arise. For a university to engage energetic and well-
qualified lecturers, such lack of flexibility limits the capacity of government universities and
thereby provides a potential advantage to autonomous institutions that are well managed. Such
good management requires unified university budgetary management complete with regulations
on finances, budgets, academic requirements including quality and personnel developmental
matters. To be able to manage such matters without seeking to allocate individual tasks to
predetermined government expenditure categories allows smooth and independent operation that
is more transparent and accountable. Ultimate accountability is maintained by every university
being subject to inspection by the Office of the Auditor General of Thailand, which is an
403
independent organization that verifies external accounts and reports to the Office of the Higher
Education Commission, or the Ministry of Education for some more recently ungraded
universities. The flexibility allow for autonomous universities is not absolute, however, as for
example in purchasing and the hiring which must follow regulations and criteria set by the
university to be in line with Cabinet Resolutions. For purchasing and hiring expenditure above
two million baht procedures must conform to the supply regulations prescribed by Prime
Minister’s Office. This constraint on autonomy affects all such universities and in the case of
Thaksin University means that it is not fully independent in areas where it must follow
governmental criteria. Flexibility in budget administration is also a tool to meet government
policy in areas of ethnic and religious diversity (OHEC, 2008b).
Conclusion
The Bureau of the Budget almost ignores considering budgets in the operation category. Rather,
more emphasis is put on investment budgets and personnel budgets. Nonetheless, the university’s
income budgets are used to add to the operation budgets. Regulations on purchasing and hiring
can be established by an autonomous university. This helps the university’s financial
administration run more smoothly. However, some have to follow governmental regulations as
its financial operations has to be verified by the Office of the Auditor General of Thailand.
Procedures for purchasing and disbursement also require Auditor General Permission as well. An
apparent advantage of being an autonomous university in the financial aspect is that the
university’s budgets which are not used within a fiscal year can be effectively managed. There is
no need for accelerating the purchasing and the hiring before the end of each fiscal year.
Additionally, transfer of budgets is not required. Some budgets can be maintained in case of any
404
essentiality. Another benefit is on the evaluation of the university’s staff, namely performance of
administrators as well as other staff members can be rigorously evaluated. As a result, the
university’s work can run smoothly and quickly. It is because those with an unsatisfactory
performance will be assessed as having failed. Here, a long evaluation is arranged. That is, they
are to be evaluated every year, every two years and every three years. Passing the assessment,
they will be able to become the university’s permanent staff. The administrators at a faculty level
are to be evaluated as well. To be precise, personnel in the faculty are capable of taking part in
this evaluation.
References
Bovornsiri, V. (2006). Higher Education in South-East Asia . Thailand :
UNESCO Bangkok,The UNESCO Asia and Pacific Regional
Bureau for Education.
Brubacher, J. S. (1977). On the Philosophy of Higher Education. San Francisco
: Jossey Bass.
Encel, S.(1965). (pp. 1-32). The Social role of higher education, in E.L. Wheelwright,
(editor). Higher Education in Australia. Melbourne, F.W. : Cheshire,
Fry, G., Wisalaporn, S., Lertpaithoon, S., Sinprasert, C., Peerapornratana, P., and
Larpkesorn, P. (1999). Management of education in Thailand : A review
and recommendations for an implementation strategy for decentralization.
prepared for UNESCO Bangkok as part of the Asian Development Bank
Social Program Loan in the framework of the Educational Management
and Finance Study, 2, 1.
Higher Education Council. (1993). Seventh Report . Canberra, Commonwealth
government printer.
Higher Education in South-East Asia. (2006). Asia Pacific Programme of
Educational Innovation for Development, United Nations Educational, Scientific and
Cultural Organization. Bangkok : UNESCO Bangkok.
405
Kirtikara, K. (2002). Thai public university system in transition : some
issues on management and financing. Symposium conducted at the Thai-
UK University Presidents Forum, Bangkok, Thailand.
Kirtikara, K. (2004). Transition from a university under the bureaucratic system
to an autonomous university : Reflections on concepts and experience of the King
Mongkut’s University of Technology Thonburi. Bangkok : Office of the Education
Council.
Liefner, I., and Schiller, D. (2008), “Academic capabilities in developing countries
A conceptual framework with empirical illustrations from Thailand”. Research
Policy, 37, 276-293.
OEC (Office of Educational Council) . (2006). Education in Thailand 2005/2006.
Bangkok : OEC.
OHEC (Office of the Higher Education) . (2007b). RaikganPrajupi 2550, [Annual
Report 2007]. Bangkok : The Higher Education.
OHEC (Office of the Higher Education) . (2008a). Krob Pan Udomsuksa Raya Yao
15 Pi : Chabub Ti 2 (Por, Sor, 2551-2565). [Framework of the Second 15
Year Long Range Plan: 2008-2022]. Bangkok : The Higher Education.
OHEC (Office of the Higher Education) . (2008b). Executive Report: Framework of
the Second 15 Year Long Range Plan on Higher Education of Thailand .
Bangkok : Office of The Higher Education.
Princess of Narathiwat University. (n.d). Retrieved September 5, 2013 from
http://www.pnu.ac.th/eng.
Russell, C. (1993). Academic Freedom. London: Routledge.
Suwanwela, C. (2005). Higher education reform in Thailand. In The Third
Session of the Regional Follow up Committee for the 1998 World
Conference on Higher Education in Asia and the Pacific, Seoul Royal
Hotel, July (pp. 5-6).
West, L. (1999). “Systemic Resource Allocation using Relative Funding Models
in Higher Education”. In, Budgeting and Resource Allocation in an
Autonomous Public Higher Education System : Report on Progress II,
PID : Activity 2.2.2.1, PM15 (PM.G4) by Leo West and Peter Schelluch.
Ministry of University Affairs, Bangkok.
406
407
DESIGNING PERFORMANCE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM USING THE BALANCED
SCORECARD METHOD IN NON-PROFIT ORGANIZATION
(Study Case: NGO x)
Dara Maisarah
Bandung Institute of Technology
dara.maisarah@sbm-itb.ac.id
ABSTRACT
Non-Governmental Organization (NGO) is one form of organization that is important to improve
the welfare of the community through educational programs, the environment, agriculture,
health, and finances. This research is to build (designing) performance management system that
appropriate to NGO by interview and discussion with relevant parties in the organization, the
term of performance management system in private sector already well known but in NGO sector
it is new thing that need to concern. The findings of this research showed there are some KPI
and strategic objective in non-profit organizations using The Balanced Scorecard method that
have different characteristic with KPI and strategic objective in private sector, although both
sectors using same method because they have different goal.
Keywords: Performance Management System, Non-Profit Organization, The Balanced Scorecard
INTRODUCTION
NGO (Non-Governmental Organization)/ non-profit organization is an organization formed of
empathy towards fellow human beings to help each other. Each year the number of NGOs in
Indonesia continues to grow, until February 2015 the number is 2898 NGO in Indonesia, this is
caused by the condition of Indonesia is still a concern in, terms of both social and economic,
coupled with the many natural disasters that occurred in Indonesia.
Backgrounds
NGO x is the only non-profit organization whose vision is to contribute to a united and peaceful
Indonesia through synergy among diverse constituents (government, business, and civil society)
of the Indonesian society and the international community, because NGO x realize all elements
should synergize each other to get better future of Indonesia. NGO x main course is education to
synergize 3 sectors (government, business, and civil society). Same with another organization, to
enrich their vision NGO x also have strategies, but the biggest challenge is how to aligning the
strategic goals of organization into individual performance, so that the execution can run
smoothly.
408
NGO x need performance management to answer that challenge, performance management is a
continuous process of identifying, measuring and developing the performance of individuals or
teams and aligning that performance to the strategic goals of the organization. Performance
management has three main functions which are classified as strategic, administrative and
developmental. The strategic function links the workers performance to the overall
organizational strategy. Administratively, performance management provides valuable
information to help the managers make important decisions such as salary increments,
promotions, recognition and rewards. The developmental function of performance management
is realized through the provision of information on the strengths and weaknesses of
organizations.
BUSINESS ISSUE EXPLORATION
Business issue that should be addresses is NGO x need performance management system,
because NGO x already in the comfort zone need more challenge to get sustainability. To
explore this issue, the first thing to do is to define the factors that influence the performance of
the current NGO x. These factors are performance management system has been implemented in
the organization, external factors and internal factors. Factors that affect the performance of this
NGO x will be further analyzed to obtain root causes.
Figure 1 Conceptual Framework
Current Performance Management System
In the journey started from 2003, NGO x has been trying to build a performance management
system using the Balance Scorecard method in 2013, but the process of performance
management system is not running in the next year. The design process of performance
management system in 2013 began with analysis external condition and internal condition to
formulate in SWOT diagram. After formulation SWOT analysis, in 2013 NGO x also built
TOWS matrix to defined strategy and describe the strategy in strategy map for organization level
to obtained KPI of the organization.
409
The design of the performance management system in 2013 only reached the stage of the
organization, because of lack of resources. Problems that occur is the review process do not run
properly. Factors which cause are:
a. The performance management system that has been designed NGO x less suited to the
conditions at this time
b. Lack of manpower to assist in the design and control of the performance management
system
c. There are many key performance indicators that cannot be measured as yet unidentified
and it’s happened until 2014.
External Analysis
An organization’s external environment creates both opportunities and threat to the organization.
Opportunities and threats affect an organization’s strategic actions, the external environment
influences organizations as they seek strategic competitiveness and above average returns.
Organizations understand the external environment by acquiring information about competitors,
customer and other stakeholders to build their own base of knowledge and capabilities. The
output of the external analysis into opportunities and threats
Internal Analysis
In the Internal aspect is about organization resources as all assets, capabilities, organizational
process, organization attributes, information, knowledge, controlled by an organization and
proposed that an organization has a competitive advantage when it creates a successful strategy
based on organization resources that cannot be duplicated by a current or potential competitor.
There are two kind resources, tangible resources with 4 aspects and intangible resources with 3
aspects. The output of the internal analysis into strengths and weaknesses.
SWOT Analysis
SWOT analysis is summary from external analysis and internal analysis. Here is the SWOT
analysis form NGO x a. Strength
Network resources
Unique programs/ U theory
Reliable Board of Trustee
Capable knowledge of human resources
Appointed chair of SDSN
Group support
b. Weaknesses
Understanding of organization vision and mission
Management System
Financial autonomy single donor
Internalization of core value (team work,
communication and trust)
decision making and operational challenges (Execution)
Supporting Technology
Branding communication
Clarity as independent foundation
Limited resources (Financial, Manpower, Infrastructure)
c. Opportunities
Demographic Bonus
AEC (Asean Economic Community)
Alumni IDEAS
d. Threats
Competitors
Donor fatigue
410
Capacity building for other NGO
Alignment of our core program with
government strategic direction
Close bilateral relationship between
Singapore and Indonesia Governments
MOOC on U theory
Private sector need to allocate funding
especially in CSR (Corporate Social
Responsibility)
BUSINESS ANALYSIS
Analysis business solution will be carried out in three steps to design the performance
management system using BSC method based on premium execution book (Kaplan&Norton,
2004):
Develop the strategy
Clarify Vision and Mission statement
NGO x Vision: “To contribute to a united and peaceful Indonesia through synergy among
diverse constituents of the Indonesian society and the international community.”
There are several criteria to clarify vision and mission statement and develop good vision and
mission.
To vision, here the criteria:
A single sentence
Inspire-making employees feel comfortable working in an organization
Written in good and correct without empty words
Easily understood by all employees
Focus on one or two aspects of performance only. Not too much
Can be tested levels of achievement
Developed by the CEO or the manager, not by committee
Validity is reviewed annually
Realistic, showing the company's current position and the limited resources they have
Can be changed
Catchy employees without having to see the brochure
Based on criteria above about good vision, NGO x vision is not inspiring the employee because
there is no ambitious statement about long-term goal. Proposed vision is “To be leader as
learning foundation to contribute to a united and peaceful Indonesia through synergy among
diverse constituents of the Indonesian society and the international community.”
NGO x mission is “To serve as an educational platform and to act as a catalyst for trust-building
and cooperation among business, the public sector, and civil society through a learning process
411
for the betterment and of Indonesia while managing the challenges and opportunities for
globalization.”
To mission, here the criteria
Clearly distinguish between your organization with competitors
Defining what the organization is doing
Identify key capabilities and competencies
Encourage organizations to make better decisions regarding future opportunities
Define the product or service without becoming too narrow
No longer than one paragraph
Can be clearly understood by employees
Written in good and correct sentence without including the blank sentences
Focus on current conditions and are not mixed / combined with a vision statement for the
future
Reviewed and rewritten if the organization experienced a change in scope
Specifically to influence the behavior of individuals within the company
Reflect the real advantage of the company and based on the recognition of the strengths and
weaknesses of the company
Realistic and achievable
Flexible enough so that it can respond to environmental changes
Refers to a competitive advantage
Includes some logical statement and values behind these statements to evoke the spirit and
facilitating communication within and outside the organization
The mission statement of NGO x already clearly enough and suitable with a good mission
criteria. In conclusion, there is no need to change to mission statement.
Strategy Analysis using IFAS and EFAS Analysis
IFAS and EFAS analysis can be used to analyze the strategy of the organization by providing a
rating on the weights and factors strengths, weaknesses, opportunities and threats are already
formulated in SWOT analysis and get final scores to be mapped on IE matrix. IE matrix will
show in figure below:
412
Figure 2 IE Matrix
Strategy Formulation using TOWS matrix
TOWS analysis is an algorithm of the strategic analysis process, involving systematic and
comprehensive assessment of external and internal factors that determine current condition and
growth potential of the company.
It is based on a simple classification scheme: all of the factors influencing the current and future
position of the organization is divided into: External and internal to the organization, Having
negative and positive impact on the organization.
By comparing opportunities and threats with strengths and weaknesses of the organizations in
TOWS matrix will allows the organization to define its strategic position, and can also be a
source of interesting ideas of strategies
Plan the strategy
Planning the strategy begin with develop strategy map to clearly the communicate their strategic
plan. The Balanced scorecard itself has four perspectives, there are financial, customer, internal
process and learning and growth. All perspective of the Balanced Scorecard should addresses in
the strategy map.
NGO x as a non-profit organization has a strategy map that is slightly different in perspective, if
it is generally four perspectives on the BSC consists of a financial, customer, internal process
and learning & growth. In NGO x, perspective used is the perspective of the stakeholders,
financial, internal process and learning & growth. Design of the strategy map as the composition
of the figure below:
413
Figure 3 Strategy Map Framework for non-profit organization
The strategy map of the NGO x will be shown in appendix 2. From the strategy map strategy
maps obtained from strategic objectives, KPIs and strategic initiatives.
Align the strategy
To success in executing the performance management system by linking the strategy to
operations, the next step is aligning to division, because division is a part of the system in the
organization that should has same strategy with the organization. The strategy map of the
division in NGO x will be show in appendix 3
CONCLUSION and RECOMMENDATION
Conclusion
Based on analysis in the previous chapter, it can be concluded that:
a. NGO x has 12 strategic objectives with 25 KPIs and 125 strategic initiatives. For each
division here detail explanation:
Learning: 8 strategic objectives, 21 KPIs and 58 strategic initiatives
Community Learning Center: 10 strategic objectives, 21 KPIs and 59 strategic initiatives
Finance: 9 strategic objectives, 17 KPIs and 22 strategic initiatives
General Admin: 9 strategic objectives, 24 KPIs and 51 strategic initiatives
Funding and Program Development: 9 strategic objectives, 16 KPIs, and 26 strategic
initiatives
Waste Management: 6 strategic objectives, 16 KPIs, 27 strategic initiatives
b. There are several aspects that need to be considered in designing performance
management system with The Balanced Scorecard method especially in non-profit
organization. The aspects as follow:
Employees Commitment
When building a performance management system, both in the government sector, the
business sector or the non-profit organization if it is not supported by the participation of
all parties concerned, the performance management system will only end in a document
and will not have any function for the organization. Therefore, before designing a
performance management system required the support and commitment of all employees
of the organization to jointly bring the organization to a better direction through a
performance management system.
Perspective of The Balanced Scorecard
414
The Balanced Scorecard perspective in general is a financial perspective, customer,
internal process and learning and growth. However, any time can be changed according
to the needs of the company/organization, for NGO x as non-profit organizations there
was little change in the perspective used is not the customer perspective is replaced with
a stakeholder perspective, because NGO x coverage for the parties to be fulfilled
satisfaction is very wide and varied (NGO x’s stakeholder: Donor, client, local
community, alumni, partners).
Strategy Map
The composition of a strategy map for each company or organization is not the same,
depending on the needs of the company/organization. In the case of the NGO x, the
design of the strategy map as the composition of the figure 4.
Identification new KPI
In the previous chapter there is a quotation in Kaplan & Norton book The Balanced
Scorecard: “if you can’t measure it, then you can’t manage it.” So that, in this research
author should make sure that all KPI has been identified.
4.2 Recommendation
Recommendation for the next final project in NGO x:
a. Develop application to review performance that easy to be implementing (user
friendly).
b. Run the implementation process to execute NGO x strategy using BSC method and
make improvements and updates KPI according to the state of the organization at that
time.
REFERENCES
Ascendant Strategic Management Group. Balanced Scorecard Strategy Maps Non Profit and
Charity Examples. www.ascendantmg.com
David, Fred. (2013) Strategic Management: Concepts and Cases, 14th Edition, New Jersey:
Prentice Hall, Pearson Education Asia Pte Ltd.
Neely, A., Adams, C., & Kennerly, M., (2002), The Performance Prism: The Scorecard for
Measuring and Managing Business Success, London: Pearson Education Limited.
Niven, P. R. (2003). Balanced scorecard: Step-by-step for government and nonprofit agencies.
Hoboken, NJ: John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
Kaplan, R.S. and Norton, D.P. (1996). The Balanced Scorecard: Translating Strategy into
Action, Harvard Business School Press, Boston, MA.
Kaplan, R.S. and Norton, D.P. (2004). Strategy Maps: Converting Intangible Assets into
Tangible Outcomes, Harvard Business School Press, Boston, MA.
415
Kaplan, R.S. and Norton, D.P. (2008). The Premium Execution: Linking Strategy to Operations
for Competitive Advantage, Harvard Business School Press, Boston, MA.
Ronchetti, Jan L. An Integrated Balanced Scorecard Strategic Planning Model for Nonprofit
Organizations, City of Naperville, IL.
Wibisono, Dermawan. (2012) How to Create a World Class Company, PT. Gramedia Pustaka
Umum, Jakarta
Internet Center for Management and Business Administration. SWOT Analysis.
http://www.netmba.com/strategy/swot/.
Julianto, Ari. (2013). Conceptual vs Theoretical Frameworks. http://skripsi-fkip-
inggris.blogspot.com/2013/04/conceptual-vs-theoretical-frameworks.html.
APPENDIX 1 NGO X STRATEGY MAP 2013
416
APPENDIX 2 TOWS MATRIX
S W
S1 Network resources
S2 Unique programs/ U theory
S3 Reliable Board of Trustee
S4 Capable knowledge of human resources
S5 Appointed chair of SDSN
S6 Group support
W1 Understanding of organization vision and mission
W2 Management System
W3 Financial autonomy single donor
W4 Internalization of core value (team work,
communication and trust)
W5 decision making and operational challenges
(Execution)
W6 Supporting Technology
W7 Branding communication
W8 Clarity as independent foundation
W9 Limited resources (Financial, Manpower,
Infrastructure)
O O1 Demographic Bonus
O2 AEC (Asean Economic Community)
O3 Alumni IDEAS
O4 Capacity building for other NGO
O5 Alignment of our core program with
government strategic direction
O6 Close bilateral relationship between
Singapore and Indonesia Governments
O7 MOOC on U theory
O8 Private sector need to allocate funding
especially in CSR (Corporate Social
Responsibility)
SO Strategy
(S1,S4, S5 : O4, O5, O8) Nurturing Learning
ability of the key stakeholder in 3 sector
(S1, S3 : O1, O3, O4, O5, O6, O8) Expanding
and Synergize Partner Relationship (S4, S6 : O8) Nurturing Learning ability of the
key stakeholder in 3 sector
(S2 : O7) Strengthening awareness of program
WO Strategy
(W1, W4, W8 , W9 : O4, O5, O8) Enhancing quality
and performance of the personnel (W2, W5 : O4, O5, O8) Enhancing governance of
program
(W3 : O1, O6) Increase financial autonomy
(W6 : O7) Excellent Information System
(W7 : O1, O2) Strengthening Awareness of program
T T1 Competitors
T2 Donor fatigue
ST Strategy
(S2 : T1) Strengthening awareness of program
(S1, S6 : T2) Increase financial autonomy
(S1, S3 : T1) Expanding and synergize partner
relationship
WT Strategy
(W2, T2) Excellent Financial management
(W5 : T1) Enhancing quality and performance of the
personnel
(W3 : T2) Increase financial autonomy
(W6 : T1) Adapting appropriate technology
(W7 : T1) Strengthening awareness of program
TO
WS
417
APPENDIX 3 STRATEGY MAP OF NGO X 2015
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (ORGANIZATION)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL % of reduce donor from group
% commercial revenue growth
INTERNAL % NGO x financial report accuracy
418
PROCESS # of Audit finding
% On time NGO x financial report to Management (monthly)
% Budget deviation of NGO x
% on time annual budget submission
# of Information update in NGO x website
# of organization publication
Program Quality index
# of visitor to CLC
# of learning and community development activity
# of collaborative program
# of partner increase
# of new donor
% of SDSN Initiatives followed up
% accomplishment of SDSN program
% accomplishment of general policy and regulation of organization
% accomplishment of HR Policy
% accomplishment of Asset and facility management Policy
% accomplishment of Accounting Policy
% of product development
% accomplishment of planning document
% accomplishment of annual reporting document
LEARNING
AND GROWTH
% of individual compliance
Average training hours
# of value sharing session
Employee satisfaction index
# of new technology adapted
Service level of Internal Application
% of internet access downtime
L/T of information technology services
419
APPENDIX 4 STRATEGY MAP DIVISION
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (LEARNING DIV)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL
% of financial autonomy of Learning Division
# late days of Cash in advance settlement
% budget deviation of division
# late days of final budget submission
INTERNAL
PROCESS
# of news update from NGO x website
# of posting blog
# of article in NGO x newsletter
# of Learning Div publication
Program quality index
# of delivered learning program activity
# of alumni database entry
Duration of visit to the Alumni forum learning page (online)
# of events
# of attendance of Alumni gathering
# of partners
# of collaborative program
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (LEARNING DIV)
LEARNING % of product development
420
AND GROWTH % accomplishment of planning document
% accomplishment of reporting document
% of Leaning Div personnel compliance
Training hours of Learning Div
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (CLC DIV)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL
% of financial autonomy of the CLC division
# late days of Cash in advance settlement
% budget deviation of division
# late days of final budget submission
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (CLC DIV)
INTERNAL
PROCESS
# of news update from NGO x website
# of article in NGO x newsletter
421
# of CLC publication
CLC Program quality index
# of visitor
# of delivered CLC program activity
# of collaborative program activity
# partner increase
LEARNING
AND GROWTH
% of individual personnel compliance
% of local community attendance
# of local community sharing session hours
Training hours of Division
% of concept development
Accomplishment of document planning
Accomplishment of reporting document
# of new technology adapted
% accomplishment of facility development
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (GA DIV)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL # late days of final budget submission
422
% Budget deviation of GA division
INTERNAL
PROCESS
% accomplishment of general policy and regulation of organization
Update organization structure
# late days of attendance report
# late days of foundations KPI report
% of all personnel compliance
# of NGO x dialogue studio
# internal coordination meeting
# management meeting
% accomplishment of HR policy
Employee satisfaction index
Average Training hours
% accomplishment of Asset and infrastructure management Policy
Service level of Internal Application
% of internet access downtime
L/T of information technology services
# of new technology adapted
# completion draft legal
Program quality index
# of delivered program activity
# of news update from NGO x website
# of posting blog
# of article in NGO x newsletter
# of publication
LEARNING
AND GROWTH
% accomplishment of planning document
% accomplishment template of reporting document
% of GA Div personnel compliance
Training hours of GA Div
423
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (FINANCE DIV)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL
# Update information of the performance of financial autonomy
monthly
# late days of final budget submission
% Budget deviation of finance division
INTERNAL
PROCESS
NGO x financial report accuracy
% On time NGO x financial report to Management (monthly)
# of audit finding
% On time tax payment and reporting
# late days of cash in advance settlement
Lead time of expenses reimbursement
% on time annual budget compilation and review
% budget deviation of Foundation
LEARNING
AND GROWTH
% of policy development and deployment
% accomplishment of annual financial report
Training hours of FIN
% of Finance personnel compliance
Achievement of accounting system
424
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (FUNDING DIV)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL
% reduce donation from group
% revenue growth
% budget deviation of division
# late days of final budget submission
INTERNAL
PROCESS
# of proposal
# of new donor
# of collaborative program activity
# of new partners
Index of recognition
# of knowledge sharing
% compliance to donor
LEARNING
AND GROWTH
Update donor database
% of concept development
% accomplishment of planning document
% accomplishment of reporting document
% of Fund raising personnel compliance
Training hours of division
425
OBJECTIVE KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATOR (WASTE MANAGEMENT
DIV)
STAKEHOLDER Collaborative Index
Knowledge index
FINANCIAL
% of financial autonomy of Waste Management Division
# late days of Cash in advance settlement
% budget deviation of division
# late days of final budget submission
INTERNAL
PROCESS
Level of awareness of waste management initiative
# of NGO partner campaigns/events participated
# of events
# of partners engage
% accomplishment of kompos development as piloting project
LEARNING
AND GROWTH
% of concept development
% accomplishment of planning document
% accomplishment of reporting document
% of waste management div personnel compliance
Training hours of waste management Div
426
THE EFFECT OF HUMAN RELATION ON EMPLOYEE
PERFORMANCE AT FACULTY OF ECONOMICS OF
SYIAH KUALA UNIVERSITY
Dra. Yurnalis, M.Ed.
Faculty of Economics
Syiah Kuala University, Aceh
Yoernalis2005@yahoo.com
Wirdah Irawati, S.E, M.sc.
Faculty of Economics
Syiah Kuala University, Aceh
ABSTRACT
In an organization, institution or enterprise, human resource is very important aspect
since many human skills cannot be replaced by technology tools even though technology
has advanced rapidly now. The relationship among people is very necessary to create a
subordinate and leader relation in the assumption that human beings are creatures who
have feeling, desires, needs, aspirations and ideas differing from one another. This
study on human relation was conducted at the Faculty of Economics of UNSYIAH,
Darussalam, Banda Aceh, while the research object is associated with human relations
and employee performance in Faculty of Economics of UNSYIAH. To determine the
extent of employee relations in Faculty of Economics with fellow employees or
superiors, the employees are given some questions. The result shows that human
relations influence the employee performance at Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH
strongly.
Keywords: human relation, employee performance, communication, syiah kuala
I. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Backgrounds
In an organization, institution or enterprise, human resource is very important
aspect since many human skills cannot be replaced by technology tools even though
technology has advanced rapidly now. Thus the importance of human resources, so
much time, energy and thought of an organization, business entity, or agency
devoted to it to take care of the problems that are complicated and sensitive which
427
cannot be solved easily but require discretion. Leaders use the greater part of their
time to solve the problem of employees as subordinates in order to create
atmosphere of peace, quiet, and harmony in carrying out their work.
In connection with that, the relationship among people is very necessary to
create a subordinate and leader relation in the assumption that human beings are
creatures who have feeling, desires, needs, aspirations and ideas differing from one
another. This is true for organizations such Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH as
organizational leadership education agency that oversees the two categories of
workers as teachers and educators, and employees as administrative personnel who
take care of everything regarding education in this institution.
In performing their duties the employees of the Faculty of Economics cannot be
separated from the constraints that could lead to problems such as feeling pressure
where it must be dealt with human relations in a popular language called Human
Relations which serves to motivate employees and create a comfortable working
situation like one harmonious big family. Good human relations within an
organization will avoid conflicts and humanitarian problems and even can move
employees to work with more vigor and yield better work from time to time so that
organizational goals of Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH can be achieved in great
manner.
Although the factor of human relations is not the only factor that affects the
performance of employees, because there are still factors of salary, work
environment, discipline, self-motivation in employees, facilities and equipment, but
the factor of human relations is a factor that is very worth noting and maintained. To
that the authors will be attempting to examine the influence of human relations at
the Faculty of Economics of Unsyiah with the title "Human Relations Influence on
Employee Performance Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH".
1.2 Research Issues
Based on the background described above, then the problem in this study is how
far the influence of human relations to employee performance in Faculty of
Economics UNSYIAH.
1.3 Research Purposes
Based on the identification of the problem above, this study aims to determine
the effect of variable human relations to employee performance in Faculty of
Economics UNSYIAH.
1.4 Research Usefulness
This research is expected to be useful for:
a. To be input to the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH in an effort to improve the
quality of employee performance.
b. To be authors' knowledge to design further research in improving the
performance of employees.
428
II. LITERATURE REVIEW
2.1. Human Relations
2.1.1. Understanding Human Relations.
Human relations have several definitions that have been formulated by some
experts included what has been proposed by Flippo (2009: 94) that Human Relation
is "combining between resources (as individual or group) with the organization and
attempting to resolve the dispute that is not inevitable". While Effendi (2002: 48)
split human relations into two terms, namely:
"Human relations in the broad sense are persuasive communication that a person
does to another person face to face in all situations and walks of life that create the
happiness and satisfaction of both parties. Human relations in the narrow sense are
persuasive communications conducted by a person to another person face to face in
a work situation and in the organization of the workmanship (work organization)
with the aim of stirring excitement and activity work in a spirit of fruitful
cooperation with happy feeling and satisfied heart".
Of the two definitions above, it can be taken notion that human relations are a
series of good relations among people in order to achieve the objectives of the
organization or company that has elements of persuasive communication,
employment situation, and the organization workmanship. According to Effendi
(2002; 81), the process of delivering a persuasive action here is done by one person
to another in order to change attitudes, opinions, and its behavior with self-
awareness. While the definition of the employment situation is a situation, whether
good or bad, that happens in the work environment in the time the work
progresses. Therefore, it can be understood that human relations are integrating
people into a work situation that reminds them to work together with satisfaction,
whether the satisfaction of economic or social psychology. While Siagian (2000:
92) split human relations into 10 basic principles, namely:
1. There should be synchronization between organizational goals with individual
goals within the organization.
2. Pleasant working atmosphere.
3. In pleasant relation of informality of work.
4. Human subordinate is not a machine.
5. Develop the ability of subordinates to the maximum level.
6. Job that’s interesting and challenging.
7. Recognition and appreciation for the execution of tasks well (extraordinary
performance).
8. Sufficient fittings.
9. The right man on the right place.
10. Remuneration must be commensurate with services rendered.
To establish good cooperation among people within an organization, good
human relations are needed in harmonious relations among employees within an
429
organization. The human factor in human relations is not intended in physical figure but
rather the nature, character, behavior and personality, and other psychological aspects
contained in human beings where there is a role to encourage a productive and creative
collaboration to achieve a common goal. Therefore it requires leadership and skills
development in the disciplines of psychology, sociology, anthropology and ethology in
understanding and addressing human relations problem.
2.1.2. The human factor in human relations
Human resource is an important element in an organization in which the quality
of an organization is determined by the quality of its resources, which are human beings
(people) who work in achieving the organization goals. So, many organizations say that
"our people are our asset". The employees are one portion of human resources in the
enterprise, agency or organization where employees are characterized by the possession
of knowledge, skills, organizational skills, and high working motivation of the estuary
to produce peak performance. So in practice, the human relations of the leaders should
pay attention to and study the nature of the employee which is somewhat different from
one another, as raised by Effendi book "Communication and Practice" (2002: 54), that
there are two factors that determine human nature, namely;
"Demeanor since he was born (heredity) and the environment. Inborn is his nature that’s
later influenced by the environment in which he lives. Environment that will determine
the properties how he will be flourished and directed. Interaction with people in the
environment will affect the properties available to him. "
Furthermore, Effendi (2000: 56) explains that based on psychic functions above,
humans are divided into three groups according to the direction of his attention, namely:
a. People whose attention directed out, called type extraverse, more concerned with
the environment than himself alone, places more priority in public interest rather
than their own interests. The person called extravert. People like this usually be
open, happy, welcoming, fluent interaction and radiate warmth, so quickly get a
lot of friends.
b. People whose attention mainly directed into himself called the introverted type,
and it’s called introvert. These people are more concerned with their own
interests rather than the public interest, taciturn, selfish, meditative, happy to
alienate himself, and cannot get along.
c. People who are among the groups that embiverse types, and individual
called embivert. This type of people is in greater number than
those extrovert and introvert.
For humans, the employee was made up of people who are extrovert and
introvert, therefore leaders need to know the nature of the employee so that he will be
able to understand the properties of their employees and ultimately may make it easier
to resolve the problems facing them. In the relationship between this man Matutina
(2000: 46) quotes Susanto said that the things that must be considered by the
organization are:
a. Willingness to obtain the cooperation among employees.
b. Allows a person to produce and higher achievement.
430
c. Allows someone working with a gain satisfaction from the work.
Furthermore, Davis (2000: 10) suggests there are four basic assumptions relating to the
human, namely:
1. Individual differences
People who have a lot in common in the world are also different
individually. Since the time of birth, every people bring their uniqueness and
individual experience to make people different. Because of these differences, it
cannot be applied to certain standards in terms of employees management.
2. People as a Whole
Although certain organizations may wish to only use the skill or brain of a
person, they got that person as a whole, not specific characteristics
separately. People function as whole beings. Because in addition to being an
employee of a particular company, they also become members in other
organizations, and they play many roles outside the company.
431
3. Motivated Behavior.
In case of necessity, people are not motivated by the things that we think they
should have but by the things they want.
4. People Value (Human Dignity)
This confirms the concept that people need to be distinguished from other
production factors because they are higher than all things in the universe. They
want to be respected in accordance with the dignity as human beings.
As humans, employees also have the desire to be appreciated not only
materially, but they would be happy if their works are consulted and considered by the
leaders, and they will be able to achieve a maximum level of personal growth if
provided in order environment that stimulates and encourages them to go forward,
because all human beings always want to do better all the time. The employees want to
do their best to achieve the goals of the organization because they constitute the main
capital in an organization that needs leaders who can create good human relations in
order to achieve the objectives in an efficient, economical, and practical way.
2.1.3. Principal components of the Human Relations
Key components of human relations according Handayaningrat (2002: 107) is;
1. Individual
An essential element in human relations is a very unique personality of each
individual (unique personality).
2. Group
Individual activities can be developed in a way which will form the
organizational group both formal and informal. The function of the individual
and group productivity is how the influence of the individual against the
group. An important aspect of the group is their relationship can be known by
communication, the other aspect is the personal relationship of human society
together in the framework of a working relationship with a certain group.
3. Situation
The situation is the third principal component of human relations known as the
state of the environment and this is associated with the provision of the
leadership of the reactor subordinates.
2.1.4. Factors Important In Human Relations
Kossen (2004: 8) divides the under- relation to the four types of goods that are both
formal and informal organization, namely:
1. The relationship between managers and workers.
2. Relations among the workers.
3. Relations among management personals.
432
4. The relationship between the members of the organization and society at
large.
Fostering good relations and harmony among all the principal types is an important
thing in order to achieve organizational goals, so that Rusdi (2000: 75) mentions several
important factors in human relations in an institution or an organization, namely:
1. Importance of individual; showing interests or feelings for each
individual, as employees, workers, and so on.
2. Mutual acceptance; mutual understanding, accepting and understanding
between leaders and subordinates to perform tasks and functions.
3. High moral standard; ie attention to the high standard of morality in
every attitude and behavior such as professionalism, leadership and
workers.
4. Common interest; human relationships developed in order to achieve
common interests.
5. Open communication; the principles of communication that are open to
create a mutual understanding and comprehension of the instruction
execution tasks effectively.
6. Participation; human relationships that involve the participation of,
opinions, ideas and suggestions for all levels contribution to achieve a
common goal.
While Musanef (2001: 54) explains that in human relations there should be nine factors
/ principles that must be applied by the management are:
1. Should strive for synchronization between organizational goals and
individual goals within the organization. Synchronization is necessary
because every human being has a different basis.
2. Attractive working environment and not to treat subordinates as a
machine. A leader must strive to be able to foster an attractive working
environment so not to cause frustration for any subordinate led.
3. Informality in labor relations needs to be based on the axiom that applies
in organization theory, that the more successful group leaders foster a
democratic organization.
4. Develop the ability to subordinate to the maximum level possible under
the relevant restrictions and budget scope as well as the needs of the
organization.
5. Avoid jobs that are routine because basically people who actually work
is a dynamic person full of challenges that cause excitement when they
work.
6. Recognition and appreciation for the implementation of tasks well.
Balance between obligations to the rights of employees is needed in the
sense that the award should be given in a timely manner to the execution
of a job well done.
7. Fulfillment of their facilities and equipment in the organization's needs.
8. The right man on the right place; placement of employees in positions
corresponding to the knowledge and expertise.
433
9. Remuneration that’s commensurate with services rendered should be
feasible taking into account economic factors, social, and ethical as well
as other factors such as the job facilities, working conditions, provision
of pensioners and so on.
Furthermore Musanef (2001; 57) explains that in implementing the principles of human
relations there are four points that must be considered as follows:
1. Basically human beings are never satisfied.
2. No two or more people who have the same motive in all respects.
3. Everyone coming to work in an organization brings with it the properties,
both negative and positive.
4. Humans have basically the ratio, dignity and self-esteem so that they are
never an equivalent tool.
2.2. Performance
2.2.1. Understanding Performance
Prawiro Sentono (2002: 120) mentions performance is the result of work that
can be achieved by individual or group of people in an organization, in accordance with
the responsibilities and authority of each in an effort to achieve organizational
goals. There is a close relationship between individual performance and organizational
performance, ie, if the employee's performance is good then there is great likelihood
organizational performance will be good.
Lowyer and Porte in quotation As'ad (2000: 120) states that job performance or
the performance of the business is a result achieved by a person under conditional size
where work is concerned, as a degree to which employees meet / achieve the specified
job requirements. While Dessler (200: 268) states that the work decline analysis is
verifying the work and determining whether the decline should be corrected through
training or through other means. While Badudu (2002: 697) in a common dictionary
Indonesian stated that "performance is what is achieved or performance to be
seen". And further Bastian (2001: 329) states that the performance was "a picture of the
level of achievement of the implementation of an activity / program / wisdom in
realizing the goals, objectives, mission, and vision of the organization as stated in the
formulation of strategic schemes (strategic planning) of an organization. In general it
can also be noted that the performance is a feat that can be achieved by the organization
in particular period".
From the quote above it can be concluded that the performance is achievement
acquired a company or individual on a level-where employees meet or achieve the
specified job requirements. To get the workforce that has good performance, the
performance appraisal is necessary, because with a good assessment system, the
employees understand what is expected by the company. Individual assessment is a
systematic process of reviewing and assessing leader abilities, work behavior, and
performance of officer in a certain time period to be used as consideration for decisions
on actions in the field of human resources.
2.2.2 Performance Measurement
434
Human resources department uses the information collected through
performance assessment to evaluate the success of the recruitment, selection,
orientation, placement, training and development, as well as other activities although
informal assessments during the activity day after day is essential for rapid action. For
this, Mangkuprawira (2003: 201) argues that "the approach to performance assessment
should identify the relevant performance standards, measuring criteria, and then
providing feedback to the employees and the Department of Human Resources".
If the calculation of performance standards has no relation to work, evaluation
can lead to inaccurate or biased test results, relaxes the relationship manager with the
employee, and minimize the same working condition opportunity. Without feedback,
the improvement in the behavior of the human resources department is not possible and
will not have an accurate record of the human resources information system. Thus, the
basic decisions in drafting the job until the compensation will be disrupted.
Human Resources Department typically design and manage corporate performance
appraisal system. Although the Human Resources Department develop different
approaches for managers, professionals, workers, and pain groups, uniform performance
of each group is needed to ensure a result that can be compared.
Some common causes that often lead to failures in the assessment of performance and
should be avoided are mentioned by Dessler followed by Ruky (2002: 102) as follows:
1. The absence of standards.
Without a standard, objective assessment cannot be achieved. There is only a
subjective assessment that relies on estimates and feelings.
2. Standards that are not relevant and are subjective.
Standards should be established through the process of job analysis / position to
determine the outcome or the expected output of the job.
3. Standards are realistic.
Standards are targets that have the potential to stimulate motivation. Standards
should be more reasonable and challenging potential to stimulate motivation.
4. Improper measure of achievement.
Objectivity and comparison requires that the progress towards the
achievement of standards can be measured easily and transparently. Examples of
quantitative measurement is: "1% failure rate for quality production, 10 sales
orders from every 100 visits". Whereas qualitative example: "completion of the
project on a fixed date".
5. Assessor error.
435
Including fault evaluator of 'partiality' (bias), the feeling of prejudice,
"halo effect" (affected by the assessed), a tendency to be "stingy" or vice versa,
the tendency to choose the middle value and be afraid to confront subordinates.
6. Giving bad feedback.
At the beginning of the performance management process, standards
should be communicated to employees and considered to be known and agreed
upon. Similarly, the whole process of assessment and appraisal results should be
communicated to them in accordance with the principles and objectives of the
program, particularly the performance management program.
7. Negative communications.
The evaluation process turned out to be disturbed by the communication
constituted with such negative attitude of arrogance and selfishness on the part
of the assessor and defensiveness and secrecy on the part of the assessed.
Appraisers should establish accurate picture of individual
performance. Assessment is not done just for knowing bad performance. The
results were good and acceptable to be identified so that it can be used as a basis
for the assessment of other things. To achieve this goal, ranking system should
be associated with the work and practice, including standards, and using
measurable criteria. Related work means that the system evaluates critical
behavior containing job success. If the evaluation is not linked to the job, it is
not valid. Without validity and the degree of confidence, the system can be
discriminated by existing laws fairly.
To corroborate the above opinion, the following are the terms of an effective
performance management program cited by Ruky (2002: 25), namely:
1. Relevance.
Things or factors measured are relevant (associated) with his work, whether
it is output, process or input.
2. Sensitivity.
The system used must be sensitive enough to distinguish between employees
who perform and do not perform.
3. Reliability.
The system used must be reliable as objective benchmarks, authentic,
accurate, consistent and stable.
4. Acceptability.
436
The system used must be understood and accepted by employees and the
assessor and facilitate the active and constructive communication between
the two.
5. Practicality.
All instruments, such as the form used, should be easy to use by both sides,
not complicated, horrible and convoluted.
According to Soeprihanto (2001: 7), performance is the result of an employment
for a certain period compared with a range of possibilities, such as standards, targets /
goals or criteria that have been determined in advance and have been
agreed. Furthermore, he stated again that performance appraisal is a system used to
assess and determine whether the employee has been carrying out their respective jobs
overall. Implementation of the work is not only seen from the results of his physical
activity but includes various factors such as the ability of workers, discipline, labor
relations, and special things in accordance with the fields and the level of work that he
held.
2.3. Framework
Framework scheme in the study shows human relations as an independent
variable while performance as the dependent variable that will be analyzed using simple
linear regression model to determine how much influence the human relations to
employee performance at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH. The following
schematic drawing of thought:
Independent Variables Dependent Variables
Human Relations: employee performance
a. Good relationship a. Results of the assessment
b. Mutual respect. b. The performance is satisfactory
c. Leadership act c. Standard with task completion
d. Implementation of the work d. Work to support the vision and mission
e. Employee behavior e. Work completed well and on time
f. Work atmosphere f. The performance assessment
g. Participation in activities g. Responsibility and authority
h. Participation in the meeting i. Effect to achieve the vision and mission
2.4. Hypothesis
Based on the previous research and review of literature, the hypothesis in this study are:
437
1. Ho: Human relations do not significantly influence employee
performance in Faculty of Economics of UNSYIAH.
2. Ha: Human relations have a significant effect on the performance of
employees at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH.
III. RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
3.1 Location and Research Object
This research was conducted at the Faculty of Economics of UNSYIAH,
Darussalam, Banda Aceh, while the research object is associated with human relations
and employee performance in Faculty of Economics of UNSYIAH.
3.2 Population and Sample
Population is the totality of all objects or individuals that have certain
characteristics, clear and complete aspect to be studied (materials research), while the
portion of the population sample is taken through certain ways which also represents
certain characteristics, clear, complete aspect that is considered to represent population
(Iqbal, 2001: 84).
Sampling based on the opinions of Arikunto (2000: 125), states that if the
number of population of less than 100 people then you should take all samples, so
research is the study of population, and if the amount is less than the population of 100
people, the number of samples is 10-15%. The population in this study were all
employees at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH totaling 150 people, the number of
samples to be drawn is approximately 15% (23 people) conducted by random sampling.
3.3 Data Collection Technique
To obtain the data in addressing problems of this study, the researchers
conducted a questionnaire that is a series of questions, where questions
structured include independent variables and the dependent variables of Human
Relations, i.e. employee performance. To find out about human relations are
good relations among employees in the achievement of objectives (vision and
mission) of Faculty of Economics, given the question:
a. Good relations among current employees in the workplace
b. Mutual respect of fellow employees.
c. The attitude of the leadership in understanding the employee.
d. Execution of work orders from superiors / leaders.
e. Employee behavior in the workplace.
f. Atmosphere in the work will be more excited with mutual respect and
appreciation.
438
g. Participation in any activities of the Faculty.
h. Participation in the meeting of the Faculty of Economics.
While to know about the performance of the employee, then it’s given questions
including:
a. The response to the results of the assessment given by the supervisor /
leader.
b. Whether performance determines promotion.
c. Does the boss employee satisfy performance requirement.
d. Can complete the task according to the standard.
e. Do employees support the vision and mission of Faculty of Economics
Unsyiah.
f. Can employees do a job well and on time.
g. Is the performance appraisal indispensable to find out what is expected
by this Faculty.
h. Feel all the responsibility and authority influence in achieving the vision
and mission of the Faculty.
3.4 Measurement of Scale Data
Data obtained through questionnaires in the form of qualitative composed
beforehand into quantitative form. The quantitative value composed done by
using Likert Scale;
a. A value of 1 for answers Strongly Disagree.
b. A value of 2 to answer Strongly Agree
c. Grades 3 to answer Less Agree
d. Grades 4 to answer Agree
e. Grades 5 to answer Strongly Agree
3.5 Data Analysis Equipment
Analytical equipment used is simple linear regression method. Mathematically
the form of a simple linear regression formulation is as follows (Gujarati, 2002:
24):
Y = a + b X + e
Y = Variable Performance
439
a = constant
b = coefficient of regression
X = Human Relations
e = Factor Disruptors
4. Hypothesis Testing
To test the effect of human relations on the performance of the Faculty of
Economics employees, research is done using two methods, namely the partial test
using t test, with the following hypotheses:
Ho: There is no effect of variable human relations to employee performance in
Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH.
Ha: There is a variable influence on the performance of the employee human
relations in the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH.
To test this hypothesis the author using the t test, namely at the level of confidence of
95% or error rate (alpha) by 0'05, which can be done by comparing the t-table with t-
test: if t count> t-table , then Ha is accepted, but if t count <t-table then Ha is
rejected. And when the significant value of 0 - 0.05 then Ho is accepted, but if the value
is significantly less than 0 or more than 0.05, then Ho is rejected.
Table III Characteristics of Respondents
No. Variables Frequency Percentage
1. Gender:
a. Male
b. Female
10
13
43.5
56.5
2. Employee status:
a. Permanent employee
b. Honor employees
19
4
82.6
17.4
3. Education:
a. SLTA
b. Diploma
4
4
17.4
17.4
440
c. S1
d. S2
14
1
60.9
4.3
4. Years Of Service:
a. <3 years
b. 3-4 years
c. 5-9 years
d. 10-14 years
e. 15-19 years
f. 20-24 years
g. = /> 25 years
1
1
5
3
8
3
2
4.3
4.3
21.7
13.0
34.8
13.0
8.7
4. M
a
Single
Married
2
21
8.7
91.3
IV. DISCUSSION
4.1 Variable Analysis of Human Relations
The relationship among the human beings is the result of interaction between
one person and another person, as well as the relationship between employee and
employer in an organization. Human relations will appear with their attitude and
communication both verbal and nonverbal in relationships and daily
activities. Similarly, the relationship among employees at the Faculty of Economics
is responsible for maximizing their employment effectiveness as their responsibility
who receive monthly salary in return. Therefore, to determine the extent of
employee relations in Faculty of Economics with fellow employees or superiors,
then they are given some questions to the direction of the relationship that gets the
following response:
Table IV-1 Respondents to the Human Relations in the workplace
No. Variables Average
1. The relationship between employees in the workplace is currently
running well
3.4348
441
2. Each employee respect each other 3.6957
3. The boss is very understanding to the employees 4.0435
4. Each superior orders is always welcomed and well done 4.1304
5. The average behavior of employees in the workplace is relatively good 4.2609
6. Atmosphere in the work is more excited with mutual respect and
appreciation
4.2174
7. Always participate in any activity of the Faculty of Economics 3.9130
8. Always participate in the meeting of the Faculty of Economics 3.9565
The mean 3.95653
Based on the table V-1 above it can be seen that the most employees feel that
employee behavior in the workplace are relatively good obtaining the value of 4.2609,
then the next ranking is still good in the more excited work atmosphere with mutual
respect and appreciation, that gain value of 4.2174, and followed by “any superior order
is always welcomed and well done by employees”, with a value of 4.1304. “The boss is
very understanding to the employees” gains value of 4.0435. “Participation in the
meeting of the Faculty of Economics” obtains the value of 3.9565, while the variable
"Always participate in any activities of the Faculty of Economics" gets the value of
3.9130. While the two lowest-ranked in the value of the variable that is recognized by
respondents is "Each employee respects one another", gains the value of 3.6957, and
"The relationship among employees in the workplace is currently running well" with
3.4348 points. Average value for human relations which is responded by the respondent
is 3.95653, which means that the relationship among humans (human relations ) among
the employees of the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH is good.
4.2. Analysis of Performance Variables.
To determine the performance of the employees of the Faculty of Economics
UNSYIAH, an understanding of the role of leadership is needed, in this regard the Dean
in interacting with subordinates both formal and informal. Dean’s insight and
understanding of the employees in their daily activities is necessary so that the work can
be achieved with the maximum result given the employees as human beings have needs
and problems that differ from one another both in the form of physical or
psychological. Dean's expertise in managing employees will affect the good relations
among employees, which in turn also affect the performance of the employees.
To find out how respondents on the performance of employee at the Faculty of
Economic Syiah Kuala University, GITEC following Table V-2 is the result of exposure
to the respondents' answers.
Table IV-2 Respondents To Performance Relation
442
No. Variables Average
value
1. Performance assessment of superiors satisfaction 3.3478
2. Your performance determines promotions 3.5652
3. Your performance satisfies boss 4.0000
4. You complete a task according to the standard 4.2609
5. You work to support the achievement of the vision and mission of the
Faculty
4.2609
6. Able to complete the task on time 4.3913
7. System Performance Assessment is required for knowing the expectations
of the Faculty
4.1739
8. The whole responsibility and authority influential in achieving the mission
of the Faculty
4.1739
The mean 4.02174
Listening to the table above it can be seen that the employees (respondents)
provides the highest-value response to the statement that "to complete the task on
time", accompanied by a second positive answer ranked second is the statement "You
work to support the achievement of the vision and mission of the Faculty", and "you r
complete a task according to the standard" that each gets the value of 4.2609. Ranked
third while there are also two variables which get the same value that is worth 4.1739,
which is still positive for the variable "All the responsibility and authority of the
influential in achieving the mission of the Faculty" and variable "System Performance
Assessment is required for knowing the expectations of the Faculty". Meanwhile to the
statement "your performance satisfying the boss" of the respondents respond with a
value of 4.0000, and for the statement "your performance determines promotion" gets
the average value of 3.5652 and last for the statement "Performance assessment of
superiors satisfaction" got an average rating of 3.3478. The value of the latter of two
variables can be understood that the employees are less satisfied with what is applicable.
4.3 Influence on Employee Performance Human Relations at Faculty Economics
UNSYIAH
To determine the influence of human relations to employee performance at
Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH, then Simple Linear Regression calculation is carried
that produces the following output:
Table IV-3 Summary of Analysis Results by Simple Linear Regression.
443
Variables
Research
Label Regression
coefficient
t-Count Significant
a Constants 2,047 0802 0,000
X Human Relations 0952 11 899 0,000
R squared: 0, 871
R correlation: 0, 933
Calculate F: 141 575
Significant: 0,000
Look at the output of the linear regression analysis above, it was found that the
estimated final equation is Y = 2047 + 0952 X, which means when 2047 as
variable human relations held constant, the level of employee performance at Faculty
Economics UNSYIAH amounted to 2.047%. If the variable X (Human Relations)
unchanged at one percent, it will affect the performance of employees increased by 0.
952 percent, assuming other variables beside human relation affecting human relations
are considered permanent.
Meanwhile, the correlation coefficient (R) which is 0, 933 or 93,3% indicated
that human relations are very closely related to the performance of the employees of the
Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH ie 93.3%. Furthermore, the coefficient determinant or
R squared worth 0.871 (87.1%), which means that human relations can influence the
performance of employees at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH by 87.1%, and only
18.9% as the rest which is another factor that can affect employee performance. The
numbers are so great for human relations employee of the Faculty of Economics, this
could have happened by several factors such as variables that are presented to
respondents only limited to variable of human relations, or it could also be caused by a
big difference between other business organizations with the organization / educational
institutions, which requires other studies.
4.4. Proof of Hypothesis
To test the hypothesis, this study used the t test at 95% confidence level or
degree of guilt ( a ) 0:05. The t test is done to see the influence of explanatory variables
on the dependent variable. The results were obtained by value t - count for the variable
human relations at 11.899 bigger than t table which is 2.0687, with a significance value
of 0.00, below the tolerance value of 0.05. It can be concluded that human
relations have partial influence on employee performance at Faculty of Economics
UNSYIAH.
V. CONCLUSIONS AND SUGGESTIONS
5.1 Conclusions
444
From the discussion in the previous chapter, then some conclusions can be
drawn:
1. Respondent to Human Relations at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH has an
average value of 3.95, which means that the respondents agree that the Human
Relations at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH have been implemented well
in carrying out their daily work.
2. Respondents to the performance of the employees of the Faculty of Economics
UNSYIAH has an average value of 4:02, which means that the employee agrees
with the performance at the Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH, and they have
also done a good job.
3. Human relations influence the employee performance at Faculty of Economics
UNSYIAH strongly.
4. The relationship between human relations with employee performance at
Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH is very strong.
5. Human relations have a significant effect on the performance of the employees
at Faculty of Economics UNSYIAH, as partial test results.
5.2 Suggestions
Here are suggestions that can be submitted after obtaining the results of research:
1. Employees’ human relations at Faculty of Economics of UNSYIAH, should be
kept well maintained and improved continuously so that the employee's
performance keeps increasing.
2. Leader of Faculty of Economics need to continue to hold events that can
strengthen and continue to improve human relations among employees Faculty
of Economics, Syiah Kuala University.
445
LIST OF REFERENCES
Almunadia, Miss. (2010). Effect of Human Relations on Employee Performance At
PT. Telkom Kandatel Aceh. Thesis, Unsyiah. Darussalam, Banda Aceh.
Arikunto, Suharmi (2000), Management Research, Rineka Reserved. Jakarta
Badudu, Zain. (2002). General Indonesian dictionary. Publishers Heritage Sinar
Harapan, Jakarta.
Davis. (2000) Human Resource Management. New Jersey: Prints to seven grants,
Jakarta.
Goddess (2008), Analysis of Human Relations At Hotel Jakarta. Journal of Economics
and Business. Vol. 6 3.
Effendi, Uchana Onong, (2002). Communication Science and Practice. Pt. Gunung
Agung, Jakarta.
Flippo, Edwin B. (2002) Personnel Management. Sixth edition of Volume 1 and 2,
Erland, Jakarta.
Gujarati, Damodar. (2002), Basic Econometrics, Translation Sumarno Zain, Publisher
grants University, Jakarta.
Handayaningrat, Soewarno (2002). Introduction to Administration and
Management. Mold to XI. CV. Haji Masagung, Jakarta.
Kossen (2004) Human Resource Management (Human Resources Management)
Volume I, Issue Indonesia, Simon and Schuester: Seventh Edition.
Malhotra, NK (2005). Marketing Research: An Applied Orientation. Forth Edition,
Prentice Hall of India Private Limited, New Delhi.
Matutina, Domic. C, (2000) Personnel Management). PT. Rineka Cipta, Jakarta.
Musanef (2001). Indonesian Personnel Management. Publisher of Mount Agung,
Jakarta.
Prasisto, Edi (2004). SPSS, Data Processing statistics Professionally. PT. Elex media
Komputindo, Jakarta.
Prawirosentono, (2002) Human Resources Management. Publishers Earth Literacy,
Jakarta.
Ruky, Achmad S. (2002) Performance Management System. PT. Gramedia Pustaka
Utama of Jakarta.
Soeprihanto, J. (2001), Human Resource Management II. Jakarta: The gift, the Open
University.
446
THE MEDIATING ROLE OF ORGANIZATIONAL COMMITMENT:
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN JOB SATISFACTION
AND INTENTION TO QUIT
I Gusti Ayu Putu Wita Indrayani
Bali Tourism Institute – Nusa Dua Bali
Email: wita_venus@yahoo.com
I Gede Riana
Economic Faculty and Business – University of Udayana - Bali
Email: gederiana@yahoo.com
ABSTRACT
The employee turnover rate in hotels lately was quite high, which could be observed
through the numbers of employee entering and leaving certain hotels since 2010 until
2014. Turnover was commonly initiated by the rise of employee’s intention to quit from
the job, in which related to job satisfaction and organizational commitment. The
research was aimed at identifying the role of organizational commitment in relationship
between job satisfaction and intention to quit. Survey design was applied to gather data
and information from various respondents. The population of this research was entire
employees of Nusa Dua Beach Hotel & Spa, one of many five star classified hotels
located in Bali. Proportionate stratified sampling was determined as sampling method
and research hypothesis was tested by Partial Least Square (PLS) method. The findings
of this research were: 1) job satisfaction had significant positive impact on
organizational commitment; 2) organizational commitment had significant positive
impact on intention to quit, 3) job satisfaction had no significant impact on intention to
quit, and 4) job satisfaction and intention to quit were fully mediated by the presence of
organizational commitment. These findings indicated that job dissatisfaction perceived
by employee had no direct impact on increasing their intention to quit, however it
implied to degradation of their organizational commitment before they eventually made
decision to quit at some point. Thus, hotel management is expected to be able to
carefully formulate various programs and policies to reduce employee’s intention to
quit by considering the efforts to enhance job satisfaction and organizational
commitment.
Keywords: Job Satisfaction, Organizational Commitment, and Intention to Quit
447
INTRODUCTION
The rapid development of hotels in Bali raises a fierce competition among them to deliver best
service to customers. Various efforts have been done to showcase the competitiveness of certain
hotels, such as developing varieties of the product or elevating the quality and capacity of
resources. Hotel industry must be able to achieve its goals (growth, profit, ability to survive,
good image, customer satisfaction and loyalty) through maximum utilization of diverse
resources. Simamora (2004) stated that one of the factors which showed potential competitive
advantage is human capital and how it is managed.
Employee turnover has been the strategic issue in this top level competition. At most of the case,
high turnover rate indicates a problem within an organization. Turnover includes employee
resignation, early retirement, termination, mutation to other units, and mortality. Employee
turnover, especially those who decide to quit from the organization will create imbalance in
system. There are many things related to turnover, but job satisfaction, organizational
commitment, and intention to quit are the most significant contributors to employee turnover
(Elangovan, 2001).
Turnover is initiated by the emergence of employee’s initiative to leave the organization. Gentry
et al. (1988) quoted that employee’s intention to quit from organization represented the actual
turnover. Furthermore, the antecedents of intention to quit are role ambiguity, role conflict,
conflict between job and family, job satisfaction, and organizational commitment. Pack et al.
(2007) argued that job satisfaction and management support are also the significant predictors of
employee’s intention to quit.
Decision to quit from and leave the organization is a consequence from the low level of
organizational commitment. Result of the research which was conducted by Foon et al. (2010)
showed negative relationship between organizational commitment and intention to quit.
Increasing organization commitment is most likely the fundamental aspect within an
organization. By developing organizational commitment, employee turnover rate can be
decreased ((DeConinck dan Bachmann, 1994). Another cause of employee’s intention to quit is
the lack of job satisfaction (Foon et al. 2010). Based on Cambridge Dictionary, job satisfaction
is the feeling of pleasure and achievement that is experienced in certain job. Job dissatisfaction
from employee implies to the rise of work absenteeism, turnover, work enthusiasm, complaints,
and other personnel vital issues (Martoyo, 2007).
The research done by Foon et al. (2010) and Luthans (2006) indicated negative relationship
between job satisfaction and intention to quit. Moreover, it is also revealed that job satisfaction
is one of the predictors of intention to quit (Yang et al., 2009). Koh and Boo (2004) found
significant positive relationship between job satisfaction and organizational commitment.
Azeem (2010) stated that supervision, salary, job satisfaction, age, and job tenure are significant
predictors of organizational commitment.
Organizational commitment can mediate relationship between job satisfaction and intention to
quit (Clugston, 2000). By using Structural Equation Modeling (SEM) analysis technique to
estimate the mediation effect of affective commitment, continuance commitment, and normative
commitment on the relationship between job satisfaction and intention to quit, finding of the
research revealed partial mediation between those variables. Another research suggested that
only affective commitment mediated relationship between job satisfaction and intention to quit
(Netemeyer et al. 1995). However, these findings are contrary with the study developed by
448
Allen and Meyer (1991; three dimensions of organizational commitment are fully mediating the
relationship between those two variables.
Some researchers have analyzed relationship between job satisfaction and organization
commitment with intention to quit (Foon et al. 2010). The rise of employee turnover rate is a
crucial problem to be solved immediately. High turnover rate is potential contributor in creating
the critical work load within organization because additional cost has to be made in order to
recruit, hire, and train the employees (Sulu et al. 2010)
CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK AND HYPOTHESIS
Employee turnover is originally initiated by the emergence of employee’s initiative to leave
organization. Intention to quit is one action performed by employee in consciousness to leave
the organization, either by thinking to leave organization or showing the intention to search
other jobs (George dan Alex, 2011). Intention to quit is the most significant predictor in
employee turnover pattern, especially voluntary turnover (Pack, 2007). Further in the study
mentioned that intention to quit is often triggered by the lack of job satisfaction and
organizational commitment.
One thing that can bring impact to intention to quit is job satisfaction level. (Martoyo, 2007).
There is correlation between job satisfaction and intention to quit. Yang et al. (2009) stated that
job satisfaction has negative impact on intention to quit. Intention to quit is related to
organizational commitment, which is a certain degree of employee’s loyalty toward
organization, accepting and internalizing the goals and values within organization, and involving
themselves in every organization activities (Lambert et al. 2007). There are three dimensions of
organizational commitment, such as affective commitment, continuance commitment, and
normative commitment (Allen dan Meyer, 1993). Moreover, organizational commitment is
significant predictor of employee’s intention to quit which can be seen as the effective solution
to overcome employee turnover (Sulu et al. 2010). The research conducted by Jaramillo et al.
(2005) found out significant negative relationship between organizational commitment and
intention to quit. Organizational commitment can also mediate the relationship between job
satisfaction and intention to quit partially (Clugston, 2000).
Based on previous description, the conceptual framework of this research is shown below:
FIGURE 1: THE CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK
TABLE 1: INDICATORS OF VARIABLES
Indicator Variable Indicator Variable
X1.1 Control X2.1 Affective commitment
X1.2 Job itself X2.2 Continuance commitment
Job
Satisfaction
Intention
to Quit
Org.
Commit
ment
Y1.1
Y1.2
Y1.3
Y1.4
X1.1
X1.2
X1.3
X1.4
X1.5
X2.1 X2.2 X2.3
449
X1.3 Job condition X2.3 Normative commitment
X1.4 Promotion Y1.1 Tendency to leave organization
X1.5 Salary Y1.2 Possibility to seek alternative job
Y1.3 Possibility to leave organization
Y1.4 Presence of better job opportunity
THE RELATIONSHIP OF JOB SATISFACTION AND ORGANIZATIONAL
COMMITMENT
Locke in Yuli (2005) revealed that someone’s job satisfaction depends on the discrepancy
between value, need, and expectation which should be received compared to their job perception
or what they have achieved. Thus a person will be satisfied if there is no discrepancy between
what is desired by the perception of reality, since the desired minimum limit has been reached.
An employee who is satisfied, likely would choose to stay in an organization because there has
been a meeting point between their desire with what is given by the organization. This will have
implications on an increased sense of psychological attachment to the organization's employees
in line with their commitment to the organization.
Many previous studies conducted to examine the relationship between job satisfaction and
organizational commitment. Research conducted by the McNeese-Smith (1996) suggested that
there was a positive relationship between job satisfaction and organizational commitment. These
results are consistent with further research which revealed that there was a strong and significant
correlation between job satisfaction and organizational commitment (Ghiselli et al., 2001; Koh
and Boo, 2004; Su-Chao and Ming-Shing, 2006; Azeem, 2010; Aydogdu and Asikgil, 2011).
Based on several studies that have been disclosed previously, the research hypothesis can be
formulated as follows:
H1 : Job satisfaction has significant positive effect to organizational commitment
THE RELATIONSHIP OF ORGANIZATIONAL COMMITMENT AND INTENTION
TO QUIT
Organizational commitment is a strong feeling of someone to the organization's goals and values
in relation to their role towards the efforts to achieve the objectives and values of the
organization (Durkin, 1999). Furthermore, Zurnali (2010) defined organizational commitment as
a psychological state that characterized employee relationship with the organization or the
implications that affected whether the employee would remain in the organization or not. When
the organizational commitment of employees is at a quite high level, it will be able to suppress
their desire to leave the organization, and vice versa. Thus, it can be concluded that the low level
of organizational commitment will give contribution on the intention to quit.
The findings of previous researched found out that organizational commitment had significant
negative effect to the employee’s intention to quit (Mayes and Ganster, 1988; McNeilly and
Russ, 1992; Lum et al., 1998; Sims and Kroeck, 1994; Deconinck and Bachmann, 1994;
Elangovan, 2001; Firth et al., 2004; Jaramillo et al., 2005; Kidd and Green, 2006; Foon et al.,
2010; Sulu et al., 2010). Furthermore, it was stated that organizational commitment affected
employee’s turnover intention, both internal and external (Chou-Kang et al., 2005). However,
450
the study conducted by Lacity et al. (2008) revealed opposite result; organizational commitment
has no significant correlation to the intention to quit.
Based on several studies that have been disclosed previously, the research hypothesis can be
formulated as follows:
H2: organizational commitment has significant negative effect to the intention to quit
THE RELATIONSHIP OF JOB SATISFACTION AND INTENTION TO QUIT
Job satisfaction is an emotional state in which the employee happens or does not happen having
the intersection between the actual remuneration given by organization with remuneration levels
of the desired value of the employee (Martoyo, 2007). When satisfaction occurs, it is generally
reflected in the feelings of employees towards their work, which is often manifested in the
positive attitude of employees towards work and everything that is faced by or assigned to them
in the workplace. Instead, the work will lead to dissatisfaction in aggressive behavior, or
otherwise indicate withdrawal from contact with the social environment, for leaving the
organization (turnover), play truant, and other negative behaviors that tend to create space from
the activity of the organization (Sutrisno, 2009). Furthermore, it is revealed that job satisfaction
will give implication to several things, such as increasing absenteeism, declining morale, the
incidence of complaints, as well as the employee turnover that is characterized by the
appearance of their intention to quit from the organization.
Job satisfaction is one of the predictors of the intention to quit (Firth et al., 2004; Pack et al.,
2007). Some theories and researches that have been done previously found negative relationship
between job satisfaction and intention to quit (Sims and Kroeck, 1994; Moncrief et al., 1997;
Poon, 2003; Robbins and Judge, 2009; Foon et al., 2010; Paille , 2011). The findings from
research conducted by Mayes and Ganster (1988), Malik et al. (2010), and Scott et al. (2006)
were consistent with the results of previous researches which stated that there was a significant
correlation between job satisfaction and intention to quit. To reduce the high rate of turnover in
the organization, the necessary supervision of the factors forming the satisfaction, both intrinsic
and extrinsic is crucially needed (Firth et al., 2004). However, a study of Elangovan (2001)
contradicts previous research which revealed that job satisfaction has only an indirect
relationship with the intention to quit through organizational commitment. Further said that job
satisfaction had positive direct correlation with organizational commitment.
Based on several studies that have been disclosed previously, the research hypothesis can be
formulated as follows:
H3: Job satisfaction has significant negative effect to the intention to quit
THE RELATIONSHIP OF JOB SATISFACTION AND INTENTION TO QUIT
THROUGH ORGANIZATIONAL COMMITMENT AS MEDIATING VARIABLE
Job satisfaction is a meeting point between the expected value of the remuneration of employees
with the actual value of fringe benefits provided by the organization. When job satisfaction is
achieved it will increase employee’s engagement with the organization and suppress the desire
to leave the organization. Organizational commitment, reflected through three dimensions, i.e.
affective commitment (love the organization), continuous commitment (needs to survive in the
organization), and normative commitment (having to remain in the organization because of
451
particular value), would increase if job satisfaction is achieved, which will affect their intentions
to quit. Thus, it can be said that the organizational commitment acts as a mediator between the
relationship of job satisfaction and the intention to quit.
Several studies have been conducted to estimate the mediating role of organizational
commitment on job satisfaction relationship with the intention to quit. The result of Clugston’s
research (2000) suggested that organizational commitment partially mediated the relationship
between job satisfaction and intention to quit. This result was consistent with previous studies
which stated that only affective commitment that mediated the relationship between job
satisfaction and intentions to quit (Wunder et al. 1982; Schaubroeck et al. 1989; Netemeyer et al.
1995). However, a study conducted by Allen and Meyer (1991) found out that the three-
dimensional organizational commitment had a full mediating role in the relationship between
job satisfaction and intention to quit.
Based on several studies that have been disclosed previously, the research hypothesis can be
formulated as follows:
H4: organizational commitment mediates the effect of job satisfaction on intention to quit
RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
This research is conducted at the Nusa Dua Beach Hotel & Spa Bali which is one among the
five-star hotel in Nusa Dua tourist area. Data collection methods used in this study are
questionnaires and interviews. The population of this research is all permanent and contract
employees with the total number of 591 employees. The sampling technique used in this study is
proportionate stratified sampling, which is selecting respondents proportionally if the condition
of population is heterogeneous and stratified (Sumarni and Wahyuni, 2006). Sample of
population in this research is determined by using Slovin method in Husein Umar (2000) with
10%, tolerable error rate. Before the data is collected, data quality test is conducted (reliability
test and validity test), then the data that has been valid and reliable is analyzed by descriptive
analysis and Partial Least Square analysis using smart PLS. Subsequently, in order to test the
mediating effect, model analysis developed by Baron and Kenny (1986) is applied, which is
causal step method. In implementing test using the causal steps, researchers must estimate the
following three regressions equation (Baron and Kenny, 1986):
1. Single regression equation of mediating variable (M) on independent variable (X): M
= i1 + aX + e1 ……………………….(Equation 1)
2. Single regression equation of dependent variable (Y) on independent variable (X): Y
= i2 + cX + e2 ……….…….…………(Equation 2)
3. Multiple regression equation of dependent variable (Y) on both independent variables
(X) and mediating variable (M):
Y = i3 + c' X + bM + e3 .………………………(Equation 3)
In order to examine the mediation effects between variables, this study adopts the method
suggested by Hair er al (2010). This method is applied in four critical steps, such as:
a. Testing the effect of independent variable on dependent variable in the model by
involving the mediating variable (effect A).
b. Testing the effect of independent variable on dependent variable in the model without
involving the mediating variable (effect B).
c. Testing the effect of independent variable on mediating variable in the model (effect
C).
d. Testing the effect of mediating variable on dependent variable in the model (effect D).
452
Based on the test result of those four effects (effect A, B, C,D), next stage is to prove the
intervention of mediating variable referring to certain criteria:
1) If effect A and C are significant, but effect A is not, then the full mediation is proven.
2) If effect C, D, and A are significant, then the partial mediation is proven.
3) If effect C, D, and A are significant, but path coefficient (standardize) of effect A is
relatively same with effect B, then mediation is not proven in the model.
4) If one of effect C or D is not significant, then mediation in the model is not proven.
RESULTS AND FINDINGS
Goodness of Fit Evaluation – Outer Model (Measurement Model)
To evaluate the goodness of fit of the outer model (measurement model), three things that
should be points of attention are the value of convergent validity, discriminant validity, and
composite reliability.
Calculation of convergent validity aims to find instruments items which can be used as an
indicator of all latent variables. The convergent validity shows that the correlation between
reflective indicator score and loading factor for latent variable between 0,887 – 0,981 (>0,5).
So it can be concluded that these measurements meet the requirements of convergent validity.
In addition to test the convergent validity, the discriminant validity is also tested. The test
method is done by comparing the value of the square root of average variance extracted
(AVE) of the constructs with the correlation between one construct to the other in the model.
If the value of the initial measurement of both methods is better than the value of other
constructs in the model, it can be concluded that the construct has good validity discriminant
value, or otherwise. Discriminant validity shows that the value of square root of Average
Variance Extracted (AVE) for every construct, with correlation between construct within the
model with the value between 0,846 – 0,953 (>0,5). Thus, the conclusion is that these
measurements meet the requirements of discriminant validity.
After testing the validity of the convergent validity and discriminant validity, the last step in
evaluating the goodness of fit of the outer model is reliability testing of the composite
reliability and croanbach's alpha. Composite reliability testing aims to test the reliability of
the instrument in a research model specifically for the reflexive indicator. Based on the
results of the study can be described that the composite reliability test results indicate
satisfactory values, where the value is between 0,957 – 0,985 (>0,7).It means that all
indicators have indeed measured each construct respectively. In addition to composite
reliability, another thing which is considered in the reliability test is croanbach's alpha value.
Test results showed that all latent variables have croanbach's alpha coefficient above 0.7. So
it can be concluded that this measurement meets reliability requirements. Therefore, the result
of validity and reliability analysis show that all of contsructs are deemed valid and reliable.
Goodness of Fit Evaluation - Inner Model (Structural Model)
Goodness of fit testing on inner model (structural model) is using predictive-relevance value
(Q2), which can be calculated from the value of R2 of each endogenous variable. The R
2
values of each endogenous variable are shown in Table. 2:
TABLE 2: ENDOGENOUS VARIABLES R2 VALUE
453
Endogenous Variables R2
Organizational Commitment (X2) 0.389
Intention to Quit (Y) 0.525
The value of predictive-relevance is calculated with the following formula:
Q2 = 1 – ( 1 – R1
2) ( 1 – R2
2 )
Q2 = 1 – (1 – 0.389) (1 – 0,525) = 0.7098
The calculation result shows the predictive-relevance value is 0.7098 (> 0). This means that
70.98% of the variation in the variable of intention to quit as a dependent variable is
explained by the variables used in this model (job satisfaction and organizational
commitment). The rest 29.02% is explained by other factors outside the model. Thus, the
model is considered feasible to have relevant predictive value.
In addition to the value of R-Square, another thing to consider is the loading factor value.
Loading factor value (outer loading) shows the weight of each indicator as a measure of each
variable. The largest loading factor indicates that the indicator is said to be the most dominant
variable gauge, and vice versa. The result of empirical analysis using the Partial Least Square
(PLS) indicates that the loading factor value on variable dimension of job satisfaction is
significantly forming the variables of job satisfaction itself. From the value, job dimension is
identified as the dominant dimension in contributing job satisfaction variable with loading
factor of 0.969. Based on the loading factor value, it can be explained that organizational
commitment variable is shaped significantly by the three dimensions of organizational
commitment. The dominant dimension which forming the organizational commitment is
normative commitment dimension with loading factor of 0,981. Analysis result also shows
that four dimensions of intension to quit have contribution on the variable of intention to quit,
whereas the most dominant dimension is the dimension of the possibility of finding another
job with aloading factor of 0.937.
Hypothesis Testing
The result of hypothesis testing by using Partial Least Square (PLS) shows the four
hypotheses (hypothesis 1 to 4) are stated significant. Hypothesis testing is conducted by using
t-test on every effect path between independent and dependent variables. These results are
shown in Table 3.
TABLE 3 : HYPOTHESIS TESTING
original sample
estimate
mean of
subsamples
Standard
deviation
T-
Statistic
Job sat -> Commitment O 0.632 0.650 0.138 4.565
Job sat -> Intention T -0.361 -0.369 0.194 1.860
Commitment O ->
Intention T -0.437 -0.434 0.192 2.270
454
The analysis using SmartPLS is shown in Figure. 2:
FIGURE 2 : PARTIAL LEAST SQUARE (PLS) ANALYSIS
H1: Job satisfaction has significant positive effect to organizational commitment
Hypothesis testing with PLS approach shows the path coefficients value on direct effect
between job satisfaction and organizational commitment is 0.632 with t-statistics of 4.565.
From these results, it can be seen that the t-statistic is greater than 1.960 (t table), so it was
concluded that the first hypothesis is accepted. This means the higher the job satisfaction of
employees, the higher perceived organizational commitment they have, vice versa. These
results also confirm previous study which argued that there was a positive relationship
between job satisfaction and organizational commitment. The more employees are satisfied,
the higher their organizational commitment. These results are consistent with other researches
that reveal that there is a strong significant correlation between job satisfaction and
organizational commitment (Koh and Boo, 2004; Azeem, 2010; Aydogdu and Asikgil, 2011).
H2: Organization commitment has significant negative effect to intention to quit
Hypothesis testing with PLS approach shows the path coefficients value on direct effect
between organizational commitment and intention to quit is 0.437 with t-statistics of 2.270.
From these results, it can be seen that the t-statistic is greater than 1.960 (t-table), so it was
concluded that the second hypothesis is accepted. This means the higher the organizational
commitment possessed by employees, the lower their intention to leave the organization, vice
versa. Results of this analysis are consistent with results of previous studies, such as research
conducted by the Deconinck and Bachmann (1994), Elangovan (2001), Foon et al. (2010), as
well as Sulu et al. (2010). The study suggested that organizational commitment had
significant negative effect to the intention to quit of the organization. Furthermore it is stated
that the organizational commitment affects turnover intention of employees, both internal and
external (Chou-Kang et al. 2005).
455
H3: Job satisfaction has significant negative effect to intention to quit
Hypothesis testing with PLS approach shows the path coefficients value on direct effect
between job satisfaction and intention to quit is 0.361 with t-statistics of 1.860. From these
results, it can be seen that the t-statistic is smaller than 1.960 (t-table), so it was concluded
that the hypothesis 3 is rejected. That is, job satisfaction felt by employees has no significant
effect on their intention to quit from the organization. This result is not confirming the
previous study conducted by Malik et al. (2010) and Scott et al. (2006) which suggested the
significance in the relationship of job satisfaction and intention to quit. However, it is
consistent with the research finding by Elangovan (2001); it is stated that job satisfaction had
indirect relationship with intention to quit through organizational commitment. This is also
strengthened by the testing result of hypothesis 4.
H4: Organizational commitment mediates the effect of job satisfaction on the intention
to quit
Mediation hypothesis testing with PLS approach refers to rules of thumb suggested by Hair et
al. (2010). From the test results can be seen that the variable of job satisfaction on the
intention to quit has t-statistic value which is smaller than 1.96 (proved in hypothesis 3
testing), so that effect A is not significant. The effect of job satisfaction and organizational
commitment variables show the t-statistic value is more than 1.96 (proved in hypothesis 1
testing), so that effect C is significant. Furthermore, variable of organizational commitment
and intention to quit have t-statistics value above 1.96 also (proved in testing of hypothesis
2), so that effect D is also significant. If effect C and D are significant but effect A is not,
then there is a full mediation proved in the model. In this case the organizational commitment
fully mediates the relationship of job satisfaction and intention to quit. This can be explained
that when employees feel job dissatisfaction, it will affect on the decrease of organizational
commitment before they eventually decide to leave the organization. This result is also
confirming the research finding by Clugston (2000) which suggested that organizational
commitment is partially mediating the relationship of job satisfaction and intention to quit.
This finding is consistent with previous studies (Schaubroeck et al. 1989; Netemeyer et al.
1995).
CONCLUSION
From these results, it can be seen that the variables of organizational commitment are
significantly affecting in suppressing or reducing the employee’s intention to quit. Job
satisfaction variables are not significantly affecting the intention to quit. When employees
feel job dissatisfaction, it will reduce organizational commitment before eventually decide to
leave the organization. Thus the results of this study indicate that these variables need to be
considered by policy-makers and decision-makers in hotel industry, which includes efforts to
improve job satisfaction and organizational commitment to maintain the intention to quit in
low intensity.
Hotel Management can perform various efforts and policies to suppress or reduce the
intention to quit of employees. Attempts to suppress the intention to quit of the employees
can be done through increasing the employee’s job satisfaction which has five dimensions,
such as the work itself, the system of compensation (salaries), career promotion systems,
supervision systems, as well as a conducive working condition. Of the five dimensions, it is
known that satisfaction on the work itself is the most dominant dimension of job satisfaction
in suppressing the intention to quit, which includes job varieties and control over the work
456
procedure and methods. One dimension which is least affected the intention to quit is
satisfaction on career promotion system. In the era of modern management, one of the things
that can increase employee loyalty in the organization is good system of career promotion.
Employees who have the competence and good qualification are supposed to be appreciated
through promotion.
The intention to quit of employees can also be reduced by improving organizational
commitment that has three dimensions namely affective commitment, continuance
commitment, and normative commitment. Of the three dimensions can be seen that the
normative commitment is an indicator which has the most dominant influence on intention to
quit. One dimension which is least affected the intention to quit is continuance commitment.
This disengagement may arise because the lack of positive benefits they can get while
working at this hotel, either financial or non-financial benefits.
REFFERENCES
Allen, N.J. dan J.P. Meyer. 1991. A Three-Component Conceptualization of Organizational
Commitment. Human Resource Management Review, Vol.78, No. 1, pg 61-89.
Allen, N. J. dan J. P. Meyer. 1993. Organizational Commitment: Evidence of Career Stage
Effects ? Journal of Business Research, Vol. 26, No. 1, pg 49-61.
Aydogdu, Sinem dan Baris Asikgil. 2011. An Empirical Study of the Relationship Among
Job Satisfaction, Organizational Commitment, and Turnover Intention. International Review
of Management and Marketing, Vol.1, No.3, pg 43-53.
457
Azeem, Syed Mohammad. 2010. Job Satisfaction and Organizational Commitment Among
Employees in the Sultanate of Oman. Journal of Psychology, Vol.1, No. 1, pg 295-299.
Baron, Reuben M. dan David A. Kenny. 1986. The Moderator-Mediator Variable Distinction
in Social Psychological Research: Conceptual, Strategic, and Statistical Considerations.
Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, Vol.51, No.6, pg 1173-1182.
Chou-Kang, Chiu; Chien Chi-Seng; Lin Chieh-Peng; dan Chin Yun Hsiao. 2005.
Understanding Hospital Employee Job Stress and Turnover Intentions in a Practical Setting:
The Moderating Role of Locus of Control. The Journal of Management Development, Vol.
24, No. 10, pg 837-855.
Clugston, Michael. 2000. The Mediating Effects of Multidimensional Commitment on Job
Satisfaction and Intent to Leave. Journal of Organizational Behavior, Vol.21, No.4, pg 477-
486.
DeConinck, James B dan Duane P. Bachmann. 1994. Organizational Commitment and
Turnover Intentions of Marketing Managers. Journal of Applied Business Research, Vol. 10,
No. 3, pg 87-95.
Elangovan, A.R. 2001. Causal Ordering of Stress, Satisfaction, and Commitment, and
Intention To Quit : A Structural Equation Analysis. Leadership and Organization
Development Journal; 2001; Vol. 22, No. 4; pg 159-165.
Firth, Lucy; David J. Mellor,; Kathleen A. Moore; dan Claude Loquet. 2004. How Can
Managers Reduce Employee Intention to Quit?. Journal of Managerila Psychology, Vol. 19,
No. 2, pg 170-187.
Foon,Yeoh Sok; Lim Chee Leong; dan Syuhaily Osman. 2010. An Exploratory Study on
Turnover Intention Among Private Sector Employees. International Journal of Business and
Management, Vol. 5, No. 8, pg 57-64.
Gentry, James W.; Linda K. Good; dan Grovalynn F. Sisler. 1988. Antecedents of Turnover
Intentions Among Retail Management Personnel. Journal of Retailing, Vol. 64, No. 3, pg
295-314.
Hair, J. F. Jr; R.E. Anderson; R.L. Tatham. dan W.C. Blanck. 2006. Multivariate Data
Analysis, 6th edition. Upper Saddle River, Prentice Hall International, Inc.
Hair,J.F.Jr; William C. Black; Barry J. Babin; dan Rolph E. Anderson. 2010. Multivariate
Data Analysis, 7th
edition. Global Edition, Pearson.
Jaramillo, Fernando; Robert Nixon; dan Doreen Sams. 2005. The Effect of Law Enforcement
Stress on Organizational Commitment. Policing: An International Journal of Police
Strategies and Management, Vol. 28, No. 2, pg. 321-336.
Koh, Hian Chye dan El’fred H.Y. Boo. 2004. Organizational Ethics and Employee
Satisfaction and Commitment. Management Decision, Vol.42, No.4, pg 677-693.
458
Lambert, E.G; N.L. Hogan; M.L. Griffin. 2007. The Impact of Distributive and Procedural
Justice on Correctional Staff Job Stress, Job Satisfaction, and Organizational Commitment.
Journal of Criminal Justice, Vol. 35, No. 3, pg. 644-656.
Luthans, Fred. 2006. Perilaku Organisasi, Edisi kesepuluh. Jakarta : Andi Offset.
Malik, Muhammad Imran; Arsyad Zaheer; M. Aslam Khan; dan Mehboob Ahmed. 2010.
Developing and Testing a Model of Burnout at Work and Turnover Intentions Among
Doctors in Pakistan. International Journal of Business and Management. Vol. 5, No. 10, pg.
234-247.
Malik, Omer Farooq; Aamer Waheed; dan K.U.R. Malik. 2010. The Mediating Effects of Job
Satisfaction on Role Stressors and Affective Commitment. International Journal of Business
and Management, Vol.5, No.11, pg 223-235.
Martoyo, Susilo. 2007. Management of Human Resources. Yogyakarta : BPFE.
Netemeyer, R.G.; S. Burton; dan M.W. Johnson. 1995. A Nested Comparison of Four Models
of the Consequences of Role Perception Variables. Organizational Behavior and Human
Decision Process, Vol.61, No.1, pg 77-93.
Pack, Tresvil G; Richard T Roessler; Rona Turner; dan Judith Robertson. 2007. Predictions
of Turnover Intentions among Employed Adults with Multiple Sclerosis. Journal of
Rehabilitations. Vol. 73, No. 3, pg 26-35.
Purwanto, Erwan Agus and Dyah Ratih Sulistyastuti. 2007. Metode Penelitian Kuantitatif
Administrasi Publik dan Masalah-Masalah Sosial. Yogyakarta: Gava Media.
Riduan Engkos and Achmad Kuncoro. 2007. Cara Menggunakan dan Memaknai Analisis
Jalur (Path Analysis). Cetakan Pertama. Bandung : Alfabeta
Schaubroeck, J.; J.L. Cotton; dan K.R. Jennings. 1989. Antecedents and Concequences of
Role Stress : a Covariance Structure Analysis. Journal of Organization Behavior, Vol. 10,
No.1, pg 35-38.
Scott, Anthony; Hugh Gravelle; Steven Simoens; Chris Bojke; dan Bonnie Sibbald. 2006. Job
Satisfaction and Quitting Intentions: A Structural Model of British General Practitioners.
British Journal of Industrial Relations, Vol. 44, No. 3, pg. 519-540.
Simamora, Henry. 2004. Manajemen Sumber Daya Manusia, Edisi Ketiga. Yogyakarta:
Bagian Penerbitan Sekolah Tinggi Ilmu Ekonomi YKPN.
Sugiyono. 2010. Statistika untuk Penelitian. Bandung : Alfabeta.
Sulu, Seyfettin; Adnan Ceylan; dan Ramazan Kaynak. 2010. Work Alienation as a Mediator
of the Relationship Between Organizational Injustice and Organizational Commitment:
Implications for Healtcare Professionals. International Journal of Business and Management,
Vol. 5, No. 8, pg. 27-38.
459
Yang, Yuh Cheng; Jui Chu Ma; Pi Hsia Lee; dan Wen Yin Chang. 2009. Predicting Factors
Related to Nurses’ Intention to Leave, Job Satisfaction, and Perception of Quality of Care in
Acute Care Hospitals. Nursing Economics, May-June 2009, Vol.27, No. 3, pg 178-202.
Yuli, Sri Budi Cantika. 2005. Manajemen Sumber Daya Manusia. Malang : Universitas
Muhammadiyah.
460
MANAGING EXECUTIVE EDUCATION IN VIETNAM
– A SWISS PERSPECTIVE
Tobias Hüttche University of Applied Sciences and Arts Northwestern Switzerland
(tobias.huettche@fhnw.ch)
Uta Milow University of Applied Sciences and Arts Northwestern Switzerland
(uta.milow@fhnw.ch)
ABSTRACT
The School of Business of the University of Applied Sciences and Arts Northwestern Switzerland
(FHNW) is - given the level of internationalization - leading amongst their fellow institutions in
Switzerland. The internationalization of Business Education is a key element in mission and strategy.
From summer schools and short term programs to dual degree and doctoral studies the FHNW is
offering students and lecturers from Switzerland and abroad a wide range of opportunities to "learn
by comparing". Cooperations with ASEAN countries and universities are core: About 1'000 students
have yet graduated from programs in Vietnam, similar projects are currently discussed with partners
in Indonesia. As in the management of every project, structure (i.e. curricula, lecturers, target group,
audience and financials), process (i.e. enrollment, examination and graduation) and management
(i.e. local representatives, compensation of in- and outbound lecturers, travel expenses) are key for
the success of these programs. Additionally the Swiss perspective has to be considered: Thus a small
country, it is home to leading global companies (as Nestlé, Novartis or ABB) and is equalized with the
financial industry (for the good and the bad). Located in the heart of Europe, Switzerland is not part
of the European Union (EU). Towards ASEAN countries, this situation bears chances but also pitfalls.
Keywords: Business Education, Economics, Education, Teaching, Teaching of Economics, Degree Program
JEL classification numbers: A20, A23, I25.
461
1. Introduction
During the last centuries, Switzerland evolved from an alliance of rural formed cantons into a highly
industrialized and service oriented confederation. The number of employed in the tertiary sector
almost doubled over the last 50 years: In 2014 75% of all employees in Switzerland work in service
industries (1960: 39%), 22% in production, manufacturing and trade (1960: 47%) and only 3% in
agriculture (1960: 14%) (BFS 2015b, G 3.1). Thus job profiles and job descriptions were changing and
- consequently - the educational and training system had to respond to this development. As to our
knowledge, Switzerland is the only country, with a constitutional obligation of the state, to promote
and govern the continuing education (Art. 64a BV). Hence, a separate federal law on continuing
education provides detailed regulations and procedures (Bundesgesetz über die Weiterbildung,
WeBiG). Today Switzerland is in a leading position when it comes to continuing education and
lifelong learning (WEF 2015, p. 9).
Compared to the educational systems in other countries, the Swiss system is highly stratified and
qualifying (Weber/Tremel 2008, p. 11). Individuals are early graded, selected and assigned to defined
educational paths. Along these paths, individuals are trained to a specific job. This early
determination is hard to alter. To do so, further education is key: Certificates and Diplomas are
signalizing that the holder is employable on a higher level or in another context. Accordingly,
Switzerland is one of the leading countries when it comes to lifelong learning (WEF 2015, p. 15).
The Universities of Applied Sciences (UAS) play an important role in the Swiss economic and
educational system. First, they are an intermediary between the vocational training and the
academic education. Second, they offer executive education with more and more graduates
returning to their alma mater to take part in their programs. The UAS take in account the ongoing
globalization by internationalizing their programs.
Switzerland takes on a special position: geographically in the heart of Europe, it is not part of the
European Union (EU) but entangled with their countries. Immigration of highly qualified employees
and the solid Swiss Franken are among the reasons for constant wealth and prosperity. Recently this
benefit is also seen as a burden: The Swiss Franken is said to be overrated and hampers the export.
In a plebiscite the people of Switzerland have decided to limit the immigration. These recent
developments have an impact on the market of further education, especially the international off
shore programs.
In the following we discuss aspects of managing executive education in Vietnam from a Swiss
perspective.
2. Executive Education in Switzerland
2.1. Economy, corporate structure and demography as driver
Switzerland has become a highly developed country, driven by the financial and pharmaceutical
sector. The Swiss Economy is strongly segmented, given the number and the size of the entities:
462
From the 557'829 companies, only 1'256 have more than 250 employees. 514'736 companies have
less than 10 employees (BFS 2014a). About 60% of the entities are sole proprietorships and only 40%
are organized as companies with a limited liability (BFS 2014a).
The importance of SME is often pointed out and they are seen as the backbone of the Swiss
economy, given their low volatility and consistent development (BFS 2008, p. 73 ff.). So the Swiss
policy is explicitly "SME friendly". Despite their size, Swiss SMEs have strong international ties.
Around seven out of ten SMEs are involved in at least one direct or indirect cross-border business
activity (Credit Suisse 2014, p. 18 ff.): SMEs account for an estimated 20% of total Swiss exports of
goods. The machinery, electrical engineering and metals (MEM) industry is responsible for the
majority of SME exports, while the proportion of pharmaceutical/chemical exports in total SME
exports is relatively low.
In the 19th century, Switzerland has been an emigration country. This stopped around 1890 due to
the industrialization and the need for skilled workforce. Since then Switzerland has become one of
the most important immigration countries in Europe: In 1910 already 15% of the Swiss residents
were foreign nationals, 2015 it is about 23% (BFS 2015a). Reasons are the economic and political
stability, but also the pull effect of the Swiss economy.
Switzerland is a relatively small country with geographical limitations. The Alps cover 60% of
Switzerland, so land, appropriate for cultivation, industrial use and housing is limited. Agriculture
and industry are competing for land, additionally the demand for living space is increasing. The Swiss
economy is geographical concentrated but international orientated and globalized. Accordingly, the
share of highly skilled employment is at about 50% and therefore - after Luxembourg - at rank 2 in
Europe and Central Asia (WEF 2015, p. 39). Swiss companies - despite their size - look for employees
who think and act within an international perspective.
2.2. Business Education
The importance of SMEs for the Swiss economy has a direct impact on the system of business
education. SMEs need practically orientated employees, so practical training and hands-on
experience is still seen as the silver bullet for a professional career.
Corresponding to this, about 75 % of the pupils attend secondary school and start a vocational
training, 25% attend grammar school (BFS 2013). When finishing school, about 75% of the latter go
to a university. The Swiss model of the vocational training is no mere training on the job, but a dual
track of continuing classroom and industrial training. The success of this approach has been proven
and it is seen as best practice by a number of other countries (NZZ, 2015).
To meet the challenges of a changing economy and new evolving job profiles, since the mid-1990s
the universities of applied sciences (UAS) provide practical training at tertiary A level. UAS have a
legal mandate to do the following: offer degree programs and continuing education and training
programs, conduct applied research and render services. The first universities of applied sciences
were introduced in Switzerland in the mid-1990s. At the time, this type of higher education
institution was intended to revitalize the economy and provide greater value to Switzerland’s
463
successful upper-secondary level VET sector and tertiary B level PET sector by establishing linkages
to the tertiary A sector. In 1998, various tertiary B level professional colleges (Höhere Technische
Lehranstalt (Ingenieurschule) HTL, Höhere Wirtschafts- und Verwaltungsschule HWV, Höhere
Fachschule für Gestaltung HFG) were merged to form today’s tertiary A level UAS. At the end of
2003, the Federal Council gave unlimited approval to seven public UAS, each covering a different
region of Switzerland.
The Swiss educational System is highly pervious. With an additional year in School, the apprentices
get a vocational diploma, which allows to study at an UAS. During the last decade, more than 50% of
the graduates start at one of the Swiss UAS (BFS 2013). Most of the UAS - like FHNW - offer extra-
occupational studies.
464
2.3. Executive Education
As to ensure both, the perviousness and performance of the educational system, quality control is a
key element. Certificates and Diplomas are therefore signaling capability and skills of the students.
Swiss employees are highly motivated to educate themselves: 55% of all employees between 25 and
64 years take part in formal or informal activities of continuing education (BFS 2010, p. 10). . To
adapt or change their educational and professional profile, it needs continuing education and
certificated studies. In these efforts, the employees are supported by their employers: About 53%
get financial support, be it by covering the fees or granting off-time (BFS 2010, p. 8). Traditionally,
the UAS are leading in the executive education in Switzerland, partly due to their approach to
"apply" science, partly because more and more executives attended these schools and return to
their alma mater.
The Executive Education in Switzerland is more subtle than in other European countries. Besides the
usual MBA and E-MBA programs are the so called Master of Advanced Studies (MAS) well
established. A MAS consists of about 60 ECTS and takes about two years of extra-occupational
studies. The students reduce their workload to about 80 to 90%, the lectures are accordingly on
weekends and/or en bloc. More and more MAS are split in modules, so called Certificates of
Advanced Studies (CAS), with about 15 ECTS. To earn a MAS degree, it takes usually three CAS and a
master thesis. According to the profile of the MAS, students can chose out of variety of CAS. So they
can set their own marks and follow their preferences. Another important difference is that a
universities degree - as Bachelor or another Diploma - is not mandatory for the admission to the
programs. The regulations allow a certain percentage of students with no academic but proven
professional background ("sur dossier").
Since the professional world of the students goes global, the executive education has to follow.
Whilst it is clear that programs on Banking, Controlling or Corporate Finance have an international
"DNA", also presumably local contents as HR must show global cross references. This development is
challenging both, the students and the institutions. The FHNW chose a two sided approach to step
up to the plate: First by a consequent and visible international reference in the national programs
("on shore"), second by developing programs for an international market ("off shore"). The off shore
programs are both, inbound and outbound: FHNW offers focused short terms (i.e. tourism, finance,
agriculture) for Executives form China, and E-MBAs and MAS in Vietnam.
3. Swissness in Executive Education- Benefit and Burden
Swissness is - in legal terms - a declaration of the origin of products and goods. Recently various
parliamentary procedural requests have called for a strengthening of the ‘Made in Switzerland’
designation. It also has connotations of precision, meticulousness, reliability and thoroughness. It
refers to a country that is rich in various cultures, cosmopolitan and open to the world. So Swissness
is an equivalent for high quality and after all an invaluable selling argument for the offshore
executive education.
465
On the other hand, the latest developments shadowed this picture: Switzerland is not part of the EU,
but bound to it by various agreements, among others the bilateral guarantee of freedom of
movement. In a plebiscite in 2014 the Swiss people decided with a narrow majority of 50.3% to limit
the immigration to Switzerland. The EU already declared the principle of freedom of movement as
not negotiable and consequently excluded Switzerland from various programs, also affecting the
international exchange of students (ERASMUS).
Switzerland is known for a high living standard but also high prices. The spread to other countries
has been significantly increased by the decision of the Swiss National Bank (SNB) to terminate the
minimum price of the Swiss Franken in January 2015. Since then, and fueled by the Greece crisis, the
Swiss currency revaluated continuously. This makes it hard for off shore programs in both directions:
the outbound products got more expensive, the inbound products - due to the risen costs of living
for the foreign students - less attractive.
4. Executive Education in Vietnam - Executive Master of Business
Administration (EMBA) FHNW Degree Programs
Vietnam is for the University of Applied Sciences and Arts Northwestern Switzerland (FHNW) one of
the countries with a long-lasting tradition of university cooperation in various programs. The
following aspects in paragraph 4 describe FHNW experiences in implementing and running several
executive education programs on Master-level.
The first EMBA-Management Consulting International course started in January 2010 in
cooperation with the HCMC University of Technology in Ho Chi Minh City. The HCMC
University of Technology is a well-known university in Vietnam and has a very good
reputation. This program is one of the world pioneer EMBA programs that provide
management consulting education. The management consulting education is also available
at the University of Applied Sciences and Arts Northwestern Switzerland (FHNW) as an Area
of Specialization in the General Management EMBA. Associations of Management
Consultants in Europe and elsewhere support the initiative.
In response to the Vietnamese society’s urgent need of personal development and career
enhancement, an EMBA with its unique training program is helping ambitious students to
strengthen their expertise in consulting and related professions.
466
The Executive MBA - EMBA is a general management program in a Vietnamese-Swiss
Cooperation between the FPT University - School of Business (FSB) and the University of
Applied Sciences Northwestern Switzerland FHNW – School of Business. It also started in
2010. The FHNW General Management EMBA is a holistic post-graduate management
education at the premises of FSB.
In cooperation with the Ho Chi Minh City Banking University, the Executive MBA in Banking
and Finance started in 2005. Over 600 students have graduated from this programme which
is taught part-time in Vietnam but also includes a 3-week study trip to Switzerland.
To complete the list, we also have one joint program on Bachelor’s level. The BSc Business
Administration in International Management programme is jointly delivered with our
partner organization, the Banking University HCMC in Vietnam. As we focus on Executive
Education in this paper, this programme will not be examined.
4.1. Single or Dual Degree? MBA or E(xecutive) MBA?
When starting a joint degree program, both universities have to decide on many variables that
define the cooperation. A contract or memorandum of agreement is signed that includes this and
the following issues, among others. First, the type of degree must be defined.
A joint degree is a study program that two universities, normally from two different countries, jointly
develop from the scratch. Students can switch and study at one or the other university.
For a double degree two universities offer two very similar programs. Both universities accept
performance records from the other university. If students study parts of the program at both
universities, they will receive two degrees. If they stay only at their home university, they will be
awarded only one degree.
The division between those two types of cooperation is not strict and both terms might be used
either way.
Another form of cooperation is a single degree that is offered on more than one campus. That is, a
university offers a program also in a foreign country. Lectures take place at the foreign partner
university’s campus, lecturers come from both universities but teach according to the one
curriculum that is given. This is what we at FHNW mostly have. The advantage for the students is
that they can receive an accredited degree from a university that they could not easily visit for the
467
whole study period. Because of a given accreditation the program cannot be adapted very much –
otherwise the accreditation would become invalid. The foreign university can but doesn’t have to
award an additional own degree. For this degree the students have to finish some more courses that
are not part of the accredited FHNW-program. This second degree can be attractive both for the
foreign university that shows its contribution and for the students who also receive a local degree.
The title MBA or Executive MBA/EMBA today is often used as a synonym. Traditionally, an EMBA
was shorter, always part-time and participants were middle to high management, “executives”.
Nowadays, the range of programs is very broad. In some countries students go for the MBA right
after finishing their Bachelor’s degree (India), and these will be mostly full-time programs. In other
countries students have to have several years of practical experience, preferable in management
positions, before they can join a MBA or EMBA program. In Switzerland, for example, practical
experience is a prerequisite for the studies, and students continue their full-time job while in the
program. And we have only the EMBA, no Swiss MBA programs by government regulation.
4.2. Division of tasks and program management
A clear division of tasks is important for the success of the program. This includes financial issues,
lecturing and program management. Normally, both universities appoint a program manager. With a
single degree program, the university who awards the diploma has the lead and is responsible for
quality control, curriculum and appointing lecturers.
Critical issues in everyday program management can arise from a different understanding of
academic standards. Students can be seen as “customers – they pay, therefore they should get the
diploma in any case”. Other universities will have the strict academic view with high standards –
some students will fail, which is seen as a sign for a demanding high quality program and
improvement of the reputation. Of course, a different understanding in this regard causes conflicts.
Steering committee meetings at regular intervals will be necessary to keep in touch. Many details
can be arranged via email. Personal meetings strengthen the goals and joint understanding of the
program, though. In case of problems they often are the only way to solve them – especially with
Asian collaboration partners. Here the personal relationship seems to be even more important than
in European cultures.
Many conflicts can be prevented with a detailed agreement. The contract that both universities sign
should include:
type of program with detailed description, number of teaching days and curriculum
schedule of setting up the program, marketing plan
468
location of teaching, arrangement of study visits abroad
tuition fees, admission procedures
division of revenues between universities, payment scheme if required
tasks and responsibilities of both universities, cost coverage
copyright, documentation, legal and other general agreements
appendix with module descriptions, study regulations, schedules, and other useful
documents
4.3. Lecturing
Lectures are held by lecturers from both universities on the premises of the partner universities in
Vietnam. Therefore the Swiss professors have to travel, and the willingness to teach abroad
generally is high. The share of FHNW lectures, though, depends on the course content, on the ability
of the partner university to arrange courses with their lecturers and on costs. Switzerland being a
high-price and high-wage country, we cannot send too many lecturers to our partner universities.
The flights, accommodation and the comparatively higher salary of Swiss professors generate costs
that limit the Swiss participation in the programs. Normally, about 40% of lectures will be held by
Swiss professors and 60% by the partner institution.
4.4. Finance
As a first step, both partners have to get an idea about the division of tasks, including lectures. Next,
both universities calculate their costs for conducting their defined part of the program. Third, a
market oriented and realistic students’ fee for the program is identified. With the overall costs, the
minimum number of students per intake is defined.
From our experience, the best way to organize the program is to let the partner university do the
marketing and recruitment. They know the local market for international EMBA programs best and
also know how to address the prospective students. FHNW helps with information sessions if one of
the professors is around.
FHNW gets a lump-sum payment when both sides agree to start with a new intake, that is when the
group size is sufficient. This lump-sum covers all costs that are related to FHNW’s tasks. The partner
university will only agree to start when their costs are also covered, of course. As they have the
responsibility for the recruitment, they have the risk of initial investment in marketing but possibly a
469
too small group to start with. But they also have the chance to make a profit with the program if the
students’ group size extends the minimum group size. This can be quite attractive for the partner
university – FHNW will not claim any part of this profit but only will get the lump-sum. This
arrangement proofed to be of mutual benefit for both partners.
4.5. Local representative
Another finding is the high benefit of a local representative of our School of Business. For running
international programs a similar understanding of quality and process management is helpful. If we
have a local person who is also familiar with Western/European cultures, travel needs for FHNW are
reduced a lot. This person can be a professor or manager from the partner university or an
independent academic who acts as a consultant.
The local representative contributes to the negotiations of the general arrangements and can be the
local program manager. He or she manages administrative details and mediates between the
cultures. Normally, the representative also gives lectures in the program.
4.6. Benefits on both sides
Internationalization of business became more and more important over the years. The worldwide
trade volume multiplied many times since the mid 1950ies (UNCTAD, 2012, p. 12) not only among
industrial countries but in recent decades also with and among developing countries.
Thus, international management is an important part of most management and leadership training
programs. International management includes many different aspects: strategic management in an
international context, types of international activities of companies, international flow of capital,
and intercultural learning. The intercultural experience and both the achieving of local business and
international management skills in foreign countries is a focus of the FHNW EMBA program. In
cooperation with a foreign partner university these goals can be reached more easily than in any
other program setting. There are benefits for the students but also for the faculty. Lecturers
intensify their international experience with teaching abroad and get to know faculty members from
the partner university. Lecturers from both partner institutions are included in curriculum
development. If both partner universities see a mutual benefit of the internationalization of
programs, there will be a long-term and fruitful cooperation.
One good way of experiencing the culture of the partnering country are study trips that are part of
the EMBA program. Vietnamese students visit Switzerland for two to three weeks and have a mix of
lectures and company visits during this stay. They meet Swiss students and can explore the Swiss
mountains and cultural heritage on the weekends.
4.7. The market for international MBA and EMBA programs –
competition
470
When we started our EMBA General Management in Hanoi and EMBA Management Consulting
International in Ho Chi Minh City both in 2010, there were already several other programs from
international and Vietnamese universities. In Hanoi we experienced a first mover advantage for a
bilingual program: teaching language was Vietnamese with in-class translation from English speaking
professors. Larger groups and several intakes per year showed the success of the program. With
English being the major language for international business, we switched to an all-English second
year of this EMBA program. Other English EMBA and MBA programs compete in a slowly growing
market. English skills are not sufficient for studying in this language for some applicants. The overall
level of English is lower in Hanoi than in Ho Chi Minh City which reduces the number of potential
students.
For the EMBA Management Consulting International program the partner universities took a
different approach. From the beginning Ho Chi Minh University of Technology introduced the
consulting topic as a special feature of the program. Besides information events with an introducing
speech, other marketing instruments were used. Once a year an all-day consulting event gathers
several hundred participants and is a very good way of introducing the program. Regular “consulting
cafés” on a weekend morning give some more informal input and encourage discussion among the
participants. After some years now, this strategy is successful with regular starts of new intakes.
One way of standing out in the crowd is getting a well reputed accreditation from an international
agency. FHNW received FIBAA accreditiation for the EMBA Management Consulting International
program and aims for AACSB accreditation for the School of Business in a few years.
To sum up, there are many universities offering similar MBA and EMBA programs. For a successful
implementation of a program, active marketing management is necessary. This marketing mix
proofed to be effective in FHNW programs in Vietnam:
website with detailed information and regular updates
brochure
individual information via telephone, email, personal meeting
information events, if possible with an FHNW professor and a sample lecture
frequent contribution on facebook, twitter and other social media (the EMBA MCI program
has almost 36’000 followers on facebook!)
special actions like all-day events, once-a-month open and informal morning meetings (like
“consulting café”) with a business topic, and else
471
5. Short-term programs, other forms of cooperation and new cooperation
partners
Short-term programs like summer schools are more easily to handle than degree programs. The
students stay enrolled at their home university and visit the foreign partner university for some
weeks. The responsibility for the program is solely with the inviting university. Therefore no division
of tasks among the cooperating universities is necessary. Like other forms of students’ exchange, a
Summer School offers both content input and intercultural experience for the students. Normally,
students can get credits for participation at their home university. Summer schools, students’ and
lecturers’ exchange are forms of initial cooperation that can be followed by a joint program like the
ones described in this paper.
Currently we are in the process of implementing a joint EMBA program with Telkom University in
Bandung, Indonesia. The procedure follows the settings that we described in this paper for the
Vietnamese projects and we are looking forward to start the first intake early in 2015.
472
References
BFS (2008): KMU-Landschaft im Wandel, Neuchâtel 2008.
BFS (2010): Teilnahme an Weiterbildung in der Schweiz - Erste Ergebnisse des Moduls
"Weiterbildung" der Schweizerischen Arbeitskräfteerhebung 2009, Neuchâtel 2010.
BFS (2013): Bildungssystem Schweiz - Übertrittsquoten Maturität HS, Berufs- und Allgemeinbildung
auf der Sekundarstufe II.
BFS (2014a): Arbeitgeberunterstützte Weiterbildung - Weiterbildungsaktive Unternehmen und
unterstützte Arbeitnehmende, Neuchâtel 2014.
BFS (2014b): Statistik der Unternehmensstruktur STATENT.
BFS (2015a): Ausländer, Ausländerinnen in der Schweiz.
BFS (2015b): Arbeit und Erwerb - Panorama, 2015.
Credit Suisse (2014): Success Factors for Swiss SMEs, 2014.
Eidgenössisches Volkswirtschaftsdepartement EVD (2011): Vernehmlassung zu einem Bundesgesetz
über die Weiterbildung (WeBiG), erläuternder Bericht, Bern 2011.
NZZ (2015): Neue Zürcher Zeitung vom 9.1.2015, Begehrte Schweizer "Lehre"
UNCTAD (Ed.). (2012). Development and Globalization: Facts and Figures 2012: United Nations.
Weber, Karl / Tremel, Patricia (2008): Expertise Weiterbildung - Ein institutioneller Blick, Universität
Bern, Koordinationsstelle für Weiterbildung, 2008.
WEF (2015): World Economic Forum - The Human Capital Report 2015.
Recommended